0% found this document useful (0 votes)
500 views

Manual Unidrive M700 - Parameters Guide RFC-A Modus PDF

Uploaded by

Wouter Janssen
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
0% found this document useful (0 votes)
500 views

Manual Unidrive M700 - Parameters Guide RFC-A Modus PDF

Uploaded by

Wouter Janssen
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
You are on page 1/ 653

Parameter Reference Guide

Unidrive M700
RFC-A Mode

Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)


About Parameter Reference Guide
The manufacturer accepts no liability for any consequences resulting from inappropriate, negligent or incorrect installation or adjustment of the optional
operating parameters of the equipment or from mismatching the variable speed drive with the motor.

The contents of this guide are believed to be correct at the time of printing. In the interests of a commitment to a policy of continuous development and
improvement, the manufacturer reserves the right to change the specification of the product or its performance, or the contents of the guide, without
notice.

All rights reserved. No parts of this guide may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electrical or mechanical including
photocopying, recording or by an information storage or retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publisher.

Copyright © August 2019 Control Techniques Ltd


Issue Number: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)

Unidrive M700 Firmware Version: V01.21.00.00


Slot 4 (Ethernet) Firmware Version: V02.09.00.06

Unidrive M700 Project Last Modified: 23-Jul-2019 09:50:05


Slot 4 (Ethernet) Project Last Modified: 20-Feb-2019 11:35:16

HTML Generator Version: 4.0.3.30104

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


2 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter mm.000
Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) is one parameter that can be accessed from every drive menu so that the user can initiate various actions by setting a
value in this parameter and then performing a drive reset. If the action is completed successfully parameter mm.000 is cleared when the action is
complete. If the action is not started because the value does not correspond to an action, or because the action is not allowed (i.e. an attempt is made
to load defaults and the drive is enabled), parameter mm.000 is not cleared. If the action is started and then fails a trip is produced and parameter
mm.000 is not cleared.

There could be some conflict between the actions of Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) and Parameter Cloning (11.042) when the drive is reset. If
Parameter Cloning (11.042) has a value of 1 or 2 and a valid action is required from the value of parameter mm.000 then only the action required by
parameter mm.000 is performed, but on successful completion of the action both parameters are cleared. If Parameter Cloning (11.042) has any other
value it is not affected.

The table below shows the possible actions that can be initiated with Parameter mm.000 (mm.000).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 3
Parameter
mm.000
Action Possible failures
(mm.000)
value
No action if the drive is in the under voltage state (i.e.
Save drive user save parameters to non-volatile memory. Power- Under Voltage Active (10.016)), or
1000 down save parameters are saved when the drive enters the under Low Under Voltage Threshold Select (06.067) =1 or
voltage state. Backup Supply Mode Enable (06.068) = 1 or User Supply Select
(06.072).
Save drive parameters to non-volatile memory. It should be noted that
1001 power-down save parameters are also saved which will result in one
background task scan being extended to 100ms.
1070 Reset all option modules
1233 Load 50Hz defaults No action if the drive is enabled
Load 50Hz defaults to all menus except option module menus (i.e 15
1234 No action if the drive is enabled
to 20 and 24 to 28)
1244 Load 60Hz defaults No action if the drive is enabled
Load 60Hz defaults to all menus except option module menus (i.e 15
1245 No action if the drive is enabled
to 20 and 24 to 28)
1253 Change drive mode and load 50Hz defaults No action if the drive is enabled
1254 Change drive mode and load 60Hz defaults No action if the drive is enabled
Change drive mode and load 50Hz defaults except for menus 15 to
1255 No action if the drive is enabled
20 and 24 to 28
Change drive mode and load 60Hz defaults except for menus 15 to
1256 No action if the drive is enabled
20 and 24 to 28
1299 Reset Stored HF trip.
Create a boot file on a non-volatile media card based on the present
2001 Non-volatile media card trips
drive parameters including all Menu 20 parameters
4xxx NV media card: Transfer the drive parameters to parameter file xxx Non-volatile media card trips
NV media card: Transfer the onboard user program to onboard user
5xxx Non-volatile media card trips
program file xxx
NV media card: Load the drive parameters from parameter file xxx or No action if the drive is enabled
6xxx
the onboard user program from onboard user program file xxx Non-volatile media card trips
7xxx NV media card: Erase file xxx Non-volatile media card trips
8xxx NV Media card: Compare the data in the drive with file xxx Non-volatile media card trips
9555 NV media card: Clear the warning suppression flag Non-volatile media card trips
9666 NV media card: Set the warning suppression flag Non-volatile media card trips
9777 NV media card: Clear the read-only flag Non-volatile media card trips
9888 NV media card: Set the read-only flag Non-volatile media card trips
9999 NV media card: Erase and format the NV media card Non-volatile media card trips

If a drive interface is selected (i.e. S = 0):

If a suitable feedback device is not available then


parameter zero will remain at the value set and no action
will be taken.
If the device does not respond, or there is a comms error or
the CRC of the nameplate data is incorrect then a trip is
Transfer electronic nameplate data from an encoder into drive initated.
parameters.
110SI I is the interface: 1=P1 position feedback interface, 2=P2 position If an option module interface is selected (i.e. S = 1, 2, 3 or 4):
feedback interface.
S is the source: 0=drive, 1=Option Slot 1, ... 4=Option Slot 4. If the selected option module is not present or does not
support the electronic nameplate function then the system
will time out and initiate a trip.
If the device does not respond, or there is a comms error or
the CRC of the nameplate data is incorrect then a trip is
initated.

See Name Plate for more details on the trips.

Only display parameters that are different from their default value.
12000
This action does not require a drive reset.
Only display parameters that are used to set-up destinations (i.e. DE
12001
format bit is 1). This action does not require a drive reset.
Deletes an onboard user program if a program is present. No action if the drive is enabled.
No action if there is no program present.
59999
Note: Any parameter changes that have not been saved will be lost No action if the user program is enabled (i.e.
during this action. Onboard User Program: Enable (11.047) = 1)

If xxx is between 001 and 999 the system is cloned on to an SD card


if fitted.
No action if the drive is enabled.
This system has been partially implemented, so initiating this process
40xxx The drive will trip if the requested back-up data already exists or an
creates the back-up structure on the SD card but does not copy any
option module does respond correctly during the process.
drive or option module data. Future development is required to
complete this function.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


4 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
If xxx is between 001 and 999 the system is cloned from an SD card if
fitted.
60xxx This system has not been implemented, but parameter mm.000 is No action if the drive is enabled.
reset if a value between 60001 and 60999 is entered and the drive is
reset. Future development is required to complete this function.

Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) values from 1 to 14 are equivalent to other values as shown in the table below to allow easy access to some commonly
used functions. For 0 and each of these values the keypad provides a string as shown.

Value String Equivalent value Action


0 [No Action] 0
1 [Save parameters] 1001 Save drive parameters to non-volatile memory
2 [Load file 1] 6001 Load the data from file 1 on a non-volatile media card into the drive provided it is a parameter file
3 [Save to file 1] 4001 Store the drive parameters in file 1 on a non-volatile media card
4 [Load file 2] 6002 Load the data from file 2 on a non-volatile media card into the drive provided it is a parameter file
5 [Save to file 2] 4002 Store the drive parameters in file 2 on a non-volatile media card
6 [Load file 3] 6003 Load the data from file 3 on a non-volatile media card into the drive provided it is a parameter file
7 [Save to file 3] 4003 Store the drive parameters in file 3 on a non-volatile media card
8 [Show non-default] 12000 Only display parameters that are different from their default value
9 [Destinations] 12001 Only display parameters that are used to set-up destinations
10 [Reset 50Hz defs] 1233 Load 50Hz defaults
11 [Reset 60Hz defs] 1244 Load 60Hz defaults
12 [Reset modules] 1070 Reset all option modules
13 [Read Enc. NP P1] 11001 Encoder electronic nameplate transfer from the encoder connected to drive P1 interface to the drive.
14 [Read Enc. NP P2] 11051 Encoder electronic nameplate transfer from the encoder connected to drive P2 interface to the drive.

Saving drive parameters


User-save and power-down save drive parameters are stored in non-volatile memory within the drive. Any values that have changed are copied to this
memory under the following conditions.

Parameter type Conditions for copy to non-volatile memory

Drive reset with 1000 in Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) if the drive is not in the under voltage state and the standard under
voltage threshold is being used (i.e. Low Under Voltage Threshold Select (06.067) = 0).

OR
A drive reset with 1001 in Parameter mm.000 (mm.000).

OR
User-save parameter After parameters are transferred from a non-volatile media card.
not visible in menu 0
OR
After the drive mode is changed.

OR
After default parameters are loaded.

OR
After parameters are transferred from an electronic nameplate.

Under the conditions given above for user save parameters not visible in Menu 0.

User save parameter OR


visible in menu 0 If the keypad is in edit mode for a user-save parameter in Menu 0, the parameter is saved when the keypad mode is
changed from edit mode.

A drive reset with 1000 in Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) if the drive is not in the under voltage state and the standard under
voltage threshold is being used (i.e. Low Under Voltage Threshold Select (06.067) = 0).

OR
A drive reset with 1001 in Parameter mm.000 (mm.000).

OR
Power-down save On the transition into the under voltage state when the standard under voltage threshold is being used (i.e.
parameter Low Under Voltage Threshold Select (06.067) is zero).

OR
After the drive mode is changed.

OR
After parameters are transferred from a non-volatile media card which results in the drive mode changing.

It can take some time for parameter data to be copied to non-volatile memory, especially if there are a large number of differences between the
parameter values in the drive and the values stored in the memory. Saving Power-down save parameters takes a maximum of 300ms, but saving user-
save parameters can take several seconds. If the drive is powered from a 24V control supply, or from a low voltage supply, the power down time of the
control system can be very short and there is a risk that either the stored values of the power-down save or user-save parameters could be corrupted.
This would result in an EEPROM Fail trip at the next power-up. To reduce this risk, the power-down save and user-save parameters are each stored in
two banks. The banks are alternated each time a save is performed and the bank pointer is only updated once the save is complete. If the new bank is

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 5
corrupted a User Save or Power Down Save is initiated at the next power-up indicating an error in the user-save or power-down save data respectively,
and the data from the old bank is used. The following points should be noted:

1. If a User Save or Power Down Save trip occur at power-up then parameter changes made before power down will be lost. To clear these trips a
parameter save must be performed. If both the user-save and power-down save data is corrupted then a Power Down Save trip is produced.
2. When a Menu 0 parameter is changed its value is saved immediately to the active bank and the bank pointer is not changed. Therefore
changes made via Menu 0 are not lost if a User Save trip occurs at power-up.
3. When the drive mode changes all the data in both banks in the non-volatile memory is cleared and the default parameters are saved in both
banks. Therefore there is an extended parameter saving period immediately after a drive mode change.
4. Two banks are not provided in non-volatile media cards therefore the card could be corrupted if the power is removed when the drive is writing
data to the card.

Loading defaults
A drive reset with 1233 in Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) loads the defaults defined for each parameter. If defaults are loaded with 1244 in Parameter
mm.000 (mm.000) then the parameters in the table below have different defaults that are intended for the 60Hz regions.

Parameter Default Drive modes Drive voltage rating


Maximum reference clamp (01.006) 60.0Hz Open-loop All
Maximum reference clamp (01.006) 1800rpm RFC-A All
Standard Ramp Voltage (02.008) 775V Open-loop, RFC-A, RFC-S 400V
Rated Frequency (05.006) 60.0Hz Open-loop, RFC-A All
Rated Load rpm (05.008) 1800rpm Open-loop All
Rated Load rpm (05.008) 1770rpm RFC-A All
Rated Voltage (05.009) 460V Open-loop, RFC-A, RFC-S 400V
M2 Maximum Reference Clamp (21.001) 60.0Hz Open-loop All
M2 Maximum Reference Clamp (21.001) 1800rpm RFC-A All
M2 Rated Frequency (21.006) 60.0Hz Open-loop, RFC-A All
M2 Rated Load rpm (21.008) 1800rpm Open-loop All
M2 Rated Load rpm (21.008) 1770rpm RFC-A All
M2 Rated Voltage (21.009) 460V Open-loop, RFC-A, RFC-S All

Non-volatile media card data transfer


Details of the data that can be stored on a non-volatile media card and the methods to transfer/access this data are given in Menu 11.

Stored HF trips
When the drive is subsequently powered up a Stored HF trip is initiated where the sub-trip number is the number of the HF trip that last occurred. This
trip will occur at every power-up until it is reset. The trip can only be reset by first entering 1299 into Parameter mm.000 (mm.000). If the drive is
powered up and a Stored HF trip occurs, Onboard User Program: Enable (Pr 11.047) is reset to zero to prevent the on-board user program from
running. This ensures that the user program can be changed or erased in case it causes an HF trip at every power-up. Once the Stored HF is cleared, it
is necessary to power cycle the drive or to re-download the user program to allow the program to restart.

Electronic nameplate
The electronic nameplate is stored in an encoder as a table of bytes as shown in the example below which contains 7 parameter objects.

N1 N0
CRC3 CRC2 CRC1 CRC0 FLG1 FLG0 0xFF 0xFF 0xFF 0xFF 0xFF 0xFF 0xFF 0xFF

M P V3 V2 V1 V0 M P V3 V2 V1 V0 M P V3 V2
V1 V0 M P V3 V2 V1 V0 M P V3 V2 V1 V0 M P
V3 V2 V1 V0 M P V3 V2 V1 V0

N1(MS byte) and N0(LS byte) gives the number of parameter objects stored in the nameplate. In this example N1=0x00 and N0=0x07.

CRC3 (MS byte) to CRC0 (LS byte) is a 32 bit CRC applied to all bytes in the nameplate except for the number of parameter objects and the CRC. The
CRC is generated with a reverse polynomial 0xEDB88320.

FLG1 (MS byte) and FLG0 (LS byte) are assigned for bit flags. At present none of these flags are used, and so these bytes are always zero.

Each parameter object consists of 6 bytes:


M is the menu number between 1 and 41.
P is the parameter number between 0 and 255.
V3 (MS byte) to V0 (LS byte) give a signed 32 bit parameter value. This is equivalent to the largest parameter size used by the drive, and so it can be
used to hold the maximum or minimum value of any parameter.

The total size of the nameplate in bytes is the 16 header bytes plus 6 x number of parameter objects.

In an EnDat encoder the namplate begins at the start of MRS area 0xAB and finishes at the end of MRS area 0xAD. Although not guaranteed, these
areas normally both consist of 256 words giving a total size of 1024 bytes. Therefore a nameplate can hold up to (1024 - 16 (header)) / 6 = 168
parameter objects. The time to read the nameplate is approximately 60ms per parameter object when P1 Device Type (03.038) is SC.EnDat, and
120ms per parameter when P1 Device Type (03.038) is EnDat.

In a Hiperface encoder the nameplate can be stored in up to 8 datafields starting at the begining of datafield 0. The size of datafields can be between 16
and 128 bytes. It is recommended that 128 byte datafields are used, and so the maximum size of the nameplate is 1024 bytes. Therefore a nameplate
can hold up to (1024 - 16 (header)) / 6 = 168 parameter objects. The time to read the nameplate is approximately 100ms per parameter object.

The nameplate can hold any parameters stored in drive menus (i.e. 1 to 41). If the menu and parameter number correspond to a parameter that does
not exist or is read-only then the parameter is simply not written and no trip is initiated. If the value of the parameter is out of range for the parameter
then the parameter is not written and no trip is initiated.

In RFC-A and RFC-S modes it is possible to get the drive to automatically update the current controller gains in the active motor map from the motor
resistance and inductance values when the electronic nameplate transfer is complete. This is initiated if the current controller proportional gain for the

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


6 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
active motor map is zero at the end of the nameplate transfer from the encoder. Therefore to initiate this, the nameplate should include a value
for Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) (optional) to select the required motor map and a value of zero for Current Controller Kp Gain
(04.013) or M2 Current Controller Kp Gain  (21.022) depending on which motor map is selected. The nameplate should also contain the motor
parameters required to set up the current controller gains: RFC-A mode - stator resistance and transient inductance, RFC-S mode - stator resistance,
Ld and no-load Lq. This feature sets up the correct current controller gains for the motor whatever the current rating of the drive. If it is necessary to set
up speed controller gains that can also be used for a motor and load with different drive sizes, then the inertia of the motor and load should be included
in the nameplate. Speed Controller Set-up Method (03.017) and Bandwidth (03.020) or Compliance Angle (03.019) should also be included so that the
speed controller gains are set up automatically when the nameplate transfer is complete.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 7
Current Ratings
The tables below give the maximum output current ratings, peak current ratings and power ratings for all drive sizes and voltage ratings.

200V Rated Drives


Heavy Duty Normal Duty Current Trip
Peak Peak Level As
Rated Rated Peak Kc
Model Motor Shaft Power Current Current Motor Shaft Power Percentage
Current Current Current Kc
Open Loop RFC
A kW hp A A A kW hp A A %
03200050 5 0.75 1 7.8 10 6.6 1.1 1.5 7.26 11.111 160
03200066 6.6 1.1 1.5 10.3 13.2 8 1.5 2 8.8 14.667 146
03200080 8 1.5 2 12.4 16 11 2.2 3 12.1 17.778 140
03200106 10.6 2.2 3 16.5 21.2 12.7 3 3 13.97 23.556 126
04200137 13.7 3 3 21.3 27.4 18 4 5 19.8 30.444 103
04200185 18.5 4 5 28.8 37 25 5.5 7.5 27.5 41.111 101
05200250 25 5.5 7.5 38.9 50 30 7.5 10 33 55.556 101
06200330 33 7.5 10 51.3 66 50 11 15 55 73.333 102
06200440 44 11 15 68.4 88 58 15 20 63.8 97.778 101
07200610 61 15 20 94.9 122 75 18.5 25 82.5 135.556 104
07200750 75 18.5 25 116.7 150 94 22 30 103.4 166.667 103
07200830 83 22 30 129.1 166 117 30 40 128.7 184.444 101
08201160 116 30 40 180.4 232 149 37 50 163.9 257.778 101
08201320 132 37 50 205.3 264 180 45 60 198 293.333 101
09201760 176 45 60 239.6 308 216 55 75 237.6 342.222 105
09202190 219 55 75 298.1 383.25 266 75 100 292.6 425.833 101
10202830 283 75 100 385.2 495.25 325 90 125 357.5 550.278 103
10203000 300 90 125 408.3 525 360 110 150 396 583.333 101

400V Rated Drives


Heavy Duty Normal Duty Current Trip
Peak Peak Level As
Rated Rated Peak Kc
Model Motor Shaft Power Current Current Motor Shaft Power Percentage
Current Current Current Kc
Open Loop RFC
A kW hp A A A kW hp A A %
03400025 2.5 0.75 1 3.9 5 3.4 1.1 1.5 3.74 5.556 168
03400031 3.1 1.1 1.5 4.8 6.2 4.5 1.5 2 4.95 6.889 159
03400045 4.5 1.5 2 7 9 6.2 2.2 3 6.82 10 137
03400062 6.2 2.2 3 9.6 12.4 7.7 3 5 8.47 13.778 151
03400078 7.8 3 5 12.1 15.6 10.4 4 5 11.44 17.333 156
03400100 10 4 5 15.6 20 12.3 5.5 7.5 13.53 22.222 139
04400150 15 5.5 10 23.3 30 18.5 7.5 10 20.35 33.333 120
04400172 17.2 7.5 10 26.8 34.4 24 11 15 26.4 38.222 113
05400270 27 11 20 42 54 30 15 20 33 60 106
05400300 30 15 20 46.7 60 31 15 20 34.1 66.667 106
06400350 35 15 25 54.4 70 38 18.5 25 41.8 77.778 103
06400420 42 18.5 30 65.3 84 48 22 30 52.8 93.333 104
06400470 47 22 30 73.1 94 63 30 40 69.3 104.444 101
07400660 66 30 50 102.7 132 79 37 50 86.9 146.667 104
07400770 77 37 60 119.8 154 94 45 60 103.4 171.111 105
07401000 100 45 75 155.6 200 112 55 75 123.2 222.222 101
08401340 134 55 100 208.4 268 155 75 100 170.5 297.778 104
08401570 157 75 125 244.2 314 184 90 125 202.4 348.889 101
09402000 200 90 150 272.2 350 221 110 150 243.1 388.889 104
09402240 224 110 150 304.9 392 266 132 200 292.6 435.556 101
10402700 270 132 200 367.5 472.5 320 160 250 352 525 105
10403200 320 160 250 435.6 560 361 200 300 397.1 622.222 101
11403770 377 185 300 513.1 659.75 437 225 350 480.7 733.056 104
11404170 417 200 350 567.6 729.75 487 250 400 535.7 810.833 103
11404640 464 250 400 631.6 812 507 315 450 557.7 902.222 101

575V Rated Drives


Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide
8 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Heavy Duty Normal Duty Current Trip
Peak Peak Level As
Rated Rated Peak Kc
Model Motor Shaft Power Current Current Motor Shaft Power Percentage
Current Current Current Kc
Open Loop RFC
A kW hp A A A kW hp A A %
05500030 3 1.5 2 4.7 6 3.9 2.2 3 4.29 6.667 162
05500040 4 2.2 3 6.2 8 6.1 4 5 6.71 8.889 148
05500069 6.9 4 5 10.7 13.8 10 5.5 7.5 11 15.333 126
06500100 10 5.5 7.5 15.6 20 12 7.5 10 13.2 22.222 107
06500150 15 7.5 10 23.3 30 17 11 15 18.7 33.333 102
06500190 19 11 15 29.6 38 22 15 20 24.2 42.222 101
06500230 23 15 20 35.8 46 27 18.5 25 29.7 51.111 104
06500290 29 18.5 25 45.1 58 34 22 30 37.4 64.444 102
06500350 35 22 30 54.4 70 43 30 40 47.3 77.778 101
07500440 44 30 40 68.4 88 53 45 50 58.3 97.778 106
07500550 55 37 50 85.6 110 73 55 60 80.3 122.222 101
08500630 63 45 60 98 126 86 75 75 94.6 140 105
08500860 86 55 75 133.8 172 108 90 100 118.8 191.111 101
09501040 104 75 100 141.6 182 125 110 125 137.5 202.222 106
09501310 131 90 125 178.3 229.25 150 110 150 165 254.722 103
10501520 152 110 150 206.9 266 200 130 200 220 295.556 101
10501900 190 132 200 258.6 332.5 200 150 200 220 369.444 101
11502000 200 150 200 272.2 350 248 175 250 272.8 388.889 103
11502540 254 185 250 345.7 444.5 288 225 300 316.8 493.889 104
11502850 285 225 300 387.9 498.75 315 250 350 346.5 554.167 101

690V Rated Drives


Heavy Duty Normal Duty Current Trip
Peak Peak Level As
Rated Rated Peak Kc
Model Motor Shaft Power Current Current Motor Shaft Power Percentage
Current Current Current Kc
Open Loop RFC
A kW hp A A A kW hp A A %
07600190 19 15 20 29.6 38 23 18.5 25 25.3 42.222 117
07600240 24 18.5 25 37.3 48 30 22 30 33 53.333 111
07600290 29 22 30 45.1 58 36 30 40 39.6 64.444 107
07600380 38 30 40 59.1 76 46 37 50 50.6 84.444 105
07600440 44 37 50 68.4 88 52 45 60 57.2 97.778 106
07600540 54 45 60 84 108 73 55 75 80.3 120 103
08600630 63 55 75 98 126 86 75 100 94.6 140 105
08600860 86 75 100 133.8 172 108 90 125 118.8 191.111 101
09601040 104 90 125 141.6 182 125 110 150 137.5 202.222 106
09601310 131 110 150 178.3 229.25 155 132 175 170.5 254.722 103
10601500 150 132 175 204.2 262.5 172 160 200 189.2 291.667 102
10601780 178 160 200 242.3 311.5 197 185 250 216.7 346.111 108
11602100 210 185 250 285.8 367.5 225 200 250 247.5 408.333 115
11602380 238 200 250 323.9 416.5 275 250 300 302.5 462.778 111
11602630 263 250 300 358 460.25 305 315 400 335.5 511.389 109

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 9
Variable Minimum / Maximum Pairs
The descriptions below define the variable minimum/maximum pairs that can be used with parameters when the VM format bit is set. The variable
minimum and maximum themselves can be dependent on other parameters, or the drive rating or other conditions as defined. The variable minimum
and the variable maximum have a limited range and this is defined for each minimum/maximum pair.

Identifier VM_AC_VOLTAGE
Description Range applied to parameters showing a.c. voltage
Units V
Range of [MIN] 0
Range of [MAX] 0 to 930

VM_AC_VOLTAGE[MAX] in drive voltage rating dependent. See the table below.

Voltage level 200V 400V 575V 690V


VM_AC_VOLTAGE[MAX] 325 650 780 930

VM_AC_VOLTAGE[MIN] = 0

Identifier VM_AC_VOLTAGE_SET
Description Range applied to a.c. voltage set-up parameters
Units V
Range of [MIN] 0
Range of [MAX] 0 to 765

VM_AC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX] is drive voltage rating dependent. See the table below.

Voltage level 200V 400V 575V 690V


VM_AC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX] 265 530 635 765

VM_AC_VOLTAGE_SET[MIN] = 0

Identifier VM_ACCEL_RATE
Description Maximum applied to the ramp rate parameters
Units s/100Hz, s/1000rpm, s/1000mm/s
Open-loop: 0.0
Range of [MIN]
RFC-A, RFC-S: 0.000
Open-loop: 0.0 to 3200.0
Range of [MAX]
RFC-A, RFC-S: 0.000 to 3200.000

A maximum needs to be applied to the ramp rate parameters because the units are a time for a change of speed from zero to a defined level or to
maximum speed. The defined level is 100Hz for Open-loop mode and 1000rpm or 1000mm/s for RFC-A and RFC-S modes. If the change of speed is to
the maximum speed then changing the maximum speed changes the actual ramp rate for a given ramp rate parameter value. The variable maximum
calculation ensures that longest ramp rate (parameter at its maximum value) is not slower than the rate with the defined level, i.e. 3200.00 s / Hz for
Open-loop mode, and 3200.000 s / 1000rpm or 3200.000 s / 1000mm/s for RFC-A and RFC-S modes.

The maximum frequency/speed is taken from Maximum Reference Clamp (01.006) if Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 0, or M2 Maximum
Reference Clamp (21.001) if Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 1.

Open-loop mode
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] = 0.0

If Ramp Rate Units (02.039) = 0:
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] = 3200.0
Otherwise:
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] = 3200.0 x Maximum frequency / 100.0

RFC-A, RFC-S modes


VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] = 0.000

If Ramp Rate Units (02.039) = 0:
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] = 3200.000
Otherwise:
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] = 3200.000 x Maximum speed / 1000.0

Identifier VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR
Description Range applied to the parameters showing the AMC jerk
Units User units / ms / ms / ms
Range of [MIN] 0
Range of [MAX] 107374.1823

VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MAX] = 107374.1823 / AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016)

VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MIN] = 0

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


10 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Identifier VM_AMC_POSITION
Description Range applied to the parameters showing the AMC position
Units User units
Range of [MIN] -2147483648
Range of [MAX] 2147483647

VM_AMC_POSITION is modified by AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016) and AMC Roll Over Limit (31.010). See the table below.

AMC Roll Over Limit (31.010) = 0 >0


2147483647 / AMC Auto Resolution Scaling AMC Roll Over Limit
VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX]
(31.016) (31.010) - 1
-2147483648 / AMC Auto Resolution
VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] 0
Scaling (31.016)

Identifier VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM
Description Range applied to the parameters showing the AMC cam position
Units User units
Range of [MIN] -1073741824
Range of [MAX] 1073741823

VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM is modified by AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016) and AMC Roll Over Limit (31.010). See the table below.

AMC Roll Over Limit (31.010)


=0 >0
1073741823 / AMC Auto Resolution AMC Roll Over Limit
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Scaling (31.016) (31.010) - 1
-1073741824 / AMC Auto Resolution -AMC Roll Over Limit
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN]
Scaling (31.016) (31.010) + 1

Identifier VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR
Description Unipolar version of VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM
Units User units
Range of [MIN] 0
Range of [MAX] 1073741823

VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR is modified by AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016) and AMC Roll Over Limit (31.010). See the table below.

AMC Roll Over Limit (31.010) =0 >0


1073741823 / AMC Auto AMC Roll Over Limit
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Resolution Scaling (31.016) (31.010) - 1
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MIN] 0 0

Identifier VM_AMC_POSITION_REF
Description Range applied to the AMC position reference
Units User units
Range of [MIN] -2147483648
Range of [MAX] 2147483647

VM_AMC_POSITION_REF is modified by AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016), AMC Roll Over Limit (31.010) and AMC Rotary Mode (34.005). See


the table below.

AMC Roll Over Limit (31.010)


=0 >0 >0
AMC Rotary Mode (34.005) Not active <4 =4
2147483647 / AMC Auto Resolution AMC Roll Over Limit 1073741823 / AMC Auto Resolution Scaling
VM_AMC_POSITION_REF[MAX]
Scaling (31.016) (31.010) - 1 (31.016)
-2147483648 / AMC Auto Resolution -1073741824 / AMC Auto Resolution
VM_AMC_POSITION_REF[MIN] 0
Scaling (31.016) Scaling (31.016)

Identifier VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR
Description Unipolar version of VM_AMC_POSITION
Units User units
Range of [MIN] 0
Range of [MAX] 2147483647

VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR is modified by AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016) and AMC Roll Over Limit (31.010). See the table below.

AMC Roll Over Limit (31.010) =0 >0


2147483647 / AMC Auto Resolution AMC Roll Over Limit
VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Scaling (31.016) (31.010) - 1
VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR[MIN] 0 0

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 11
Identifier VM_AMC_RATE
Description Range applied to the parameters showing the AMC acceleration
Units User units / ms / ms
Range of [MIN] 1073742.824
Range of [MAX] 1073741.823

VM_AMC_RATE_UNIPOLAR[MAX] = 1073741.823 / AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016)

VM_AMC_RATE_UNIPOLAR[MIN] = -1073741.824 / AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016)

Identifier VM_AMC_RATE_UNIPOLAR
Description Unipolar version of VM_AMC_RATE
Units User units / ms / ms
Range of [MIN] 0
Range of [MAX] 1073741.823

VM_AMC_RATE_UNIPOLAR[MAX] = 1073741.823 / AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016)

VM_AMC_RATE_UNIPOLAR[MIN] = 0

Identifier VM_AMC_ROLLOVER
Description Maximum applied to the AMC Rollover parameter
Units User units
Range of [MIN] 0
Range of [MAX] 1073741823

VM_AMC_ROLLOVER[MAX] = 1073741823 / AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016)

VM_AMC_ROLLOVER[MIN] = 0

Identifier VM_AMC_SPEED
Description Range applied to the parameters showing the AMC speed
Units User units / ms
Range of [MIN] -21474836.48
Range of [MAX] 21474836.47

VM_AMC_SPEED[MAX] = 21474836.47 / AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016)

VM_AMC_SPEED[MIN] = -21474836.48 / AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016)

Identifier VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR
Description Unipolar version of VM_AMC_SPEED
Units User units / ms
Range of [MIN] 0
Range of [MAX] 21474836.47

VM_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MAX] = 21474836.47 / AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016)

VM_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MIN] = 0

Identifier VM_DC_VOLTAGE
Description Range applied to d.c. voltage reference parameters
Units V
Range of [MIN] 0
Range of [MAX] 0 to 1190

VM_DC_VOLTAGE[MAX] is the full scale d.c. link voltage feedback (over voltage trip level) for the drive. This level is drive voltage rating dependent.
See the table below.

Voltage level 200V 400V 575V 690V


VM_DC_VOLTAGE[MAX] 415 830 990 1190

VM_DC_VOLTAGE[MIN] = 0

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


12 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Identifier VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET
Description Range applied to d.c. voltage reference parameters
Units V
Range of [MIN] 0
Range of [MAX] 0.0 to 1150.0

VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX] is drive voltage rating dependent. All values are shown in the table below.

Voltage level 200V 400V 575V 690V


VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX] 400 800 955 1150

VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MIN] = 0

Identifier VM_DRIVE_CURRENT
Description Range applied to parameters showing current in A
Units A
Range of [MIN] -99999.999 to 0.000
Range of [MAX] 0.000 to 99999.999

VM_DRIVE_CURRENT[MAX] is equivalent to the full scale (over current trip level) for the drive and is given by Full Scale Current Kc (11.061).

VM_DRIVE_CURRENT[MIN] = - VM_DRIVE_CURRENT[MAX]

Identifier VM_DRIVE_CURRENT_UNIPOLAR
Description Unipolar version of VM_DRIVE_CURRENT
Units A
Range of [MIN] 0.000
Range of [MAX] 0.000 to 99999.999

VM_DRIVE_CURRENT_UNIPOLAR[MAX] = VM_DRIVE_CURRENT[MAX]

VM_DRIVE_CURRENT_UNIPOLAR[MIN] = 0.000

Identifier VM_HIGH_DC_VOLTAGE
Description Range applied to the parameters showing high d.c. voltage
Units V
Range of [MIN] 0
Range of [MAX] 0 to 1500

VM_HIGH_DC_VOLTAGE[MAX] = 1500. This is the full scale d.c. link voltage feedback for the high d.c. link voltage measurement which can measure
the voltage if it goes above the normal full scale value.

VM_HIGH_DC_VOLTAGE[MIN] = 0

Identifier VM_LOW_UNDER_VOLTS
Description Range applied to the low under voltage threshold
Units V
Range of [MIN] 24
Range of [MAX] 24 to 1150

If Back-up Mode Enable (06.068) = 0
VM_LOW_UNDER_VOLTS[MAX] = VM_STD_UNDER_VOLTS[MIN]

Otherwise
VM_LOW_UNDER_VOLTS[MAX] = VM_STD_UNDER_VOLTS[MIN] / 1.1.

VM_LOW_UNDER_VOLTS[MIN] = 0.

Identifier VM_MIN_SWITCHING_FREQUENCY
Description Range applied to the minimum switching frequency parameter
Units User units
Range of [MIN] 0
Range of [MAX] 0 to 6

VM_MIN_SWITCHING_FREQUENCY[MAX] = Maximum Switching Frequency (05.018)

VM_MIN_SWITCHING_FREQUENCY[MIN] = 0 for motor control modes, or 1 for Regen mode (subject to the maximum)

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 13
Identifier VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT
Description Range applied to current limit parameters (motor 1)
Units %
Range of [MIN] 0.0
Range of [MAX] 0.0 to 1000.0

VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT[MAX] is dependent on the drive rating and motor set-up parameters. See Drive Limits document included in this
parameter reference guide for more details.

VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT[MIN] = 0.0

Identifier VM_MOTOR2_CURRENT_LIMIT
Description Range applied to current limit parameters (motor 2)
Units %
Range of [MIN] 0.0
Range of [MAX] 0.0 to 1000.0

VM_MOTOR2_CURRENT_LIMIT[MAX] is dependent on the drive rating and motor set-up parameters. See Drive Limits document included in this
parameter reference guide for more details.

VM_MOTOR2_CURRENT_LIMIT[MIN] = 0.0

Identifier VM_NEGATIVE_REF_CLAMP1
Description Limits applied to the negative frequency or speed clamp (motor 1)
Open-loop: Hz
Units
RFC-A, RFC-S: rpm or mm/s
Open-loop: -599.0 to 0.0
Range of [MIN]
RFC-A, RFC-S: -550 x 60 / Motor pole pairs to 0.0
Open-loop: 0.0 to 599.0
Range of [MAX]
RFC-A, RFC-S: 0.0 to 550 x 60 / Motor pole pairs

This variable maximum/minimum defines the range of the negative frequency or speed clamp associated with motor map 1 (Minimum Reference Clamp
(01.007)). The minimum and maximum are affected by the settings of the Negative Reference Clamp Enable (01.008), Bipolar Reference Enable
(01.010) and Maximum Reference Clamp (01.006) as shown in the table below.

Negative Bipolar
Reference Reference
VM_NEGATIVE_REF_CLAMP1[MIN] VM_NEGATIVE_REF_CLAMP1[MAX]
Clamp Enable Enable
(01.008) (01.010)
0 0 0.0 Pr 01.006
0 1 0.0 0.0
1 X -VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP[MAX] 0.0

Identifier VM_NEGATIVE_REF_CLAMP2
Description Limits applied to the negative frequency or speed clamp (motor 2)
Open-loop: Hz
Units
RFC-A, RFC-S: rpm or mm/s
Open-loop: -599.0 to 0.0
Range of [MIN]
RFC-A, RFC-S: -550 x 60 / Motor pole pairs to 0.0
Open-loop: 0.0 to 599.0
Range of [MAX]
RFC-A, RFC-S: 0.0 to 550 x 60 / Motor pole pairs

This variable maximum/minimum defines the range of the negative frequency or speed clamp associated with motor map 2 (M2 Minimum Reference
Clamp (21.002)). It is defined in the same way as VM_NEGATIVE_REF_CLAMP1 except that the M2 Maximum Reference Clamp (21.001) is used
instead of Maximum Reference Clamp (01.006).

Identifier VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP1
Description Limits applied to the positive frequency or speed reference clamp
Open-loop: Hz
Units
RFC-A, RFC-S: rpm or mm/s
Open-loop: 0.0
Range of [MIN]
RFC-A, RFC-S: 0.0
Open-loop: 0.0 to 599.0
Range of [MAX]
RFC-A, RFC-S: 0.0 to 550 x 60 / Motor pole pairs

VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP1[MAX] defines the range of the positive reference clamp Maximum Reference Clamp (01.006), which in turn limits the
references if Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045 = 0). VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP2[MAX] defines the range of the positive reference clamp M2
Maximum Reference Clamp (21.001), which in turn limits the references if Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045 = 1).

In RFC-A and RFC-S modes a limit is applied so that the position feedback does not exceed the speed where the drive can no longer interpret the
feedback signal correctly as given in the table below. The limit is based on the active position feedback selected with Motor Control Feedback Select
(03.026) if Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045 = 0), M2 Motor Control Feedback Select (21.021) if Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045 = 1) and RFC
Feedback Mode (03.024). It is possible to disable this limit if the RFC Feedback Mode (03.024) ≥ 1, so that the motor can be operated at a speed above

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


14 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
the level where the drive can interpret the feedback in sensorless mode. It should be noted that the position feedback device itself may have a
maximum speed limit that is lower than those given in the table. Care should be taken not to exceed a speed that would cause damage to the position
feedback device. An additional overriding limit is applied so that the maximum speed does not exceed 550 x 60 / Motor Pole Pairs.

Feedback device VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP1[MAX]


(500kHz x 60 / rotary lines per revolution) rpm
AB, AB Servo
(500kHz x linear line pitch in mm) mm/s
(500kHz x 60 / rotary lines per revolution)/2 rpm
FD, FR, FD Servo, FR Servo
(500kHz x linear line pitch in mm)/2 mm/s
(500kHz x 60 / sine waves per revolution) rpm
SC, SC Hiper, SC EnDat, SC SSI, SC Servo
(500kHz x linear line pitch in mm) mm/s
30000 rpm
Resolver
(250Hz x pole pitch in mm) mm/s
Any other device 50000.0 rpm or mm/s

The limits ensure that the frequency of incremental digital or sine wave signals from the encoder do not exceed 500kHz and the modulation frequency
of a resolver does not exceed 1kHz, neglecting any speed controller overshoot. The position feedback resolution remains fixed over the whole
frequency range for digital signals, but reduces with increased frequency or reduced voltage for sine wave signals. The position resolution with sine
wave signal is given by the equations below.

Position resolution for a rotary device = K x sine waves per revolution

Position resolution for a linear device = K x sine waves per pole pitch

The value of K varies with the frequency and magnitude of the sine wave signals. The nominal value of K is 1024, and the drive interface provides at
least this resolution with 1.0Vp-p sine waves up to a frequency of 50kHz. The table below shows the variation of K with sine wave peak to peak voltage
and frequency.

1kHz 5kHz 50kHz 100kHz 200kHz 500kHz


1.2Vp-p 2048 2048 1024 1024 512 512
1.0Vp-p 2048 2048 1024 512 512 128
0.8Vp-p 1024 1024 1024 512 256 128
0.6Vp-p 1024 1024 512 512 256 128
0.4Vp-p 512 512 512 256 128 64

VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP1[MIN] = 0.0

VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP2[MAX] defines the range of the positive reference clamp, M2 Maximum Reference Clamp (21.001), which in turn limit the
references. See VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP1 for more details.

Identifier VM_POWER
Description Range applied to parameters that either set or display power
Units kW
Range of [MIN] -99999.999 to 0.000
Range of [MAX] 0.000 to 99999.999

VM_POWER[MAX] is rating dependent and is chosen to allow for the maximum power that can be output by the drive with maximum a.c. output
voltage, at maximum controlled current and unity power factor.

VM_POWER[MAX] = √3 x VM_AC_VOLTAGE[MAX] x VM_DRIVE_CURRENT[MAX] / 1000

VM_POWER[MIN] = -VM_POWER[MAX]

Identifier VM_RATED_CURRENT
Description Range applied to rated current parameters
Units A
Range of [MIN] 0.000
Range of [MAX] 0.000 to 99999.999

VM_RATED_CURRENT [MAX] = Maximum Rated Current (11.060) and is dependent on the drive rating.

VM_RATED_CURRENT [MIN] = 0.000

Identifier VM_REGEN_REACTIVE
Description Range applied to the reactive current reference in Regen mode
Units %
Range of [MIN] -1000.0 to 0.0
Range of [MAX] 0.0 to 1000.0

VM_REGEN_REACTIVE[MAX] applies a limit to the reactive current reference in Regen mode so that the total current reference does not exceed its
maximum allowed level. See Drive Limits document included in this parameter reference guide for more details.

VM_REGEN_REACTIVE[MIN] = - VM_REGEN_REACTIVE[MAX]

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 15
Identifier VM_SPEED
Description Range applied to parameters showing speed
Units Open-loop, RFC-A, RFC-S: rpm or mm/s
Range of [MIN] Open-loop, RFC-A, RFC-S: -50000.0 to 0.0
Range of [MAX] Open-loop, RFC-A, RFC-S: 0.0 to 50000.0

This variable minimum/maximum defines the range of speed monitoring parameters. To allow headroom for overshoot the range is set to twice the
range of the speed references.

VM_SPEED[MIN] = 2 x VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN]

VM_SPEED[MAX] = 2 x VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]

Identifier VM_SPEED_FREQ_KEYPAD_REF
Description Range applied to the keypad reference
Open-loop: Hz
Units
RFC-A, RFC-S: rpm or mm/s
Open-loop: -599.0 to 599.0
Range of [MIN]
RFC-A, RFC-S: -550 x 60 / Motor pole pairs to 550 x 60 / Motor pole pairs
Open-loop: 0.0 to 599.0
Range of [MAX]
RFC-A, RFC-S: 0.0 to 550 x 60 / Motor pole pairs

This variable maximum is applied to Keypad Control Mode Reference (01.017). The maximum applied to these parameters is the same as other
frequency reference parameters.

VM_SPEED_FREQ_USER_REFS [MAX] = VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]

However the minimum is dependent on Negative Reference Clamp Enable (01.008) and Bipolar Reference Enable (01.010).

Negative Reference Bipolar


Clamp Enable Reference VM_SPEED_FREQ_USER_REFS[MIN]
(01.008) Enable (01.010)
If Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 0 Minimum Reference
0 0
Clamp (01.007), otherwise M2 Minimum Reference Clamp (21.002)
0 1 -VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
1 0 0.0
1 1 -VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]

Identifier VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF
Description Range applied to the frequency or speed reference parameters
Open-loop: Hz
Units
RFC-A, RFC-S: rpm or mm/s
Open-loop: -599.0 to 0.0
Range of [MIN]
RFC-A, RFC-S: -550 x 60 / Motor pole pairs to 0.0
Open-loop: 0.0 to 599.0
Range of [MAX]
RFC-A, RFC-S: 0.0 to 550 x 60 / Motor pole pairs

This variable minimum/maximum is applied throughout the frequency and speed reference system so that the references can vary in the range from the
minimum to maximum clamps.

Negative
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX] if Select VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX] if Select
Reference Clamp
Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 0 Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 1
Enable (01.008)
0 Maximum Reference Clamp (01.006) M2 Maximum Reference Clamp (21.001)
Maximum Reference Clamp (01.006) or M2 Maximum Reference Clamp (21.001) or
1 |Minimum Reference Clamp (01.007)| |M2 Minimum Reference Clamp (21.002)|
whichever the larger whichever the larger

VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] = -VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX].

Identifier VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF_UNIPOLAR
Description Unipolar version of VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF
Open-loop: Hz
Units
RFC-A, RFC-S: rpm or mm/s
Open-loop: 0.0
Range of [MIN]
RFC-A, RFC-S: 0.0
Open-loop: 0.0 to 599.0
Range of [MAX]
RFC-A, RFC-S: 0.0 to 550 x 60 / Motor pole pairs

VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF_UNIPOLAR[MAX] = VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]

VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF_UNIPOLAR[MIN] = 0.0

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


16 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Identifier VM_SPEED_FREQ_USER_REFS
Description Range applied to analogue reference parameters
Open-loop: Hz
Units
RFC-A, RFC-S: rpm or mm/s
Open-loop: -599.00 to 599.00
Range of [MIN]
RFC-A, RFC-S: -550 x 60 / Motor pole pairs to 550 x 60 / Motor pole pairs
Open-loop: 0.0 to 599.00
Range of [MAX]
RFC-A, RFC-S: 0.0 to 550 x 60 / Motor pole pairs

This variable maximum is applied to Analogue Reference 1 (01.036) and Analogue Reference 2 (01.037). It should be noted that in Open-loop mode the
analogue reference parameters have two decimal places.

The maximum applied to these parameters is the same as other frequency reference parameters.

VM_SPEED_FREQ_USER_REFS [MAX] = VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]

However the minimum is dependent on Negative Reference Clamp Enable (01.008) and Bipolar Reference Enable (01.010).

Negative Reference Bipolar


Clamp Enable Reference VM_SPEED_FREQ_USER_REFS[MIN]
(01.008) Enable (01.010)
If Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 0 Minimum Reference
0 0
Clamp (01.007), otherwise M2 Minimum Reference Clamp (21.002)
0 1 -VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
1 0 0.0
1 1 -VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]

Identifier VM_STD_UNDER_VOLTS
Description Range applied to the standard under voltage threshold
Units V
Range of [MIN] 0 to 1150
Range of [MAX] 0 to 1150

VM_STD_UNDER_VOLTS[MAX] = VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET / 1.1

VM_STD_UNDER_VOLTS[MIN] is voltage rating dependent. See the table below.

Voltage level 200V 400V 575V 690V


VM_STD_UNDER_VOLTS[MIN] 175 330 435 435

Identifier VM_SUPPLY_LOSS_LEVEL
Description Range applied to the supply loss threshold
Units V
Range of [MIN] 0 to 1150
Range of [MAX] 0 to 1150

VM_SUPPLY_LOSS_LEVEL[MAX] = VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX]

VM_SUPPLY_LOSS_LEVEL[MIN] is drive voltage rating dependent. See the table below.

Voltage level 200V 400V 575V 690V


VM_SUPPLY_LOSS_LEVEL[MIN] 205 410 540 540

Identifier VM_SWITCHING_FREQUENCY
Description Range applied to the maximum switching frequency parameters
Units User units
Range of [MIN] 0
Range of [MAX] 0 to 6

VM_SWITCHING_FREQUENCY[MAX] = Power stage dependent

VM_SWITCHING_FREQUENCY[MIN] = 0 for motor control modes, or 1 for Regen mode (subject to the maximum)

Identifier VM_TORQUE_CURRENT
Range applied to torque and torque producing current parameters. (Where this is used in Regen
Description
mode it refers to the active current.)
Units %
Range of
-1000.0 to 0.0
[MIN]
Range of 0.0 to 1000.0
[MAX]

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 17
Select Motor 2 Parameters
VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MAX]
(11.045)
0 VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT[MAX]
1 VM_MOTOR2_CURRENT_LIMIT[MAX]

VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MIN] = -VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MAX]

Identifier VM_TORQUE_CURRENT_UNIPOLAR
Description Unipolar version of VM_TORQUE_CURRENT
Units %
Range of [MIN] 0.0
Range of [MAX] 0.0 to 1000.0

VM_TORQUE_CURRENT_UNIPOLAR[MAX] = VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MAX]

VM_TORQUE_CURRENT_UNIPOLAR[MIN] =0.0

Identifier VM_USER_CURRENT
Description Range applied to torque reference and percentage load parameters with one decimal place
Units %
Range of [MIN] -1000.0 to 0.0
Range of [MAX] 0.0 to 1000.0

VM_USER_CURRENT[MAX] = User Current Maximum Scaling (04.024)

VM_USER_CURRENT[MIN] = -VM_USER_CURRENT[MAX]

Identifier VM_USER_CURRENT_HIGH_RES
Description Range applied to torque reference and percentage load parameters with two decimal places
Units %
Range of [MIN] -1000.00 to 0.00
Range of [MAX] 0.00 to 1000.00

VM_USER_CURRENT_HIGH_RES[MAX] = User Current Maximum Scaling (04.024) with an additional decimal place

VM_USER_CURRENT_HIGH_RES[MIN] = -VM_USER_CURRENT_HIGH_RES[MAX]

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


18 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 1 Single Line Descriptions − Speed References
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 19
Parameter Range Default Type
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
01.001 Reference Selected RO Num ND NC PT
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
01.002 Pre‑skip Filter Reference RO Num ND NC PT
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
01.003 Pre‑ramp Reference RO Num ND NC PT
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
01.004 Reference Offset 0.0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
01.005 Jog Reference 0.0 to 4000.0 0.0 RW Num US
VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP1[MIN] to 50Hz: 1500.0
01.006 Maximum Reference Clamp RW Num US
VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP1[MAX] 60Hz: 1800.0
VM_NEGATIVE_REF_CLAMP1[MIN] to
01.007 Minimum Reference Clamp 0.0 RW Num US
VM_NEGATIVE_REF_CLAMP1[MAX]
01.008 Negative Reference Clamp Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
01.009 Reference Offset Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
01.010 Bipolar Reference Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
01.011 Reference On Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
01.012 Reverse Select Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
01.013 Jog Select Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
A1 A2 (0), A1 Preset (1), A2 Preset (2),
01.014 Reference Selector Preset (3), Keypad (4), Precision (5), A1 A2 (0) RW Txt US
Keypad Ref (6)
01.015 Preset Selector 0 to 9 0 RW Num US
01.016 Preset Selector Timer 0.0 to 400.0 s 10.0 s RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_KEYPAD_REF[MIN]
01.017 Keypad Control Mode Reference to 0.0 RO Num NC PT PS
VM_SPEED_FREQ_KEYPAD_REF[MAX]
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
01.018 Precision Reference Coarse 0.0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
01.019 Precision Reference Fine 0.000 to 0.099 0.000 RW Num US
01.020 Precision Reference Update Disable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
01.021 Preset Reference 1 0.0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
01.022 Preset Reference 2 0.0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
01.023 Preset Reference 3 0.0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
01.024 Preset Reference 4 0.0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
01.025 Preset Reference 5 0.0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
01.026 Preset Reference 6 0.0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
01.027 Preset Reference 7 0.0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
01.028 Preset Reference 8 0.0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
01.029 Skip Reference 1 0 to 33000 0 RW Num US
01.030 Skip Reference Band 1 0 to 250 0 RW Num US
01.031 Skip Reference 2 0 to 33000 0 RW Num US
01.032 Skip Reference Band 2 0 to 250 0 RW Num US
01.033 Skip Reference 3 0 to 33000 0 RW Num US
01.034 Skip Reference Band 3 0 to 250 0 RW Num US
01.035 Reference In Rejection Zone Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
VM_SPEED_FREQ_USER_REFS[MIN] to
01.036 Analog Reference 1 0.0 RO Num NC
VM_SPEED_FREQ_USER_REFS[MAX]
VM_SPEED_FREQ_USER_REFS[MIN] to
01.037 Analog Reference 2 0.0 RO Num NC
VM_SPEED_FREQ_USER_REFS[MAX]
01.038 Percentage Trim ±100.00 % 0.00 % RW Num NC
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
01.039 Speed Feed‑forwards RO Num ND NC PT
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
01.040 Speed Feed‑forwards Select Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
01.041 Reference Select Flag 1 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
01.042 Reference Select Flag 2 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
01.043 Reference Select Flag 3 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
01.044 Reference Select Flag 4 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
01.045 Preset Select Flag 1 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
01.046 Preset Select Flag 2 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
01.047 Preset Select Flag 3 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


20 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
01.048 Preset Selector Timer Reset Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
01.049 Reference Selected Indicator 1 to 6 RO Num ND NC PT
01.050 Preset Selected Indicator 1 to 8 RO Num ND NC PT
01.051 Power‑up Keypad Control Mode Reference Reset (0), Last (1), Preset (2) Reset (0) RW Txt US
01.052 Hand/Off/Auto Operating Mode 0 to 3 0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
01.053 Fire Mode Reference 0.0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
01.054 Fire Mode Activate Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RO Bit NC
01.055 Linear Speed Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
01.056 Linear Speed Selected Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
01.057 Force Reference Direction None (0), Forward (1), Reverse (2) None (0) RW Txt

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 21
Menu 1 − Speed References
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


22 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide
Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 23
Parameter 01.001 Reference Selected
Short description Displays the basic reference selected from the available sources
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, VM, ND, NC, PT

Reference Selected (01.001) is the basic reference selected from the available sources including the effect of the reference offset.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


24 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 01.002 Pre-skip Filter Reference
Short description Displays the level of the reference after the reference clamps
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, VM, ND, NC, PT

Pre-skip Filter Reference (01.002) is the level of the reference after the reference clamps but before the skip filters.

Parameter 01.003 Pre-ramp Reference


Short description Displays the final output from the Menu 1 reference system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, VM, ND, NC, PT

The Pre-ramp Reference (01.003) is the final output from the Menu 1 reference system that is fed into the Menu 2 ramp system.

Parameter 01.004 Reference Offset


Short description Defines the the offset applied to the reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

If Reference Offset Select (01.009) = 0 then Reference Selected (01.001) is the selected reference multiplied by [1 + (Percentage Trim (01.038) / 100.00)].
If Reference Offset Select (01.009) = 1 then the Reference Offset (01.004) is added to the selected reference to give Reference Selected (01.001).

Parameter 01.005 Jog Reference


Short description Defines the reference when jog is enabled
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 4000.0
Default 0.0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, BU

The Jog Reference (01.005) is selected when Jog Select (01.013) = 1. Jog Select (01.013) is controlled by the drive sequencer (see Menu 6).

Parameter 01.006 Maximum Reference Clamp


Short description Defines the maximum value for the reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP1[MIN] Maximum VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP1[MAX]
Default See exceptions below Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

Default Value
1500.0
1800.0

Maximum Reference Clamp (01.006) provides a limit on the maximum frequency or speed. (If Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 1 then
M2 Maximum Reference Clamp (21.001) is used instead.)

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 25
Parameter 01.007 Minimum Reference Clamp
Short description Defines the minimum value for the reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_NEGATIVE_REF_CLAMP1[MIN] Maximum VM_NEGATIVE_REF_CLAMP1[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

If Negative Reference Clamp Enable (01.008) = 1 then Minimum Reference Clamp (01.007) is forced to be a negative value and is applied to the final
reference as the negative limit. If Negative Reference Clamp Enable (01.008) = 0 then -Maximum Reference Clamp (01.006) is applied to the final
reference as the negative limit. (If Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 1 then M2 Minimum Reference Clamp (21.002) is used instead.)

The minimum reference clamp is also used to provide the minimum speed limit for uni-polar mode (i.e. Bipolar Reference Enable (01.010) = 0) after
the Reference Selected (01.001).

Parameter 01.008 Negative Reference Clamp Enable


Short description Set to 1 to allow the minimum reference clamp value to be negative
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Minimum Reference Clamp (01.007).

Parameter 01.009 Reference Offset Select


Short description Enables the use of the reference offset
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Reference Offset (01.004).

Parameter 01.010 Bipolar Reference Enable


Short description Enables the minimum value of the reference to be negative
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Minimum Reference Clamp (01.007).

Parameter 01.011 Reference On


Short description Indicates that the reference from the reference system is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Reference On (01.011), which is controlled by the drive sequencer (see Menu 6) indicates that the reference from the reference system is active. Note that
Reference On (01.011) is also used in RFC-A and RFC-S modes to enable and disable the Hard Speed Reference (03.022).

Parameter 01.012 Reverse Select


Short description Indicates when the reverse function is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


26 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Reverse Select (01.012), which is controlled by the drive sequencer (see Menu 6), is used to invert Reference Selected (01.001) or the Jog Reference
(01.005).

Parameter 01.013 Jog Select


Short description Indicates when the jog function is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Jog Select (01.013), which is controlled by the drive sequencer (see Menu 6), is used to select the Jog Reference (01.005).

Parameter 01.014 Reference Selector


Short description Defines the source for the references
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 6
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 A1 A2
1 A1 Preset
2 A2 Preset
3 Preset
4 Keypad
5 Precision
6 Keypad Ref

Reference Selector (01.014) defines how Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) is derived. If Reference Selector (01.014) is not 0 then
Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) is equal to Reference Selector (01.014). If Reference Selector (01.014) = 0 then Reference Selected Indicator
(01.049) is controlled by the reference select flags as shown below. The higher numbered flags have priority over the lower numbered flags.

Reference Selected Indicator


Reference select flag states
(01.049)
All reference select flags equal to 0 1
Reference Select Flag 1 (01.041) =
2
1
Reference Select Flag 2 (01.042) =
3
1
Reference Select Flag 3 (01.043) =
4
1
Reference Select Flag 4 (01.044) =
5
1

Preset Selector (01.015) defines how Preset Selected Indicator (01.050) is derived as shown below.

Preset Selector
Preset Selected Indicator (01.050)
(01.015)
Controlled by the preset select flags (
0
01.045 to 01.047)
1 1
2 2
3 3
4 4
5 5
6 6
7 7
8 8
Controlled by the preset reference selector timer
9
(see Preset Selector Timer (01.016))

When Preset Selector (01.015) = 0 then Preset Selected Indicator (01.050) is defined by the preset select flags as shown below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 27
Preset Select Flag 3 Preset Select Flag 2 Preset Select Flag 1 Preset Selected Indicator
(01.047) (01.046) (01.045) (01.050)
0 0 0 1
0 0 1 2
0 1 0 3
0 1 1 4
1 0 0 5
1 0 1 6
1 1 0 7
1 1 1 8

Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) and Preset Selected Indicator (01.050) then define the reference to be used as shown below.

Reference Selected Indicator Preset Selected Indicator


Reference
(01.049) (01.050)
1 1 Analog Reference 1 (01.036)
Preset reference defined by the value of
1 >1
Preset Selected Indicator (01.050)
2 1 Analog Reference 2 (01.037)
Preset reference defined by the value of
2 >1
Preset Selected Indicator (01.050)
Preset reference defined by the value of
3 x
Preset Selected Indicator (01.050)
4 x Keypad Control Mode Reference (01.017)
Precision Reference Coarse (01.018) and
5 x
Precision Reference Fine (01.019)
6 x Keypad Control Mode Reference (01.017)

If Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) = 4 the Keypad Control Mode Reference (01.017) is used and the sequencer operates in keypad mode where the
start, stop and optionally the reverse selection functions are provided from the drive keypad. Jog Select (01.013) and Speed Feed-forwards Select
(01.040) are always 0 when keypad mode is active.

If Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) = 6 the Keypad Control Mode Reference (01.017) is used, but keypad control mode is not active.

Parameter 01.015 Preset Selector


Short description Defines which preset is used for the reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 9
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 01.016 Preset Selector Timer


Short description Defines the time between changes of preset selector
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 400.0
Default 10.0 Units s
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

If Preset Selector (01.015) = 9 then Preset Selected Indicator (01.050) is incremented by one at intervals defined by Preset Selector Timer (01.016). When
Preset Selected Indicator (01.050) has a value of 8 and is incremented it rolls over to 1. If Preset Selector Timer Reset (01.048) = 1 and Preset Selector
(01.015) = 9, then Preset Selected Indicator (01.050) is held at 1.

Parameter 01.017 Keypad Control Mode Reference


Short description Defines the value of the keypad reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_KEYPAD_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_KEYPAD_REF[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, VM, NC, PT

Keypad control mode is active if the Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) is 4 or 6. The value of this parameter is controlled by the reference selector
system and whether Hand/Off/Auto mode is selected (see Hand/Off/Auto Operating Mode (01.052)). If keypad control is selected the frequency/speed
reference is defined by Keypad Control Mode Reference (01.017) which is a read-only parameter. The parameter can only be adjusted by pressing the Up
or Down keys when the keypad is in Status Mode and only when keypad control mode is active. Holding the Up or down keys auto-increments or
decrements Keypad Control Mode Reference (01.017), and the rate of adjustment increases the longer the key is held. Keypad Control Mode Reference
(01.017) can be adjusted whether the drive is enabled or not, and can be retained at power-down if required (see Power-

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


28 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
up Keypad Control Mode Reference (01.051)).

If the Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) is 6 then the normal drive sequencer is used and the run commands are derived from the sequencer control bit
parameters. If Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) is 4 then the keypad control sequencer is used and the drive run commands are derived using keys
on the keypad. If the keypad control sequencer is active the Stop and Run keys automatically become active and the Auxilliary key may be optionally
enabled as the reverse key with Enable Auxiliary Key (06.013).

Parameter 01.018 Precision Reference Coarse


Short description Defines the value of the coarse precision reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

The Precision Reference Coarse (01.018) and Precision Reference Fine (01.019) can be combined to provide a reference with a precision of 3 decimal
places. The precision reference value is given by Precision Reference Coarse (01.018) + Precision Reference Fine (01.019), therefore
Precision Reference Fine (01.019) increases positive values of Precision Reference Coarse (01.018) away from zero, and negative values of
Precision Reference Coarse (01.018) towards zero.

If Precision Reference Update Disable (01.020) = 0 then any changes to Precision Reference Coarse (01.018) or Precision Reference Fine (01.019) have
an effect immediately. When Precision Reference Update Disable (01.020) is changed to 1 then Precision Reference Coarse (01.018) and
Precision Reference Fine (01.019) are stored in memory and used to provide the precision reference until Precision Reference Update Disable (01.020) is
changed back to 0. This allows the component values of the precision reference to be changed without giving an unwanted intermediate value due to data
skew.

Parameter 01.019 Precision Reference Fine


Short description Defines the value of the fine precision reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 0.099
Default 0.000 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See Precision Reference Coarse (01.018).

Parameter 01.020 Precision Reference Update Disable


Short description Set to 1 to prevent immediate update to the reference from the precision reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Precision Reference Coarse (01.018).

Parameter 01.021 Preset Reference 1


Short description Defines the value for preset reference 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 01.022 Preset Reference 2


Short description Defines the value for preset reference 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 29
Parameter 01.023 Preset Reference 3
Short description Defines the value for preset reference 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 01.024 Preset Reference 4


Short description Defines the value for preset reference 4
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 01.025 Preset Reference 5


Short description Defines the value for preset reference 5
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 01.026 Preset Reference 6


Short description Defines the value for preset reference 6
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 01.027 Preset Reference 7


Short description Defines the value for preset reference 8
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 01.028 Preset Reference 8


Short description Defines the value for preset reference 8
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


30 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 01.029 Skip Reference 1
Short description Defines the 1st reference point to skip
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 33000
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

The skip references functions are available to prevent continuous operation within a specified speed range (i.e. where mechanical resonance may occur).
When Skip Reference 1 (01.029) = 0 Filter 1 is disabled. Skip Reference Band 1 (01.030) defines the range either side of Skip Reference 1 (01.029) over
which references are rejected in either direction. The actual rejection band is therefore twice that defined by Skip Reference Band 1 (01.030) with
Skip Reference 1 (01.029) as the centre of the band. When the selected reference is within the rejection band the lower limit of the band is passed through
the filter so that reference is always less than demanded.

Filter 2 (Skip Reference 2 (01.031), Skip Reference Band 2 (01.032)) and Filter 3 (Skip Reference 3 (01.033), Skip Reference Band 3 (01.034)) operate in
the same ways as Filter 1.

If any of the filters are active (i.e. the reference is within their rejection band) Reference In Rejection Zone (01.035) is set to 1, otherwise it is 0.

Parameter 01.030 Skip Reference Band 1


Short description Defines the range either side of skip reference 1 to be implemented
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 250
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

See Skip Reference 1 (01.029).

Parameter 01.031 Skip Reference 2


Short description Defines the 2nd reference point to skip
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 33000
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

See Skip Reference 1 (01.029).

Parameter 01.032 Skip Reference Band 2


Short description Defines the range either side of skip reference 2 to be implemented
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 250
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

See Skip Reference 1 (01.029).

Parameter 01.033 Skip Reference 3


Short description Defines the 3rdreference point to skip
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 33000
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

See Skip Reference 1 (01.029).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 31
Parameter 01.034 Skip Reference Band 3
Short description Defines the range either side of skip reference 3 to be implemented
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 250
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

See Skip Reference 1 (01.029).

Parameter 01.035 Reference In Rejection Zone


Short description Displays when the reference is in 1 of the pre-defined rejection zones
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Skip Reference 1 (01.029).

Parameter 01.036 Analog Reference 1


Short description Defines the relationship between the final value from analog 1 input and the frequency or speed reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_USER_REFS[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_USER_REFS[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read*
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, VM, NC

* A faster update rate of 250μs is possible for the speed reference from an analog input. See Menu 7 for details. Note that this parameter has higher
resolution than other frequency parameters in Open-loop mode as this prevents loss of resolution when an analogue input is routed to this parameter with a
typical drive output frequency range.

Analog Reference 1 (01.036) or Analog Reference 2 (01.037) should be used as the destinations for drive analog inputs when these provide the frequency
or speed reference. The variable maximum/minimum applied to Analog Reference 1 (01.036) or Analog Reference 2 (01.037) gives the relationship shown
below between the final value from the analog input and the frequency or speed reference.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


32 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 01.037 Analog Reference 2
Short description Defines the relationship between the final value from analog input 2 and the frequency or speed reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_USER_REFS[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_USER_REFS[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read*
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, VM, NC

* A faster update rate of 250μs is possible for the speed reference from an analog input. See Menu 7 for details. Note that this parameter has higher
resolution than other frequency parameters in Open-loop mode as this prevents loss of resolution when an analogue input is routed to this parameter with a
typical drive output frequency range.

See Analog Reference 1 (01.036).

Parameter 01.038 Percentage Trim


Short description Defines the value of the reference trim as a percentage
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 0.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW, NC

See Reference Offset Select (01.009).

Parameter 01.039 Speed Feed-forwards


Short description Displays the value of the speed feed-forwards used by the standard motion controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, VM, ND, NC, PT

Speed Feed-forwards (01.039) can be used by the Standard Motion Controller (Menu 13) to provide a speed feed-forwards term which uses the drive ramp
system (Menu 2) to provide a speed profile. The speed feed-forwards is enabled with Speed Feed-forwards Select (01.040), which is controlled directly by
the Standard Motion Controller.

Parameter 01.040 Speed Feed-forwards Select


Short description Indicates if the speed feed-forwards is being used by the standard motion controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Speed Feed-forwards (01.039).

Parameter 01.041 Reference Select Flag 1


Short description Defines which reference is selected by the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 01.042 Reference Select Flag 2


Short description Defines which reference is selected by the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 33
See Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 01.043 Reference Select Flag 3


Short description Defines which reference is selected by the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 01.044 Reference Select Flag 4


Short description Defines which reference is selected by the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 01.045 Preset Select Flag 1


Short description Defines which preset is selected by the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 01.046 Preset Select Flag 2


Short description Defines which preset is selected by the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 01.047 Preset Select Flag 3


Short description Defines which preset is selected by the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 01.048 Preset Selector Timer Reset


Short description Set to 1 to hold the preset selected indicator at 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Preset Selector Timer (01.016).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


34 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 01.049 Reference Selected Indicator
Short description Displays which reference is currently selected
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 6
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 01.050 Preset Selected Indicator


Short description Displays which preset is currently selected
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 8
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 01.051 Power-up Keypad Control Mode Reference


Short description Defines which value of keypad control mode reference is displayed at power-up
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Power-up read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Reset
1 Last
2 Preset

Power-up Keypad Control Mode Reference (01.051) defines the value written to Keypad Control Mode Reference (01.017) at power-up as given below.

Power-
Value written to Keypad Control Mode Reference (01.017) at
up Keypad Control Mode Reference
power-up
(01.051)
0 0.0
The value in Keypad Control Mode Reference (01.017) at the
1
previous power-down
2 The value saved in Preset Reference 1 (01.021)

Parameter 01.052 Hand/Off/Auto Operating Mode


Short description Defines the hand/off/auto operating mode of the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Hand/Off/Auto Operating Mode (01.052) defines the operating mode for this system as given in below.

Hand/Off/Auto Operating Mode (01.052) Operating mode


0 Hand/Off/Auto system disabled
Hand/Off/Auto system enabled
1
Auto state at power-up
Hand/Off/Auto system enabled
2
Off state at power-up
Hand/Off/Auto system enabled
3 Off state at power-up if off or hand state at previous power-down
Auto state if auto state at previous power-down

Hand/Off/Auto mode is an additional state machine that directly controls Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) and Keypad Control Mode Reference
(01.017). When Hand/Off/Auto mode is active the drive state and keypad keys are defined as shown in the tables below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 35
Hand/Off/Auto state Equivalent normal state
Ready with Reference Selected Indicator
Off
(01.049) = 4
Run with Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) =
Hand
4
Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) defined by
Auto
the reference selector system

Hand/Off/Auto key Equivalent normal key


Off Stop
Hand Run
Auxilliary (the reverse key does not function
Auto normally, and so the system behaves as though
Enable Auxiliary Key (06.013) = 0)

The state diagram below shows how the system moves between states when the keypad keys are pressed and Hand/Off/Auto Operating Mode (01.052) is
adjusted.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


36 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 01.053 Fire Mode Reference
Short description Defines the reference value when fire mode is activated
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

See Fire Mode Activate (01.054).

Parameter 01.054 Fire Mode Activate


Short description Route a digital input to this parameter to activate fire mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, NC

Fire Mode Activate (01.054) cannot be written directly, but it can be controlled from a digital input. This prevents fire mode from being enabled from the
keypad, comms or an option module.

Fire mode is intended for purging air from a ventilation system in the event of a fire. All trips are either disabled or are automatically reset after 1s. The use
of fire mode can result in damage to the drive, and so if fire mode is enabled and any trip is initiated an indication that cannot be reset by the user is stored
in Potential Drive Damage Conditions (10.106). For Open-loop, RFC-A or RFC-S modes fire mode is activated and if Fire Mode Reference (01.053) has a
non-zero value and Fire Mode Activate (01.054) = 1. When fire mode is activated normal drive operation is overridden as follows.

1. Pre-ramp Reference (01.003) is forced to the value in Fire Mode Reference (01.053).


2. The Final drive enable is forced to be active provided the safe torque off hardware input will allow the drive to be enabled. The Final drive run is
forced to be active.
3. Forward Limit Switch (06.035) and Reverse Limit Switch (06.036) are disabled.
4. Hard Speed Reference (03.022) is forced to 0 (RFC-A and RFC-S modes). The hard speed reference should not be used when fire mode can be
activated as this could cause an abrupt change in speed.
5. The hand/off/auto system is disabled. If this system is in the hand state when fire mode is activated it will be forced to the off state, so that hand
state is not active when fire mode is de-activated.
6. Keypad control mode is disabled.
7. All latched states in the sequencer (Menu 6) are reset.

For Regen mode fire mode is activated if Fire Mode Activate (01.054) = 1. When fire mode is activated the Final drive enable is forced to be active provided
the safe torque off hardware input will allow the drive to be enabled.

If the drive is in the tripped state when fire mode is activated the trip is reset and then only the trips listed in the table below can be initiated whilst fire mode
is active. If any of the trips shown as resettable occur, the drive will attempt to automatically reset the trip after 1s.

Trip number Trip Resettable


2 Over Volts Yes
3 OI ac Yes
4 OI Brake Yes
5 PSU Yes
9 PSU 24V Yes
21 OHt Inverter Yes
31 EEPROM Fail No
36 User Save No
37 Power Down Save No
109 OI dc Yes
200 Slot1 HF No
205 Slot2 HF No
210 Slot3 HF No
217-249 No
250 Slot4 HF No

Parameter 01.055 Linear Speed Select


Short description Set to 1 to enable linear speed units
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Normally the units for speed parameters are rpm for both rotary and linear applications. For a linear application one revolution corresponds to one motor
pole. If the position feedback device that is selected for motor control with Motor Control Feedback Select (03.026) is a linear device then

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 37
if Linear Speed Select (01.055) = 1 the units for speed parameters are mm/s with the following exceptions:

1. All speed parameters are displayed in rpm if sensorless mode is active, i.e. Sensorless Mode Active (03.078) = 1.
2. Speed feedback parameters associated with each feedback interface, i.e. P1 Speed Feedback (03.027) for position feedback interface P1, etc., are
always displayed in rpm for a rotary device.

Linear Speed Selected (01.056) shows whether rotary of linear speed is being used. If Linear Speed Selected (01.056) = 0 then rotary speed is being used
otherwise if it is 1 then linear speed is being used.

To enable the use of linear speed units, P1 Linear Feedback Select (03.051) must also be set to 1 to allow Linear Speed Selected (01.056) to be set to 1.

Parameter 01.056 Linear Speed Selected


Short description Indicates if linear speed units are being used
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Linear Speed Select (01.055).

Parameter 01.057 Force Reference Direction


Short description Defines the direction of the reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 None
1 Forward
2 Reverse

If Force Reference Direction (01.057) = 0 then it has no effect. If Force Reference Direction (01.057) is non-zero then the modulus of the reference is used
and the sign is defined by the value of Force Reference Direction (01.057). If Force Reference Direction (01.057) = 1 then Pre-skip Filter Reference
(01.002) is always positive, and if Force Reference Direction (01.057) = 2 then Pre-skip Filter Reference (01.002) is always zero or negative.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


38 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 2 Single Line Descriptions − Speed Ramps
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 39
Parameter Range Default Type
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
02.001 Post Ramp Reference RO Num ND NC PT
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
02.002 Ramp Enable Off (0) or On (1) On (1) RW Bit US
02.003 Ramp Hold Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
02.004 Ramp Mode Fast (0), Standard (1) Standard (1) RW Txt US
02.005 Disable Ramp Output Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
02.006 S Ramp Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
02.007 Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration 0.000 to 100.000 1.500 RW Num US
200V drive: 375 V
400V drive 50Hz: 750 V
VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MIN] to
02.008 Standard Ramp Voltage 400V drive 60Hz: 775 V RW Num RA US
VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX] V
575V drive: 895 V
690V drive: 1075 V
02.009 Deceleration Fail Detection Disable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
02.010 Acceleration Rate Selector 0 to 9 0 RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.011 Acceleration Rate 1 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.012 Acceleration Rate 2 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.013 Acceleration Rate 3 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.014 Acceleration Rate 4 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.015 Acceleration Rate 5 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.016 Acceleration Rate 6 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.017 Acceleration Rate 7 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.018 Acceleration Rate 8 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.019 Jog Acceleration Rate 0.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
02.020 Deceleration Rate Selector 0 to 9 0 RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.021 Deceleration Rate 1 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.022 Deceleration Rate 2 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.023 Deceleration Rate 3 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.024 Deceleration Rate 4 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.025 Deceleration Rate 5 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.026 Deceleration Rate 6 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.027 Deceleration Rate 7 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.028 Deceleration Rate 8 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
02.029 Jog Deceleration Rate 0.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
02.030 Acceleration Rate Selected 0 to 8 RO Num ND NC PT
02.031 Deceleration Rate Selected 0 to 8 RO Num ND NC PT
02.032 Acceleration Rate Select Bit 0 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
02.033 Acceleration Rate Select Bit 1 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
02.034 Acceleration Rate Select Bit 2 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
02.035 Deceleration Rate Select Bit 0 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
02.036 Deceleration Rate Select Bit 1 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
02.037 Deceleration Rate Select Bit 2 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
02.038 Inertia Compensation Torque ±1000.0 % RO Num ND NC PT
02.039 Ramp Rate Units Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
02.040 S Ramp Percentage 0.0 to 50.0 % 0.0 % RW Num US
Single (0), Percentage (1),
02.041 S Ramp Set‑up Mode Single (0) RW Txt US
Independent (2)
02.042 Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration 1 0.000 to 100.000 0.000 RW Num US
02.043 Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration 2 0.000 to 100.000 0.000 RW Num US
02.044 Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration 3 0.000 to 100.000 0.000 RW Num US
02.045 Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration 4 0.000 to 100.000 0.000 RW Num US

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


40 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 41
Menu 2 − Speed Ramps
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


42 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 02.001 Post Ramp Reference
Short description Displays the output of the ramp system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, VM, ND, NC, PT

The Post Ramp Reference (02.001) can be combined with the Hard Speed Reference (03.022) to give the final speed reference at the input to the
speed controller (see Menu 3). If the Hard Speed Reference (03.022) is used alone to give the final speed reference, and the ramp output is not
required, then the ramp output can be disconnected by setting Disable Ramp Output (02.005) = 1. This ensures that the reference and ramp systems
do not affect the final speed reference.

It should be noted that the ramps are applied during starting and stopping (i.e. when Reference On (01.011) changes from 0 to 1 and vice versa) even
when the hard speed reference is being used. This is achieved on starting by making the ramp output equal to Speed Feedback (03.002) -
Hard Speed Reference (03.022). (See Catch A Spinning Motor (06.009) for more details.) For example, if the motor is stationary then the initial value of
the ramp output is equal to -Hard Speed Reference (03.022). On stopping the ramp output is made equal to Final Speed Reference (03.001) and the
setting of Disable Ramp Output (02.005) is ignored and so the ramp is always used, but just while the drive is in the deceleration state. If the hard speed
reference is being used alone and ramps are not required on starting the ramps should be disabled. If ramps are not required on stopping then stopping
without ramps should be used (i.e. Stop Mode (06.001) should be set for no ramp stop). The same feature is applied when stopping when the supply is
lost, so that if Supply Loss Mode (06.003) is set to select a ramped stop, the speed will be ramped to standstill even if the hard speed reference is being
used.

If the Advanced Motion Controller is being used, ramped stopping is selected and the run is deactivated (i.e. Reference On (01.011) changes from 1 to
0), but the drive enable ramains active, the AMC will be disabled and the speed will be ramped to zero using the ramp rate selected with Menu 2. If
ramped stop on supply loss is selected then on supply loss the AMC is disabled and the ramp selected via Menu 2 will be used to stop the motor. It
should be noted that orientation stop cannot be used when the run is deactivated if the AMC is selected (i.e. AMC Select (31.001) = 1).

Parameter 02.002 Ramp Enable


Short description Set to 1 to enable the ramp system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

If Ramp Enable (02.002) = 1 then the ramp system is present between the Pre-ramp Reference (01.003) and the Post Ramp Reference (02.001). If
Ramp Enable (02.002) = 0 then any changes in the Pre-ramp Reference (01.003) are reflected immediately in the Post Ramp Reference (02.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 43
Parameter 02.003 Ramp Hold
Short description Set to 1 to hold the ramp system at its present value
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 250µs read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If Ramp Hold (02.003) = 0 the ramp system functions normally. If Ramp Hold (02.003) is set to 1 and S Ramp Enable (02.006) = 0 the ramp system
output is held at its current level. If Ramp Hold (02.003) is subsequently set to 0 the ramp system output is released and continues to operate normally.
If S Ramp Enable (02.006) = 1 when Ramp Hold (02.003) is set to 1 the acceleration will ramp towards zero and the frequency or speed will change in
an S curve towards a constant speed. If a drive stop is requested (i.e. Reference On (01.011) = 0) the ramp hold function is disabled.

Parameter 02.004 Ramp Mode


Short description Defines the mode used by the ramp system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Fast
1 Standard

Acceleration is defined as a positive (forward) or negative (reverse) frequency or speed change away from zero, and deceleration is defined as a
change towards zero. Ramp Mode (02.004) defines the ramp mode used for deceleration. During acceleration the frequency or speed changes are
based on the final acceleration rate only.

0: Fast ramp
During deceleration the frequency or speed changes are based on the final deceleration rate.

1: Standard ramp
If the d.c. bus voltage rises to the level defined by Standard Ramp Voltage (02.008) the regenerative current limit is modified to prevent the voltage from
rising any higher. This form of control applies to speed or torque control and during supply loss. If the Standard Ramp Voltage (02.008) is set to a level
that is below the nominal d.c. bus voltage level the motor is likely to accelerate with a low level of torque. The waveforms below show the behaviour of
the system when the speed reference is set to zero and standard ramp control becomes active. In the first example the speed reference (ramp output)
reaches zero before the actual speed reaches zero because the deceleration is being controlled to limit the d.c. link voltage. Then when standard ramp
control becomes inactive the ramp output is set to the actual speed, so that the required ramp rate is used to decelerate to stop. In the second example
the reference is reapplied before the speed reaches zero. Because the speed reference has fallen faster than the actual speed, there is a recovery time
before the speed reference rises to meet the actual speed.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


44 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide
Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 45
Parameter 02.005 Disable Ramp Output
Short description Set to 1 to disable the ramp system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Post Ramp Reference (02.001).

Parameter 02.006 S Ramp Enable


Short description Set to 1 to enable the use of S ramps
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If S Ramp Enable (02.006) = 0 linear ramps are used, but if S Ramp Enable (02.006) = 1 an acceleration limit is applied to give S ramps. See
Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration (02.007) for more details of S ramps.

Parameter 02.007 Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration


Short description Defines the maximum rate of change of acceleration used by the ramp system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 100.000
Default 1.500 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

A rate of change of acceleration ramp (S ramp) can be applied by different methods depending on the value of S Ramp Set-up Mode (02.041). If
S Ramp Set-up Mode (02.041) = 0 then the maximum rate of change of acceleration in both directions, accelerating away from or towards zero, is
defined by Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration (02.007).

The general equations are given below for a linear ramp and S ramp where
Δw is the required change of frequency or speed
aMax is the maximum allowed acceleration in units of frequency/s or speed/s
JMax is the maximum rate of change of acceleration (i.e. jerk) in units of frequency/s2 or speed/s2

The time for a linear ramp to give a change of frequency or speed Δw is

TLinear = Δw / aMax

If an S ramp is used wB is the change of frequency or speed as the acceleration changes from zero to aMax, i.e. the S shaped part of the frequency or
speed change.

wB = aMax2 / 2JMax

If the required frequency or speed change is less than 2wB, i.e. Δw < 2wB, then the acceleration never reaches its limit and the ramp does not contain a
linear ramp section and the time for the ramp is given by

TSRamp1 = 2 √(Δw / JMax)

Otherwise

TSRamp2 = (Δw / aMax) + (aMax / JMax)

The following is an example based on the default parameter values for Open-loop mode. The diagram below shows a change of frequency from 0Hz to
50Hz with the ramp rate set to 5.0s/100Hz and Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration (02.007) set to its default value of 3.1s2/100Hz.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


46 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
The required change of frequency Δw = 50Hz. The acceleration and jerk are converted from the parameter values as follows:

aMax = 100 / ramp rate = 20.0Hz/s

JMax = 100 / Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration (02.007) = 32.3Hz/s2

The linear ramp time TLinear = Δw x aMax = 50.0 / 20.0 = 2.5s

The frequency change for the acceleration to reach its limit wB = aMax2 / 2JMax = 20.02 / (2 x 32.3) = 6.19Hz

The required frequency change for Δw = 50Hz and this is greater than 2wB, i.e. Δw > 2 x 6.19Hz. Therefore the time for the ramp

TSRamp2 = (Δw / aMax) + (aMax / JMax) = (50.0 / 20.0) + (20.0 / 32.3) = 2.5 + 0.62 = 3.12s

Note that the default value of Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration (02.007) has been chosen so that when it is combined with the default
acceleration rate, each of the S sections of the ramp is 20% of the overall time for the frequency change, i.e. 0.62/3.12 x 100% = 20%. This is the same
as if S Ramp Set-up Mode (02.041) = 2 and S Ramp Percentage (02.040) = 20%.

If the required change of frequency had been 5.0Hz, i.e. less than 2 x wB, then the alternative equation should be used:

TSRamp1 = 2 √(Δw / JMax) = 2 √(5.0 / 32.3) = 0.78s

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 47
For RFC-A and RFC-S modes the general equations are used in the same way as for Open-loop mode. The required values are calculated as follows:
Δw = 1000 / ramp rate
aMax = 1000 / ramp rate
JMax = 1000 / Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration (02.007)

Parameter 02.008 Standard Ramp Voltage


Short description Defines the standard ramp voltage used by the ramp system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MIN] Maximum VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX]
Default See exceptions below Units V
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM, RA

Voltage Region Default Value


200V All 375
400V 50Hz 750
400V 60Hz 775
575V All 895
690V All 1075

See Ramp Mode (02.004).

Parameter 02.009 Deceleration Fail Detection Disable


Short description Set to 1 to disable the deceleration fal detection function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

In the following circumstances it is possible that the motor may not decelerated or even accelerate.

1. When standard ramp is selected with a high inductance supply it is possible for the d.c. bus voltage to rise as the motor speed approaches
zero, and so the motor will continue to rotate slowly and not stop.
2. An overhauling load can cause the motor to accelerate.

It can be a problem if the drive state is changed to the "Decelerating" state and the motor does not stop. If Deceleration Fail Detection Disable
(02.009) is at its default value of 0, the motor frequency or speed is monitored in the "Decelerating" state, and if this does not fall over a period of 10s
the ramp output is forced to zero and the drive state is changed to "Stop" or "Inhibit" as appropriate.

If Deceleration Fail Detection Disable (02.009) = 1 this feature is disabled. This can be used in the following circumstances to prevent the system state
from changing from the "Decelerating" state before the motor has stopped:

1. If S ramps are being used with long ramp rates, and the motor is still accelerating when the drive is changed to the "Decelerating" state
because the run command is removed, then the ramp output may increase further before falling again towards zero.
2. In RFC-A or RFC-S modes the speed may appear not to reduce when very long ramp rates are used.

Parameter 02.010 Acceleration Rate Selector


Short description Defines which acceleration rate is used by the ramp system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 9
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The Acceleration Rate Selector (02.010) is used to either select an acceleration rate directly or to define the method used to select an acceleration rate.
If 1 ≤ Acceleration Rate Selector (02.010) ≤ 8 the acceleration rate is selected directly, i.e. 1 selects Acceleration Rate 1 (02.011), 2 selects
Acceleration Rate 2 (02.012), etc. If Acceleration Rate Selector (02.010) = 0 the acceleration rate is selected with the acceleration rate select bits as
shown in the table below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


48 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Acceleration Rate Select Bit 2 Acceleration Rate Select Bit 1 Acceleration Rate Select Bit 0 Acceleration rate
(02.034) (02.033) (02.032) selected
Acceleration Rate 1
0 0 0
(02.011)
Acceleration Rate 2
0 0 1
(02.012)
Acceleration Rate 3
0 1 0
(02.013)
Acceleration Rate 4
0 1 1
(02.014)
Acceleration Rate 5
1 0 0
(02.015)
Acceleration Rate 6
1 0 1
(02.016)
Acceleration Rate 7
1 1 0
(02.017)
Acceleration Rate 8
1 1 1
(02.018)

If Acceleration Rate Selector (02.010) = 9 the acceleration rate is selected based on the value of Preset Selected Indicator (01.050), i.e. 1
selects Acceleration Rate 1 (02.011), 2 selects Acceleration Rate 2 (02.012), etc.

Parameter 02.011 Acceleration Rate 1


Short description Defines the acceleration rate present in acceleration rate 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

Acceleration Rate 1 (02.011) to Acceleration Rate 8 (02.018) can be selected to define the linear ramp rate. The acceleration rate applies when the
frequency/speed is changing away from zero.

Selecting a ramp rate that has been set to zero in Open-loop mode disables the ramp system so that the Post Ramp Reference (02.001) follows thePre-
ramp Reference (01.003) without any delay for acceleration or deceleration. It should be noted that this also disables the standard ramp d.c. link voltage
controller and the frequency based current limits.

The units of Acceleration Rate 1 (02.011) to Acceleration Rate 8 (02.018) are s / Ramp rate frequency or s / Ramp rate speed. See Ramp Rate Units
(02.039) for the definition of Ramp rate frequency and Ramp rate speed.

Parameter 02.012 Acceleration Rate 2


Short description Defines the acceleration rate present in acceleration rate 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

See Acceleration Rate 1 (02.011).

Parameter 02.013 Acceleration Rate 3


Short description Defines the acceleration rate present in acceleration rate 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

See Acceleration Rate 1 (02.011).

Parameter 02.014 Acceleration Rate 4


Short description Defines the acceleration rate present in acceleration rate 4
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 49
See Acceleration Rate 1 (02.011).

Parameter 02.015 Acceleration Rate 5


Short description Defines the acceleration rate present in acceleration rate 5
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

See Acceleration Rate 1 (02.011).

Parameter 02.016 Acceleration Rate 6


Short description Defines the acceleration rate present in acceleration rate 6
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

See Acceleration Rate 1 (02.011).

Parameter 02.017 Acceleration Rate 7


Short description Defines the acceleration rate present in acceleration rate 7
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

See Acceleration Rate 1 (02.011).

Parameter 02.018 Acceleration Rate 8


Short description Defines the acceleration rate present in acceleration rate 8
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

See Acceleration Rate 1 (02.011).

Parameter 02.019 Jog Acceleration Rate


Short description Defines the acceleration rate present when the jog function is selected
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 0.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

The Jog Acceleration Rate (02.019) is selected when Jog Select (01.013) is active and when the frequency/speed is changing away from zero in either
direction. The units of Jog Acceleration Rate (02.019) are s / Ramp rate frequency or s / Ramp rate speed. See Ramp Rate Units (02.039) for the
definition of Ramp rate frequency and Ramp rate speed.

Parameter 02.020 Deceleration Rate Selector


Short description Defines which deceleration rate is used by the ramp system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 9
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


50 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
The Deceleration Rate Selector (02.020) operates in the same way as the Acceleration Rate Selector (02.010). If Deceleration Rate Selector (02.020) =
0 the deceleration rate is selected with the deceleration rate select bits as shown in the table below.

Deceleration Rate Select Bit 2 Deceleration Rate Select Bit 1 Deceleration Rate Select Bit 0 Deceleration rate
(02.037) (02.036) (02.035) selected
Deceleration Rate 1
0 0 0
(02.021)
Deceleration Rate 2
0 0 1
(02.022)
Deceleration Rate 3
0 1 0
(02.023)
Deceleration Rate 4
0 1 1
(02.024)
Deceleration Rate 5
1 0 0
(02.025)
Deceleration Rate 6
1 0 1
(02.026)
Deceleration Rate 7
1 1 0
(02.027)
Deceleration Rate 8
1 1 1
(02.028)

Parameter 02.021 Deceleration Rate 1


Short description Defines the deceleration rate present in deceleration rate 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

Deceleration Rate 1 (02.021) to Deceleration Rate 8 (02.028) can be selected to define the linear ramp rate. The deceleration rate applies when the
frequency/speed is changing towards zero.

Selecting a ramp rate that has been set to zero in Open-loop mode disables the ramp system so that the Post Ramp Reference (02.001) follows thePre-
ramp Reference (01.003) without any delay for acceleration or deceleration. It should be noted that this also disables the standard ramp d.c. link voltage
controller and the frequency based current limits.

The units of Deceleration Rate 1 (02.021) to Deceleration Rate 8 (02.028) are s / Ramp rate frequency or s / Ramp rate speed. See Ramp Rate Units
(02.039) for the definition of Ramp rate frequency and Ramp rate speed.

Parameter 02.022 Deceleration Rate 2


Short description Defines the deceleration rate present in deceleration rate 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

See Deceleration Rate 1 (02.021).

Parameter 02.023 Deceleration Rate 3


Short description Defines the deceleration rate present in deceleration rate 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

See Deceleration Rate 1 (02.021).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 51
Parameter 02.024 Deceleration Rate 4
Short description Defines the deceleration rate present in deceleration rate 4
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

See Deceleration Rate 1 (02.021).

Parameter 02.025 Deceleration Rate 5


Short description Defines the deceleration rate present in deceleration rate 5
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

See Deceleration Rate 1 (02.021).

Parameter 02.026 Deceleration Rate 6


Short description Defines the deceleration rate present in deceleration rate 6
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

See Deceleration Rate 1 (02.021).

Parameter 02.027 Deceleration Rate 7


Short description Defines the deceleration rate present in deceleration rate 7
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

See Deceleration Rate 1 (02.021).

Parameter 02.028 Deceleration Rate 8


Short description Defines the deceleration rate present in deceleration rate 8
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

See Deceleration Rate 1 (02.021).

Parameter 02.029 Jog Deceleration Rate


Short description Defines the deceleration rate present when the jog function is selected
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 0.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

The Jog Deceleration Rate (02.029) is selected when Jog Select (01.013) is active and when the frequency/speed is changing towards zero in either
direction. It should be noted that when jog is selected and the drive run is de-activated Jog Deceleration Rate (02.029) is used to decelerate the motor
to stop. The units of Jog Deceleration Rate (02.029) are s / Ramp rate frequency or s / Ramp rate speed. See Ramp Rate Units (02.039) for the

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


52 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
definition of Ramp rate frequency and Ramp rate speed.

Parameter 02.030 Acceleration Rate Selected


Short description Indicates which acceleration rate is selected
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 8
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Acceleration Rate Selected (02.030) shows a value between 1 and 8 that corresponds to parameters 02.011 to 02.018 indicating which of these
acceleration rates is actually being used.

Parameter 02.031 Deceleration Rate Selected


Short description Indicates which deceleration rate is selected
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 8
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Deceleration Rate Selected (02.031) shows a value between 1 and 8 that corresponds to parameters 02.021 to 02.028 indicating which of these
deceleration rates is actually being used.

Parameter 02.032 Acceleration Rate Select Bit 0


Short description Defines which acceleration rate is used if acceleration rate selector = 0
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Acceleration Rate Selector (02.010).

Parameter 02.033 Acceleration Rate Select Bit 1


Short description Defines which acceleration rate is used if acceleration rate selector = 0
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Acceleration Rate Selector (02.010).

Parameter 02.034 Acceleration Rate Select Bit 2


Short description Defines which acceleration rate is used if acceleration rate selector = 0
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Acceleration Rate Selector (02.010).

Parameter 02.035 Deceleration Rate Select Bit 0


Short description Defines which deceleration rate is used if deceleration rate selector = 0
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 53
See Deceleration Rate Selector (02.020).

Parameter 02.036 Deceleration Rate Select Bit 1


Short description Defines which deceleration rate is used if deceleration rate selector = 0
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Deceleration Rate Selector (02.020).

Parameter 02.037 Deceleration Rate Select Bit 2


Short description Defines which deceleration rate is used if deceleration rate selector = 0
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Deceleration Rate Selector (02.020).

Parameter 02.038 Inertia Compensation Torque


Short description Displays the torque as a percentage of rated torque
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -1000.0 Maximum 1000.0
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

The Motor And Load Inertia (03.018), Torque Per Amp (05.032) and the rate of change of the Post Ramp Reference (02.001) are used to produce a
torque feed-forwards value that should accelerate and decelerate the load at the required rate. This value can be used as a feed-forwards term that is
added to the speed controller output if Inertia Compensation Enable (04.022) = 1. Inertia Compensation Torque (02.038) gives the torque as a
percentage of rated torque.

Parameter 02.039 Ramp Rate Units


Short description Defines the units used by the ramp system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The ramp rate parameters (Acceleration Rate 1 (02.011) to Acceleration Rate 8 (02.018), Jog Acceleration Rate (02.019), Deceleration Rate 1
(02.021) to Deceleration Rate 8 (02.028) and Jog Deceleration Rate (02.029)) are specified in s / Ramp rate frequency for Open-loop mode and s /
Ramp rate speed for RFC-A and RFC-S modes. Ramp rate frequency and Ramp rate speed are selected with Ramp Rate Units (02.039) as defined in
the table below.

Ramp Rate Units (02.039) Open-loop Ramp rate frequency RFC-A and RFC-S mode Ramp rate speed
0 100Hz 1000rpm ot 1000mm/s
1 Maximum frequency Maximum speed

Maximum frequency and Maximum speed are defined by Maximum Reference Clamp (01.006) if Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 0,
or M2 Maximum Reference Clamp (21.001) if Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 1.

Parameter 02.040 S Ramp Percentage


Short description Defines the profile of the S ramp system as a percentage
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 50.0
Default 0.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

If S Ramp Set-up Mode (02.041) = 1 the percentage of the ramp to Maximum frequency or Maximum speed that includes half the S ramp profile can be
specified with S Ramp Percentage (02.040) as shown in the diagram below. If motor map one is active (i.e. Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 0),

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


54 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
the acceleration or deceleration times are defined by Acceleration Rate 1 (02.011) and Deceleration Rate 1 (02.021) respectively irrespective of which
ramps rates are selected. The maximum frequency/speed is defined by Maximum Reference Clamp (01.006). The time for the frequency/speed change
remains constant at the time defined by the acceleration or deceleration rate, and so as the percentage S ramp is changed the maximum acceleration is
modified automatically. If motor map 2 is selected then M2 Maximum Reference Clamp (21.001), M2 Acceleration Rate 1 (21.004) and
M2 Deceleration Rate 1 (21.005) are used to define the ramp profile. It should be noted that for ramp times to the maximum speed/frequency exceeding
30s this system becomes less accurate and the ramp time may become shorter than expected.

Parameter 02.041 S Ramp Set-up Mode


Short description Defines the mode used by the S ramp system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Single
1 Percentage
2 Independent

S Ramp Set-up Mode (02.041) defines the method used to set up the S ramp function.

0: Single maximum rate of change of acceleration


The maximum rate of change of acceleration in either direction, when the frequency/speed is changing away from or towards zero, is defined
by Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration (02.007).

1: Percentage
A single maximum rate of change of acceleration is used in either direction, when the frequency/speed is changing away from or towards zero, but this
is specified as the percentage of the ramp from zero to Maximum frequency or Maximum speed which is covered by the S shaped profile.
See S Ramp Percentage (02.040).

2: Independent maximum rate of change of acceleration values


The maximum rate of change of acceleration can be specified as four independent values. See Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration 1 (02.042).

Parameter 02.042 Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration 1


Short description Defines the 1st maximum rate of change of acceleration used by the S ramp system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 100.000
Default 0.000 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

If S Ramp Set-up Mode (02.041) = 2 it is possible to set up four independent maximum rate of change of acceleration values as shown in the diagram
below. The values from 1 to 4 correspond to Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration 1 (02.042) to Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration 4
Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide
Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 55
(02.045) respectively.

Parameter 02.043 Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration 2


Short description Defines the 2nd maximum rate of change of acceleration used by the S ramp system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 100.000
Default 0.000 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration 1 (02.042).

Parameter 02.044 Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration 3


Short description Defines the 3rd maximum rate of change of acceleration used by the S ramp system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 100.000
Default 0.000 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration 1 (02.042).

Parameter 02.045 Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration 4


Short description Defines the 4th maximum rate of change of acceleration used by the S ramp system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 100.000
Default 0.000 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See Maximum Rate Of Change Of Acceleration 1 (02.042).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


56 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 3 Single Line Descriptions − Speed Control and Position Feedback
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 57
Parameter Range Default Type
VM_SPEED[MIN] to
03.001 Final Speed Reference RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_SPEED[MAX]
VM_SPEED[MIN] to
03.002 Speed Feedback RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_SPEED[MAX]
VM_SPEED[MIN] to
03.003 Speed Error RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_SPEED[MAX]
VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MIN] to
03.004 Speed Controller Output RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MAX] %
03.005 Zero Speed Threshold 0 to 200 5 RW Num US
03.006 At Speed Lower Limit 0 to 33000 5 RW Num US
03.007 At Speed Upper Limit 0 to 33000 5 RW Num US
03.008 Over Speed Threshold 0 to 33000 0 RW Num US
03.009 Absolute At Speed Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
03.010 Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 0.0000 to 200.0000 s/rad 0.0300 s/rad RW Num US
03.011 Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1 0.00 to 655.35 s²/rad 0.10 s²/rad RW Num US
03.012 Speed Controller Differential Feedback Gain Kd1 0.00000 to 0.65535 1/rad 0.00000 1/rad RW Num US
03.013 Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp2 0.0000 to 200.0000 s/rad 0.0300 s/rad RW Num US
03.014 Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki2 0.00 to 655.35 s²/rad 0.10 s²/rad RW Num US
03.015 Speed Controller Differential Feedback Gain Kd2 0.00000 to 0.65535 1/rad 0.00000 1/rad RW Num US
03.016 Speed Controller Gain Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
Disabled (0), Bandwidth (1),
Comp Angle (2),
Kp Gain Times 16 (3),
03.017 Speed Controller Set‑up Method Low Performance (4), Disabled (0) RW Txt US
Std Performance (5),
High Performance (6),
First Order (7)
03.018 Motor And Load Inertia 0.00000 to 1000.00000 kgm² 0.00000 kgm² RW Num US
03.019 Compliance Angle 0.0 to 360.0 ° 4.0 ° RW Num US
03.020 Bandwidth 1 to 1000 Hz 10 Hz RW Num US
03.021 Damping Factor 0.0 to 10.0 1.0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
03.022 Hard Speed Reference 0.0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
03.023 Hard Speed Reference Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
Feedback (0), Sensorless (1),
03.024 RFC Feedback Mode Feedback NoMax (2), Feedback (0) RW Txt US
Sensorless NoMax (3)
P1 Drive (0), P2 Drive (1),
P1 Slot1 (2), P2 Slot1 (3),
03.026 Motor Control Feedback Select P1 Drive (0) RW Txt US
P1 Slot2 (4), P2 Slot2 (5),
P1 Slot3 (6), P2 Slot3 (7)
VM_SPEED[MIN] to
03.027 P1 Speed Feedback RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_SPEED[MAX]
03.028 P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT PS
03.029 P1 Position 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT PS
03.030 P1 Fine Position 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT
03.031 P1 Marker Mode 0000 to 1111 0100 RW Bin US
03.032 P1 Marker Flag Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
03.033 P1 Rotary Turns Bits 0 to 16 16 RW Num US
03.034 P1 Rotary Lines Per Revolution 1 to 100000 1024 RW Num US
03.035 P1 Comms Bits 0 to 48 0 RW Num US
03.036 P1 Supply Voltage 5V (0), 8V (1), 15V (2) 5V (0) RW Txt US
100k (0), 200k (1), 300k (2),
03.037 P1 Comms Baud Rate 400k (3), 500k (4), 1M (5), 1.5M (6), 300k (2) Baud RW Txt US
2M (7), 4M (8) Baud
AB (0), FD (1), FR (2), AB Servo (3),
FD Servo (4), FR Servo (5), SC (6),
SC Hiperface (7), EnDat (8),
SC EnDat (9), SSI (10), SC SSI (11),
03.038 P1 Device Type SC Servo (12), BiSS (13), AB (0) RW Txt US
Resolver (14), SC SC (15),
Commutation Only (16),
SC BiSS (17), EnDat Alt (18),
SSI Alt (19), BiSS Alt (20)
03.039 P1 Termination Select 0 to 2 1 RW Num US
03.040 P1 Error Detection Level 00000000 to 11111111 00000001 RW Bin US
03.041 P1 Auto‑configuration Select Disabled (0), Enabled (1) Enabled (1) RW Txt US
Disabled (0), 1ms (1), 2ms (2),
03.042 P1 Feedback Filter Disabled (0) RW Txt US
4ms (3), 8ms (4), 16ms (5)
03.043 P1 Maximum Reference 0 to 33000 1500 RW Num US

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


58 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
03.044 P1 Reference Scaling 0.000 to 4.000 1.000 RW Num US
03.045 P1 Reference ±100.0 % RO Num ND NC PT FI
03.046 P1 Reference destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
03.047 P1 SSI Incremental Mode Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
03.048 P1 SSI Binary Mode Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
03.049 P1 Additional Power‑up Delay 0.0 to 25.0 s 0.0 s RW Num US
03.050 P1 Feedback Lock Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
03.051 P1 Linear Feedback Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
03.052 P1 Linear Comms Pitch 0.001 to 100.000 0.001 RW Num US
03.053 P1 Linear Line Pitch 0.001 to 100.000 0.001 RW Num US
03.054 P1 Linear Comms And Line Pitch Units millimetres (0), micrometres (1) millimetres (0) RW Txt US
03.055 P1 Pole Pair Pitch 0.01 to 1000.00 mm 10.00 mm RW Num US
03.056 P1 Feedback Reverse Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
03.057 P1 Normalisation Turns 0 to 16 16 RW Num US
03.058 P1 Normalised Position -2147483648 to 2147483647 RO Num ND NC PT
03.059 P1 Normalised Marker Position -2147483648 to 2147483647 RO Num ND NC PT
03.060 P1 Calculation Time 0 to 20 µs 5 µs RW Num US
03.061 P1 Recovery Time 4 to 100 µs 30 µs RW Num US
03.062 P1 Line Delay Time 0 to 5000 ns RO Num ND NC PT US
03.063 P1 Low Speed Update Rate Active Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
None (0), Hiperface (1),
03.064 P1 Encoder Protocol Detected EnDat2.1 (2), EnDat2.2 (3), RO Txt ND NC PT
BiSS (4)
03.065 P1 Resolver Poles 2 (1) to 20 (10) Poles 2 (1) Poles RW Txt US
6kHz 3V (0), 8kHz 3V (1),
6kHz 2V (2), 8kHz 2V (3),
03.066 P1 Resolver Excitation 6kHz 3V (0) RW Txt US
6kHz 3V Fast (4), 8kHz 3V Fast (5),
6kHz 2V Fast (6), 8kHz 2V Fast (7)
03.067 P1 User Comms Enable 0 to 1 0 RW Num NC PT
03.068 P1 User Comms Transmit Register 0 to 65535 0 RW Num NC PT
03.069 P1 User Comms Receive Register 0 to 65535 0 RW Num NC PT
03.070 P1 Position Feedback Signals 000000 to 111111 RO Bin ND NC PT
03.071 P1 Error Detected Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
03.073 P1 Absolute Turns Recovery Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
03.074 P1 Additional Configuration 0 to 511116116 0 RW Num US
03.075 Initialise Position Feedback Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
03.076 Position Feedback Initialized 0000000000 to 1111111111 RO Bin ND NC PT
03.078 Sensorless Mode Active Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
03.079 Sensorless Mode Filter 4 (0), 8 (1), 16 (2), 32 (3), 64 (4) ms 4 (0) ms RW Txt US
03.080 Sensorless Position -2147483648 to 2147483647 RO Num ND NC PT
03.085 Encoder Simulation Source 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
None (0), Full (1),
03.086 Encoder Simulation Status RO Txt ND NC PT
No Marker Pulse (2)
03.087 Encoder Simulation Sample Period 0.25 (0), 1 (1), 4 (2), 16 (3) ms 0.25 (0) ms RW Txt US
Hardware (0), Lines Per Rev (1),
03.088 Encoder Simulation Mode Hardware (0) RW Txt US
Ratio (2), SSI (3)
03.089 Encoder Simulation Hardware Divider 0 to 7 0 RW Num US
03.090 Encoder Simulation Hardware Marker Lock Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
03.091 Encoder Simulation Incremental Mode Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
03.092 Encoder Simulation Output Lines Per Revolution 1 to 16384 4096 RW Num US
03.093 Encoder Simulation Numerator 1 to 65536 65536 RW Num US
03.094 Encoder Simulation Denominator 1 to 65536 65536 RW Num US
03.095 Encoder Simulation Output Roll‑over Limit 1 to 65535 65535 RW Num US
03.096 Encoder Simulation SSI Turns Bits 0 to 16 16 RW Num US
03.097 Encoder Simulation SSI Comms Bits 2 to 48 33 RW Num US
AB/Gray (0), FD/Binary (1),
03.098 Encoder Simulation Output Mode AB/Gray (0) RW Txt US
FR/Binary (2)
Digital Input 4 (0), Digital Input 5 (1),
P1 Marker (2), P2 Marker (3),
03.100 F1 Freeze Trigger Source Digital Input 4 (0) RW Txt US
Common (4), P1 Zero (5),
P2 Zero (6)
Rising 1st (0), Falling 1st (1),
03.101 F1 Freeze Mode Rising 1st (0) RW Txt US
Rising all (2), Falling all (3)
03.102 F1 Freeze Position Source P1 (0), P2 (1), Time (2) P1 (0) RW Txt US
03.103 F1 Normalised Freeze Position -2147483648 to 2147483647 RO Num ND NC PT
03.104 F1 Freeze Flag Off (0) or On (1) RW Bit ND NC PT
Digital Input 4 (0), Digital Input 5 (1),

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 59
P1 Marker (2), P2 Marker (3),
03.105 F2 Freeze Trigger Source Digital Input 4 (0) RW Txt US
Common (4), P1 Zero (5),
P2 Zero (6)
Rising 1st (0), Falling 1st (1),
03.106 F2 Freeze Mode Rising 1st (0) RW Txt US
Rising all (2), Falling all (3)
03.107 F2 Freeze Position Source P1 (0), P2 (1), Time (2) P1 (0) RW Txt US
03.108 F2 Normalised Freeze Position -2147483648 to 2147483647 RO Num ND NC PT
03.109 F2 Freeze Flag Off (0) or On (1) RW Bit ND NC PT
Digital Input 4 (0), Digital Input 5 (1),
03.110 Common Freeze Source 1 P1 Marker (2), P2 Marker (3), Digital Input 4 (0) RW Txt US
Disabled (4)
Digital Input 4 (0), Digital Input 5 (1),
03.111 Common Freeze Source 2 P1 Marker (2), P2 Marker (3), Digital Input 4 (0) RW Txt US
Disabled (4)
03.112 Common Freeze Mode 0000 to 1111 0000 RW Bin US
03.113 Freeze Input States 00 to 11 RO Bin ND NC PT
03.114 F1 Freeze Sensor Delay 0.0 to 250.0 µs 0.0 µs RW Num US
03.115 F2 Freeze Sensor Delay 0.0 to 250.0 µs 0.0 µs RW Num US
DIN44082 (0), KTY84 (1), 0.8mA (2),
03.118 P1 Thermistor Type DIN44082 (0) RW Txt US
Encoder (3)
03.119 P1 Thermistor Feedback 0 to 5000 Ω RO Num ND NC PT
03.120 P1 Thermistor Trip Threshold 0 to 5000 Ω 3300 Ω RW Num US
03.121 P1 Thermistor Reset Threshold 0 to 5000 Ω 1800 Ω RW Num US
03.122 P1 Thermistor Temperature -50 to 300 °C RO Num ND NC PT
None (0), Temperature (1),
03.123 P1 Thermistor Fault Detection None (0) RW Txt US
Temp or Short (2)
VM_SPEED[MIN] to
03.127 P2 Speed Feedback RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_SPEED[MAX]
03.128 P2 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT PS
03.129 P2 Position 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT PS
03.130 P2 Fine Position 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT
03.131 P2 Marker Mode 0000 to 1111 0100 RW Bin US
03.132 P2 Marker Flag Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
03.133 P2 Rotary Turns Bits 0 to 16 16 RW Num US
03.134 P2 Rotary Lines Per Revolution 0 to 100000 1024 RW Num US
03.135 P2 Comms Bits 0 to 48 0 RW Num US
100k (0), 200k (1), 300k (2),
03.137 P2 Comms Baud Rate 400k (3), 500k (4), 1M (5), 1.5M (6), 300k (2) Baud RW Txt US
2M (7), 4M (8) Baud
None (0), AB (1), FD (2), FR (3),
03.138 P2 Device type None (0) RW Txt US
EnDat (4), SSI (5), BiSS (6)
03.140 P2 Error Detection Level 00000 to 11111 00001 RW Bin US
03.141 P2 Auto‑configuration Select Disabled (0), Enabled (1) Enabled (1) RW Txt US
Disabled (0), 1ms (1), 2ms (2),
03.142 P2 Feedback Filter Disabled (0) RW Txt US
4ms (3), 8ms (4), 16ms (5)
03.143 P2 Maximum Reference 0 to 33000 1500 RW Num US
03.144 P2 Reference Scaling 0.000 to 4.000 1.000 RW Num US
03.145 P2 Reference ±100.0 % RO Num ND NC PT FI
03.146 P2 Reference Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
03.147 P2 SSI Incremental Mode Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
03.148 P2 SSI Binary Mode Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
03.149 P2 Additional Power‑up Delay 0.0 to 25.0 s 0.0 s RW Num US
03.150 P2 Feedback Lock Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
03.151 P2 Linear Feedback Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
03.152 P2 Linear Comms Pitch 0.001 to 100.000 0.001 RW Num US
03.153 P2 Linear Line Pitch 0.001 to 100.000 0.001 RW Num US
03.154 P2 Linear Comms And Line Pitch Units millimetres (0), micrometres (1) millimetres (0) RW Txt US
03.155 P2 Pole Pair Pitch 0.01 to 1000.00 mm 10.00 mm RW Num US
03.156 P2 Feedback Reverse Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
03.157 P2 Normalisation Turns 0 to 16 16 RW Num US
03.158 P2 Normalised Position -2147483648 to 2147483647 RO Num ND NC PT
03.159 P2 Normalised Marker Position -2147483648 to 2147483647 RO Num ND NC PT
03.160 P2 Calculation Time 0 to 20 µs 5 µs RW Num US
03.161 P2 Recovery Time 4 to 100 µs 30 µs RW Num US
03.162 P2 Line Delay Time 0 to 5000 ns RO Num ND NC PT US
03.163 P2 Low Speed Update Rate Active Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
None (0), Hiperface (1),
03.164 P2 Encoder Protocol Detected EnDat2.1 (2), EnDat2.2 (3), RO Txt ND NC PT

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


60 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
BiSS (4)
03.167 P2 User Comms Enable 0 to 1 0 RW Num NC PT
03.168 P2 User Comms Transmit Register 0 to 65535 0 RW Num NC PT
03.169 P2 User Comms Receive Register 0 to 65535 0 RW Num NC PT
03.171 P2 Error Detected Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
None (0), AB (1), FD (2), FR (3),
EnDat (4), SSI (5), BiSS (6),
03.172 P2 Status RO Txt ND NC PT
EnDat Alt (7), SSI Alt (8),
BiSS Alt (9)
03.173 P2 Absolute Turns Recovery Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
03.174 P2 Additional Configuration 0 to 511116116 0 RW Num US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 61
Menu 3 − Speed Control and Position Feedback
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


62 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Normally the units for speed parameters are rpm for both rotary and linear applications. For a linear application one revolution corresponds to one motor
pole. If the position feedback device that is selected for motor control with Motor Control Feedback Select (03.026) is a linear device then if
Linear Speed Select (01.055) is set to 1 the units for speed parameters are mm/s with the following exceptions:

1. All speed parameters are displayed in rpm if sensorless mode is active, i.e. Sensorless Mode Active (03.078) = 1.
2. Speed feedback parameters associated with each feedback interface, i.e. P1 Speed Feedback (03.027) for position feedback interface P1, etc.,
are always displayed in rpm for a rotary device.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 63
Position feedback interfaces

Two position feedback interfaces with associated freeze system are provided. Access to both these interfaces and the encoder simulation output are
provided via one 15 way high density connector. There are limitations on the functions that can be provided simultaneously as shown in the table below
along with the connections required for each combination of functions.

Functions Connections
P1 Position P2 Position Encoder
feedback feedback Simulation 1/2 3/4 5/6 7/8 9/10 11/12 13/14 15
interface interface Output
AB Servo
FD Servo A1 B1 Z1 U1 V1 W1 PS1 Th
FR Servo
SC Servo Cos1 Sin1 Z1 U1 V1 W1 PS1 Th
AB, FD, FR AB, FD, FR A1 B1 Z1 A2 B2 Z2 PS1 Th
AB, FD, FR EnDat, BiSS, SSI A1 B1 Z1 D2 Clk2 Z2 PS1 Th
AB, FD, FR Full A1 B1 Z1 AOut BOut ZOut PS1 Th
SC AB, FD, FR Cos1 Sin1 Z1 A2 B2 Z2 PS1 Th
SC EnDat, BiSS, SSI Cos1 Sin1 Z1 D2 Clk2 Z2 PS1 Th
SC Full Cos1 Sin1 Z1 AOut BOut ZOut PS1 Th
Resolver AB, FD, FR Cos1 Sin1 Ref1 A2 B2 Z2 PS1 Th
Resolver EnDat, BiSS, SSI Cos1 Sin1 Ref1 D2 Clk2 Z2 PS1 Th
Resolver Full Cos1 Sin1 Ref1 AOut BOut ZOut PS1 Th
SC Hiperface AB, FD, FR Cos1 Sin1 D1 A2 B2 Z2 PS1 Th
SC Hiperface EnDat, BiSS, SSI Cos1 Sin1 D1 D2 Clk2 Z2 PS1 Th
SC Hiperface Full Cos1 Sin1 D1 AOut BOut ZOut PS1 Th
AB, FD, FR
SC EnDat, SC
No Z marker Cos1 Sin1 D1 A2 B2 Clk1 PS1 Th
SSI, SC BiSS
pulse
SC EnDat, SC
EnDat, BiSS, SSI Cos1 Sin1 D1 D2 Clk2 Clk1 PS1 Th
SSI, SC BiSS
SC EnDat, SC No Z marker
Cos1 Sin1 D1 AOut BOut Clk1 PS1 Th
SSI, SC BiSS pulse
EnDat, BiSS, SSI AB, FD, FR D1 Clk1 Z1 A2 B2 Z2 PS1 Th
EnDat, BiSS, SSI EnDat, BiSS, SSI D1 Clk1 Z1 D2 Clk2 Z2 PS1 Th
EnDat, BiSS, SSI Full D1 Clk1 Z1 AOut BOut ZOut PS1 Th
No Z marker
EnDat, BiSS, SSI EnDat, BiSS, SSI D1 Clk1 D2 AOut BOut Clk2 PS1 Th
pulse
SC SC Cos1 Sin1 Z1 SCs1 SSn1 Z2 PS1 Th
Commutation
U1 V1 W1 PS1 Th
Only
AB, FD, FR
EnDat Alt,
No Z marker * * D1 A2 B2 Clk1 PS1 Th
SSI Alt, BiSS Alt
pulse
EnDat Alt,
EnDat, BiSS, SSI * * D1 D2 Clk2 Clk1 PS1 Th
SSI Alt, BiSS Alt
EnDat Alt, No Z marker
* * D1 AOut BOut Clk1 PS1 Th
SSI Alt, BiSS Alt pulse

*These inputs are unused. If an SC EnDat, SC SSI or SC BiSS encoder is connected to the P1 interface the sine wave signals from the device will be
connected to these inputs. If EnDat Alt, SSI Alt or BiSS Alt are selected then the position feedback can be derived from the encoder communications
alone and the sine wave signals will be ignored by the drive.

The marker inputs can be used without their associated position feedback as freeze trigger inputs, therefore these are present where possible even if the
associated incremental or SINCOS position feedback is not possible. The table below gives the connection functions associated with the codes used.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


64 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Connection
Connection Definition
Function
Position Interface inputs
A input for AB, or AB Servo encoders
A
F input for FD, FD Servo, FR or FR Servo encoders
B input for AB, or AB Servo encoders
B D input for FD or FD Servo encoders
R input for FR or FR Servo encoders
Z input for AB, AB Servo, FD, FD Servo, FR, FR Servo, SC encoders
Z
Freeze input

Commutation signals for AB Servo, FD Servo, FR Servo, SC Servo or Commutation Only


U, V, W
encoders
Cosine and Sine inputs for SC, SC EnDat, SC BiSS, SC Hiperface, SC SSI or SC Servo
Cos, Sin encoders
Cosine and Sine inputs for resolvers

Ref Reference output for resolvers

Data input/output for SC EnDat, SC BiSS, SC Hiperface, EnDat or BiSS encoders


D
Data input for SC SSI, SSI encoders

Clk Clock output for SC EnDat, SC SSI, EnDat, BiSS or SSI encoders

SCs, SSn Single turn Cosine and Sine signals used to determine the absolute position within one turn

Encoder Simulation Output
A output for AB or AB Lock modes
AOut F output for FD, FD Lock or FR modes
Data output for SSI Gray or SSI Binary modes
B output for AB or AB Lock modes
BOut D output for FD, FD Lock or FR modes
Clock input for SSI Gray or SSI Binary modes

Zout Z output for AB, AB Lock, FD, FD Lock or FR modes

Power Supply and Temperature Measurement

PS1 Power supply output (13 = Supply, 14 = 0V)

Th Temperature measurement input

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 65
P1 Position feedback interface

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


66 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
P2 Position feedback interface

The P2 position feedback interface duplicates most of the parameter structure and functions of the P1 feedback interface. The P2 interface parameters
(03.127 to 03.169) have the same functions as the P1 interface parameters (03.027 to 03.069) except that parameters 03.136, 03.139, 03.162 and 03.163
are not included because the P2 interface does not have its own position feedback power supply, does not support resolvers, and the termination
resistors are not selectable and are always enabled. Also P2 Device type (03.138) has less possible settings because the P2 interface does not support
all the devices supported by the P1 interface.

Priority of the 15-way D-type is assigned in the following order from the highest priority to the lowest.

1. P1 position interface
2. Encoder simulation output
3. P2 position interface

The availability of the P2 position interface on the 15-way D-type on the drive is dependent on type of feedback device selected in P1 Device Type
(03.038) and the encoder simulation mode selected in Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088). P2 Status (03.172) shows the status of the P2 position
interface depending on the settings in P2 Device type (03.138), P1 Device Type (03.038), and Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 67
Position and speed measurement timing

The position information is taken at each current control datum point which is at the start of each current controller task (shown as "I" in the diagram
below). The current controller sample period varies with switching frequency. At each of these datum points the position of the motor within one revolution
is required for basic motor control. The speed controller sample period is 250us for all switching frequencies, and so the speed control datum points
(shown as "S" in the diagram below) occur every 250us. At each of these datum points the full encoder position is obtained and all calculations related to
this are completed. The diagram below shows examples of the datum points for switching frequencies of 12kHz and 16kHz. The internal "I" datum points
are not visible outside the drive control system. The "S" datum points are used to synchronise with option modules.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


68 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Position feedback initialisation

Position feedback devices need to be initialised before they can provide position feedback information. For details of the initialisation required for each
type of device see Position Feedback Initialized (03.076). The user can force all position feedback devices connected directly to the drive or to an option
module to be initialised (see Initialise Position Feedback (03.075)). The drive also automatically initialises all position feedback devices connected to the
drive position feedback interfaces immediately after power-up. An attempt is made to initialise any position feedback device that needs to be initialised
when a drive reset occurs. This would happen inherently if the drive is tripped and the drive is reset to clear the trip.

It should be noted that the initialised bit for any position feedback interface in Position Feedback Initialized (03.076) is set to zero if any of the parameters
given below are changed if they could be used by the position feedback device whether rotary or linear. If the parameter could not be used by the device
then it remains initialised when the parameter is changed. The initialisation bit for a position feedback device is also set to zero if the number of motor
poles parameter for the active motor is changed. If the device becomes uninitialised because of a parameter change then an Encoder 7 trip will occur.

P1 Position feedback interface P2 Position feedback interface


P1 Rotary Turns Bits (03.033) P2 Rotary Turns Bits (03.133)
P1 Rotary Lines Per Revolution (03.034) P2 Rotary Lines Per Revolution (03.134)
P1 Comms Bits (03.035) P2 Comms Bits (03.135)
P1 Comms Baud Rate (03.037) P2 Comms Baud Rate (03.137)
P1 Device Type (03.038)
P1 Error Detection Level (03.040) P2 Error Detection Level (03.140)
(Changing bit 2 only) (Changing bit 2 only)
P1 Auto-configuration Select (03.041) P2 Auto-configuration Select (03.141)
P1 SSI Incremental Mode (03.047) P2 SSI Incremental Mode (03.147)
P1 SSI Binary Mode (03.048) P2 SSI Binary Mode (03.148)
P1 Linear Feedback Select (03.051) P2 Linear Feedback Select (03.151)
P1 Linear Comms Pitch (03.052) P2 Linear Comms Pitch (03.152)
P1 Linear Line Pitch (03.053) P2 Linear Line Pitch (03.153)
P1 Linear Comms And Line Pitch Units (03.054) P2 Linear Comms And Line Pitch Units (03.154)
P1 Pole Pair Pitch (03.055) P2 Pole Pair Pitch (03.155)
P1 Feedback Reverse (03.056) P2 Feedback Reverse (03.156)
P1 Calculation Time (03.060) P2 Calculation Time (03.160)
P1 Recovery Time (03.061) P2 Recovery Time (03.161)
P1 Resolver Poles (03.065)
P1 Resolver Excitation (03.066)
(Except when changed by plus or minus 4)
P1 Absolute Turns Recovery Enable (03.073) P2 Absolute Turns Recovery Enable (03.173)
P1 Additional Configuration (03.074) P2 Additional Configuration (03.174)
P2 Status (03.172)
Motor pole pairs for the currently active motor Motor pole pairs for the currently active motor

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 69
Encoder Simulation Output

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


70 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Freeze System

The drive has two freeze functions that can capture the position from either the P1 or P2 position interface in the drive when a freeze trigger event occurs.
A common freeze logic system is also provided, so that the freeze trigger events can be combined either to trigger the freeze system in the drive or to
generate a freeze trigger for option modules. The freeze system is shown in the diagram below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 71
Position feedback interface thermistor input

Parameter 03.001 Final Speed Reference


Short description Shows the reference at the input to the speed controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED[MAX]
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

Final Speed Reference (03.001) shows the reference at the input to the speed controller, which is the sum of the Post Ramp Reference (02.001) if the
ramp output is not disabled and the hard speed reference (if enabled).

Parameter 03.002 Speed Feedback


Short description Displays the speed feedback from the selected feedback source
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED[MAX]
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

The speed feedback can be selected with Motor Control Feedback Select (03.026) to be taken from either of the drive position feedback interfaces or from
a position feedback interface in a position feedback category option module. It is also possible to selected sensorless speed feedback
with RFC Feedback Mode (03.024). Speed Feedback (03.002) shows the level of the speed feedback selected for the speed controller.

The FI attribute is set for this parameter, so display filtering is active when this parameter is viewed with one of the drive keypads. The value held in the
drive parameter (accessible via comms or an option module) does not include this filter, but is a value that is obtained over a sliding 16ms period to limit
the ripple. The speed feedback includes quantisation ripple given by the following equation in rpm:

Ripple in Speed Feedback (03.002) = 60 / 16ms / Position resolution

The ripple for a linear system is given by the following equation in mm/s:

Ripple in Speed Feedback (03.002) = Pole pitch in mm / 16ms / Position resolution

The position resolution for each type of feedback device is defined in the table below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


72 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Position feedback device Position resolution
AB, AB Servo 4 x lines per revolution or pole pitch

FD, FR, FD Servo, FR Servo 2 x lines per revolution or pole pitch

SC, SC Hiperface, SC EnDat, SC SSI, SC Servo 1024 x sine waves per revolution or pole pitch

EnDat, SSI, BiSS Comms bits per revolution or pole pitch

Resolver See P1 Resolver Excitation (03.066)

For example the ripple in Speed Feedback (03.002) when a 4096 line AB type encoder is used is 0.23rpm. It should be noted that no filtering is
applied to the speed feedback used by the speed controller or for the position feedback reference system unless the feedback filter for that
particular interface is activated by putting a non-zero value in the appropriate set up parameter (i.e. P1 Feedback Filter (03.042) for the P1 drive
position feedback interface). The diagram below shows the filtering applied to the speed feedback when this is taken from the P1 drive position
feedback interface.

The speed feedback ripple seen by the speed controller and the position feedback reference is given by the following equations when the filter set up
value P1 Feedback Filter (03.042) = 0.

Ripple for a rotary system in rpm = 60 / Speed controller sample time / Position resolution

Ripple for a linear system in mm/s = Pole pitch in mm / Speed controller sample time / Position resolution

The speed controller sample time is 250µs. If the filter set up value is non-zero the ripple is given by:

Ripple for a rotary system in rpm = 60 / Filter time / Position resolution

Ripple for a linear system in mm/s = Pole pitch in mm / Filter time / Position resolution

The description so far covers the P1 drive position feedback interface. Similar filtering is provided with the P2 drive position feedback interface and with
position feedback interfaces in position feedback category option modules.

It is not advisable to use the speed feedback filter unless it is specifically required for high inertia applications with high controller gains, or if commutation
signals alone are used for feedback, because the filter has a non-linear transfer function. It is preferable to use the current demand filters
(Current Reference Filter 1 Time Constant (04.012) or Current Reference Filter 2 Time Constant (04.023)) as these are linear first order filters that provide
filtering on noise generated from both the speed reference and the speed feedback. It should be noted that any filtering included within the speed
controller feedback loop, either on the speed feedback or the current demand, introduces a delay and limits the maximum bandwidth of the controller for
stable operation.

The speed ripple seen by the speed controller can be quite high in some cases, for example with a 4096 line encoder the speed ripple is 14.6rpm with a
sample time of 250µs. This causes high frequency torque ripple and acoustic motor noise. These effects increase with the level of speed feedback ripple
and with the gains used in the speed controller. Therefore high speed feedback ripple usually limits the maximum possible gain settings for the speed
controller, and so a position feedback device with high position resolution is usually required for a system with high dynamic performance or stiffness. It
should be noted that the ripple caused by feedback quantisation and does not define speed feedback resolution. The speed controller
accumulates all pulses from the position feedback, and so the speed controller resolution is not limited by the feedback, but by the resolution
of the speed reference.

Parameter 03.003 Speed Error


Short description Displays the difference betweent the Final Speed Reference and the Speed Feedback
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED[MAX]
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

The speed error is the difference between the final Final Speed Reference (03.001) and the Speed Feedback (03.002), and does not include the effect of
the differential term in the speed controller feedback branch.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 73
Parameter 03.004 Speed Controller Output
Short description Displays the output from the speed controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MIN] Maximum VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MAX]
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

The output of the speed regulator is a torque demand given as a percentage of rated motor torque. It should be noted that this will be modified to take into
account in the level of motor flux if field weakening is active before it is converted into the Final Current Reference (04.004).

Parameter 03.005 Zero Speed Threshold


Short description Set to the required zero speed threshold
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 200
Default 5 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

If the Speed Feedback (03.002) is at or below the level defined by this parameter in either direction Zero Speed (10.003) = 1, otherwise Zero Speed
(10.003) = 0.

Parameter 03.006 At Speed Lower Limit


Short description Set to the required minimum at speed threshold
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 33000
Default 5 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

At Speed (10.006) is set if the Speed Feedback (03.002) is on the boundaries or within the at speed window. Above Set Speed (10.007) and
Below Set Speed (10.005) are set if the feedback is above or below the window respectively.

If Absolute At Speed Select (03.009) = 0 reference window mode is used.


The "at speed" condition is true if,

(|Pre-ramp Reference (01.003)| - At Speed Lower Limit (03.006)) ≤ |Speed Feedback (03.002)| ≤ (|Pre-ramp Reference (01.003)|


+ At Speed Upper Limit (03.007))

(If the lower limit is less than zero then zero is used as the lower limit.)

If Absolute At Speed Select (03.009) = 1 absolute window mode is used.


The "at speed" condition is true if,

At Speed Lower Limit (03.006) ≤ |Speed Feedback (03.002)| ≤ At Speed Upper Limit (03.007)

Parameter 03.007 At Speed Upper Limit


Short description Set to the required maximum at speed threshold
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 33000
Default 5 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

See At Speed Lower Limit (03.006).

Parameter 03.008 Over Speed Threshold


Short description Set to the required over speed threshold
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 33000
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

If Over Speed Threshold (03.008) is set to a non-zero value it defines the over speed threshold. If the Speed Feedback (03.002) exceeds this threshold in

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


74 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
either direction an Over Speed trip is produced. If Over Speed Threshold (03.008) is set to 0.0 the threshold is based on the variable minimum/maximum
for the references and is equal to 1.2 x VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX].

Parameter 03.009 Absolute At Speed Select


Short description Indicates when the motor is running at speed
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See At Speed Lower Limit (03.006).

Parameter 03.010 Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1


Short description Defines the proportional gain for the speed controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0000 Maximum 200.0000
Default 0.0300 Units s/rad
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW

The diagram below shows a generalised representation of the speed controller. The controller includes a feed forward proportional gain (Kp), a feed
forward integral gain (Ki), and a differential feedback gain (Kd). The description here refers to the first set of gains for motor map 1
(Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010), Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1 (03.011) and Speed Controller Differential Feedback Gain Kd1
(03.012)). See Speed Controller Gain Select (03.016) on how to select a different set of gains.

Proportional gain (Kp) - Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010)


If Kp is non-zero and Ki is zero the controller will only have a proportional term, and there must be a speed error to produce a torque reference. Therefore,
as the motor load increases there will be a difference between the reference and actual speeds. This effect, called regulation, depends on the level of the
proportional gain, the higher the gain the smaller the speed error for a given load. If the proportional gain is too high either the acoustic noise produced
due to speed feedback quantisation becomes unacceptable, or the closed-loop stability limit is reached.

Integral gain (Ki) - Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1 (03.011)


The integral gain is provided to prevent speed regulation. The error is accumulated over a period of time and used to produce the necessary torque
reference without any speed error. Increasing the integral gain reduces the time taken for the speed to reach the correct level and increases the stiffness
of the system, i.e. it reduces the positional displacement produced by applying a load torque to the motor. Unfortunately increasing the integral gain also
reduces the system damping giving overshoot after a transient. For a given integral gain the damping can be improved by increasing the proportional
gain. A compromise must be reached where the system response, stiffness and damping are all adequate for the application. The integral term is
implemented in the form of ∑(Ki x error), and so the integral gain can be changed when the controller is active without causing large transients on the
torque reference.

Differential gain (Kd) - Speed Controller Differential Feedback Gain Kd1 (03.012)


The differential gain is provided in the feedback of the speed controller to give additional damping. The differential term is implemented in a way that does
not introduce excessive noise normally associated with this type of function. Increasing the differential term reduces the overshoot produced by under-
damping, however for most applications the proportional and integral gains alone are sufficient. It should be noted that the differential term is limited
internally so that it is ineffective if speed in rpm x Kd x Ki is greater than 170.

To analyse the performance of the speed controller it may be represented as an s-domain model as shown below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 75
Kc' is the conversion between the speed controller output and the torque producing current reference. A value of unity at the output of the speed controller
gives a torque producing current equal to Kc'. The drive automatically compensates the torque producing current reference for flux variations in field
weakening, and so Kc' can be assumed to have a constant value even in field weakening. Kc' = Full Scale Current Kc (11.061) x 0.45.

Kt is the torque constant of the motor (i.e. torque in Nm per amp of torque producing current). This value is normally available from the manufacturer for a
permanent magnet motor, however, for induction motors the value must be calculated from the motor parameters. In RFC-A mode this calculation is
performed by the drive and the result is stored in Torque Per Amp (05.032)

L(s) is the transfer function of the load.

The speed controller calculations are provided for a rotary application. However, for a linear application it is possible to set Torque Per Amp (05.032) to
the force per amp and the Motor And Load Inertia (03.018) to the mass, and all the rotary system equations still apply.

It should be noted that the gain levels are compatible with those in Unidrive SP. The internal resolution of the intergral gain parameter is twice that of
Unidrive SP. In most applications this makes no difference to the performance, however, with Unidrive SP the internal value is zero (the integral term
disabled) if the user parameter is less than 0.05. In Unidrive M the internal integral gain would be zero if Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1 (03.011) is
less than 0.03. However, if Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1 (03.011) is non-zero and less than 0.03 (i.e. 0.01 or 0.02) the internal value is one, so that
the integral term remains active, unless the user deliberately disables this term by setting Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1 (03.011) to zero.

Parameter 03.011 Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1


Short description Defines the integral gain for the speed controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 655.35
Default 0.10 Units s²/rad
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW, BU

See Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010).

Parameter 03.012 Speed Controller Differential Feedback Gain Kd1


Short description Defines the differential gain for the speed controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00000 Maximum 0.65535
Default 0.00000 Units 1/rad
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 5
Coding RW, BU

See Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010).

Parameter 03.013 Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp2


Short description Defines a 2nd proportional gain for the speed controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0000 Maximum 200.0000
Default 0.0300 Units s/rad
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW

See Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


76 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 03.014 Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki2
Short description Defines a 2nd integral gain for the speed controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 655.35
Default 0.10 Units s²/rad
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW, BU

See Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010).

Parameter 03.015 Speed Controller Differential Feedback Gain Kd2


Short description Defines a 2nd differential gain for the speed controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00000 Maximum 0.65535
Default 0.00000 Units 1/rad
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 5
Coding RW, BU

See Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010).

Parameter 03.016 Speed Controller Gain Select


Short description Set to 1 to enable the 2nd set of speed controller proportional, integral and differential gains
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If Speed Controller Gain Select (03.016) = 0 then Kp1, Ki1 and Kd1 are used as the speed controller gains. These gains are given by
Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010), Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1 (03.011) and Speed Controller Differential Feedback Gain Kd1
(03.012) if motor map 1 is selected (i.e. Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 0), or M2 Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (21.017),
M2 Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1 (21.018) and M2 Speed Controller Differential Feedback Gain Kd1 (21.019) if motor map 2 is selected (i.e.
Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 1). If Speed Controller Gain Select (03.016) = 1 then Kp2, Ki2 and Kd2 are used as the speed controller gains.
These gains are given by Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp2 (03.013), Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki2 (03.014) and
Speed Controller Differential Feedback Gain Kd2 (03.015). When Speed Controller Gain Select (03.016) is changed the gains are changed smoothly
between the old and new values over a period of 250ms. This allows the system gains to be switched between two different sets of values without causing
significant torque transients.

Parameter 03.017 Speed Controller Set-up Method


Short description Defines how the speed controller gains are set up or are automatically calculated
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 7
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 1s read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Disabled
1 Bandwidth
2 Comp Angle
3 Kp Gain Times 16
4 Low Performance
5 Std Performance
6 High Performance
7 First Order

0: Disabled
When Speed Controller Set-up Method (03.017) is at its default value of 0, its functions are disabled and it has no effect.

1: Bandwidth set-up
If the load is predominantly a constant inertia and constant torque, the drive can calculate the required speed loop gain values, provided
the Motor And Load Inertia (03.018) and the Torque Per Amp (05.032) are set-up correctly. If Speed Controller Set-up Method (03.017) = 1 the gain
values are calculated to give the required Bandwidth (03.020) and Damping Factor (03.021). The calculated values for Kp and Ki are written
to Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010) and Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1 (03.011) once per second.
The Speed Controller Differential Feedback Gain Kd1 (03.012) is not affected. The gains are calculated from a linear model assuming a pure inertia load,
not including unwanted delays in the speed and current controllers. The following equations are used by the drive to calculate the gains.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 77
Ki = J / (Kc' x Kt) x (2π x ωbw / Kbw)2

Kp = 2 ξ √[ (Ki x J) / (Kc' x Kt) ]

where:
Kc' = Full Scale Current Kc (11.061) x 0.45
J = Motor And Load Inertia (03.018)
Kt = Torque Per Amp (05.032)
ωbw = Bandwidth (03.020)
ξ = Damping Factor (03.021)
Kwb = √[ (2ξ2 + 1) +√( (2ξ2 + 1)2 + 1) ]

2: Compliance angle set-up


If Speed Controller Set-up Method (03.017) = 2 the speed controller gains are set up based on the required Compliance Angle (03.019) and
Damping Factor (03.021)
based on the following equations.

Ki = 1 / αcomp(rs-1)

Kp = 2 ξ √[ (Ki x J) / (Kc' x Kt) ]

where:
Kc' = Full Scale Current Kc (11.061) x 0.45
J = Motor And Load Inertia (03.018)
Kt = Torque Per Amp (05.032)
αcomp = Compliance Angle (03.019)
ξ = Damping Factor (03.021)

3: Kp gain times 16
If Speed Controller Set-up Method (03.017) = 3 the selected proportional gain used by the drive is multiplied by 16. This feature was provided in Unidrive
SP because the range of the proportional gain parameters was limited. The range has now been increased to allow higher gains to be selected, and so
this feature is no longer necessary, but is provided for compatibility with Unidrive SP. It should be noted that if this feature is used the value of gain used
by the speed controller (i.e. Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010) x 16) is limited internally to the maximum for
Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010).

4-6: Low, Standard or High performance


If Speed Controller Set-up Method (03.017) is set to a value from 4 to 6 the Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010)
and Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1 (03.011) are automatically set up to give the bandwidths given in the table below and a damping factor of unity.
These settings give low, standard or high performance.

Speed Controller Set-up Method (03.017) Performance Bandwidth

4 Low 5Hz

5 Standard 25Hz

6 High 100Hz

7: First order characteristic


If Speed Controller Set-up Method (03.017) = 7 then Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010), Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1 (03.011) and
Speed Controller Differential Feedback Gain Kd1 (03.012) are set up to give a closed-loop speed controller response that approximates to a first order
system with a transfer function of 1 / (sτ + 1), where τ = 1/ωbw and ωbw = 2π x Bandwidth (03.020). In this case the damping factor is meaningless, and
Damping Factor (03.021) and Compliance Angle (03.019) have no effect. The following equations are used by the drive to calculate the gains.

Ki = J / (Kc' x Kt) x (2π x ωbw / 2)2

Kp = 2 √[ (Ki x J) / (Kc' x Kt) ]

Kd = Kp / 4Ki

where:
Kc' = Full Scale Current Kc (11.061) x 0.45
J = Motor And Load Inertia (03.018)
Kt = Torque Per Amp (05.032)
ωbw = Bandwidth (03.020)

Parameter 03.018 Motor And Load Inertia


Short description Defines the inertia of the motor and the load for use in calculating the speed controller gains
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00000 Maximum 1000.00000
Default 0.00000 Units kgm²
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 1s read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 5
Coding RW

The Motor And Load Inertia (03.018) represents the total inertia driven by the motor. This is used to set the speed controller

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


78 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
gains (see Speed Controller Set-up Method (03.017)) and to provide torque feed forwards during acceleration when required (see Torque Mode Selector
(04.011)).

It is possible to measure the inertia as part of the auto-tune process (see Auto-tune (05.012)).

Parameter 03.019 Compliance Angle


Defines the required angular displacement when the drive delivers a torque producing current
Short description
equivalent to drive rated current
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 360.0
Default 4.0 Units °
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 1s read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

The Compliance Angle (03.019) is the required angular displacement when the drive delivers a torque producing current equivalent to Kc',
i.e. Full Scale Current Kc (11.061) x 0.45, with no field weakening. The value of this parameter is used to automatically determine the speed controller
gains if required. See Speed Controller Set-up Method (03.017).

Parameter 03.020 Bandwidth


Defines the theoretical 3dB point on the closed-loop gain characteristic of the speed controller as a
Short description
second order system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 1000
Default 10 Units Hz
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 1s read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The Bandwidth (03.020) is defined as the theoretical 3dB point on the closed-loop gain characteristic of the speed controller as a second order system. At
this point the phase shift is approximately 60°. The value of Bandwidth (03.020) is used to automatically determine the speed controller gains if required.
See Speed Controller Set-up Method (03.017).

Parameter 03.021 Damping Factor


Short description Defines the factor for the response of the system to a torque transient
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 10.0
Default 1.0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 1s read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

Damping Factor (03.021) defines this factor for the response of the system to a torque transient, and so if the Damping Factor (03.021) is unity, the
response to a load torque transient is critically damped. The closed-loop step response of the speed controller gives approximately 10% overshoot with
unity damping factor. Damping Factor (03.021) is used to automatically determine the speed controller gains if required. See Speed Controller Set-
up Method (03.017).

Parameter 03.022 Hard Speed Reference


Short description Defines a speed reference value which does not pass through the ramp system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 250µs read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

The Hard Speed Reference (03.022) is a reference value which does not pass through the ramp system, but is added directly to
the Post Ramp Reference (02.001).The Hard Speed Reference (03.022) is only added when selected by the Hard Speed Reference Select (03.023) and
the Reference On (01.011) is active.

Parameter 03.023 Hard Speed Reference Select


Short description Set to 1 to enable the use of the hard speed reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Hard Speed Reference (03.022).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 79
Parameter 03.024 RFC Feedback Mode
Short description Defines the method of feedback used for the speed controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Feedback
1 Sensorless
2 Feedback NoMax
3 Sensorless NoMax

RFC Feedback Mode (03.024), which can be changed even when the motor is running, selects the feedback method used to provide position feedback to
control the motor. The actual feedback method being used at any time is given by Sensorless Mode Active (03.078). When sensorless mode is used, a
filter with a 4ms time constant is automatically included in the speed feedback as this is required for this system to operate correctly. The possible speed
controller bandwidth will be reduced by a factor of approximately 10 compared with the bandwidth possible with a position feedback device. The maximum
and minimum for the speed references are limited by the VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP variable minimum/maximum which prevents the speed from
exceeding the level where the position feedback cannot be interpreted correctly. This limit is disabled if RFC Feedback Mode (03.024) is 2 or 3, so that it
is possible to change between operation with or without position feedback if the speed range needs to be extended beyond the limit of the position
feedback device. Care should be taken not to exceed a speed that would damage the position feedback device.

0: Position feedback
RFC mode is active using the position feedback selected Motor Control Feedback Select (03.026) to control the motor.

1: Sensorless
RFC mode using a sensorless algorithm to provide position feedback, is used to control the motor.

2: Position feedback with no maximum speed limit


RFC mode with position feedback selected with Motor Control Feedback Select (03.026)) is used to control the motor. The maximum reference limit is
disabled.

3: Sensorless with no maximum speed limit


RFC mode using a sensorless algorithm to provide position feedback, is used to control the motor. The maximum reference limit is disabled.

It should be noted that when sensorless mode is active the maximum torque that can be produced at low speeds (i.e. < 2% or rated speed) is reduced.

Parameter 03.026 Motor Control Feedback Select


Short description Defines the source of position feedback
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 7
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 P1 Drive
1 P2 Drive
2 P1 Slot1
3 P2 Slot1
4 P1 Slot2
5 P2 Slot2
6 P1 Slot3
7 P2 Slot3

Motor Control Feedback Select (03.026) should be used to select the position feedback interface for motor control. If the feedback interface does not exist
then the drive will produce an Encoder 9 trip if it is enabled. Note that if RFC Feedback Mode (03.024) is set to 1 or 3 to select sensorless control then this
trip is suppressed.

Parameter 03.027 P1 Speed Feedback


Short description Displays the speed feedback from device P1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED[MAX]
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

Provided the set-up parameters for the position feedback device connected to the drive P1 position interface are correct P1 Speed Feedback (03.027)
shows the speed derived from the feedback. The speed is given in mm/s if P1 Linear Feedback Select (03.051) = 1 and Linear Speed Select (01.055) = 1,

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


80 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
otherwise it is given in rpm. The value shown is measured over a 16ms sliding window period, and so the ripple in this value is as defined
for Speed Feedback (03.002).

Parameter 03.028 P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter


Short description Displays the revolution/pole pitch counter from device P1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028), P1 Position (03.029) and P1 Fine Position (03.030) combined give the encoder position with a resolution of
1/232 of a revolution/pole pitch as a 48 bit number. If a rotary position feedback device is being used (P1 Linear Feedback Select (03.051) = 0) then these
quantities relate directly to the rotary position of the feedback device. If a linear feedback device is used then one revolution or pole pitch relates to the
distance given by P1 Pole Pair Pitch (03.055).

Provided the position feedback interface set-up parameters are correct, the position is always converted to units of 1/2 32 of a revolution/pole pitch, but
some parts of the value may not be relevant depending on the resolution of the feedback device. For example a 1024 line digital encoder produces 4096
counts per revolution, and so the position is represented by the bits in the shaded area only.

When the position feedback moves by more than one revolution or pole pitch the P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028) increments or decrements in
the form of a sixteen bit roll-over counter. If an absolute position feedback device (except AB Servo, FD Servo, FR Servo, SC Servo) is used the position
is initialised at power-up and each time the encoder is subsequently initialised with the absolute position including the revolution count if a multi-turn
absolute rotary encoder is used, or the pole pitch count if an absolute linear encoder is used. To avoid showing turns values that are outside the range of
the encoder any bits beyond the turns information are normally masked. For example, if the encoder provides 12 bits of turns information, then the most
significant 4 bits of the revolutions are always zero. If a single turn encoder is used all the bits of the revolutions are zero. To remove this masking
P1 Absolute Turns Recovery Enable (03.073) should be set to one. In addition to removing the mask, the extended turns value is retained on power-down
and will be recovered on power-up. See P1 Absolute Turns Recovery Enable (03.073) for more details.

The position interface parameter descriptions cover rotary and linear applications, but the revolutions or pole pitches are always referred to as turns.

Parameter 03.029 P1 Position


Short description Displays the position feedback from device P1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

See P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028).

Parameter 03.030 P1 Fine Position


Short description Displays the fine position feedback from device P1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

See P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028).

Parameter 03.031 P1 Marker Mode


Short description Defines the marker mode for device P1
Mode RFC‑A
0 15
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0000) (Display: 1111)
4
Default Units
(Display: 0100)
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P1 Device Type (03.038): AB, FD, FR, AB Servo, FD Servo, FR Servo

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 81
Each position feedback device produces incremental signals which are counted in hardware. If P1 Marker Mode (03.031) = 0 the following occurs when a
marker event is produced by the Z1 input:

1. P1 Position (03.029) and P1 Fine Position (03.030) are reset to zero.


2. The bits in P1 Normalised Position (03.058) related to P1 Position (03.029) and P1 Fine Position (03.030) are reset to zero
3. P1 Marker Flag (03.032) is set to one.

The marker is a hardware function, and so the position appears as though it is reset at the marker event time even if this is between control system
sample points. It should be noted that the marker event occurs on the rising edge of the marker pulse if the position change over the last sample was
positive or on the falling edge if the position change over the last sample was negative. This ensures that the marker event occurs at the same physical
location for either direction of rotation.

The action taken when a marker event occurs can be modified by setting the bits of P1 Marker Mode (03.031) as described in the table below.

Bit Effect of setting bit to one

0 No action is taken unless the marker flag is zero before the marker event occurs

P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028) and the whole of P1 Normalised Position (03.058) are also set to
1
zero on a marker event

P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028), P1 Position (03.029), P1 Fine Position (03.030) and the related


part of P1 Normalised Position (03.058) are not reset. (This overrides bit 1.) P1 Normalised Position
2
(03.058) is transferred to P1 Normalised Marker Position (03.059) and P1 Marker Flag (03.032) is set to
one.

If this bit is 0 the state of the marker is only undefined when the differential input is in the range from -200mV
to 200mV. The marker pulse is only guaranteed to be recognised if it is at least 500ns wide. This setting is
used for most encoders with standard level marker pulses.

3 If this bit is set to 1 the undefined state region is reduced to the range from -30mV to 30mV. The marker
pulse is only guaranteed to be recognised if it is at least 10us wide. The smaller undefined region is required
for position feedback devices that produce a small marker pulse, such as the Heidenhain ERN1387
encoder. Note that the reduced undefined region is only provided for position feedback interface P1 and that
this bit in P2 Marker Mode (03.131) has no effect.

The marker input can be used for a standard type marker function or alternatively it can be used as an additional freeze input for the P1 position feedback
interface.

P1 Device Type (03.038): SC, SC Servo, SC SC


The marker function operates in the same way as for the digital incremental encoders. The resolution of the marker actions is only as accurate as the zero
crossings of the sine waves. The marker is used with an SC SC type device to trim the absolute position derived from the single sine wave per turn
channels once after initialisation. Until this is done (i.e. the marker has been active once after initialisation) marker events will not be registered.

P1 Device Type (03.038): Any other device type


The marker function cannot be used and P1 Marker Mode (03.031) has no effect.

Parameter 03.032 P1 Marker Flag


Short description Indicates when a marker event occurs
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

P1 Marker Flag (03.032) is set to one when a marker event occurs. The flag must be cleared by the user.

Parameter 03.033 P1 Rotary Turns Bits


Short description Defines the number of rotary turns bits for device P1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 16
Default 16 Units
Background read, auto-configuration
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P1 Rotary Turns Bits (03.033) normally only has any effect if the position feedback interface is being used with a rotary device
(i.e. P1 Linear Feedback Select (03.051) = 0).

P1 Device Type (03.038): SC Hiperface, SC EnDat, SC SSI, EnDat, BISS, SSI, SC BiSS
P1 Rotary Turns Bits (03.033) is used to determine the number of bits within the comms messages from the position feedback device that represent turns.
For a single turn encoder P1 Rotary Turns Bits (03.033) must be set to zero. The most significant bits in P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028) that
are not included in the turns information provided by the encoder comms are held at zero. If P1 Rotary Turns Bits (03.033) = 0 (single turn encoder) the
whole of P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028) is held at zero. The number of bits of position information within one revolution for a rotary device are

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


82 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
calculated from P1 Rotary Turns Bits (03.033) and P1 Comms Bits (03.035). If the resulting value is greater than 32 it is limited to 32.

Some SSI encoders include leading zeros before the turns information and in this case the number of turns bits should include the leading zeros. Some
BiSS encoders include zero padding either before or after the turns information (see P1 Additional Configuration (03.074)). P1 Rotary Turns Bits
(03.033) should include the actual turns bits and the additional padding.

P1 Device Type (03.038): Any other device type


It is sometimes desirable to mask off the most significant bits of P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028), but this does not have to be done for the drive
to function correctly. If P1 Rotary Turns Bits (03.033) = 0 the whole of P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028) is held at zero. If P1 Rotary Turns Bits
(03.033) has any other value it indicates the number of bits in P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028) that are not held at zero. For example, if
P1 Rotary Turns Bits (03.033) = 5, then P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028) counts up to 31 before being reset.

The description above is for normal operation when P1 Absolute Turns Recovery Enable (03.073) = 0. If P1 Absolute Turns Recovery Enable (03.073) = 1
no masking is applied to P1 Rotary Turns Bits (03.033), and so a 16 bit value is always shown.

Parameter 03.034 P1 Rotary Lines Per Revolution


Short description Defines the number of rotary lines per revolution for device P1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 100000
Default 1024 Units
Background read, auto-configuration
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P1 Rotary Lines Per Revolution (03.034) only has any effect if the position feedback interface is being used with a rotary device (i.e.
P1 Linear Feedback Select (03.051) = 0).

P1 Device Type (03.038): AB, AB Servo


P1 Rotary Lines Per Revolution (03.034) should be set to the number of lines per revolution for the encoder connected to the P1 position feedback
interface.

P1 Device Type (03.038): FD, FR, FD Servo, FR Servo


P1 Rotary Lines Per Revolution (03.034) should be set to the number of lines per revolution for the encoder connected to the P1 position feedback
interface divided by 2.

P1 Device Type (03.038): SC, SC Servo, SC Hiperface, SC EnDat, SC SSI, SC SC, SC BiSS
P1 Rotary Lines Per Revolution (03.034) should be set to the number of sine waves per revolution for the encoder connected to the P1 position feedback
interface.

P1 Device Type (03.038): Any other device type


P1 Rotary Lines Per Revolution (03.034) has no effect.

Parameter 03.035 P1 Comms Bits


Defines the total number of bits of position information in the comms message from the encoder for
Short description
device P1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 48
Default 0 Units
Background read, auto-configuration
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P1 Device Type (03.038): SC Hiperface, EnDat, SC EnDat


Total number of bits of position information in the comms message from the encoder.

P1 Device Type (03.038): SSI, SC.SSI


Total number of bits of position information in the comms message from the encoder including any leading or trailing zeros and the power supply alarm bit
if present.

P1 Device Type (03.038): BiSS, SC BiSS


Total number of bits of position information in the comms message from the encoder excluding the warning and error bits. It is always assumed there is
one warning bit and one error bit. The length of the position information includes any zero padding that is included by the encoder. The CRC is applied to
the whole message including the error (/E) and warning (/W) bits. The warning bit is ignored, but if the error bit is low then an Encoder 6 trip is initiated.

P1 Device Type (03.038): Any other device type


P1 Comms Bits (03.035) has no effect.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 83
Parameter 03.036 P1 Supply Voltage
Short description Defines the supply voltage output for device P1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 5V
1 8V
2 15V

P1 Supply Voltage (03.036) sets the level for the supply voltage output. To ensure that the maximum voltage for the position feedback device is not
accidentally exceeded, the device should be disconnected from the drive when the level is being adjusted.

Parameter 03.037 P1 Comms Baud Rate


Short description Defines the baud rate used for encoder communications
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 8
Default 2 Units Baud
Background read, Auto-configuration
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 100k
1 200k
2 300k
3 400k
4 500k
5 1M
6 1.5M
7 2M
8 4M

P1 Comms Baud Rate (03.037) defines the baud rate used for encoder communications. Restrictions are applied to the baud rate for different feedback
devices, and so the baud rate may be different to the parameter value.

P1 Device Type (03.038): SC.Hiperface


A fixed baud rate of 9600 baud is always used with this type of encoder so P1 Comms Baud Rate (03.037) has no effect.

P1 Device Type (03.038): SC.SSI, SC EnDat, SC BiSS


Any baud rate that is within the range specified for the encoder may be used. The data from the encoder is not used for time critical functions, and so it is
recommended that the default value of 300k baud is used unless this needs to be reduced because of a limitation imposed by the encoder.

P1 Device Type (03.038): EnDat, BiSS, SSI


Any baud rate that is within the range specified for the encoder may be used. The line delay is measured during initialisation, and used to compensate this
delay during communications with the encoder. Therefore there is no timing based restriction on the length of the cable between the position feedback
interface and the encoder. However, care should be taken to ensure that the wiring arrangement and the type of cable used are suitable for the selected
baud rate and the distance between the position interface and the encoder. See P1 Low Speed Update Rate Active (03.063) for more details on timing
restrictions related to the drive sample times.

P1 Device Type (03.038): Any other device


P1 Comms Baud Rate (03.037) has no effect.

Parameter 03.038 P1 Device Type


Short description Defines the device type connected to the drive P1 position feedback interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 20
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


84 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Value Text
0 AB
1 FD
2 FR
3 AB Servo
4 FD Servo
5 FR Servo
6 SC
7 SC Hiperface
8 EnDat
9 SC EnDat
10 SSI
11 SC SSI
12 SC Servo
13 BiSS
14 Resolver
15 SC SC
16 Commutation Only
17 SC BiSS
18 EnDat Alt
19 SSI Alt
20 BiSS Alt

P1 Device Type (03.038) should be set up to match the device connected to the drive P1 position feedback interface. The table below gives the position
feedback types supported by the P1 position feedback interface.

P1 Device Type
Signals Position feedback type Communications
(03.038)
0: AB Quadrature Incremental None
1: FD Frequency and direction Incremental None
2: FR Forward and reverse Incremental None
Absolute commutation signals
3: AB Servo Quadrature and commutation None
with incremental
Absolute commutation signals
4: FD Servo Frequency and direction, and commutation None
with incremental
Absolute commutation signals
5: FR Servo Forward and reverse, and commutation None
with incremental
6: SC SINCOS Incremental SINCOS None
Absolute comms with
7: SC Hiperface SINCOS and Hiperface comms Hiperface
incremental SINCOS
EnDat 2.1
8: EnDat EnDat comms Absolute comms
EnDat 2.2
Absolute comms with
9: SC EnDat SINCOS and EnDat comms EnDat 2.1
incremental SINCOS
10: SSI SSI comms Absolute comms SSI
Absolute comms with
11: SC SSI SINCOS and SSI comms SSI
incremental SINCOS
Absolute commutation signals
12: SC Servo SINCOS and commutation None
with incremental
13: BiSS BiSS comms Absolute comms BiSS
14: Resolver Resolver Resolver None
SINCOS with absolute position
SINCOS and single sine and cosine signals
15: SC SC from single sine and cosine None
per revolution
signals
Absolute commutation signals
16: Commutation Only Commutation only None
only
Absolute comms with
17: SC BiSS BiSS comms BiSS
incremental SINCOS
EnDat comms only, but connected to the
EnDat 2.1
18: EnDat Alt same comms connections as an SC EnDat Absolute comms
EnDat 2.2
device
SSI comms only, but connected to the same
19: SSI Alt Absolute comms SSI
comms connections as an SC SSI device
BiSS comms only, but connected to the
20: BiSS Alt same comms connections as an SC BiSS Absolute comms BiSS
device

Position feedback type:

Incremental
Position devices that provide incremental feedback do not give absolute position feedback. The position is zero at power-up and accumulates the change
of position from that point on. These devices are suitable for motor control in RFC-A mode. They can also be used for RFC-S mode, but some form of
phasing auto-tune is required each time the position feedback is initialised.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 85
Absolute commutation signals with incremental
Position devices with commutations signals are intended to provide absolute position feedback for motor control in RFC-S mode. If one of these devices is
used for RFC-A mode the commutation signals are ignored. The position information given in P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028), P1 Position
(03.029) and P1 Fine Position (03.030) appears as though the position feedback device is an incremental type in that it is initialised to zero at power-up
and then accumulates the change of position from that point on. The commutation signals are used directly by the motor control algorithms in RFC-S
mode to determine the motor position after position feedback initialisation. There must be one period of the commutation signals for each pole pair for a
rotary motor (i.e. 3 commutation signal periods per revolution for a 6 pole motor), or one period of the commutation signals must be equal to the motor
pole pitch for a linear motor. It should be noted that for a movement of up to 1/3 of the commutation signal period after position feedback initialisation the
maximum motor torque is limited to 0.866 of the maximum possible torque.

Absolute commutation signals only


Position devices with commutations signals are intended to provide absolute position feedback for motor control in RFC-S mode but can also be used to
provide position feedback for motor control in RFC-A mode. The position is derived from the commutation signals alone. A phase locked loop is used to
smooth the feedback, but this introduces a delay and there is significant ripple in the position and speed feedback at low speeds. If this method is used for
motor control then low speed loop gains should be used and P1 Feedback Filter (03.042) should be used to filter the feedback.

Incremental SINCOS
An incremental SINCOS encoder can be used in the same way as an AB incremental encoder, except that the position resolution is increased with
interpolation. These devices are suitable for motor control in RFC-A mode. They can also be used for RFC-S mode, but some form of phasing auto-tune
is required each time the position feedback is initialised. The increase in resolution due to interpolation depends on the magnitude and frequency of the
sine wave signals at the position feedback interface inputs on the drive. The sine wave inputs take balanced signals each with a nominal 1V peak to peak
level. (This means that the difference measured between the two signals for one sine wave input would be 2V peak to peak or 1V peak.) If interpolation
is not used the position feedback would have a resolution related to the number of sine waves per revolution (i.e. 512 sine waves per revolution would
give position feedback resolution equivalent to a 512 line incremental encoder, which gives 2048 discernible positions per revolution). With the nominal
signal level and an input frequency below 5kHz the interpolation using sine waves instead of digital incremental signals increases the resolution by a
factor of 900. For a 512 sine wave encoder this would give a resolution of 512 x 4 x 900 = 1843200 discernible positions per revolution. This is equivalent
to a digital incremental encoder with 460800 lines per revolution.The increased resolution due to interpolation is directly proportional to the sine wave
signal voltage levels, and also reduces with sine wave signal frequency. The resolution is given by

Resolution = P1 Rotary Lines Per Revolution (03.034) x 4 x 900 x Vpeak to peak of the sine wave signals x Frequency Factor

where the frequency factor is given below.

1kHz 5kHz 50kHz 100kHz 200kHz 500kHz


1.00 1.00 0.86 0.66 0.39 0.14

Increasing the sine wave signal level above 1V peak to peak will increase the resolution, but the level should not be increased above 1.5V or else the
input will saturate and the sine waves will be distorted.

Absolute comms with incremental SINCOS


The absolute position is obtained after position feedback initialisation via the comms interface and then after that point by tracking the incremental change
from the sine wave signals. Interpolation is used to increase the position resolution. The comms interface can be used to check the position derived from
the sine waves. It can also be used for bi-direction transfer of data between the drive and encoder (except SSI comms). These devices can be used for
motor control in RFC-A or RFC-S modes.

Absolute comms
The absolute position is obtained at all times via the encoder comms. The comms interface can also be used for bi-directional transfer of data between
the drive and the encoder (except SSI mode). These devices can be used for motor control in RFC-A or RFC-S modes.

Resolver
A resolver can be used to provide absolute position feedback within the range covered by one electrical revolution of the resolver (i.e. 360° mechanical for
a 2 pole device, 180° mechanical for a 4 pole device, etc.). An angle of 0 degrees corresponds to the position where the cosine input is at its maximum
and in phase with the excitation and the sine input zero. A resolver can be used for motor control in RFC-A mode or RFC-S mode. In RFC-S mode a 2
pole resolver can be used with a motor with any number of motor poles, but with any other number of poles there must be an integer number of motor
poles for each resolver pole. In RFC-A mode this restriction does not apply. Standard or high speed sampling can be selected with P1 Resolver Excitation
(03.066). If standard sampling is selected and the position feedback used for motor control the maximum operating speed is limited before the control
peroformance starts to deteriorate. See P1 Resolver Excitation (03.066) for more details.

SINCOS with absolute position from sine and cosine signals


This type of device, which is not recommended for new applications, is intended to provide absolute position feedback for motor control in RFC-S mode. If
one of these devices is used for RFC-A mode the additional sine wave signals and the Z1 marker signal do not affect the motor control position feedback.
The position information given in P1 Position (03.029) and P1 Fine Position (03.030) is initialised to the position within one turn
and P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028) is set to zero when the device is initialised based on the once per turn sine and cosine signals. This gives
a moderately accurate absolute position. When a marker event occurs it is used to give a more accurate absolute position. Care should be taken to
ensure that the position feedback device is connected correctly. For example a Heidenhain ERN1387 device should be connected as follows: 1/2=A+/A-
(Cosine), 3/4=B+/B-(Sine), 5/6=R+/R-(Marker), 7/8=C+/C-(Single turn cosine), 9/10=D+/D-(Single turn sine). It is assumed that the marker occurs at the
positive zero crossing of the single turn cosine signal when operating in the forwards direction (i.e. compatible with the ERN1387). To ensure the drive
can correctly detect the reference marker pulse with a Heidenhain ERN1387 encoder it is recommended that bit 3 of P1 Marker Mode (03.031) is set to 1.

Communications:

Hiperface
Hiperface is an asynchronous bi-direction communications protocol that is only used with incremental sine waves. Therefore it can be used to check the
position derived from the sine waves or for bi-direction transfer of data between the drive and encoder. A checksum is provided for error checking.

EnDat 2.1
EnDat 2.1 is a synchronous bi-direction communications protocol that is intended to be used with incremental sine waves. Therefore it can be used to
check the position derived from the sine waves or for bi-direction transfer of data between the drive and encoder. It can be used as an absolute comms
only type position feedback interface, but the resolution of the position feedback using this method may be limited. If it is used in this way it is not possible
to use the position feedback via comms at the same time as communicating with the encoder for data transfer or electronic nameplate. A CRC is provided
for error checking.

EnDat 2.2 and BiSS C Mode


EnDat 2.2 and BiSS are synchronous bi-direction communications protocols that are intended to be used alone. It is possible to obtain position feedback
at the same time as communicating with the encoder for data transfer or electronic nameplate. A CRC is provided for error checking.

SSI

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


86 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
SSI is a uni-directional communications protocol that is intended to be used alone. It is only possible to obtain the position information from the encoder
and it is not possible to transfer data between the drive and the encoder. No error checking is provided by the SSI protocol, and so encoders based on
this interface are not recommended for new applications.

Parameter 03.039 P1 Termination Select


Short description Used to enable or disable the terminations on the position feedback interface inputs
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P1 Termination Select (03.039) is used to enable or disable the terminations on the position feedback interface inputs. The function of
P1 Termination Select (03.039) depends on the position feedback device type selected in P1 Device Type (03.038) as shown below.

Terminals 5/6 have selectable pull-apart resistors which follow the same state as the termination resistors for terminals 5/6, unless described differently
below.

P1 Device Type (03.038): AB, FD, FR, AB Servo, FD Servo, FR Servo

Terminal Input 03.039 = 0 03.039 = 1 03.039 = 2


1/2 & 3/4 A1 & B1 Disabled Enabled Enabled
5/6 Z1 Disabled Disabled Enabled

U1, V1 & W1 terminations (terminals 7/8, 9/10 & 11/12) are always enabled for AB Servo, FD Servo and FR Servo encoders.

P1 Device Type (03.038): SC, SC Servo, SC SC

Terminal Input 03.039 = 0 03.039 = 1 03.039 = 2


1/2 & 3/4 Cos1 & Sin1 Disabled Enabled Enabled
5/6 Z1 Disabled Disabled Enabled

U1, V1 & W1 (terminals 7/8, 9/10 & 11/12) terminations are always enabled for SC Servo encoders. SCs1 and SSn1 (terminals 7/8 & 9/10)
terminations are always enabled for SC SC encoders.

P1 Device Type (03.038): SC Hiperface, SC EnDat, SC SSI, SC BiSS

Terminal Input 03.039 = 0 03.039 = 1 03.039 = 2


1/2 & 3/4 Cos1 & Sin1 Disabled Enabled Enabled
5/6 D1 Enabled Enabled Enabled

For SC EnDat and SC SSI encoder the pull-apart resistors on the D1 input/output (terminals 5/6) are always disabled, and for SC Hiperface encoders the
pull-apart resistors on the D1 input/output (terminals 5/6) are always enabled.

P1 Device Type (03.038): EnDat, BiSS, SSI

Terminal Input 03.039 = 0 03.039 = 1 03.039 = 2


1/2 & 3/4 D1/CLK1 Enabled Enabled Enabled
5/6 Z1 Disabled Disabled Enabled

If the P2 Device type (03.138) is set to EnDat, BiSS or SSI and the encoder simulation output is enabled, then the Z1 input becomes the data (D2) input
for the P2 position interface and termination resistors are always enabled and pull-apart resistors are always disabled.

P1 Device Type (03.038): Resolver


P1 Termination Select (03.039) has no effect as terminations are always disabled.

P1 Device Type (03.038): Commutation Only


P1 Termination Select (03.039) has no effect as terminations are always enabled.

Parameter 03.040 P1 Error Detection Level


Short description Used to enable or disable position feedback trip functions
Mode RFC‑A
0 255
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00000000) (Display: 11111111)
1
Default Units
(Display: 00000001)
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter can be used to enable or disable position feedback trip functions as follows:

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 87
Bit Function Trip(s) Comments
Enable wire break
0 Encoder 2 Bits 5 to 7 have no effect if this bit is set to zero.
detection.
Enable phase error
1 Encoder 3
detection.
Enable SSI power
2 supply alarm bit Encoder 6
monitor.
Encoder 1 to Trips related to bits 0, 1, 2, 5, 6 and 7 do not occur if this bit is set to one. See note below about the
3 Disable indicated trips.
Encoder 6 position feedback device becoming uninitialised.
4 Disable indicated trip. Encoder 7
Enable wire break
detection for sine
5 wave commutation Encoder 2
signals for SC SC type
encoders.
Enable wire break
detection for the
marker with SC SC
6 Encoder 2
type encoders with
Heidenhain ERN1387
type marker signals.
The standard wire break detection is only likely to detect a break in the excitation signal, or both the sine
and cosine signals together. The more sensitive system will detect a break in any signal provided the
Enable more sensitive
motor is rotating. If the motor is stationary, there are positions where wire break will not be detected. The
7 resolver wire break Encoder 2
standard system uses 10% of the expected 1Vrms feedback signals as the detection threshold, but the
detection.
more sensitive system uses 80%. If the resolver ratio is significantly less than 3:1 with 3V excitation, or 2:1
with 2V excitation, then the more sensitive detection system should not be used.

Bits 3 and 4 do not prevent the device from becoming un-initialised. The trip is suppressed, but the device is still un-initialised and this is indicated by the
appropriate bit for the position feedback interface in Position Feedback Initialized (03.076).

Encoder trips
The following table shows trips that can be initiated that are related to the position feedback interface P1. The sub-trip number is 1 for the drive P1
position feedback interface.

Drive trip Encoders Reason for error


Encoder 1 All Power supply short circuit
AB, FD, FR, AB Servo, Hardware wire-break detect on A1, B1 and Z1 inputs 1. (Note that there is no wire break detection on the U1, V1
FD Servo, FR Servo and W1 commutation inputs.)
SC, SC Servo,
Encoder 2 SC Hiperface, Software wire break detection on sine wave signals.
SC EnDat, SC SSI, Marker and single turn sine wave commutation signals for SC SC device5.
Resolver, SC SC, SC (Note that there is no wire break detection on the U1, V1 and W1 commutation inputs.)
BiSS
AB Servo, FD Servo,
FR Servo, SC Servo Phase error 2
Encoder 3 SC Hiperface,
SC EnDat, SC SSI, SC Sine/cosine phase error 3
BiSS
SC Hiperface,
Encoder 4 SC EnDat, EnDat, BISS, Comms timeout
SC BiSS
SC Hiperface,
SC EnDat, EnDat, BISS, Checksum/CRC error
Encoder 5 SC BiSS
SC SSI, SSI Not ready at start of position transfer (i.e. data input not one)
SC Hiperface,
SC EnDat, EnDat, BiSS, The encoder has indicated an error
Encoder 6 SC BiSS
SSI, SC SSI Power supply alarm bit active
A set-up parameter for the device or the number of pole pairs for the currently selected motor have been
Encoder 7 All
changed.
P1 Device Type (03.038), P1 Comms Bits (03.035), P1 Comms Baud Rate (03.037), P1 Calculation Time
(03.060), P1 Recovery Time (03.061), P1 Line Delay Time (03.062) and P1 User Comms Enable (03.067) are
Encoder 8 EnDat, SSI, BiSS
used to determine the time taken for the communications exchange with the encoder. If this time exceeds 250μs
an Encoder 8 trip is initiated.
Speed feedback selected from an option slot that does not have a position feedback category option module
Encoder 9 All
fitted
Phasing Error All Incorrect encoder phasing 4
Encoder 12 SC Hiperface, BiSS The encoder could not be identified during auto-configuration
SC Hiperface,
Encoder 13 SC EnDat, EnDat, BiSS, Data read from the position feedback device during auto-configuration is out of range
SC BiSS
Encoder 14 BiSS, SC BiSS The turns or position padding values in parameter P1 Additional Configuration (03.074) are out of range.

1. If the terminations are not enabled on the A1, B1 or Z1 inputs the wire break system will not operate. (Note that as default the Z1 input

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


88 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
terminations are disabled to disable wire break detection on this input.)
2. Phase error detection for AB Servo, FD Servo, FR Servo or SC Servo encoders monitors the relationship between the position from the
incremental signals and the commutation signals to ensure that the incremental pulses have been counted correctly. The error is detected if the
incremental position moves outside the position range defined by the UVW commutation signals by 10 o. The trip is initiated if the error is detected
for 10 consecutive samples. This system should not be used unless one encoder line (AB Servo), or two lines (FD Servo, FR Servo), are less
than 10° electrical or else spurious Encoder 3 trips will occur.
3. Phase error detection for SINCOS encoders with comms monitors the relationship between the position derived from the sine waves with the
position derived via comms. The encoder is interrogated via comms and the comparison is made once per second. If the error is greater than 10°
electrical for 10 consecutive samples the trip is initiated. This system should not be used unless one sine wave is less than 10° electrical or else
spurious Encoder 3 trips will occur.
4. Incorrect encoder phasing is detected if the motor reaches half of the speed defined by VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX] and the phasing error is
large enough for the motor to accelerate uncontrollably.
5. Detection of wire break on the sine wave commutation signals or marker of an SC SC device may require the encoder to rotate by several
mechanical turns before the fault is detected, i.e. up to 2 turns for the sine wave commutation signals and up to 3 turns for the marker).

Wire-break detection
It may be important to detect a break in the connections between the drive and the position feedback device. This feature is provided for most position
feedback devices either directly or indirectly as listed below.

Device Detection method Trip produced

AB, FD, FR, AB Servo,


Hardware detectors on the A1, B1 and Z1 signal detect a wire break. Encoder 2
FD Servo, FR Servo

The magnitudes of the sine wave signals are monitored as the magnitude of a vector which is calculated
as √(Sine2+Cosine2). If this is less than the value produced by two valid waveforms with a peak to peak
magnitude of 0.25V (i.e. 0.25 of the nominal level of 1V peak to peak) then a trip is initiated. This always
SC, SC Servo, detects wire break in the sine and cosine connections if the position feedback is changing. If the position
SC Hiperface, feedback is stationary this may not detect wire break until the position feedback moves, e.g. if the sine
SC EnData, connection is broken, but the cosine is at it's maximum then wirebreak will not be detected. Encoder 2
SC SSI, SC SC, SC
BiSS Additional monitoring is provided for SC SC encoders to give software wire break detection for the single
turn sine wave commutation signals and the marker. If the device is a Heidenhain ERN1387 the marker is
too small for hardware wire break detection, and so the additional software detection is required to detect
wire break on the marker.

The magnitudes of the sine and cosine input signals are monitored in a similar way to SINCOS signals
where the peak of the sine and cosine waveforms are used to calculate the vector magnitude. If the
calculated value is less than the value produced by two valid waveforms with a differential peak to peak
Resolver Encoder 2
magnitude of 0.4V then a trip is initiated. This detects wire break in the sine and cosine connections. If the
position feedback is stationary this may not detect wire break until the position feedback moves, e.g. if the
sine connection is broken, but the cosine is at it's maximum then wire break will not be detected.

SC Hiperface,
Encoder 4,
SC EnDat, EnDat, Wire break in the comms link is detected by a CRC or timeout error.
Encoder 5
BiSS, SC BiSS

Wire break detection in the comms is difficult with these devices. However, if power supply alarm bit
monitoring is enabled the drive will be looking for a one at the start of the message and a zero to indicate Encoder 5,
SSI, SC SSI
that the power supply is okay. If the clock stops or the data line is disconnected the data input to the drive Encoder 6
may stay in one state or the other and cause a trip.

Position feedback power supply trips


The position feedback power supply from the drive can be switched off by the drive either because the power supply is overloaded (Encoder 1 trip) or
because the internal 24V supply within the drive is overloaded (PSU 24V trip). The internal 24V supply provides power for the position feedback power
supply, user 24V output, digital I/O, option modules etc. To ensure that an Encoder 1 trip is not initiated when the internal 24V is overloaded, and
subsequently switched off by the drive, there is a delay of 40ms in the detection of Encoder 1 trip. It is possible for other position feedback trips, such as
wire break detection (i.e. Encoder 2), to occur when the power supply is removed from the position feedback device. Therefore overloading the internal
24V supply or the position feedback supply could result in an immediate Encoder 2 trip. To ensure that the correct reason for the trip is given PSU 24V
and Encoder 1 trips override an existing Encoder 2 to Encoder 6 trip. This means that both the original trip (Encoder 2 to Encoder 6) and then the new trip
(PSU 24V or Encoder 1) are stored in the trip log.

Parameter 03.041 P1 Auto-configuration Select


Short description Set to 1 to enable interrogation of the encoder to determine the set up required
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Disabled
1 Enabled

P1 Device Type (03.038): SC Hiperface, SC EnDat, EnDat

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 89
If auto-configuration has not been disabled (i.e. P1 Auto-configuration Select (03.041) is not 0) then during position feedback initialisation the encoder is
interrogated to determine whether the encoder is a rotary or linear encoder and P1 Linear Feedback Select (03.051) is set up appropriately. Then the
following parameters are set up based on information from the encoder:

Rotary Linear
P1 Rotary Turns Bits (03.033) P1 Linear Comms Pitch (03.052)
P1 Rotary Lines Per Revolution
P1 Linear Line Pitch (03.053)
(03.034)
P1 Comms Bits (03.035) P1 Comms Bits (03.035)
P1 Additional Configuration P1 Linear Comms And Line Pitch Units
(03.074) (03.054)

The following actions are also taken to set up the timing for the encoder.

Comms Protocol Actions taken

P1 Calculation Time (03.060) = From the encoder


EnDat 2.1 P1 Recovery Time (03.061) = 30μs
Line delay measured and result written to P1 Line Delay Time (03.062)

P1 Calculation Time (03.060) = From the encoder


P1 Recovery Time (03.061) is set to 4μs (and the encoder itself is set up to use its
EnDat 2.2
short recovery time of 3.75μs) if the P1 Comms Baud Rate (03.037) is 1M or more.
Line delay measured and result written to P1 Line Delay Time (03.062)

Once these parameters have been set up it should be possible for the drive to operate correctly with the encoder. Auto-configuration occurs as part of the
position interface initialisation if selected, and so if the auto-configuration fails (i.e. communications cannot be established) then initialisation will not be
completed. If initialisation has not been completed successfully the drive cannot be enabled (see Enable Conditions (06.010)). For SC Hiperface encoders
the drive must identify the encoder model number to perform auto-configuration. If communications is established, but the drive cannot recognise the
encoder model, an Encoder 12 trip is produced immediately.

If auto-configuration is disabled ((i.e. P1 Auto-configuration Select (03.041) = 0) then none of the above actions are carried out except for the line delay
measurement.

P1 Device Type (03.038): BiSS, SC BiSS


With P1 Auto-configuration Select (03.041) set to either 0 or 1 the only action taken during initialisation is to measure the line delay and write the result to
P1 Line Delay Time (03.062).

P1 Device Type (03.038): All other device types


P1 Auto-configuration Select (03.041) has no effect.

Parameter 03.042 P1 Feedback Filter


Defines the time period for a sliding window filter that may be applied to the feedback taken from the
Short description
drive P1 position feedback interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Disabled
1 1ms
2 2ms
3 4ms
4 8ms
5 16ms

P1 Feedback Filter (03.042) defines the time period for a sliding window filter that may be applied to the feedback taken from the drive P1 position
feedback interface. This is particularly useful in applications where the drive encoder is used to give speed feedback for the speed controller and where
the load includes a high inertia, and so the speed controller gains are very high. Under these conditions, without a filter on the feedback, it is possible for
the speed loop output to change constantly from one current limit to the other and lock the integral term of the speed controller. In Unidrive SP this filter
was applied to the output of the sensorless speed feedback, however, a separate filter is now provided (see Sensorless Mode Filter (03.079)).

Parameter 03.043 P1 Maximum Reference


Short description Defines the maximum speed reference from device P1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 33000
Default 1500 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

The speed feedback from the drive P1 position feedback interface can be used as a source to control a parameter. The speed feedback is scaled to give

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


90 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
a value as a percentage of P1 Maximum Reference (03.043) in 0.1% units which is displayed in P1 Reference (03.045). The value is then scaled by
the P1 Reference Scaling (03.044) and then routed to the destination defined by P1 Reference destination (03.046).

Normally the destination is updated every 4ms, but if the destination is the Hard Speed Reference (03.022), P1 Maximum Reference (03.043) =
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX] and P1 Reference Scaling (03.044) = 1.000 it is updated every 250μs. Although the hard speed reference is updated
every 250μs internally a value in rpm or mm/s is written to Hard Speed Reference (03.022) every 4ms for indication only. It should be noted that if the fast
update method is used the resolution of the speed feedback devived from the position feedback device defines the resolution of the hard speed reference
and that any ripple on the feedback will be present on the hard speed reference (see Speed Feedback (03.002)).

Parameter 03.044 P1 Reference Scaling


Short description Defines the scaling applied to P1 reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See P1 Maximum Reference (03.043).

Parameter 03.045 P1 Reference


Short description Displays the value in P1 reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.0 Maximum 100.0
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, FI, ND, NC, PT

See P1 Maximum Reference (03.043).

Parameter 03.046 P1 Reference destination


Short description Defines the destination parameter for P1 reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See P1 Maximum Reference (03.043).

Parameter 03.047 P1 SSI Incremental Mode


Short description Set to 1 to enable SSI incremental mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P1 Device Type (03.038): EnDat, BISS


P1 SSI Incremental Mode (03.047) has no effect and these comms modes can only operate in incremental mode, i.e. the absolute position is taken during
encoder initialisation and then incremental positions are accumulated from that point on, to determine the position. If there is an error in the position read
from the encoder this will be detected from the CRC check, and the position data will be ignored until correct data is available or the drive trips after a
number of consecutive errors. This prevents large spurious changes in position due to data errors, and so absolute mode is not required.

P1 Device Type (03.038): SSI


If P1 SSI Incremental Mode (03.047) = 0 the complete absolute position is read at each sample. Care should be taken when using this mode as some
unwanted effects can occur when the encoder passes through the boundary between its maximum position and zero. In this mode the encoder can be
used for motor control provided at least 6 bits of turns information are provided by the encoder otherwise an over speed trip will be produced as the
position passes over the maximum position to zero boundary. P1 Normalised Position (03.058) can be used for position control over this boundary
provided the normalised turns bits are set up so that the normalised positions do not contain turns information that is not available from the encoder. As
the SSI format does not include any error checking it is not possible to detect if the position data has been corrupted by noise. The benefit of using the
absolute position directly from an SSI encoder is that even if the encoder communications are disturbed by noise and position errors occur, the position
will always recover the correct position after the disturbance has ended.

If P1 SSI Incremental Mode (03.047) = 1 the absolute position is only taken from the encoder during initialisation. The change of position over each
sample is then accumulated to determine the position. This method always gives 16 bits of turns information that can always be used without jumps in
position whatever value is used as the turns bits for normalisation. If noise corrupts the data from an SSI encoder it is possible to have apparent large
change of position, and this can result in the turns information becoming and remaining corrupted until the encoder is re-initialised.

If an SSI encoder is used, but is not powered from the drive, and the encoder is powered up after the drive, it is possible that the first change of position
detected could be large enough to cause the problems described above. This can be avoided if the encoder interface is initialised
with Initialise Position Feedback (03.075) after the encoder has powered up. If the encoder includes a power supply alarm bit, the power supply monitor

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 91
should be enabled. This will ensure that the drive remains tripped until the encoder is powered up and the action of resetting the trip will reinitialise the
encoder interface.

P1 Device Type (03.038): All other device types


P1 SSI Incremental Mode (03.047) has no effect.

Parameter 03.048 P1 SSI Binary Mode


Short description Set to 1 to enable SSI binary mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P1 Device Type (03.038): SC SSI, SSI


SSI encoders normally use Gray code data format. However, some encoders use binary format which may be selected by setting P1 SSI Binary Mode
(03.048) to one.

P1 Device Type (03.038): All other device types


P1 SSI Binary Mode (03.048) has no effect.

Parameter 03.049 P1 Additional Power-up Delay


Short description Defines an additional delay for when any attempt is made to communicate to the device P1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 25.0
Default 0.0 Units s
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, BU

When the position feedback is initialised, at power-up or at any other time, a delay is included before the information from the feedback device is used or
any attempt is made to communicate with the device. The minimum delays are shown in the table below. P1 Additional Power-up Delay (03.049) defines
an additional delay that is added to the minimum delay.

P1 Device Type (03.038) Minimum delay


AB, FD, FR
AB Servo, FD Servo, FR Servo
100ms
SC, SC Servo
Resolver, SC SC
SC Hiperface 150ms
EnDat, SC EnDat
SSI, SC SSI 1.3s
BISS, SC BiSS

Parameter 03.050 P1 Feedback Lock


Short description Set to 1 to prevent the position feedback paramters for P1 being updated
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If P1 Feedback Lock (03.050) = 1 then P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028), P1 Position (03.029) and P1 Fine Position (03.030) are not updated.
If P1 Feedback Lock (03.050) = 0 then these parameters are updated normally.

Parameter 03.051 P1 Linear Feedback Select


Short description Set to 1 to configure the P1 interface to operate with a linear position feedback device
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Background read, Auto-configuration
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If P1 Linear Feedback Select (03.051) = 0 then the drive P1 position feedback interface is configured to operate with a rotary position feedback
device. P1 Rotary Turns Bits (03.033) and P1 Rotary Lines Per Revolution (03.034) should be used to set up the position feedback interface.

If P1 Linear Feedback Select (03.051) = 1 then the position feedback interface is configured to operate with a linear position feedback
device. P1 Linear Comms Pitch (03.052) and P1 Linear Line Pitch (03.053) should be used to set up the position feedback interface.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


92 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 03.052 P1 Linear Comms Pitch
Defines the distance covered by the least significant bit of the position information in a comms message
Short description
from a linear encoder
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.001 Maximum 100.000
Default 0.001 Units
Background read, auto-configuration
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

P1 Device Type (03.038): SC Hiperface, EnDat, SC EnDat, SSI, SC SSI, BiSS, SC BiSS
P1 Linear Comms Pitch (03.052) is used to define the distance covered by the least significant bit of the position information in a comms message from a
linear encoder. The units used by this parameter are defined by P1 Linear Comms And Line Pitch Units (03.054).

P1 Device Type (03.038): Any other device


P1 Linear Comms Pitch (03.052) has no effect.

Parameter 03.053 P1 Linear Line Pitch


Short description Defines the linear line pitch for device P1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.001 Maximum 100.000
Default 0.001 Units
Background read, auto-configuration
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

P1 Linear Line Pitch (03.053) only has any effect if the position feedback interface is being used with a linear device (i.e. P1 Linear Feedback Select
(03.051) = 1) and should be used to define the distances listed below for each type of device. The units used by this parameter are defined
by P1 Linear Comms And Line Pitch Units (03.054).

P1 Device Type (03.038): AB, AB Servo


P1 Linear Line Pitch (03.053) should be set to the distance covered by one line period on the encoder.

P1 Device Type (03.038): FD, FR, FD Servo, FR Servo


P1 Linear Line Pitch (03.053) should be set to the distance covered by two line periods on the encoder.

P1 Device Type (03.038): SC, SC Hiperface, SC EnDat, SC SSI, SC Servo, SC SC, SC BiSS
P1 Linear Line Pitch (03.053) should be set to the distance covered by one sine wave period on the encoder.

P1 Device Type (03.038): Resolver


P1 Linear Line Pitch (03.053) should be set to the distance covered by one pole of the resolver divided by 214.

P1 Device Type (03.038): Any other device


P1 Linear Line Pitch (03.053) has no effect.

Parameter 03.054 P1 Linear Comms And Line Pitch Units


Short description Defines the linear units in either millimetres or micrometres
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 millimetres
1 micrometres

P1 Linear Comms And Line Pitch Units (03.054) defines the units used by P1 Linear Comms Pitch (03.052) and P1 Linear Line Pitch (03.053) in either
millimetres or micrometres.

Parameter 03.055 P1 Pole Pair Pitch


Defines the change of position for one electrical revolution of the drive output with a linear position
Short description
device.
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.01 Maximum 1000.00
Default 10.00 Units mm
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

P1 Pole Pair Pitch (03.055) gives the distance equivalent to one electrical revolution when linear position feedback is used with a motor. One electrical

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 93
revolution is one cycle of the a.c. output current from the drive. If the linear position feedback device is being used with a linear motor, then
P1 Pole Pair Pitch (03.055) should be set to the pole pair pitch of the motor. The pole pitch for linear motors can be the distance between the pole pieces
on the stator as shown below. If this is the case the the pole pair pitch is twice the length of the motor pole pitch. If Number Of Motor Poles (05.011) is set
up correctly for a linear motor as 2, then the position feedback as shown in P1 Position (03.029) should change by one revolution (65536) over the
distance defined by P1 Pole Pair Pitch (03.055).

If the linear position feedback is not being used with a motor then the pole pair pitch is the distance over which the position feedback as shown
in P1 Position (03.029) should change by one revolution, i.e. 65536.

Parameter 03.056 P1 Feedback Reverse


Short description Set to 1 to reverse the direction of the position feedback
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If P1 Feedback Reverse (03.056) = 1 the position feedback is negated. This can be used to reverse the direction of the position feedback. It should be
noted that the position and the turns are negated, so for example if P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028) = 0 and P1 Position (03.029) = 1000 with
P1 Feedback Reverse (03.056) = 0, then if P1 Feedback Reverse (03.056) is set to one then P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028) = 65535 (-1) and
P1 Position (03.029) = 64536 (65536 - 1000). This will have an effect on the initial position for example, for a resolver which is a single turn absolute
device, where the initial P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028) = 0 with P1 Feedback Reverse (03.056) = 0 or 65535 (-1) with P1 Feedback Reverse
(03.056) = 1.

Reversing the position feedback will not compensate for the following situations:

1. The direction of the incremental signals and the direction of the digital commutation signals are different for encoders which have digital
commutation signals (i.e. AB Servo)
2. The direction of the SINCOS signals are incorrect for a SINCOS encoder with comms.

Parameter 03.057 P1 Normalisation Turns


Short description Defines the number of turns bits included in the normalisation parameters
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 16
Default 16 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The combination of P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028), P1 Position (03.029) and P1 Fine Position (03.030) give the position feedback as a 48 bit
value. This position cannot be read atomically without locking the position feedback (P1 Feedback Lock (03.050) = 1) and it cannot be used directly by the
Advanced Motion Controller (see Menu 31). It is useful to be able to create 32 bit position values that can be held by a single parameter as this value can
be accessed atomically and can be used directly by the Advanced Motion Controller. P1 Normalisation Turns (03.057) defines the number of turns bits
included in the following parameters.

P1 Normalised Position (03.058)
P1 Normalised Marker Position (03.059)
F1 Normalised Freeze Position (03.103) if P1 is the source position for freeze function F1
F2 Normalised Freeze Position (03.108) if P1 is the source position for freeze function F2

Parameter 03.058 P1 Normalised Position


Short description Displays the position taken from the position feedback device including the effect of the marker function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

P1 Normalised Position (03.058) is the position taken from the position feedback device including the effect of the marker function.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


94 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
See P1 Normalisation Turns (03.057) for details of the format.

Parameter 03.059 P1 Normalised Marker Position


Short description Displays the normalised position at the last marker event
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

P1 Normalised Marker Position (03.059) is the value P1 Normalised Position (03.058) at the last marker event provided bit 2 of P1 Marker Mode
(03.031) is set to 1. See P1 Marker Mode (03.031) for more details.

Parameter 03.060 P1 Calculation Time


Defines the time from the first edge of the clock signal from the position feedback interface until the
Short description
encoder has calculated the position and is ready to return this information
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 20
Default 5 Units µs
Background read, auto-configuration
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P1 Device Type (03.038): EnDat, BiSS


P1 Calculation Time (03.060) is the time from the first edge of the clock signal from the position feedback interface until the encoder has calculated the
position and is ready to return this information. This is used to calculate the overall time for a message interchange with the encoder.
See P1 Low Speed Update Rate Active (03.063) for more details.

P1 Device Type (03.038): Any other type of device


P1 Calculation Time (03.060) has no effect.

Parameter 03.061 P1 Recovery Time


Short description Defines the time that must be allowed after each message interchange before a new message begins
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 4 Maximum 100
Default 30 Units µs
Background read, auto-configuration
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P1 Device Type (03.038): EnDat, SSI, BiSS


P1 Recovery Time (03.061) is the time that must be allowed after each message interchange before a new message begins.

P1 Device Type (03.038): Any other type of device


P1 Recovery Time (03.061) has no effect.

Parameter 03.062 P1 Line Delay Time


Displays the transmission delay between the position feedback interface and the encoder and back
Short description
again
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5000
Default Units ns
Background read, position feedback
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate
initialisation write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

P1 Device Type (03.038): EnDat, SC EnDat, BiSS, SC BiSS


During position feedback initialisation the transmission delay between the position feedback interface and the encoder and back again is measured and
stored in P1 Line Delay Time (03.062). This value is then used to compensate for this delay so that the clock/data skew does not prevent the data from
the encoder from being read. This means that longer line lengths can be used with these feedback devices provided the correct cable and connection
arrangements are used.

P1 Device Type (03.038): Any other type of device


P1 Line Delay Time (03.062) is always zero.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 95
Parameter 03.063 P1 Low Speed Update Rate Active
Short description Indicates when the low speed update rate is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

P1 Device Type (03.038): EnDat, SSI, BISS


There is a delay when the position information is obtained via a communications interface from an encoder. It is assumed that the position information is
taken from all types of encoder at a fixed datum point during each sample period. The drive initiates the comms transfer at a suitable point in advance of
the datum to ensure that the position information is available when required. A correction is then applied to the position information based on the change
of position over the previous sample and the advance time so that the position appears to have been sampled at the datum. If the communications
exchange, including allowing the encoder a recovery time (P1 Recovery Time (03.061)), is completed in 60μs and the time required to obtain the full
position is completed in 40μs then the position is sampled at each current controller task and P1 Low Speed Update Rate Active (03.063) = 0. Otherwise
if the communication exchange is completed in 230μs the position is sampled every 250μs and P1 Low Speed Update Rate Active (03.063) = 1. If the
complete exchange takes any longer an Encoder 8 trip is initiated. The following table shows the calculations used by the drive to determine the
necessary time to obtain the required data.

Protocol Time for full position Time for complete data exchange

tST + tD + 10T + 2T + NtT + 5T


where tcal ≤ tST + tD/2+ 10T
Endat 2.1 encoder Time for full position + tm
tST + tD + tcal + 2T + NtT + 5T
where tcal > tST + tD/2 + 10T

tST + tD + 10T + 3T + NtT + 5T + tAdd


where tcal ≤ tST + tD/2+ 10T
EnDat 2.2 encoder Time for full position + tm
tST + tD + tcal + 3T + NtT + 5T + tAdd
where tcal > tST + tD/2 + 10T

BiSS tD + tcal + 2T + NtT + 2T + (CRCBits x T) Time for full position + tm

tD + T + NtT
SSI Time for full position + tm
(tD cannot be measured, and so a value of 1.25μs is used)

where

Value Description Source


tST EnDat start time For 100K baud = 5us, 200K baud = 2.5us, for all other baud rates = 2μs
tD Transmission delay from the drive to the encoder and back P1 Line Delay Time (03.062)
T 1 / baud rate P1 Comms Baud Rate (03.037)
tcal Position calculation time P1 Calculation Time (03.060)
Nt Total number of position information bits P1 Comms Bits (03.035)
tm Encoder recovery time P1 Recovery Time (03.061)
tAdd Time for additional information tAdd1 = 31T + tST + 30T
CRCBits The number of bits in the CRC applied to the position P1 Additional Configuration (03.074)

P1 Device Type (03.038): Any other type of device


P1 Low Speed Update Rate Active (03.063) is always zero.

Parameter 03.064 P1 Encoder Protocol Detected


Short description Defines which protocol is used with the device P1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


96 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Value Text
0 None
1 Hiperface
2 EnDat2.1
3 EnDat2.2
4 BiSS

P1 Encoder Protocol Detected (03.064) shows the encoder comms protocol detected during position feedback initialisation. If P1 Device Type (03.038) is
set to SC Hiperface or BiSS then P1 Encoder Protocol Detected (03.064) is set to the appropriate value after successful communication with the encoder
during initialisation. If P1 Device Type (03.038) is set to EnDat or SC EnDat then P1 Encoder Protocol Detected (03.064) is set to the appropriate EnDat
protocol after successful communication with the encoder during initialisation. If communications is not successful during initialisation then
P1 Encoder Protocol Detected (03.064) is set to 0.

Parameter 03.065 P1 Resolver Poles


Short description Defines the number of poles for the resolver connected to P1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 10
Default 1 Units PolePairs
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P1 Device Type (03.038): Resolver


P1 Resolver Poles (03.065) should be set to the number pole pairs for the resolver connected to the P1 position feedback interface. If the resolver is
being used for motor control then a 2 pole resolver can be used with any motor, but if the number of resolver poles is greater than 2, it can only be used
when motor poles / resolver poles is an integer (i.e. a 4 pole resolver can be used with an 8 pole motor). Note that this value is only used if
P1 Linear Feedback Select (03.051) = 0. If not then the position feedback must be set up using P1 Linear Line Pitch (03.053) and P1 Pole Pair Pitch
(03.055).

P1 Device Type (03.038): Any other type of device


P1 Resolver Poles (03.065) has no effect.

Parameter 03.066 P1 Resolver Excitation


Short description Defines the excitation of the resolver when connected to P1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 7
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 6kHz 3V
1 8kHz 3V
2 6kHz 2V
3 8kHz 2V
4 6kHz 3V Fast
5 8kHz 3V Fast
6 6kHz 2V Fast
7 8kHz 2V Fast

P1 Device Type (03.038): Resolver


P1 Resolver Excitation (03.066) defines the excitation voltage and frequency. A level of 3V r.m.s. should be used with 3:1 resolvers and 2V r.m.s. with 2:1
resolvers. These give a nominal level of 1V r.m.s. feedback into the position feedback interface. Other ratios can be used, but if the feedback is increased
above the expected levels the feedback seen by the drive will be distorted. The resolution of the position feedback will be reduced proportionally if
the feedback is less than 1V r.m.s. With a 2 pole resolver the nominal resolution is equivalent to 1600 line encoder. If the number of resolver poles are
increased then the resolution increases, for example a 4 pole resolver gives a resolution equivalent to a 3200 line encoder, etc. The position feedback
system allows for a delay from the excitation to the feedback from the resolver of up to 45o and will compensate for this lag during the position feedback
initialisation process. (It should be noted that the excitation voltage given is the nominal level, but this can slightly higher than the nominal level.)

The resolver interface offers two sampling rates: standard and fast. With standard sampling (P1 Resolver Excitation (03.066) < 4) any switching frequency
can be used with any resolver excitation frequency and the switching frequency can be changed when the position feedback is being used without any
transient effects. There is a 250us sampling delay with this system and if the resolver feedback is used for motor control the system can become unstable
at high speeds. It is recommended that the motor speed is limited to 9000rpm / Motor Pole Pairs. With fast sampling (P1 Resolver Excitation (03.066) ≥ 4)
the sample delay is significantly reduced and resolver feedback can be used up to the maximum limit of 30000rpm, but the feedback is much noisier and
the acoustic noise produced by the motor is increased. It is possible to switch between standard and fast sampling while the drive is enabled and
controlling a motor, so for example standard sampling can be used at low speeds, and then fast sampling can be used at higher speeds. Normally
when P1 Resolver Excitation (03.066) is changed an Encoder 7 is initiated because the position feedback set-up has been changed and the position
feedback interface needs to be re-initialised. However, if the new value of P1 Resolver Excitation (03.066) is the old value plus or minus 4 (i.e. 0 to 4, or 5
to 1, etc.) then a trip is not initiated and the interface does not need to be initialised.

The following restrictions apply if fast sampling is selected:

1. 2, 4, 8 or 16kHz switching frequencies should be used with 8kHz excitation. 3, 6 or 12kHz switching frequencies should be used with 6kHz
excitation. If these conditions are not met the system will automatically operate with standard sampling.
2. If the switching frequency is changed by one step, i.e. from 2 to 3kHz, there will be a transient in the position feedback. To ensure that this does

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 97
not happen as the drive alters the switching frequency because it has become too hot Auto-switching Frequency Step Size (05.036) should be left
at its default value, so that all changes are made in steps of 2.
3. If the resolver feedback is not being used as the feedback for motor control then its sample rate is automatically reduced and the position
feedback will automatically operate with standard sampling.
4. If a linear mode is selected (i.e. P1 Linear Feedback Select (03.051) = 1) then the system will operate with standard sampling.

P1 Device Type (03.038): Any other type of device


P1 Resolver Excitation (03.066) has no effect

Parameter 03.067 P1 User Comms Enable


Short description Enables the use of the user comms paramters to communicate to the encoder connected to P1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC, PT

If P1 User Comms Enable (03.067) set to one it is possible to use P1 User Comms Transmit Register (03.068) and P1 User Comms Receive Register
(03.069) to communicate with an encoder that has a Hiperface, EnDat 2.1, EnDat2.2 or BiSS interface. A description of how to use these registers is
given below.

P1 Device Type (03.038): SC Hiperface, SC EnDat


Hiperface or EnDat 2.1 communications are used as appropriate if P1 User Comms Enable (03.067) is set to one.

P1 Device Type (03.038): EnDat


Communication is enabled when P1 User Comms Enable (03.067) is set to one. If the encoder supports EnDat 2.2 it is possible to enable user
communications at any time even if the drive is enabled. Otherwise if the encoder only supports EnDat 2.1 communication with the encoder is not
possible.

P1 Device Type (03.038): BISS, SC BiSS


If P1 User Comms Enable (03.067) is set to one it is possible to enable user communications at any time even if the drive is enabled.

Encoder communications
A communication channel is provided to allow the user to communicate with an encoder connected to one of the communications interfaces. It should be
noted that the communications channel is disabled under the following conditions:

1. If auto-configuration is active.
2. During the transfer of electronic nameplate data.
3. If the position feedback device is not initialised.
4. The channel is being used by an option module with safety functions.

To send a message to the encoder the required message must be written to the transmit register. To read the response from the encoder the data is read
from the receive register. The data is written one byte at a time and is stored in a 16 byte buffer before being sent to the encoder. The data should only be
written to the transmit register when it has been cleared to zero by the drive. Bits 13 to 15 are used to control the interface.

Bit Function

This bit should be set to one each time data is written to the transmit register. This indicates that data has been written. This bit will be cleared when
15
the LS byte of the data has been transferred into the comms buffer.

This bit should be set when the last byte of the message is written to the transmit register. The data will be read and transferred to the comms buffer
14
and then the message will be sent to the encoder.

This bit should be set when the first byte of the message is written to the transmit register. Setting this bit will reset the pointer to the start of the
13
comms buffer.

Data can be read from the receive register at any time. If there is data in the buffer bit 15 will be set. Once the data has been read the register should be
cleared and the drive will transfer the next byte of data to the register.

Bit Function

15 Indicates that data from the last transfer can be read from the receive register.

14 Indicates that the last byte from the receive message is in the register.

There is no data in the receive buffer and the LS byte of the receive register is the comms system status. If there was an error in the received
13
message one of the status error bits will also be set until the comms is used again by this system or by the drive.

The status flags are defined as follows:

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


98 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Bit Meaning

0 The number of bytes put into the transmit buffer is not consistent with the expected message length. (Hiperface only)

The number of bytes written to the transmit buffer, or the expected length of the store data transmit message, or the expected length of a read data
1
message have exceed the length of the buffer. (Hiperface only)

2 The command code is not supported.

3 A valid response was not received from the encoder.

The following sequence should be followed when transmitting and receiving data to ensure that the received data is always read correctly.

1. Check that P1 User Comms Receive Register (03.069) is not zero.


2. Check that P1 User Comms Transmit Register (03.068) is zero.
3. Write each word of the transmit message to P1 User Comms Transmit Register (03.068) in turn, waiting each time for the drive to return
P1 User Comms Transmit Register (03.068) back to zero before writing the next word.
4. Write zero to P1 User Comms Receive Register (03.069).
5. Read P1 User Comms Receive Register (03.069) and when it is not zero the drive has updated it with a receive word.
6. Read each receive word in turn writing zero to P1 User Comms Receive Register (03.069) after reading the word.

If the above sequence is not followed correctly, it is possible that data from the transmit message will be seen in the first read of the receive message. It is
not essential that any or all of the receive message is read before sending a new transmit message, and so steps 4 to 6 can be omitted if required
provided step 1 is not ignored.

Hiperface
Up to 15 bytes of data can be written to the buffer. The first byte should be the encoder address. The checksum will be calculated by the drive and added
to the end of the message before the message is transmitted to the encoder. The drive checks the checksum of the received message. If successfully
received, the receive message can be read via the receive register including the address and the checksum received from the encoder. It should be noted
that the encoder must be set up for 9600 baud, 1 start bit, 1 stop bit and even parity (default set-up) for the encoder comms to operate with the drive. Also
the data block security should not be enabled in the encoder if the drive encoder nameplate system is to operate correctly. See Hiperface specification for
more details of the comms message format.

The following commands are supported:

Code Command
0x42 Read position
0x43 Set position
0x44 Read analog value
0x46 Read counter
0x47 Increment counter
0x49 Clear counter
0x4a Read data (maximum of 10 bytes)
0x4b Store data (maximum of 9 bytes)
0x4c Data field status
0x4d Create a data field
0x4e Available memory
0x50 Read encoder status
0x52 Read type
0x53 Reset encoder

SC EnDat
Up to 4 bytes can be written to the buffer in the following format.

Byte 0
Command Address Data (MSB) Data (LSB)

The following commands are supported.

Code Command Address Data (MSB) Data (LSB)


0x07 Encoder to send position value Any Any Any
0x0E Selection of memory area MRS code Any Any
0x1C Encoder to receive parameter Address Data (MSB) Data (LSB)
0x23 Encoder to send parameter Address Any Any
0x2A Encoder to receive reset Any Any Any

The message from the encoder contains a CRC which is checked. If there are no errors in the message, then the message is put into the comms buffer.
The position is retrieved from the drive buffer most significant byte first (Byte 0) and least significant byte last (Byte 7). An example is shown below where
a 48 bit value has been read from the encoder which contains an error bit (Bit 0) and 47 bits of position data (Bits 1 to 47) where Bit 1 is the least
signficant bit of the position. If there are less position bits the position is right justified with leading zeros.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 99
Byte 0 Byte 7

0 0 Bits47-40 Bits 39-32 Bits 31-24 Bits 23-16 Bits 15-8 Bits 7-0

If any other command is sent the response is shown below. The response is available when the encoder has responded, but for "Encoder to recieve
parameter" and "Encoder to receive reset" commands there is an additional delay of 12ms and 20ms respectively to allow the encoder to be ready again.

Byte 0 Byte 2
Address Data (MSB) Data (LSB)

EnDat
Up to 4 bytes can be written to the buffer in the same format as for EnDat 2.1. The following commands are supported.

Code Command Address Data (MSB) Data (LSB)


Encoder to send position value with additional information and select MRS Block
0x09 0x00
memory area code address
Encoder to send position value with additional information and receive
0x1B Address Data (MSB) Data (LSB)
parameters
Encoder to send position value with additional information and send
0x24 Address Any Any
parameters
Encoder to send position value with additional information and receive
0x2D Any Any Any
error reset
0x36 Encoder to send position values and receive test command Any Any Any

The message from the encoder contains a CRC which is checked. If there are no errors in the message the message is put into the comms buffer.

Byte 0 Byte 2
Additional information 1 Byte 0
(B7) WRN
(B6) RM
(B5) Busy
(B4) I4 Additional Information 1 Byte 1 Additional Information 1 Byte 2
(B3) I3
(B2) I2
(B1) I1
(B0) I0

It should be noted that the encoder is set up automatically so that it always returns Additional Information 1 with no data contents. An MRS is sent to the
encoder to select which data contents should be included in Additional Information 1. An MRS code can also be used to select Additional Information 1,
Additional Information 2 or no Additional Information to be sent from the encoder, but these commands must not be used. Although the contents of
Additional Information 1 can be changed the encoder should always be in the state where it transmits only Additional Information 1.

BiSS, SC BiSS
It is possible to read or write to 8 bit registers in a BiSS device. The addressing range is 0 to 127 giving access to 128 registers. Two bytes should be
written to the buffer for both read or write operations. Byte 0 contains the command in bit 7 (0 = read, 1= write) and the register address in bit 6 to bit 0.
For reading Byte 1 can contain any value, for writing it should contain the data to be written.

Byte 0 Byte 1
Command + Address Data

The response is always two bytes as shown below. Byte 0 is the same as Byte 0 in the request sent to the drive. For reading Byte 1 is the value read
from the register and for writing it is always zero.

Byte 0 Byte 1
Command + Address Data

Parameter 03.068 P1 User Comms Transmit Register


Short description Defines the value present in the user comms transmit register
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read/write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC, PT, BU

See P1 User Comms Enable (03.067).

Parameter 03.069 P1 User Comms Receive Register


Short description Defines the value present in the user comms receive register
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read/write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC, PT, BU

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


100 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
See P1 User Comms Enable (03.067).

Parameter 03.070 P1 Position Feedback Signals


Short description Shows the state of the signals from the position feedback device
Mode RFC‑A
0 63
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 000000) (Display: 111111)
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

P1 Position Feedback Signals (03.070) shows the state of the signals from the position feedback device as given in the table below where the signals are
relevant for the type of device. P1 Position Feedback Signals (03.070) is only intended as a debugging aid.

P1 Position Feedback Signals (03.070) bits Signals


0 A or F or Cos
1 B or D or R or Sin
2 Z
3 U
4 V
5 W

For Cos and Sin signals the relevant bits of P1 Position Feedback Signals (03.070) will be set when the signals are positive and cleared when the signals
are negative.

Parameter 03.071 P1 Error Detected


Indicates if an error has been detected with the position feedback device connected to the P1 position
Short description
interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

P1 Error Detected (03.071) is set if an error has been detected with the position feedback device connected to the P1 position interface. This parameter
is useful if encoder trips have been disabled by setting bit 3 of P1 Error Detection Level (03.040). It should be noted that this bit is not set if specific trips
are disabled with bits 0 to 2 of P1 Error Detection Level (03.040).

Parameter 03.073 P1 Absolute Turns Recovery Enable


Set to 1 to allow turns information beyond the number of turns bits provided by the position feedback
Short description
device connected to P1 to be stored on power-down and recovered at next power-up
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P1 Absolute Turns Recovery Enable (03.073) can be used to remove the masking applied to P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028) for any type of
position feedback device. If P1 Device Type (03.038) is set to EnDat, SC.EnDat, SC.Hiperface, SSI, SC.SSI, and BiSS then this parameter has an
additional feature which allows turns bits beyond the number of turns bits provided by the position feedback device to be stored on power-down and then
recovered on the next power-up. P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028) is saved as a power-down save parameter. If
P1 Absolute Turns Recovery Enable (03.073) = 0 the value saved at power-down is ignored on the next power-up and P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter
(03.028) is set up based on the information provided by the position feedback device. For example a device with 12 turns bits can define the position with
up to 4096 turns. If P1 Absolute Turns Recovery Enable (03.073) = 1 the turns beyond those provide by the position feedback device are simulated from
the saved value. This means that 65536 turns can be generated from a position feedback device with any number of turns bits. The following should be
noted:

1. If the position feedback device moves by more than +/-1/4 of the range of the most significant turns bit while powered down the turns at power-up
will not be correct. For example a device with 12 turns bits must not move by more than the range defined by 10 turns bits, or a device with no
turns bits must not move by more than 1/4 of a turn.
2. This feature is not applicable to linear position feedback devices.
3. If an SSI based device is being used then P1 SSI Incremental Mode (03.047) must be set to one.
4. The recovered turns bits are stored in P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028). To reset the additional bits P1 Absolute Turns Recovery Enable
(03.073) should be set to zero to remove the recovered turns bits. A parameter save should then be initiated using a value of 1 or 1001 in
parameter mm.000 to save the contents of P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028). Absolute turns recovery can then be selected again by
setting P1 Absolute Turns Recovery Enable (03.073) to one.
5. Absolute turns recovery is not possible when Low Under Voltage Threshold Select (06.067) = 1 or Backup Supply Mode Enable (06.068) = 1
or User Supply Select (06.072) = 1. If absolute turns recovery is required when one of these modes is enabled then a user save (Parameter
mm.000 (mm.000) = 1 or 1001) should be performed before the drive is powered down.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 101
Parameter 03.074 P1 Additional Configuration
Provides additional configuration information for the position feedback device not included in the other
Short description
set-up parameters.
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 511116116
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P1 Additional Configuration (03.074) provides configuration information, not covered by the other set-up parameters, for the position feedback device
connected to the P1 position feedback interface and is specific to the type of device being used.

P1 Device Type (03.038): BiSS, SC BiSS

This parameter is split into 3 fields as shown below.

Decimal
9-6 5-3 2-0
Digits
CRC Rotary Turns Rotary Position
polynomial Padding Padding
Default 0067 000 000

CRC polynomial
The CRC polynomial is a bit representation of the terms of a polynomial used to generate the CRC applied to the position and the additional data
transferred to/from the encoder via the BiSS communications channel. The standard value is 0067 which in hexadecimal is 0x0043, or in binary form is
0000 0000 0100 0011. The bits that are set to one show which terms exist in the polynomial. The standard value has bits 6, 1 and 0 set to one and gives
the polynomial normally used with BiSS encoders which is X6+X1+1. If the encoder uses a different polynomial then this can be selected with the four
digits (9-6). The maximum value is 511 (0x01FF), and so a polynomial up to degree 10 can be set up.

Rotary Turns Padding


The turns, and position within a turn, provided by a rotary encoder may not completely fill the number of bits provided. The unfilled bits will normally be
padded with zeros. The total number of bits provided for the turns including zero padding is given by P1 Rotary Turns Bits (03.033). The zero padding is
given by decimal digits 5 to 3 of P1 Additional Configuration (03.074). Digits 4 and 3 give the number of bits and digit 5 specifies whether the padding is
on the left (0) or on the right (1). For example a value of 104 would specify 4 padding bits on the right of the turns data. The default value of 000 specifies
no padding. If the padding value is outside the range +/-16 then an Encoder 14 is initiated. If right padding is specified the turns data will be shifted right
by the number of padding bits as shown below. If left padding is specified it simply means that there are zeros to the left of the turns information, and so
no adjustment is required. Therefore specifying left padding is optional. It is not possible to specify padding for linear encoders.

Data from encoder with 4 right padding bits

1 0 1 1 0 0 0 0

Data after adjustment for padding bits

0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1

Rotary Position Padding


The total number of bits provided for position within a turn is given by P1 Comms Bits (03.035) - P1 Rotary Turns Bits (03.033). The zero padding is given
by decimal digits 2 to 0 of P1 Additional Configuration (03.074) in the same manner as is used for the turns padding. If left padding is specified the turns
data will be shifted left by the number of padding bits as shown below. If right padding is specified it simply means that there are zeros to the right of the
position information, and so no adjustment is required. Therefore specifying right padding is optional.

Data from encoder with 4 left padding bits

0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1

Data after adjustment for padding bits

1 0 1 1 0 0 0 0

P1 Device Type (03.038): Any other device type


This parameter has no effect.

Parameter 03.075 Initialise Position Feedback


Short description Set to 1 to re-initialise any position feedback device connected
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If Initialise Position Feedback (03.075) is set to one any position feedback devices connected to the drive position feedback interfaces or any position
feedback category option modules will be re-initialised.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


102 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 03.076 Position Feedback Initialized
Short description Indicates the initialisation state of position feedback devices connected
Mode RFC‑A
0 1023
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0000000000) (Display: 1111111111)
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Position Feedback Initialized (03.076) contains flags that represent the initialisation state of position feedback devices connected to the drive position
feedback interfaces or position feedback interfaces on position feedback category option modules. One indicates that the interface is initialised and zero
indicates that the interface is not initialised. The flags are assigned as shown below.

Bit Position feedback interface


0 P1 Drive
1 P2 Drive
2 P1 Option slot 1
3 P2 Option slot 1
4 P1 Option slot 2
5 P2 Option slot 2
6 P1 Option slot 3
7 P2 Option slot 3
8 P1 Option slot 4
9 P2 Option slot 4

If no option module, or an option module other than a position feedback category module, is fitted in an option slot then the relevant flag is always set to
one. If an attempt is made to enable the drive when any of the flags are zero the drive initiates an Encoder 7 trip. If a drive reset is initiated, the bits
in Position Feedback Initialized (03.076) are checked, and if any position feedback devices are not initialised an attempt is made to initialise them.

The table below shows the initialisation process for different position feedback devices that can be connected to the drive.

Encoder types Initialisation process


AB, FD, FR
None. Initialisation is immediate and is always successful. The position feedback is set to zero on initialisation.
Resolver

AB Servo The absolute position used to control a motor can only be defined accurately after two different changes of state of the UVW
FD Servo commutation signals. Initialisation resets the system that ensures that the UVW signals alone will be used to define the motor position
FR Servo until the encoder has moved through two valid commutation signal state changes. Initialisation is immediate and is always successful.
SC Servo The position feedback is set to zero on initialisation.

The SINCOS interpolation system must be initialised. Initialisation is immediate and is always successful. The position feedback is set to
SC
zero on initialisation.

SC Hiperface Auto-configuration if required except SC SSI.


SC EnDat The absolute position must be obtained via comms. This may cause a large change in position feedback.
SC SSI The SINCOS interpolation system must be initialised. This may have a small effect on the position feedback.

EnDat
Auto-configuration if required except SSI.
BiSS
The absolute position must be obtained via comms. This may cause a large change in position feedback.
SSI

The absolute position used to control a motor is obtained from the sine and cosine signals provided for one revolution until the marker
pulse occurs. The position obtained from the marker pulse is assumed to be a position of zero. Once a marker has occurred the
incremental position is used and the single turn sine wave signals are ignored. When the position feedback device is initialised the single
SC SC
turn sine wave signals are used again until another marker event occurs. No part of the initialisation process affects the position
feedback seen in parameters, except that the SINCOS interpolation system must be initialised which may have a small effect on the
position feedback. Initialisation is immediate and is always successful.

Parameter 03.078 Sensorless Mode Active


Short description Indicates that sensorless mode is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

If Sensorless Mode Active (03.078) = 0 it indicates that the position feedback selected with Motor Control Feedback Select (03.026) is being used for
motor control. If Sensorless Sensorless Mode Active (03.078) = 1 it indicates that the sensorless algorithm is being used instead.
See RFC Feedback Mode (03.024) for more information.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 103
Parameter 03.079 Sensorless Mode Filter
Short description Sensorless Mode Filter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units ms
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 4
1 8
2 16
3 32
4 64

When sensorless mode is active the measured speed can include some ripple, which increases as the drive passes into field weakening. A filter is applied
to the estimated speed and Sensorless Mode Filter (03.079) defines the time constant. The default time constant is 4ms, but this can be extended to
improve the filtering. This is particularly useful when using standard ramp or spinning start with a low friction high inertia load, and can prevent over
voltage trips when the drive has no braking resistor.

Parameter 03.080 Sensorless Position


Short description Displays the motor position when sensorless mode is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

When the drive is operating without position feedback Sensorless Position (03.080) gives the motor position where the least significant 16 bits represent a
movement equivalent to one pole of the motor. The most significant 16 bits represent turns where one turn is the movement associate with one pole. For
example in a rotary application with a 4 pole motor, the movement associated with one pole is a mechanical movement of 180°. In RFC-A mode
Sensorless Position (03.080) is aligned with the motor flux and voltages, but this has no fixed relationship to the mechanical position of the rotor.

Parameter 03.085 Encoder Simulation Source


Short description Defines the source parameter used for the encoder simulation
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

Encoder Simulation Source (03.085) is used to select a parameter as the input to the encoder simulation system. If Encoder Simulation Source (03.085) is
zero then no source is selected and the encoder simulation system is disabled. The encoder simulation output connections are shared with the P1 and P2
position feedback interfaces, and so encoder simulation may be disabled because the connections are not available. See Encoder Simulation Status
(03.086) for details.

Any parameter can be selected as the source, but it is assumed that the input is a 16 bit value with a range from 0 to 65535 or from -32768 to 32767. The
source parameter is treated differently depending on the value of Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088) as given in the table below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


104 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Encoder Simulation Mode
(03.088)
Encoder Simulation Source (03.085) must be set to 3.029 for the output to be
Hardware (0) enabled and the position from the P1 position feedback interface is used
and P1 Position (03.029) is the source.

If Encoder Simulation Source (03.085) = 3.029 (i.e. P1 Position (03.029) is the


source) then P1 Position (03.029) and P1 Fine Position (03.030) are combined as a
16 bit value with 16 bit fractional part as the input to the encoder simulation system,
which gives additional output resolution if encoder simulation ratio is greater than
unity.

Lines Per Rev (1) or Ratio The encoder simulation system is intended to be used with a 16 bit source
(2) parameter. If the source of the encoder simulation system is not a 16 bit parameter
then the drive uses the source parameter as follows.

1 bit parameter: Zero extended


8 bit parameter: Sign extended if BU attribute is zero (signed), otherwise
zero extended (unsigned)
32 bit parameter: Only the least significant word is used.

For SSI output mode the number of bits included in the output can be selected
SSI (3)
(see Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088) for details).

Although Encoder Simulation Source (03.085) is not a standard source parameter in common with other sources the actual source is only changed on
drive reset.

Parameter 03.086 Encoder Simulation Status


Short description Displays the status of the encoder simulation
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text
0 None
1 Full
2 No Marker Pulse

The availability of the encoder simulation output on the 15 way connector on the drive is dependent on the type of feedback device selected
with P1 Device Type (03.038). Priority is as follows from highest to lowest priority:

1. P1 position feedback interface


2. Encoder simulation output
3. P2 position feedback interface

Encoder Simulation Status (03.086) shows the status of the encoder simulation output.

0: None
The encoder simulation output is not enabled or is not available.

1: Full
Full encoder simulation with marker output is available.

2: No Marker
Encoder simulation without marker output is available.

Parameter 03.087 Encoder Simulation Sample Period


Short description Defines the sample period of the encoder simulation
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default 0 Units ms
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 0.25
1 1
2 4
3 16

The update rate of the encoder simulation system is nominally 250μs, i.e. default value of Encoder Simulation Sample Period (03.087), but if the update
rate of the source parameter is different, the encoder simulation output will consist of bursts of pulses at the update rate of the parameter. To prevent this

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 105
and to give a smooth output, the update rate can be adjusted with Encoder Simulation Sample Period (03.087). Encoder Simulation Sample Period
(03.087) has no effect if hardware mode is selected, i.e. Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088) = 0.

Parameter 03.088 Encoder Simulation Mode


Short description Defines the mode of the encoder simulation
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Hardware
1 Lines Per Rev
2 Ratio
3 SSI

Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088) defines the encoder simulation output as incremental signals (AB, FD or FR) derived directly via hardware,
incremental signals generated via software or SSI data generated via software.

0: Hardware
The encoder simulation output is derived directly in hardware from the P1 position feedback interface in the drive and the output is derived from the input
with negligible delay. The ratio between the input at the P1 interface and the output is either unity or a limited number of binary divider ratios
(see Encoder Simulation Hardware Divider (03.089)). Hardware mode only produces an output with AB, FD, FR, SC, SC Hiperface, SC EnDat or SC SSI
type devices. It should be noted that with a SINCOS source device the output is based on the zero crossings of the sine wave inputs and does not include
interpolation. If Encoder Simulation Hardware Marker Lock (03.090) = 0 the marker output is derived directly from the marker input. If
Encoder Simulation Hardware Marker Lock (03.090) = 1 the incremental output signals are adjusted on each marker event so that the A and B are high
with an AB type output, or F is high with an FD or FR type output. Marker locking is not recommended if the number of lines per revolution of the encoder
simulation source combined with the ratio does not give an encoder simulation output with a multiple of 4 counts per revolution (i.e. between each output
marker event) for AB signals, or a multiple of 2 counts for FD or FR signals, because this causes a count error in the system receiving these signals. The
input marker pulse width is not adjusted to take account of the divider ratio, but is simply routed from the input to the output. Therefore the output marker
pulse becomes shorter with respect to the output incremental signals as the divider ratio is increased.

1: Lines Per Rev


The encoder simulation output is derived via software from the selected source with a resolution defined
by Encoder Simulation Output Lines Per Revolution (03.092) with a minimum delay of 250μs which may be extended
if Encoder Simulation Sample Period (03.087) is set up for a longer sample period. Note that the number of output lines per revolution apply to a
quadrature (AB) type device, and that if FD or FR mode are selected the number of lines per revolution are 2 x
Encoder Simulation Output Lines Per Revolution (03.092). The output is derived by applying a ratio and output counter roll-over limit defined by
Encoder Simulation Output Lines Per Revolution (03.092) as shown below. The output marker is produced when the output counter is zero.

If P1 Position (03.029) is selected as the source and Encoder Simulation Incremental Mode Select (03.091) = 0 then the input and output counters are
synchronised at power-up and when the P1 position feedback interface becomes initialised, so that the output marker is synchronised with zero position
for the P1 position feedback interface. For devices that support a marker, the effect of the marker on the position can be selected using P1 Marker Mode
(03.031). At power-up and on device initialisation there will be a step change in position from zero to the actual position from the device and the pulses
necessary to make this change are produced at the encoder simulation output. If a marker event occurs that causes a step change in position, again the
necessary pulses will be produced for this change of position. Where large sudden changes occur the maximum output frequency is limited to 500kHz,
and so it may take some time for the output position to reach the input position. This mode of operation gives an initial position change from zero position
and then follows all changes of position from that point onwards, and may be used to follow the absolute position of the device connected to the P1
position feedback interface.

If P1 Position (03.029) is selected as the source and Encoder Simulation Incremental Mode Select (03.091) = 1 then the encoder simulation output only
follows the changes of source position. At power-up, on device initialisation and a marker event no additional pulses are produced to give the absolute
position of the device related to zero position. The encoder simulation output markers is not synchronised to the source marker.

If a source other than P1 Position (03.029) is selected Encoder Simulation Incremental Mode Select (03.091) has no effect and the encoder simulation
system always operates in absolute mode.

2: Ratio
The encoder simulation is derived in the same way as described previously for Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088) = 1 (i.e. lines per rev mode), except
that different parameters are used to set up the system giving more flexibility as shown below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


106 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
With the default settings (Encoder Simulation Numerator (03.093) = 65536, Encoder Simulation Denominator (03.094) = 65536
and Encoder Simulation Output Roll-over Limit (03.095) = 65535) the output produces a state change each time the source parameter changes by one.
The numerator and denominator can be changed to provide a different ratio between the source and the output. Output markers are produced each time
the output counter is zero and the counters are synchronised in the same way as for lines per rev mode. It is possible to control the roll-over limit of the
output counter and hence the rate at which output markers are produced using Encoder Simulation Output Roll-over Limit (03.095). For example if the
ratio is set to 1024/ 65536 and the roll-over limit is 1023 then one output marker is produced for every 1024 lines of output incremental signals. If the roll-
over limit is changed to 512, then two output markers are produced for every 1024 lines of output incremental signals.

3: SSI
In this mode the B output becomes the clock input and the A output is the data output. If the source position is the P1 position feedback interface the data
from the position feedback interface is transferred to the SSI output register once per sample period defined by Encoder Simulation Sample Period
(03.087). An example is given below which shows how the data is aligned.

The SSI output is then clocked out from the register as shown in another example below which includes 15 bits of data.

It should be noted that the data is shifted out by a clock that is produced by the SSI master connected to the encoder simulation interface as the interface
is emulating an SSI encoder. However, unlike an SSI encoder the position data is not sampled on the first edge of the clock, but is updated by the drive at
the rate defined by Encoder Simulation Sample Period (03.087). If the P1 position interface is being used as the source the power supply alarm bit (PS) is
the inverse of the initialised flag in Position Feedback Initialized (03.076) related to this interface. The master can clock out as many bits of data as
required, but once the power supply alarm bit has been produced the output will remain low. The SSI interface reset time (tm) of 20μs is required so that
the interface can detect the end of the transmission and reset itself so that the output data begins again at the most significant bit. During this period the
master should hold the clock line high. The master should not use a clock frequency of less than 50kHz or else spurious reset periods may be detected.

If any other parameter is used as the source the most significant M bits of the source parameter are used, where M
= Encoder Simulation SSI Comms Bits (03.097) - 1. If the source parameter has less than M bits then trailing zeros are added. The power supply alarm bit
is always zero in this mode.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 107
Parameter 03.089 Encoder Simulation Hardware Divider
Defines the divider ratio between the device connected to the P1 interface and the encoder simulation
Short description
output when hardware simulation mode is used
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 7
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If hardware mode is selected (i.e. Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088) = 0) then Encoder Simulation Hardware Divider (03.089) defines the divider ratio
between the device connected to the P1 position feedback interface and the output as 1/2 Encoder Simulation Hardware Divider (03.089). The maximum allowed
input frequency is 500kHz, and so the maximum output frequency with the highest ratio of unity is 500kHz.

Parameter 03.090 Encoder Simulation Hardware Marker Lock


Short description Defines if the marker output is derived directly from the marker input
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088).

Parameter 03.091 Encoder Simulation Incremental Mode Select


Short description Set to 1 to select incremental mode for the encoder simulation
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088).

Parameter 03.092 Encoder Simulation Output Lines Per Revolution


Short description Defines the required lines per revolution when using the encoder simulation mode of Lines Per Rev
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 16384
Default 4096 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088).

Parameter 03.093 Encoder Simulation Numerator


Short description Defines the numerator when using the encoder simulation mode of Ratio
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 65536
Default 65536 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088).

Parameter 03.094 Encoder Simulation Denominator


Short description Defines the denominator when using the encoder simulation mode of Ratio
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 65536
Default 65536 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


108 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 03.095 Encoder Simulation Output Roll-over Limit
Defines the roll-over limit of the output counter and hence the rate at which output markers are
Short description
produced when using the encoder simulation mode of Ratio
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 65535
Default 65535 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

See Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088).

Parameter 03.096 Encoder Simulation SSI Turns Bits


Short description Defines the number of bits of the outputted SSI data that are used to represent turns information
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 16
Default 16 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088).

Parameter 03.097 Encoder Simulation SSI Comms Bits


Short description Defines the total number of bits of SSI data to be outputted
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 2 Maximum 48
Default 33 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088).

Parameter 03.098 Encoder Simulation Output Mode


Short description Defines the format of the encoder simulation output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 AB/Gray
1 FD/Binary
2 FR/Binary

Encoder Simulation Output Mode (03.098) is used to select the format of the encoder simulation output as given in the table below.

Encoder Simulation Mode Encoder Simulation Output Mode


Format
(03.088) (03.098)
Hardware (0), Lines Per
AB/Gray AB quadrature signals
Rev (1), Ratio (2)
Hardware (0), Lines Per
FD/Binary Frequency and direction signals
Rev (1), Ratio (2)
Hardware (0), Lines Per
FR/Binary Forward and reverse signals
Rev (1), Ratio (2)
The position data is in Gray code format. This
SSI (3) AB/Gray does not include the “power supply” bit if
present.
SSI (3) FD/Binary, FR/Binary The position data is in binary format

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 109
Parameter 03.100 F1 Freeze Trigger Source
Short description Used to select the source that generates trigger events for the F1 system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 6
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Digital Input 4
1 Digital Input 5
2 P1 Marker
3 P2 Marker
4 Common
5 P1 Zero
6 P2 Zero

F1 Freeze Trigger Source (03.100) is used to select the source that generates trigger events for the F1 system.

0, 1: Dig I/O 4, Dig I/O 5


Digital I/O 4 or Digital I/O 5 on the drive can be used as trigger sources. If the digital I/O is set up as an input, then trigger events will be produced on the
relevant edge of the input signal. If the digital I/O is set up as an output, then trigger events will be produced on the relevant edge of the output signal.

2, 3: Z1, Z2
Z1 selects the P1 position feedback interface marker input as the trigger source and Z2 selects the P2 position feedback interface marker input as the
trigger source. No trigger events will be produced unless the selected maker input is available.

4: Common
The output of the common freeze line is selected. If the output of the drive common freeze system is enabled (Bit 3 of Common Freeze Mode (03.112) =
1) then the drive common freeze system provides the freeze event triggers. If the output of the drive common freeze system is disabled the option module
freeze line provides the freeze event triggers.

5, 6: P1 Zero, P2 Zero
A freeze event is triggered when the turns for the respective position feedback interface change (i.e. the feedback position passes through zero in either
direction). The freeze position stored in F1 Normalised Freeze Position (03.103) or F2 Normalised Freeze Position (03.108) will include the turns
associated with the zero position whichever direction the position changes. For example if the turns change from 4 to 5 or 5 to 4 the turns value stored is
5. This mode can be used as a substitute for a physical marker, with a position device that does not have one, to trigger an event to occur at the zero
position of the feeback device. For example, it can be used with the AMC to start a CAM at the zero position of the feedback device. It should be noted
that if P1 Zero is selected as the trigger source then F1 Freeze Position Source (03.102) has no effect and P1 is always used as the freeze position
source. If P2 Zero is selected as the trigger source then F1 Freeze Position Source (03.102) has no effect and P2 is always used as the freeze position
source. This is because these freeze trigger sources are only intended to capture the zero position of the device being used to give the zero position
trigger event.

Parameter 03.101 F1 Freeze Mode


Short description Sets the mode used for the F1 freeze system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Rising 1st
1 Falling 1st
2 Rising all
3 Falling all

0: Rising 1st
Freeze events are produced on the rising edge of the freeze trigger source. If the F1 Freeze Flag (03.104) is 0 then the first suitable edge produced by the
trigger source causes the freeze position to be stored and the F1 Freeze Flag (03.104) to be set to 1. No further freeze events are possible until
the F1 Freeze Flag (03.104) has been cleared by the user.

1: Falling 1st
As for Rising 1st, but the falling edge is used to trigger freeze events.

2: Rising All
Freeze events are produced on the rising edge of the freeze trigger source. If the F1 Freeze Flag (03.104) is 0 then the first suitable edge produced by the
trigger source causes the freeze position to be stored and the F1 Freeze Flag (03.104) to be set to 1. If further suitable edges are produced by the trigger
source the freeze position is updated with the current position.

3: Falling All
As for Rising All, but the falling edge is used to trigger freeze events.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


110 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 03.102 F1 Freeze Position Source
Short description Defines the source position for the F1 freeze system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 P1
1 P2
2 Time

F1 Freeze Position Source (03.102) defines the source for the F1 freeze system as follows:

P1 or P2
When a freeze event occurs, the position from the relevant position feedback interface within the drive (i.e. P1 or P2), including the effect of the marker
(see P1 Marker Mode (03.031)), is stored and can be accessed as a 32 bit normalised value in F1 Normalised Freeze Position (03.103). For a digital
incremental source (AB, FD, FR, AB Servo, FD Servo or FR Servo) the position is captured at the freeze event using a hardware system. For a resolver
the freeze position is the position at the last 250us sample point. For all other position feedback devices the time of the freeze event is captured with
hardware and then interpolation, based on the change of position during the previous nominal 250us period, is used to estimate the position at the freeze
event.

Time
The time of the freeze event is stored with respect to the last datum used by the position feedback system and option modules fitted to the drive. These
datum events occur at a nominal rate of 250us, but if the drive timing is being synchronised by the comms system in an option module then the actual
timing may vary slightly depending on the accuracy of the clock providing the sysnchronisation. The time stored in F1 Normalised Freeze Position
(03.103) is given as a proportion of the nominal 250us time period where 65536 corresponds to one nomial 250us time period. Note that the value may be
positive or negative. Positive values give the time of an event that occured after the last datum, but before the freeze information is processed. Negative
values give the time of an event that occurred before the datum, but after the previous time when the freeze information was processed. The time of the
freeze event could be used, for example, to determine the value of a virtual position being generated within an option module at the freeze event. The
calculated value would only be meaningful if the freeze information is used during the period between the position datum before and after the freeze
event, because the time is related to the datum before the freeze information is made available.

Parameter 03.103 F1 Normalised Freeze Position


Short description Displays the normalised position from the F1 freeze system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See F1 Freeze Position Source (03.102).

Parameter 03.104 F1 Freeze Flag


Short description Displays when a freeze event occurs from the F1 freeze system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, ND, NC, PT

The freeze flag is set when a freeze event occurs. If 0 is written to F1 Freeze Flag (03.104) the freeze flag is cleared.

Parameter 03.105 F2 Freeze Trigger Source


Short description User to select the source that generates trigger events for the F2 freeze system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 6
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 111
Value Text
0 Digital Input 4
1 Digital Input 5
2 P1 Marker
3 P2 Marker
4 Common
5 P1 Zero
6 P2 Zero

F2 Freeze Trigger Source (03.105) is used to select the source that generates trigger events for the F2 freeze system.

0, 1: Dig I/O 4, Dig I/O 5


Digital I/O 4 or Digital I/O 5 on the drive can be used as trigger sources. If the digital I/O is set up as an input, then trigger events will be produced on the
relevant edge of the input signal. If the digital I/O is set up as an output, then trigger events will be produced on the relevant edge of the output signal.

2, 3: Z1, Z2
Z1 selects the P1 position feedback interface marker input as the trigger source and Z2 selects the P2 position feedback interface marker input as the
trigger source. No trigger events will be produced unless the selected maker input is available.

4: Common
The output of the common freeze line is selected. If the output of the drive common freeze system is enabled (Bit 3 of Common Freeze Mode (03.112) =
1) then the drive common freeze system provides the freeze event triggers. If the output of the drive common freeze system is disabled the option module
freeze line provides the freeze event triggers.

5, 6: P1 Zero, P2 Zero
A freeze event is triggered when the turns for the respective position feedback interface change (i.e. the feedback position passes through zero in either
direction). The freeze position stored in F1 Normalised Freeze Position (03.103) or F2 Normalised Freeze Position (03.108) will include the turns
associated with the zero position whichever direction the position changes. For example if the turns change from 4 to 5 or 5 to 4 the turns value stored is
5. This mode can be used as a substitute for a physical marker with a position device that does not have one to trigger an event to occur at the zero
position of the feeback device. For example, it can be used with the AMC to start a CAM at the zero position of the feedback device. It should be noted
that if P1 Zero is selected as the trigger source then F1 Freeze Position Source (03.102) has no effect and P1 is always used as the freeze position
source. If P2 Zero is selected as the trigger source then F1 Freeze Position Source (03.102) has no effect and P2 is always used as the freeze position
source. This is because these freeze trigger sources are only intended to capture the zero position of the device being used to give the zero position
trigger event.

Parameter 03.106 F2 Freeze Mode


Short description Defines the mode for the F2 freeze system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Rising 1st
1 Falling 1st
2 Rising all
3 Falling all

0: Rising 1st
Freeze events are produced on the rising edge of the freeze trigger source. If the F2 Freeze Flag (03.109) is 0 then the first suitable edge produced by the
trigger source causes the freeze position to be stored and the F2 Freeze Flag (03.109) to be set to 1. No further freeze events are possible until
the F2 Freeze Flag (03.109) has been cleared by the user.

1: Falling 1st
As for Rising 1st, but the falling edge is used to trigger freeze events.

2: Rising All
Freeze events are produced on the rising edge of the freeze trigger source. If the F2 Freeze Flag (03.109) is 0 then the first suitable edge produced by the
trigger source causes the freeze position to be stored and the F2 Freeze Flag (03.109) to be set to 1. If further suitable edges are produced by the trigger
source the freeze position is updated with the current position.

3: Falling All
As for Rising All, but the falling edge is used to trigger freeze events.

Parameter 03.107 F2 Freeze Position Source


Short description Defines the source position for the F2 freeze system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


112 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Value Text
0 P1
1 P2
2 Time

F2 Freeze Position Source (03.107) defines the source for the F1 freeze system as follows:

P1 or P2
When a freeze event occurs, the position from the relevant position feedback interface within the drive (i.e. P1 or P2), including the effect of the marker
(see P1 Marker Mode (03.031)), is stored and can be accessed as a 32 bit normalised value in F2 Normalised Freeze Position (03.108). For a digital
incremental source (AB, FD, FR, AB Servo, FD Servo or FR Servo) the position is captured at the freeze event using a hardware system. For a resolver
the freeze position is the position at the last 250us sample point. For all other position feedback devices the time of the freeze event is captured with
hardware and then interpolation, based on the change of position during the previous nominal 250us period, is used to estimate the position at the freeze
event.

Time
The time of the freeze event is stored with respect to the last datum used by the position feedback system and option modules fitted to the drive. These
datum events occur at a nominal rate of 250us, but if the drive timing is being synchronised by the comms system in an option module then the actual
timing may vary slightly depending on the accuracy of the clock providing the sysnchronisation. The time stored in F2 Normalised Freeze Position
(03.108) is given as a proportion of the nominal 250us time period where 65536 corresponds to one nomial 250us time period. Note that the value may be
positive or negative. Positive values give the time of an event that occured after the last datum, but before the freeze information is processed. Negative
values give the time of an event that occurred before the datum, but after the previous time when the freeze information was processed. The time of the
freeze event could be used, for example, to determine the value of a virtual position being generated within an option module at the freeze event. The
calculated value would only be meaningful if the freeze information is used during the period between the position datum before and after the freeze
event, because the time is related to the datum before the freeze information is made available.

Parameter 03.108 F2 Normalised Freeze Position


Short description Displays the normalised position from the F2 freeze system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See F2 Freeze Position Source (03.107).

Parameter 03.109 F2 Freeze Flag


Short description Displays when a freeze event occurs from the F2 freeze system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, ND, NC, PT

The freeze flag is set when a freeze event occurs. If 0 is written to F2 Freeze Flag (03.109) the freeze flag is cleared.

Parameter 03.110 Common Freeze Source 1


Short description Defines source 1 for the common freeze system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Digital Input 4
1 Digital Input 5
2 P1 Marker
3 P2 Marker
4 Disabled

See F1 Freeze Trigger Source (03.100) or F2 Freeze Trigger Source (03.105). It should be noted that if the Disabled option is selected then the input is
set to a one.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 113
Parameter 03.111 Common Freeze Source 2
Short description Defines source 2 for the common freeze system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Digital Input 4
1 Digital Input 5
2 P1 Marker
3 P2 Marker
4 Disabled

See F1 Freeze Trigger Source (03.100) or F2 Freeze Trigger Source (03.105). It should be noted that if the Disabled option is selected then the input is
set to a one.

Parameter 03.112 Common Freeze Mode


Short description Defines the mode used for the common freeze system
Mode RFC‑A
0 15
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0000) (Display: 1111)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0000)
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The common freeze system can be used to logically combine two freeze trigger sources. The switches in the common freeze system are controlled by the
bits in Common Freeze Mode (03.112) as defined in the table below.

Bit Function
0 Source 1 input invert 1
1 Source 2 input invert
2 Output invert
3 Output enable

Therefore the value defined bits 2 to 0 can be used to generate various logic functions as given in the table below.

Bits 2 to 0 Function
0 Source1 AND Source2
1 NOT(Source1) AND Source2
2 Source1 AND NOT(Source2)
3 Source1 NOR Source2
4 Source1 NAND Source2
5 NOT(Source1) NAND Source2
6 Source1 NAND NOT(Source2)
7 Source1 OR Source2

Parameter 03.113 Freeze Input States


Short description Displays the level of the selected freeze inputs
Mode RFC‑A
0 3
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00) (Display: 11)
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

The bits in Freeze Input States (03.113) show the level of the selected freeze trigger inputs. Bit 0 corresponds to F1 freeze input and bit 1 corresponds to
F2 freeze input. It should be noted that if the trigger option is P1Zero or P2Zero there is no hardware trigger input, and so the relevant bit is always zero.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


114 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 03.114 F1 Freeze Sensor Delay
Short description Used to compensate for the sensor delay for F1 freeze channel.
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 250.0
Default 0.0 Units µs
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

Any delay in the sensor used to trigger a freeze event in the drive through freeze channel F1 or F2 will cause the freeze position to advance (give a larger
freeze position) in the forward direction or retard (give a smaller freeze position) in the reverse direction compared to the actual physical position. This
effect becomes worse as the speed is increased. The error for a rotary device is given by

Freeze Error = (Speed (rpm) / 60) x 2Normalised Position Bits x Sensor Time Delay

Where Normalised Position Bits is the number of bits representing one turn for the position feedback being used. For example Normalised Position Bits =
32 - P1 Normalisation Turns (03.057) if the position feedback is being taken from the drive P1 interface. The Sensor Delay Time also includes delays in
the drive electronics, but these are less than 500ns for either the digital I/O or the marker inputs. The delay compensation feature is only provided under
the following conditions, where examples are given for Freeze Channel F1.

1. The position source is not set to Time. (F1 Freeze Position Source (03.102) must be set to P1 or P2.)
2. The trigger source is not set to P1 Zero or P2 Zero. (F1 Freeze Trigger Source (03.100) must be set to Digital Input 4, Digital Input 5, P1 Marker,
P2 Marker or Common.)
3. The position feedback type must not be Resolver or Commutation Only.

Parameter 03.115 F2 Freeze Sensor Delay


Short description Used to compensate for the sensor delay for F2 freeze channel.
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 250.0
Default 0.0 Units µs
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

See F1 Freeze Sensor Delay (03.114).

Parameter 03.118 P1 Thermistor Type


Short description Defines the thermistor type for the P1 interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 DIN44082
1 KTY84
2 0.8mA
3 Encoder

P1 Thermistor Type (03.118) defines the operating mode of the P1 thermistor input.

P1 Thermistor Type
Compatible devices
(03.118)
Three thermistors in series as specified in
0: DIN44082
DIN44082 standard
1: KTY84 KTY84 PTC thermistor
2: 0.8mA Any device
3: Encoder EnDat 2.2 encoder

All except 3(Encoder)


If a device is connected between the pin 15 of the encoder interface and 0V a current source will pass 0.8mA through the device with a maximum voltage
of approximately 3.8V (i.e. maximum resistance of approximately 4750 Ohms). The resistance of the device is calculated and displayed in
P1 Thermistor Feedback (03.119). If P1 Thermistor Type (03.118) is set to select KTY84 the temperature is also calculated and written to
P1 Thermistor Temperature (03.122). Note that DIN44082 mode and 0.8mA mode operate in exactly the same way.

3 (Encoder)
If an EnDat 2.2 encoder which supports external temperature feedback is connected to the P1 position feedback interface then it is possible to obtain the
measured temperature from the encoder if P1 Thermistor Type (03.118) is set to 3. The temperature is displayed in P1 Thermistor Temperature
(03.122) and a resistance equivalent to that for a KTY84 device is displayed in P1 Thermistor Feedback (03.119). The drive does not check if an external
device is connected, but short circuit protection can be selected to detect if the device is not connected because the resistance will appear as zero.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 115
Parameter 03.119 P1 Thermistor Feedback
Short description Displays the resistance of the thermistor on the P1 interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5000
Default Units Ω
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See P1 Thermistor Type (03.118).

Parameter 03.120 P1 Thermistor Trip Threshold


Short description Defines the thermistor trip threshold for the P1 interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5000
Default 3300 Units Ω
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See P1 Thermistor Fault Detection (03.123).

Parameter 03.121 P1 Thermistor Reset Threshold


Short description Defines the thermistor reset threshold for the P1 interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5000
Default 1800 Units Ω
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See P1 Thermistor Fault Detection (03.123).

Parameter 03.122 P1 Thermistor Temperature


Displays the temperature of the device based on the resistance to temperature characteristic for the
Short description
specified device
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -50 Maximum 300
Default Units °C
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See P1 Thermistor Type (03.118).

Parameter 03.123 P1 Thermistor Fault Detection


Short description Defines the fault detection for the P1 thermsitor input
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 None
1 Temperature
2 Temp or Short

Defines the fault detection for the P1 thermsitor input:

P1 Thermistor Fault Detection


Fault detection
(03.123)
0: None No detection active
1: Temperature Over temperature detection
Over temperature and short circuit
2: Temp and short
detection

If over temperature detection is enabled a Thermistor.001 trip is initiated if P1 Thermistor Feedback (03.119) is above the level defined by

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


116 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
P1 Thermistor Trip Threshold (03.120). The trip cannot be reset until P1 Thermistor Feedback (03.119) is below P1 Thermistor Reset Threshold (03.121).

If short circuit detection is enabled then a Th Short Circuit.001 is initiated if P1 Thermistor Feedback (03.119) is below 50 Ohms.

Parameter 03.127 P2 Speed Feedback


Short description Displays the speed feedback from the P2 interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED[MAX]
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

Provided the set-up parameters for the position feedback device connected to the drive P2 position interface are correct P2 Speed Feedback (03.127)
shows the speed derived from the feedback. The speed is given in mm/s if P2 Linear Feedback Select (03.151) = 1 and Linear Speed Select (01.055) = 1,
otherwise it is given in rpm. The value shown is measured over a 16ms sliding window period, and so the ripple in this value is as defined
for Speed Feedback (03.002).

Parameter 03.128 P2 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter


Short description Displays the revolution/pole pitch counter from the P2 interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

P2 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.128), P2 Position (03.129) and P2 Fine Position (03.130) combined give the encoder position with a resolution of
1/232 of a revolution/pole pitch as a 48 bit number. If a rotary position feedback device is being used (P2 Linear Feedback Select (03.151) = 0) then these
quantities relate directly to the rotary position of the feedback device. If a linear feedback device is used then one revolution or pole pitch relates to the
distance given by P2 Pole Pair Pitch (03.155).

See P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.028) for more information.

Parameter 03.129 P2 Position


Short description Displays the position feedback from the P2 interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

See P2 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.128).

Parameter 03.130 P2 Fine Position


Short description Displays the fine position from the P2 interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

See P2 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.128).

Parameter 03.131 P2 Marker Mode


Short description Defines the marker mode for the P2 interface
Mode RFC‑A
0 15
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0000) (Display: 1111)
4
Default Units
(Display: 0100)
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P2 Device type (03.138): AB, FD, FR


Each position feedback device produces incremental signals which are counted in hardware. If P2 Marker Mode (03.131) = 0 the following occurs when a
marker event is produced by the Z1 input:

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 117
1. P2 Position (03.129) and P2 Fine Position (03.130) are reset to zero.
2. The bits in P2 Normalised Position (03.158) related to P2 Position (03.129) and P2 Fine Position (03.130) are reset to zero
3. P2 Marker Flag (03.132) is set to one.

The marker is a hardware function, and so the position appears as though it is reset at the marker event time even if this is between control system
sample points. It should be noted that the marker event occurs on the rising edge of the marker pulse if the position change over the last sample was
positive or on the falling edge if the position change over the last sample was negative. This ensures that the marker event occurs at the same physical
location for either direction of rotation.

The action taken when a marker event occurs can be modified by setting the bits of P2 Marker Mode (03.131) as described in the table below.

Bit Effect of setting bit to one

0 No action is taken unless the marker flag is zero before the marker event occurs

P2 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.128) and the whole of P2 Normalised Position (03.158) are also set to
1
zero on a marker event

P2 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.128), P2 Position (03.129), P2 Fine Position (03.130) and the related


part of P2 Normalised Position (03.158) are not reset. (This overrides bit 1.) P2 Normalised Position
2
(03.158) is transferred to P2 Normalised Marker Position (03.159) and P2 Marker Flag (03.132) is set to
one.

3 This bit in has not effect.

The marker input can be used for a standard type marker function or alternatively it can be used as an additional freeze input for the P1 position feedback
interface.

P2 Device type (03.138): Any other device type


The marker function cannot be used and P2 Marker Mode (03.131) has no effect.

Parameter 03.132 P2 Marker Flag


Short description Indicates when a marker event occurs
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

P2 Marker Flag (03.132) is set to one when a marker event occurs. The flag must be cleared by the user.

Parameter 03.133 P2 Rotary Turns Bits


Short description Defines the number of rotary turns bit for the P2 interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 16
Default 16 Units
Background read, auto-configuration
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P2 Rotary Turns Bits (03.133) only has any effect if the position feedback interface is being used with a rotary device (i.e. P2 Linear Feedback Select
(03.151) = 0).

P2 Device type (03.138): EnDat, BISS, SSI


P2 Rotary Turns Bits (03.133) is used to determine the number of bits within the comms messages from the position feedback device that represent turns.
For a single turn encoder P2 Rotary Turns Bits (03.133) must be set to zero. It should be noted that some SSI encoders include leading zeros before the
turns information and in this case the number of turns bits should include the leading zeros. The most significant bits in P1 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter
(03.028) that are not included in the turns information provided by the encoder comms are held at zero. If P2 Rotary Turns Bits (03.133) = 0 (single turn
encoder) the whole of P2 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.128) is held at zero.

P2 Device type (03.138): Any other device type


It is sometimes desirable to mask off the most significant bits of P2 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.128), but this does not have to be done for the drive
to function correctly. If P2 Rotary Turns Bits (03.133) = 0 the whole of P2 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.128) is held at zero. If P2 Rotary Turns Bits
(03.133) has any other value it indicates the number of bits in P2 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.128) that are not held at zero. For example, if
P2 Rotary Turns Bits (03.133) = 5, then P2 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.128) counts up to 31 before being reset.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


118 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 03.134 P2 Rotary Lines Per Revolution
Short description Defines the number of rotary lines per revolution for the P2 interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 100000
Default 1024 Units
Background read, auto-configuration
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P2 Rotary Lines Per Revolution (03.134) only has any effect if the position feedback interface is being used with a rotary device (i.e.
P2 Linear Feedback Select (03.151) = 0).

P2 Device type (03.138): AB


P2 Rotary Lines Per Revolution (03.134) should be set to the number of lines per revolution for the encoder connected to the P1 position feedback
interface.

P2 Device type (03.138): FD, FR


P2 Rotary Lines Per Revolution (03.134) should be set to the number of lines per revolution for the encoder connected to the P1 position feedback
interface multiplied by 2.

P2 Device type (03.138): Any other device type


P2 Rotary Lines Per Revolution (03.134) has no effect.

Parameter 03.135 P2 Comms Bits


Defines the total number of bits of position information in the comms message from the encoder on the
Short description
P2 interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 48
Default 0 Units
Background read, auto-configuration
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P2 Device type (03.138): EnDat, SSI, BiSS


P2 Comms Bits (03.135) should be set to the total number of bits of position information in the comms message from the encoder. If SSI communications
is being used this should include any leading or trailing zeros and the power supply alarm bit if present.

P2 Device type (03.138): Any other device type


P2 Comms Bits (03.135) has no effect.

Parameter 03.137 P2 Comms Baud Rate


Short description Defines the baud rate used for encoder communications
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 8
Default 2 Units Baud
Background read, auto-configuration
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 100k
1 200k
2 300k
3 400k
4 500k
5 1M
6 1.5M
7 2M
8 4M

P2 Comms Baud Rate (03.137) defines the baud rate used for encoder communications. Restrictions are applied to the baud rate for different feedback
devices, and so the baud rate may be different to the parameter value.

P2 Device type (03.138): EnDat, BiSS, SSI


Any baud rate that is within the range specified for the encoder may be used. The line delay is measured during initialisation, and used to compensate this
delay during communications with the encoder. Therefore there is no timing based restriction on the length of the cable between the position feedback
interface and the encoder. However, care should be taken to ensure that the wiring arrangement and the type of cable used are suitable for the selected
baud rate and the distance between the position interface and the encoder. See P2 Low Speed Update Rate Active (03.163) for more details on timing
restrictions related to the drive sample times.

P2 Device type (03.138): Any other device


P2 Comms Baud Rate (03.137) has no effect.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 119
Parameter 03.138 P2 Device type
Short description Set this to the feedback device type connected to the P2 position interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 6
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 None
1 AB
2 FD
3 FR
4 EnDat
5 SSI
6 BiSS

If P2 Device type (03.138) = Disabled, the P2 position feedback interface is disabled and does not provide any position feedback.

See P1 Device Type (03.038) for more information on the different position feedback device types.

Parameter 03.140 P2 Error Detection Level


Short description Used to enable or disable position feedback trip functions
Mode RFC‑A
0 31
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00000) (Display: 11111)
1
Default Units
(Display: 00001)
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

This parameter can be used to enable or disable position feedback trip functions as follows:

Bit Function
0 Not used with the P2 position interface.
1 Not used with the P2 position interface.
Enable SSI power supply alarm bit monitor (indicated by trip
2
Encoder 6).
3 Disable trips Encoder 1 to Encoder 6.
4 Disable trip Encoder 7.

Bits 3 and 4 do not prevent the device from becoming un-initialised. The trip is suppressed, but the device is still un-initialised and this is indicated by the
appropriate bit for the position feedback interface in Position Feedback Initialized (03.076).

Encoder trips
The following table shows trips that can be initiated that are related to the position feedback interface P2. The sub-trip number is 2 for the drive P2
position feedback interface.

Drive trip Encoders Reason for error


Encoder 4 EnDat, BISS Comms timeout
EnDat, BISS Checksum/CRC error
Encoder 5
SSI Not ready at start of position transfer (i.e. data input not one)
EnDat, BiSS The encoder has indicated an error
Encoder 6
SSI Power supply alarm bit active
Encoder 7 EnDat, BiSS, SSI An attempt has been made to enable the drive, but a position feedback device is not initialised
Maximum Switching Frequency (05.018), P2 Device type (03.138), P2 Comms Bits
(03.135), P2 Comms Baud Rate (03.137), P2 Calculation Time (03.160), P2 Recovery Time
Encoder 8 EnDat, SSI, BiSS (03.161), P2 Line Delay Time (03.162) and P2 User Comms Enable (03.167) are used to determine the time
taken for the communications exchange with the encoder. If this time exceeds 250μs an Encoder 8 trip is
initiated.
Speed feedback selected from an option slot that does not have a position feedback category option module
Encoder 9 All
fitted
Phasing Error All Incorrect encoder phasing 1
Encoder 12 BiSS The encoder could not be identified during auto-configuration

1. Incorrect encoder phasing is detected if the motor reaches half of the speed defined by VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX] and the phasing error is
large enough for the motor to accelerate uncontrollably.

Wire-break detection

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


120 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
It may be important to detect a break in the connections between the drive and the position feedback device. This feature is provided for most position
feedback devices either directly or indirectly as listed below.

Device Detection method Trip produced


AB, FD, FR There is no wire break detection of the A2, B2, and Z2 signals on the P2 position interface. None
Encoder 4,
EnDat, BiSS Wire break in the comms link is detected by a CRC or timeout error.
Encoder 5
Wire break detection in the comms is difficult with these devices. However, if power supply alaram bit
monitoring is enabled the drive will be looking for a one at the start of the message and a zero to indicate Encoder 5,
SSI
that the power supply is okay. If the clock stops or the data line is disconnected the data input to the drive Encoder 6
may stay in one state or the other and cause a trip.

Parameter 03.141 P2 Auto-configuration Select


Short description Set this parameter to enable auto-configuration of EnDat and BiSS feedback devices
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Disabled
1 Enabled

P2 Device type (03.138): EnDat, BiSS


If auto-configuration has not been disabled (i.e. P2 Auto-configuration Select (03.141) = 0) then during position feedback initialisation the encoder is
interrogated to determine whether the encoder is a rotary or linear encoder and P2 Linear Feedback Select (03.151) is set up appropriately. Then the
following parameters are set up based on information from the encoder:

Rotary Linear
P2 Rotary Turns Bits (03.133) P2 Linear Comms Pitch (03.152)
P2 Rotary Lines Per Revolution
P2 Linear Line Pitch (03.153)
(03.134)
P2 Comms Bits (03.135) P2 Comms Bits (03.135)
P2 Linear Comms And Line Pitch Units
(03.154)

The following actions are also taken to set up the timing for the encoder.

Comms Protocol Actions taken

P2 Calculation Time (03.160) = From the encoder


EnDat 2.1 P2 Recovery Time (03.161) = 30μs
Line delay measured and result written to P2 Line Delay Time (03.162)

P2 Calculation Time (03.160) = From the encoder


P2 Recovery Time (03.161) = 4μs and the recovery time within the encoder is set
EnDat 2.2
up to the shortest value of 3.75μs if the P2 Comms Baud Rate (03.137) is 1M or
more.Line delay measured and result written to P2 Line Delay Time (03.162)

P2 Recovery Time (03.161) = 12μs


BiSS
Line delay measured and result written to P2 Line Delay Time (03.162)

SSI Line delay measured and result written to P2 Line Delay Time (03.162)

If P2 Auto-configuration Select (03.141) = 1 then P2 Comms Baud Rate (03.137) is set to the minimum value that will give a total message transfer time of
less than 62μs, so that the transfer will occur at the fast update rate with the minimum baud rate. It should be noted that the value
of P2 User Comms Enable (03.167) is taken into account as this may affect the message time.

Once these parameters have been set up it should be possible for the drive to operate correctly with the encoder. The drive repeatedly attempts to
initialise the encoder, including auto-configuration which is part of this process, until it is successful. Therefore if auto-configuration has not been
successful by the time the drive is enabled because the drive cannot establish communications an Encoder 7 trip occurs. For BiSS encoders the drive
must identify the encoder model number to perform auto-configuration. If communications is established, but the drive cannot recognise the encoder
model an Encoder 12 trip is produced immediately.

If auto-configuration is disabled (i.e. P2 Auto-configuration Select (03.141) = 1) then none of the above actions are carried out except for the line delay
measurement.

P2 Device type (03.138): All other device types


P2 Auto-configuration Select (03.141) has no effect.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 121
Parameter 03.142 P2 Feedback Filter
Defines the time period for a sliding window filter that may be applied to the feedback taken from the P2
Short description
interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Disabled
1 1ms
2 2ms
3 4ms
4 8ms
5 16ms

P2 Feedback Filter (03.142) defines the time period for a sliding window filter that may be applied to the feedback taken from the drive P2 position
feedback interface. This is particularly useful in applications where the drive encoder is used to give speed feedback for the speed controller and where
the load includes a high inertia, and so the speed controller gains are very high. Under these conditions, without a filter on the feedback, it is possible for
the speed loop output to change constantly from one current limit to the other and lock the integral term of the speed controller.

Parameter 03.143 P2 Maximum Reference


Short description Defines the maximum speed reference from the P2 interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 33000
Default 1500 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

The speed feedback from the drive P1 position feedback interface can be used as a source to control a parameter. The speed feedback is scaled to give
a value as a percentage of P2 Maximum Reference (03.143) in 0.1% units which is displayed in P2 Reference (03.145). The value is then scaled by the
P2 Reference Scaling (03.144) and then routed to the destination defined by P2 Reference Destination (03.146).

Normally the destination is updated every 4ms, but if the destination is the Hard Speed Reference (03.022), P2 Maximum Reference (03.143) =
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX] and P2 Reference Scaling (03.144) = 1.000 it is updated every 250μs. Although the hard speed reference is updated
every 250μs internally a value in rpm or mm/s is written to Hard Speed Reference (03.022) every 4ms for indication only. It should be noted that if the fast
update method is used the resolution of the speed feedback devived from the position feedback device defines the resolution of the hard speed reference
and that any ripple on the feedback will be present on the hard speed reference (see Speed Feedback (03.002)).

Parameter 03.144 P2 Reference Scaling


Short description Defines the scaling applied to the P2 reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See P2 Maximum Reference (03.143).

Parameter 03.145 P2 Reference


Short description Displays the value in P2 reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.0 Maximum 100.0
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, FI, ND, NC, PT

See P2 Maximum Reference (03.143).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


122 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 03.146 P2 Reference Destination
Short description Defines the destination parameter for P2 reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See P2 Maximum Reference (03.143).

Parameter 03.147 P2 SSI Incremental Mode


Short description Set to 1 to enable SSI incremental mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P2 Device type (03.138): SSI


If P2 SSI Incremental Mode (03.147) = 0 the complete absolute position is read at each sample. Care should be taken when using this mode as some
unwanted effects can occur when the encoder passes through the boundary between its maximum position and zero. In this mode the encoder can be
used for motor control provided at least 6 bits of turns information are provided by the encoder otherwise an over speed trip will be produced as the
position passes over the maximum position to zero boundary. P2 Normalised Position (03.158) can be used for position control over this boundary
provided the normalised turns bits are set up so that the normalised positions do not contain turns information that is not available from the encoder. As
the SSI format does not include any error checking it is not possible to detect if the position data has been corrupted by noise. The benefit of using the
absolute position directly from an SSI encoder is that even if the encoder communications are disturbed by noise and position errors occur, the position
will always recover the correct position after the disturbance has ended.

If P2 SSI Incremental Mode (03.147) = 1 the absolute position is only taken from the encoder during initialisation. The change of position over each
sample is then accumulated to determine the position. This method always gives 16 bits of turns information that can always be used without jumps in
position whatever value is used as the turns bits for normalisation. If noise corrupts the data from an SSI encoder it is possible to have apparent large
change of position, and this can result in the turns information becoming and remaining corrupted until the encoder is re-initialised.

If an SSI encoder is used, but is not powered from the drive, and the encoder is powered up after the drive, it is possible that the first change of position
detected could be large enough to cause the problems described above. This can be avoided if the encoder interface is initialised with
Initialise Position Feedback (03.075) after the encoder has powered up. If the encoder includes a power supply alarm bit, the power supply monitor should
be enabled. This will ensure that the drive remains tripped until the encoder is powered up and the action of resetting the trip will reinitialise the encoder
interface.

P2 Device type (03.138): All other device types


P2 SSI Incremental Mode (03.147) has no effect.

Parameter 03.148 P2 SSI Binary Mode


Short description Set to 1 to enable SSI binary mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P2 Device type (03.138): SSI


SSI encoders normally use Gray code data format. However, some encoders use binary format which may be selected by setting P2 SSI Binary Mode
(03.148) to one.

P2 Device type (03.138): All other device types


P2 SSI Binary Mode (03.148) has no effect.

Parameter 03.149 P2 Additional Power-up Delay


Short description Defines an additional delay for when any attempt is made to communicate to the device P2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 25.0
Default 0.0 Units s
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, BU

When the position feedback is initialised, at power-up or at any other time, a delay is included before the information from the feedback device is used or
any attempt is made to communicate with the device. P2 Additional Power-up Delay (03.149) defines an additional delay that is added to the minimum
delay. See P1 Additional Power-up Delay (03.049) for the minimum delays for the different position feedback device types.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 123
Parameter 03.150 P2 Feedback Lock
Short description Set to 1 to prevent the position feedback paramters for P2 being updated
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If P2 Feedback Lock (03.150) = 1 then P2 Revolution/Pole Pitch Counter (03.128), P2 Position (03.129) and P2 Fine Position (03.130) are not updated.
If P2 Feedback Lock (03.150) = 0 then these parameters are updated normally.

Parameter 03.151 P2 Linear Feedback Select


Short description Set to 1 to configure the P2 interface to operate with a linear position feedback device
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Background read, auto-configuration
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If P2 Linear Feedback Select (03.151) = 0 then the drive P1 position feedback interface is configured to operate with a rotary position feedback device.
P2 Rotary Turns Bits (03.133) and P2 Rotary Lines Per Revolution (03.134) should be used to set up the position feedback interface.

If P2 Linear Feedback Select (03.151) = 1 then the position feedback interface is configured to operate with a linear position feedback device.
P2 Linear Comms Pitch (03.152) and P2 Linear Line Pitch (03.153) should be used to set up the position feedback interface.

Parameter 03.152 P2 Linear Comms Pitch


Defines the distance covered by the least significant bit of the position information in a comms message
Short description
from a linear encoder
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.001 Maximum 100.000
Default 0.001 Units
Background read, auto-configuration
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

P2 Device type (03.138): EnDat, SSI, BiSS


P2 Linear Comms Pitch (03.152) is used to define the distance covered by the least significant bit of the position information in a comms message from a
linear encoder. The units used by this parameter are defined by P2 Linear Comms And Line Pitch Units (03.154).

P2 Device type (03.138): Any other device


P2 Linear Comms Pitch (03.152) has no effect.

Parameter 03.153 P2 Linear Line Pitch


Short description Defines the linear line pitch for device P2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.001 Maximum 100.000
Default 0.001 Units
Background read, auto-configuration
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

P2 Linear Line Pitch (03.153) only has any effect if the position feedback interface is being used with a linear device (i.e. P2 Linear Feedback Select
(03.151) = 1) and should be used to define the distances listed below for each type of device. The units used by this parameter are defined by
P2 Linear Comms And Line Pitch Units (03.154).

P2 Device type (03.138): AB


P2 Linear Line Pitch (03.153) should be set to the distance covered by one line period on the encoder.

P2 Device type (03.138): FD, FR


P2 Linear Line Pitch (03.153) should be set to the distance covered by two line periods on the encoder.

P2 Device type (03.138): Any other device


P2 Linear Line Pitch (03.153) has no effect.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


124 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 03.154 P2 Linear Comms And Line Pitch Units
Short description Defines the linear units in either millimetres or micrometres
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 millimetres
1 micrometres

P2 Linear Comms And Line Pitch Units (03.154) defines the units used by P2 Linear Comms Pitch (03.152) and P2 Linear Line Pitch (03.153) in
millimetres or micrometres.

Parameter 03.155 P2 Pole Pair Pitch


Defines the change of position for one electrical revolution of the drive output with a linear position
Short description
device.
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.01 Maximum 1000.00
Default 10.00 Units mm
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

P2 Pole Pair Pitch (03.155) gives the distance equivalent to one electrical revolution when linear position feedback is used. See P1 Pole Pair Pitch
(03.055) for more detail.

Parameter 03.156 P2 Feedback Reverse


Short description Set to 1 to reverse the direction of the position feedback
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If P2 Feedback Reverse (03.156) = 1 the position feedback is negated. This can be used to reverse the direction of the position feedback.

Parameter 03.157 P2 Normalisation Turns


Short description Defines the number of turns bits included in the normalisation parameters
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 16
Default 16 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P2 Normalisation Turns (03.157) defines the number of turns bits included in the following parameters. See P1 Normalisation Turns (03.057) for more
information.

P2 Normalised Position (03.158)
P2 Normalised Marker Position (03.159)
F1 Normalised Freeze Position (03.103) if P2 is the source position for freeze function F1
F2 Normalised Freeze Position (03.108) if P2 is the source position for freeze function F2

Parameter 03.158 P2 Normalised Position


Short description Displays the position taken from the position feedback device including the effect of the marker function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

P2 Normalised Position (03.158) is the position taken from the position feedback device including the effect of the marker function.
See P2 Normalisation Turns (03.157) for details of the format.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 125
Parameter 03.159 P2 Normalised Marker Position
Short description Displays the normalised position at the last marker event
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

P2 Normalised Marker Position (03.159) is the value P2 Normalised Position (03.158) at the last marker event provided bit 2 of P2 Marker Mode
(03.131) is set to 1. See P2 Marker Mode (03.131) for more details.

Parameter 03.160 P2 Calculation Time


Defines the time from the first edge of the clock signal from the position feedback interface until the
Short description
encoder has calculated the position and is ready to return this information
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 20
Default 5 Units µs
Background read, auto-configuration
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P2 Device type (03.138): EnDat


P2 Calculation Time (03.160) is the time from the first edge of the clock signal from the position feedback interface until the encoder has calculated the
position and is ready to return this information. This is used to calculate the overall time for a message interchange with the encoder. See
P2 Low Speed Update Rate Active (03.163) for more details.

P2 Device type (03.138): Any other type of device


P2 Calculation Time (03.160) has no effect.

Parameter 03.161 P2 Recovery Time


Short description Defines the time that must be allowed after each message interchange before a new message begins
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 4 Maximum 100
Default 30 Units µs
Background read, auto-configuration
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

P2 Device type (03.138): EnDat, SSI, BiSS


P2 Recovery Time (03.161) is the time that must be allowed after each message interchange before a new message begins.

P2 Device type (03.138): Any other type of device


P2 Recovery Time (03.161) has no effect.

Parameter 03.162 P2 Line Delay Time


Displays the transmission delay between the position feedback interface and the encoder and back
Short description
again
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5000
Default Units ns
Background read, position feedback
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate
initialisation write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

P2 Device type (03.138): EnDat, SSI, BiSS


During position feedback initialisation the transmission delay between the position feedback interface and the encoder and back again is measured and
stored in P2 Line Delay Time (03.162). This value is then used to compensate for this delay so that the clock/data skew does not prevent the data from
the encoder from being read. This means that longer line lengths can be used with these feedback devices provided the correct cable and connection
arrangements are used.

P2 Device type (03.138): Any other type of device


P2 Line Delay Time (03.162) is always zero.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


126 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 03.163 P2 Low Speed Update Rate Active
Short description Indicates when the low speed update rate is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

P2 Device type (03.138): EnDat, SSI, BISS


If the position can be sampled in 60μs P2 Low Speed Update Rate Active (03.163) = 0, otherwise P2 Low Speed Update Rate Active (03.163) = 1.

The following parameters are used by the drive to determine the necessary time to obtain the required data from the position feedback device.

P2 Rotary Turns Bits (03.133)
P2 Comms Bits (03.135)
P2 Comms Baud Rate (03.137)
P2 Calculation Time (03.160)
P2 Recovery Time (03.161)
P2 Line Delay Time (03.162)
P2 User Comms Enable (03.167)

See P1 Low Speed Update Rate Active (03.063) for more information on how this time is calculated.

P2 Device type (03.138): Any other type of device


P2 Low Speed Update Rate Active (03.163) is always zero.

Parameter 03.164 P2 Encoder Protocol Detected


Short description Defines which protocol is used with the device P2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text
0 None
1 Hiperface
2 EnDat2.1
3 EnDat2.2
4 BiSS

P2 Encoder Protocol Detected (03.164) shows the encoder comms protocol detected during position feedback initialisation. If P2 Device type (03.138) is
set to BiSS then P2 Encoder Protocol Detected (03.164) is set to the appropriate value after successful communication with the encoder during
initialisation. If P2 Device type (03.138) is set to EnDat then P2 Encoder Protocol Detected (03.164) is set to the appropriate EnDat protocol after
successful communication with the encoder during initialisation. If communications is not successful during initialisation then
P2 Encoder Protocol Detected (03.164) is set to 0 (None).

Parameter 03.167 P2 User Comms Enable


Short description Enables the use of the user comms paramters to communicate to the encoder connected to P2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC, PT

If P2 User Comms Enable (03.167) set to a non-zero value it is possible to use P2 User Comms Transmit Register (03.168) and
P2 User Comms Receive Register (03.169) to communicate with an encoder that has a Hiperface, EnDat 2.1, EnDat2.2 or BiSS interface. See
P1 User Comms Enable (03.067) for a description of how to use these registers.

Parameter 03.168 P2 User Comms Transmit Register


Short description Defines the value present in the user comms transmit register
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read/write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC, PT, BU

See P2 User Comms Enable (03.167).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 127
Parameter 03.169 P2 User Comms Receive Register
Short description Defines the value present in the user comms receive register
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read/write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC, PT, BU

See P2 User Comms Enable (03.167).

Parameter 03.171 P2 Error Detected


Indicates if an error has been detected with the position feedback device connected to the P1 position
Short description
interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

P2 Error Detected (03.171) is set if an error has been detected with the position feedback device connected to the P2 position interface. This parameter
is useful if encoder trips have been disabled with P2 Error Detection Level (03.140).

Parameter 03.172 P2 Status


Short description Displays the status of the P2 position interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 9
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text
0 None
1 AB
2 FD
3 FR
4 EnDat
5 SSI
6 BiSS
7 EnDat Alt
8 SSI Alt
9 BiSS Alt

Priority of the 15-way D-type is assigned in the following order from the highest priority to the lowest.

1. P1 position interface
2. Encoder simulation output
3. P2 position interface

The availability of the P2 position interface on the 15-way D-type on the drive is dependent on type of feedback device selected in P1 Device Type
(03.038) and the encoder simulation mode selected in Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088). P2 Status (03.172) shows the status of the P2 position
interface depending on the settings in P2 Device type (03.138), P1 Device Type (03.038), and Encoder Simulation Mode (03.088).

0: None
The P2 position interface is not available.

1: AB
2: FD
3: FR
4: EnDat
5: SSI
6: BiSS
The P2 position interface is available. The connections for the P2 position interface are shown below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


128 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
15-way D-type connections
P2 Status (03.172)
1/2 3/4 5/6 7/8 9/10 11/12
AB A2 B2 Z2
FD F2 D2 Z2
FR F2 R2 Z2
EnDat D2 Clk2 Z2
SSI D2 Clk2 Z2
BiSS D2 Clk2 Z2

7: EnDat Alt
8: SSI Alt
9: BiSS Alt
The P2 position interface is available but uses alternative connections as shown below as connection 7/8 and 9/10 are used by the encoder simulation
output.

15-way D-type connections


P2 Status (03.172)
1/2 3/4 5/6 7/8 9/10 11/12
EnDat Alt D2 AOut BOut Clk2
SSI Alt D2 AOut BOut Clk2
BiSS Alt D2 AOut BOut Clk2

See the introduction to this menu for more information on the position feedback interfaces.

Parameter 03.173 P2 Absolute Turns Recovery Enable


Set to 1 to allow turns information beyond the number of turns bits provided by the position feedback
Short description
device connected to P2 to be stored on power-down and recovered at next power-up
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See P1 Absolute Turns Recovery Enable (03.073).

Parameter 03.174 P2 Additional Configuration


Provides additional configuration information for the position feedback device not included in the other
Short description
set-up parameters.
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 511116116
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See P1 Additional Configuration (03.074).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 129
Menu 4 Single Line Descriptions − Torque and current control
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


130 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter Range Default Type
VM_DRIVE_CURRENT_UNIPOLAR[MIN] to
04.001 Current Magnitude RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_DRIVE_CURRENT_UNIPOLAR[MAX] A
VM_DRIVE_CURRENT[MIN] to
04.002 Torque Producing Current RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_DRIVE_CURRENT[MAX] A
VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MIN] to
04.003 Final Torque Reference RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MAX] %
VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MIN] to
04.004 Final Current Reference RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MAX] %
VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT[MIN] to
04.005 Motoring Current Limit 0.0 % RW Num RA US
VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT[MAX] %
VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT[MIN] to
04.006 Regenerating Current Limit 0.0 % RW Num RA US
VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT[MAX] %
VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT[MIN] to
04.007 Symmetrical Current Limit 0.0 % RW Num RA US
VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT[MAX] %
VM_USER_CURRENT_HIGH_RES[MIN] to
04.008 Torque Reference 0.00 % RW Num US
VM_USER_CURRENT_HIGH_RES[MAX] %
VM_USER_CURRENT[MIN] to
04.009 Torque Offset 0.0 % RW Num US
VM_USER_CURRENT[MAX] %
04.010 Torque Offset Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
04.011 Torque Mode Selector 0 to 5 0 RW Num US
04.012 Current Reference Filter 1 Time Constant 0.0 to 25.0 ms 0.0 ms RW Num US
04.013 Current Controller Kp Gain 0 to 30000 150 RW Num US
04.014 Current Controller Ki Gain 0 to 30000 2000 RW Num US
04.015 Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 1.0 to 3000.0 s 89.0 s RW Num US
Motor Trip (0), Motor Limit (1), Drive Limit (2),
04.016 Thermal Protection Mode Motor Trip (0) RW Txt US
Both Limit (3), Disabled (4)
VM_DRIVE_CURRENT[MIN] to
04.017 Magnetising Current RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_DRIVE_CURRENT[MAX] A
VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MIN] to
04.018 Final Current Limit RO Num ND NC PT
VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MAX] %
04.019 Motor Protection Accumulator 0.0 to 200.0 % RO Num ND NC PT PS
VM_USER_CURRENT[MIN] to
04.020 Percentage Load RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_USER_CURRENT[MAX] %
04.021 Current Feedback Filter Disable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
04.022 Inertia Compensation Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
04.023 Current Reference Filter 2 Time Constant 0.0 to 25.0 ms 0.0 ms RW Num US
VM_TORQUE_CURRENT_UNIPOLAR[MIN] to
04.024 User Current Maximum Scaling 175.0 % RW Num RA US
VM_TORQUE_CURRENT_UNIPOLAR[MAX] %
04.025 Low Speed Thermal Protection Mode 0 to 1 0 RW Num US
VM_USER_CURRENT[MIN] to
04.026 Percentage Torque RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_USER_CURRENT[MAX] %
04.027 Low Load Detection Level 0.0 to 100.0 % 0.0 % RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF_UNIPOLAR[MIN] to
04.028 Low Load Detection Speed/Frequency Threshold 0.0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
04.029 Enable Trip On Low Load Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
04.030 Current Controller Mode Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
04.031 Notch Filter Centre Frequency 50 to 1200 Hz 100 Hz RW Num US
04.032 Notch Filter Bandwidth 0 to 1200 Hz 0 Hz RW Num US
04.033 Inertia Times 1000 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
04.036 Motor Protection Accumulator Power‑up Value Power down (0), Zero (1), Real time (2) Power down (0) RW Txt US
04.037 Motor Thermal Time Constant 2 1.0 to 3000.0 s 89.0 s RW Num US
04.038 Motor Thermal Time Constant 2 Scaling 0 to 100 % 0% RW Num US
04.039 Rated Iron Losses As Percentage Of Losses 0 to 100 % 0% RW Num US
04.041 Rated Torque 0.00 to 50000.00 Nm 0.00 Nm RW Num US
04.042 Torque Estimation Minimum Frequency 0 to 100 % 5% RW Num US
04.043 Torque Correction Time Constant 0.00 to 10.00 s 0.00 s RW Num US
04.044 Torque Correction Maximum 0 to 100 % 20 % RW Num US
04.045 No‑load Core Loss 0.000 to 99999.999 kW 0.000 kW RW Num US
04.046 Rated Core Loss 0.000 to 99999.999 kW 0.000 kW RW Num US
04.049 Magnetising Current Limit 0.0 to 100.0 % 100.0 % RW Num US
04.050 Low‑pass Filter Cut‑off Frequency 0 to 1000 Hz 0 Hz RW Num US
04.051 Bi‑quad Filter1: a0 ±2.0000 0.0000 RW Num US
04.052 Bi‑quad Filter1: a1 ±2.0000 0.0000 RW Num US
04.053 Bi‑quad Filter1: a2 ±2.0000 0.0000 RW Num US
04.054 Bi‑quad Filter1: b1 ±2.0000 0.0000 RW Num US

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 131
04.055 Bi‑quad Filter1: b2 ±2.0000 0.0000 RW Num US
04.056 Bi‑quad Filter2: a0 ±2.0000 0.0000 RW Num US
04.057 Bi‑quad Filter2: a1 ±2.0000 0.0000 RW Num US
04.058 Bi‑quad Filter2: a2 ±2.0000 0.0000 RW Num US
04.059 Bi‑quad Filter2: b1 ±2.0000 0.0000 RW Num US
04.060 Bi‑quad Filter2: b2 ±2.0000 0.0000 RW Num US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


132 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 4 − Torque and current control
Mode: RFC‑A

RFC-A and RFC-S modes

The diagram below is common to both RFC-A and RFC-S modes.

The drive can have a heavy duty rating intended for applications where high overload current may be required under transient conditions, or it can have a
normal duty rating where a lower level of overload current is required. The duty rating is selected automatically by the drive based on the setting of
Rated Current (05.007). The Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032) and Maximum Rated Current (11.060) are fixed for each drive size and the table below
shows the possible duty ratings that can be selected depending on the levels of these parameters.

Conditions Possible duty ratings


Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032) = 0.00 Normal duty operation only
Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032) < Heavy duty operation if rated current > MAX, otherwise
Maximum Rated Current (11.060) normal duty operation
Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032) =
Heavy duty operation only
Maximum Rated Current (11.060)

The different duty ratings modify the motor protection characteristic (see Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 (04.015)), and also change the maximum settings for
the current limits.

In a drive that contains multiple power modules Full Scale Current Kc (11.061) is the full scale current of an individual module multiplied by the number of
modules. Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032) and Maximum Rated Current (11.060) are the value for an individual module multiplied by the number of
modules.

RFC-A mode

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 133
The torque reference is normally provided by the speed controller, or from the torque reference, or as a combination of both depending on the value of
the Torque Mode Selector (04.011). During supply loss or when standard ramp mode is selected and the motor is regenerating it is possible that the torque
producing current reference may be provided by the d.c. bus voltage controller as shown above. The torque reference is converted to the torque producing
current reference based on the level of motor flux and then current limits are applied. For more details of the current limit system and the calculation of the
variable maximums that limit the current limit user parameters (VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT and VM_MOTOR2_CURRENT_LIMIT) see the "Drive Limits"
document included in this parameter reference guide.

RFC-S mode

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


134 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
The torque reference is provided by the speed controller, or from the torque reference, or as a combination of both depending on the value of the
Torque Mode Selector (04.011). During supply loss or when standard ramp mode is selected and the motor is regenerating it is possible that the torque
producing current reference may be provided by the d.c. bus voltage controller as shown above. The torque reference is converted into the final current
reference and can include the effect of changes in magnet flux and then the current limits are applied. For more details of the current limit system and the
calculation of the variable maximums that limit the current limit user parameters (VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT and VM_MOTOR2_CURRENT_LIMIT) see
the "Drive Limits" document included in this parameter reference guide. The final current reference defines the current magnitude that should be applied to the
motor which is split into d and q axis components depending on the Rated Torque Angle (05.089). Either the d or q axis current may be further modified to limit
the motor voltage when flux weakening is required.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 135
Parameter 04.001 Current Magnitude
Short description Shows the instantaneous drive output current
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_DRIVE_CURRENT_UNIPOLAR[MIN] Maximum VM_DRIVE_CURRENT_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default Units A
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

Current Magnitude (04.001) is the instantaneous drive output current scaled so that it represents the r.m.s. phase current in Amps under steady state
conditions.

Parameter 04.002 Torque Producing Current


Short description Shows the instantaneous level of torque producing current
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_DRIVE_CURRENT[MIN] Maximum VM_DRIVE_CURRENT[MAX]
Default Units A
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

Iq, Torque Producing Current (04.002) is the instantaneous level of torque producing current scaled so that it represents the r.m.s. level of current under
steady state conditions. Iq, Torque Producing Current (04.002) is proportional to the torque produced by the motor provided field weakening is not active. For
field weakening operation the Iq, Torque Producing Current (04.002) is boosted for a given level of torque to compensate for the reduction in the motor flux.

Sign of Iq,
Sign of frequency Direction of motor
Torque Producing Current
or speed torque
(04.002)
+ + Accelerating
- + Decelerating
+ - Decelerating
- - Accelerating

Parameter 04.003 Final Torque Reference


Short description Shows the final torque reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MIN] Maximum VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MAX]
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

The Speed Controller Output (03.004) can include a feed forward torque that will provide the torque necessary to accelerate the load inertia. This can be
combined with the Torque Reference (04.008) and the Torque Offset (04.009) as defined by the Torque Mode Selector (04.011) to give
the Final Torque Reference (04.003) as a percentage of rated motor torque.

Parameter 04.004 Final Current Reference


Short description Shows the final current reference after the current limits
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MIN] Maximum VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MAX]
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

The Final Torque Reference (04.003) is converted into the Final Current Reference (04.004) by applying a torque to current conversion and by applying the
Final Current Limit (04.018). The torque to current conversion is applied as follows:

Current reference = Final Torque Reference (04.003) x Motor Rated Flux / Motor Flux

It is possible to disable, or change the method for the flux compensation using Flux Compensation (05.028). This may be required, for example to prevent
motor instability when an inaccurate value for Rated Speed (05.008) is being used.

Parameter 04.005 Motoring Current Limit


Short description Defines the current limit used when the motor is being accelerated away from standstill
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT[MIN] Maximum VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM, RA

The Motoring Current Limit (04.005) limits the current when the motor is being accelerated away from standstill. The Regenerating Current Limit (04.006) limits

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


136 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
the current when the motor is being decelerated towards standstill. If the Symmetrical Current Limit (04.007) is below the Motoring Current Limit (04.005) then
it is used instead of the Motoring Current Limit (04.005). If the Symmetrical Current Limit (04.007) is below the Regenerating Current Limit (04.006) then it is
used instead of the Regenerating Current Limit (04.006).

The maximum possible current limit (VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT [MAX]) varies between drive sizes with default parameters loaded. For some drive
sizes the default value may be reduced below the value given by the parameter range limiting.

Parameter 04.006 Regenerating Current Limit


Short description Defines the current limit used when the motor is being decelerated towards standstill
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT[MIN] Maximum VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM, RA

See Motoring Current Limit (04.005).

Parameter 04.007 Symmetrical Current Limit


Short description Defines the symmetrical current limit
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT[MIN] Maximum VM_MOTOR1_CURRENT_LIMIT[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM, RA

See Motoring Current Limit (04.005).

Parameter 04.008 Torque Reference


Short description Defines the torque reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_USER_CURRENT_HIGH_RES[MIN] Maximum VM_USER_CURRENT_HIGH_RES[MAX]
Default 0.00 Units %
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 250µs read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW, VM

Gives the required torque reference as a percentage of rated motor torque.

Parameter 04.009 Torque Offset


Short description Defines the torque offset to be added to the torque reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_USER_CURRENT[MIN] Maximum VM_USER_CURRENT[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

The torque offset added to Torque Reference (04.008) if Torque Offset Select (04.010) = 1.

Parameter 04.010 Torque Offset Select


Short description Set to add the torque offset to the torque reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Torque Reference (04.008).

Parameter 04.011 Torque Mode Selector


Short description Defines the torque mode used by the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 137
The value of the Torque Mode Selector (04.011) defines how the Final Torque Reference (04.003) is produced. The inputs to the torque mode selector system
are referred to below as the Speed control torque reference and the User torque reference. The Speed control torque reference is the Speed Controller Output
(03.004), combined with the Inertia Compensation Torque (02.038) if this is enabled. The User torque reference is the Torque Reference (04.008), combined
with the Torque Offset (04.009) if this is enabled. Each of the modes is described below.

Mode 0 and Mode 4 use speed control with the combined output of the ramp system and the hard speed reference as the reference. The other modes are
torque control modes (although the speed controller may be active). In these modes the ramp system output is not used, but the output of the ramp
system (Post Ramp Reference (02.001)) is constantly preset with Speed Feedback (03.002) − Hard Speed Reference (03.022). This prevents a transient if the
mode is changed to 0 or 4 while the drive is active, or the drive run is removed and the motor is stopped under ramp control, i.e. Stop Mode (06.001) is 1 or 2.

0: Speed control mode


The Final Torque Reference (04.003) is the Speed controller torque reference.

1: Torque control
The Final Torque Reference (04.003) is the User torque reference. The speed is not limited by the drive but, the drive will trip at the over-speed threshold if
runaway occurs.

2: Torque control with speed override


The drive effectively operates in speed control and Final Torque Reference (04.003) is controlled by the Speed controller torque reference, however this
is limited between 0 and the User torque reference. The effect is to produce an operating area as shown below if the Speed controller torque reference and
the User torque reference are both positive. The speed controller will attempt to accelerate the motor to the Final Speed Reference (03.001) with a torque
equivalent to the User torque reference. However, the speed cannot be forced above the Final Speed Reference (03.001) by the drive because the required
torque would be negative, and so it would be clamped to zero.

Depending on the sign of the Final Speed Reference (03.001) and the User torque reference there are four possible areas of operation as shown below.

3: Coiler/uncoiler mode
Positive Final Speed Reference (03.001): Positive User torque reference gives torque control with a positive speed limit defined by the Final Speed Reference
(03.001). A negative User torque reference gives torque control with a negative speed limit of -5rpm.

Negative Final Speed Reference (03.001): Negative User torque reference gives torque control with a negative speed limit defined by the
Final Speed Reference (03.001). A positive User torque reference gives torque control with a positive speed limit of +5rpm.

Example of coiler operation:
This is an example of a coiler operating in the positive direction. The Final Speed Reference (03.001) is set to a positive value just above the coiler reference

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


138 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
speed. If the User torque reference is positive the coiler operates with a limited speed, so that if the material breaks the speed does not exceed a level just
above the reference. It is also possible to decelerate the coiler with a negative User torque reference. The coiler will decelerate down to -5rpm until a stop is
applied. The operating area is shown below:

Example of uncoiler operation:
This is an example for an uncoiler operating in the positive direction. The Final Speed Reference (03.001) should be set to a level just above the maximum
normal speed. When the User torque reference is negative the uncoiler will apply tension and try and rotate at 5rpm in reverse, and so take up any slack. The
uncoiler can operate at any positive speed applying tension. If it is necessary to accelerate the uncoiler a positive User torque reference is used. The speed
will be limited to the Final Speed Reference (03.001). The operating area is the same as that for the coiler and is shown below:

4: Speed control with torque feed-forward


The Speed control torque reference and User torque reference are summed so that the drive operates under speed control, but a torque value may be added
to the output of the speed controller. This can be used to improve the regulation of systems where the speed controller gains need to be low for stability.

5: Bi-directional torque control with speed override


The drive effectively operates in speed control and Final Torque Reference (04.003) is controlled by the Speed controller torque reference. If the User torque
reference is positive then the speed reference is Final Speed Reference (03.001) and the torque is limited to the User torque reference. Therefore for any
negative speed and any positive speed up to Final Speed Reference (03.001) the motor will produce the required positive torque. If the speed exceeds
Final Speed Reference (03.001) no torque will be produced. The system works in the same way for a negative User torque reference, but with a speed limit of
-Final Speed Reference (03.001). This system can be used for torque control in either direction with a safe speed limit in either direction if the load torque is
less than the applied torque (i.e. the load is removed). The diagram below shows the possible regions of operation.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 139
Parameter 04.012 Current Reference Filter 1 Time Constant
Short description Defines the time constant of a first order filter that can be applied to the final current reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 25.0
Default 0.0 Units ms
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, BU

Current Reference Filter 1 Time Constant (04.012) defines the time constant of a first order filter that can be applied to the Final Current Reference (04.004).
The filter is provided to reduce acoustic noise and vibration produced as a result of position feedback quantisation. The filter introduces a lag in the speed
controller loop, and so the speed controller gains may need to be reduced to maintain stability as the filter time constant is increased. The time constant used
is dependent on Speed Controller Gain Select (03.016) so that different time constants can be used with different gains.
Current Reference Filter 1 Time Constant (04.012) is used if Speed Controller Gain Select (03.016) = 0, and Current Reference Filter 2 Time Constant
(04.023) is used if Speed Controller Gain Select (03.016) = 1.

If Low-pass Filter Cut-off Frequency (04.050) is set to a value of 10Hz or greater then it overrides the settings of Current Reference Filter 1 Time Constant
(04.012) and Current Reference Filter 2 Time Constant (04.023).

Parameter 04.013 Current Controller Kp Gain


Short description Defines the current loop controller proportional gain
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 30000
Default 150 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013) and Current Controller Ki Gain (04.014) are the proportional and integral gains of the current controllers. It is possible to
use the current controller in standard mode (Current Controller Mode (04.030) = 0) or high performance mode (Current Controller Mode (04.030) = 1). The set
up method for the current controller gains is described separately for each of these modes below. It should be noted that when an auto-tune is performed that
measures the Transient Inductance (05.024) and Stator Resistance (05.017) the Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013) and Current Controller Ki Gain (04.014)
are automatically set to the levels defined in the description for standard mode even if high performance mode is selected. These gains will give good
performance in standard mode and produce moderate acoustic noise due to position feedback quantisation with a standard incremental encoder. These
represent the maximum levels that are likely to be used with this mode in most applications. For high performance mode it is recommended that a high
resolution position feedback device is used or else the acoustic noise due to position feedback quantisation is likely to be excessive. In high performance
mode the proportional gain can be increased to a higher level as given in the description of this mode.

Standard mode
Standard mode can be used to give good current control dynamic performance and is compatible with the performance of Unidrive SP. The current controller
gains can either be set using auto-tuning (see Auto-tune (05.012)) or the values can be set up manually by the user. The calculations given below are those
used by the auto-tuning system and should give good performance without excessive overshoot.

The proportional gain, Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013), is the most critical value in controlling the performance of the current controllers. The required
value can be calculated as

Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013) = (L / T) x (Ifs / Vfs) x (256 / 5)

where:

T is the sample time of the current controllers. The drive compensates for any change of sample time, and so it should be assumed that the sample time is
equivalent to the base value of 167μs.

L is the motor inductance. For a servo motor this is half the phase to phase inductance that is normally specified by the manufacturer. For an induction motor
this is the per phase transient inductance (σLs). The inductance for either of these motors can be taken from the manufacturers data or it can be obtained from
the value stored in the Transient Inductance (05.024) after auto-tuning.

Ifs is the peak full scale current feedback, i.e. full scale current x √2. The r.m.s. full scale current is given by Full Scale Current Kc (11.061), and so Ifs =
Full Scale Current Kc (11.061) x √2.

Vfs is the maximum d.c. bus voltage.

Therefore:

Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013) = (L / 167μs) x (Kc x √2/ Vfs) x (256 / 5) = K x L x Kc

Where K = [√2 / (Vfs x 167μs)] x (256 / 5)

There is one value of the scaling factor K for each drive voltage rating as shown in the table below.

Drive Rated Voltage (11.033) Vfs K


200V 415V 1045
400V 830V 522
575V 990V 438
690V 1190V 364

The integral gain, Current Controller Ki Gain (04.014), is less critical. A suggested value which matches the zero with the pole caused by the electrical time
constant of the motor and ensures that the integral term does not contribute to current overshoot is given by

Current Controller Ki Gain (04.014) = Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013) x 256 x T / τm

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


140 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Where τm is the motor time constant (L / R). R is the per phase stator resistance of the motor (i.e. half the resistance measured between two phases).

Therefore:

Current Controller Ki Gain (04.014) = (K x L x Kc) x 256 x 167μs x R / L = 0.0427 x K x R x Kc

The above equations give the gain values that should give a good response with minimal overshoot. If required the gains can be adjusted to modify the
performance as follows:

1. Current Controller Ki Gain (04.014) can be increased to improve the performance of the current controllers by reducing the effects of inverter non-
linearity. These effects become more significant with higher switching frequency. These effects will be more significant for drives with higher current
ratings and higher voltage ratings. If Current Controller Ki Gain (04.014) is increased by a factor of 4 it is possible to get up to 10% overshoot in
response to a step change of current reference. For high performance applications, it is recommended that Current Controller Ki Gain (04.014) is
increased by a factor of 4 from the auto-tuned values. As the inverter non-linearity is worse with higher switching frequencies it is may be necessary to
increase Current Controller Ki Gain (04.014) by a factor of 8 for operation with 16kHz switching frequency.
2. It is possible to increase Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013) to reduce the response time of the current controllers. If Current Controller Kp Gain
(04.013) is increased by a factor of 1.5 then the response to a step change of reference will give 12.5% overshoot. It is recommended that
Current Controller Ki Gain (04.014) is increased in preference to Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013).

As already stated, the drive compensates for changes of switching frequency and the sampling method used by the controller. The table below shows the
adjustment applied to the proportional and integral gains.

Switching Frequency Current controller Current Controller Kp Gain Current Controller Ki Gain
(05.037) sample time Current (04.013) adjustment (04.014) adjustment
2kHz 250μs x 167 / 250 = 0.7 x 1.0
3kHz 167μs x 167 / 167 = 1.0 x 1.0
4kHz 125μs x 167 / 125 = 1.3 x 1.0
6kHz 83μs x 167 / 83 = 2.0 x 1.0
8kHz 62.5μs x 167 / 62.5 = 2.7 x 1.0
12kHz 83μs x (167 / 83) x (4 / 3) = 2.7 x 4 / 3 = 1.3
16kHz 62.5μs x (167 / 62.5) x (4 / 3) = 3.6 x 4 / 3 = 1.3

The amount of acoustic noise produced in the motor from position feedback quantisation is related to the resolution of the position feedback and the product of
the speed controller and current controller proportional gains. The values in this table can be used in conjunction with the speed controller loop proportional
gain to assess the amount of acoustic noise that is likely to be produced.

High performance mode


High performance mode gives fast closed-loop dynamic performance as though the proportional gain has been set to the maximum value defined below. This
is the maximum value that should be used to prevent excessive over-shoot or instability. It should be noted that this is 5 times the maximum value used
for standard mode.

Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013) = (L / T) x (Ifs / Vfs) x 256 = K x L x Kc x 5

The closed-loop dynamic performance defines the response of the current controllers to a change of current reference. This response cannot be changed by
modifying Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013), however the ability of the current controllers to reject voltage disturbances is affected by
Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013). Normally the auto-tuned value (which is one fifth of of the maximum recommended value) will give good rejection of
voltage disturbances, but the proportional gain can be increased up to the maximum value to improve this. It should be noted that the higher closed-loop
response of the controllers means that encoder position quantisation will cause significant acoustic noise in the motor unless a high resolution encoder is
used. Increasing Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013) also increases acoustic noise due to noise on the current feedback. High performance mode uses the
measured motor resistance and inductance, and so it is recommended that these are obtained with auto-tuning using test 1 or 2.

The integral gain provides a trim on the currents, and generally the auto-tuned value should be sufficient, however, this may be increased if required.

The drive compensates for changes of switching frequency used by the controller. The table below shows the adjustment applied to the proportional and
integral gains.

Switching Frequency Current controller Current Controller Kp Gain Current Controller Ki Gain
(05.037) sample time Current (04.013) adjustment (04.014) adjustment
2kHz 500us x 167 / 500 = 0.3 x 1.0
3kHz 333us x 167 / 333 = 0.5 x 1.0
4kHz 250us x 167 / 250 = 0.7 x 1.0
6kHz 167μs x 167 / 167 = 1.0 x 1.0
8kHz 125μs x 167 / 125 = 1.3 x 1.0
12kHz 83μs x 167 / 83 = 2.0 x 1.0
16kHz 62.5μs x 167 / 62.5 = 2.7 x 1.0

Parameter 04.014 Current Controller Ki Gain


Short description Defines the current loop controller integral gain
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 30000
Default 2000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 141
Parameter 04.015 Motor Thermal Time Constant 1
Short description Set to the thermal time constant for the motor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1.0 Maximum 3000.0
Default 89.0 Units s
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

A dual time constant thermal model is provided that can be used to estimate the motor temperature as a percentage of its maximum allowed temperature. The
input to the model is the Current Magnitude (04.001). Throughout the following discussion Rated Current (05.007) is used in the model
assuming Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 0. If Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 1 then M2 Rated Current (21.007) is used instead. It should be
noted that if the parameters that have been added in addition to those in Unidrive SP are left at their default values the model is a simple single time constant
model as provided in Unidrive SP.

Percentage Losses
The losses in the motor are calculated as a percentage value.

Percentage Losses = 100% x [Load Related Losses + Iron Losses]

where:
Load Related Losses = (1 - Kfe) x (I / (K1 x IRated))2
Iron Losses = Kfe x (w / wRated)1.6

where:
I = Current Magnitude (04.001)
IRated = Rated Current (05.007)
Kfe = Rated Iron Losses As Percentage Of Losses (04.039) / 100%

The iron losses are relatively low in motors that have a rated frequency of 60Hz or less, and so the motor could be modelled based on load related losses
alone. This can be done by setting Kfe to zero. In motors where iron losses are significant, Kfe defines the proportion of losses that are iron losses under rated
conditions (i.e. rated current and rated frequency). For example if the iron losses are 30% of losses and other losses are 70% of losses under rated
conditions Rated Iron Losses As Percentage Of Losses (04.039) should be set to 30%.

The value of K1 defines the continuous allowable motor overload as a proportion of the Rated Current (05.007) before the Motor Protection Accumulator
(04.019) reaches 100%. The value of K1 can be used to model reduced cooling at low speeds and to allow the motor to operate under rated conditions with a
small margin to prevent spurious trips. K1 is defined in more detail later.

Motor Protection Accumulator


So far the steady state motor losses have been defined, but the motor model must estimate the temperature within the motor under dynamically changing
conditions, and so the Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) is given by the following equation.

T = Percentage Losses x [(1 − K2) (1 − e-t/τ1) + K2 (1 − e-t/τ2)]

where
T = Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019)
K2 = Motor Thermal Time Constant 2 Scaling (04.038) / 100%
τ1 = Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 (04.015)
τ2 = Motor Thermal Time Constant 2 (04.037)

[(1 − K2) (1 − e-t/τ1) + K2 (1 − e-t/τ2)] gives the effects of the thermal time constants in the motor. K2 defines the ratio of the contribution to
the Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) value from each of the time constants. If K2 is set to its default value of 0 then only Motor Thermal Time Constant 1
(04.015) is included and the model will give the temperature of the main mass of the motor body. To give better protection to the motor, the model can be used
to model a particular point in the motor, for example the stator windings. This can be done by including an additional shorter time constant representing the
thermal impedance between the windings and the main mass of the motor body which can be modelled with Motor Thermal Time Constant 2 (04.037).

Reduced cooling with lower speed


If Rated Current (05.007) ≤ Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032) then K1 is defined as shown below. If Low Speed Thermal Protection Mode (04.025) = 0 the
characteristic is intended for a motor which can operate at rated current over the whole speed range. Induction motors with this type of characteristic normally
have forced cooling. If Low Speed Thermal Protection Mode (04.025) = 1 the characteristic is intended for motors where the cooling effect of motor fan
reduces with reduced motor speed below half of rated speed. The maximum value for K 1 is 1.05, so that above the knee of the characteristics the motor can
operate continuously up to 105% of rated current.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


142 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
If Rated Current (05.007) > Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032) then K1 is defined as shown below. Two different characteristics are provided, but in both
cases the motor performance is limited at lower speeds and the permissible overload is reduced from 105% to 101%.

Time for Motor Protection Accumulator to reach 100%


Assuming a single time constant model is being used (i.e. Motor Thermal Time Constant 2 Scaling (04.038), the time for the Motor Protection Accumulator
(04.019) to change from its initial value to 100% is given by the following equation:

Time to reach 100.0% = -τ1 x ln[(1 − C1) / (C0 − C1)]

C0 represents the conditions that have persisted for long enough for the Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) to reach a steady state value. If the motor
current and speed are I0 and w0 then,

C0 = [(1 - Kfe) x (I0 / (K1 x IRated))2] + [Kfe x (w0 / wRated)1.6]

C1 represents the conditions that begin at the start of the time being calculated. If the motor current and speed are by I 1 and w1 then,

C1 = [(1 - Kfe) x (I1 / (K1 x IRated))2] + [Kfe x (w1 / wRated)1.6]

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 143
Example 1: The effect of iron losses are not modelled (Kfe = 0), Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 (04.015) = 89s, the initial current is zero, Rated Current
(05.007) ≤ Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032) and the new level of current is 1.5 x Rated Current (05.007).

C0 = 0
C1 = [1.5 / (1.05 x 1.0)]2 = 2.041

Time to reach 100.0% = -89 x ln(1 − 1/C1) = -89 x ln(1 − 1/2.041) = 60s

This is the default setting for Open-loop and RFC-A modes allowing an induction motor to run at 150% rated current for 60s from cold.

Example 2: The effect of iron losses are not modelled (Kfe = 0), Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 (04.015) = 89s, the initial current is Rated Current (05.007),
Rated Current (05.007) ≤ Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032) and the new level of current is 1.5 x Rated Current (05.007).

C0 = [1.0 / (1.05 x 1.0)]2 = 0.907


C1 = [1.5 / (1.05 x 1.0)]2 = 2.041

Time to reach 100.0% = -89 x ln((1 − C1) / (C0 − C1)) = -89 x ln[(1 − 2.041) / (0.907 − 2.041)] = 7.6s

This is the default setting for Open-loop and RFC-A modes allowing an induction motor to run at 150% rated current for 7.6s after running under rated
conditions for a significant period of time.

Motor Protection Accumulator Reset


The initial value in the Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) at power-up is defined by Motor Protection Accumulator Power-up Value (04.036) as given in
the table below.

Motor Protection Accumulator Power-


Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) at power-up
up Value (04.036)

Power Down The value is saved at power-down and is used as the initial value at power-up.

Zero The value is set to zero

If a real-time clock is present and if Date/Time Selector  (06.019) is set up to select the real-time clock then the
value saved at power-down is modified to include the effect of the motor thermal protection time constants over the
Real Time time between power-down and power-up. This modified value is then used as the initial value at power-up.

If no real time clock is present then and this option is selected then the value saved at power-down is used as the
initial value.

The Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) is reset under the following conditions:

1. Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 (04.015) is set to 0.0. Note that this is not possible in the standard product as the minimum parameter value is 1.0.
2. Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) is modified.
3. Rated Current (05.007) is modified when Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 0, or M2 Rated Current (21.007) is modified when
Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 1.
4. Thermal Protection Mode (04.016) is modified.

Motor Protection Accumulator Warning


If Percentage Losses > 100% then eventually the Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) will reach 100% causing the drive to trip or the current limits to be
reduced. If this is the case and Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) > 75.0% then [Motor Overload] alarm indication is given and Motor Overload Alarm
(10.017) is set to one.

Parameter 04.016 Thermal Protection Mode


Short description Set to the require thermal protection mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Motor Trip
1 Motor Limit
2 Drive Limit
3 Both Limit
4 Disabled

Thermal Protection Mode (04.016) defines the action taken by the drive when Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) reaches 100%
and/or Percentage Of Drive Thermal Trip Level (07.036) exceeds 90%. The actions for each mode are given in the table below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


144 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Thermal Protection Mode (04.016) Actions

Motor Too Hot trip is initiated when Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) reaches 100%.


Motor Trip (0) No current limiting.
Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) is limited to 100.0%.

Motor Too Hot trip is disabled.


Motor Current Limit (1) Current limiting on motor overload as described below.
Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) is limited to 100.0%.

Motor Too Hot trip is initiated when Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) reaches 100%.


Drive Current Limit (2) Current limiting on drive thermal monitoring as described below.
Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) is limited to 100.0%.
Motor Too Hot trip is disabled.
Motor and Drive Current Limit (3) Current limiting on motor overload and drive thermal monitoring as described below.
Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) is limited to 100.0%.
Motor Too Hot trip is disabled and Motor Overload alarm is disabled.
Disabled (4) No current limiting.
Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) is limited to 200.0%.

The current limit is derived from the current limit parameters (i.e. Motoring Current Limit (04.005), etc.) depending on the set-up and conditions. The current
limit can be further limited by current limit on motor overload and/or drive temperature monitoring as shown below to give the Final Current Limit (04.018).

Current limiting on motor overload


When the Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) reaches 100.0% the current limit is limited to (K1 – 0.05) x 100.0%. This limitation is removed when the
Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) falls below 95.0%. (K1 is defined in the description of Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 (04.015).)

Drive thermal monitoring current limiting


If Percentage Of Drive Thermal Trip Level (07.036) exceeds 90% the current limit is modified as follows:

Final Current Limit (04.018) = Current limit x (100% - Percentage Of Drive Thermal Trip Level (07.036)) / 10%

If both of the above attempt to reduce the final current limit the lowest calculated value of current limit is used.

This system has the effect of reducing the current limit to zero at the point where the drive should be tripped because its thermal monitoring has reached a trip
threshold. This is intended to limit the load on the drive to prevent it from tripping when supplying a load that increases with speed and does not include rapid
transients.

Parameter 04.017 Magnetising Current


Short description Shows the instantaneous level of magnetising current
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_DRIVE_CURRENT[MIN] Maximum VM_DRIVE_CURRENT[MAX]
Default Units A
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

Id, Magnetising Current (04.017) is the instantaneous level of magnetising current scaled so that it represents the r.m.s. level of magnetising current under
steady state conditions.

Parameter 04.018 Final Current Limit


Short description Shows the final current limit that is applied to the torque producing current
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MIN] Maximum VM_TORQUE_CURRENT[MAX]
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, VM, ND, NC, PT

Final Current Limit (04.018) is the current limit level that is applied to give the Final Current Reference (04.004).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 145
Parameter 04.019 Motor Protection Accumulator
Short description Shows the level of the motor protection accumulator
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 200.0
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 (04.015).

Parameter 04.020 Percentage Load


Shows the level of torque producing current as a percentage of rated torque producing current for the
Short description
motor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_USER_CURRENT[MIN] Maximum VM_USER_CURRENT[MAX]
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

Percentage Load (04.020) gives the Iq, Torque Producing Current (04.002) as a percentage of the rated torque producing current for the motor. Positive
values indicate motoring and negative values represent regenerating.

Parameter 04.021 Current Feedback Filter Disable


Short description Disables the 4ms filter applied to current feedback parameters
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If Current Feedback Filter Disable (04.021) = 0 a 4ms filter is applied to the current feedback components measured by the drive to be used in Iq,
Torque Producing Current (04.002) and Id, Magnetising Current (04.017). This filter removes ripple components associated with the PWM switching. If
Current Feedback Filter Disable (04.021) = 1, the filter is disabled and the user parameters are based on the current components sampled every 250us.

Parameter 04.022 Inertia Compensation Enable


Short description Set to enable inertia compensation
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If Inertia Compensation Enable (04.022) is set to one the Inertia Compensation Torque (02.038) is added to the output of the speed controller. The
Inertia Compensation Torque (02.038) is calculated based on a value of load inertia supplied by the user (Motor And Load Inertia (03.018)) and the rate of
change of the speed reference. This can be used in speed or torque controller applications to provide the torque necessary to accelerate or decelerate the
load.

Parameter 04.023 Current Reference Filter 2 Time Constant


Defines the time constant of an alternative first order filter that can be applied to the final current
Short description
reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 25.0
Default 0.0 Units ms
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, BU

See Current Reference Filter 1 Time Constant (04.012).

Parameter 04.024 User Current Maximum Scaling


Short description Defines the maximum for the torque reference and percentage load parameters
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_TORQUE_CURRENT_UNIPOLAR[MIN] Maximum VM_TORQUE_CURRENT_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 175.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM, RA

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


146 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
User Current Maximum Scaling (04.024) defines the variable maximum/minimums VM_USER_CURRENT and VM_USER_CURRENT_HIGH_RES which are
applied to Percentage Load (04.020), Torque Reference (04.008) and Torque Offset (04.009). This is useful when routing these parameters to an analog
output as it allows the full scale output value to be defined by the user.

The maximum value (VM_TORQUE_CURRENT_UNIPOLAR [MAX]) varies between drive sizes with default parameters loaded. For some drive sizes the
default value may be reduced below the value given by the parameter range limiting.

Parameter 04.025 Low Speed Thermal Protection Mode


Short description Set to enable low speed thermal protection mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 (04.015).

Parameter 04.026 Percentage Torque


Short description Shows the calculated torque as a percentage of rated torque
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_USER_CURRENT[MIN] Maximum VM_USER_CURRENT[MAX]
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

The shaft torque of the motor is estimated by the drive and Percentage Torque (04.026) gives this torque as a percentage of the expected torque defined
by Rated Torque (04.041). The default value for Rated Torque (04.041) is zero which disables this feature so that Percentage Torque (04.026) is always zero.
To enable the torque estimation system Rated Torque (04.041) should be set to the expected torque from the motor under rated conditions. For accurate
torque estimation, and consistent results for both motoring and regenerating conditions, it is necessary to provide the drive with the core losses under no-load
and rated load conditions at rated speed (i.e. No-load Core Loss (04.045) and Rated Core Loss (04.046) respectively). The drive will then include the core
power loss in the torque calculation as

PCoreLoss = No-load Core Loss (04.045) + (Rated Core Loss (04.046) - No-load Core Loss (04.045)) x (Torque Producing Current / Rated Torque Producing
Current)

If Rated Core Loss (04.046) ≤ No-load Core Loss (04.045) then only the no load value is used and PCoreLoss = No-load Core Loss (04.045). This provides
some compensation for core losses, but not the load dependent component. The core loss power values can be difficult to obtain except by experimental
measurement because the loss mechanisms within the motor are complex and are affected by the PWM frequencies applied to the motor by the drive. It is
possible to obtain an estimate for No-load Core Loss (04.045) during auto-tuning for RFC-A mode, but not RFC-S mode. As the auto-tuning algorithm cannot
measure Rated Core Loss (04.046) this is set to zero, so that it is not used. If power dependent core losses are to be included Rated Core Loss (04.046) must
be set by the user.

Parameter 04.027 Low Load Detection Level


Short description Defines the low load detection level
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 100.0
Default 0.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

If Low Load Detection Level (04.027) is set to 0.0 the low load detection system is disabled, otherwise the low load detection system is enabled. The low load
detection system is provided so that loss of load can be detected and action taken. So that the detector can be used with fan and pump type loads, where the
load is relatively light at low motor speed, the detector is only active when the output frequency or speed is above the level defined
by Low Load Detection Speed/Frequency Threshold (04.028). The detector is also only enabled when the motor is at the required speed (i.e. not accelerating
or decelerating), and so it is only active when At Speed (10.006) = 1. Once the detector is active, the low load condition is detected when the Percentage Load
(04.020) falls below the threshold defined by Low Load Detection Level (04.027). Therefore the condition for detecting low load is given by,

At Speed (10.006) = 1 AND |Speed Feedback (03.002)| > Low Load Detection Speed/Frequency Threshold (04.028) AND |Percentage Load (04.020)| <
Low Load Detection Level (04.027)

The diagram below shows a typical fan type load and the shaded areas define where low load is detected.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 147
Enable Trip On Low Load (04.029) defines the action taken when low load is detected. If Enable Trip On Low Load (04.029) = 0 a Low Load warning is
displayed and Low Load Detected Alarm (10.062) is set to one. If Enable Trip On Low Load (04.029) = 1 no warning is given, but a Low Load trip is initiated.

Parameter 04.028 Low Load Detection Speed/Frequency Threshold


Short description Defines the low load detection speed/frequency threshold
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF_UNIPOLAR[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

See Low Load Detection Level (04.027).

Parameter 04.029 Enable Trip On Low Load


Short description Defines the action taken when low load is detected
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Low Load Detection Level (04.027).

Parameter 04.030 Current Controller Mode


Short description Set to enable high performance current controller mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


148 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 04.031 Notch Filter Centre Frequency
Short description Defines the centre frequency for a notch filter to cancel a mechanical resonance
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 50 Maximum 1200
Default 100 Units Hz
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

A notch filter can be inserted be applied to the Final Current Reference (04.004) to remove the effect of a mechanical resonance in the system.
Notch Filter Centre Frequency (04.031) defines the centre frequency (f0) in Hertz and Notch Filter Bandwidth (04.032) defines the bandwidth (fBW) which is the
frequency difference between the 3dB points of the notch filter in Hertz. The Q of the filter is given by Q = f0 / fBW. If Notch Filter Bandwidth (04.032) is at its
default value of zero then the notch filter is disabled. It should be noted that although it is possible to set a bandwidth that is higher than twice the centre
frequency, the bandwidth of the filter is limited to twice the centre frequency.

Parameter 04.032 Notch Filter Bandwidth


Short description Defines the bandwidth for a notch filter to cancel mechanical resonance
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1200
Default 0 Units Hz
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Notch Filter Centre Frequency (04.031).

Parameter 04.033 Inertia Times 1000


Short description Inertia is in 1000kgm2 units
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The inertia in Motor And Load Inertia (03.018) is in kgm2 if this parameter is zero, otherwise if it is one the inertia is in 1000kgm2 units.

Parameter 04.036 Motor Protection Accumulator Power-up Value


Short description Defines the initial power-up value of the motor protection accumulator
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Power down
1 Zero
2 Real time

See Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 (04.015).

Parameter 04.037 Motor Thermal Time Constant 2


Short description Can be used to define an additional motor thermal time constant
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1.0 Maximum 3000.0
Default 89.0 Units s
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

See Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 (04.015).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 149
Parameter 04.038 Motor Thermal Time Constant 2 Scaling
Defines the ratio of the contribution to the motor protection accumulator value from each of the time
Short description
constants
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 100
Default 0 Units %
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 (04.015).

Parameter 04.039 Rated Iron Losses As Percentage Of Losses


Short description Set to the rated iron losses of the motor as a percentage of the total losses for the motor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 100
Default 0 Units %
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 (04.015).

Parameter 04.041 Rated Torque


Short description Rated torque used by the torque correction system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 50000.00
Default 0.00 Units Nm
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

The estimated torque (Percentage Torque (04.026)) is given as a percentage of Rated Torque (04.041). If Rated Torque (04.041) is left at the default value of
zero then Percentage Torque (04.026) will remain at zero under all conditions.

Parameter 04.042 Torque Estimation Minimum Frequency


Short description Minimum frequency used by the torque correction system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 100
Default 5 Units %
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The drive estimates the motor shaft torque (Percentage Torque (04.026)), but at low output frequencies this estimate is very inaccurate.
Torque Estimation Minimum Frequency (04.042) defines the point where the estimate of torque is too inaccurate to use as a percentage of Rated Frequency
(05.006), i.e. FThreshold = Rated Frequency (05.006) x Torque Estimation Minimum Frequency (04.042) / 100.

Condition Percentage Torque (04.026)


|Output Frequency (05.001)| <
FThreshold Torque reference with no core loses

FThreshold < | Output Frequency Changes linearly between torque reference with no core losses and
(05.001) | < 2FThreshold calculated torque including core losses
|Output Frequency (05.001)| >
2FThreshold Calculated torque including core losses

Parameter 04.043 Torque Correction Time Constant


Short description Time constant used by the torque correction system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 10.00
Default 0.00 Units s
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

The torque correction system uses the Final Torque Reference (04.003) and the Percentage Torque (04.026) to calculate the error between the required and
actual torque. This error is used by the torque correction system to apply a trim to the torque reference being used by the drive. If
Torque Correction Time Constant (04.043) is set to a non-zero value this system is enabled and Torque Correction Time Constant (04.043) defines the time
constant of the correction system. The maximum positive or negative trim that can be applied is defined by Torque Correction Maximum (04.044).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


150 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 04.044 Torque Correction Maximum
Short description Maximum trim that can be applied to the torque reference to correct the torque.
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 100
Default 20 Units %
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Torque Correction Time Constant (04.043).

Parameter 04.045 No-load Core Loss


Short description Defines the no-load core loss for the motor used by the torque correction system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 99999.999
Default 0.000 Units kW
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See Percentage Torque (04.026).

Parameter 04.046 Rated Core Loss


Short description Defines the rated core loss for the motor used by the torque correction system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 99999.999
Default 0.000 Units kW
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See Percentage Torque (04.026).

Parameter 04.049 Magnetising Current Limit


Short description Magnetising Current Limit
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 100.0
Default 100.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

Magnetising Current Limit (04.049) defines the maximum level of magnetising current used as a percentage of Rated Current (05.007). The magnetising
current is normally at the rated level for the motor, but may increase up to this limit when the drive is enabled to raise the flux in the motor as fast as possible.
The magnetising current can also be increased above the rated level when the motor is decelerated rapidly from the flux weakening range. The default value
for Magnetising Current Limit (04.049) is normally suitable, but may be decreased if required. The maximum level of magnetising current will not be decreased
below the rated level for the motor how ever low the value in Magnetising Current Limit (04.049).

Parameter 04.050 Low-pass Filter Cut-off Frequency


Short description Overrides the other setting for the current reference low-pass filter and defines the cut-off frequency.
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1000
Default 0 Units Hz
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The current reference low-pass filter is normally set up using its time constant with Current Reference Filter 1 Time Constant (04.012),
Current Reference Filter 2 Time Constant (04.023) or M2 Current Reference Filter Time Constant 1 (21.032). If these parameter are used the resolution of the
cut-off frequency is poor with shorter time constants. If Low-pass Filter Cut-off Frequency (04.050) is less than 10Hz it has no effect. If it is set to 10Hz or
above it overrides all other setting parameters and defines the cut-off frequency in Hz.

Parameter 04.051 Bi-quad Filter1: a0


Short description Used to define the a0 coefficient for a bi-quad filter to repace the notch filter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2.0000 Maximum 2.0000
Default 0.0000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 151
It is possible to replace low-pass filter defined by Current Reference Filter 1 Time Constant (04.012), Current Reference Filter 2 Time Constant
(04.023), M2 Current Reference Filter Time Constant 1 (21.032) or Low-pass Filter Cut-off Frequency (04.050) with a user defined first or second order
filter. The replacement filter is a bi-quad filter with the following transfer function.

F(s) = (As2 + Bs + C) / (Ds2 + Es + F)

The coefficients of the transfer function must be translated into the coefficients for the difference equation below which implements this filter with a sample
time of 250us.

ON = a0.IN + a1.IN-1 + a2.IN-2 - b1.ON-1 - b2.ON-2

where
Bi-quad Filter1: a0 (04.051) = a0
Bi-quad Filter1: a1 (04.052) = a1
Bi-quad Filter1: a2 (04.053) = a2
Bi-quad Filter1: b1 (04.054) = b1
Bi-quad Filter1: b2 (04.055) = b2

If any of these parameters are changed from their default value of zero then the internal low-pass filter is disabled and the coefficients in these parameter are
used to define the replacement filter. A method that can be used to calculate the coefficients, with some examples, is given in the "Digital Filter Design"
document included in this parameter reference guide.

Parameter 04.052 Bi-quad Filter1: a1


Short description Used to define the a1 coefficient for a bi-quad filter to repace the notch filter.
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2.0000 Maximum 2.0000
Default 0.0000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW

See Bi-quad Filter1: a0 (04.051).

Parameter 04.053 Bi-quad Filter1: a2


Short description Used to define the a2 coefficient for a bi-quad filter to repace the notch filter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2.0000 Maximum 2.0000
Default 0.0000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW

See Bi-quad Filter1: a0 (04.051).

Parameter 04.054 Bi-quad Filter1: b1


Short description Used to define the b1 coefficient for a bi-quad filter to repace the notch filter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2.0000 Maximum 2.0000
Default 0.0000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW

See Bi-quad Filter1: a0 (04.051).

Parameter 04.055 Bi-quad Filter1: b2


Short description Used to define the b2 coefficient for a bi-quad filter to repace the notch filter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2.0000 Maximum 2.0000
Default 0.0000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW

See Bi-quad Filter1: a0 (04.051).

Parameter 04.056 Bi-quad Filter2: a0


Short description Used to define the a0 coefficient for a bi-quad filter to repace the low-pass filter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2.0000 Maximum 2.0000
Default 0.0000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


152 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
It is possible to replace the notch filter defined by Notch Filter Centre Frequency (04.031) and Notch Filter Bandwidth (04.032) with a user defined first or
second order filter. The replacement filter is a bi-quad filter. See Bi-quad Filter1: a0 (04.051) for details. This filter is set up by the following parameters.

Bi-quad Filter2: a0 (04.056) = a0
Bi-quad Filter2: a1 (04.057) = a1
Bi-quad Filter2: a2 (04.058) = a2
Bi-quad Filter2: b1 (04.059) = b1
Bi-quad Filter2: b2 (04.060) = b2

If any of these parameters are changed from their default value of zero then the internal notch filter is disabled and the coefficients in these parameter are
used to define the replacement filter.

Parameter 04.057 Bi-quad Filter2: a1


Short description Used to define the a1 coefficient for a bi-quad filter to repace the low-pass filter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2.0000 Maximum 2.0000
Default 0.0000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW

See Bi-quad Filter2: a0 (04.056).

Parameter 04.058 Bi-quad Filter2: a2


Short description Used to define the a2 coefficient for a bi-quad filter to repace the low-pass filter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2.0000 Maximum 2.0000
Default 0.0000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW

See Bi-quad Filter2: a0 (04.056).

Parameter 04.059 Bi-quad Filter2: b1


Short description Used to define the b1 coefficient for a bi-quad filter to repace the low-pass filter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2.0000 Maximum 2.0000
Default 0.0000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW

See Bi-quad Filter2: a0 (04.056).

Parameter 04.060 Bi-quad Filter2: b2


Short description Used to define the b2 coefficient for a bi-quad filter to repace the low-pass filter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2.0000 Maximum 2.0000
Default 0.0000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW

See Bi-quad Filter2: a0 (04.056).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 153
Menu 5 Single Line Descriptions − Motor Control
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


154 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter Range Default Type
05.001 Output Frequency ±2000.0 Hz RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_AC_VOLTAGE[MIN] to
05.002 Output Voltage RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_AC_VOLTAGE[MAX] V
05.003 Output Power VM_POWER[MIN] to VM_POWER[MAX] kW RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_DC_VOLTAGE[MIN] to
05.005 D.c. Bus Voltage RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_DC_VOLTAGE[MAX] V
50Hz: 50.0 Hz
05.006 Rated Frequency 0.0 to 550.0 Hz RW Num US
60Hz: 60.0 Hz
VM_RATED_CURRENT[MIN] to
05.007 Rated Current 0.000 A RW Num RA US
VM_RATED_CURRENT[MAX] A
50Hz: 1500.00 rpm
05.008 Rated Speed 0.00 to 33000.00 rpm RW Num US
60Hz: 1800.00 rpm
200V drive: 230 V
400V drive 50Hz: 400 V
VM_AC_VOLTAGE_SET[MIN] to
05.009 Rated Voltage 400V drive 60Hz: 460 V RW Num RA US
VM_AC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX] V
575V drive: 575 V
690V drive: 690 V
05.010 Rated Power Factor 0.000 to 1.000 0.850 RW Num RA US
05.011 Number Of Motor Poles Automatic (0) to 480 (240) Poles Automatic (0) Poles RW Txt US
Auto‑tune None (0), Basic (1), Improved (2), Inertia 1 (3),
05.012 None (0) RW Txt NC
Inertia 2 (4)
05.013 Flux Optimisation Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
05.015 Low Frequency Voltage Boost 0.0 to 25.0 % 3.0 % RW Num US
Disabled (0), Classic Slow (1), Classic Fast (2),
05.016 Rated Speed Optimisation Select Combined (3), VARs Only (4), Disabled (0) RW Txt US
Voltage Only (5)
05.017 Stator Resistance 0.000000 to 1000.000000 Ω 0.000000 Ω RW Num RA US
05.018 Maximum Switching Frequency 0 to VM_SWITCHING_FREQUENCY kHz 3 (1) kHz RW Txt RA US
05.019 Rated Speed Optimisation Minimum Frequency 0 to 100 % 10 % RW Num US
05.020 Rated Speed Optimisation Minimum Load 0 to 100 % 50 % RW Num US
05.021 Mechanical Load Test Level 0 to 100 % 0% RW Num US
VM_HIGH_DC_VOLTAGE[MIN] to
05.023 D.c. Bus Voltage High Range RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_HIGH_DC_VOLTAGE[MAX] V
05.024 Transient Inductance 0.000 to 500.000 mH 0.000 mH RW Num RA US
05.025 Stator Inductance 0.00 to 5000.00 mH 0.00 mH RW Num RA US
05.026 High Dynamic Performance Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
05.027 Flux Control Gain ±10.0 1.0 RW Num US
05.028 Flux Compensation 0 to 2 0 RW Num US
05.029 Saturation Breakpoint 1 0.0 to 100.0 % 50.0 % RW Num US
05.030 Saturation Breakpoint 3 0.0 to 100.0 % 75.0 % RW Num US
05.031 Voltage Controller Gain 1 to 30 1 RW Num US
05.032 Torque Per Amp 0.00 to 500.00 Nm/A RO Num ND NC PT
05.034 Percentage Flux 0.0 to 150.0 % RO Num ND NC PT FI
Auto‑switching Frequency Change Enabled (0), Disabled (1),
05.035 Enabled (0) RW Txt US
No Ripple Detect (2)
05.036 Auto‑switching Frequency Step Size 1 to 2 2 RW Num US
05.037 Switching Frequency 2 (0), 3 (1), 4 (2), 6 (3), 8 (4), 12 (5), 16 (6) kHz RO Txt ND NC PT
05.038 Minimum Switching Frequency 0 to VM_MIN_SWITCHING_FREQUENCY kHz 2 (0) kHz RW Txt US
05.039 Maximum Inverter Temperature Ripple 20 to 60 °C 60 °C RW Num US
05.040 Spin Start Boost 0.0 to 10.0 1.0 RW Num US
05.041 Voltage Headroom 0 to 20 % 0% RW Num US
05.042 Reverse Output Phase Sequence Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
An In 3 (0), User (1), P1 Drive (2), P1 Slot1 (3),
05.044 Stator Temperature Source An In 3 (0) RW Txt US
P1 Slot2 (4), P1 Slot3 (5), P1 Slot4 (6)
05.045 User Stator Temperature -50 to 300 °C 0 °C RW Num
05.046 Stator Temperature -50 to 300 °C RO Num ND NC PT
05.047 Stator Temperature Coefficient 0.00000 to 0.10000 1/°C 0.00390 1/°C RW Num US
05.048 Stator Base Temperature -50 to 300 °C 0 °C RW Num US
05.049 Enable Stator Compensation Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
05.050 Temperature Compensated Stator Resistance 0.000000 to 1000.000000 RO Num ND NC PT
An In 3 (0), User (1), P1 Drive (2), P1 Slot1 (3),
05.051 Rotor Temperature Source An In 3 (0) RW Txt US
P1 Slot2 (4), P1 Slot3 (5), P1 Slot4 (6)
05.052 User Rotor Temperature -50 to 300 °C 0 °C RW Num
05.053 Rotor Temperature -50 to 300 °C RO Num ND NC PT
05.054 Rotor Temperature Coefficient 0.00000 to 0.10000 1/°C 0.00390 1/°C RW Num US
05.055 Rotor Base Temperature -50 to 300 °C 0 °C RW Num US
05.056 Enable Rotor Compensation Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
05.057 Temperature compensated rated speed 0.00 to 33000.00 rpm RO Num ND NC PT
05.059 Maximum Deadtime Compensation 0.000 to 10.000 µs 0.000 µs RO Num NC PT US

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 155
05.060 Current At Maximum Deadtime Compensation 0.00 to 100.00 % 0.00 % RO Num NC PT US
05.061 Disable Deadtime Compensation Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
05.062 Saturation Breakpoint 2 0.0 to 100.0 % 0.0 % RW Num US
05.063 Saturation Breakpoint 4 0.0 to 100.0 % 0.0 % RW Num US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


156 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 5 − Motor Control
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 157
Parameter 05.001 Output Frequency
Short description Displays the frequency applied to the motor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2000.0 Maximum 2000.0
Default Units Hz
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, FI, ND, NC, PT

The output frequency is not controlled directly, but the Output Frequency (05.001) is a measurement of the frequency applied to the motor.

Parameter 05.002 Output Voltage


Short description Displays the r.m.s. line to line voltage at the a.c. terminals of the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AC_VOLTAGE[MIN] Maximum VM_AC_VOLTAGE[MAX]
Default Units V
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

The Output Voltage (05.002) is the r.m.s. line to line voltage at the a.c. terminals of the drive.

Parameter 05.003 Output Power


Short description Displays the power flowing via the a.c. terminals of the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_POWER[MIN] Maximum VM_POWER[MAX]
Default Units kW
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

The Output Power (05.003) is the power flowing via the a.c. terminals of the drive. The power is derived as the dot product of the output voltage and
current vectors, and so this is correct even if the motor parameters are incorrect and the motor model does not align the reference frame with the flux
axis of a motor in RFC-A mode. For Open-loop, RFC-A and RFC-S modes a positive value of power indicates power flowing from the drive to motor. For
Regen mode a positive value of power indicates power flowing from the supply to the regen drive.

Parameter 05.005 D.c. Bus Voltage


Short description Displays the voltage across the d.c. link of the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_DC_VOLTAGE[MIN] Maximum VM_DC_VOLTAGE[MAX]
Default Units V
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) gives the voltage across the d.c. link of the drive.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


158 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 05.006 Rated Frequency
Short description Set to the rated frequency of the motor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 550.0
Default See exceptions below Units Hz
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

Default Value
50.0
60.0

Rated Frequency (05.006), Rated Speed (05.008) and Number Of Motor Poles (05.011) are used to calculate the rated slip of the motor which is used
by the motor control algorithm. An incorrect estimate of rated slip has the following effects:

1. Reduced efficiency
2. Reduction of maximum torque available from the motor
3. Reduced transient performance
4. Inaccurate control of absolute torque in torque control modes
5. The drive will produce rated flux in the motor in the shortest possible time when it is enabled. Incorrect parameter values will affect the
flux build-up time.

The rated speed on the motor nameplate is normally the value for a hot motor, however, some adjustment may be required when the drive is
commissioned if this is inaccurate. Either a fixed value can be entered for Rated Speed (05.008) or the optimisation system within the drive may be
used to automatically adjust the Rated Speed (05.008). See Rated Speed Optimisation Select (05.016). It should be noted that the optimisation system
does not operate when sensorless RFC-A mode is used (i.e. Sensorless Mode Active (03.078) = 1).

Parameter 05.007 Rated Current


Short description Set to the rated current rated of the motor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_RATED_CURRENT[MIN] Maximum VM_RATED_CURRENT[MAX]
Default 0.000 Units A
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM, RA

Rated Current (05.007) is used as follows:

Function Details
Motor thermal protection Defines the motor rated current.
Motor pre-heat Motor pre-heat is set up as a percentage of rated current.
Motor control Used in the motor control algorithm.
Current limits Curent limits are set up as a percentage of rated torque producing current.

Parameter 05.008 Rated Speed


Short description Set to the rated speed of the motor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 33000.00
Default See exceptions below Units rpm
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

Default Value
1500.00
1800.00

See Rated Frequency (05.006).

Parameter 05.009 Rated Voltage


Short description Set to the rated voltage of the motor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AC_VOLTAGE_SET[MIN] Maximum VM_AC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX]
Default See exceptions below Units V
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM, RA

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 159
Voltage Region Default Value
200V All 230
400V 50Hz 400
400V 60Hz 460
575V All 575
690V All 690

The Rated Voltage (05.009) is the maximum continuous voltage that is applied to the motor. Normally this should be set to the motor nameplate value. If
the drive is supplied through its own diode rectifier the maximum possible output voltage is just below the supply voltage level, and so the output voltage
will not reach Rated Voltage (05.009) if this is equal to or above the supply voltage. If high transient performance is required at higher speeds then
Rated Voltage (05.009) should be set to 95% of the minimum d.c. link voltage divided by √2 to allow some headroom for the drive to control the motor
current. If the drive is fed through its own diode rectifier the minimum d.c. link voltage is approximately supply voltage x √2.

In some cases it may be necessary to set the Rated Voltage (05.009) to a value other than the motor nameplate value. If this is the case the
Rated Frequency (05.006) and Rated Speed (05.008) should be set up as follows:

K = Rated Voltage (05.009) / motor rated voltage

Rated Frequency (05.006) = motor rated frequency x K

Rated Speed (05.008) = motor rated speed + [(K - 1) x motor rated frequency x 60 / (number of motor poles / 2)]

The Rated Voltage (05.009), Rated Frequency (05.006) and Number Of Motor Poles (05.011) are used during the auto-tuning process to determine the
flux level required in the motor for normal operation. Therefore if the Rated Voltage (05.009) is set to a value other than the nameplate value and the
above adjustment is not applied the motor may be under or over-fluxed

Parameter 05.010 Rated Power Factor


Set to the rated power factor of the motor. This value can be measured by the drive during a rotating
Short description
autotune.
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 1.000
Default 0.850 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read/write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, RA

Rated Power Factor (05.010) is the true power factor of the motor under rated conditions, i.e. the cosine of the angle between the motor voltage and
current. If Stator Inductance (05.025) is set to a non-zero value then the stator inductance is used to calculate the rated magnetising current for the
motor and the rated power factor can be calculated by the drive. Therefore if Stator Inductance (05.025) is non-zero Rated Power Factor (05.010) is
continuously set to the calculated value of rated power factor by the drive. If Stator Inductance (05.025) is set to zero then Rated Power Factor (05.010)
is used to estimate the rated magnetising current which is an approximation and not as accurate. Stator Inductance (05.025) can be measured by the
drive during auto-tuning and this is the preferred option, however, if it is not possible to obtain the value for Stator Inductance (05.025) then
Rated Power Factor (05.010) should be set to the motor nameplate value.

Parameter 05.011 Number Of Motor Poles


Short description Set to the number of poles of the motor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 240
Default 0 Units PolePairs
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

* The units relate to the numeric value of the parameter and not the text string.

The numeric value in Number Of Motor Poles (05.011) should be set to the number of motor pole pairs (i.e. number of motor poles / 2). The text strings
associated with Number Of Motor Poles (05.011) show the number of motor poles (i.e. the parameter value x 2). If a linear position feedback device is
used Number Of Motor Poles (05.011) should be set to 1 (2 Poles).

If Number Of Motor Poles (05.011) = 0 the number of motor poles are calculated automatically as given below.

Pole pairs = 60 x Rated Frequency (05.006) / Rated Speed (05.008) rounded down to the nearest integer.

Parameter 05.012 Auto-tune


Short description Defines the auto-tune test to be performed
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, NC

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


160 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Value Text
0 None
1 Basic
2 Improved
3 Inertia 1
4 Inertia 2

The following describes how an auto-tune test can be initiated and normal operation can be resumed after the test for RFC-A mode:

1. An auto-tune test cannot be initiated if the drive is tripped or the drive inverter is active, i.e. Drive Healthy (10.001) = 0 or Drive Active
(10.002) = 1. The inverter can be made inactive by ensuring that the Final drive enable is inactive, or the Final drive run is inactive and
Hold Zero Speed (06.008) = 0.
2. An auto-tune test is initiated by setting Auto-tune (05.012) to a non-zero value and making the Final drive enable and the Final drive run
active.
3. All tests that move the motor will move the motor in the forward direction if Reverse Select (01.012) = 0 or the reverse direction
if Reverse Select (01.012) = 1.
4. If the auto-tune sequence is completed successfully the Final drive enable is set to the inactive state and Auto-tune (05.012) is set to
zero. The Final drive enable can only be set to the active state again by removing the enable and reapplying it. The enable can be
removed by setting Drive Enable (06.015) = 0, or by setting bit 0 of the Control Word (06.042) to 0 provided Control Word Enable
(06.043) = 1, or by making Hardware Enable (06.029) = 0.
5. If a trip occurs during the auto-tune sequence the drive will go into the trip state and Auto-tune (05.012) is set to zero. As in 4. above
the enable must be removed and re-applied before the drive can be restarted after the trip has been reset. However, care should be
taken because if the auto-tune was not completed the drive parameters that should have been measured and set up will still have their
original values.
6. If the Final drive enable is made active, the Final drive run is inactive and Hold Zero Speed (06.008) = 1 the drive would normally be in
the Stop state (i.e. the inverter is active, but the frequency or speed reference is 0).

The following describes the effects of the auto-tune test on the drive parameters for RFC-A mode:

1. All auto-tune tests rely on the motor being stationary when the test is initiated to give accurate results.
2. If Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 0 then the parameters associated with motor map 1 are updated as a result of the test, and if
Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 1 the parameters associated with motor map 2 are updated.
3. When each stage of the test is completed the results written to the appropriate parameters and these parameters saved in the drive
non-volatile memory. If Parameter Cloning (11.042) is set to 3 or 4 the parameters are also written to a non-volatile media card fitted in
the drive.

The table below shows the parameters required for motor control indicating which should be set by the user and which can be measured with an auto-
tune test.

Parameter Required for Measured in test


Rated Frequency (05.006) Basic control User set-up
Rated Current (05.007) Basic control User set-up
Rated Speed (05.008) Basic control User set-up
Rated Voltage (05.009) Basic control User set-up
Rated Power Factor (05.010) Basic control 2
Number Of Motor Poles (05.011) Basic control User set-up
Stator Resistance (05.017) Basic control 1, 2
Transient Inductance (05.024) Basic control 1, 2
Stator Inductance (05.025) Improved performance 2
Saturation Breakpoint 1 (05.029) Improved performance with flux weakening 2
Saturation Breakpoint 3 (05.030) Improved performance with flux weakening 2
Maximum Deadtime Compensation (05.059) Basic control 1, 2
Current At Maximum Deadtime Compensation (05.060) Basic control 1, 2
Saturation Breakpoint 2 (05.062) Improved performance with flux weakening 2
Saturation Breakpoint 4 (05.063) Improved performance with flux weakening 2
Motor And Load Inertia (03.018) Speed controller set-up and torque feed-forwards 3, 4
Inertia Times 1000 (04.033) Speed controller set-up and torque feed-forwards 3, 4
Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013) Basic control 1, 2
Current Controller Ki Gain (04.014) Basic control 1, 2
No-load Core Loss (04.045) *Torque feedback 2
Rated Core Loss (04.046) *Torque feedback User set-up

*Torque feedback is provided in Percentage Torque (04.026). The estimated value can be improved by setting up the No-load Core Loss (04.045) and
Rated Core Loss (04.046) for the motor. It should be noted that the core loss characteristic for a motor is complex and depends to some extent on the
switching frequency, but the drive can include an approximation to the core losses based on these two parameters. The value for the no-load core
losses measured by the auto-tuning is likely to be higher than the actual value, but can be used to significantly reduce the difference that will be seen in
the estimate torque between motoring and regenerating operation. If more accurate core loss compensation is required No-load Core Loss (04.045) and
Rated Core Loss (04.046) must be set up based on testing the motor using a torque transducer.

1: Basic
This test measures the basic control parameters without moving the motor.

1. A stationary test is performed to measure Stator Resistance (05.017), Transient Inductance


(05.024), Maximum Deadtime Compensation (05.059) and Current At Maximum Deadtime Compensation (05.060). If
Enable Stator Compensation (05.049) = 1 then Stator Base Temperature (05.048) is made equal to Stator Temperature (05.046).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 161
2. Stator Resistance (05.017) and Transient Inductance (05.024) are used to set up Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013) and
Current Controller Ki Gain (04.014). This is only performed once during the test, and so the user can make further adjustments to the
current controller gains if required.

2: Improved
This test measures the parameters for improved performance by rotating the motor.

1. Auto-tune 1 test is performed.


2. A rotating test is performed in which the motor is accelerated with the currently selected ramps up to a frequency of Rated Frequency
(05.006) x 2/3, and the frequency is maintained at that level for up to 40 seconds. Stator Inductance (05.025) is measured and this
value is used in conjunction with other motor parameters to calculate Rated Power Factor (05.010). Saturation Breakpoint 1 (05.029),
Saturation Breakpoint 3 (05.030), Saturation Breakpoint 2 (05.062) and Saturation Breakpoint 4 (05.063) are measured. The no-load
motor core losses are measured and written to No-load Core Loss (04.045). It is not possible to measure the rated load motor core
losses, and so Rated Core Loss (04.046) is set to zero.The motor should be unloaded for this test.

3: Inertia 1
This test measures the mechanical characteristic of the motor and load by rotating the motor at the speed defined by the present speed reference and
injecting a series of speed test signals. This test should only be used provided all the basic control parameters have been set-up correctly and the
speed controller parameters should be set to conservative levels, such as the default values, so that the motor is stable when it runs. The test may give
inaccurate results if standard ramp is active, particularly with high inertia low loss loads. The test measures the motor and load inertia, which can be
used in automatic set-up of the speed controller gains and in producing a torque feed-forward term. If Mechanical Load Test Level (05.021) is left at its
default value of zero then the peak level of the injection signal will be 1% of the maximum speed reference subject to a maximum of 500rpm. If a
different test level is required then Mechanical Load Test Level (05.021) should be set to a non-zero value to define the level as a percentage of the
maximum speed reference, again subject to a maximum of 500rpm. The user defined speed reference which defines the speed of the motor should be
set to a level higher than the test level, but not high enough for flux weakening to become active. In some cases however, it is possible to perform the
test at zero speed provided the motor is free to move, but it may be necessary to increase the test signal from the default value. The test will give the
correct results when there is a static load applied to the motor and in the presence of mechanical damping. This test should be used if possible,
however for sensorless mode, or if the speed controller cannot be set up for stable operation an alternative test is provided (Auto-tune (05.012) = 4 )
where a series of torque levels are applied to accelerate and decelerate the motor to measure the inertia.

1. A rotating test is performed in which the motor is accelerated with the currently selected ramps up to the currently selected speed
reference, and this speed is maintained for the duration of the test. The Motor And Load Inertia (03.018) and Inertia Times 1000
(04.033) are set up.

4: Inertia 2
Auto-tune test 3 should normally be used for mechanical load measurement, but under some circumstances this test may be used as an alternative.
This test will not give such accurate results as test 3 if the motor rated speed is not set to the correct value for the motor. Also this test is likely to give
incorrect results if standard ramp mode is active. A series of progressively larger torque levels are applied to the motor (20%, 40% ... 100% of rated
torque) to accelerate the motor up to 3/4 x VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF (i.e. speed reference variable maximum) to determine the inertia from the
acceleration/deceleration time. The test attempts to reach the required speed within 5s, but if this fails the next torque level is used. When 100% torque
is used the test allows 60s for the required speed to be reached, but if this is unsucessful a trip is initiated. To reduce the time taken for the test it is
possible to define the level of torque to be used for the test by setting Mechanical Load Test Level (05.021) to a non-zero value. When the test level is
defined the test is only carried out at the defined test level and 60s is allowed for the motor to reached the required speed. It should be noted that if the
maximum speed allows for flux weakening then it may not be possible to acheive the required torque level to accelerate the motor fast enough. If this is
the case, the maximum speed reference should be reduced.

1. The motor is accelerated in the required direction up to 3/4 of the maximum speed reference and then decelerated to zero speed.
2. The test is repeated with progressively higher torques until the required speed is reached.
3. Motor And Load Inertia (03.018) and Inertia Times 1000 (04.033) are set up.

The table below shows the trips that can occur during an auto-tune test:

Trip Reason
Autotune Stopped The final drive enable or the final drive run were removed before the test was completed.
The measured value of Stator Resistance (05.017) exceeded a value of (VFS / √2) / Full Scale Current Kc (11.061), where VFS is
Resistance.001
the full scale d.c. link voltage.
It has not been possible to measure the drive inverter characteristic to define Maximum Deadtime Compensation (05.059) and
Resistance.002
Current At Maximum Deadtime Compensation (05.060).

Autotune 1.001 The position feedback did not change when position feedback is being used.

Autotune 1.002 The motor did not reach the required speed.

Autotune 2.001 Position feedback direction is incorrect when position feedback is being used.

A SINCOS encoder with comms is being used for position feedback and the comms position is rotating in the opposite direction to
Autotune 2.002
the sine wave based position.

Autotune 3.001 The measured inertia exceeds the parameter range.


Autotune 3.003 The mechanical load test has failed to identify the inertia.
The motor poles or the position feedback resolution have been set up incorrectly where position feedback is being used. The trip
Autotune 7
will not occur if Number Of Motor Poles (05.011) ≥ 6 (i.e. 12 poles).

If Sensorless Mode Active (03.078) = 1 then trips Autotune 1 (except Autotune 1.008), Autotune 2 and Autotune 7 are disabled.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


162 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 05.013 Flux Optimisation Select
Short description Set to 1 to enable Flux Optimisation
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If Flux Optimisation Select (05.013) = 0 the rated level of flux is used in the motor when flux weakening is not active. If Flux Optimisation Select (05.013)
= 1 the flux is reduced so that the Id, Magnetising Current (04.017) is approximately equal to the Iq, Torque Producing Current (04.002) to optimise
copper losses and reduce iron losses in the motor under low load conditions. The flux can be reduced from the rated level down to half the rated level.
This feature is not available with sensorless mode (i.e. when Sensorless Mode Active (03.078) = 1).

Parameter 05.015 Low Frequency Voltage Boost


Short description Defines the level of low voltage boost when performing auto-tune test 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 25.0
Default 3.0 Units %
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, BU

The default value for this parameter depends on the frame size of the drive as follows:

3.0% up to frame size 06 drives,


2.0% for frame size 07 and frame size 08 drives
1.0% for larger sizes

During auto-tune test 2 the drive uses the Open-loop mode control strategy with fixed voltage boost. Low Frequency Voltage Boost (05.015) is used to
define the level of low voltage boost used during the test. See Open-loop Control Mode (05.014) in Open-loop mode for more details.

Parameter 05.016 Rated Speed Optimisation Select


Short description Rated Speed Optimisation Select
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Disabled
1 Classic Slow
2 Classic Fast
3 Combined
4 VARs Only
5 Voltage Only

The Rated Frequency (05.006) and Rated Speed (05.008) are used to define the rated slip of the motor. The rated slip is used in sensorless mode
(Sensorless Mode Active (03.078) = 1) to correct the motor speed with load. When this mode is active Rated Speed Optimisation Select (05.016) has
no effect.

If sensorless mode is not active (Sensorless Mode Active (03.078) = 0) the rated slip is used in the motor control algorithm and an incorrect value of slip
can have a significant effect on the motor performance. If Rated Speed Optimisation Select (05.016) = 0 then the adaptive control system is disabled.
However, if Rated Speed Optimisation Select (05.016) is set to a non-zero value the drive can automatically adjust the Rated Speed (05.008) to give the
correct value of rated slip. Rated Speed (05.008) is not saved at power-down, and so when the drive is powered-down and up again it will return to the
last value saved by the user. The rate of convergence and the accuracy of the adaptive controller reduces at low output frequency and low load. The
minimum frequency is defined as a percentage of Rated Frequency (05.006) by Rated Speed Optimisation Minimum Frequency (05.019). The minimum
load is defined as a percentage of rated load by Rated Speed Optimisation Minimum Load (05.020). The adaptive controller is enabled when a motoring
or regenerative load rises above Rated Speed Optimisation Minimum Load (05.020) + 5%, and is disabled again when it falls below
Rated Speed Optimisation Minimum Load (05.020). For best optimisation results the correct values of Stator Resistance (05.017), Transient Inductance
(05.024), Stator Inductance (05.025), Saturation Breakpoint 1 (05.029), Saturation Breakpoint 2 (05.062), Saturation Breakpoint 3 (05.030) and
Saturation Breakpoint 4 (05.063) should be used.

A number of different adaptive control methods can be selected as follows:

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 163
Rated Speed Optimisation Select
Adaptive Method
(05.016)
0 - Disabled None
VARs at low speed and vsy at higher
1 - Classic Slow
speeds with low adaptive gain
VARs at low speed and vsy at higher
2 - Classic Fast
speeds with high adaptive gain
VARs when flux weakening is not
3 - Combined active, vsy when flux weakening is
active with medium adaptive gain
4 - VARs VARs with medium adaptive gain
5 - Vsy vsy with medium adaptive gain

The classic methods normally operate correctly, but can diverge from the corrected rated speed especially with regenerative operation. These are
provided for legacy applications. The "Combined" method is the preferred method as this is more robust against divergence. However the VARs method
can be affected if the value of Transient Inductance (05.024) used by the drive is incorrect for the motor. It is possible to select the VARs or vsy
methods alone if required. All except the "Classic Slow" adaptive method use high adaptive gain which gives faster convergence.

Parameter 05.017 Stator Resistance


Short description Defines the resistance of the motor stator
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000000 Maximum 1000.000000
Default 0.000000 Units Ω
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 6
Coding RW, RA

The Stator Resistance (05.017), Transient Inductance (05.024) and Stator Inductance (05.025) are derived from the star connected per phase
equivalent circuit of an induction motor shown below.

The steady state parameters are converted to equivalent transient model parameters:

Rs = R1

Lm = Lm

Ls = L1 + Lm

Lr = L2 + Lm

σLs = Ls - (Lm2 / Lr)

The equivalent drive parameters are:

Stator Resistance (05.017) = Rs

Transient Inductance (05.024) = σLs

Stator Inductance (05.025) = Ls

Stator Resistance (05.017) is used as described in the table below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


164 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Function
Details

Control above low speeds with sensorless The stator resistance is used by the algorithm that detemines the rotor
control position.
During auto-tuning the stator resistance is used in the calculation of the
Current controller integral gain set-up
current controller integral gain.
If high performance current control is selected the stator resistance is
High performance current control
used in the control for both d and q axis current.

Although the maximum value of this parameter is 1000Ohms the maximum resistance is limited to (VM_DC_VOLTAGE / √2) / Full Scale Current Kc
(11.061). If the parameter is set to a higher value a Resistance.001 trip is initiated.

Parameter 05.018 Maximum Switching Frequency


Short description Defines the maximum switching frequency that can be used by the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_SWITCHING_FREQUENCY[MAX]
Default 1 Units kHz
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, VM, RA

Value Text
0 2
1 3
2 4
3 6
4 8
5 12
6 16

Maximum Switching Frequency (05.018) should be set to the required PWM switching frequency. The drive inverter will operate at this frequency unless
the inverter temperature becomes too hot. Under these conditions the drive will reduce the switching frequency in an attempt to avoid tripping (see
Auto-switching Frequency Change (05.035) ). The actual switching frequency is shown in Switching Frequency (05.037). The switching frequency has a
direct effect on the sample rate for the current controllers (see Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013)). All other control tasks are at a fixed rate.

Task
Speed controller (RFC-A,
250μs
RFC-S)
D.c. link voltage controller 1ms
Flux controller (RFC-A, RFC-
1ms
S)

Parameter 05.019 Rated Speed Optimisation Minimum Frequency


Short description Rated Speed Optimisation Minimum Frequency
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 100
Default 10 Units %
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Rated Speed Optimisation Select (05.016).

Parameter 05.020 Rated Speed Optimisation Minimum Load


Short description Rated Speed Optimisation Minimum Load
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 100
Default 50 Units %
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Rated Speed Optimisation Select (05.016).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 165
Parameter 05.021 Mechanical Load Test Level
Short description Mechanical Load Test Level
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 100
Default 0 Units %
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Auto-tune (05.012).

Parameter 05.023 D.c. Bus Voltage High Range


Short description Displays the d.c. bus level but with a higher range
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_HIGH_DC_VOLTAGE[MIN] Maximum VM_HIGH_DC_VOLTAGE[MAX]
Default Units V
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

D.c. Bus Voltage High Range (05.023) provides voltage feedback that has lower resolution and a higher range than D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005), and so it
is possible to determine the d.c. link voltage even if this exceeds the level of the over-voltage trip. It should be noted that due to tolerances,
D.c. Bus Voltage High Range (05.023) may not correspond exactly with the level given by D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005). In a system with parallel power
modules where the control pod is remote from any of the power modules, this parameter always shows zero.

Parameter 05.024 Transient Inductance


Short description Defines the inducatance of the transient components in the motor stator
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 500.000
Default 0.000 Units mH
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, RA

See Stator Resistance (05.017).

Transient Inductance (05.024) is used as described in the table below.

Function Details
During auto-tuning the stator resistance is used in the calculation of the
Current controller proportional gain set-up
current controller proportional gain.
If high performance current control is selected
High performance current control
(Current Controller Mode (04.030)) the transient inductance is used.
The system that prevent the motor from exceeding its voltage based
Voltage based torque limit
torque limit used the transient inductance.
If sensorless mode is selected the transient inductance is used in
Sensorless mode control
defining the flux axis of the motor.

Parameter 05.025 Stator Inductance


Short description Defines the inductance of the motor stator
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 5000.00
Default 0.00 Units mH
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW, RA

See Stator Resistance (05.017).

Stator Inductance (05.025) is used as described in the table below.

Function Details
Along with the stator resistance and transient inductance, the stator inductance is
Rated current components used to calculate the flux producing and torque producing current components,
and the power factor.
The system that prevent the motor from exceeding its voltage based torque limit
Voltage based torque limit
used the transient inductance.
Voltage feed-forwards is provided for the current controllers which improves
Voltage feed-forwards
performance and reduces transient when starting with position feedback.
Flux level The stator inductance is used to set the correct flux level in the motor.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


166 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 05.026 High Dynamic Performance Enable
Short description Set to 1 to enable High Dynamic Performance
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Whatever the value of High Dynamic Performance Enable (05.026) a feed-forward term based on the estimated level of flux in the motor and the motor
speed is used to improve the performance of the current controllers and to avoid transients during spinning start. However, if
High Dynamic Performance Enable (05.026) = 1 additional feed-forward terms are provided to remove the effects of cross-coupling between the flux
and torque axes. This improves the performance of the current controllers under dynamic conditions at high speeds. It should be noted that
High Dynamic Performance Enable (05.026) has no effect if sensorless control is active (i.e. Sensorless Mode Active (03.078) = 1).

Parameter 05.027 Flux Control Gain


Short description Flux Control Gain
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -10.0 Maximum 10.0
Default 1.0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

The output voltage is limited to the voltage limit defined either by the maximum possible drive output voltage or Rated Voltage (05.009) whichever is
lowest by the outer voltage controller shown below. If the voltage limit is not active then the output of the voltage controller is clamped to give rated flux
in the motor. An inner flux controller is provided to control the magnetising current which is limted by Magnetising Current Limit (04.049). Using an inner
flux controller gives faster rate of rise of flux on enable because a magnetising current higher than rated magnetising current can be used to force the
flux to increase. It also gives faster reduction of flux as the motor accelerates into flux weakening because negative flux producing current can be used
to reduce the flux.

Default set-up
If Flux Control Gain (05.027) is set to the default value of 1.0 the system that controls the flux and motor voltage is automatically set up based on the
motor parameters to give stable operation. The closed-loop transfer function of the flux controller approximates to a first order time constant of 25ms,
and the closed-loop transfer function of the voltage controller approximates to a first order time constant of 50ms. The automatic set-up of the flux
controller can result is very high gains if the motor has a very long rotor time constant (i.e. greater than 0.5s), and this can result in noise on the
magnetising current. To avoid this the gain is limited, and so the response time of the flux and voltage controllers will reduce proportionally when the
rotor time contant exceeds 0.5s. For example if the rotor time contant is 1s then the response time of the controllers will be doubled (i.e. flux control
50ms and voltage control 100ms).

Improved voltage control


The integral gain of the voltage controller is set to a conservative value to ensure the system is always stable. If Flux Control Gain (05.027) is
changed from the default value of 1.0 in the range from 0.1 to 10.0 the integral gain of the voltage controller is multiplied by Flux Control Gain (05.027).
This is most useful to increase the integral gain of the voltage controller, so that the motor voltage is more tightly controlled during fast acceleration into
the flux weakening region. The only gain that is affected is the integral gain of the voltage controller and the maximum limit on the flux controller gains
described in the default set-up still applies.

Reduced noise on the magnetising current


The maximum limit on the flux controller gains should prevent excessive noise on the magnetising current when the motor has a long rotor time
constant. However, if Flux Control Gain (05.027) is reduced below -1.0 the time constants of the flux controller and voltage closed-loop transfer function
are extended. For example a value of -2.0 will extend these to 50ms and 100ms respectively. It should be noted that if the motor has a long rotor time
constant, smaller negative values may not have an effect because the maximum limits on the flux controller gain may already be extending the time
constants.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 167
The settings for Flux Control Gain (05.027) are summarised below.

Range Effect
-10.0 to -1.0 Equivalent time constants of the controllers are Default Time Constant x -Flux Control Gain (05.027).
-1.0 to 0.0 Default set-up is used.
0.1 to 10.0 Default set-up is used, except that the integral gain of the voltage controller is Default Integral Gain x Flux Control Gain (05.027).
In all cases the controller gains are limited with a rotor time constant that is longer than 0.5s.
Parameter 05.028 Flux Compensation
Short description Determines the method used for flux compensation
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

To maintain the system gain if speed control is being used, or to maintain the correct relationship between the torque reference and the actual torque,
the conversion from Final Torque Reference (04.003) to Final Current Reference (04.004) normally includes the level of flux in the motor. If
Flux Compensation (05.028) is left at its default value of 0, the drive uses an estimate of motor flux to perform the conversion. This is the preferred
method of operation. There can be stability problems especially at very high speeds under some circumstances and Flux Compensation (05.028) can
be used to change the method of compensation to overcome the issues. If Flux Compensation (05.028) = 1, then torque to torque producing current
compensation is disabled altogether. This can be used for example, if Rated Speed (05.008) is set up incorrectly. If Flux Compensation (05.028)
= 2, Final Current Reference (04.004) = Final Torque Reference (04.003) x Rated Frequency (05.006) / |Output Frequency (05.001)|. This is not as
accurate as using the calculated flux, and does not boost the torque on starting as the flux is increased in the motor, but it reduces the likelihood of
instability at high speeds and high levels of flux weakening.

Parameter 05.029 Saturation Breakpoint 1


Short description Defines Saturation Breakpoint 1 within the saturation characteristic
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 100.0
Default 50.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

The relationship between the Id, Magnetising Current (04.017) and the motor flux is non-linear because of saturation. For accurate control of torque and
good dynamic performance when flux weakening is active it is important that the control system can estimate the flux level from the Id,
Magnetising Current (04.017). The saturation characteristic is provided with a set of breakpoints as shown below.

The default values for the breakpoints are Saturation Breakpoint 1 (05.029) = 50.0%, Saturation Breakpoint 2 (05.062) = 0.0%, Saturation Breakpoint 3
(05.030) = 75.0% and Saturation Breakpoint 4 (05.063) = 0.0%. For compatibility with Unidrive SP, Saturation Breakpoint 2 (05.062) and

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


168 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Saturation Breakpoint 4 (05.063) are ignored if they are left at their default values of 0.0%. Therefore the default values give a linear relationship
between the Id, Magnetising Current (04.017) and the flux. The required values are not normally available from the motor manufacturer and should be
obtained by auto-tuning.

Parameter 05.030 Saturation Breakpoint 3


Short description Defines Saturation Breakpoint 3 within the saturation characteristic
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 100.0
Default 75.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

See Saturation Breakpoint 1 (05.029).

Parameter 05.031 Voltage Controller Gain


Short description Defines the proportional gain of the d.c. link voltage controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 30
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Voltage Controller Gain (05.031) can be used to modify the proportional gain of the d.c. link voltage controller used for standard ramp and supply loss
control.

Parameter 05.032 Torque Per Amp


Short description Displays the calculated value of kt for the attached motor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 500.00
Default Units Nm/A
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

Torque Per Amp (05.032) is automatically calculated from the motor parameters assuming a motor efficiency of 90%.

Torque Per Amp (05.032) = Estimated rated shaft power / [Rated Speed (05.008) x ITRated]

where

ITRated is the rated torque producing current

and

Estimated rated shaft power = √3 x Rated Voltage (05.009) x Rated Current (05.007) x Rated Power Factor (05.010) x 0.9

Torque Per Amp (05.032) is used in the automatic calculation of the speed controller gains. See Speed Controller Set-up Method (03.017).

Parameter 05.034 Percentage Flux


Short description Displays the flux level in the motor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 150.0
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, FI, ND, NC, PT

Percentage Flux (05.034) gives an indication of the flux level in the motor where a value of 100% is equivalent to the rated flux level for the motor.

Parameter 05.035 Auto-switching Frequency Change


Short description Defines auto-switching frequency control with thermal model
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 169
Value Text
0 Enabled
1 Disabled
2 No Ripple Detect

The drive inverter can be damaged if the temperature is too high. The inverter can also be damaged or the lifetime of the power devices reduced, if the
temperature ripple of the devices is too high. Auto-switching Frequency Change (05.035) defines the action taken if the drive inverter becomes too hot
or the temperature ripple becomes too high.

Enabled:
If the inverter becomes too hot or the ripple temperature is higher than the level defined by Maximum Inverter Temperature Ripple (05.039) the
switching frequency is reduced in an attempt to prevent tripping.

Disabled:
The switching frequency is not reduced, and so the drive will trip if the inverter is too hot or the temperature ripple is too high.

No Ripple Detect:
The switching frequency is reduced if the inverter temperature, but not the temperature ripple is too high. If the temperature ripple exceeds the level
defined by Maximum Inverter Temperature Ripple (05.039) then the drive will trip.

The switching frequency is changed in steps defined by Auto-switching Frequency Step Size (05.036). For example with a switching frequency of 16kHz
and a step size of two, the frequency will be reduced to 8kHz, then 4kHz etc. Minimum Switching Frequency (05.038) defines the minimum switching
frequency that the system will attempt to use. If the switching frequency needs to switch to a lower level, then the drive will trip.
If Minimum Switching Frequency is changed the new value will only become active when Switching Frequency is at or above the minimum value.

Parameter 05.036 Auto-switching Frequency Step Size


Short description Auto-switching frequency reduction step size
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 2
Default 2 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Auto-switching Frequency Change (05.035).

Parameter 05.037 Switching Frequency


Short description Displays the current switching frequency used by the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 6
Default Units kHz
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text
0 2
1 3
2 4
3 6
4 8
5 12
6 16

Shows the actual inverter switching frequency after the auto-change function.

Parameter 05.038 Minimum Switching Frequency


Short description Minimum Switching Frequency
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_MIN_SWITCHING_FREQUENCY[MAX]
Default 0 Units kHz
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, VM

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


170 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Value Text
0 2
1 3
2 4
3 6
4 8
5 12
6 16

See Auto-switching Frequency Change (05.035).

Parameter 05.039 Maximum Inverter Temperature Ripple


Short description Maximum Inverter Temperature Ripple
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 20 Maximum 60
Default 60 Units °C
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Maximum Inverter Temperature Ripple (05.039) defines the maximum inverter temperature ripple allowed before the switching frequency is reduced.
See Auto-switching Frequency Change (05.035).

Parameter 05.040 Spin Start Boost


Short description Defines the level of spin start boost used by the algorithm that detects the speed of a spinning motor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 10.0
Default 1.0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

Spin Start Boost (05.040) is used by the algorithm that detects the speed of a spinning motor when the drive is enabled and Catch A Spinning Motor
(06.009) ≥ 1. This algorithm is not used if position feedback is being used, and so in these applications Spin Start Boost (05.040) has no effect. For
most motors Spin Start Boost (05.040) does not need to be changed from the default value, but for some larger motors Spin Start Boost (05.040) may
need to be increased. If Spin Start Boost (05.040) is too small the drive will detect zero speed whatever the speed of the motor, and if Spin Start Boost
(05.040) is too large the motor may accelerate away from standstill when the drive is enabled.

Parameter 05.041 Voltage Headroom


Short description Voltage Headroom
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 20
Default 0 Units %
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The voltage applied to the motor is always limited by Rated Voltage (05.009). When Voltage Headroom (05.041) is set to its default value of zero
the output voltage of the inverter is also limited to a level equivalent to full modulation, which is the supply voltage minus voltage drops within the
inverter itself. Depending on the relative values of the supply voltage and Rated Voltage (05.009) there may be some headroom between the rated
voltage limit and the maximum possible voltage from the inverter to allow the current control system to give good dynamic performance. In some
applications it is useful to enforce some headroom between the maximum allowed motor voltage and the inherent limit imposed by the inverter. If the
supply voltage is known this can be done by setting Rated Voltage (05.009) to a suitable value below the supply voltage level, however, it is more
convenient to set Rated Voltage (05.009) to the actual rated voltage of the motor, and to use Voltage Headroom (05.041) to enforce the voltage
headroom. This parameter can be used to increase the headroom between the maximum modulation limit and the maximum motor voltage from zero up
to 20% of the maximum modulation limit. For example, if the supply voltage is 400V then a value of 10% will give a voltage headroom of approximately
40V.

Parameter 05.042 Reverse Output Phase Sequence


Short description Set to 1 to reverse the sequence on the output phases
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If Reverse Output Phase Sequence (05.042) = 0 the output phase sequence is U-V-W when Output Frequency (05.001) is positive and W-V-U when
Output Frequency (05.001) is negative. If Reverse Output Phase Sequence (05.042) = 1 the output phase sequence is reversed so that the phase
sequence in W-V-U for positive frequencies and U-V-W for negative frequencies.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 171
Parameter 05.044 Stator Temperature Source
Short description Defines the source of the stator temperature
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 6
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 An In 3
1 User
2 P1 Drive
3 P1 Slot1
4 P1 Slot2
5 P1 Slot3
6 P1 Slot4

The stator temperature can be used to compensate for changes in stator resistance. See Stator Temperature Coefficient (05.047).
Stator Temperature Source (05.044) is used to select the source for the stator temperature measurement.

Stator Temperature Source


Source Comments
(05.044)
Analog Input 3 Thermistor Temperature Analog input 3 must be set up for the
0
(07.050) correct temperature feedback device
The user can provide a stator temperature
value. If an alternative feedback device is
1 User Stator Temperature (05.045)
to be used or the user provides an
algorithm to model the stator temperature.
P1 position feedback interface must be
2 P1 Thermistor Temperature (03.122) set up for the correct temperature
feedback device
A position feedback category option
Option slot P1 Thermistor Temperature module must be fitted and the P1 position
3-6
(xx.122) feedback must be set up for the correct
temperature feedback device

Parameter 05.045 User Stator Temperature


Short description Defines the stator temperature as set by the user
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -50 Maximum 300
Default 0 Units °C
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Stator Temperature Source (05.044).

Parameter 05.046 Stator Temperature


Short description Displays the temperature of the motor stator
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -50 Maximum 300
Default Units °C
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Stator Temperature Source (05.044).

Parameter 05.047 Stator Temperature Coefficient


Short description Defines the coefficient used to calculate the temperature of the motor stator
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00000 Maximum 0.10000
Default 0.00390 Units 1/°C
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 5
Coding RW

Temperature Compensated Stator Resistance (05.050) shows the stator resistance from the active motor that is being used by the drive for motor

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


172 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
control. If Enable Stator Compensation (05.049) = 0 and motor 1 is selected then Temperature Compensated Stator Resistance (05.050) is equal to
Stator Resistance (05.017). If Enable Stator Compensation (05.049) = 1 the value of Stator Resistance (05.017) is not changed, but
Temperature Compensated Stator Resistance (05.050) is derived as follows:

α = Stator Temperature Coefficient (05.047) and this is the temperature coefficient for the stator winding at 20oC as a proportion of the resistance per
degree C.

Temperature Compensated Stator Resistance (05.050) = Stator Resistance (05.017) x [1 + (Stator Temperature (05.046) – 20oC) x α] / [1 +


(Stator Base Temperature (05.048) - 20oC) x α]

Stator Resistance (05.017) and Stator Base Temperature (05.048) can be set up by the user with the stator resistance at a given temperature. The
preferred method is for the Stator Resistance (05.017) to be measured and set up using the auto-tuning system (See Auto-tune (05.012)). If
Enable Stator Compensation (05.049) = 1 when the auto-tuning is carried out the Stator Base Temperature (05.048) will be updated automatically with
Stator Temperature (05.046).

The temperature compensation system can only function correctly if the Stator Temperature Coefficient (05.047) is set up correctly. The default value is
suitable for copper or aluminium windings and should not need to be adjusted for these materials provided the temperature measurement is a
reasonable measure of the winding temperature. If the temperature measurement is not closely coupled to the winding it may be necessary to adjust
Stator Temperature Coefficient (05.047) for correct compensation.

Parameter 05.048 Stator Base Temperature


Short description Defines the base temperature used to calculate the temperature of the motor stator
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -50 Maximum 300
Default 0 Units °C
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Stator Temperature Coefficient (05.047).

Parameter 05.049 Enable Stator Compensation


Short description Set to 1 to enable stator compensation
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Stator Temperature Coefficient (05.047).

Parameter 05.050 Temperature Compensated Stator Resistance


Short description Final stator resistance value used by the drive including temperature compensation
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000000 Maximum 1000.000000
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 6
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Temperature Compensated Stator Resistance (05.050) shows the stator resistance value for the active motor that is being used by the drive including
the effect of temperature compensation.

Parameter 05.051 Rotor Temperature Source


Short description Defines the source of the rotor temperature
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 6
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 An In 3
1 User
2 P1 Drive
3 P1 Slot1
4 P1 Slot2
5 P1 Slot3
6 P1 Slot4

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 173
The rotor temperature can be used to compensate for changes in rotor resistance that affects the motor slip and hence the rated speed in Open-loop or
RFC-A mode, or the magnet flux that affects motor torque in RFC-S mode. See Rotor Temperature Coefficient (05.054) for
details. Rotor Temperature Source (05.051) is used to select the source for the rotor temperature measurement.

Rotor Temperature Source


Source Comments
(05.051)
Analog Input 3 Thermistor Temperature Analog input 3 must be set up for the
0
(07.050) correct temperature feedback device
The user can provide a rotor temperature
value if an alternative feedback device is
1 User Rotor Temperature (05.052)
to be used or the user provides an
algorithm to model the rotor temperature
P1 position feedback interface must be set
2 P1 Thermistor Temperature (03.122) up for the correct temperature feedback
device
A position feedback category option
Option Slot P1 Thermistor Temperature module must be fitted and the P1 position
3-6
(xx.122) feedback must be set up for the correct
temperature feedback device

Parameter 05.052 User Rotor Temperature


Short description Defines the temperature of the motor as set by the user
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -50 Maximum 300
Default 0 Units °C
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Rotor Temperature Source (05.051).

Parameter 05.053 Rotor Temperature


Short description Displays the temperature of the motor rotor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -50 Maximum 300
Default Units °C
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Rotor Temperature Source (05.051).

Parameter 05.054 Rotor Temperature Coefficient


Short description Defines the coefficient used to calculate the temperature of the rotor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00000 Maximum 0.10000
Default 0.00390 Units 1/°C
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 5
Coding RW

The slip of an induction motor is proportional to the rotor resistance, and so as the motor becomes hotter the slip increases. Therefore the rated
speed of a motor, which is used by the drive control algorithm, changes with rotor temperature. To avoid less than optimal control the rated speed value
used by the drive should be modified with changing rotor temperature. Temperature compensated rated speed (05.057) shows the rated speed from
the active motor that is being used by the drive control system. If Enable Rotor Compensation (05.056) = 0 and motor 1 is selected (i.e. Motor 2 Active
(21.015) = 0) then Temperature compensated rated speed (05.057) is equal to Rated Speed (05.008). If Enable Rotor Compensation (05.056) = 1 then
Temperature compensated rated speed (05.057) is calculated as follows:

Uncompensated Rated Slip = Synchronous Speed - Rated Speed (05.008) = (Rated Frequency (05.006) x 60 / Number Of Motor Poles (05.011)) -
Rated Speed (05.008)

α = Rotor Temperature Coefficient (05.054) and this is the rotor winding temperature coefficient at 20oC as a proportion of the resistance per degree
C.

Compensated Rated Slip = Uncompensated Rated Slip x [1 + (Rotor Temperature (05.053) - 20oC) x α] / [1 + (Rotor Base Temperature (05.055) -
20oC) x α]

Temperature compensated rated speed (05.057) = (Rated Frequency (05.006) x 60 / Number Of Motor Poles (05.011)) - Compensated Rated Slip

If sensorless mode is not being used (i.e. Sensorless Mode Active (03.078) = 0) then an adaptive system is provided to adjust the Rated Speed
(05.008) value (see Rated Speed Optimisation Select (05.016)). The adaptive control system cannot operate at low speeds or light loads, and so the
rated speed may be incorrect if the motor runs under these conditions for a long period of time. If adaptive control is selected
(i.e.Rated Speed Optimisation Select (05.016) > 0) and Enable Rotor Compensation (05.056) = 1 then Rotor Base Temperature (05.055) is updated
with Rotor Temperature (05.053) while the adaptive controller is active, and so the rotor compensation system has no effect. When the adaptive

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


174 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
controller changes to the inactive state because of the speed and load conditions, the Rotor Base Temperature (05.055) is no longer updated and the
difference between this and the Rotor Temperature (05.053) is used to adjust the Rated Speed (05.008). When the adaptive controller becomes active
again the rotor compensation system is disabled and Rated Speed (05.008) is again adjusted by the adaptive controller. Therefore the rotor
compensation system provides the necessary adjustment of the rated speed when the adaptive controller cannot operate. To give a smooth change
when the adaptive controller becomes active Temperature compensated rated speed (05.057) is copied to the rated speed parameter for the active
motor once during the transition.

Parameter 05.055 Rotor Base Temperature


Short description Defines the base temperature used to calculate the temperature of the rotor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -50 Maximum 300
Default 0 Units °C
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Rotor Temperature Coefficient (05.054).

Parameter 05.056 Enable Rotor Compensation


Short description Set to 1 to enable rotor compensation
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Rotor Temperature Coefficient (05.054).

Parameter 05.057 Temperature compensated rated speed


Short description Final rated speed value used by the drive including temperature compensation
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 33000.00
Default Units rpm
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Temperature compensated rated speed (05.057) shows the rated speed value for the active motor that is being used by the drive including the effect
of temperature compensation.

Parameter 05.059 Maximum Deadtime Compensation


Short description Shows the deadtime compensation used to compensate for dead-time effects in the inverter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 10.000
Default 0.000 Units µs
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RO, NC, PT

Maximum Deadtime Compensation (05.059) is the deadtime compensation used to compensate for dead-time effects in the inverter. This level of
compensation is used when the drive output current is above Current At Maximum Deadtime Compensation (05.060). Both of these values related to
dead-time compensation are measured during auto-tuning and cannot be set by the user. It should be noted that if the auto-tuning test is not performed
and Maximum Deadtime Compensation (05.059) = 0 then dead-time compensation is disabled. Although it is not recommended, it is possible to disable
dead-time compensation by setting Disable Deadtime Compensation (05.061) = 1.

Parameter 05.060 Current At Maximum Deadtime Compensation


Short description Current at which maximum deadtime compensation is applied
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 0.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, NC, PT

See Maximum Deadtime Compensation (05.059).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 175
Parameter 05.061 Disable Deadtime Compensation
Short description Disable Deadtime Compensation
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Maximum Deadtime Compensation (05.059).

Parameter 05.062 Saturation Breakpoint 2


Short description Defines Saturation Breakpoint 2 within the saturation characteristic
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 100.0
Default 0.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

See Saturation Breakpoint 1 (05.029).

Parameter 05.063 Saturation Breakpoint 4


Short description Defines Saturation Breakpoint 4 within the saturation characteristic
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 100.0
Default 0.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

See Saturation Breakpoint 1 (05.029).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


176 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 6 Single Line Descriptions − Sequencer and Clock
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 177
Parameter Range Default Type
06.001 Stop Mode Coast (0), Ramp (1), No Ramp (2) Ramp (1) RW Txt US
06.002 Limit Switch Stop Mode Stop (0), Ramp (1) Stop (0) RW Txt US
Disable (0), Ramp Stop (1), Ride Thru (2),
06.003 Supply Loss Mode Disable (0) RW Txt US
Limit Stop (3)
06.008 Hold Zero Speed Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
Disable (0), Enable (1), Fwd Only (2),
06.009 Catch A Spinning Motor Enable (1) RW Txt US
Rev Only (3)
06.010 Enable Conditions 000000000000 to 111111111111 RO Bin ND NC PT
06.011 Sequencer State Machine Inputs 000000 to 111111 RO Bin ND NC PT
06.012 Enable Stop Key Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
Disabled (0), Forward/Reverse (1),
06.013 Enable Auxiliary Key Disabled (0) RW Txt US
Run Reverse (2)
06.015 Drive Enable Off (0) or On (1) On (1) RW Bit US
06.016 Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 RW Date ND NC PT
06.017 Time 00:00:00 to 23:59:59 RW Time ND NC PT
Sunday (0), Monday (1), Tuesday (2),
06.018 Day Of Week Wednesday (3), Thursday (4), Friday (5), RO Txt ND NC PT
Saturday (6)
Set (0), Powered (1), Running (2),
06.019 Date/Time Selector Acc Powered (3), Local Keypad (4), Powered (1) RW Txt US
Remote Keypad (5)
06.020 Date Format Std (0), US (1) Std (0) RW Txt US
06.021 Time Between Filter Changes 0 to 30000 hours 0 hours RW Num US
06.022 Filter Change Required / Change Done Off (0) or On (1) RW Bit ND NC
06.023 Time Before Filter Change Due 0 to 30000 hours RO Num ND NC PT PS
06.024 Reset Energy Meter Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit
06.025 Energy Meter: MWh ±999.9 MWh RO Num ND NC PT PS
06.026 Energy Meter: kWh ±99.99 kWh RO Num ND NC PT PS
06.027 Energy Cost Per kWh 0.0 to 600.0 0.0 RW Num US
06.028 Running Cost ±32000 RO Num ND NC PT
06.029 Hardware Enable Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
06.030 Run Forward Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
06.031 Jog Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
06.032 Run Reverse Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
06.033 Forward/Reverse Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
06.034 Run Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
06.035 Forward Limit Switch Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
06.036 Reverse Limit Switch Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
06.037 Jog Reverse Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
06.039 Not Stop Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
06.040 Enable Sequencer Latching Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
06.041 Drive Event Flags 00 to 11 00 RW Bin NC
06.042 Control Word 000000000000000 to 111111111111111 000000000000000 RW Bin NC
06.043 Control Word Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
06.044 Active Supply Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
06.045 Cooling Fan control -10 to 11 10 RW Num US
06.046 Cooling Fan Speed 0 to 10 RO Num ND NC PT
06.047 Input Phase Loss Detection Mode Full (0), Ripple Only (1), Disabled (2) Full (0) RW Txt US
200V drive: 205 V
VM_SUPPLY_LOSS_LEVEL[MIN] to 400V drive: 410 V
06.048 Supply Loss Detection Level RW Num RA US
VM_SUPPLY_LOSS_LEVEL[MAX] V 575V drive: 540 V
690V drive: 540 V
06.051 Hold Supply Loss Active Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
06.052 Motor Pre‑heat Current Magnitude 0 to 100 % 0% RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF_UNIPOLAR[MIN]
06.053 Sleep / Wake Threshold to 0.0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
06.054 Sleep Time 0.0 to 250.0 s 10.0 s RW Num US
06.055 Wake Time 0.0 to 250.0 s 10.0 s RW Num US
06.056 Sleep Required Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
06.057 Sleep Active Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
06.058 Output Phase Loss Detection Time 0.5s (0), 1.0s (1), 2.0s (2), 4.0s (3) 0.5s (0) RW Txt US
Disabled (0), Phases (1), Devices (2),
06.059 Output Phase Loss Detection Enable Disabled (0) RW Txt US
Low Noise (3)
06.060 Standby Mode Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
06.061 Standby Mode Mask 0000000 to 1111111 0000000 RW Bin US

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


178 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
200V drive: 175 V
VM_STD_UNDER_VOLTS[MIN] to 400V drive: 330 V
06.065 Standard Under Voltage Threshold RW Num RA US
VM_STD_UNDER_VOLTS[MAX] V 575V drive: 435 V
690V drive: 435 V
200V drive: 175 V
VM_LOW_UNDER_VOLTS[MIN] to 400V drive: 330 V
06.066 Low Under Voltage Threshold RW Num RA US
VM_LOW_UNDER_VOLTS[MAX] V 575V drive: 435 V
690V drive: 435 V
06.067 Low Under Voltage Threshold Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
06.068 Backup Supply Mode Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
06.069 Under‑voltage System Contactor Close Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
06.070 Under‑voltage System Contactor Closed Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit
06.071 Slow Rectifier Charge Rate Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
06.072 User Supply Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
200V drive: 390 V
VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MIN] to 400V drive: 780 V
06.073 Braking IGBT Lower Threshold RW Num RA US
VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX] V 575V drive: 930 V
690V drive: 1120 V
200V drive: 390 V
VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MIN] to 400V drive: 780 V
06.074 Braking IGBT Upper Threshold RW Num RA US
VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX] V 575V drive: 930 V
690V drive: 1120 V
VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MIN] to
06.075 Low Voltage Braking IGBT Threshold 0V RW Num RA US
VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX] V
06.076 Low Voltage Braking IGBT Threshold Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit
06.084 Date And Time Offset ±12.00 hours 0.00 hours RW Num US
06.085 Control Word Override 000000000000000 to 111111111111111 000000000000000 RW Bin NC
06.086 Control override enable Disabled (0), Control Word (1), Enabled (2) Disabled (0) RW Txt NC

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 179
Menu 6 − Sequencer and Clock
Mode: RFC‑A

The diagram below shows the sequencer for RFC-A and RFC-S modes.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


180 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
The sequencer, which provides overall control of the drive, is implemented in two stages. The first stage includes the enable logic and sequencer logic

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 181
and consists of static logic elements. The second stage is a state machine with internal states.

Hardware Enable (06.029) follows the safe torque off enable signal provided none of the digital inputs that are integral to the drive are routed to the
Hardware Enable (06.029). The safe torque off hardware includes a delay in detecting a change from the enable to disable state of up to 20ms, but for
most applications this is not a problem. However, a faster disable time can be achieved (600us) if digital input 4 or 5 on the drive is routed to the
Hardware Enable (06.029).

If the safety function of the safe torque off input is required, then there must not be a direct connection between the safe torque off input and any other
digital I/O on the drive. If the safety function of the safe torque off input and a fast disable function are required together, then the drive should be given
two separate independent enable input signals. A signal from a safe source should be connected to the safe torque off input on the drive. A second
enable should be connected to the digital I/O selected for the fast disable function. The circuit must be arranged so that a fault which causes the fast input
to be forced high cannot cause the safe torque off input to be forced high as well, including the case where a component such as a blocking diode has
failed.

The diagram below shows the sequencer logic when Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) is not equal to 4 (i.e. keypad control mode is not selected).
The definition of the logic symbols is given below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


182 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
The diagram below shows the sequencer logic when Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) = 4 (i.e. keypad control mode is selected). The definition of
the logic symbols is given below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 183
Parameter 06.001 Stop Mode
Short description Defines how the motor is controlled when the run signal is removed from the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


184 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Value Text
0 Coast
1 Ramp
2 No Ramp

There is only one phase during the stopping sequence as shown in the table below for each of the possible values of Stop Mode (06.001).

Stop Mode (06.001) Action


0: Coast Inverter disabled
1: Ramp Stop with ramp
2: No ramp Stop with no ramp

The following should be noted:

1. If Stop Mode (06.001) = 0 (Coast) the inverter is inhibited immediately when the Final drive run is de-activated. If however, Hold Zero Speed
(06.008) = 1, then the inverter will be re-enabled to hold zero speed. The result is that the inverter is disabled for one sample and then enabled to
ramp the motor to a stop. Therefore, if coast stop is required Hold Zero Speed (06.008) should be set to 0.
2. If Stop Mode (06.001) = 1 (stop with ramp) the relevant ramp rate is used to stop the motor even if Ramp Enable (02.002) = 0.
3. The motor can be stopped with position orientation after stopping. This mode is selected with Standard Motion Controller Mode (13.010). When
orientation stop is selected Stop Mode (06.001) has no effect.

Parameter 06.002 Limit Switch Stop Mode


Short description Defines the behaviour of the drive when a limit switch is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Stop
1 Ramp

If Limit Switch Stop Mode (06.002) = 0 then when Limit switch active is activated the motor is stopped without ramps.

If Limit Switch Stop Mode (06.002) = 1 then the motor is stopped with the stop mode defined by Stop Mode (06.001). Therefore, if the limit switch is
required to stop the motor with a ramp then Stop Mode (06.001) must be set to 1 (Ramp). The motor will then stop with the currently selected ramp rate.

Parameter 06.003 Supply Loss Mode


Short description Defines the behaviour of the drive when the supply voltage is reduced
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Disable
1 Ramp Stop
2 Ride Thru
3 Limit Stop

If Supply Loss Mode (06.003) > 0 and the D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) falls below Supply Loss Detection Level (06.048) - 0.05 x
VM_SUPPLY_LOSS_LEVEL[MIN] then the supply loss condition is detected and Supply Loss (10.015) = 1. If the supply subsequently rises above
Supply Loss Detection Level (06.048) + 0.05 x VM_SUPPLY_LOSS_LEVEL[MIN] then the supply loss condition is no longer active and Supply Loss
(10.015) = 0.

0: Disable
No supply loss detection is provided by monitoring the D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005). The drive will continue to operate normally unless the under voltage
condition is detected.

1: Ramp Stop
The action taken by the drive is the same as for ride through mode, except that the ramp down rate is at least as fast as the currently selected
deceleration ramp and the drive will continue to decelerate and stop even if the supply is re-applied. Once the sequencer state machine has reached the
DISABLE state, it will be necessary to disable and re-enable the drive for it to run again because bit 2 of Enable Conditions (06.010) is set when the
sequencer state machine changes from the DECELERATION state. It should be noted that even if S ramps are enabled (i.e. S Ramp Enable (02.006) =
1) this is ignored while the drive is stopping in this mode, and a linear ramp is always used.

2: Ride through
The drive attempts to control the d.c. link voltage to take energy from the motor and load inertia to ride through the Supply loss condition for as long as
possible.

3: Limit Stop

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 185
The speed reference is set to zero and the ramps are disabled allowing the drive to decelerate the motor to a stop under current limit. If the supply is re-
applied while the motor is stopping any run signal is ignored until the motor has stopped. If the current limit value is set at a very low level the drive
may enter the Under Voltage state before the motor has stopped. Once the sequencer state machine has reached the DISABLE state, it will be necessary
to disable and re-enable the drive for it to run again because bit 2 of Enable Conditions (06.010) is set when the sequencer state machine changes from
the DECELERATION state.

Parameter 06.008 Hold Zero Speed


Short description Set to 1 to hold the motor at zero speed
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If Hold Zero Speed (06.008) = 0 the sequencer state machine goes to the DISABLE state and the inverter is disabled when the Final drive run is de-
activated and the motor reaches standstill.

If Hold Zero Speed (06.008) = 1 and Motor Pre-heat Current Magnitude (06.052) = 0% the sequencer state machine goes to the STOP state when the
Final drive run is de-activated and the motor reaches standstill. The drive remains enabled with a frequency or speed reference of zero. If Motor Pre-
heat Current Magnitude (06.052) is set to a non-zero value it defines the current in the motor when the sequencer state machine is in the STOP state.
This is intended for applications where there is no motor load at standstill, but motor current is required to prevent condensation in the motor when it is
stopped. If the motor is not force cooled the motor cooling is less effective at standstill than when the motor is rotating, and so care should be taken not to
damage the motor by leaving it at standstill for prolonged periods with a high level of current.

Parameter 06.009 Catch A Spinning Motor


Short description Defines the behaviour of the drive when the drive is enabled whilst the motor is not at zero speed
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Disable
1 Enable
2 Fwd Only
3 Rev Only

When the drive is enabled the ramp output can be set up so that the initial speed reference (i.e. combination of the ramp output and the hard speed
reference if enabled) matches the speed of the motor, so that there is no transient speed change on enable. To do this Post Ramp Reference (02.001) is
pre-loaded with Speed Feedback (03.002) - Hard Speed Reference (03.022) if the hard speed reference is enabled, or with Speed Feedback (03.002) if
not. If Catch A Spinning Motor (06.009) = 1 then the ramp output is reloaded in this way, however different settings of Catch A Spinning Motor
(06.009) can be used to restrict the initial speed reference if required as given in the table below. If the initial speed reference is forced to zero then
Post Ramp Reference (02.001) is pre-loaded with Speed Feedback (03.002) - Hard Speed Reference (03.022) if the hard speed reference is enabled, or
with zero if not.

Catch A Spinning Motor (06.009) Initial speed reference


0 Always zero
1 In either direction
2 Zero or positive
3 Zero or negative

RFC-A mode
If sensorless mode is being used then it is recommended that catch a spinning motor is disabled if the motor will always be stationary when the drive is
enabled as this gives a smooth start and avoids unwanted transient movement of the motor on starting. If catch a spinning motor is enabled, but the
motor is at standstill or rotating slowly it is likely than some unwanted movement will occur. This can be reduced by reducing Magnetising Current Limit
(04.049), however if this is reduced too much, especially with larger motors, and over-current trip may occur on starting. It is possible, although not likely,
that the drive does not correctly detect the speed of the motor when sensorless control is active. If this is the case Spin Start Boost (05.040) can be
increased to correct this.

RFC-S mode
If sensorless mode is being used then it is recommended that catch a spinning motor is disabled if the motor will always be stationary when the drive is
enabled as this gives a smooth start and avoids unwanted transient movement of the motor on starting. It should be noted that catch a spinning motor will
not operate correctly if the speed of the motor is high enough that the open-circuit voltage is larger than the a.c. supply voltage to the drive. As part of the
speed detection it is possible for the d.c link voltage to rise, and the increase in voltage is higher when the motor is spinning at higher speeds. Even if
standard ramp is being used (Ramp Mode (02.004)=1), when the motor is spinning at high speed the increase in d.c. link voltage may be enough to
causes d.c. link over-voltage trips. If this is the case then a braking resistor will be required that can absorb the transient energy.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


186 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 06.010 Enable Conditions
Short description Displays all the conditions needed to change the state of the final drive enable
Mode RFC‑A
0 4095
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 000000000000) (Display: 111111111111)
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

The Final drive enable is a combination of the Hardware Enable (06.029), Drive Enable (06.015) and other conditions that can prevent the drive from
being enabled. All of these conditions are shown as bits in Enable Conditions (06.010) as given in the table below.

Enable Conditions
Enable condition
(06.010) bits
0 Hardware Enable (06.029)
1 Drive Enable (06.015)
0 if auto-tune completed or trip during auto-tune, or if the drive stops when supply loss stop is
2
active, but the drive needs to be disabled and re-enabled. (Always 1 in Regen mode).
3 1 if fire mode is active.
Zero if Position Feedback Initialized (03.076) is present and all devices are not indicated as
4
initialised, otherwise one.
Zero until the drive thermal model has obtained temperatures from all drive thermistors at
5
least once.
Zero until all option modules that are present in the drive have indicated that they are ready
6
to run or the system has timed out waiting for this.
Zero if an option module has forced the drive to be disabled if for example it is updating its
7-10
user program. Bit 7 corresponds to slot 1, bit 8 to slot 2, etc.
11 Zero if the drive is in standby mode. See Standby Mode Enable (06.060)

Parameter 06.011 Sequencer State Machine Inputs


Short description Displays the states of inputs into the sequencer state machine
Mode RFC‑A
0 63
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 000000) (Display: 111111)
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

The bits in Sequencer State Machine Inputs (06.011) show the state of the inputs to the sequencer state machine as given in the tables below.

Sequencer State Machine Inputs


Signal Indicates
(06.011)
0 Final drive enable The drive inverter is allowed to be enabled.
1 Final drive run The motor can move away from standstill.
Under Voltage Active The under voltage condition has been
2
(10.016) detected.
3 Zero Speed (10.003) Indicated when the motor has stopped.
4 Drive tripped The drive is tripped.
5 Supply Loss (10.015) Supply loss condition has been detected.

Parameter 06.012 Enable Stop Key


Short description Set to 1 to enable the use of the stop key
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The Stop key can be used to stop the drive if Enable Stop Key (06.012) = 1 or Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) = 4. The Stop key is also used to
reset the drive from the keypad. If Enable Stop Key (06.012) = 0 and Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) is not equal to 4 the Stop key is not active
and can be used to initiate a drive reset and without stopping the drive from running. If Enable Stop Key (06.012) = 1 or Reference Selected Indicator
(01.049) = 4 the drive reset can be initiated without stopping the drive by holding the Run key and then pressing the Stop key.

It should be noted that if the drive is tripped and is then reset from any source other than the keypad Stop key then the drive may start immediately under
the following conditions:

Enable Sequencer Latching (06.040) = 0, the Final drive enable is active and one of the sequencer bits (Run Forward (06.030), Run Reverse

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 187
(06.032) or Run (06.034) is active.

Enable Sequencer Latching (06.040) = 1, the Final drive enable is active, Not Stop (06.039) is active and one of the sequencer bits (Run Forward
(06.030), Run Reverse (06.032) or Run (06.034) is active.

The drive sequencer has been designed so that pressing the Stop key, whatever the value of Enable Stop Key (06.012) or Reference Selected Indicator
(01.049), does not make the drive state change from stopped to running. As pressing the Stop key could reset a drive trip which could then restart the
drive, the run output from the sequencer is held off until the following conditions are met when the drive is tripped and the Stop key is pressed.

(Run Forward (06.030) = 0 and Run Reverse (06.032) = 0 and Run (06.034) = 0 and Not Stop (06.039) = 0*

OR (Run Forward (06.030) = 1 and Run Reverse (06.032) = 1 for at least 60ms*

OR The Hardware Enable (06.029) = 0 or software enable is zero+

OR The sequencer is in the UNDER_VOLTAGE state

*Not Stop (06.039) is only used with latching logic (i.e. Enable Sequencer Latching (06.040) = 1). When latching logic is not used then Not Stop
(06.039) is normally zero, and so it does not affect the conditions required to reapply the drive run.
+The software enable is either Drive Enable (06.015) or the enable from Control Word (06.042) as selected by Control Word Enable (06.043).

Once the necessary conditions have been met the drive can then be restarted by activating the necessary bits for a normal start.

Parameter 06.013 Enable Auxiliary Key


Short description Defines the behaviour of the drive when the auxiliary button is pressed
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Disabled
1 Forward/Reverse
2 Run Reverse

If Hand/Off/Auto mode is active (see Hand/Off/Auto Operating Mode (01.052)) then Enable Auxiliary Key (06.013) has no effect. Otherwise if
Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) = 4 then Enable Auxiliary Key (06.013) can be used to enable the Auxiliary key as a reverse key. If
Enable Auxiliary Key (06.013) = 1 then each time the Auxiliary key is pressed Reverse Select (01.012) is toggled. If Enable Auxiliary Key (06.013) = 2
then the Auxiliary key behaves in a similar way to the Run key except that the drive runs in the reverse direction when it is pressed.

Parameter 06.015 Drive Enable


Short description Set to 1 to enable the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 2ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Drive Enable (06.015) must be active for the drive to be enabled. See description of enable logic.

Parameter 06.016 Date


Short description Displays the current date
Mode RFC‑A
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read/write
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, ND, NC, PT

Date (06.016), Time (06.017) and Day Of Week (06.018) show the date and time as selected by Date/Time Selector  (06.019). Date (06.016) stores the
date in dd.mm.yy format regardless of the setting made in Date Format (06.020) however if the parameter is viewed using a keypad the date will be
displayed in the format selected in Date Format (06.020). If a real time clock is selected from an option module then the days, months and years are from
the real time clock and the day of the week is displayed in Day Of Week (06.018). Otherwise the days have a minimum value of 0 and roll over after 30,
the months have a minimum value of 0 and roll over after 11, and Day Of Week (06.018) is always 0 (Sunday).

If when setting the date/time this parameter is being written via comms or from an applications module then the value should be written in standard
dd/mm/yy format as described below.

The value of this parameter as seen over comms or to an applications module is as follows.

Value = (day[1..31] x 10000) + (month[1..12] x 100) + year[0..99]

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


188 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 06.017 Time
Short description Displays the current time
Mode RFC‑A
0 235959
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00) (Display: 23:59:59)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read/write
Display Format Time Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, ND, NC, PT

See Date (06.016).

The value of this parameter as seen over comms or to an applications module is as follows.

Value = (hour[0..23] x 10000) + (minute[0..59] x 100) + seconds[0..59]

Parameter 06.018 Day Of Week


Short description Displays the current day of the week
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 6
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text
0 Sunday
1 Monday
2 Tuesday
3 Wednesday
4 Thursday
5 Friday
6 Saturday

See Date (06.016).

Parameter 06.019 Date/Time Selector


Short description Defines which clock is used to display the current time, date and day of the week
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Set
1 Powered
2 Running
3 Acc Powered
4 Local Keypad
5 Remote Keypad

Date/Time Selector  (06.019) is used to select the drive date and time as shown in the table below.

Date/Time Selector
Date/Time Source
(06.019)
0: Set Date and time parameters can be written by the user.
1: Power Time since the drive was powered up.
2: Running Accumulated drive running time since the drive was manufactured.
3: Acc Power Accumulated powered-up time since the drive was manufactured.
If a keypad fitted to the front of the drive includes a real-time clock then the date/time from
4: Local Keypad
this clock is displayed, otherwise the date/time is set to zero.
If a keypad connected to the user comms port of a drive with a 485 includes a real-time
5: Remote Keypad
clock then the date/time from this clock is displayed, otherwise the date/time is set to zero.

When Date/Time Selector  (06.019) = 0 the Date (06.016) and Time (06.017) can be written by the user and the values in these parameters are
transferred to the real time clocks in keypads that support this feature that are fitted to the drive. When Date/Time Selector  (06.019) is changed to any
other value, the real time clocks are allowed to run normally again. When Date/Time Selector  (06.019) is changed from any value to 0 the date and time
from a real time clock, if present, is automatically loaded into Date (06.016) and Time (06.017), so that this date and time is used as the initial value for

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 189
editing. If more than one real time clock is present the date/time from the local keypad is used, if present.

Date (06.016) and Time (06.017) are used by the timers in Menu 09 and for time stamping trips. These features will continue to use the originally selected
clock even if Date/Time Selector  (06.019) is changed until a drive reset is initiated. If Date/Time Selector  (06.019) has been changed and a reset is
initiated Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) and Timer 2 Repeat Function (09.049) are set to zero to disable the timers, and the trip dates and times
(10.041 to 10.060) are reset to zero.

Parameter 06.020 Date Format


Short description Defines if the US date format is used or not
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Std
1 US

Date Format (06.020) selects the display style for Date (06.016), Timer 1 Start Date (09.035), Timer 1 Stop Date (09.037), Timer 2 Start Date (09.045),
Timer 2 Stop Date (09.047), and for the trip time stamping date parameters (10.041, 10.043, 10.045, 10.047, 10.049, 10.051, 10.053, 10.055,
10.057 and 10.059) when displayed on a keypad connected to the drive. The format selection made in this parameter does not affect the value of these
parameters if they are read using comms or by an applications program.

If Date Format (06.020) is 0 then standard format is used and the date is displayed on the keypad as dd.mm.yy and if Date Format (06.020) is 1 then US
format is used and the date is displayed on the keypad as mm.dd.yy.

Parameter 06.021 Time Between Filter Changes


Short description Defines the time between filter changes
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 30000
Default 0 Units hours
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Time Between Filter Changes (06.021) should be set to a non-zero value to enable the filter change timer system. Each time
Filter Change Required / Change Done (06.022) is changed by the user from 1 to 0 the value of Time Between Filter Changes (06.021) is copied to
Time Before Filter Change Due (06.023). For each hour while Drive Active (10.002) = 1 the Time Before Filter Change Due (06.023) is reduced by 1 until
it reaches zero. When Time Before Filter Change Due (06.023) reaches 0 Filter Change Required / Change Done (06.022) is set to 1 to indicate that a
filter change is required. The filter should be changed and the system reset again by resetting Filter Change Required / Change Done (06.022) to 0.

When a non-zero value is written to Time Between Filter Changes (06.021) to enable the system, Filter Change Required / Change Done (06.022) should
be set to 1 and then back to 0 to transfer the required time to Time Before Filter Change Due (06.023) and to enable the count down.

Parameter 06.022 Filter Change Required / Change Done


Short description Set to 0 when a filter change has taken place
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read/write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, ND, NC

See Time Between Filter Changes (06.021).

Parameter 06.023 Time Before Filter Change Due


Short description Displays the time before a filter change is required
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 30000
Default Units hours
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Time Between Filter Changes (06.021).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


190 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 06.024 Reset Energy Meter
Short description Set to 1 to reset the energy meter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Energy Meter: MWh (06.025) and Energy Meter: kWh (06.026) accumulate the energy transferred through the drive. If Reset Energy Meter (06.024) = 1
then Energy Meter: MWh (06.025) and Energy Meter: kWh (06.026) are held at zero. If Reset Energy Meter (06.024) = 0 then the energy meter is enabled
and will accumulate the energy flow. If the maximum or minimum of Energy Meter: MWh (06.025) is reached the parameter does not rollover and is
instead clamped at the maximum or minimum value. For Open-loop, RFC-A and RFC-S modes a positive energy flow indicates that power is flowing out
of the a.c. motor terminals. For Regen mode a positive energy flow indicates that power is flowing from the supply to the a.c. drive terminals.

Parameter 06.025 Energy Meter: MWh


Short description Displays the accumulated energy transferred through the drive in MWh
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -999.9 Maximum 999.9
Default Units MWh
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Reset Energy Meter (06.024).

Parameter 06.026 Energy Meter: kWh


Short description Displays the accumulated energy transferred through the drive in kWh
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -99.99 Maximum 99.99
Default Units kWh
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Reset Energy Meter (06.024).

Parameter 06.027 Energy Cost Per kWh


Short description Defines the cost of energy per kWh
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 600.0
Default 0.0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

Running Cost (06.028) is derived from the Output Power (05.003) and the Energy Cost Per kWh (06.027) in cost per hour. The sign of Running Cost
(06.028) is the same as the sign of Output Power (05.003).

Parameter 06.028 Running Cost


Short description Displays the running cost of the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32000 Maximum 32000
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Energy Cost Per kWh (06.027).

Parameter 06.029 Hardware Enable


Short description Set to 1 to enable the hardware of the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 191
Hardware Enable (06.029) normally shows the hardware enable state based on the state of the safe torque off system. However, drive I/O can be routed
to Hardware Enable (06.029) to reduce the disable time. See description of the enable logic for more details.

Parameter 06.030 Run Forward


Short description Set to 1 to give the drive a run forward signal
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) is not equal to 4 then Run Forward (06.030) can be used to make the Final drive run active and Reverse Select
(01.012) = 0, i.e. to make the drive run in the forward direction. See description of sequencer logic for more details.

Parameter 06.031 Jog


Short description Set to 1 to give the drive a jog signal
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) is not equal to 4 then Jog (06.031) can be used to make the Final drive run active and Jog Select (01.013) = 1,
i.e. to make the drive run using the jog reference and jog ramps rates. The jog function is disabled if the run is made active through the normal running
sequencing bits. See description of sequencer logic for more details.

Parameter 06.032 Run Reverse


Short description Set to 1 to give the drive a run reverse signal
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) is not equal to 4 then Run Reverse (06.032) can be used to make the Final drive run active and Reverse Select
(01.012) = 1, i.e. to make the drive run in the reverse direction. See description of sequencer logic for more details.

Parameter 06.033 Forward/Reverse


Short description Set to 1 to reverse the direction of the motor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) is not equal to 4 then Forward/Reverse (06.033) can be used to force the state of Reverse Select (01.012). If
Forward/Reverse (06.033) = 1 then Reverse Select (01.012) = 1. If Forward/Reverse (06.033) = 0 then Forward/Reverse (06.033) = 0 unless it is set to 1
by the rest of the normal run or jog logic. See description of sequencer logic for more details.

Parameter 06.034 Run


Short description Set to 1 to give the drive a run signal
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) is not equal to 4 then Run (06.034) can be used to make the Final drive run active, but not to affect the state of
Reverse Select (01.012). Normally Run (06.034) would be used in conjunction with Forward/Reverse (06.033) if control of the direction is required. See
description of sequencer logic for more details.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


192 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 06.035 Forward Limit Switch
Short description Set to 1 to activate the forward limit switch and remove the final drive run signal
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms or 250µs read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

Forward Limit Switch (06.035) and Reverse Limit Switch (06.036) can be used to activate Limit Switch Active (10.066) and remove the Final drive run
signal. When Limit Switch Active (10.066) is active and Limit Switch Stop Mode (06.002) = 0 the motor is stopped without ramps, otherwise it is stopped
with the currently selected ramp rate. If digital input 4 or 5 are routed to Forward Limit Switch (06.035) or Reverse Limit Switch (06.036) the maximum
delay is approximately 600us. The limit switches are direction dependant as shown below, so that the motor can rotate in a direction that allows the
system to move away from the limit switch.

Forward Limit Switch Reverse Limit Switch


Condition
(06.035) (06.036)
Pre-ramp Reference (01.003) + Hard Speed Reference
Enabled Not enabled
(03.022) > 0.0
Pre-ramp Reference (01.003) + Hard Speed Reference
Not enabled Enabled
(03.022) < 0.0
Pre-ramp Reference (01.003) + Hard Speed Reference
Enabled Enabled
(03.022) = 0.0

Note that if Hard Speed Reference Select (03.023) = 0 then the Hard Speed Reference (03.022) is taken as 0.

Parameter 06.036 Reverse Limit Switch


Short description Set to 1 to activate the reverse limit switch and remove the final drive run signal
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms or 250µs read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Forward Limit Switch (06.035).

Parameter 06.037 Jog Reverse


Short description Set to 1 to give the drive a jog reverse signal
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) is not equal to 4 then Jog Reverse (06.037) can be used to make the Final drive run active, Jog Select (01.013) =
1 and Reverse Select (01.012) = 1, i.e. to make the drive run using the jog reference and jog ramps rates in the reverse direction. The jog function is
disabled if the run is made active through the normal running sequencing bits. See description of sequencer logic for more details.

Parameter 06.039 Not Stop


Short description Set to 1 to reset the latched sequencer bits if sequencer latching is enabled
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If Enable Sequencer Latching (06.040) = 1 then the sequencer bits can be latched. Not Stop (06.039) should be used to reset the latched sequencer bits.
If Not Stop (06.039) = 1 then the sequencer bits can be latched. If Not Stop (06.039) = 0 then the latches are cleared and their outputs are forced to zero
which will de-activate the Final drive run. See description of sequencer logic for more details.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 193
Parameter 06.040 Enable Sequencer Latching
Short description Set to 1 to enable sequencer latching
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 2ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Not Stop (06.039).

Parameter 06.041 Drive Event Flags


Short description Displays if certain actions have occurred within the drive
Mode RFC‑A
0 3
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00) (Display: 11)
0
Default Units
(Display: 00)
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

Drive Event Flags (06.041) indicates that certain actions have occurred within the drive as described below.

Bit Corresponding event


0 Defaults loaded
1 Drive mode changed

Bit 0: Defaults loaded


The drive sets bit 0 when defaults have been loaded and the associated parameter save has been completed. The drive does not reset this flag except at
power-up.

Bit 1: Drive mode changed


The drive sets bit 1 when the drive mode has changed and the associated parameter save has been completed. The drive does not reset this flag except
at power-up.

Parameter 06.042 Control Word


Short description Controls the sequencer state machine inputs if the control word is enabled
Mode RFC‑A
0 32767
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 000000000000000) (Display: 111111111111111)
0
Default Units
(Display: 000000000000000)
Bits 9,7-0: 2ms read. Other bits:
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate
Background read
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If Control Word Enable (06.043) = 0 then Control Word (06.042) has no effect. If Control Word Enable (06.043) = 1 the bits in Control Word (06.042) are
used instead of their corresponding parameters or to initiate drive functions as shown in the table below.

Bit Corresponding parameter or function


0 Drive Enable (06.015)
1 Run Forward (06.030)
2 Jog (06.031)
3 Run Reverse (06.032)
4 Forward/Reverse (06.033)
5 Run (06.034)
6 Not Stop (06.039)
7 Auto/manual
8 Analogue/Preset reference
9 Jog Reverse (06.037)
10 Not used
11 Not used
12 Trip drive
13 Drive Reset (10.033)
14 Watchdog

Bits 0-7 and bit 9: Sequencer control


When Auto/manual bit (bit7) = 1 then bits 0 to 6 and bit 9 of the Control Word (06.042) become active. The equivalent parameters are not modified by
these bits, but become inactive when the equivalent bits in the Control Word (06.042) are active. When the bits are active they replace the functions of the

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


194 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
equivalent parameters.

Bit 8: Analogue/preset reference


The state of Analogue/Preset Reference (bit 8) is written continuously to Reference Select Flag 2 (01.042). With default drive settings (i.e.
Reference Selector (01.014) = 0) this selects Analog Reference 1 (01.036) when bit 8 = 0 or Preset Reference 1 (01.021) when bit8 = 1. If any other drive
parameters are routed to Reference Select Flag 2 (01.042) the value of this parameter is undefined.

Bit 10 and bit 11: Not used


The values of these bits have no effect on the drive.

Bit 12: Trip drive


If bit 12 = 1 then a Control Word trip is repeatedly initiated. The trip cannot be cleared until bit 12 = 0.

Bit 13: Reset drive


If bit 13 is changed from 0 to 1 a drive reset is initiated. Bit 13 does not modify Drive Reset (10.033).

Bit 14: Watchdog


A watchdog system can be enabled or serviced each time bit 14 is changed from 0 to 1. Once bit 14 has been changed from 0 to 1 to enable the
watchdog, this must be repeated every 1s or else a Watchdog trip will be initiated. The watchdog is disabled when the trip occurs and must be re-enabled
if required when the trip is reset.

Parameter 06.043 Control Word Enable


Short description Set to 1 to enable the control word
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 2ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Control Word (06.042).

Parameter 06.044 Active Supply


Indicates when the backup supply mode is enabled and the dc link voltage is below the upper under
Short description
voltage threshold
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

If Backup Supply Mode Enable (06.068) = 0 then Active Supply (06.044) = 0. If Backup Supply Mode Enable (06.068) = 1 then Active Supply (06.044) = 0
when the d.c. link voltage is above the upper under-voltage threshold otherwise it is one. In Regen mode Active Supply (06.044) is always zero.

Parameter 06.045 Cooling Fan control


Short description Defines the maximum speed of the drive cooling fan
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -10 Maximum 11
Default 10 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Cooling Fan control (06.045) can be used to select various fan control functions as shown in the table below. The actual control speed of the fan(s) is
given in Cooling Fan Speed (06.046). There are 10 control speeds for the fan(s) in the drive, however the actual hardware control is more coarse than
this, and so there may not be an actual change of fan speed as Cooling Fan Speed (06.046) changes from one value to the next. The default value for
Cooling Fan control (06.045) is 10, which gives maximum cooling and does not limit the fan speed below its maximum. It should be noted that if the speed
is limited, by setting a lower value, then the drive may trip prematurely under load.

Cooling Fan control


Function Selected
(06.045)
Minimum fan noise function with fan speed limited to
-10 to -1
the value of Cooling Fan control (06.045).
0 Fan does not run.
Maximum cooling with fan speed limited to the
1 to 10
modulus of Cooling Fan control (06.045).
11 Fan runs continuously at full speed.

The two possible control characteristics are shown in the diagram below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 195
The fan speed is derived from Percentage Of Drive Thermal Trip Level (07.036) which shows the percentage to the trip level of the hottest monitored
point in the drive. The "Maximum Cooling" characteristic brings the fan(s) on at a relatively low temperature to give maximum cooling. The "Minimum Fan
Noise" characteristic does not switch on the fan(s) until the drive temperature has risen significantly, and the characteristic has a lower gradient.
Therefore with lighter continuous loads the fan noise is kept to a minimum. This characteristic also prevents the fan(s) from coming on when the drive is
disabled and operating in a high ambient. With both characteristics a filter is applied to Percentage Of Drive Thermal Trip Level (07.036) to avoid the fans
switching on and off during short high transient loads. The "Minimum Fan Noise" characteristic also includes a hysteresis band of 15% that is applied to
the percentage of drive thermal trip level at the input to the control algorithm to prevent the feedback from changing the speed back again. This reduces
the chance of the fan repetitively changing speed under constant load conditions.

Parameter 06.046 Cooling Fan Speed


Short description Cooling Fan Speed
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 10
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background Write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Cooling Fan control (06.045).

Parameter 06.047 Input Phase Loss Detection Mode


Short description Defines how the input phase loss is detected
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Full
1 Ripple Only
2 Disabled

Input phase loss is detected by monitoring the d.c. link voltage ripple which increases with load. When compared to normal operation, if an input phase is
missing or there is excessive input phase imbalance the d.c. link the ripple level is higher. For frame sizes 07 and above additional input phase loss
detection is provided by direct monitoring of the supply voltages. Unlike the d.c. voltage ripple based detection which can only operate when the drive is
enabled and on load, the additional input phase loss detection can operate whether the drive is enabled or not. Input Phase Loss Detection Mode
(06.047) defines the methods used for input phase loss detection provided by the drive.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


196 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Input Phase Loss Detection Mode
Drive Active (10.002) = 0 Drive Active (10.002) = 1
(06.047)
*Direct input phase loss *Direct input phase loss detection
0
detection D.c. link voltage ripple detection
1 No input phase loss detection D.c. link voltage ripple detection
2 No input phase loss detection No input phase loss detection

*Frame sizes 07 and above

Input phase loss detection can be disabled when the drive is required to operate from a d.c. supply connected to the d.c. link or from a single phase
supply. If the drive operates from a single phase supply or a supply with high levels of phase imbalanced under load the input stage and d.c. link thermal
protection system may produce an OHt dc bus trip.

When frame sizes 10 and above are operated with parallel power modules a trip is initiated if the supply is completely removed from the input to any of
the parallel modules. This additional detection is disabled if Input Phase Loss Detection Mode (06.047) > 0.

Parameter 06.048 Supply Loss Detection Level


Short description Defines the threshold for indicating when the supply loss condition is detected
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SUPPLY_LOSS_LEVEL[MIN] Maximum VM_SUPPLY_LOSS_LEVEL[MAX]
Default See exceptions below Units V
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM, RA

Voltage Default Value


200V 205
400V 410
575V 540
690V 540

See Supply Loss Mode (06.003).

Parameter 06.051 Hold Supply Loss Active


Short description Hold Supply Loss Active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If supply loss is detected (i.e. Supply Loss (10.015) = 1) or Hold Supply Loss Active (06.051) = 1 the supply loss indication and the action taken on supply
loss will be active. For example, Hold Supply Loss Active (06.051) can be controlled by an external rectifier or a Regen system (via a digital input) to
prevent power from being taken from the supply if supply loss ride-through mode is being used until the input system is ready to provide power. For
example, this can allow a charge system in an external rectifier to complete the charging of the d.c. link and become inactive before power is taken from
the supply. A Regen system connected between the supply and the drive can operate in auto-synchronisation mode for a short time when the supply is
removed. Hold Supply Loss Active (06.051) can be used to make the supply loss state persist for a short time after the supply is reapplied while the
Regen system recovers. See Disable Charge System / Close Contactor (03.007) for more details.

Parameter 06.052 Motor Pre-heat Current Magnitude


Short description Defines the current in the motor when the state machine is in the stop state
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 100
Default 0 Units %
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Hold Zero Speed (06.008).

Parameter 06.053 Sleep / Wake Threshold


Short description Defines the threshold used for enabling the sleep/wake function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF_UNIPOLAR[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

The diagram below shows the sleep mode detection system. If Fire mode active = 1, Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) = 4, the Run excluding sleep
= 0 or Sleep / Wake Threshold (06.053) = 0 then the sleep mode system is disabled, and so Sleep Required (06.056) and Sleep Active (06.057) are held

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 197
at zero.

The sleep mode system will stop the motor if |Reference Selected (01.001)| < Sleep / Wake Threshold (06.053) for a time equal to Sleep Time (06.054)
and restart the motor if |Reference Selected (01.001)| ≥ Sleep / Wake Threshold (06.053) for a time equal to Wake Time (06.055). If
Bipolar Reference Enable (01.010) = 0 (i.e. unipolar mode is being used) then negative values of Reference Selected (01.001) are treated as zero. It is
possible for the PID controller (Menu 14) to hold off sleep mode by setting PID1 Pre-sleep Boost Level  (14.028) to 1.

Parameter 06.054 Sleep Time


Short description Defines the time that the drive will stop the motor if the sleep function is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 250.0
Default 10.0 Units s
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

See Sleep / Wake Threshold (06.053).

Parameter 06.055 Wake Time


Short description Defines the time that the drive will restart the motor if the wake function is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 250.0
Default 10.0 Units s
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

See Sleep / Wake Threshold (06.053).

Parameter 06.056 Sleep Required


Short description Indicates if the pre-requisites of the sleep mode system are in the state to enable the sleep function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Sleep / Wake Threshold (06.053).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


198 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 06.057 Sleep Active
Short description Displays if the sleep function has been activated
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Sleep / Wake Threshold (06.053).

Parameter 06.058 Output Phase Loss Detection Time


Short description Output Phase Loss Detection Time
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 0.5s
1 1.0s
2 2.0s
3 4.0s

See Output Phase Loss Detection Enable (06.059). This parameter has no effect in RFC-S mode.

Parameter 06.059 Output Phase Loss Detection Enable


Short description Set to non-zero value to enable output phase loss detection
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Disabled
1 Phases
2 Devices
3 Low Noise

Output phase loss detection can be used to detect a disconnected motor phase or a failed power device if Output Phase Loss Detection Enable
(06.059) is set to a non-zero value.

0: Disabled
Output phase loss detection is not active.

1: Phases
A test is carried out each time the drive is enabled to run to check if all three phases are connected. If the test fails an Out Phase Loss.X trip is initiated
where X indicates which phase is not connected (1 = U, 2 = V, 3 = W). It should be noted that this test is not carried out in Open-loop mode if "catch a
spinning motor" is enabled (i.e. Catch A Spinning Motor (06.009) > 0). A test is also carried out while the drive is running. If the drive output frequency is
above 4Hz and a phase is disconnected for the time specified by Output Phase Loss Detection Time (06.058) then a Out Phase Loss.4 trip is initiated. It
should be noted that if the motor is operating at high speed and flux weakening is active so that the magnetising current is below half the rated level then
output phase loss will not be detected. If the motor is heavily loaded when a phase is disconnected it is likely that the motor will stall and the drive output
frequency may fall below 4Hz before output phase loss is detected.

2: Devices
This test is similar to the "Phases" test above except that additional tests are carried out when the drive is enabled to run which can detect if a either the
positive or negative power device has failed in each phase. If a phase is disconnected or the positive power device has failed then an Out Phase Loss.X
trip is initiated where X is between 1 and 3 and indicates the phase that is not connected or has a failed positive device (1 = U, 2 = V, 3 = W). If X is
between 5 and 7 it indicates that the negative power device in a phase has failed (5 = U, 6 = V, 7 = W). The "Phases" test requires that 1/2 rated motor
current flows to indicate that the phase is connected. The "Devices" test only requires 1/8 of rated current, and so it produces much less acoustic noise on
starting. In either mode the tests take approximately 50ms. The "Devices" test is the preferred test as it tests all the power devices and produces less
acoustic noise. The "Phases" test is provided for legacy reasons.

3: Low Noise
This test is similar to the "Devices" test, but is intended for applications where the acoustic noise produced by the test is a problem. The applied voltage is
reduced and the current threshold is reduced to 1/32 rated motor current.

If the motor rated current is reduced from its default value then the current threshold also reduces. For each test the motor rated current should be above
the levels given in the table below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 199
Minimum motor rated current as a proportion of the default
Test
value
Phases 0.125
Devices 0.125
Low
0.5
Noise

Parameter 06.060 Standby Mode Enable


Short description Set to 1 to enable standby mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If Standby Mode Enable (06.060) = 1 then the drive will go into the standby power state whenever Drive Active (10.002) = 0 with a delay of 30s. In this
state the LED on the front of the drive flashes 0.5s on and 5s off, the drive cannot be enabled and the following actions are taken as defined by the
Standby Mode Mask (06.061). Actions are enabled by setting the appropriate bit to 1. Once standby mode has become active it will remain active, even if
an attempt is made subsequently to enable the drive, until Standby Mode Enable (06.060) is set to 0.

Standby Mode Mask


Action
(06.061) bits
Turn off the drive position feedback power supply.
0 On leaving standby mode the drive position
feedback interfaces will be re-initialised.
Turn off the power supply to a keypad fitted to the
1
drive.
2 Turn off the drive 24V output.
Request that the option module in option slot 1 to go
3
into the standby power mode
Request that the option module in option slot 2 to go
4
into the standby power mode
Request that the option module in option slot 3 to go
5
into the standby power mode
Request that the option module in option slot 4 to go
6
into the standby power mode

Parameter 06.061 Standby Mode Mask


Short description Defines the actions of the drive with standby mode enabled
Mode RFC‑A
0 127
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0000000) (Display: 1111111)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0000000)
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Standby Mode Enable (06.060).

Parameter 06.065 Standard Under Voltage Threshold


Short description Defines the standard under voltage threshold
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_STD_UNDER_VOLTS[MIN] Maximum VM_STD_UNDER_VOLTS[MAX]
Default See exceptions below Units V
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM, RA

Voltage Default Value


200V 175
400V 330
575V 435
690V 435

Under-voltage and power supply control

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


200 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Under-voltage system
The under-voltage system controls the state of Under Voltage Active (10.016) which is then used by the sequencer state machine. Normally one detector
is used to detect when the under-voltage state is active, unless back-up mode is being used with smaller drives (see below). The detector(s) include 5%
hysteresis subject to a minimum of 5V. If D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) is below the threshold Under Voltage Active (10.016) = 0. If D.c. Bus Voltage
(05.005) is above the threshold, but below the threshold plus the 5% hysteresis there is no change of state. If D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) is above the
threshold plus 5% hysteresis Under Voltage Active (10.016) changes to one with a delay of 250ms. The delay is provided to allow the d.c. link voltage to
stop rising before the charging system is disabled.

When Under Voltage Active (10.016) = 1 the sequencer state machine will change to the UNDER_VOLTAGE state and when the UNDER_VOLTAGE
state is active it is not possible to enable the drive inverter. The under-voltage system operates in different ways depending on the setting of
Backup Supply Mode Enable (06.068).

If the low under-voltage threshold is used or if back-up supply mode is selected the internal drive power supplies are normally powered from the 24V
supply input (i.e. Digital I/O 13). See User Supply Select (06.072) for details. (It should be noted that in Regen mode Backup Supply Mode Enable
(06.068) is not present, and so back-up supply mode cannot be selected.)

Drive frame sizes 06 and below use a charging system based on a charge resistor and shorting relay. For larger drive frame sizes a thyristor based
charge system is used. The type of charge system does not alter the operation of the drive except for the times allowed for soft-start state changes and
the method used for back-up supply mode. The setting for the under-voltage level is used to detect the under-voltage condition based on the d.c. link
voltage. If a thyristor charging system is used this level is also passed to the thyristor rectifier system so that it is fully deactivated (i.e. the thyristors are
phased forwards so that the drive can take power from the supply) by the time the d.c. link voltage reaches the under-voltage level and allows the drive
inverter to become active. It should be noted that the under-voltage threshold used with a thyristor based charge system and the charging rate
(Slow Rectifier Charge Rate Enable (06.071)) are automatically saved within the rectifier units each time the value is changed because these will be
required at the next power-up before the drive control system is active. These values will be retained when they are changed 128 times. If any more
changes are made between power-up and power-down the new values are not retained.

Standard mode: Backup Supply Mode Enable (06.068) = 0


If Low Under Voltage Threshold Select (06.067) = 0 then the under voltage threshold is defined by Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065). If
Low Under Voltage Threshold Select (06.067) = 1 then the under voltage threshold is defined by Low Under Voltage Threshold (06.066). For drives
which have a d.c. link charge system based on a charge resistor and shorting contactor, the charge system is normally active (contactor open) when
Under Voltage Active (10.016) = 1, and inactive when Under Voltage Active (10.016) = 0. The exception is that there is a delay of 50ms while the
contactor changes state and during these periods Under Voltage Active (10.016) = 1.

If the d.c. link voltage is above the under-voltage threshold and Under Voltage Active (10.016) = 0 a large surge of current can occur if the a.c. supply is
removed and then reapplied to the drive. For a given level of supply voltage the worst case surge occurs when the supply is applied at the point where
one of the line voltages is at its peak. The surge is proportional to the difference between the d.c. link voltage before the supply is reconnected and the
magnitude of the supply voltage. The minimum setting and default for Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065) corresponds to the lowest d.c. link
voltage level where the maximum allowed a.c. supply voltage can be applied without damaging the drive or rupturing the recommended supply fuses.
Therefore it is safe to adjust the under-voltage threshold using the Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065). If the under-voltage threshold needs to be
lower than the minimum of Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065), then the Low Under Voltage Threshold (06.066) should be used. It is important
that the difference between the under-voltage threshold level and the peak of the supply voltage is never larger than the difference between the minimum
Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065) and the peak of the maximum allowed a.c. supply voltage for the drive. For example:

The minimum Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065) for a 400V drive is 330V

The maximum allowed supply voltage for this drive is 480V + 10%

The peak of the maximum allowed supply voltage = 480 x 1.1 x √2 = 747V

The difference between the under-voltage threshold and the peak supply voltage = 747 - 330 = 417V

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 201
Therefore for this drive voltage rating the peak line to line voltage must never be higher than Low Under Voltage Threshold (06.066) + 417V.

If Low Under Voltage Threshold Select (06.067) is set to one and Low Under Voltage Threshold (06.066) is reduced below the variable maximum level
VM_STD_UNDER_VOLTAGE[MIN], or if Backup Supply Mode Enable (06.068) is set to one, an indication is stored in Potential Drive Damage Conditions
(10.106) that cannot be cleared by the user. This marks the drive, so that if it is damaged as a result of an input current surge, this can be detected by
service personnel.

For frame size 07 drives and larger, which use a d.c. link charge system based on a half controlled thyristor input bridge, the charge system is activated
based on the level of the voltage at the a.c. supply terminals of the drive. The threshold for the charge system is set so that the rectified supply will give
the required under-voltage threshold level. The under-voltage system operates in exactly the same way as for smaller drives except that the delay during
the transition out of the under-voltage state is extended. For single power module drive the delay is 1.0s to allow the thyristor charge system to charge the
d.c. link. For parallel power modules the delay is extended to 2.5s to ensure that all modules power up correctly.

Backup Supply Mode for frame size 06 drives and smaller: Backup Supply Mode Enable (06.068) = 1
Backup supply mode is intended to provide a smooth transition, without disabling the drive, from a high voltage a.c. supply to a low voltage d.c. backup
supply. It is necessary to disable the drive for the transition back to the high voltage a.c. supply. The following diagram is a simple representation of the
power circuit required. This does not include the necessary circuit protection components or possible battery charger, etc.

The diagram below shows the state of Under Voltage Active (10.016), the control signal to the external contactor (Under-voltage System Contactor Close
(06.069)) and Active Supply (06.044). When Backup Supply Mode Enable (06.068) is set to one the maximum applied to Low Under Voltage Threshold
(06.066) prevents this from being increased above Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065) / 1.1 so that the 5% hysteresis band on the low under-
voltage threshold does not overlap the standard under-voltage threshold.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


202 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
The numbers below correspond to the numbers shown in the diagram:

1. If the D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) is below the Lower Threshold the drive is in the under-voltage state and the internal charge system is
active to limit the charging current either from the low voltage d.c. backup supply or the high voltage a.c. supply. Under-
voltage System Contactor Close (06.069) = 1, and so it is possible for the high voltage a.c. supply to charge the d.c. link.
2. If the D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) is above the Lower Threshold, but below the Upper Threshold, there are two possible states depending
on whether the Final drive enable is 0 or 1. If Final drive enable = 0 then Under Voltage Active (10.016) = 1, the internal charge system is
active and Under-voltage System Contactor Close (06.069) = 1, so that the d.c. link can be charged by the high voltage a.c. supply. If
Final drive enable = 1 then Under Voltage Active (10.016) = 0 and the internal charge system is inactive so that the drive can run from the
low voltage d.c. backup supply. Under-voltage System Contactor Close (06.069) = 0, so that it is not possible for the high voltage a.c.
supply to charge the d.c. link.
3. If the D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) is above the Upper Threshold then Under Voltage Active (10.016) = 0 and Under-
voltage System Contactor Close (06.069) = 1, so the drive can run from the high voltage a.c. supply.
4. If the D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) subsequently falls below the Upper Threshold and the Final drive enable = 1, the drive can continue to
run, but Under-voltage System Contactor Close (06.069) is set to zero to open the high voltage a.c. supply contactor. The d.c. link
voltage will fall until it reaches the low voltage d.c. backup supply level. This gives a smooth changeover to the backup supply without
stopping the motor.

To ensure that the soft-start is in the correct state to protect the drive the following additional restrictions are applied:

1. The soft-start cannot change to the inactive state (i.e. internal soft-start relay closed) unless the d.c. link voltage is above the upper
under-voltage threshold or Under-voltage System Contactor Closed (06.070) = 0. This is shown in the diagram below which shows the
drive operation when the d.c. link voltage is between the upper and lower thresholds. When the Final Drive Enable becomes active the
external contactor is opened to disconnect the supply because the drive is intended to run from the back-up supply. The soft-start should
not be deactivated until the external contactor is opened because it is providing protection against surge currents due to the supply being
reapplied. Once it is open the soft-start is deactivated (relay closed) and the drive can run. A side effect of this additional condition occurs
when the d.c. link voltage falls and crosses the upper threshold when the drive in running. There should be a smooth transition, but the
delay between disabling the external contactor (Under-voltage System Contactor Close (06.069) = 0) and confirmation of this (Under-
voltage System Contactor Closed (06.070) = 0) when the d.c. link voltage crosses the threshold will cause the soft-start to activate
transiently giving a period with under-voltage active. To prevent this problem the indication that the d.c. link voltage has fallen and
crossed the upper threshold is delayed by 200ms.
2. Under-voltage System Contactor Close (06.069) is not set to one until the soft-start is fully active (relay open) because the soft-start is
required to prevent current surges from the supply being applied. This is also shown in the diagram below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 203
Backup Supply Mode for frame size 07 drives and larger: (Backup Supply Mode Enable (06.068) = 1)
Backup supply mode is intended to provide a smooth transition, without disabling the drive, from a high voltage a.c. supply to a low voltage d.c. backup
supply and vice versa. The following diagram is a simple representation of the power circuit required. This does not include the necessary circuit
protection components or possible battery charger, etc.

The diagram below shows the state of Under Voltage Active (10.016) and the control signal to the external contactor (Under-
voltage System Contactor Close (06.069)).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


204 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
The backup supply system contactor is used to provide the charge system for the low voltage d.c. backup supply. The charge system for the high voltage
a.c. supply is provided by the half controlled thyristor input bridge within the drive. The system operates in a similar way to standard mode (i.e. back-up
mode not enabled) with the following differences.

1. The thyristor charge system always uses a threshold voltage related to the upper under-voltage threshold.
2. Under-voltage System Contactor Close (06.069) is set to one when the d.c. link voltage is above the lower under-voltage threshold.
3. Under Voltage Active (10.016) cannot be zero to allow the drive to be enabled if Under-voltage System Contactor Closed (06.070) is
zero. This prevents power from being taken from the back-up supply if the mains supply is not present when the external soft-start
system contactor is open.

The following diagram shows how these differences apply to the system operation.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 205
Parameter 06.066 Low Under Voltage Threshold
Short description Defines the low under voltage threshold
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_LOW_UNDER_VOLTS[MIN] Maximum VM_LOW_UNDER_VOLTS[MAX]
Default See exceptions below Units V
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM, RA

Voltage Default Value


200V 175
400V 330
575V 435
690V 435

See Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065).

Parameter 06.067 Low Under Voltage Threshold Select


Short description Set to 1 to use the low under voltage threshold
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065). Also see User Supply Select (06.072) for details of when and how drive parameters can be saved, and
when a User 24V trip can occur.

Parameter 06.068 Backup Supply Mode Enable


Short description Set to 1 to enable the backup supply mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065). Also see User Supply Select (06.072) for details of when and how drive parameters can be saved, and
when a User 24V trip can occur.

Parameter 06.069 Under-voltage System Contactor Close


Should be used as the source of a digital output to control an external supply contactor when using low
Short description
voltage operation
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065).

Parameter 06.070 Under-voltage System Contactor Closed


Should be the destination of a digital input that indicates the state of an external supply contactor when
Short description
using low voltage operation
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


206 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 06.071 Slow Rectifier Charge Rate Enable
Short description Set to 1 to reduce the charge rate of the d.c. bus
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

For frame size 07 drives and larger, which use a d.c. link charge system based on a half controlled thyristor input bridge, the rate at which the d.c. bus is
charged can be reduced by setting Slow Rectifier Charge Rate Enable (06.071) to one. This will reduce the charging current which may be required if
significant additional capacitance is added to the d.c. link to prevent rupturing of input fuses.

Parameter 06.072 User Supply Select


Short description Set to 1 to select the supply from the user 24V input
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The power for the drive control system is either taken from the user 24V power supply or the main supply (i.e. derived from the power circuit d.c. link). If
Low Under Voltage Threshold Select (06.067) = 0 and Backup Supply Mode Enable (06.068) = 0 and User Supply Select (06.072) = 0 then the
supply used is determined as follows for drive sizes 5 and below. (For drive sizes 6 and above a diode OR system is used to select the required power
supply, and so this is done automatically in hardware.)

1. When the drive first powers up it tries to use the main supply or the user 24V supply in turn until the drive starts up, beginning with the main
supply.
2. If the main supply is active and the d.c. link voltage (D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005)) falls to a level where it is no longer possible to communicate with
the power stage then the drive attempts to switch over to the user 24V supply. If the user 24V supply is not present then the drive will power
down, otherwise it will continue to run off the user 24V supply. The level at which the power stage powers down depends on whether the user
24V supply is present or not. However this is maybe below half the minimum for Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065) depending on the
drive power supply loading from option modules, encoders, I/O etc.
3. If the user 24V supply is being used and the d.c. link voltage (D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005)) rises above 95% of the minimum for
Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065) then the drive attempts to switch to the main supply.

The following should be noted:

1. Parameters can be saved by setting Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) to 1000 (not in under-voltage state), or to 1 or 1001 (in any state) and initiating
a drive reset. Power-down save parameters are saved when the under-voltage state becomes active.
2. If the drive is powered from the user 24V supply and then the main supply is activated but is not above 95% of the minimum for
Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065) then the drive will continue to be powered from the user 24V supply. If the user 24V supply is
subsequently removed the drive will power down, but then if the main supply is high enough will power up again on the main supply.
3. Although the drive can run off power derived from its d.c. link at a level well below the minimum for Standard Under Voltage Threshold
(06.065) the level down to which it will operate depends on the loading applied by option modules, position feedback devices and I/O. For reliable
operation it is advisable that the d.c. link voltage is above 90% of the minimum for Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065) when the 24V
supply is not present.
4. It is possible to initiate saving power-down save parameters by forcing the drive into the under-voltage state by changing
Low Under Voltage Threshold Select (06.067) from 1 to 0 when the d.c. link voltage is below 90% of the minimum of
Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065). This is not advisable because failure of the 24V supply or the main supply at this point could result
in corruption of the drive parameters saved in non-volatile memory.

If Low Under Voltage Threshold Select (06.067) = 1 or Backup Supply Mode Enable (06.068) = 1 or User Supply Select (06.072) = 1 then the 24V user
supply is always selected. If the user 24V supply is not present then a User 24V is initiated. The following should be noted:

1. The drive will still power-up on the main supply even if the user 24V supply is not present because the drive tries each supply in turn to power up,
however the drive will remain in the tripped state until the user 24V supply is activated.
2. Parameters can only be saved by setting Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) to1001 and initiating a drive reset. Power-down save parameters are not
saved when the under-voltage state becomes active.

Parameter 06.073 Braking IGBT Lower Threshold


Short description Defines the lowest level of the d.c. bus voltage where the braking IGBT becomes active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MIN] Maximum VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX]
Default See exceptions below Units V
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM, RA

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 207
Voltage Default Value
200V 390
400V 780
575V 930
690V 1120

Braking IGBT Lower Threshold (06.073) defines the lowest level of D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) where the braking IGBT will become active and
Braking IGBT Upper Threshold (06.074) defines the level of D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) where the braking IGBT will be on continuously. When the braking
IGBT is turned on it will remain on for at least 1ms. The braking IGBT on-time is defined by the thresholds and the d.c. link voltage as given in the table
below where L = Braking IGBT Lower Threshold (06.073) and U = Braking IGBT Upper Threshold (06.074).

D.c. link voltage level On-time


D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) 0%
L ≤ D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) [(D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) - L) / (U - L)] x 100%
D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) ≥ U 100%

As the D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) rises above the lower threshold the braking IGBT is active with an on/off ratio of 1/100. As the voltage rises further, the
on/off ratio increases until at the upper threshold the braking IGBT is on continuously. The upper and lower voltage threshold can be set up so that
braking resistors in drives with parallel connected d.c. links will share the braking load.

If Braking IGBT Lower Threshold (06.073) ≥ Braking IGBT Upper Threshold (06.074) then the braking IGBT is off when D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) <
Braking IGBT Upper Threshold (06.074) and on if D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) ≥ Braking IGBT Upper Threshold (06.074). This method of control is the
same as that used in Unidrive SP and the default values for the braking thresholds are equal to the braking thresholds in Unidrive SP.

Unless sharing between braking resistors is required the braking thresholds do not normally need to be adjusted. Care should be taken when reducing the
thresholds because if either threshold is below the maximum value of the peak rectified supply voltage the braking resistor could take power from the
supply.

The list below gives conditions that will disable the braking IGBT:

1. Braking IGBT Upper Threshold (06.074) = 0, or Low Voltage Braking IGBT Threshold Select (06.076) = 1 and


Low Voltage Braking IGBT Threshold (06.075) = 0.
2. The drive is in the under-voltage state.
3. A priority 1, 2 or 3 trip is active (see Trip 0 (10.020)).
4. One of the following trips is active or would be active if another trip is not already active: OI Brake, PSU, Th Brake Res or OHt Inverter.
5. Percentage Of Drive Thermal Trip Level (07.036) = 100%. This is an indication that some part of the drive is too hot and is used to
indicate if an internally fitted braking resistor is too hot.
6. Brake R Too Hot is active or the system has been set up to disable the braking IGBT based on the braking resistor temperature and the
resistor is too hot (i.e. bit 2 of Action On Trip Detection (10.037) is set).

Parameter 06.074 Braking IGBT Upper Threshold


Short description Defines the level of the d.c. bus voltage where the braking IGBT will be on continuously
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MIN] Maximum VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX]
Default See exceptions below Units V
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM, RA

Voltage Default Value


200V 390
400V 780
575V 930
690V 1120

See Braking IGBT Lower Threshold (06.073).

Parameter 06.075 Low Voltage Braking IGBT Threshold


Short description Defines the threshold used for low voltage braking
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MIN] Maximum VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX]
Default 0 Units V
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM, RA

If Low Voltage Braking IGBT Threshold Select (06.076) = 0 the normal thresholds are used. If Low Voltage Braking IGBT Threshold Select (06.076) = 1


then Low Voltage Braking IGBT Threshold (06.075) is used, so that the braking IGBT is on with a minimum on time of 1ms if the d.c. link voltage is above
this level, or off if the d.c. link voltage is below this level.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


208 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 06.076 Low Voltage Braking IGBT Threshold Select
Short description Set to 1 to enable low voltage IGBT braking
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Low Voltage Braking IGBT Threshold (06.075).

Parameter 06.084 Date And Time Offset


Short description Date And Time Offset
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -12.00 Maximum 12.00
Default 0.00 Units hours
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

Date And Time Offset (06.084) is an offset, specified in hours, that can be applied to the Time (06.017). If the offset applied causes the time to roll-over at
midnight then the Date (06.016) and Day Of Week (06.018) are also modified. The offset is only applied when the clock source is a clock derived from a
keypad, i.e. Date/Time Selector  (06.019) > 3. The offset can be used for time zone offsets or daylight saving time etc.

Parameter 06.085 Control Word Override


Short description Can be used to override the control word.
Mode RFC‑A
0 32767
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 000000000000000) (Display: 111111111111111)
0
Default Units
(Display: 000000000000000)
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

Control Word Override (06.085) is used instead of Control Word (06.042) if Control override enable (06.086) is set to 1 (Control Word) or 2 (Enable). The
individual bits in this parameter operate in the same way as the bits in Control Word (06.042).

Parameter 06.086 Control override enable


Short description Selects the level of control override
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, NC

Value Text Description


0 Disabled Control override is disabled.
1 Control Word Control override is only overriding the control word.
Control override is overriding the control word and has disabled
2 Enabled
the drive onboard user program.

Control override enable (06.086) is intended to be used by PC tools to take control of the drive for various reasons, i.e. to initiate an auto-tune. The level
of control is defined by the value of this parameter.

0: Disabled
The control override is disabled and has no effect.

1: Control Word
Control Word Override (06.085) is used instead of Control Word (06.042). Note that Control Word Override (06.085) is active whatever the value
of Control Word Enable (06.043).

2: Enabled
Control Word Override (06.085) is active and the drive onboard user program is disabled. Option modules that support this override feature will also
initiate various actions to stop controlling the drive within 2s of Control override enable (06.086) being set to 2 (Enabled). See the documentation for each
option module for details.

This override system can be used for other purposes, for example to take control of the drive to operate it locally when it is being controlled by a comms
option module via Control Word (06.042), but this can prevent various functions of PC tools from operating correctly. Therefore it is not advisable to write
to Control Word Override (06.085) or Control override enable (06.086) continuously from a user program or via comms.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 209
Menu 7 Single Line Descriptions − Analog I/O
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


210 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter Range Default Type
07.001 Analog Input 1 ±100.00 % RO Num ND NC PT FI
07.002 Analog Input 2 ±100.00 % RO Num ND NC PT FI
07.003 Analog Input 3 ±100.00 % RO Num ND NC PT FI
07.004 Monitored Temperature 1 ±250 °C RO Num ND NC PT
07.005 Monitored Temperature 2 ±250 °C RO Num ND NC PT
07.006 Monitored Temperature 3 ±250 °C RO Num ND NC PT
4‑20mA Low (-4),
20‑4mA Low (-3),
4‑20mA Hold (-2),
07.007 Analog Input 1 Mode 20‑4mA Hold (-1), 0‑20mA (0), Volt (6) RW Txt US
20‑0mA (1), 4‑20mA Trip (2),
20‑4mA Trip (3), 4‑20mA (4),
20‑4mA (5), Volt (6)
07.008 Analog Input 1 Scaling 0.000 to 10.000 1.000 RW Num US
07.009 Analog Input 1 Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
07.010 Analog Input 1 Destination 0.000 to 59.999 1.036 RW Num DE PT US
4‑20mA Low (-4),
20‑4mA Low (-3),
4‑20mA Hold (-2),
07.011 Analog Input 2 Mode 20‑4mA Hold (-1), 0‑20mA (0), Volt (6) RW Txt US
20‑0mA (1), 4‑20mA Trip (2),
20‑4mA Trip (3), 4‑20mA (4),
20‑4mA (5), Volt (6)
07.012 Analog Input 2 Scaling 0.000 to 10.000 1.000 RW Num US
07.013 Analog Input 2 Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
07.014 Analog Input 2 Destination 0.000 to 59.999 1.037 RW Num DE PT US
Volt (6), Therm Short Cct (7),
07.015 Analog Input 3 Mode Thermistor (8), Volt (6) RW Txt US
Therm No Trip (9)
07.016 Analog Input 3 Scaling 0.000 to 10.000 1.000 RW Num US
07.017 Analog Input 3 Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
07.018 Analog Input 3 Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
07.019 Analog Output 1 Source 0.000 to 59.999 3.002 RW Num PT US
07.020 Analog Output 1 Scaling 0.000 to 10.000 1.000 RW Num US
07.022 Analog Output 2 Source 0.000 to 59.999 4.002 RW Num PT US
07.023 Analog Output 2 Scaling 0.000 to 10.000 1.000 RW Num US
07.025 Calibrate Analog Input 1 Full Scale Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
07.026 Analogue Input 1 Fast Update Active Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
07.027 Analogue Input 2 Fast Update Active Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
07.028 Analog Input 1 Current Loop Loss Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
07.029 Analog Input 2 Current Loop Loss Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
07.030 Analog Input 1 Offset ±100.00 % 0.00 % RW Num US
07.031 Analog Input 2 Offset ±100.00 % 0.00 % RW Num US
07.032 Analog Input 3 Offset ±100.00 % 0.00 % RW Num US
07.033 Power Output ±100.0 % RO Num ND NC PT
07.034 Inverter Temperature ±250 °C RO Num ND NC PT
07.035 Percentage Of d.c. Link Thermal Trip Level 0 to 100 % RO Num ND NC PT
07.036 Percentage Of Drive Thermal Trip Level 0 to 100 % RO Num ND NC PT
07.037 Temperature Nearest To Trip Level 0 to 20999 RO Num ND NC PT
07.038 Temperature Monitor Select 1 0 to 1999 1001 RW Num US
07.039 Temperature Monitor Select 2 0 to 1999 1002 RW Num US
07.040 Analog Input 1 Minimum ±100.00 % -100.00 % RW Num US
07.041 Analog Input 2 Minimum ±100.00 % -100.00 % RW Num US
07.042 Analog Input 3 Minimum ±100.00 % -100.00 % RW Num US
07.043 Analog Input 1 Maximum ±100.00 % 100.00 % RW Num US
07.044 Analog Input 2 Maximum ±100.00 % 100.00 % RW Num US
07.045 Analog Input 3 Maximum ±100.00 % 100.00 % RW Num US
DIN44082 (0), KTY84 (1),
PT100 (4W) (2),
PT1000 (4W) (3),
PT2000 (4W) (4),
07.046 Analog Input 3 Thermistor Type 2.0mA (4W) (5), DIN44082 (0) RW Txt US
PT100 (2W) (6),
PT1000 (2W) (7),

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 211
PT2000 (2W) (8),
2.0mA (2W) (9)
07.047 Analog Input 3 Thermistor Feedback 0 to 5000 Ω RO Num ND NC PT
07.048 Analog Input 3 Thermistor Trip Threshold 0 to 5000 Ω 3300 Ω RW Num US
07.049 Analog Input 3 Thermistor Reset Threshold 0 to 5000 Ω 1800 Ω RW Num US
07.050 Analog Input 3 Thermistor Temperature -50 to 300 °C RO Num ND NC PT
07.051 Analog Input 1 Full Scale 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT PS
07.052 Temperature Monitor Select 3 0 to 1999 1 RW Num US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


212 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 7 − Analog I/O
Mode: RFC‑A

Analog Outputs
The update rate for analog outputs is 250μs; although the output will only change at the update rate defined by the source parameter for the output. The
following exceptions apply:

1. Speed Feedback (03.002) has an update rate of 4ms and includes a 16ms window filter. If this parameter is selected as a source for output 2
the update rate of the source changes to 250us and the only filter applied is the window filter associated with the position feedback interface
(i.e. P1 Feedback Filter (03.042) for the P1 interface). It should be noted that this feature is only provided when the position feedback is from a
drive interface and not from an option module.
2. If either analogue output is set up for current mode then the update rate for both analogue outputs is 4ms.

Analog Inputs
The normal sample rate for the analog inputs is 4ms, however this is increased to 250us for analogue inputs 1 and 2 under the following conditions:

1. The maximum and the minimum for the input are at their default values of 100.00% and -100.00% respectively.
2. The input is set to voltage mode.
3. One of the destinations given in the table below must be selected.
4. If the destination is Analog Reference 1 (01.036) or Analog Reference 2 (01.037) the reference system must not be in uinpolar mode, i.e.
Bipolar Reference Enable (01.010) must be one.

Note that Analogue Input 1 Fast Update Active (07.026) and Analogue Input 2 Fast Update Active (07.027) indicate if fast updating is active for each
input.

Drive
Parameter Comment
modes
RFC- The data from Analog Reference 1 (01.036) is processed in the 250us
Analog Reference 1
A, task so that the reference to the speed controller is updated every
(01.036)
RFC-S 250us.
RFC- The data from Analog Reference 2 (01.037) is processed in the 250us
Analog Reference 2
A, task so that the reference to the speed controller is updated every
(01.037)
RFC-S 250us.
RFC-
Hard Speed Reference
A,
(03.022)
RFC-S
RFC-
Torque Reference
A,
(04.008)
RFC-S
Power Input 1 (03.010)
Power Input 2 (03.013) Regen
Power Input 3 (03.014)

The diagram below shows the parameter structure for each I/O. See Internal I/O Identifier (11.068) for details of which I/O is present for different I/O
options.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 213
Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide
214 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 07.001 Analog Input 1
Short description Displays the value of analog input 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, FI, ND, NC, PT

Each analogue input has a resolution of 11 bits plus sign. The inputs can operate in different modes (defined by Analog Input 1 Mode (07.007) for
analogue input 1). These modes include voltage, current and thermistor modes. The available modes depend on the hardware configuration and are
given in the table below.

Internal I/O Identifier


Analogue Input 1 Analogue Input 2 Analogue Input 3
(11.068)
0: Standard Analogue and Bipolar Voltage,
Bipolar Voltage, Current Bipolar Voltage, Current
Digital I/O Thermistor
1: Digital I/O Not present Not present Thermistor, Disabled
2: HVAC Analogue and Unipolar Voltage, Current, Unipolar Voltage, Current,
Not present
Digital I/O Thermistor Thermistor

The "Input Level" is defined for the different modes in the table below.

Mode Input Level


Voltage (Input Voltage / 10V) x 100.00%
0-20mA (Input Current / 20mA) x 100.00%
20-0mA ((20mA - Input Current) / 20mA) x 100.00%
4-20mA ((Input Current - 4mA) / 16mA) x 100.00%
20-4mA ((20mA - Input Current) / 16mA) x 100.00%
Thermistor (Input resistance / 10K Ohm) x 100%

Analog Input 1 (07.001) is derived as follows:

Limits
A1 is the value after the minimum and maximum limits are applied.

If Analog Input 1 Minimum (07.040) ≥ Analog Input 1 Maximum (07.043) then:


A1 = 0.00% whatever the input level.

If Analog Input 1 Minimum (07.040) < 0.00% and Analog Input 1 Maximum (07.043) > 0.00% then:
A1 = Input Level x (100.00% / Analog Input 1 Maximum (07.043))
A1 is then limited between -100% and +100%.

Otherwise:
Input Level is limited between Analog Input 1 Minimum (07.040) and Analog Input 1 Maximum (07.043)
A1 = [Input Level - Analog Input 1 Minimum (07.040)] x 100.00% / (Analog Input 1 Maximum (07.043) - Analog Input 1 Minimum (07.040))

For thermistor modes it should be noted that Analog Input 1 Minimum (07.040), Analog Input 2 Minimum (07.041) and Analog Input 3 Minimum
(07.042) have no effect and that the input resistance is limited between 0 and 5kΩ.

Parameter 07.002 Analog Input 2


Short description Displays the value of analog input 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, FI, ND, NC, PT

See Analog Input 1 (07.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 215
Parameter 07.003 Analog Input 3
Short description Displays the value of analog input 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, FI, ND, NC, PT

See Analog Input 1 (07.001).

Parameter 07.004 Monitored Temperature 1


Short description Displays the temperature set up by Temperature Monitor Select 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -250 Maximum 250
Default Units °C
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Thermal monitoring is provided within the drive to protect the power stage and the control system from over temperature.

Monitored Temperature 1 (07.004), Monitored Temperature 2 (07.005) and Monitored Temperature 3 (07.006) give an indication of the temperature of
three selected monitoring points within the drive power system or control system. The required monitoring points can be selected using
Temperature Monitor Select 1 (07.038), Temperature Monitor Select 2 (07.039) and Temperature Monitor Select 3 (07.052) respectively. The default
values give two monitoring points in the power system in Monitored Temperature 1 (07.004) and Monitored Temperature 2 (07.005), and control board
temperature 1 in Monitored Temperature 3 (07.006).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


216 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 07.005 Monitored Temperature 2
Short description Displays the temperature set up by Temperature Monitor Select 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -250 Maximum 250
Default Units °C
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Monitored Temperature 1 (07.004) for details.

Parameter 07.006 Monitored Temperature 3


Short description Displays the temperature set up by Temperature Monitor Select 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -250 Maximum 250
Default Units °C
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Monitored Temperature 1 (07.004) for details.

Parameter 07.007 Analog Input 1 Mode


Short description Defines the mode of analog input 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -4 Maximum 6
Default 6 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text Description


4-20mA low value on current loss. Analog input level is 0.00% if
-4 4-20mA Low
the current is below 3mA.
20-4mA low value on current loss. Analog input level is 0.00% if
-3 20-4mA Low
the current is below 3mA.
4-20mA hold at level before loss on current loss. Analog input
-2 4-20mA Hold level remains at the value it had in the previous sample before
the current fell below 3mA.
20-4mA hold at level before loss on current loss. Analog input
-1 20-4mA Hold level remains at the value it had in the previous sample before
the current fell below 3mA.
0 0-20mA 0-20mA
1 20-0mA 20-0mA
4-20mA trip on current loss. Analog input level is 0.00% and an
2 4-20mA Trip
'An Input 1/2 Loss' trip is initiated if the current is below 3mA.
20-4mA trip on current loss. Analog input level is 0.00% and an
3 20-4mA Trip
'An Input 1/2 Loss' trip is initiated if the current is below 3mA.
4-20mA no action on loss. Analog input level is 0.00% if the
4 4-20mA
current is below 3mA.
20-4mA no action on loss. Analog input level is 0.00% if the
5 20-4mA
current is below 3mA.
6 Volt Voltage

This parameter defines the possible input modes for analog input 1.

Parameter 07.008 Analog Input 1 Scaling


Short description Defines the scaling factor of analog input 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 10.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

Analog Input 1 (07.001) is modified by Analog Input 1 Scaling (07.008), Analog Input 1 Offset (07.030) and Analog Input 1 Invert (07.009) before it is
routed to its destination as follows:

A1O = Analog Input 1 (07.001) + Analog Input 1 Offset (07.030)

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 217
A1O is the value after the offset has been applied and is limited between -100.00% and 100.00%

A1S = A1O x Analog Input 1 Scaling (07.008)

A1S is the value after the scaling and the offset have been applied and is limited between -100.00% and 100.00%

If Analog Input 1 Invert (07.009) = 0 then A1I = A1S otherwise A1I = -A1S

A1I is the value after the invert, scaling and offset have been applied and is the final value that is routed to the destination defined
by Analog Input 1 Destination (07.010).

Parameter 07.009 Analog Input 1 Invert


Short description Inverts the signal for analog input 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Analog Input 1 Scaling (07.008).

Parameter 07.010 Analog Input 1 Destination


Short description Defines the output parameter for analog input 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 1.036 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See Analog Input 1 Scaling (07.008).

Parameter 07.011 Analog Input 2 Mode


Short description Defines the mode for analog input 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -4 Maximum 6
Default 6 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text Description


4-20mA low value on current loss. Analog input level is 0.00% if
-4 4-20mA Low
the current is below 3mA.
20-4mA low value on current loss. Analog input level is 0.00% if
-3 20-4mA Low
the current is below 3mA.
4-20mA hold at level before loss on current loss. Analog input
-2 4-20mA Hold level remains at the value it had in the previous sample before
the current fell below 3mA.
20-4mA hold at level before loss on current loss. Analog input
-1 20-4mA Hold level remains at the value it had in the previous sample before
the current fell below 3mA.
0 0-20mA 0-20mA
1 20-0mA 20-0mA
4-20mA trip on current loss. Analog input level is 0.00% and an
2 4-20mA Trip
'An Input 1/2 Loss' trip is initiated if the current is below 3mA.
20-4mA trip on current loss. Analog input level is 0.00% and an
3 20-4mA Trip
'An Input 1/2 Loss' trip is initiated if the current is below 3mA.
4-20mA no action on loss. Analog input level is 0.00% if the
4 4-20mA
current is below 3mA.
20-4mA no action on loss. Analog input level is 0.00% if the
5 20-4mA
current is below 3mA.
6 Volt Voltage

This parameter defines the possible input modes for analog input 2.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


218 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 07.012 Analog Input 2 Scaling
Short description Defines the scaling factor for analog input 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 10.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

The scaling, offset and invert functions for analog input 2 are defined in the same way as for analog input 1. See Analog Input 1 Scaling (07.008).

Parameter 07.013 Analog Input 2 Invert


Short description Inverts the signal for analog input 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The scaling, offset and invert functions for analog input 2 are defined in the same way as for analog input 1. See Analog Input 1 Scaling (07.008).

Parameter 07.014 Analog Input 2 Destination


Short description Defines the output parameter for analog input 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 1.037 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

The scaling, offset and invert functions for analog input 2 are defined in the same way as for analog input 1. See Analog Input 1 Scaling (07.008).

Parameter 07.015 Analog Input 3 Mode


Short description Defines the mode of analog input 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 6 Maximum 9
Default 6 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text Description


6 Volt Voltage
7 Therm Short Cct Temperature measurement input with short circuit detection
8 Thermistor Temperature measurement without short circuit detection
9 Therm No Trip Temperature measurement input with no trips

This parameter defines the possible input modes for analog input 3.

Parameter 07.016 Analog Input 3 Scaling


Short description Defines the scaling factor for analog input 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 10.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

The scaling, offset and invert functions for analog input 3 are defined in the same way as for analog input 1. See Analog Input 1 Scaling (07.008).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 219
Parameter 07.017 Analog Input 3 Invert
Short description Inverts the signal of analog input 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The scaling, offset and invert functions for analog input 3 are defined in the same way as for analog input 1. See Analog Input 1 Scaling (07.008).

Parameter 07.018 Analog Input 3 Destination


Short description Defines the output parameter for analog input 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

The scaling, offset and invert functions for analog input 3 are defined in the same way as for analog input 1. See Analog Input 1 Scaling (07.008).

Parameter 07.019 Analog Output 1 Source


Short description Defines the input parameter for analog output 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 3.002 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

Analog Output 1 Source (07.019) defines the source parameter for analog output 1. The value of the source parameter is scaled with
Analog Output 1 Scaling (07.020) and if the scaling is greater than 1.000 the value is clamped between -100% and +100% or between 0% and 100%
depending on whether the output is bipolar or unipolar. The resulting value is then used to control the output. It should be noted that the normal rules for
parameter routing do not apply, but the scaling always makes -100% to +100% correspond to the range from minus source parameter maximum to plus
source parameter maximum, and 0% corresponds to the source parameter value of zero. This means for example that a parameter with a minimum of 1
and a maximum of 10 will produce an output that changes from 10% to 100% as the parameter is change from minimum to maximum.

The outputs provided with different hardware are given in the table below.

Internal I/O Identifier
Analogue Output 1 Analogue Output 2
(11.068)
0: Standard Analogue and
Bipolar Voltage Bipolar Voltage
Digital I/O
1: Basic I/O No output No output
2: HVAC Analogue and Unipolar Voltage or Unipolar Voltage or
Digital I/O Current Current

The output mode is defined by Analogue Output 1 Mode (07.021) as shown in the table below.

Analogue Output 1 Mode Standard Analogue and HVAC Analogue and


(07.021) Digital I/O Digital I/O
Volt -10V to + 10V 0V to +10V
0-20mA Not possible 0mA to 20mA
20-0mA Not possible 20mA to 0mA
4-20mA Not possible 4mA to 20mA
20-4mA Not possible 20mA to 4mA

Parameter 07.020 Analog Output 1 Scaling


Short description Defines the scaling factor for analog output 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 10.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See Analog Output 1 Source (07.019).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


220 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 07.022 Analog Output 2 Source
Short description Defines the input source for analog output 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 4.002 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

Analog Output 2 Source (07.022) defines the source parameter for analog output 2. The value of the source parameter is scaled with
Analog Output 2 Scaling (07.023) and if the scaling is greater than 1.000 the value is clamped between -100% and +100% or between 0% and 100%
depending on whether the output is bipolar or unipolar. The resulting value is then used to control the output. The outputs provided with different
hardware are given in the table below.

Internal I/O Identifier


Analogue Output 1 Analogue Output 2
(11.068)
0: Standard Analogue and
Bipolar Voltage Bipolar Voltage
Digital I/O
1: Basic I/O No output No output
2: HVAC Analogue and Unipolar Voltage or Unipolar Voltage or
Digital I/O Current Current

The output mode is defined by Analogue Output 2 Mode (07.024) as shown in the table below.

Analogue Output 2 Mode Standard Analogue HVAC Analogue and


(07.024) and Digital I/O Digital I/O
Volt -10V to + 10V 0V to +10V
0-20mA Not possible 0mA to 20mA
20-0mA Not possible 20mA to 0mA
4-20mA Not possible 4mA to 20mA
20-4mA Not possible 20mA to 4mA

Parameter 07.023 Analog Output 2 Scaling


Short description Defines the scaling factor for analog output 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 10.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See Analog Output 2 Source (07.022).

Parameter 07.025 Calibrate Analog Input 1 Full Scale


Short description Calibrates the input level for analog input 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

For analog input 1, and in voltage mode only, the full scale value used to determine the input level can be changed from 10V by calibrating the input.
The calibration process is triggered by setting Calibrate Analog Input 1 Full Scale (07.025) to one. Calibrate Analog Input 1 Full Scale (07.025) is
cleared automatically when the calibration process is complete. After calibration the actions are as follows:

Input voltage
during Result
calibration
The calibration result is ignored and the full scale is set
V < 1.5V
to 10V. Analog Input 1 Full Scale (07.051) is set to zero.
The calibration result is ignored and the full scale or
1.5V < V < 2.5V
Analog Input 1 Full Scale (07.051) are not affected.
The calibration result is used to set full scale and the
V > 2.5V value is also stored in Analog Input 1 Full Scale
(07.051).

It should be noted that Analog Input 1 Full Scale (07.051) is a power-down save parameter, and so the result is automatically retained after power-
down.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 221
Parameter 07.026 Analogue Input 1 Fast Update Active
Short description Analogue Input 1 Fast Update Active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Analogue Input 1 Fast Update Active (07.026) is one if the destination for analogue input 1 is being updated at the fast rate of 250us.

Parameter 07.027 Analogue Input 2 Fast Update Active


Short description Analogue Input 2 Fast Update Active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Analogue Input 2 Fast Update Active (07.027) is one if the destination for analogue input 2 is being updated at the fast rate of 250us.

Parameter 07.028 Analog Input 1 Current Loop Loss


Short description Displays when analog input 1 falls below 3mA
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

If Analog Input 1 Mode (07.007) is set to any of the 4-20mA or 20-4mA modes and the current falls below 3mA then Analog Input 1 Current Loop Loss
(07.028) is set to one. If the current is more than 3mA or any other mode is selected then Analog Input 1 Current Loop Loss (07.028) is set to zero.

Parameter 07.029 Analog Input 2 Current Loop Loss


Short description Displays when analog input 2 falls below 3mA
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Analog Input 1 Current Loop Loss (07.028).

Parameter 07.030 Analog Input 1 Offset


Short description Defines the offset of analog input 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 0.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See Analog Input 1 Scaling (07.008).

Parameter 07.031 Analog Input 2 Offset


Short description Defines the offset of analog input 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 0.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

The scaling, offset and invert functions for analog input 2 are defined in the same way as for analog input 1. See Analog Input 1 Scaling (07.008).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


222 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 07.032 Analog Input 3 Offset
Short description Defines the offset of analog input 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 0.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

The scaling, offset and invert functions for analog input 3 are defined in the same way as for analog input 1. See Analog Input 1 Scaling (07.008).

Parameter 07.033 Power Output


Short description Instant output power
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.0 Maximum 100.0
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

This is an instantaneous power output with fast update rate that is primarily intended to be used as a power feed-forward for applications with a Regen
system front end. The full scale (100.0%) value is equal to a power of 3 x (VM_DC_VOLTAGE[MAX] / 2√2) x Full Scale Current Kc (11.061). This is
compatible with the power output provided in Unidrive SP and is directly compatible with Power Input 1 (03.010) (and the other power feed-forward
parameters) in Regen mode. The scaling is intended to cover the maximum range of likely power in the drive. For example with a 400V 7.5kW drive the
full scale d.c. link voltage is 831V and Kc=38.222A, and so the full scale value of this parameter is 3 x (831 / 2√2) x 38.222 = 33.689kW. For Open-loop,
RFC-A and RFC-S modes a positive value of power indicates power flowing from the drive to motor. For Regen mode a positive value of power
indicates power flowing from the supply to the regen drive.

Parameter 07.034 Inverter Temperature


Short description Displays the estimated junction temperature of the hottest power device within the drive inverter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -250 Maximum 250
Default Units °C
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Inverter Temperature (07.034) shows the estimated junction temperature of the hottest power device within the drive inverter. If this temperature
exceeds the switch down threshold defined for the power stage the switching frequency is reduced provided this feature has not been disabled (see
Auto-switching Frequency Change (05.035)).

Parameter 07.035 Percentage Of d.c. Link Thermal Trip Level


Displays the percentage of the maximum allowed temperature as estimated by the thermal model of the
Short description
d.c. link components
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 100
Default Units %
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Percentage Of d.c. Link Thermal Trip Level (07.035) gives the percentage of the maximum allowed temperature as estimated by the thermal model of
the d.c. link components.

Parameter 07.036 Percentage Of Drive Thermal Trip Level


Displays the percentage of the thermal trip level of the temperature monitoring point or thermal model in
Short description
the drive that is highest
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 100
Default Units %
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Percentage Of Drive Thermal Trip Level (07.036) gives the percentage of the thermal trip level of the temperature monitoring point or thermal model in
the drive that is highest. This includes all thermal monitoring points (not just those selected by Monitored Temperature 1 (07.004),
Monitored Temperature 2 (07.005) and Monitored Temperature 3 (07.006)), Inverter Temperature (07.034) and
Percentage Of d.c. Link Thermal Trip Level (07.035).

Percentage Of d.c. Link Thermal Trip Level (07.035) is used directly to give Percentage Of Drive Thermal Trip Level (07.036), but for all other monitored

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 223
values which are temperatures this is given by Percentage of thermal trip level = (Temperature - 40 oC) / (Trip temperature - 40oC) x 100%

The location of the measurement or the thermal model that is related to this temperature is given in Temperature Nearest To Trip Level (07.037). If
Percentage Of Drive Thermal Trip Level (07.036) exceeds 90% Drive Over-temperature Alarm (10.018) is set to one. If
Percentage Of Drive Thermal Trip Level (07.036) reaches 100% one of the trips given in the table below is initiated. The trip can be reset when the
percentage of thermal trip level fall below 95%.

Temperature Trip
Inverter Temperature (07.034) OHt Inverter
Power system temperature OHt Power
Percentage Of d.c. Link Thermal Trip Level (07.035) OHt dc Link
Control system temperature OHt Control

Parameter 07.037 Temperature Nearest To Trip Level


Displays the thermistor location or the model that corresponds to the value shown in Percentage Of
Short description
Drive Thermal Trip Level
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 20999
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Temperature Nearest To Trip Level (07.037) shows the thermistor location or the model that corresponds to the value shown
in Percentage Of Drive Thermal Trip Level (07.036) in the form xxyzz as shown in the table below.

Source xx y zz
Control system 00 0 01: Control board thermistor 1
Control system 00 0 02: Control board thermistor 2
Control system 00 0 03: I/O board thermistor (or internal braking resistor in servo Drive)
Control system 00 1 00: Inverter thermal model
Control system 00 2 00: D.c. link thermal model
Control system 00 3 00: Braking IGBT thermal model
Power system 01 0 zz: Thermistor location defined by zz in the power system
Power system 01 Rectifier number zz: Thermistor location defined by zz in the rectifier

Parameter 07.038 Temperature Monitor Select 1


Short description Defines the temperature to be monitored in Monitored Temperature 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1999
Default 1001 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Temperature Monitor Select 1 (07.038) selects the temperature to be monitored in Monitored Temperature 1 (07.004) using the format given
for Temperature Nearest To Trip Level (07.037). If the monitoring point selected does not exist then the monitored temperature is always zero. The
table below shows the monitoring points that can be selected.

Source xx y zz
Control system 00 0 01: Control board thermistor 1
Control system 00 0 02: Control board thermistor 2
Control system 00 0 03: I/O board thermistor (or internal braking resistor in Servo Drive)
Control system 00 1 00: Inverter thermal model
Control system 00 3 00: Braking IGBT thermal model
Control system 00 4 00: Rectifier thermal model
Power system 01 0 zz: Thermistor location defined by zz in the power system
Power system 01 Rectifier number zz: Thermistor location defined by zz in the rectifier

For a multi-module power system the power system measurement that can be selected is shown in the table below. It should be noted that the specific
power module cannot be selected and that the highest temperature from each of the power modules is given.

Source xx y zz
Power system 01 0 01: U phase power device thermistor
Power system 01 0 02: V phase power device thermistor
Power system 01 0 03: W phase power device thermistor
Power system 01 0 04: General rectifier thermistors
Power system 01 0 05: General power system thermistor

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


224 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 07.039 Temperature Monitor Select 2
Short description Defines the temperature to be monitored in Monitored Temperature 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1999
Default 1002 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Temperature Monitor Select 1 (07.038).

Parameter 07.040 Analog Input 1 Minimum


Short description Defines the minimum value for analog input 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default -100.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See Analog Input 1 (07.001).

Parameter 07.041 Analog Input 2 Minimum


Short description Defines the minimum value for analog input 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default -100.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See Analog Input 1 (07.001).

Parameter 07.042 Analog Input 3 Minimum


Short description Defines the minimum value for analog input 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default -100.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See Analog Input 1 (07.001).

Parameter 07.043 Analog Input 1 Maximum


Short description Defines the maximum value for analog input 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 100.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See Analog Input 1 (07.001).

Parameter 07.044 Analog Input 2 Maximum


Short description Defines the maximum value for analog input 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 100.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See Analog Input 1 (07.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 225
Parameter 07.045 Analog Input 3 Maximum
Short description Defines the maximum value for analog input 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 100.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See Analog Input 1 (07.001).

Parameter 07.046 Analog Input 3 Thermistor Type


Short description Defines the thermistor type for analog input 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 9
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 DIN44082
1 KTY84
2 PT100 (4W)
3 PT1000 (4W)
4 PT2000 (4W)
5 2.0mA (4W)
6 PT100 (2W)
7 PT1000 (2W)
8 PT2000 (2W)
9 2.0mA (2W)

Analog Input 3 Thermistor Type (07.046) defines the operation of the temperature feedback interface for analog input 3 when Analog Input 3 Mode
(07.015) is set up for a temperature feedback mode. When a temperature feedback mode is selected a 2mA current source is connected to analog input
3 to supply the temperature feedback device that is connected to the input.

Analog Input 3 Thermistor Type


Compatible devices
(07.046)
0: DIN44082 Three thermistors in series as specified in DIN44082 standard
1: KTY84 KTY84 PTC thermistor
2: PT100 (4W) PT100 PTC thermistor with 4 wire connection
3: PT1000 (4W) PT1000 PTC thermistor with 4 wire connection
4:PT2000 (4W) PT2000 PTC thermistor with 4 wire connection
Any device. Full scale equivalent to a resistance of 5k Ohms with 4 wire
5: 2.0mA (4W)
connection
6: PT100 (2W) PT100 PTC thermistor with 2 wire connection
7: PT1000 (2W) PT1000 PTC thermistor with 2 wire connection
8: PT2000 (2W) PT2000 PTC thermistor with 2 wire connection
Any device. Full scale equivalent to a resistance of 5k Ohms with 2 wire
9: 2.0mA (2W)
connection

DIN44082 and KTY84 devices should always be connected directly to analog input 3. The other devices can be connected directly to analog input 3 if
the 2 wire connection option is selected. Alternatively these devices can be used with a 4 wire connection to remove the effect of voltage drops due to
the 2mA supply current via the path shown below. If a 4 wire connection is selected analog input 1 is disabled and Analog Input 1 (07.001) always reads
as 0.0%. It should be noted that the input system takes account of the input impedance of analogue input 3 when 2 wire mode is used, and of both
analogue input 1 and analogue input 3 when 4 wire mode is used. For this reason it is important that 2 wire mode is selected when the connection
between Analogue Input 1+ and Analogue input 3 is not present, and that 4 wire mode is selected if the connection is present.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


226 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 07.047 Analog Input 3 Thermistor Feedback
Short description Displays the measured resistance of analog input 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5000
Default Units Ω
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Analog Input 3 Thermistor Feedback (07.047) shows the measured resistance.

Parameter 07.048 Analog Input 3 Thermistor Trip Threshold


Short description Defines the thermistor trip threshold for analog input 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5000
Default 3300 Units Ω
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Over-temperature detection becomes active for input 3 if Analog Input 3 Thermistor Feedback (07.047) > Analog Input 3 Thermistor Trip Threshold
(07.048). Over-temperature becomes inactive for input 3 if Analog Input 3 Thermistor Feedback (07.047) < Analog Input 3 Thermistor Reset Threshold
(07.049). If Analog Input 3 Mode (07.015) is 7 or 8 (i.e. tripping is enabled) a Thermistor.003 trip is initiated. The default values for
Analog Input 3 Thermistor Trip Threshold (07.048) and Analog Input 3 Thermistor Reset Threshold (07.049) are the levels specified in the DIN 44082
standard.

Parameter 07.049 Analog Input 3 Thermistor Reset Threshold


Short description Defines the thermistor reset threshold for analog input 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5000
Default 1800 Units Ω
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Analog Input 3 Thermistor Trip Threshold (07.048).

Parameter 07.050 Analog Input 3 Thermistor Temperature


Displays the temperature of the device based on the resistance to temperature characteristic for the
Short description
specified device
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -50 Maximum 300
Default Units °C
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

If a KTY84, PT100, PT1000 or PT2000 type device is selected for temperature feedback then Analog Input 3 Thermistor Temperature (07.050) shows

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 227
the temperature of the device based on the resistance to temperature characteristic specified for this device. Otherwise
Analog Input 3 Thermistor Temperature (07.050) = 0.0.

Parameter 07.051 Analog Input 1 Full Scale


Short description Displays the full scale value of analog input 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Calibrate Analog Input 1 Full Scale (07.025).

Parameter 07.052 Temperature Monitor Select 3


Short description Defines the temperature to be monitored in Monitored Temperature 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1999
Default 1 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Temperature Monitor Select 1 (07.038).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


228 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 8 Single Line Descriptions − Digital I/O
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


08.001 Digital I/O 01 State Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
08.002 Digital I/O 02 State Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
08.003 Digital I/O 03 State Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
08.004 Digital Input 04 State Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
08.005 Digital Input 05 State Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
08.006 Digital Input 06 State Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
08.007 Relay Output State Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
08.008 24V Supply Output State Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
08.009 STO Input 01 State Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
Disable (0), STO 1 (1), STO 2 (2),
08.010 External Trip Mode Disable (0) RW Txt US
STO 1 OR STO 2 (3)
08.011 Digital I/O 01 Invert Not Invert (0), Invert (1) Not Invert (0) RW Txt US
08.012 Digital I/O 02 Invert Not Invert (0), Invert (1) Not Invert (0) RW Txt US
08.013 Digital I/O 03 Invert Not Invert (0), Invert (1) Not Invert (0) RW Txt US
08.014 Digital Input 04 Invert Not Invert (0), Invert (1) Not Invert (0) RW Txt US
08.015 Digital Input 05 Invert Not Invert (0), Invert (1) Not Invert (0) RW Txt US
08.016 Digital Input 06 Invert Not Invert (0), Invert (1) Not Invert (0) RW Txt US
08.017 Relay Invert Not Invert (0), Invert (1) Not Invert (0) RW Txt US
08.018 24V Supply Output Invert Not Invert (0), Invert (1) Invert (1) RW Txt US
08.020 Digital I/O Read Word 0 to 511 RO Num ND NC PT
08.021 Digital I/O 01 Source/Destination 0.000 to 59.999 10.003 RW Num DE PT US
08.022 Digital I/O 02 Source/Destination 0.000 to 59.999 10.033 RW Num DE PT US
08.023 Digital I/O 03 Source/Destination 0.000 to 59.999 6.030 RW Num DE PT US
08.024 Digital Input 04 Destination 0.000 to 59.999 6.032 RW Num DE PT US
08.025 Digital Input 05 Destination 0.000 to 59.999 1.041 RW Num DE PT US
08.026 Digital Input 06 Destination 0.000 to 59.999 6.031 RW Num DE PT US
08.027 Relay Output Source 0.000 to 59.999 10.001 RW Num PT US
08.028 24V Supply Output Source 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
08.029 Input Logic Polarity Negative Logic (0), Positive Logic (1) Positive Logic (1) RW Txt US
08.031 Digital I/O 01 Output Select Off (0) or On (1) On (1) RW Bit US
08.032 Digital I/O 02 Output Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
08.033 Digital I/O 03 Output Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
08.040 STO Input 02 State Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
08.041 Keypad Run Button State Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
08.042 Keypad Auxiliary Button State Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
08.043 24V Supply Input State Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
08.044 Keypad Stop Button State Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
08.051 Keypad Run Button Invert/Toggle Not Invert (0), Invert (1), Toggle (2) Not Invert (0) RW Txt US
08.052 Keypad Auxiliary Button Invert/Toggle Not Invert (0), Invert (1), Toggle (2) Not Invert (0) RW Txt US
08.053 24V Supply Input Invert Not Invert (0), Invert (1) Not Invert (0) RW Txt US
08.061 Keypad Run Button Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
08.062 Keypad Auxiliary Button Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
08.063 24V Supply Input Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
08.071 Digital I/O Output Enable Register 1 0000000000000000 to 1111111111111111 0000000000000000 RW Bin PT US
08.072 Digital I/O Input Register 1 0000000000000000 to 1111111111111111 RO Bin ND NC PT
08.073 Digital I/O Output Register 1 0000000000000000 to 1111111111111111 0000000000000000 RW Bin PT

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 229
Menu 8 − Digital I/O
Mode: RFC‑A

Digital I/O Interface


The normal sample rate for the digital I/O system is 2ms, however it is possible to obtain a faster update rate for some parameters with certain inputs as
described below. (Note that the keypad buttons and the rest button are always updated at the background rate and cannot be used for fast updating.)

Direction, read and write register parameters


Digital I/O Output Enable Register 1 (08.071), Digital I/O Input Register 1 (08.072) and Digital I/O Output Register 1 (08.073) provide direct access to
read/control the digital I/O that is integral to the drive.

Limit Switches
If digital inputs 4 or 5 are routed to either the Forward Limit Switch (06.035) or Reverse Limit Switch (06.036) in RFC-A or RFC-S modes the update rate
is 250us.

Parameters
The parameter structure for each digital I/O is shown in the diagram below.

The table below covers all the possible digital I/O parameters. See Internal I/O Identifier (11.068) for details of which I/O is present for different I/O
options.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


230 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
DI/O Function State Invert/Toggle Source/Destination Output Select
1 Input/Output 08.001 08.011 08.021 08.031
2 Input/Output 08.002 08.012 08.022 08.032
3 Input/Output 08.003 08.013 08.023 08.033
4 Input 08.004 08.014 08.024
5 Input 08.005 08.015 08.025
6 Input 08.006 08.016 08.026
7 Relay Output 08.007 08.017 08.027
8 24V Supply Output 08.008 08.018 08.028
9 Safe Torque Off 1 08.009
10 Safe Torque Off 2 08.040
11 Keypad Run Button 08.041 08.051 08.061
12 Keypad Auxiliary Button 08.042 08.052 08.062
13 24V Supply Input 08.043 08.053 08.063
14 Keypad Stop Button 08.044
15 Relay 2 Output 08.045 08.055 08.065
16 Drive Reset button 08.046

Parameter 08.001 Digital I/O 01 State


Short description Displays the state for digital input/output1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

The Digtial I/O State parameter shows the state of digital I/O on the drive. All I/O except Digital Input 11 (Keypad Run Button), Digital Input 12
(Keypad Auxiliary Button), Digital Input 13 (24V Supply Input) and Digital Input 14 (Keypad Stop Button) use IEC61131-2 logic levels. As default the
inputs use positive logic, and so the state parameter is 0 if the digital I/O is low or 1 if the digital I/O is high. Input Logic Polarity (08.029) can be set to
zero to change the logic for Digital I/O1-6 to negative logic, so that the state parameter is 0 if the digital I/O is high or 1 if the digital I/O is low. The state
parameter represents the digital I/O state whether it is an input or an output. If the digital I/O is configured as an output to be controlled using
the Digital I/O Output Register 1 (08.073) then the state parameter will still show the state of the output even though the route source is zero and the
invert parameter has no effect.

Digital Input 11 (Keypad Run Button), Digital Input 12 (Keypad Auxiliary Button) and Digital Input 14 (Keypad Stop Button) represent the state of the
Run, Auxiliary and Stop buttons on any keypad fitted to the drive; the input state is determined by ORing the state of the button on each keypad
connected to the drive, if the button is pressed the state parameter is one otherwise it is zero. If a keypad is not fitted the state parameters are zero.

Digital Input 13 (24V Supply Input) is an external 24V supply input that is monitored and can be used as a 24V digital input if an external 24V supply is
not required. The state parameter is low for the voltage range from 0V to 17V and high for the voltage range above 18V. As the input is a power supply
it will consume significant current if the level is taken above 24V when the drive is running from its internal power supply, or at any voltage level if this
input is the only power supply to the drive.

Digital Input 09 (STO input 1) and Digital Input 10 (STO input 2) correspond to two safe torque off channels within the drive. Both channels must be in
the high state for the drive to be enabled. The state parameters are 0 if the digital input is low, or 1 if the digital input is high. If option slot 3 does not
contain an option module providing safety functions then both safe torque off channels are connected to their state parameters and the safe torque off
input can enable/disable the drive. If an option module providing safety functions is fitted in option slot 3 then the option module can disable the drive by
breaking the path of either one or both safe torque off channels. See Menu 6 for details of the drive enable system.

Parameter 08.002 Digital I/O 02 State


Short description Displays the state for digital input/output 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Digital I/O 01 State (08.001).

Parameter 08.003 Digital I/O 03 State


Short description Displays the state for digital input/output 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 231
See Digital I/O 01 State (08.001).

Parameter 08.004 Digital Input 04 State


Short description Displays the state for digital input 4
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Digital I/O 01 State (08.001).

Parameter 08.005 Digital Input 05 State


Short description Displays the state for digital input 5
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Digital I/O 01 State (08.001).

Parameter 08.006 Digital Input 06 State


Short description Displays the state for digital input 6
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Digital I/O 01 State (08.001).

Parameter 08.007 Relay Output State


Short description Displays the state for relay output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Digital I/O 01 State (08.001).

Parameter 08.008 24V Supply Output State


Short description Displays the state for 24V supply output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Digital I/O 01 State (08.001).

Parameter 08.009 STO Input 01 State


Short description Displays the state for Safe Torque Off 1 input
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Digital I/O 01 State (08.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


232 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 08.010 External Trip Mode
Short description Defines behaviour of drive if STOs are low
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Disable
1 STO 1
2 STO 2
3 STO 1 OR STO 2

If External Trip Mode  (08.010) = 0 the safe torque off inputs simply enable or disable the drive. If External Trip Mode (08.010) > 0 it is possible to
enable the following trip functions.

External Trip Mode


Actions
(08.010)
0 Safe torque off inputs do not initiate trips
External Trip.001 if Safe Torque Off Input 1 is
1
low
External Trip.002 if Safe Torque Off Input 2 is
2
low

External Trip.001 if Safe Torque Off is low


OR
3
External Trip.002 if Safe Torque Off Input 2 is
low

Parameter 08.011 Digital I/O 01 Invert


Short description Set to invert Digital I/O 01
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Not Invert
1 Invert

A value of 0 or 1 allows the digital I/O to be non-inverted or inverted respectively.

Parameter 08.012 Digital I/O 02 Invert


Short description Set to invert Digital I/O 02
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Not Invert
1 Invert

See Digital I/O 01 Invert (08.011).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 233
Parameter 08.013 Digital I/O 03 Invert
Short description Set to invert Digital I/O 03
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Not Invert
1 Invert

See Digital I/O 01 Invert (08.011).

Parameter 08.014 Digital Input 04 Invert


Short description Set to invert Digital Input 04
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Not Invert
1 Invert

See Digital I/O 01 Invert (08.011).

Parameter 08.015 Digital Input 05 Invert


Short description Set to invert Digital Input 05
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Not Invert
1 Invert

See Digital I/O 01 Invert (08.011).

Parameter 08.016 Digital Input 06 Invert


Short description Set to invert Digital Input 06
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Not Invert
1 Invert

See Digital I/O 01 Invert (08.011).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


234 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 08.017 Relay Invert
Short description Set to invert the Relay Output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Not Invert
1 Invert

See Digital I/O 01 Invert (08.011).

Parameter 08.018 24V Supply Output Invert


Short description Set to invert 24V Supply Output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Not Invert
1 Invert

See Digital I/O 01 Invert (08.011).

Parameter 08.020 Digital I/O Read Word


Short description Displays the states for digital I/O 1 to 8
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 511
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Digital I/O Read Word (08.020) reflects the state of digital input/output 1 to STO input 1 as given below. Each bit matches the value of the state
parameter for the respective digital input or output.

Digital I/O Read Word (08.020) bit Digital I/O


0 Digital I/O 1
1 Digital I/O 2
2 Digital I/O 3
3 Digital Input 4
4 Digital Input 5
5 Digital Input 6
6 Relay
7 24V Output
8 STO Input 1

Parameter 08.021 Digital I/O 01 Source/Destination


Short description Defines the source or destination parameter for Digital I/O 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 10.003 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive Reset Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

The Digital I/O Source/Destination parameters provide the routing for the source and/or destination for the digital I/O.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 235
Parameter 08.022 Digital I/O 02 Source/Destination
Short description Defines the source or destination parameter for Digital I/O 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 10.033 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive Reset Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See Digital I/O 01 Source/Destination (08.021).

Parameter 08.023 Digital I/O 03 Source/Destination


Short description Defines the source or destination parameter for Digital I/O 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 6.030 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive Reset Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See Digital I/O 01 Source/Destination (08.021).

Parameter 08.024 Digital Input 04 Destination


Short description Defines the destination parameter for Digital Input 4
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 6.032 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive Reset Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See Digital I/O 01 Source/Destination (08.021).

Parameter 08.025 Digital Input 05 Destination


Short description Defines the destination parameter for Digital Input 5
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 1.041 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive Reset Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See Digital I/O 01 Source/Destination (08.021).

Parameter 08.026 Digital Input 06 Destination


Short description Defines the destination parameter for Digital Input 6
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 6.031 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive Reset Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See Digital I/O 01 Source/Destination (08.021).

Parameter 08.027 Relay Output Source


Short description Defines the source parameter for the Relay Output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 10.001 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive Reset Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Digital I/O 01 Source/Destination (08.021).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


236 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 08.028 24V Supply Output Source
Short description Defines the source parameter for 24V Supply Output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive Reset Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Digital I/O 01 Source/Destination (08.021).

Parameter 08.029 Input Logic Polarity


Short description Defines the polarity of the input logic
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text
0 Negative Logic
1 Positive Logic

See Digital I/O 01 State (08.001).

Parameter 08.031 Digital I/O 01 Output Select


Short description Defines if Digital I/O 1 is an input or output. 0 = input, 1 = output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

The Digital I/O Output Select parameters allow the I/O to be selected as an input (0) or an output (1). These parameters are only present for digital I/O
that can be used as an input or output.

Parameter 08.032 Digital I/O 02 Output Select


Short description Defines if Digital I/O 2 is an input or output. 0 = input, 1 = output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Digital I/O 01 Output Select (08.031).

Parameter 08.033 Digital I/O 03 Output Select


Short description Defines if Digital I/O 3 is an input or output. 0 = input, 1 = output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Digital I/O 01 Output Select (08.031).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 237
Parameter 08.040 STO Input 02 State
Short description Displays the state for the Safe Torque Off 2 input
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Digital I/O 01 State (08.001).

Parameter 08.041 Keypad Run Button State


Short description Displays the state for the Keypad Run Forward button
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Digital I/O 01 State (08.001).

Parameter 08.042 Keypad Auxiliary Button State


Short description Displays the state for the Keypad Auxiliary button
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Digital I/O 01 State (08.001).

Parameter 08.043 24V Supply Input State


Short description Displays the state for the 24V Supply Input
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Digital I/O 01 State (08.001).

Parameter 08.044 Keypad Stop Button State


Short description Displays the state for the Keypad Stop button
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Digital I/O 01 State (08.001).

Parameter 08.051 Keypad Run Button Invert/Toggle


Short description Set to invert/toggle Keypad Run Button
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


238 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Value Text
0 Not Invert
1 Invert
2 Toggle

A value of 0 or 1 allows the input state to be non-inverted or inverted respectively. An additional toggle function is provided for Keypad Run button
inputs. The toggle function output changes state on each rising edge (0 to 1 change) at its input.

Parameter 08.052 Keypad Auxiliary Button Invert/Toggle


Short description Set to invert/toggle Keypad Auxiliary Button
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Not Invert
1 Invert
2 Toggle

A value of 0 or 1 allows the input state to be non-inverted or inverted respectively. An additional toggle function is provided for Keypad Auxiliary button
inputs. The toggle function output changes state on each rising edge (0 to 1 change) at its input.

Parameter 08.053 24V Supply Input Invert


Short description Set to invert/toggle 24V Supply Input
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Not Invert
1 Invert

See Digital I/O 01 Source/Destination (08.021).

Parameter 08.061 Keypad Run Button Destination


Short description Defines the destination parameter for the keypad run button
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive Reset Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See Digital I/O 01 Source/Destination (08.021).

Parameter 08.062 Keypad Auxiliary Button Destination


Short description Defines the destination parameter for the keypad auxiliary button
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive Reset Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See Digital I/O 01 Source/Destination (08.021).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 239
Parameter 08.063 24V Supply Input Destination
Short description Defines the destination parameter for the 24V input
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive Reset Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See Digital I/O 01 Source/Destination (08.021).

Parameter 08.071 Digital I/O Output Enable Register 1


Short description Displays the binary form of the DI/O output enable register
Mode RFC‑A
0 65535
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0000000000000000) (Display: 1111111111111111)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0000000000000000)
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

The bits in the Digital I/O Output Enable Register 1 (08.071), Digital I/O Input Register 1 (08.072) and Digital I/O Output Register 1 (08.073) each
correspond with one digital I/O as shown below. The update rate of the individual bits in these registers differs depending upon the I/O.

Bit update rate


DI/O Bit Function
Input Register Output Register Output Enable Register
1 0 Digital Input/Output 2ms 250μs Background
2 1 Digital Input/Output 2ms 250μs Background
3 2 Digital Input/Output 2ms 2ms Background
4 3 Digital Input 250μs Not applicable Not applicable
5 4 Digital Input 250μs Not applicable Not applicable
6 5 Digital Input 2ms Not applicable Not applicable
7 6 Relay Output Bit always 0 2ms Background
8 7 24V Supply Output Bit always 0 2ms Background
9 8 Safe Torque Off 1 2ms Not applicable Not applicable
10 9 Safe Torque Off 2 2ms Not applicable Not applicable
11 10 Keypad Run Button Background Not applicable Not applicable
12 11 Keypad Auxiliary Button Background Not applicable Not applicable
13 12 24V Supply Input 2ms Not applicable Not applicable
14 13 Keypad Stop Button Background Not applicable Not applicable
15 14 Relay 2 Output Bit always 0 2ms Background
16 15 Drive Reset Button Background Not applicable Not applicable

The Digital I/O Input Register 1 (08.072) is always active and shows the value in the Digital I/O State parameter for all digital I/O configured as inputs.
Bits in the Digital I/O Output Register 1 (08.073) can be used to control the digital I/O directly. The bits control the output directly and are not modified by
the corresponding Digital I/O Invert/Toggle function. The bits in the Digital I/O Output Register 1 (08.073) only control the corresponding digital output if
all the conditions below are met:

1. The corresponding bit in the Digital I/O Output Enable Register 1 (08.071) must be set to 1.


2. The digital I/O must be an output, or it must be an input/output and the corresponding Digital I/O Output Select parameter must be one.
3. The corresponding Digital I/O Source/Destination parameter is not a valid source (e.g. 0.000) and the drive has been powered-up or reset since
it was first selected.

If the above conditions are not met, the digital output is controlled by the normal logic.

Parameter 08.072 Digital I/O Input Register 1


Short description Displays the binary form of the DI/O input register
Mode RFC‑A
0 65535
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0000000000000000) (Display: 1111111111111111)
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Digital I/O Output Enable Register 1 (08.071).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


240 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 08.073 Digital I/O Output Register 1
Short description Displays the binary form of the DI/O output register
Mode RFC‑A
0 65535
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0000000000000000) (Display: 1111111111111111)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0000000000000000)
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs read
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Digital I/O Output Enable Register 1 (08.071).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 241
Menu 9 Single Line Descriptions − User Functions 1
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


242 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter Range Default Type
09.001 Logic Function 1 Output Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
09.002 Logic Function 2 Output Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
09.003 Motorised Pot Output ±100.00 % RO Num ND NC PT PS
09.004 Logic Function 1 Source 1 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
09.005 Logic Function 1 Source 1 Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
09.006 Logic Function 1 Source 2 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
09.007 Logic Function 1 Source 2 Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
09.008 Logic Function 1 Output Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
09.009 Logic Function 1 Delay ±25.0 s 0.0 s RW Num US
09.010 Logic Function 1 Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
09.014 Logic Function 2 Source 1 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
09.015 Logic Function 2 Source 1 Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
09.016 Logic Function 2 Source 2 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
09.017 Logic Function 2 Source 2 Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
09.018 Logic Function 2 Output Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
09.019 Logic Function 2 Delay ±25.0 s 0.0 s RW Num US
09.020 Logic Function 2 Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
09.021 Motorised Pot Mode 0 to 4 0 RW Num US
09.022 Motorised Pot Bipolar Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
09.023 Motorised Pot Rate 0 to 250 s 20 s RW Num US
09.024 Motorised Pot Scaling 0.000 to 4.000 1.000 RW Num US
09.025 Motorised Pot Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
09.026 Motorised Pot Up Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
09.027 Motorised Pot Down Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
09.028 Motorised Pot Reset Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
09.029 Binary Sum Ones Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
09.030 Binary Sum Twos Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
09.031 Binary Sum Fours Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
09.032 Binary Sum Output 0 to 255 RO Num ND NC PT
09.033 Binary Sum Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
09.034 Binary Sum Offset 0 to 248 0 RW Num US
09.035 Timer 1 Start Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 00-00-00 RW Date US
09.036 Timer 1 Start Time 00:00:00 to 23:59:59 00:00:00 RW Time US
09.037 Timer 1 Stop Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 00-00-00 RW Date US
09.038 Timer 1 Stop Time 00:00:00 to 23:59:59 00:00:00 RW Time US
None (0), Hour (1), Day (2),
09.039 Timer 1 Repeat Function Week (3), Month (4), Year (5), None (0) RW Txt US
One off (6), Minute (7)
09.040 Timer 1 Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
09.041 Timer 1 Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
09.042 Timer 1 Output Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
09.043 Timer 1 Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
09.045 Timer 2 Start Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 00-00-00 RW Date US
09.046 Timer 2 Start Time 00:00:00 to 23:59:59 00:00:00 RW Time US
09.047 Timer 2 Stop Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 00-00-00 RW Date US
09.048 Timer 2 Stop Time 00:00:00 to 23:59:59 00:00:00 RW Time US
None (0), Hour (1), Day (2),
09.049 Timer 2 Repeat Function Week (3), Month (4), Year (5), None (0) RW Txt US
One off (6), Minute (7)
09.050 Timer 2 Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
09.051 Timer 2 Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
09.052 Timer 2 Output Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
09.053 Timer 2 Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
09.055 Scope Trace 1 Source 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
09.056 Scope Trace 2 Source 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
09.057 Scope Trace 3 Source 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
09.058 Scope Trace 4 Source 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
09.059 Scope Trigger Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit
09.060 Scope Trigger Source 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
09.061 Scope Trigger Threshold -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num US
09.062 Scope Trigger Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
09.063 Scope Mode Single (0), Normal (1), Auto (2) Single (0) RW Txt US
09.064 Scope Arm Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
09.065 Scope Data Not Ready Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 243
09.066 Scope Saving Data Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
09.067 Scope Sample Time 1 to 200 1 RW Num US
09.068 Scope Trigger Delay 0 to 100 % 0% RW Num US
09.069 Scope Time Period 0.00 to 200000.00 ms RO Num ND NC PT
09.070 Scope Auto‑save Mode Disabled (0), Overwrite (1), Keep (2) Disabled (0) RW Txt US
09.071 Scope Auto‑save File Number 0 to 99 0 RO Num NC PS
09.072 Scope Auto‑save Reset Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit
Disabled (0), Active (1), Stopped (2),
09.073 Scope Auto‑save Status Disabled (0) RO Txt NC PS
Failed (3)

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


244 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 9 − User Functions 1
Mode: RFC‑A

Menu 9 provides the parameters for the following features:

1. Logic functions
2. Motorised Pot
3. Binary Sum
4. Timers
5. Scope function

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 245
Logic functions

The logic functions are always active even if the sources and destinations are not routed to valid parameters. If the sources are not valid parameters
then the source values are taken as 0. The update rate for each of the logic functions is always 4ms.

The logic function consists of an AND gate with inverters on each input and an inverter on the output. Some of the other standard logic functions can be
produced as shown in the table below.

Logic function Source 1 Invert Source 2 Invert Output Invert


AND 0 0 0
NAND 0 0 1
OR 1 1 1
NOR 1 1 0

A delay function is provided at the output of the logic functions. If Logic Function 1 Delay (09.009) or Logic Function 2 Delay (09.019) is positive then the
output does not become 1 until the input to the delay has been at 1 for the delay time. If Logic Function 1 Delay (09.009) or Logic Function 2 Delay
(09.019) is negative then the output remains at 1 until the input to the delay has been 0 for the delay time.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


246 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide
Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 247
Motorised pot

If Motorised Pot Reset (09.028) = 1 then the motorised pot is disabled and held in its reset state with Motorised Pot Output (09.003) = 0.0%. If
Motorised Pot Reset (09.028) = 0 the motorised pot is enabled even if Motorised Pot Destination (09.025) is not routed to a valid parameter. The
sample rate of the motorised pot is always 4ms.

When the motorised pot is active Motorised Pot Output (09.003) can be increased or decreased by setting Motorised Pot Up (09.026) or
Motorised Pot Down (09.027) to 1 respectively. If both Motorised Pot Up (09.026) and Motorised Pot Down (09.027) are 1 then Motorised Pot Output
(09.003) is increased. The rate of change of Motorised Pot Output (09.003) is defined by Motorised Pot Rate (09.023) which gives the time to change
from 0 to 100%. The time to change from -100% to 100% is Motorised Pot Rate (09.023) x 2. If Motorised Pot Bipolar Select (09.022) = 0 then
Motorised Pot Output (09.003) is limited in the range 0.00% to 100.00%, otherwise it is allowed to change in the range from -100.00% to 100.00%.

Motorised Pot Mode (09.021) defines the mode of operation as given in the table below.

Motorised Pot Mode Motorised Pot Up (09.026) and


Motorised Pot Output (09.003)
(09.021) Motorised Pot Down (09.027) active
0 Reset to zero at power-up Always
1 Set to power-down value at power-up Always
2 Reset to zero at power-up When Drive Active (10.002) = 1
3 Set to power-down value at power-up When Drive Active (10.002) = 1
Reset to zero at power-up and when
4 When Drive Active (10.002) = 1
Drive Active (10.002) = 0

Motorised Pot Scaling (09.024) introduces a scaling factor at the output of the motorised pot before the output is routed to the destination. If
Motorised Pot Scaling (09.024) > 1.000 the output will exceed the range of the destination parameter, and so the destination parameter will be at its
maximum or minimum before the output of the motorised pot reaches the limits of its range.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


248 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Binary sum function

The binary sum function is always active even if the destination is not routed to valid a parameter. The update rate for the binary sum is always 4ms.

The output of the binary sum block is given by:

Binary Sum Output (09.032) = Binary Sum Offset (09.034) + (Binary Sum Ones (09.029) x 1) + (Binary Sum Twos (09.030) x 2) +


(Binary Sum Fours (09.031) x 4)

Binary Sum Destination (09.033) defines the destination for the binary sum output. The routing for this destination is special if the maximum of the
destination parameter ≤ 7 + Binary Sum Offset (09.034) as follows:

Destination parameter = Binary Sum Output (09.032), subject to the parameter minimum.

If the maximum of the destination parameter > 7, Binary Sum Output (09.032) is routed in the same way as any other destination where the destination
target is at its full scale value when the Binary Sum Output (09.032) = 7 + Binary Sum Offset (09.034).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 249
Timers

If the enable input to a timer is active and the repeat function is set to a non-zero value then the timer is active even if the destination is not routed to a
valid parameter. The timers are updated in the background task and have a resolution of 1s.

The following is a description of Timer 1, but Timer 2 behaves in the same way. If Timer 1 Invert (09.041) = 0 then Timer 1 Output (09.042) is inactive
before the Timer 1 Start Date (09.035) / Timer 1 Start Time (09.036), active between this date/time and Timer 1 Stop Date (09.037) / Timer 1 Stop Time
(09.038) and then inactive after the stop time/date within the timer 1 repeat period as shown in the diagram below.

Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) defines the length of the repeat period. For example, if Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) = 2 then the repeat period
is one day. The output is inactive until the time reaches the hour, minute and second defined in Timer 1 Start Time (09.036), and remains active until the
time reaches the hour, minute and second defined in Timer 1 Stop Time (09.038). Different repeat periods may be selected as given in the table below.
The table shows the constituent parts of the date and time that are used to determine the start and stop events. If the repeat period is set to every week
then Timer 1 Start Date (09.035) and Timer 1 Stop Date (09.037) define the day of the week and not the date (i.e. 00.00.00 = Sunday, 00.00.01 =
Monday, etc.). The week repeat period starts at 00.00.00 on sunday morning and ends at 23.59.59 on Saturday night. If the stop time event is set to
occur at or before the start time event or the Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) = 0 or Timer 1 Enable (09.040) = 0 the output remains inactive at all
times (i.e. Timer 1 Output (09.042) = 0 if Timer 1 Invert (09.041) = 0).

Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) Repeat period Second Minute Hour Day Month Year Day of week
0 None
1 Hour • •
2 Day • • •
3 Week • • • •
4 Month • • • •
5 Year • • • • •
6 One off • • • • • •
7 Minute •

As Timer 1 Invert (09.041) inverts the timer output it can be used to give an active state of 0 instead of 1. Alternatively it can be used to give an active
state of 1, but for a time period that spans the ends of the repeat period as shown in the example above. It should be noted that if this method is used to
allow the active period to span the ends of the repeat period then if the timer is disabled the output of the timer block before the invert becomes 0, and
so the final output of the timer after the invert is 1.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


250 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
If Date/Time Selector  (06.019) is changed and the drive is reset then the source for the timers will change, therefore Timer 1 Repeat Function
(09.039) and Timer 2 Repeat Function (09.049) are reset to 0 to disable the timers, and the date and time entries in the trip log are cleared.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 251
Scope function

Parameter 09.001 Logic Function 1 Output


Short description Shows the output state of logic function 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Logic Function 1 Output (09.001) shows the output of logic function 1.

Parameter 09.002 Logic Function 2 Output


Short description Shows the output state of logic function 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Logic Function 2 Output (09.002) shows the output of logic function 2.

Parameter 09.003 Motorised Pot Output


Short description Shows the output level of the motorised pot function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Motorised Pot Output (09.003) shows the output of the motorised pot function.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


252 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 09.004 Logic Function 1 Source 1
Short description Defines input source 1 of logic function 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

Logic Function 1 Source 1 (09.004) defines input source 1 of logic function 1.

Parameter 09.005 Logic Function 1 Source 1 Invert


Short description Set to invert input 1 of logic function 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Setting Logic Function 1 Source 1 Invert (09.005) inverts input 1 of logic function 1.

Parameter 09.006 Logic Function 1 Source 2


Short description Defines input source 2 of logic function 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

Logic Function 1 Source 2 (09.006) defines input source 2 of logic function 1.

Parameter 09.007 Logic Function 1 Source 2 Invert


Short description Set to invert input 2 of logic function 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Setting Logic Function 1 Source 2 Invert (09.007) inverts input 2 of logic function 1.

Parameter 09.008 Logic Function 1 Output Invert


Short description Set to invert the output of logic function 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Setting Logic Function 1 Output Invert (09.008) inverts the output of logic function 1.

Parameter 09.009 Logic Function 1 Delay


Short description Defines the output delay of logic function 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -25.0 Maximum 25.0
Default 0.0 Units s
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

Logic Function 1 Delay (09.009) defines the delay at the output of logic function 1. If Logic Function 1 Delay (09.009) is positive then the output does not
become 1 until the input to the delay has been at 1 for the delay time. If Logic Function 1 Delay (09.009) is negative then the output remains at 1 until
the input to the delay has been 0 for the delay time.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 253
Parameter 09.010 Logic Function 1 Destination
Short description Defines the output destination of logic function 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

Logic Function 1 Destination (09.010) defines the output destination of logic function 1.

Parameter 09.014 Logic Function 2 Source 1


Short description Defines input source 1 of logic function 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

Logic Function 2 Source 1 (09.014) defines input source 1 of logic function 2.

Parameter 09.015 Logic Function 2 Source 1 Invert


Short description Set to invert input 1 of logic function 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Setting Logic Function 2 Source 1 Invert (09.015) inverts input 1 of logic function 2.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


254 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 09.016 Logic Function 2 Source 2
Short description Defines input source 2 of logic function 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

Logic Function 2 Source 2 (09.016) defines input source 2 of logic function 2.

Parameter 09.017 Logic Function 2 Source 2 Invert


Short description Set to invert input 2 of logic function 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Setting Logic Function 2 Source 2 Invert (09.017) inverts input 2 of logic function 2.

Parameter 09.018 Logic Function 2 Output Invert


Short description Set to invert the output of logic function 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Setting Logic Function 2 Output Invert (09.018) inverts the output of logic function 2.

Parameter 09.019 Logic Function 2 Delay


Short description Defines the output delay of logic function 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -25.0 Maximum 25.0
Default 0.0 Units s
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

Logic Function 2 Delay (09.019) defines the delay at the output of logic function 1. If Logic Function 2 Delay (09.019) is positive then the output does not
become 1 until the input to the delay has been at 1 for the delay time. If Logic Function 2 Delay (09.019) is negative then the output remains at 1 until
the input to the delay has been 0 for the delay time.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 255
Parameter 09.020 Logic Function 2 Destination
Short description Defines the output destination of logic function 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

Logic Function 2 Destination (09.020) defines the output destination of logic function 2.

Parameter 09.021 Motorised Pot Mode


Short description Defines the motorised pot mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Motorised Pot Mode (09.021) defines the mode of operation as given in the table below.

Motorised Pot Mode Motorised Pot Up (09.026) and


Motorised Pot Output (09.003)
(09.021) Motorised Pot Down (09.027) active
0 Reset to zero at power-up Always
1 Set to power-down value at power-up Always
2 Reset to zero at power-up When Drive Active (10.002) = 1
3 Set to power-down value at power-up When Drive Active (10.002) = 1
Reset to zero at power-up and when
4 When Drive Active (10.002) = 1
Drive Active (10.002) = 0

Parameter 09.022 Motorised Pot Bipolar Select


Short description Set to enable bipolar operation of the motorised pot
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If Motorised Pot Bipolar Select (09.022) = 0 then Motorised Pot Output (09.003) is limited in the range 0.00% to 100.00%, otherwise it is allowed to

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


256 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
change in the range from -100.00% to 100.00%.

Parameter 09.023 Motorised Pot Rate


Short description Defines the rate of change of the motorised pot output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 250
Default 20 Units s
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

The rate of change of Motorised Pot Output (09.003) is defined by Motorised Pot Rate (09.023) which gives the time to change from 0 to 100%. The
time to change from -100% to 100% is Motorised Pot Rate (09.023) x 2.

Parameter 09.024 Motorised Pot Scaling


Short description Defines the scaling factor for the motorised pot output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

Motorised Pot Scaling (09.024) introduces a scaling factor at the output of the motorised pot before the output is routed to the destination.
If Motorised Pot Scaling (09.024) > 1.000 the output will exceed the range of the destination parameter, and so the destination parameter will be at its
maximum or minimum before the output of the motorised pot reaches the limits of its range.

Parameter 09.025 Motorised Pot Destination


Short description Defines the output destination of the motorised pot
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

Motorised Pot Destination (09.025) defines the output destination of the motorised pot function.

Parameter 09.026 Motorised Pot Up


Short description Set to increase the motorised pot output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If Motorised Pot Up (09.026) = 1, then the Motorised Pot Output (09.003) will increase.

Parameter 09.027 Motorised Pot Down


Short description Set to decrease the motorised pot output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If Motorised Pot Down (09.027) = 1, then the Motorised Pot Output (09.003) will decrease.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 257
Parameter 09.028 Motorised Pot Reset
Short description Set to reset the motorised pot output to zero
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If Motorised Pot Reset (09.028) = 1 then the motorised pot is disabled and held in its reset state with Motorised Pot Output (09.003) = 0.0%. If
Motorised Pot Reset (09.028) = 0 the motorised pot is enabled even if Motorised Pot Destination (09.025) is not routed to a valid parameter.

Parameter 09.029 Binary Sum Ones


Short description Set to add one to the binary sum output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Binary Sum Output (09.032).

Parameter 09.030 Binary Sum Twos


Short description Set to add two to the binary sum output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Binary Sum Output (09.032).

Parameter 09.031 Binary Sum Fours


Short description Set to add four to the binary sum output
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Binary Sum Output (09.032).

Parameter 09.032 Binary Sum Output


Short description Shows the output level of the binary sum
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

The output of the binary sum block is given by:

Binary Sum Output (09.032) = Binary Sum Offset (09.034) + (Binary Sum Ones (09.029) x 1) + (Binary Sum Twos (09.030) x 2) +


(Binary Sum Fours (09.031) x 4)

Binary Sum Destination (09.033) defines the destination for the binary sum output. The routing for this destination is special if the maximum of the
destination parameter ≤ 7 + Binary Sum Offset (09.034) as follows:

Destination parameter = Binary Sum Output (09.032), subject to the parameter minimum.

If the maximum of the destination parameter > 7, Binary Sum Output (09.032) is routed in the same way as any other destination where the destination
target is at its full scale value when the Binary Sum Output (09.032) = 7 + Binary Sum Offset (09.034).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


258 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 09.033 Binary Sum Destination
Short description Defines the output destination of the binary sum
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

Binary Sum Destination (09.033) defines the destination for the binary sum output.

See Binary Sum Output (09.032) for more information.

Parameter 09.034 Binary Sum Offset


Short description Defines the offset added to the output of the binary sum
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 248
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

See Binary Sum Output (09.032).

Parameter 09.035 Timer 1 Start Date


Short description Defines the start date for timer 1
Mode RFC‑A
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
0
Default Units
(Display: 00-00-00)
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Timer 1 Start Date (09.035) defines the start date within the repeat period of timer 1.

See Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) for more information.

Parameter 09.036 Timer 1 Start Time


Short description Defines the start time for timer 1
Mode RFC‑A
0 235959
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00) (Display: 23:59:59)
0
Default Units
(Display: 00:00:00)
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Time Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Timer 1 Start Time (09.036) defines the start time within the repeat period of timer 1.

See Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) for more information.

Parameter 09.037 Timer 1 Stop Date


Short description Defines the stop date for timer 1
Mode RFC‑A
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
0
Default Units
(Display: 00-00-00)
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Timer 1 Stop Date (09.037) defines the stop date within the repeat period of timer 1.

See Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) for more information.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 259
Parameter 09.038 Timer 1 Stop Time
Short description Defines the stop time for timer 1
Mode RFC‑A
0 235959
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00) (Display: 23:59:59)
0
Default Units
(Display: 00:00:00)
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Time Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Timer 1 Stop Time (09.038) defines the stop time within the repeat period of timer 1.

See Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) for more information.

Parameter 09.039 Timer 1 Repeat Function


Short description Defines the length of the repeat period
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 7
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 None
1 Hour
2 Day
3 Week
4 Month
5 Year
6 One off
7 Minute

Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) defines the length of the repeat period. For example, if Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) = 2 then the repeat period
is one day. The result is inactive until the time reaches the hour, minute and second defined in Timer 1 Start Time (09.036), and remains active until the
time reaches the hour, minute and second defined in Timer 1 Stop Time (09.038). Different repeat periods may be selected as given in the table below.
The table shows the constituent parts of the date and time that are used to determine the start and stop events. If the repeat period is set to every week
then Timer 1 Start Date (09.035) and Timer 1 Stop Date (09.037) define the day of the week and not the date (i.e. 00.00.00 = Sunday, 00.00.01 =
Monday, etc.). If the stop time event is set to occur at or before the start time event or the Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) = 0 or Timer 1 Enable
(09.040) = 0 the result remains inactive at all times (i.e. Timer 1 Output (09.042) = 0 if Timer 1 Invert (09.041) = 0).

Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) Repeat period Second Minute Hour Day Month Year Day of week
0 None
1 Hour • •
2 Day • • •
3 Week • • • •
4 Month • • • •
5 Year • • • • •
6 One off • • • • • •
7 Minute •

Parameter 09.040 Timer 1 Enable


Short description Set to enable the timer 1 function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Timer 1 Enable (09.040) enables the timer 1 function. If Timer 1 Enable (09.040) = 0, then the output of the timer is always inactive, i.e. Timer 1 Output
(09.042) = 0.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


260 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 09.041 Timer 1 Invert
Short description Set to invert the output of timer 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Timer 1 Invert (09.041) inverts the timer output to give an active state of 0 instead of 1. Alternatively it can be used to give an active state of 1, but for a
time period that spans the ends of the repeat period as shown in the example above. It should be noted that if this method is used to allow the active
period to span the ends of the repeat period then if the timer is disabled the output of the timer block before the invert becomes 0, and so the final
output of the timer after the invert is 1.

See Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) for more information.

Parameter 09.042 Timer 1 Output


Short description Shows the output state of timer function 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Timer 1 Output (09.042) shows the output of timer function 1.

Parameter 09.043 Timer 1 Destination


Short description Defines the output destination of timer function 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

Timer 1 Destination (09.043) defines the output destination of timer function 1.

Parameter 09.045 Timer 2 Start Date


Short description Defines the start date for timer 2
Mode RFC‑A
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
0
Default Units
(Display: 00-00-00)
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Timer 2 Start Date (09.045) defines the start date within the repeat period of timer 2.

See Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) for more information.

Parameter 09.046 Timer 2 Start Time


Short description Defines the start time for timer 2
Mode RFC‑A
0 235959
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00) (Display: 23:59:59)
0
Default Units
(Display: 00:00:00)
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Time Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Timer 2 Start Time (09.046) defines the start time within the repeat period of timer 2.

See Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) for more information.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 261
Parameter 09.047 Timer 2 Stop Date
Short description Defines the stop date for timer 2
Mode RFC‑A
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
0
Default Units
(Display: 00-00-00)
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Timer 2 Stop Date (09.047) defines the stop date within the repeat period of timer 2.

See Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) for more information.

Parameter 09.048 Timer 2 Stop Time


Short description Defines the stop time for timer 2
Mode RFC‑A
0 235959
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00) (Display: 23:59:59)
0
Default Units
(Display: 00:00:00)
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Time Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Timer 2 Stop Time (09.048) defines the stop time within the repeat period of timer 2.

See Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039) for more information.

Parameter 09.049 Timer 2 Repeat Function


Short description Defines the length of the repeat period
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 7
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 None
1 Hour
2 Day
3 Week
4 Month
5 Year
6 One off
7 Minute

See Timer 1 Repeat Function (09.039).

Parameter 09.050 Timer 2 Enable


Short description Set to enable the timer 2 function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Timer 2 Enable (09.050) enables the timer 2 function. If Timer 2 Enable (09.050) = 0, then the output of the timer is always inactive, i.e. Timer 2 Output
(09.052) = 0.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


262 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 09.051 Timer 2 Invert
Short description Set to invert the output of timer 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Timer 2 Invert (09.051) inverts the timer output to give an active state of 0 instead of 1.

See Timer 1 Invert (09.041) for more information.

Parameter 09.052 Timer 2 Output


Short description Shows the output state of timer function 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Timer 2 Output (09.052) shows the output of timer function 2.

Parameter 09.053 Timer 2 Destination


Short description Defines the output destination of timer function 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

Timer 2 Destination (09.053) defines the output destination of timer function 2.

Parameter 09.055 Scope Trace 1 Source


Short description Defines the source of scope trace 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

Up to four scope sources can be selected using Scope Trace 1 Source (09.055) to Scope Trace 4 Source (09.058). If the source value is set to 0.000,
or the source parameter does not exist or is non-visible, then no source is selected. The sources do not operate in the same way as normal source
parameters in that the input to the scope is the actual value of the parameter and not a value scaled to a percentage based on the range of the
parameter. If a scope trace source parameter is modified the actual change is not effective until the drive is reset.

Parameter 09.056 Scope Trace 2 Source


Short description Defines the source of scope trace 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Scope Trace 1 Source (09.055).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 263
Parameter 09.057 Scope Trace 3 Source
Short description Defines the source of scope trace 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Scope Trace 1 Source (09.055).

Parameter 09.058 Scope Trace 4 Source


Short description Defines the source of scope trace 4
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Scope Trace 1 Source (09.055).

Parameter 09.059 Scope Trigger


Short description Set to trigger the scope function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The scope is triggered by a rising edge at the input to the main scope block. If Scope Trigger Source (09.060) is set at its default value of 0.000 then the
output of the trigger threshold comparator is 0, and so the scope can be triggered with Scope Trigger (09.059). Scope Trigger Invert (09.062) can be
used to invert the trigger signal.

Parameter 09.060 Scope Trigger Source


Short description Defines the source of the scope trigger
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

If Scope Trigger (09.059) = 0, the scope can be triggered based on the level of a parameter defined by Scope Trigger Source (09.060) and
the Scope Trigger Threshold (09.061). This source operates in the same way as the trace sources and a direct comparison is made between the actual
parameter value and the threshold. Decimal places are ignored. The threshold detector output is 1 when the value from the scope trigger source is
greater than Scope Trigger Threshold (09.061). If Scope Trigger Source (09.060) = 0.000, or it is used to select a parameter that does not exist or is
non-visible, then the output of the threshold detector is 0.

Parameter 09.061 Scope Trigger Threshold


Short description Defines the scope trigger threshold
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Scope Trigger Source (09.060).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


264 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 09.062 Scope Trigger Invert
Short description Set to invert the scope trigger
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Scope Trigger (09.059).

Parameter 09.063 Scope Mode


Short description Defines the mode of the scope
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Single
1 Normal
2 Auto

Single (0):
If Scope Arm (09.064) is set to 1 the scope starts to acquire pre-trigger data (i.e. enough data to provide information for the pre-trigger period)
and Scope Data Not Ready  (09.065) is set to 1. The scope can then be triggered on the next trigger event (i.e. a rising edge on the trigger input of the
main scope block). Note that the scope can only be triggered once the required amount of pre-trigger data has been sampled. Failure to do this will
result in the scope function not triggering correctly. When the trigger event occurs Scope Arm (09.064) is set to 0, and when the post-trigger data has
been stored Scope Data Not Ready  (09.065) is set to 0. If Scope Auto-save Mode (09.070) is non-zero, the data in the scope trace buffer is saved to a
non-volatile media card fitted in the drive. When the save is complete (or data cannot be saved, i.e. no card fitted or no space left) the scope is ready
again to receive data. If Scope Arm (09.064) is set to 1 the scope will start to acquire data again.

It is possible to read scope files via comms or into an option module. However, scope file transfer can only be initiated when Scope Arm (09.064) =
0, Scope Data Not Ready  (09.065) = 0, Scope Saving Data (09.066) = 0 and at least one trace has been set up. While the file transfer is in progress
Scope Saving Data (09.066) is set to 1.

The scope system is reset under any of the following conditions:

1. At power-up.
2. If the drive is reset when Scope Trace 1 Source (09.055) to Scope Trace 4 Source (09.058) have been modified.
3. The drive mode is changed.
4. If Scope Mode (09.063), Scope Sample Time (09.067) or Scope Trigger Delay (09.068) are modified.

When the scope is reset Scope Arm (09.064) is reset to 0 and the trace data is all cleared to 0..

Normal (1):
The scope operates in the same way as single mode except that Scope Arm (09.064) is automatically set back to 1 after a time delay of 1s once the
post-trigger data has been acquired, and the scope data has been saved to a non-volatile media card if Scope Auto-save Mode (09.070) > 0.

Auto (2):
After the scope system is reset Scope Data Not Ready  (09.065) is set to 1 and the scope begins to acquire data. Once the buffer is full
Scope Data Not Ready  (09.065) is set to 0 and the scope continues to acquire data. Scope Arm (09.064) has no effect on data acquisition. Provided
Scope Data Not Ready  (09.065) = 0 and Scope Saving Data (09.066) = 0 it is possible to read the data from the scope buffer as a scope file. Data
acquisition is stopped when the file transfer begins. When the file transfer is complete, data acquisition begins again and Scope Data Not Ready 
(09.065) is set to 1 for a period that is long enough to fill the scope buffer with new data.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 265
Parameter 09.064 Scope Arm
Short description Set to arm the scope
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Scope Mode (09.063).

Parameter 09.065 Scope Data Not Ready


Short description Shows that the data in the scope buffer is not ready to be read out
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Scope Mode (09.063).

Parameter 09.066 Scope Saving Data


Short description Shows when the scope is saving data
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Scope Mode (09.063).

Parameter 09.067 Scope Sample Time


Short description Defines the sample time of the scope
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 200
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Scope Sample Time (09.067) defines the sample rate of the scope function for all traces in 250μs units (i.e. if Scope Sample Time (09.067) = 4, the
sample time is 1ms).

Parameter 09.068 Scope Trigger Delay


Short description Defines how much pre-trigger data is stored by the scope
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 100
Default 0 Units %
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Scope Trigger Delay (09.068) defines how much data is stored before and after the scope is triggered. If Scope Trigger Delay (09.068) = 0% then no
data is stored before the trigger and all the data is after the trigger. If Scope Trigger Delay (09.068) = 100% then no data is stored after the trigger, but
all the data is before the trigger.

Parameter 09.069 Scope Time Period


Short description Shows the time period covered by the scope buffer
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 200000.00
Default Units ms
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


266 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
The scope function can capture up to 4000 bytes of parameter data. The Scope Time Period (09.069) gives the length of the time period covered by the
scope buffer in milliseconds which depends on the number of traces stored, the sample time and the size of the parameters used as trace sources.

Sample time in milliseconds = (250 x 10-6 x Scope Sample Time (09.067)) x 1000

Size of trace data is the sum of the number of bytes in each of the trace sources selected by Scope Trace 1 Source (09.055) to Scope Trace 4 Source
(09.058).

Scope Time Period (09.069) (ms) = 4000 x Sample time in milliseconds / Size of trace data

Parameter 09.070 Scope Auto-save Mode


Short description Defines the mode for auto-saving scope files to the NV media card
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Disabled
1 Overwrite
2 Keep

Auto-save mode can be used to store a scope file on a non-volatile media card at each trigger event. The auto-save system is held in reset
if Scope Auto-save Reset (09.072) = 1. When the auto-save system is reset all the scope files in scope file folder on the NV media card are
deleted, Scope Auto-save File Number (09.071) is reset to 0 and the auto-save system is inactive. If any of the file operations fail during
reset Scope Auto-save Status (09.073) is 3 (Failed) when the reset is removed.

The following conditions must be met for auto-saving to be active:

1. Scope Auto-save Mode (09.070) is non-zero


2. Scope Auto-save Reset (09.072) = 0
3. Scope Auto-save Status (09.073) = 1 (Active)
4. Scope Mode (09.063) = 0 (Single) or 1 (Normal)

If auto-saving is active an attempt is made to copy the scope file to a non-volatile media card fitted to the drive each time the post-trigger data has been
acquired. The file name is SCP00XY.DAT, where XY is defined by Scope Auto-save File Number (09.071). If Scope Auto-save Mode (09.070) = 1
(Overwrite) then a file is over-written if it already exists. If Scope Auto-save Mode (09.070) = 2 (Keep) then if the file already exists the auto-save
process is aborted. Scope Auto-save File Number (09.071) is incremented after a file is saved successfully and rolls over to 0 if it exceeds its maximum
value.

If Scope Auto-save Status (09.073) = 0 (Disabled) and all the other conditions listed above for auto-saving to be active are met, then Scope Auto-
save Status (09.073) changes to 1 (Active), so that auto-saving becomes active. If the scope file cannot be saved because the file exists
and Scope Auto-save Mode (09.070) = 2 (Keep) then Scope Auto-save Status (09.073) is set to 2 (Stopped). If the scope file cannot be saved for any
other reason then Scope Auto-save Status (09.073) is set to 3 (Failed). If Scope Auto-save Status (09.073) is no longer 1 (Active), auto-saving is
aborted. Auto-saving can be made active again by setting Scope Auto-save Reset (09.072) to 1 and then to 0. If Scope Auto-save Mode (09.070) = 0
(Disabled) then Scope Auto-save Status (09.073) is set to 0 (Disabled), or if Scope Auto-save Mode (09.070) is non-zero then Scope Auto-save Status
(09.073) is set to 1 (Active). It should be noted that Scope Auto-save Status (09.073) is a power-down save parameter, and so auto-save will remain
inactive if Scope Auto-save Status (09.073) is 2 or 3 even if the drive is powered down and then powered up again.

Parameter 09.071 Scope Auto-save File Number


Short description Shows the file number to be used for the next auto-saved scope file
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 99
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Background read/write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, NC

See Scope Auto-save Mode (09.070).

Parameter 09.072 Scope Auto-save Reset


Short description Set to reset the scope auto-save function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Scope Auto-save Mode (09.070).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 267
Parameter 09.073 Scope Auto-save Status
Short description Shows the status of the scope auto-save function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, NC

Value Text
0 Disabled
1 Active
2 Stopped
3 Failed

See Scope Auto-save Mode (09.070).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


268 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 10 Single Line Descriptions − Status and Trips
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 269
Parameter Range Default Type
10.001 Drive Healthy Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.002 Drive Active Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.003 Zero Speed Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.004 Running At Or Below Minimum Speed Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.005 Below Set Speed Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.006 At Speed Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.007 Above Set Speed Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.008 Rated Load Reached Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.009 Current Limit Active Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.010 Regenerating Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.011 Braking IGBT Active Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.012 Braking Resistor Alarm Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.013 Reverse Direction Commanded Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.014 Reverse Direction Running Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.015 Supply Loss Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.016 Under Voltage Active Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.017 Motor Overload Alarm Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.018 Drive Over‑temperature Alarm Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.019 Drive Warning Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.020 Trip 0 0 to 255 RO Txt ND NC PT PS
10.021 Trip 1 0 to 255 RO Txt ND NC PT PS
10.022 Trip 2 0 to 255 RO Txt ND NC PT PS
10.023 Trip 3 0 to 255 RO Txt ND NC PT PS
10.024 Trip 4 0 to 255 RO Txt ND NC PT PS
10.025 Trip 5 0 to 255 RO Txt ND NC PT PS
10.026 Trip 6 0 to 255 RO Txt ND NC PT PS
10.027 Trip 7 0 to 255 RO Txt ND NC PT PS
10.028 Trip 8 0 to 255 RO Txt ND NC PT PS
10.029 Trip 9 0 to 255 RO Txt ND NC PT PS
10.030 Braking Resistor Rated Power 0.000 to 99999.999 kW 0.000 kW RW Num US
10.031 Braking Resistor Thermal Time Constant 0.000 to 1500.000 s 0.000 s RW Num US
10.032 External Trip Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
10.033 Drive Reset Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
None (0), 1 (1), 2 (2), 3 (3), 4 (4), 5 (5),
10.034 Number Of Auto‑reset Attempts None (0) RW Txt US
Infinite (6)
10.035 Auto‑reset Delay 1.0 to 600.0 s 1.0 s RW Num US
10.036 Auto‑reset Hold Drive Healthy Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
10.037 Action On Trip Detection 00000 to 11111 00000 RW Bin US
10.038 User Trip 0 to 255 RW Num ND NC
10.039 Braking Resistor Thermal Accumulator 0.0 to 100.0 % RO Num ND NC PT
10.040 Status Word 000000000000000 to 111111111111111 RO Bin ND NC PT
10.041 Trip 0 Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 RO Date ND NC PT PS
10.042 Trip 0 Time 00:00:00 to 23:59:59 RO Time ND NC PT PS
10.043 Trip 1 Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 RO Date ND NC PT PS
10.044 Trip 1 Time 00:00:00 to 23:59:59 RO Time ND NC PT PS
10.045 Trip 2 Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 RO Date ND NC PT PS
10.046 Trip 2 Time 00:00:00 to 23:59:59 RO Time ND NC PT PS
10.047 Trip 3 Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 RO Date ND NC PT PS
10.048 Trip 3 Time 00:00:00 to 23:59:59 RO Time ND NC PT PS
10.049 Trip 4 Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 RO Date ND NC PT PS
10.050 Trip 4 Time 00:00:00 to 23:59:59 RO Time ND NC PT PS
10.051 Trip 5 Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 RO Date ND NC PT PS
10.052 Trip 5 Time 00:00:00 to 23:59:59 RO Time ND NC PT PS
10.053 Trip 6 Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 RO Date ND NC PT PS
10.054 Trip 6 Time 00:00:00 to 23:59:59 RO Time ND NC PT PS
10.055 Trip 7 Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 RO Date ND NC PT PS
10.056 Trip 7 Time 00:00:00 to 23:59:59 RO Time ND NC PT PS
10.057 Trip 8 Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 RO Date ND NC PT PS
10.058 Trip 8 Time 00:00:00 to 23:59:59 RO Time ND NC PT PS
10.059 Trip 9 Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 RO Date ND NC PT PS
10.060 Trip 9 Time 00:00:00 to 23:59:59 RO Time ND NC PT PS
10.061 Braking Resistor Resistance 0.00 to 10000.00 Ω 0.00 Ω RW Num US
10.062 Low Load Detected Alarm Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


270 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
10.063 Local Keypad Battery Low Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.064 Remote Keypad Battery Low Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.065 Auto‑tune Active Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.066 Limit Switch Active Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.067 Fire Mode Active Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.068 Hold Drive Healthy on Under Voltage Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
10.069 Additional Status Bits 0000000000 to 1111111111 RO Bin ND NC PT
10.070 Trip 0 Sub‑trip Number 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT PS
10.071 Trip 1 Sub‑trip Number 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT PS
10.072 Trip 2 Sub‑trip Number 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT PS
10.073 Trip 3 Sub‑trip Number 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT PS
10.074 Trip 4 Sub‑trip Number 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT PS
10.075 Trip 5 Sub‑trip Number 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT PS
10.076 Trip 6 Sub‑trip Number 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT PS
10.077 Trip 7 Sub‑trip Number 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT PS
10.078 Trip 8 Sub‑trip Number 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT PS
10.079 Trip 9 Sub‑trip Number 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT PS
10.080 Stop Motor Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.081 Phase Loss Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
10.082 Miscellaneous Status Flags 0000000000000000 to 1111111111111111 RO Bin ND NC PT
Inhibit (0), Ready (1), Stop (2), Scan (3),
Run (4), Supply Loss (5), Deceleration (6),
dc Injection (7), Position (8), Trip (9),
10.101 Drive Status RO Txt ND NC PT
Active (10), Off (11), Hand (12), Auto (13),
Heat (14), Under Voltage (15),
Phasing (16)
10.102 Trip Reset Source 0 to 1023 RO Num ND NC PT PS
10.103 Trip Time Identifier -2147483648 to 2147483647 ms RO Num ND NC PT
None (0), Brake Resistor (1),
Motor Overload (2), Ind Overload (3),
Drive Overload (4), Auto Tune (5),
10.104 Active Alarm Limit Switch (6), Fire Mode (7), RO Txt ND NC PT
Low Load (8), Option Slot 1 (9),
Option Slot 2 (10), Option Slot 3 (11),
Option Slot 4 (12)
10.105 Hand Off Auto State Not Active (0), Off (1), Hand (2), Auto (3) RO Txt ND NC PT PS
10.106 Potential Drive Damage Conditions 0000 to 1111 RO Bin ND NC PT PS
Not Active (0), Resistance (1), pLs (2),
Ls (3), Flux (4), Flux Repeat (5),
10.107 Auto‑tune State RO Txt ND NC PT
Ld Lq No‑load (6), Lq (7), Ke (8),
Inertia (9)

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 271
Menu 10 − Status and Trips
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


272 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide
Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 273
Parameter 10.001 Drive Healthy
Short description Indicates that the drive is healthy
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Drive Healthy (10.001) indicates that the drive is not in the trip or the under voltage state if it is set to one. If Auto-reset Hold Drive Healthy (10.036) = 1
and auto-reset is being used, Drive Healthy (10.001) is not cleared until all auto-resets have been attempted and the next trip occurs. The LED on the
front of the drive gives an indication of the drive state as shown in the table below.

Drive State LED


Normal power and Drive Healthy (10.001) =
On continuously
1
Normal power and Drive Healthy (10.001) = Flashing: 0.5s on and 0.5s
0 off
Flashing: 0.5s on and 7.5s
Standby power state
off

Parameter 10.002 Drive Active


Short description Indicates that the inverter is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 2ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

If the drive inverter is active Drive Active (10.002) is set to one, otherwise it is zero.

Parameter 10.003 Zero Speed


Short description Indicates that the speed is below the zero speed threshold
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Zero Speed (10.003) is set to one under the zero speed conditions, otherwise it is zero. See Zero Speed Threshold (03.005).

Parameter 10.004 Running At Or Below Minimum Speed


Short description Indicates that the drive is running at or below the minimum speed
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

If Bipolar Reference Enable (01.010) = 1 then Running At Or Below Minimum Speed (10.004) operates in the same way as Zero Speed (10.003). If
Bipolar Reference Enable (01.010) = 0 then Running At Or Below Minimum Speed (10.004) is set if the following conditions are true:

Speed Feedback (03.002) ≤ Minimum Reference Clamp (01.007) + 5rpm

If motor map 2 is active then M2 Minimum Reference Clamp (21.002) is used instead of Minimum Reference Clamp (01.007). If Linear Speed Select
(01.055) = 1 then 5mm s-1 is used instead of 5rpm.

Parameter 10.005 Below Set Speed


Short description Indicates that the drive is running below the set speed
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


274 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
See At Speed Lower Limit (03.006).

Parameter 10.006 At Speed


Short description Indicates that the drive is running at the set speed
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See At Speed Lower Limit (03.006).

Parameter 10.007 Above Set Speed


Short description Indicates that the drive is running above the set speed
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See At Speed Lower Limit (03.006).

Parameter 10.008 Rated Load Reached


Short description Indicates that rated load has been reached
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Rated Load Reached (10.008) is set to one when the torque producing current is at or above its rated level. This condition is detected when the
modulus of Percentage Load (04.020) is greater or equal to 100.0%. It should be noted that this is an indication based on the level of current and not
torque, which means that if field weakening is active a value of one in Rated Load Reached (10.008) does not necessarily mean that the motor is
producing rated torque.

Parameter 10.009 Current Limit Active


Short description Indicates that the current limit is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Current Limit Active (10.009) is set to one if the current limit is active. It should be noted that the current limit system is used in RFC-A and RFC-S
modes when standard ramp control is active (Ramp Mode (02.004)), or supply loss control is in ramp stop or limit stop mode (Supply Loss Mode
(06.003)). Therefore Current Limit Active (10.009) is likely to change to one under these conditions, even if the user defined current limits are not active.

Parameter 10.010 Regenerating


Short description Indicates that power is being transferred from the motor to the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Regenerating (10.010) is set to one if power is being transferred from the motor to the drive.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 275
Parameter 10.011 Braking IGBT Active
Short description Indicates that the braking IGBT is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Braking IGBT Active (10.011) is set to one if the braking IGBT is active. As the braking IGBT active periods may be short, each time the braking IGBT is
switched on Braking IGBT Active (10.011) is set to one and remains at one for at least 0.5s.

Parameter 10.012 Braking Resistor Alarm


Indicates that the braking IGBT is active and the braking resistor thermal accumulator is greater than
Short description
75%
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Braking Resistor Alarm (10.012) is set when the braking IGBT is active and Braking Resistor Thermal Accumulator (10.039) is greater than 75.0%. As
the braking IGBT on periods may be short Braking Resistor Alarm (10.012) is always held on for at least 0.5s.

Parameter 10.013 Reverse Direction Commanded


Short description Indicates that the reverse direction has been commanded
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Reverse Direction Commanded (10.013) indicates the reference direction at the input to the ramp system. If the Pre-ramp Reference (01.003) is
negative Reverse Direction Commanded (10.013) is one otherwise Reverse Direction Commanded (10.013) is zero.

Parameter 10.014 Reverse Direction Running


Short description Indicates that the drive is running in the reverse direction
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Reverse Direction Running (10.014) is set to one if the Speed Feedback (03.002) is negative otherwise it is set to zero.

Parameter 10.015 Supply Loss


Short description Indicates that the drive is in the supply loss state
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Supply Loss (10.015) indicates that the drive is in the supply loss state. This condition can only occur if supply loss detection is enabled,
i.e. Supply Loss Mode (06.003) is set to a non-zero value. In the supply loss state the drive will attempt to stop the motor.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


276 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 10.016 Under Voltage Active
Short description Indicates that the drive is in the under voltage state
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Under Voltage Active (10.016) indicates that the drive is in the under voltage state. See Standard Under Voltage Threshold (06.065) for more details.

Parameter 10.017 Motor Overload Alarm


Short description Indicates that the motor overload accumulator is above 75% and the output current is high
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Motor Overload Alarm (10.017) is set if the drive output current is higher than the level that will eventually cause a Motor Too Hot trip and
the Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) is higher than 75.0%. See Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 (04.015) for more details.

Parameter 10.018 Drive Over-temperature Alarm


Short description Indicates that the drive over-temperature alarm is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Drive Over-temperature Alarm (10.018) is set if Percentage Of Drive Thermal Trip Level (07.036) is greater than 90%.

Parameter 10.019 Drive Warning


Short description Indicates that one or more of the drive warning alarms are active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Drive Warning (10.019) is set to one if any of the drive warnings is active, and is defined as:

Drive Warning (10.019) = Braking Resistor Alarm (10.012) OR Motor Overload Alarm (10.017) OR Drive Over-temperature Alarm (10.018)


OR Low Load Detected Alarm (10.062)

Parameter 10.020 Trip 0


Short description Shows the current or last trip to have occurred
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

Click here to view trips in numerical order.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 277
Value Text
28 An Input 1 Loss
29 An Input 2 Loss
219 An Output Calib
217 App Menu Changed
11 Autotune 1
12 Autotune 2
13 Autotune 3
14 Autotune 4
15 Autotune 5
16 Autotune 6
17 Autotune 7
18 Autotune Stopped
19 Brake R Too Hot
99 CAM
185 Card Access
177 Card Boot
178 Card Busy
188 Card Compare
179 Card Data Exists
187 Card Drive Mode
182 Card Error
184 Card Full
183 Card No Data
180 Card Option
175 Card Product
186 Card Rating
181 Card Read Only
174 Card Slot
102 Cloning
111 Configuration
35 Control Word
225 Current Offset
97 Data Changing
247 Derivative ID
248 Derivative Image
199 Destination
224 Drive Size
31 EEPROM Fail
189 Encoder 1
190 Encoder 2
191 Encoder 3
192 Encoder 4
193 Encoder 5
194 Encoder 6
195 Encoder 7
196 Encoder 8
197 Encoder 9
162 Encoder 12
163 Encoder 13
164 Encoder 14
6 External Trip
26 I/O Overload
8 Inductance
93 Inductor Too Hot
103 Inter-connect
160 Island
34 Keypad Mode
39 Line Sync
38 Low Load
20 Motor Too Hot
176 Name Plate
0 None
101 OHt Brake

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


278 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
23 OHt Control
27 OHt dc bus
21 OHt Inverter
22 OHt Power
3 OI ac
4 OI Brake
109 OI dc
92 OI Snubber
215 Option Disable
98 Out Phase Loss
7 Over Speed
2 Over Volts
32 Phase Loss
198 Phasing Error
90 Power Comms
220 Power Data
37 Power Down Save
5 PSU
9 PSU 24V
223 Rating Mismatch
94 Rectifier Set-up
1 Reserved 001
95 Reserved 095
104 Reserved 104
105 Reserved 105
106 Reserved 106
107 Reserved 107
108 Reserved 108
161 Reserved 161
165 Reserved 165
166 Reserved 166
167 Reserved 167
168 Reserved 168
170 Reserved 170
171 Reserved 171
172 Reserved 172
173 Reserved 173
222 Reserved 222
228 Reserved 228
229 Reserved 229
230 Reserved 230
231 Reserved 231
232 Reserved 232
233 Reserved 233
234 Reserved 234
235 Reserved 235
236 Reserved 236
237 Reserved 237
238 Reserved 238
239 Reserved 239
240 Reserved 240
241 Reserved 241
242 Reserved 242
243 Reserved 243
244 Reserved 244
245 Reserved 245
246 Reserved 246
100 Reset
255 Reset Logs
33 Resistance
204 Slot1 Different
202 Slot1 Error
200 Slot1 HF
203 Slot1 Not Fitted
201 Slot1 Watchdog

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 279
209 Slot2 Different
207 Slot2 Error
205 Slot2 HF
208 Slot2 Not Fitted
206 Slot2 Watchdog
214 Slot3 Different
212 Slot3 Error
210 Slot3 HF
213 Slot3 Not Fitted
211 Slot3 Watchdog
254 Slot4 Different
252 Slot4 Error
250 Slot4 HF
253 Slot4 Not Fitted
251 Slot4 Watchdog
216 Slot App Menu
226 Soft Start
221 Stored HF
227 Sub-array RAM
218 Temp Feedback
10 Th Brake Res
25 Th Short Circuit
24 Thermistor
110 Undefined
91 User 24V
96 User Prog Trip
249 User Program
36 User Save
40 User Trip 40
41 User Trip 41
42 User Trip 42
43 User Trip 43
44 User Trip 44
45 User Trip 45
46 User Trip 46
47 User Trip 47
48 User Trip 48
49 User Trip 49
50 User Trip 50
51 User Trip 51
52 User Trip 52
53 User Trip 53
54 User Trip 54
55 User Trip 55
56 User Trip 56
57 User Trip 57
58 User Trip 58
59 User Trip 59
60 User Trip 60
61 User Trip 61
62 User Trip 62
63 User Trip 63
64 User Trip 64
65 User Trip 65
66 User Trip 66
67 User Trip 67
68 User Trip 68
69 User Trip 69
70 User Trip 70
71 User Trip 71
72 User Trip 72
73 User Trip 73
74 User Trip 74
75 User Trip 75
76 User Trip 76
Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide
280 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
77 User Trip 77
78 User Trip 78
79 User Trip 79
80 User Trip 80
81 User Trip 81
82 User Trip 82
83 User Trip 83
84 User Trip 84
85 User Trip 85
86 User Trip 86
87 User Trip 87
88 User Trip 88
89 User Trip 89
112 User Trip 112
113 User Trip 113
114 User Trip 114
115 User Trip 115
116 User Trip 116
117 User Trip 117
118 User Trip 118
119 User Trip 119
120 User Trip 120
121 User Trip 121
122 User Trip 122
123 User Trip 123
124 User Trip 124
125 User Trip 125
126 User Trip 126
127 User Trip 127
128 User Trip 128
129 User Trip 129
130 User Trip 130
131 User Trip 131
132 User Trip 132
133 User Trip 133
134 User Trip 134
135 User Trip 135
136 User Trip 136
137 User Trip 137
138 User Trip 138
139 User Trip 139
140 User Trip 140
141 User Trip 141
142 User Trip 142
143 User Trip 143
144 User Trip 144
145 User Trip 145
146 User Trip 146
147 User Trip 147
148 User Trip 148
149 User Trip 149
150 User Trip 150
151 User Trip 151
152 User Trip 152
153 User Trip 153
154 User Trip 154
155 User Trip 155
156 User Trip 156
157 User Trip 157
158 User Trip 158
159 User Trip 159
169 Voltage Range
30 Watchdog

Trip 0 (10.020) to Trip 9 (10.029) store the most recent 10 trips that have occurred where Trip 0 (10.020) is the most recent and Trip 9 (10.029) is the

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 281
oldest. When a new trip occurs it is written to Trip 0 (10.020) and all the other trips move down the log, with oldest being lost. The date and time when
each trip occurs are also stored in the date and time log, i.e. Trip 0 Date (10.041) to Trip 9 Time (10.060). The date and time are taken from Date
(06.016) and Time (06.017). Some trips have sub-trip numbers which give more detail about the reason for the trip. If a trip has a sub-trip number its
value is stored in the sub-trip log, i.e. Trip 0 Sub-trip Number (10.070) to Trip 9 Sub-trip Number (10.079). If the trip does not have a sub-trip number
then zero is stored in the sub-trip log.

Trip categories and priorities


Trips are grouped into the categories given in the table below. A trip can only occur when the drive is not tripped, or if it is already tripped and the new
trip has a higher priority than the active trip (i.e. lower priority number). Unless otherwise stated a trip cannot be reset until 1.0s after it has been
initiated.

Priority Category Trips Comments


These are fatal problems that cannot be reset. All drive features are inactive after any of these
1 Internal faults HF01 - HF26 trips occur. If a basic keypad is fitted it will show the trip, but the keypad will not function. These
trips are not stored in the trip log.
This trip cannot be cleared unless 1299 is entered into Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) and a reset
1 Stored HF trip Stored HF
is initiated.
Trip numbers 218 to 247,
Non-resettable
2 Slot1 HF, Slot2 HF, These trips cannot be reset.
trips
Slot3 HF or Slot4 HF
Volatile memory This can only be reset if Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) is set to 1233 or 1244, or if Load Defaults
3 EEPROM Fail
failure (11.043) is set to a non-zero value.
Internal 24V
4 PSU 24V
power supply
Non-volatile Trip numbers 174, 175
5 These trips are priority 6 during power-up.
media trips and 177 to 188
Position feedback
5 interface power Encoder 1 This trip can override Encoder 2 to Encoder 6 trips.
supply
Trips with
OI ac, OI Brake, and
6 extended reset These trips cannot be reset until 10s after the trip was initiated.
OI dc
times
Phase loss and The drive will attempt to stop the motor before tripping if a Phase Loss.000 trip occurs unless this
Phase Loss and
6 d.c. link power feature has been disabled (see Action On Trip Detection (10.037). The drive will always attempt
OHt dc bus
circuit protection to stop the motor before tripping if an OHt dc bus occurs.
6 Standard trips All other trips

Internal faults
Trips {HF01} to {HF26} are internal faults that do not have trip numbers. If one of these trips occurs, the main drive processor has detected an
irrecoverable error. All drive functions are stopped and the trip message will be displayed on the drive keypad. The error can only be reset by powering
the drive down and up again. The table below gives the reasons for internal faults and their corresponding trip.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


282 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Trip Reason
{HF01} CPU has detected an address error
{HF02} CPU DMAC has detected an address error
{HF03} CPU has detected an Illegal opcode
{HF04} CPU has detected an Illegal slot instruction
{HF05} An interrupt has occurred that does not have a defined function (Undefined exception)
{HF06} An interrupt has occurred which is reserved (Reserved exception)
{HF07} Watchdog failure
{HF08} CPU Interrupt crash
{HF09} Free store overflow
{HF10} Parameter routing system error
{HF11} Non-volatile memory comms error

Stack overflow. Sub-trip is shown to indicate which stack:


1 - background tasks
{HF12}
2 - timed tasks
3 - main system interrupts

The control hardware is not compatible with the firmware. The sub-trip number gives the actual ID code
{HF13}
of the control board hardware.
{HF14} CPU register bank error
{HF15} CPU divide error
{HF16} RTOS error (the background task has returned)
{HF17} The clock supplied to the control board logic is out of specification

The internal flash memory has failed when writing option module parameter data.

Sub-trip is shown to indicate which failure:


{HF18}
1 - Programming error while writing menu in flash
2 - Erase flash block containing setup menus failed
3 - Erase flash block containing application menus failed

{HF19} Invalid main application firmware CRC. Reprogramming required.


{HF20} The ASIC is not compatible with the firmware. The sub-trip number displayed is the ASIC version.
{HF23} If this trip occurs please consult the drive supplier.
{HF24} If this trip occurs please consult the drive supplier.
{HF25} If this trip occurs please consult the drive supplier.
The control pod is either a UF90A or a UF99A and is fitted to a power stage that is not compatible
{HF26}
because it only provided two phase current feedback. If this trip occurs pleas consult the drive supplier.

When the drive is subsequently powered up a Stored HF trip is initiated where the sub-trip number is the number of the HF trip that last occurred. This
trip will occur at every power-up until it is reset. The trip can only be reset by first entering 1299 into Parameter mm.000 (mm.000). If the drive is
powered up and a Stored HF trip occurs, Onboard User Program: Enable (11.047) is reset to zero to prevent the on-board user program from running.
This ensures that the user program can be changed or erased in case it causes an HF trip at every power-up. Once the Stored HF is cleared, it is
necessary to power cycle the drive or to re-download the user program to allow the program to restart.

Similar trips that can be initiated by the control system or the power system
Trips shown in the table below can be generated either from the drive control system or from the power system. The sub-trip number which is in the
form xxyzz is used to identify the source of the trip. The digits xx are 00 for a trip generated by the control system or the number of a power module if
generated by the power system. If the drive is not a multi-power module drive then xx will always have a value of 1 indicating the trip is related to the
power system. The y digit is used to identify the location of a trip which is generated by a rectifier module connected to a power module. Where the y
digit is relevant it will have a value of 1 or more, otherwise it will be 0. The zz digits give the reason for the trip and are defined in each trip description.

Over Volts OHt dc bus
OI ac Phase Loss
OI Brake Power Comms
PSU OI Snubber
OHt Inverter Cloning
OHt Power Temp Feedback
OHt Control Power Data

Braking IGBT
The list below gives conditions that will disable the braking IGBT:

1. Braking IGBT Upper Threshold (06.074) = 0, or Low Voltage Braking IGBT Threshold Select (06.076) = 1 and


Low Voltage Braking IGBT Threshold (06.075) = 0.
2. The drive is in the under-voltage state.
3. A priority 1, 2 or 3 trip is active (see Trip 0 (10.020)).
4. One of the following trips is active or would be active if another trip is not already active: OI Brake, PSU, Th Brake Res or OHt Inverter.
5. Percentage Of Drive Thermal Trip Level (07.036) = 100%. This is an indication that some part of the drive is too hot and is used to
indicate if an internally fitted braking resistor is too hot.
6. Brake R Too Hot is active or the system has been set up to disable the braking IGBT based on the braking resistor temperature and
the resistor is too hot (i.e. bit 2 of Action On Trip Detection (10.037) is set).

Note that the braking IGBT over-current trip cannot be reset until 10s after it is initiated. This period consists of a 9s period after the trip where the

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 283
braking IGBT cannot be switched on again and the OI Brake trip is held active and cannot be reset. This 9s period is followed by the normal 1s delay,
that is present for other trips, before the trip can be reset. During this 1s period it is possible for the braking IGBT to switch on again. If the conditions
are still present that caused the trip then the trip will be initiated again with a further 9s hold-off period etc.

Parameter 10.021 Trip 1


Short description Shows the 2nd from last trip to have occurred
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.022 Trip 2


Short description Shows the 3rd from last trip to have occurred
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.023 Trip 3


Short description Shows the 4th from last trip to have occurred
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.024 Trip 4


Short description Shows the 5th from last trip to have occurred
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.025 Trip 5


Short description Shows the 6th from last trip to have occurred
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.026 Trip 6


Short description Shows the 7th from last trip to have occurred
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


284 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.027 Trip 7


Short description Shows the 8th from last trip to have occurred
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.028 Trip 8


Short description Shows the 9th from last trip to have occurred
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.029 Trip 9


Short description Shows the 10th from last trip to have occurred
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.030 Braking Resistor Rated Power


Short description Set to the rated power of the braking resistor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 99999.999
Default 0.000 Units kW
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

A thermal protection system is provided for the braking resistor. If Braking Resistor Rated Power (10.030) is set to zero this protection system is
disabled and the Braking Resistor Thermal Accumulator (10.039) is held at zero. If braking resistor thermal protection is required the
Braking Resistor Rated Power (10.030), Braking Resistor Thermal Time Constant (10.031) and Braking Resistor Resistance (10.061) should be set up
with the braking resistor parameters. The thermal time constant of the resistor can be calculated from the single pulse energy rating (E) and continuous
power rating (P) of the resistor.

Braking Resistor Thermal Time Constant (10.031) = τ = E / P

The braking resistor is protected with a single time constant model as shown below.

The drive monitors the power flowing into the braking resistor and updates the Braking Resistor Thermal Accumulator (10.039). If bit 1
of Action On Trip Detection (10.037) = 0 and the accumulator reaches 100% an Brake R Too Hot trip is initiated. If bit 1 of Action On Trip Detection
(10.037) = 1 and the accumulator reaches 100% the braking IGBT is disabled until the accumulator falls below 95.0%.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 285
Parameter 10.031 Braking Resistor Thermal Time Constant
Short description Set to the thermal time constant of the braking resistor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 1500.000
Default 0.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See Braking Resistor Rated Power (10.030).

Parameter 10.032 External Trip


Short description Set to initiate an external trip
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If External Trip (10.032) is set to one an External Trip.003 is initiated. A digital input can be routed to External Trip (10.032) to provide an external trip
input function.

Parameter 10.033 Drive Reset


Short description Set to initiate a drive reset
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

A 0 to 1 transition in Drive Reset (10.033) causes a drive reset. If a drive reset terminal is required a digital input should be routed to Drive Reset
(10.033).

Parameter 10.034 Number Of Auto-reset Attempts


Short description Set to the number of required auto-reset attempts
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 6
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 None
1 1
2 2
3 3
4 4
5 5
6 Infinite

If Number Of Auto-reset Attempts  (10.034) = 0 then no auto-reset attempts are made. Any other value will cause the drive to automatically reset
following a trip for the number of times programmed after a delay defined by Auto-reset Delay (10.035) subject to the minimum reset time allowed for
the type of trip. Note that for some trips the minimum is 10s. The auto-reset count is only incremented when the trip is the same as the previous trip
otherwise it is reset to 0. When the auto-reset count reaches the programmed value, any further trip of the same value will not cause an auto-reset. If
the number of auto-reset attempts defined by Number Of Auto-reset Attempts  (10.034) has not been reached and there has been no trip for 5 minutes
then the auto-reset count is cleared. Auto reset will not occur after any trips with priority levels 1, 2 or 3 as defined in Trip 0 (10.020). When a manual
reset occurs the auto-reset counter is reset to zero.

If Number Of Auto-reset Attempts  (10.034) = 6 the auto-reset counter is held at zero, and so there is no limit on the number of auto-reset attempts.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


286 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 10.035 Auto-reset Delay
Short description Set to the required auto-reset delay
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1.0 Maximum 600.0
Default 1.0 Units s
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

See Number Of Auto-reset Attempts  (10.034).

Parameter 10.036 Auto-reset Hold Drive Healthy


Short description Set to hold drive healthy if further auto-reset attempts are possible
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If Auto-reset Hold Drive Healthy (10.036) = 0 then Drive Healthy (10.001) is cleared every time the drive trips regardless of any auto-reset that may
occur. If Auto-reset Hold Drive Healthy (10.036) = 1 then Drive Healthy (10.001) is not cleared on a trip if any further auto-reset attempts are possible.
Note that if the under voltage state becomes active Drive Healthy (10.001) will be set to zero unless Hold Drive Healthy on Under Voltage (10.068) = 1.

Parameter 10.037 Action On Trip Detection


Short description Defines the action of the drive on detection of a trip
Mode RFC‑A
0 31
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00000) (Display: 11111)
0
Default Units
(Display: 00000)
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The bits in Action On Trip Detection (10.037) are defined as follows:

Bit 0: Stop on defined non-important trips


If bit 0 is set to one the drive will attempt to stop before tripping if any of the following trip conditions are
detected: I/O Overload, An Input 1 Loss, An Input 2 Loss or Keypad Mode. (This bit has no effect in Regen mode.)

Bit 1: Disable braking resistor overload detection


See Braking Resistor Rated Power (10.030).

Bit 2: Disable phase loss stop


Normally the drive will stop when the input phase loss condition is detected. If this bit is set to 1 the drive will continue to run and will only trip when the
drive is brought to a stop by the user. (This bit has no effect in Regen mode.)

Bit 3: Not Used

Bit 4: Disable parameter freeze on trip


If this bit is 0 then the parameters listed below are frozen on trip until the trip is cleared. If this bit is 1 then this feature is disabled.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 287
Open-loop mode RFC-A or RFC-S modes Regen
Reference Selected (01.001) Reference Selected (01.001)
Pre-skip Filter Reference (01.002) Pre-skip Filter Reference (01.002)
Pre-ramp Reference (01.003) Pre-ramp Reference (01.003)
Post Ramp Reference (02.001) Post Ramp Reference (02.001)
Frequency Slaving Demand (03.001) Final Speed Reference (03.001) Reactive Power (03.001)
Speed Feedback (03.002)
Speed Error (03.003)
Speed Controller Output (03.004)
Current Magnitude (04.001) Current Magnitude (04.001) Current Magnitude (04.001)
Iq, Torque Producing Current (04.002) Iq, Torque Producing Current (04.002) Active Current (04.002)
Id, Magnetising Current (04.017) Id, Magnetising Current (04.017) Reactive Current (04.017)
Output Frequency (05.001) Output Frequency (05.001) Output Frequency (05.001)
Output Voltage (05.002) Output Voltage (05.002) Output Voltage (05.002)
Output Power (05.003) Output Power (05.003) Output Power (05.003)
D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005) D.c. Bus Voltage (05.005)
Analog Input 1 (07.001) Analog Input 1 (07.001) Analog Input 1 (07.001)
Analog Input 2 (07.002) Analog Input 2 (07.002) Analog Input 2 (07.002)
Analog Input 3 (07.003) Analog Input 3 (07.003) Analog Input 3 (07.003)

Parameter 10.038 User Trip


Short description Can be used to generate a trip on the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, ND, NC, BU

When a value other than zero is written to the User Trip (10.038) the actions described in the following table are performed. The drive immediately
writes the value back to zero. If the value is not included in the table, then the action is the same as if the trip with the same number (with sub-trip zero)
occurred provided the drive is not already tripped.

Action User Trip (10.038)


Numbers corresponding to priority 1, 2
No action
or 3 trips.
Drive reset 100
Clear trip logs (parameters 10.020 to 10.029, 10.041 to 10.060 and
255
10.070 to 10.079)

Parameter 10.039 Braking Resistor Thermal Accumulator


Short description Shows the level of the braking resistor thermal accumulator
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 100.0
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Braking Resistor Rated Power (10.030).

Parameter 10.040 Status Word


Short description Shows the status word for the drive
Mode RFC‑A
0 32767
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 000000000000000) (Display: 111111111111111)
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

The bits in Status Word (10.040) mirror the status bit parameters as shown below. Where the parameters do not exist in any mode the bit remains at
zero.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


288 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Bit Status parameter
0 Drive Healthy (10.001)
1 Drive Active (10.002)
2 Zero Speed (10.003)
3 Running At Or Below Minimum Speed (10.004)
4 Below Set Speed (10.005)
5 At Speed (10.006)
6 Above Set Speed (10.007)
7 Rated Load Reached (10.008)
8 Current Limit Active (10.009)
9 Regenerating (10.010)
10 Braking IGBT Active (10.011)
11 Braking Resistor Alarm (10.012)
12 Reverse Direction Commanded (10.013)
13 Reverse Direction Running (10.014)
14 Supply Loss (10.015)

Parameter 10.041 Trip 0 Date


Short description Shows the date at which trip 0 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.042 Trip 0 Time


Short description Shows the time at which trip 0 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 235959
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00) (Display: 23:59:59)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Time Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.043 Trip 1 Date


Short description Shows the date at which trip 1 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.044 Trip 1 Time


Short description Shows the time at which trip 1 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 235959
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00) (Display: 23:59:59)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Time Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 289
Parameter 10.045 Trip 2 Date
Short description Shows the date at which trip 2 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.046 Trip 2 Time


Short description Shows the time at which trip 2 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 235959
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00) (Display: 23:59:59)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Time Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.047 Trip 3 Date


Short description Shows the date at which trip 3 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.048 Trip 3 Time


Short description Shows the time at which trip 3 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 235959
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00) (Display: 23:59:59)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Time Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.049 Trip 4 Date


Short description Shows the date at which trip 4 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


290 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 10.050 Trip 4 Time
Short description Shows the time at which trip 4 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 235959
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00) (Display: 23:59:59)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Time Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.051 Trip 5 Date


Short description Shows the date at which trip 5 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.052 Trip 5 Time


Short description Shows the time at which trip 5 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 235959
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00) (Display: 23:59:59)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Time Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.053 Trip 6 Date


Short description Shows the date at which trip 6 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.054 Trip 6 Time


Short description Shows the time at which trip 6 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 235959
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00) (Display: 23:59:59)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Time Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 291
Parameter 10.055 Trip 7 Date
Short description Shows the date at which trip 7 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.056 Trip 7 Time


Short description Shows the time at which trip 7 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 235959
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00) (Display: 23:59:59)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Time Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.057 Trip 8 Date


Short description Shows the date at which trip 8 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.058 Trip 8 Time


Short description Shows the time at which trip 8 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 235959
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00) (Display: 23:59:59)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Time Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.059 Trip 9 Date


Short description Shows the date at which trip 9 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


292 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 10.060 Trip 9 Time
Short description Shows the time at which trip 9 occurred
Mode RFC‑A
0 235959
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00) (Display: 23:59:59)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Time Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.061 Braking Resistor Resistance


Short description Set to the resistance value of the braking resistor
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 10000.00
Default 0.00 Units Ω
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See Braking Resistor Rated Power (10.030).

Parameter 10.062 Low Load Detected Alarm


Short description Indicates that the low load alarm is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Low Load Detected Alarm (10.062) is set to one when the low load alarm is active. See Low Load Detection Level (04.027).

Parameter 10.063 Local Keypad Battery Low


Short description Indicates that the real time clock battery in the local keypad is low
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Local Keypad Battery Low (10.063) is set to one when a keypad is fitted to the front of the drive with an internal real-time clock and the battery is not
fitted or the voltage is below the minimum threshold.

Parameter 10.064 Remote Keypad Battery Low


Short description Indicates that the real time clock battery in the remote keypad is low
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Remote Keypad Battery Low (10.064) is set to one when a keypad is connected to the drive user comms port with an internal real-time clock and the
battery is not fitted or the voltage is below the minimum threshold.

Parameter 10.065 Auto-tune Active


Short description Indicates that an auto-tune sequence is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 293
Auto-tune Active (10.065) is set to one while an auto-tune sequence is active.

Parameter 10.066 Limit Switch Active


Short description Indicates that a limit switch is enabled and active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Limit Switch Active (10.066) is set to one when a limit switch is enabled and active.

Parameter 10.067 Fire Mode Active


Short description Indicates that fire mode is enabled and active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Fire Mode Active (10.067) is set to one when fire mode is enabled and active.

Parameter 10.068 Hold Drive Healthy on Under Voltage


Short description Set to hold drive healthy if the drive is in the under voltage state
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Hold Drive Healthy on Under Voltage (10.068) can be used to hold the drive healthy active (Drive Healthy (10.001) = 1 and not flash the status LED on
the front of the drive) when the drive is in the under voltage state (Under Voltage Active (10.016) = 1).

If Hold Drive Healthy on Under Voltage (10.068) = 0 and Under Voltage Active (10.016) = 1, then Drive Healthy (10.001) will be set to 0 and the status
LED on the front of the drive will flash.

If Hold Drive Healthy on Under Voltage (10.068) = 1, Under Voltage Active (10.016) = 1 and the drive is not tripped (i.e. Drive Status (10.101) does not
equal 9), then Drive Healthy (10.001) will be set to 1 and the status LED on the front of the drive will not flash.

If the drive is tripped then Drive Healthy (10.001) will be set to 0 and the status LED will flash independent of what Hold Drive Healthy on Under Voltage
(10.068) is set to.

Parameter 10.069 Additional Status Bits


Short description Shows the additional status bits for the drive
Mode RFC‑A
0 1023
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0000000000) (Display: 1111111111)
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

The bits in Additional Status Bits (10.069) mirror the status bits parameters as shown below. Where the parameters do not exist in any mode the bit
remains at zero.

Bit Status parameter


0 Under Voltage Active (10.016)
1 Motor Overload Alarm (10.017) or Inductor Overload Alarm (10.017)
2 Drive Over-temperature Alarm (10.018)
3 Drive Warning (10.019)
4 Low Load Detected Alarm (10.062)
5 Local Keypad Battery Low (10.063)
6 Remote Keypad Battery Low (10.064)
7 Auto-tune Active (10.065)
8 Limit Switch Active (10.066)
9 Fire Mode Active (10.067)

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


294 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 10.070 Trip 0 Sub-trip Number
Short description Shows the sub-trip number for trip 0
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.071 Trip 1 Sub-trip Number


Short description Shows the sub-trip number for trip 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.072 Trip 2 Sub-trip Number


Short description Shows the sub-trip number for trip 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.073 Trip 3 Sub-trip Number


Short description Shows the sub-trip number for trip 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.074 Trip 4 Sub-trip Number


Short description Shows the sub-trip number for trip 4
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.075 Trip 5 Sub-trip Number


Short description Shows the sub-trip number for trip 5
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 295
Parameter 10.076 Trip 6 Sub-trip Number
Short description Shows the sub-trip number for trip 6
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.077 Trip 7 Sub-trip Number


Short description Shows the sub-trip number for trip 7
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.078 Trip 8 Sub-trip Number


Short description Shows the sub-trip number for trip 8
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.079 Trip 9 Sub-trip Number


Short description Shows the sub-trip number for trip 9
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

See Trip 0 (10.020).

Parameter 10.080 Stop Motor


Short description Indicates that the motor is being stopped before the drive trips
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

It is possible for some trips to cause the motor to stop before the trip is initiated (see Action On Trip Detection (10.037)). During the period while the
motor is being stopped before the trip is initiated Stop Motor (10.080) is set to one. Once the motor stops Stop Motor (10.080) is set back to zero.

Parameter 10.081 Phase Loss


Short description Indicates that the drive has detected an input phase loss
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

If phase loss or imbalance is detected that would initiate a phase loss trip with sub-trip 0, i.e. Phase Loss.000, then Phase Loss (10.081) is set to one.
Either the motor will be stopped and the drive tripped or the drive will continue to operate normally until the user stops the motor and the drive trips (see

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


296 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Action On Trip Detection (10.037)). In either case Phase Loss (10.081) is set to one when the phase loss condition is detected and remains set until the
drive trips.

Parameter 10.082 Miscellaneous Status Flags


Short description Shows additional status flags
Mode RFC‑A
0 65535
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0000000000000000) (Display: 1111111111111111)
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background Write
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

This parameter provides miscellaneous status flags that are not included as individual parameters.

Open-loop and RFC-A mode:


All flags are unsed.

RFC-S Mode:

Bit Status Indication


Indicates when the motor torque limit is active. This is a limit
defined by the motor parameters, Rated Voltage (05.009) and
the frequency being applied to the motor. The drive attempts to
0 prevent loss of control which would occur by exceeding the
maximum torque limit of the motor by imposing a limit at a level
slightly below the actual limit of the motor. This limit is only active
if Enable High Speed Mode (05.022) is set to -2 or 2.
1-15 Unused.

Parameter 10.101 Drive Status


Short description Shows the present status of the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 16
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

Value Text
0 Inhibit
1 Ready
2 Stop
3 Scan
4 Run
5 Supply Loss
6 Deceleration
7 dc Injection
8 Position
9 Trip
10 Active
11 Off
12 Hand
13 Auto
14 Heat
15 Under Voltage
16 Phasing

Drive Status (10.101) shows the present status of the drive. The strings from this parameter are also used by the basic keypad to provide the status
display text.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 297
Parameter 10.102 Trip Reset Source
Short description Indicates whether a trip in the trip log has been reset.
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1023
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

The bits in Trip Reset Source (10.102) correspond to each of the trips in the trip log (i.e. bit 0 corresponds to trip 0, bit 1 corresponds to trip 1, etc.).
When a trip occurs, bit 0 is set to one and the other bits corresponding to the trips already in the trip log are shifted left one bit. If the trip is reset then bit
0 is set back to zero, otherwise if a higher priority trip occurs bit 0 is shifted left by one bit. The result is that each of the bits in Trip Reset Source
(10.102) show whether trips in the trip log were reset or moved up the trip log by a higher priority trip.

Parameter 10.103 Trip Time Identifier


Short description Shows time in milliseconds since the drive powered up when a trip occurred
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units ms
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Write on trip
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

When a trip occurs the time in milliseconds since the drive powered up is stored in Trip Time Identifier (10.103). The time rolls-over when it reaches
231 - 1, but if the time is 0 a value of 1 is written. Trip Time Identifier (10.103) can be used to determine when a new trip has occurred as the value will
change (unless there were exactly 232ms between trips) and will be non-zero.

Parameter 10.104 Active Alarm


Short description Shows the value of the active alarm
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 12
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

Value Text
0 None
1 Brake Resistor
2 Motor Overload
3 Ind Overload
4 Drive Overload
5 Auto Tune
6 Limit Switch
7 Fire Mode
8 Low Load
9 Option Slot 1
10 Option Slot 2
11 Option Slot 3
12 Option Slot 4

If there is no alarm then Active Alarm (10.104) = 0. If one alarm is active then Active Alarm (10.104) shows the value of the alarm. If more than one
alarm is active then Active Alarm (10.104) shows the active alarm with the lowest value. The strings from this parameter are also used by the basic
keypad to provide the status display text except for option slot warnings where the option module may supply the string.

Parameter 10.105 Hand Off Auto State


Short description Shows the state of the hand/off/auto system
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


298 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Value Text
0 Not Active
1 Off
2 Hand
3 Auto

See Hand/Off/Auto Operating Mode (01.052) for details of the hand/off/auto system. Hand Off Auto State (10.105) shows the state of this system and is
used at power-up to restore the previous state if required.

Parameter 10.106 Potential Drive Damage Conditions


Short description Indicates that the user has put the drive in a condition that could potentially damage the drive
Mode RFC‑A
0 15
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0000) (Display: 1111)
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Background write
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

The bits in Potential Drive Damage Conditions (10.106) are set under the conditions shown in the table below to indicate that the user has put the
drive in a condition that could potentially damage the drive. The bits in this parameter cannot be cleared by users.

Potential Drive Damage Conditions


Condition
(10.106) bit

0 Fire mode has been active. See Fire Mode Reference (01.053).

Low Under Voltage Threshold (06.066) has been reduced from its


1
default value.

High speed RFC-S mode has been used.


2
See Enable High Speed Mode (05.022).

3 Not used.

Parameter 10.107 Auto-tune State


Short description Shows progress through auto-tuning
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 9
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text
0 Not Active
1 Resistance
2 pLs
3 Ls
4 Flux
5 Flux Repeat
6 Ld Lq No-load
7 Lq
8 Ke
9 Inertia

Auto-tune State (10.107) is zero unless an auto-tune is active when it shows the current state of the auto-tune sequence as follows:

Parameter value Auto-tune state


1 Stator resistance measurement
2 Transient inductance measurement
3 Stator inductance measurement
9 Inertia measurement

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 299
Menu 11 Single Line Descriptions − Miscellaneous
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


300 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter Range Default Type
Not Active (0), Slot 1 (1),
11.001 Option Synchronisation Select Slot 2 (2), Slot 3 (3), Slot 4 (4), Slot 4 (4) RW Txt US
Automatic (5)
Not Active (0), Slot 1 (1),
11.002 Option synchronisation Active RO Txt ND NC PT
Slot 2 (2), Slot 3 (3), Slot 4 (4)
11.018 Status Mode Parameter 1 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
11.019 Status Mode Parameter 2 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
11.021 Parameter 00.030 Scaling 0.000 to 10.000 1.000 RW Num US
11.022 Parameter Displayed At Power‑up 0.000 to 0.080 0.010 RW Num PT US
11.028 Drive Derivative 0 to 255 RO Num ND NC PT
11.029 Software Version 0 to 99999999 RO Num ND NC PT
11.030 User Security Code 0 to 2147483647 RW Num ND NC PT US
Open‑loop (1), RFC‑A (2),
11.031 User Drive Mode RW Txt ND NC PT
RFC‑S (3), Regen (4)
11.032 Maximum Heavy Duty Rating 0.000 to 99999.999 A RO Num ND NC PT
200V (0), 400V (1), 575V (2),
11.033 Drive Rated Voltage RO Txt ND NC PT
690V (3)
11.034 Software Sub‑version 0 to 99 RO Num ND NC PT
11.035 Number Of Power Modules Test -1 to 20 -1 RW Num US
11.036 NV Media Card File Previously Loaded 0 to 999 0 RO Num NC PT
11.037 NV Media Card File Number 0 to 999 0 RW Num
None (0), Open‑loop (1),
11.038 NV Media Card File Type RFC‑A (2), RFC‑S (3), RO Txt ND NC PT
Regen (4), User Prog (5)
11.039 NV Media Card File Version 0 to 9999 RO Num ND NC PT
11.040 NV Media Card File Checksum -2147483648 to 2147483647 RO Num ND NC PT
None (0), Read (1),
11.042 Parameter Cloning None (0) RW Txt NC US
Program (2), Auto (3), Boot (4)
11.043 Load Defaults None (0), Standard (1), US (2) None (0) RW Txt NC
Menu 0 (0), All Menus (1),
Read‑only Menu 0 (2),
11.044 User Security Status RW Txt ND PT
Read‑only (3), Status Only (4),
No Access (5)
11.045 Select Motor 2 Parameters Motor 1 (0), Motor 2 (1) Motor 1 (0) RW Txt US
11.046 Defaults Previously Loaded 0 to 2000 RO Num ND NC PT US
Reset And Run (-1), Stop (0),
11.047 Onboard User Program: Enable Run (1) RW Txt US
Run (1)
11.048 Onboard User Program: Status -2147483648 to 2147483647 RO Num ND NC PT
11.049 Onboard User Program: Programming Events 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT
11.050 Onboard User Program: Freewheeling Tasks Per Second 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT
11.051 Onboard User Program: Clock Task Time Used 0.0 to 100.0 % RO Num ND NC PT
11.052 Serial Number LS 000000000 to 999999999 RO Num ND NC PT
11.053 Serial Number MS 0 to 999999999 RO Num ND NC PT
11.054 Drive Date Code 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT
11.055 Onboard User Program: Clock Task Scheduled Interval 0 to 262140 ms RO Num ND NC PT
1234 (0), 1243 (1), 1324 (2),
1342 (3), 1423 (4), 1432 (5),
4123 (6), 3124 (7), 4132 (8),
2134 (9), 3142 (10), 2143 (11),
11.056 Option Slot Identifiers 1234 (0) RW Txt PT
3412 (12), 4312 (13), 2413 (14),
4213 (15), 2314 (16), 3214 (17),
2341 (18), 2431 (19), 3241 (20),
3421 (21), 4231 (22), 4321 (23)
11.060 Maximum Rated Current 0.000 to 99999.999 A RO Num ND NC PT
11.061 Full Scale Current Kc 0.000 to 99999.999 A RO Num ND NC PT
11.062 Power Board Software Version Number 0.00 to 99.99 RO Num ND NC PT
11.063 Product Type 0 to 255 RO Num ND NC PT
11.064 Product Identifier Characters 1295462448 to 2147483647 RO Num ND NC PT
11.065 Drive Rating And Configuration 00000000 to 99999999 RO Num ND NC PT
11.066 Power Stage Identifier 0 to 255 RO Num ND NC PT
11.067 Control Board Identifier 0.000 to 65.535 RO Num ND NC PT
11.068 Internal I/O Identifier 0 to 255 RO Num ND NC PT
11.069 Position Feedback Interface Identifier 0 to 255 RO Num ND NC PT
11.070 Core Parameter Database Version 0.00 to 99.99 RO Num ND NC PT
11.071 Number Of Power Modules Detected 0 to 20 RO Num ND NC PT US
11.072 NV Media Card Create Special File 0 to 1 0 RW Num NC

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 301
None (0), SMART Card (1),
11.073 NV Media Card Type RO Txt ND NC PT
SD Card (2)
11.075 NV Media Card Read‑only Flag Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
11.076 NV Media Card Warning Suppression Flag Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
11.077 NV Media Card File Required Version 0 to 9999 RW Num ND NC PT
11.079 Drive Name Characters 1‑4 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
11.080 Drive Name Characters 5‑8 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
11.081 Drive Name Characters 9‑12 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
11.082 Drive Name Characters 13‑16 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
Open‑loop (1), RFC‑A (2),
11.084 Drive Mode RO Txt ND NC PT US
RFC‑S (3), Regen (4)
None (0), Read‑only (1),
11.085 Security Status RO Txt ND NC PT PS
Status‑only (2), No Access (3)
11.086 Menu Access Status Menu 0 (0), All Menus (1) RO Txt ND NC PT PS
11.090 Keypad Port Serial Address 1 to 16 1 RW Num US
11.091 Additional Identifier Characters 1 -2147483648 to 2147483647 RO Num ND NC PT
11.092 Additional Identifier Characters 2 -2147483648 to 2147483647 RO Num ND NC PT
11.093 Additional Identifier Characters 3 -2147483648 to 2147483647 RO Num ND NC PT
11.095 Number Of Rectifiers Detected 0 to 9 RO Num ND NC PT
11.096 Number Of Rectifiers Expected 0 to 9 0 RW Num US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


302 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 11 − Miscellaneous
Mode: RFC‑A

Menu 11 provides parameters for the following features:

1. General drive set-up and identification


2. Serial communications interface
3. Non-volatile media card access
4. Onboard user programming

Non-Volatile Media Card Support

The drive supports two types of non-volatile media cards; smart cards and FAT formatted SD cards.

The NV Media Card can be used for:

Parameter copying between drives


Saving drive parameter sets
Saving an onboard user program
Storing of onboard scope data (SD card only)

The NV Media Card can be used to store drive parameter sets and/or PLC programs set from the drive in data blocks 001 to 499 on the card.

The Unidrive M is compatible with a Unidrive SP smart card and is able to read and translate the Unidrive SP parameter set into a compatible
parameter set for Unidrive M. This is only possible if the Unidrive SP parameter set was transferred to the smart card using the difference from defaults
transfer method (i.e. 4yyy transfer). The Unidrive M is not able to read any other type of Unidrive SP data block on the card. Although it is possible to
transfer difference from default data blocks from a Unidrive SP into the Unidrive M, the following should be noted:

1. If a parameter from the source drive does not exist in the target drive then no data is transferred for that parameter.
2. If the data for the parameter in the target drive is out of range then the data is limited to the range of the target parameter.
3. If the target drive has a different rating to the source drive then the normal rules for this type of transfer apply.

SD Card File system layout

The folder <MCDF/> ("Motor Control Data Files") must be present on a FAT-formatted SD card. Other folders can be added, but this folder and its
contents must not be altered. This folder structure is created when a Card Error trip is reset. The drive will place files in a <MCDF/> folder in the card
root. When individual items are saved by the drive (e.g. drive parameters or a user program), this will generate a numbered file in the root of this folder;
the number is that specified in the triggering command, and this number must be specified in the command used to restore the item from the file. This is
equivalent functionality to that provided on a smart card. When saving a parameter file, in addition to the drive parameters, the drive will also read the
option parameters from each of the installed options, and include those that have changed in the parameter file.

Changing the drive mode

If the source drive mode is different from the target drive mode then the mode will be changed to the source drive mode before the parameters are
transferred. If the required drive mode is outside the allowed range for the target then a Card Drive Mode trip is initiated and no data is transferred.

Different voltage ratings

If the voltage rating of the source and target drives is different then all parameters except those that are rating dependent are transferred to the target
drive. The rating dependent parameters are left at their default values. After the parameters have been transferred and saved to non-volatile memory a
Card Rating trip is given as a warning. The table below gives a list of the rating dependent parameters.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 303
Parameters
Standard Ramp Voltage (02.008)
Voltage Set-point (03.005)
Reactive Power Input kVAR (03.020)
Regen Supply Loss a.c. Level (03.023)
Regen Minimum Voltage (03.026)
Regen Maximum Voltage (03.027)
Supply Voltage (03.028)
Motoring Current Limit / Power From Supply Current Limit (04.005)
M2 Motoring Current Limit / M2 Power From Supply Current Limit (21.027)
Regenerating Current Limit / Power To Supply Current Limit (04.006)
M2 Regenerating Current Limit / M2 Power To Supply Current Limit (21.028)
Symmetrical Current Limit (04.007)
M2 Symmetrical Current Limit (21.029)
User Current Maximum Scaling (04.024)
Rated Current (05.007)
M2 Rated Current (21.007)
Rated Voltage (05.009)
M2 Rated Voltage (21.009)
Rated Power Factor (05.010)
M2 Rated Power Factor (21.010)
Stator Resistance (05.017)
M2 Stator Resistance (21.012)
Maximum Switching Frequency (05.018)
Transient Inductance /Ld (05.024)
M2 Transient Inductance /Ld (21.014)
Stator Inductance (05.025)
M2 Stator Inductance (21.024)
No-load Lq (05.068)
M2 No-load Lq (21.041)
Rated Load Lq (05.069)
M2 Rated Load Lq (21.042)
No-load Phase Offset (05.070)
M2 No-load Phase Offset (21.043)
Rated Load Phase Offset (05.071)
M2 Rated Load Phase Offset (21.044)
Maximum Low Speed Sensorless Mode Current (05.072)
M2 Maximum Low Speed Sensorless Mode Current (05.045)
Injection Braking Level (06.006)
Supply Loss Detection Level (06.048)
Braking IGBT Lower Threshold (06.073)
Braking IGBT Upper Threshold (06.074)
Low Voltage Braking IGBT Threshold (06.075)

Different option modules fitted

If the Option ID Code (MM.001) is different for any option module fitted to the source drive compared to the destination drive then the parameters for the
set-up and application menus for that option module are not transferred, but the parameters are set to their default values. After the parameters have
been transferred and saved to non-volatile memory a {Card Option} trip is given as a warning

Different current ratings

If any of the current rating parameters (Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032), Maximum Rated Current (11.060) or Full Scale Current Kc (11.061)) are
different between the source and target then all parameters are still written to the target drive, but some may be limited by their allowed range. To give
similar performance in the target compared to the source drive the speed and current controller gains are modified as shown below.

Gains Multiplier

Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010)
Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1 (03.011)
Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp2 (03.013)
Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki2 (03.014) [Source Full Scale Current Kc (11.061)] / [Target Full Scale Current Kc (11.061)]

M2 Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp (21.017)
M2 Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki (21.018)

Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013)
Current Controller Ki Gain (04.014)
[Target Full Scale Current Kc (11.061)] / [Source Full Scale Current Kc (11.061)]
M2 Current Controller Kp Gain (21.022)
M2 Current Controller Ki Gain (21.023)

Different variable maximums

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


304 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
It should be noted that if ratings of the source and target drives are different, or the option modules fitted to the source and target drives are different, it
is possible that some parameters with variable maximums may be limited and not have the same values as in the source drive.

Macro files

Macro files are created in the same way as parameter files except that NV Media Card Create Special File (11.072) must be set to 1 before the file is
created on the NV media card. NV Media Card Create Special File (11.072) is set to zero after the file has been created or the transfer fails. When a
macro file is transferred to a drive the drive mode is not changed even if the actual mode is different to that in the file and defaults are not loaded before
the parameters are copied from the file to the drive. The first three identification bytes at the start of a macro file are “MAC”.

Onboard user program files

Onboard user program files are created with Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) = 5xxx and the onboard user program image is transferred to the NV media
card. The onboard user program image can be loaded from an onboard user program file with Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) = 6xxx. If the drive does
not have an onboard user program loaded when the onboard user program file is created then a file is created with an empty image. If this file is then
transferred to a drive with an onboard user program loaded, the onboard user program will be erased.

Option module applications file

An option module applications file is intended to hold user program from an applications module. An option module applications file from the option
module in slot 1 can be created with Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) = 15xxx. An option module applications file can be transferred from an option module
in slot 1 to an option module applications file with Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) = 18xxx. If the transfer fails because the option module does not
respond correctly a Card Slot trip is initiated where the sub-trip number is 1 (i.e. the option module slot number). Transfer to and from other option slots
are initiated with other codes in Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) as defined previously.

Parameter 11.001 Option Synchronisation Select


Short description Option Synchronisation Select
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5
Default 4 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Not Active
1 Slot 1
2 Slot 2
3 Slot 3
4 Slot 4
5 Automatic

Option Synchronisation Select (11.001) is used to select and enable timing synchronisation between the communications system associated with an
option module fitted to the drive and the drive control system. If "Not Active" is selected then the drive control system operates using it's own processor
crystal for control sample timing. If one of the option modules is selected and is making a request to provide synchronisation then the drive control
sample timing will be synchronised to the communication system. Option synchronisation Active (11.002) shows the synchronisation source, where "Not
Active" indicates that the drive is providing the timing for the control system. Any other value indicates if an option module is providing synchronisation.
If required the synchronisation source can be selected automatically by setting Option Synchronisation Select (11.001) to "Automatic". In this case the
option module in the lowest numbered slot that is making a request to provide synchronisation will be selected.

Parameter 11.002 Option synchronisation Active


Short description Option synchronisation Active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background Write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text
0 Not Active
1 Slot 1
2 Slot 2
3 Slot 3
4 Slot 4

See Option Synchronisation Select (11.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 305
Parameter 11.018 Status Mode Parameter 1
Short description Defines the parameter displayed on the upper row of the keypad when in status mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter Displayed At Power-up (11.022).

Parameter 11.019 Status Mode Parameter 2


Short description Defines the parameter displayed on the lower row of the keypad when in status mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter Displayed At Power-up (11.022).

Parameter 11.021 Parameter 00.030 Scaling


Short description Defines the scaling for Pr 00.030
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 10.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

Parameter 00.030 Scaling (11.021) defines the scaling applied to parameter 00.030 when it is displayed on a basic keypad. The scaling is only applied
in the status and view modes. If the parameter is edited via the keypad it reverts to its unscaled value during editing.

Parameter 11.022 Parameter Displayed At Power-up


Short description Defines which parameter is displayed at power-up
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 0.080
Default 0.010 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT

If Status Mode Parameter 1 (11.018) and Status Mode Parameter 2 (11.019) are set to zero, then Parameter Displayed At Power-up (11.022) defines
which Menu 0 parameter is initially displayed at power-up. If Status Mode Parameter 1 (11.018) or Status Mode Parameter 2 (11.019) are set to valid
parameter numbers, then Parameter Displayed At Power-up (11.022) defines the active parameter at power-up, i.e. the parameter first displayed when
going in to parameter view mode on the keypad. Status Mode Parameter 1 (11.018) and Status Mode Parameter 2 (11.019) define the parameter
values to be displayed on the upper and lower rows of the keypad repectively, when in status mode. If only one of these parameters is set correctly the
other row will display the value of the current active parameter. If both Status Mode Parameter 1 (11.018) and Status Mode Parameter 2 (11.019) are
set to the same parameter number then the parameter value is displayed as double height characters.

Parameter 11.028 Drive Derivative


Short description Displays the drive derivative identifier
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

Drive Derivative (11.028) shows the derivative identifier.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


306 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 11.029 Software Version
Short description Displays the software version in the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 99999999
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Version Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Software Version (11.029) displays the drive software version number as a decimal number wwxxyyzz. A keypad will display the value in this parameter
as ww.xx.yy.zz.

Parameter 11.030 User Security Code


Short description Defines the user security code of the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, ND, NC, PT

See User Security Status (11.044).

Parameter 11.031 User Drive Mode


Short description Defines the mode of the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 4
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text
1 Open-loop
2 RFC-A
3 RFC-S
4 Regen

User Drive Mode (11.031) is set to the current drive mode at power-up. The user can change the drive mode as follows:

1. Set Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) to 1253, 1254, 1255 or 1256


2. Change User Drive Mode (11.031) to the required mode
3. Initiate a drive reset

Provided Drive Active (10.002) = 0 the drive will change to the new drive mode, and then load and save parameters to non-volatile memory.
If Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) is not set to one of the specified values then the drive mode does not change on drive reset. The value in Parameter
mm.000 (mm.000) determines which defaults are loaded as follows.

Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) Defaults loaded


1253 50Hz defaults to all menus
1254 60Hz defaults to all menus
1255 50Hz defaults to all menus except 15 to 20 and 24 to 28
1256 60Hz defaults to all menus except 15 to 20 and 24 to 28

Parameter 11.032 Maximum Heavy Duty Rating


Short description Displays the maximum heavy duty current rating of the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 99999.999
Default Units A
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032) defines the maximum setting for Rated Current (05.007) that gives heavy duty operation. If
Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032) = 0.000 then heavy duty operation is not possible. If Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032) =
VM_RATED_CURRENT[MAX] then normal duty operation is not possible.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 307
Parameter 11.033 Drive Rated Voltage
Short description Displays the voltage rating of the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text
0 200V
1 400V
2 575V
3 690V

Drive Rated Voltage (11.033) shows the voltage rating of the drive.

Parameter 11.034 Software Sub-version


Short description Software Sub-version
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 99
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up Write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

For legacy applications Software Sub-version (11.034) shows the yy part of Software Version (11.029).

Parameter 11.035 Number Of Power Modules Test


Short description Tests the number of power modules within the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -1 Maximum 20
Default -1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Number Of Power Modules Detected (11.071) shows the number of power modules detected in the drive when communications with the power system
is established. The number of modules can be checked and a trip initiated depending on the value of Number Of Power Modules Test (11.035) as
follows:

Number Of Power Modules Test


Test Trip if test fails
(11.035)
The number of modules detected is compared to the value in Configuration.mmm where mmm is the value
-1 Number Of Power Modules Detected (11.071) before it is updated of Number Of Power Modules Detected
with the number of modules present (11.071) before it is updated
0 None None
The number of modules detected is compared to the value in Configuration.mmm where mmm is the value
>0
Number Of Power Modules Test (11.035) of Number Of Power Modules Test (11.035)

If Number Of Power Modules Test (11.035) = -1 a test is being carried out to see if the number of modules detected has changed.
Number Of Power Modules Detected (11.071) is a user save parameter, and so on power-up the number of modules can be compared with the number
last saved when the system last powered up correctly.

If Number Of Power Modules Test (11.035) > 0 the expected number of modules are stored in Number Of Power Modules Test (11.035), and if the
number powering up successfully changes then this can be detected.

The sub-trip number always indicates the expected number of power modules. The actual number detected can always be seen in
Number Of Power Modules Detected (11.071).

Parameter 11.036 NV Media Card File Previously Loaded


Short description Displays the number of the last parameter file transferred from an NV Media Card to the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 999
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, NC, PT

NV Media Card File Previously Loaded (11.036) shows the number of the last parameter file transferred from an NV Media Card to the drive. If defaults
are subsequently reloaded NV Media Card File Previously Loaded (11.036) is set to 0.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


308 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 11.037 NV Media Card File Number
Short description Selects a file by its file identification number
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 999
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

NV Media Card File Number (11.037) is used to select a file by its file identification number. When NV Media Card File Number (11.037) corresponds to
the number of a file the following data about the file is shown.

Parameter
NV Media Card File Type (11.038)
NV Media Card File Version (11.039)
NV Media Card File Checksum (11.040)

The actions of erasing a card, erasing a file, creating a new file, changing a Menu 0 parameter or removing a card resets NV Media Card File Number
(11.037) to 0.

Parameter 11.038 NV Media Card File Type


Short description Displays the file type of the file selected
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text
0 None
1 Open-loop
2 RFC-A
3 RFC-S
4 Regen
5 User Prog

NV Media Card File Type (11.038) shows the file type of the file selected with NV Media Card File Number (11.037) as shown in the table below.

NV Media Card File Type (11.038) File


0 No file selected
1 Open-loop mode parameter file
2 RFC-A mode parameter file
3 RFC-S mode parameter file
4 Regen mode parameter file
5 Onboard user program file

Parameter 11.039 NV Media Card File Version


Short description Displays the version number stored with the file selected
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 9999
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

NV Media Card File Version (11.039) shows the version number stored with the file selected with NV Media Card File Number (11.037).

To set a file version number on a NV media card, the number required must be set in NV Media Card File Required Version (11.077) and then the data
must be written to the NV media card. Failure to do this will result in no version number being displayed when selecting the NV media card file number
in NV Media Card File Number (11.037).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 309
Parameter 11.040 NV Media Card File Checksum
Short description Displays the checksum from the file selected
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

NV Media Card File Checksum (11.040) shows the checksum from the file selected with NV Media Card File Number (11.037). If the media file is a
Unidrive SP SMARTCARD file, the checksum is the sum of all bytes except the checksum modulo 65536. If the file was generated by a Unidrive M, a
value of zero will be displayed.

Parameter 11.042 Parameter Cloning


Short description Can be used to initiate a data transfer to or from an NV media card
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, NC

Value Text
0 None
1 Read
2 Program
3 Auto
4 Boot

* Only a value of 3 or 4 in this parameter is saved.

Parameter Cloning (11.042) can also be used to initiate data transfer to or from an NV media card as described below for each possible value of this
parameter.

1: Read
Provided a parameter file with file identification number 1 exists on the NV media card then setting Parameter Cloning (11.042) = 1 and initiating a drive
reset will transfer the parameter data to the drive (i.e. the same action as writing 6001 to Parameter mm.000 (mm.000)). When the action is complete
Parameter Cloning (11.042) is automatically reset to zero.

2: Program
Setting Parameter Cloning (11.042) = 2 and initiating a drive reset will transfer the parameter data from the drive to a parameter file with file
identification number 1. This is the same action as writing 4001 to Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) except that the file will be overwritten if it already exists.
When the action is complete Parameter Cloning (11.042) is automatically reset to zero.

3: Auto
Setting Parameter Cloning (11.042) = 3 and initiating a drive reset will transfer the parameter data from the drive to a parameter file with file
identification number 1. This is the same action as writing 4001 to Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) except that the file will be overwritten if it already exists.
When the action is complete Parameter Cloning (11.042) remains at 3. It should be noted that if the drive is to remain in Auto mode after power-down
and subsequent power-up a parameter save is required, unless Parameter Cloning (11.042) is being accessed from Menu 0, in which case it will be
saved automatically.

If the card is removed when Parameter Cloning (11.042) = 3, then Parameter Parameter Cloning (11.042) is set to 0, which forces the user to change
Parameter Cloning (11.042) back to 3 if auto mode is still required. The user will need to set Parameter Cloning (11.042) = 3 and initiate a drive reset to
write the complete parameter set to the new card.

When a parameter in Menu zero is changed via the keypad and Parameter Cloning (11.042) = 3 the parameter is saved both to the drive non-volatile
memory and to the parameter file with identification number 1 on the card. Only the new value of the modified parameter, and not the value of all the
other drive parameters, is stored each time. If the drive did not automatically clear Parameter Cloning (11.042) when a card is removed, then when a
new card is inserted that contains a parameter file with identification number 1 the modified parameter would be written to the existing file on the new
card and the rest of the parameters in this file may not be the same as those in the drive.

When Parameter Cloning (11.042) = 3 and the drive parameters are saved to non-volatile memory, the file on the card is also updated, therefore this file
becomes a copy of the drive parameters. At power up, if Parameter Cloning (11.042) = 3, the drive will save its complete parameter set to the card. This
is done to ensure that if a card is inserted whilst the drive is powered down the new card will have the correct data after the drive is powered up again.

4: Boot
When Parameter Cloning (11.042) = 4 the drive operates in a similar way to Parameter Cloning (11.042) = 3 and automatically creates a copy of its
parameters on the NV Media card. The NC (not clonable) attribute for Parameter Cloning (11.042) is 1, and so it does not have a value stored in the
parameter file on the card in the normal way. However, the value of Parameter Cloning (11.042) is held in the parameter file header. If
Parameter Cloning (11.042) = 4 in the parameter file with a file identification value of 1 on an NV media card fitted to a drive at power-up then the
parameters from the parameter file with file identification number 1 are transferred to the drive and then saved in non-volatile memory.
Parameter Cloning (11.042) is then set to 0 after the data transfer is complete.

It is possible to create a bootable parameter file by setting Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) = 2001 and initiating a drive reset. This file is created in one
operation and is not updated when further parameter changes are made.

When the drive is powered up it detects which option modules are fitted before loading parameters from an NV media card which has been set up for
boot mode. If a new option module has been fitted since the last time the drive was powered up, a Slot1 Different trip is initiated and then the
parameters are transferred from the card. If the parameter file includes the parameters for the newly fitted option module then these are also transferred
Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide
310 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
to the drive and the Slot1 Different trip is reset. If the parameter file does not include the parameters for the newly fitted option module then the drive
does not reset the Slot1 Different trip. Once the transfer is complete the drive parameters are saved to non-volatile memory. The trip can be reset either
by initiating a drive reset or by powering down and then powering up again.

Parameter 11.043 Load Defaults


Short description Defines which defaults are to be loaded into the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, NC

Value Text
0 None
1 Standard
2 US

If Load Defaults (11.043) is non-zero and a drive reset is initiated then the drive will load and save default parameters. If Load Defaults (11.043) = 1
then 50Hz defaults are loaded and if Load Defaults (11.043) = 2 then 60Hz defaults are loaded. This parameter has priority over actions defined by
Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) and Parameter Cloning (11.042). If Load Defaults (11.043) is used to initiate loading defaults the it is cleared along with
Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) and Parameter Cloning (11.042) when the action is completed.

Parameter 11.044 User Security Status


Short description Defines the security level within the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, ND, PT

Value Text
0 Menu 0
1 All Menus
2 Read-only Menu 0
3 Read-only
4 Status Only
5 No Access

Security

The drive provides a number of different levels of security that can be set by the user via User Security Status (11.044); these are shown in the table
below.

Security User Security Status


Description
Level (11.044)
Menu 0 All writable parameters are available to be edited but only parameters in Menu 0 are visible. 0
All menus All writable parameters are visible and available to be edited. 1
Read-only
All parameters are read-only. Access is limited to Menu 0 parameters only. 2
Menu 0
Read-only All parameters are read-only however all menus and parameters are visible. 3
Status only The keypad remains in status mode and no parameters can be viewed or edited 4
The keypad remains in status mode and no parameters can be viewed or edited. Drive parameters cannot be
No access 5
accessed via serial comms.

When security has been set up the drive can either be in the locked or unlocked state. In the locked state the security level that has been set up applies.
In the unlocked state the security is not active, but when the drive is powered down and powered up again the drive will be in the locked state. The drive
may be relocked without powering down by selecting the required security level with the User Security Status (11.044) and initiating a drive reset.

Security can be set up as follows:

1. The User Security Code (11.030) should be set to the desired security unlock code (not zero). For security to remain set after power
down then a parameter save should be performed to retain the set value.
2. If no further action is taken when the drive is powered down and then powered up read-only security will be set up and locked.
3. If at any time the User Security Status (11.044) is set to a value corresponding the one of the security levels shown in the table above
and a drive reset is performed the security level is changed to that level. The desired security level is automatically saved and retained
after power down, the keypad state changes to status mode and security is locked. (The security level that is active, provided
User Security Code (11.030) has been saved as a non-zero value, is shown in Security Status (11.085).)

When security is set up and locked:

1. Parameter access is restricted as shown in the table above.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 311
2. User Security Code (11.030) reads as zero except in parameter edit mode. Therefore it is not possible to read the value of the security
code when any level of security is active and locked.

Security can be unlocked as follows:

1. If read-only security is set and locked then any attempt to edit any read/write parameter causes "Security code" to be displayed on the
first row of the display. When the Up or Down keys are pressed the second row shows the code being adjusted. On setting the code the
user presses the Enter key. If the correct code has been entered then the drive switches to Parameter edit mode on the parameter the
user selected to edit, but if the correct code has not been entered the notification "Incorrect security code" is displayed for 2s and the
drive returns to Parameter view mode.
2. If Status only or No access security is set and locked then any attempt to leave status mode causes the security code to be requested
as per the process described above. The security code entered must be correct for the keypad state machine to switch to the
Parameter view mode. It is then possible to access all parameters normally.

Security can be cleared as follows:

1. Security must be unlocked.


2. The User Security Code (11.030) should be set to zero. For security to remain cleared after power down then a parameter save should
be performed.

At any time Security Status (11.085) can be changed between 0 and 1 to restrict access to Menu 0 alone or to all menus. If the change is made by a
keypad the new value becomes active on leaving parameter edit mode.

It should be noted that Security Status (11.085) is a volatile parameter and that the actual state of the security system is stored in Security Status
(11.085) and Menu Access Status (11.086), which are both power-down save parameters. Therefore the security status will be stored when the drive
goes into the under-voltage state. If the drive is already in the under-voltage state the security state should be saved by writing 1001 to Parameter
mm.000 (mm.000) and initiating a reset.

Parameter 11.045 Select Motor 2 Parameters


Short description Set to 1 to select motor 2 parameters
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Motor 1
1 Motor 2

Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) is used to select the motor map 2 parameters from Menu 21 to be substituted for the standard motor parameters. If
Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) is modified when Drive Active (10.002) = 1 the change only becomes effective when Drive Active (10.002) = 0.
When Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) = 1 the results from auto-tuning are written to the motor map 2 parameters in Menu 21 instead of being
written to the standard parameters. Each time Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) is changed Motor Protection Accumulator (04.019) is reset to zero.
Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) operates in the same way in Regen mode, but Inductor Protection Accumulator (04.019) is reset to zero each time
the value is changed. Motor 2 Active (21.015) shows the motor map that is active.

Parameter 11.046 Defaults Previously Loaded


Short description Displays the defaults previously loaded in the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2000
Default Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Defaults Previously Loaded (11.046) shows the value used to load the previously loaded defaults (i.e. 1233 for 50Hz defaults, or 1244 for 60Hz
defaults).

Parameter 11.047 Onboard User Program: Enable


Short description Enables the onboard user program
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -1 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
-1 Reset And Run
0 Stop
1 Run

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


312 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Onboard user programming provided a background task that loops continuously and a timed task that is executed each time at a defined rate.
Onboard User Program: Enable (11.047) allows the onboard user program to be controlled as follows:.

-1: Reset And Run


The onboard user program will run. If Onboard User Program: Enable (11.047) is changed from 0 (Stop) to -1 (Reset And Run) all variables will be reset
to their initial values and the user program will run from the start.

0: Stop
The onboard user program is stopped.

1: Run
The onboard user program will run. If Onboard User Program: Enable (11.047) is changed from 0 (Stop) to 1 (Run) all variables will be unchanged and
the user program will run from the start.

The effect of the above is as follows:

If the drive powers up with Onboard User Program: Enable (11.047) set to either 1 or -1 then all variables will be reset to their initial values
before the user program starts.
If the drive powers up with Onboard User Program: Enable (11.047) set to 0, and then Onboard User Program: Enable (11.047) is changed to
either 1 or -1 then all variables will be reset to their initial values before the user program starts.
If Onboard User Program: Enable (11.047) is set to 0 and then to -1 then all variables will be reset to their initial values before the user program
starts.
If Onboard User Program: Enable (11.047) is set to 0 and then to 1 then all variables will be left at their previous values before the user
program starts.

Parameter 11.048 Onboard User Program: Status


Short description Displays the status of the onboard user program
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Onboard User Program: Status (11.048) shows the status of the onboard user program.

Value Description
0 A user program is present but is stopped
1 The user program is running
2 The user program has an exception
3 No user program is present

Parameter 11.049 Onboard User Program: Programming Events


Short description Displays the number of programming events of the onboard user program
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

Onboard User Program: Programming Events (11.049) = 0 when the drive is manufactured and is incremented each time an onboard user program
image is written to the drive. If an onboard user program image is written more than 65535 times Onboard User Program: Programming Events (11.049)
= 65535. Onboard User Program: Programming Events (11.049) shows how many times the flash memory within the drive has been reprogrammed.

Parameter 11.050 Onboard User Program: Freewheeling Tasks Per Second


Short description Displays the rate of freewheeling tasks of the onboard user program
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate One Second Background Write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

During each scan in a freewheeling task it is possible to give an indication to the drive that the scan loop is starting. If this indication is given then
Onboard User Program: Freewheeling Tasks Per Second (11.050) will give the number of times this indication is given per second. It should be noted
that this parameter is updated once per second. Because the background time slot for the user program background task occurs every 64ms (15.625
times per second) either 15 or 16 time slots could have been allocated over the montoring period. Therefore the value given by this parameter can step
between two values, one corresponding to the number of updates for 15 slots, and the one corresponding to the number of updates for 16 slots.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 313
Parameter 11.051 Onboard User Program: Clock Task Time Used
Short description Displays the percentage of the available time used by the onboard user program clock task
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 100.0
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Onboard User Program: Clock Task Time Used (11.051) shows the percentage of the available time used by the onboard user program clock task.

Parameter 11.052 Serial Number LS


Short description Shows the least significant 9 decimal digits of the drive serial number
Mode RFC‑A
0 999999999
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 000000000) (Display: 999999999)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Lead Zero Pad Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

The drive serial number is available as a pair of 32 bit values where Serial Number LS (11.052) provides the least significant 9 decimal digits and
Serial Number MS (11.053) provides the most significant 9 decimal digits. The reconstructed serial number is ((11.053 * 1000000000) + 11.052).

Example 1
Serial number "1234567898765" would be stored as 11.053 = 1234, 11.052 = 567898765.

Example 2
Serial number "1234000056789" would be stored as 11.053 = 1234, 11.052 = 56789. Serial Number LS (11.052) will be shown on the keypad as
000056789 (i.e. including the leading zeros).

Parameter 11.053 Serial Number MS


Short description Shows the most significant 9 decimal digits of the drive serial number
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 999999999
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Serial Number LS (11.052).

Parameter 11.054 Drive Date Code


Short description Shows the drive date code
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

Drive Date Code (11.054) is a four-digit number in the form yyww where yy is the year and ww the week number.

Parameter 11.055 Onboard User Program: Clock Task Scheduled Interval


Short description Displays the interval at which the clock task is scheduled in ms
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 262140
Default Units ms
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Onboard User Program: Clock Task Scheduled Interval (11.055) shows the interval at which the clock task is scheduled to run at in ms.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


314 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 11.056 Option Slot Identifiers
Short description Defines the order that option slots are used by the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 23
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up and drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, PT

Value Text
0 1234
1 1243
2 1324
3 1342
4 1423
5 1432
6 4123
7 3124
8 4132
9 2134
10 3142
11 2143
12 3412
13 4312
14 2413
15 4213
16 2314
17 3214
18 2341
19 2431
20 3241
21 3421
22 4231
23 4321

If Option Slot Identifiers (11.056) is set to its default value of 0 each option module is assigned the same slot number as its physical slot. For example
the module in physical slot 1 appears in slot 1 to all drive and option module software systems (i.e. it uses Menu 15 as its set-up menu and Menu 25 as
its application menu etc.). This arrangement can be changed by selecting a different value for Option Slot Identifiers (11.056). Although
Option Slot Identifiers (11.056) is a volatile parameter its value is saved in non-volatile memory when parameters are saved. If Option Slot Identifiers
(11.056) is changed the drive must be powered down and then powered up again for the change to take effect.

Parameter 11.060 Maximum Rated Current


Short description Displays the maximum rated current or normal duty rating of the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 99999.999
Default Units A
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Maximum Rated Current (11.060) defines the variable maximum VM_RATED_CURRENT[MAX] which defines the maximum Rated Current (05.007).
Therefore Maximum Rated Current (11.060) is the maximum rated current for normal duty operation (if normal duty operation is allowed).

Parameter 11.061 Full Scale Current Kc


Short description Displays the full scale current Kc
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 99999.999
Default Units A
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Full Scale Current Kc (11.061) shows the full scale current in r.m.s. Amps. If the drive current exceeds this level it will cause an over current trip.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 315
Parameter 11.062 Power Board Software Version Number
Short description Power Board Software Version Number
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 99.99
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background Write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Power Board Software Version Number (11.062) gives the version for the power board connected to the control board or the power board in node 1 of a
multi-power module drive.

Parameter 11.063 Product Type


Short description Displays the core product type
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

Product Type (11.063) shows the core product type as given in the table below. The drive could be the basic product or a derivative of the basic product
as defined by Drive Derivative (11.028).

Product Type (11.063) Core product range


0 Unidrive M

Parameter 11.064 Product Identifier Characters


Short description Displays the product identifier characters
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1295462448 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format String Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

The drive model and rating can be identified as AAAA B nnnnnnnn CCCC DD EE FFF where each section of the model identifier is taken from a
parameter. AAAA, B, CCCC, DDDD, EE and FFF are alpha-numeric characters. nnnnnnnn are decimal digits.

Section of Identifier Parameter


AAAA Product Identifier Characters (11.064)
nnnnnnnn Drive Rating And Configuration (11.065)
CCCC Additional Identifier Characters 1 (11.091)
DDEE Additional Identifier Characters 2 (11.092)
FFFB Additional Identifier Characters 3 (11.093)

Drive Rating And Configuration (11.065) is split into a number of fields as defined in the table below.

Digits Meaning
7 and
Frame size
6
5 Voltage code (2 = 200V, 4 = 400V, 5 = 575V, 6 = 690V)
Current rating multiplied by 10. If the drive has a heavy and normal duty rating (i.e.
Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032) > 0 and Maximum Rated Current
(11.060) > Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032)), or the drive only has a heavy duty rating (i.e.
4 and
Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032) = Maximum Rated Current (11.060)), then the current rating is
0
derived from Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032). Otherwise if the drive only has a normal duty rating
(i.e. Maximum Heavy Duty Rating (11.032) = 0) then the current rating is derived from
Maximum Rated Current (11.060).

Example
The model number M700-03400078 A001 00 AB100 would be displayed in parameters as follows

Parameter Value
Product Identifier Characters (11.064) M700
Drive Rating And Configuration (11.065) 03400078
Additional Identifier Characters 1 (11.091) A001
Additional Identifier Characters 2 (11.092) 00AB
Additional Identifier Characters 3 (11.093) 100-

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


316 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 11.065 Drive Rating And Configuration
Short description Displays the drive rating and configuration
Mode RFC‑A
0 99999999
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00000000) (Display: 99999999)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Lead Zero Pad Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Product Identifier Characters (11.064).

Parameter 11.066 Power Stage Identifier


Short description Displays the power stage identifiers within the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

Power Stage Identifier (11.066) is used to show power stages that require changes to the drive user parameters (i.e. visibility, range or defaults). It
should be noted that this parameter does not identify the rating of the power stage.

Power Stage Identifier (11.066) Power Stage


0 Standard Unidrive M
1 Unidrive M with no braking IGBT
2 Servo drive

Parameter 11.067 Control Board Identifier


Short description Displays the control board identifiers within the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 65.535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

Control Board Identifier (11.067) identifies the control board hardware in the form A.0BC. A indicates whether this is a standard (0) or high speed (1)
product, B indicates standard current feedback (0) or current feedback with Ia and Ic swapped (1), and C is the control board type.

C Control Board
2 or 3 Unidrive M
4 Servo

Parameter 11.068 Internal I/O Identifier


Short description Displays the internal I/O identifiers within the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

Internal I/O Identifier (11.068) identifies the internally fitted I/O option as given in the table below.

Internal I/O Identifier (11.068) Internal I/O


0 Analog and digital I/O
1 Digtial only I/O
2 Analogue and digital I/O with additional relay
3 Servo drive I/O

The tables below show which I/O functions are available for each of the internally fitted I/O options.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 317
AI/O 0 1 2 3
All except
Analogue Input 1 All except Disable Voltage
Disable
All except
Analogue Input 2 All except Disable
Disable
Voltage, Thermistor,
Analogue Input 3 Voltage
Thermistor Disable
Analogue Output
Voltage All
1
Analogue Output
Voltage All
2

DI/O Function 0 1 2 3

1 Input/Output Input/Output Output Input/Output Output


2 Input/Output Input/Output Output Input/Output Output
3 Input/Output Input/Output Input/Output
4 Input Input Input Input Input
5 Input Input Input Input Input
6 Input Input Input
7 Relay Output Output Output Output
8 24V Supply Output Output Output Output Output
9 Safe Torque Off 1 Input Input Input Input
10 Safe Torque Off 2 Input1 Input Input1 Input
11 Keypad Run Button Input Input Input
12 Keypad Auxiliary Button Input Input Input
13 24V Supply Input Input Input Input
14 Keypad Stop Button Input Input Input
15 Relay 2 Output Output
16 Reset button Input

1 Only one hardware input is provided which is shared by STO1 and STO2.

Parameter 11.069 Position Feedback Interface Identifier


Short description Displays the position feedback interface identifier within the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

Position Feedback Interface Identifier (11.069) identifies the type of interface fitted in the position feedback interface option location as given in the table
below.

Position Feedback Interface Identifier (11.069) Position feedback interface


0 Standard Position Feedback
1 None
2 User Comms Module

Parameter 11.070 Core Parameter Database Version


Short description Displays the core parameter database version within the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 99.99
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Core Parameter Database Version (11.070) gives the version number of the parameter database used to define the core parameter menus in the drive
(Menu 1 to 14 and 21 to 23) in 2 digit BCD format. All other menus are customisable and if these menus are changed their default values are
automatically loaded. However, if the drive software is changed it may be necessary to load defaults for all menus, although this will only be required
rarely. Defaults for all menus are loaded when the most significant digit of Core Parameter Database Version (11.070) changes. Therefore if the drive
firmware is modified and the most significant digit of the core database version has changed an EEPROM Fail.001 trip is initiated and default
parameters are loaded.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


318 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 11.071 Number Of Power Modules Detected
Short description Displays the number of power modules detected in the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 20
Default Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Write on power system detection
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Number Of Power Modules Detected (11.071) shows the number of power modules detected in a drive. See Number Of Power Modules Test (11.035)
for details.

Parameter 11.072 NV Media Card Create Special File


Short description Defines if a parameter file is created as a macro file during transfer
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If NV Media Card Create Special File (11.072) = 1 when a parameter file is transferred to an NV media card the file is created as a macro file.
NV Media Card Create Special File (11.072) is reset to 0 after the file is created or the transfer fails.

Parameter 11.073 NV Media Card Type


Short description Displays the type of the currently fitted NV media card
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text Description


0 None No media card has been inserted
1 SMART Card A SMART Card has been inserted
2 SD Card A FAT formatted SD card has been inserted

NV Media Card File Type (11.038) shows the type of non-volatile media card inserted in the drive.

Parameter 11.075 NV Media Card Read-only Flag


Short description Displays the state of the read-only flag for the currently fitted card
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

NV Media Card Read-only Flag (11.075) shows the state of the read-only flag for the currently fitted card.

Parameter 11.076 NV Media Card Warning Suppression Flag


Short description Displays the state of the warning flag for the currently fitted card
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

NV Media Card Warning Suppression Flag (11.076) shows the state of the warning flag for the currently fitted card.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 319
Parameter 11.077 NV Media Card File Required Version
Short description Displays the version number for a file when it is created on an NV media card
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 9999
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, ND, NC, PT

The value of NV Media Card File Required Version (11.077) is used as the version number for a file when it is created on an NV media card.
NV Media Card File Required Version (11.077) is reset to 0 when the file is created or the transfer fails.

Parameter 11.079 Drive Name Characters 1-4


Short description Defines characters 1-4 of a string which can be used to identify the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format String Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

Drive Name Characters 1-4 (11.079) to Drive Name Characters 13-16 (11.082) can be used to store a 16 character string which can be used to identify
the drive. The string is arranged as shown below.

This uses the standard ASCII character set.

Parameter 11.080 Drive Name Characters 5-8


Short description Defines characters 5-8 of a string which can be used to identify the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format String Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

See Drive Name Characters 1-4 (11.079).

Parameter 11.081 Drive Name Characters 9-12


Short description Defines characters 9-12 of a string which can be used to identify the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format String Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

See Drive Name Characters 1-4 (11.079).

Parameter 11.082 Drive Name Characters 13-16


Short description Defines characters 13-16 of a string which can be used to identify the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format String Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

See Drive Name Characters 1-4 (11.079).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


320 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 11.084 Drive Mode
Short description Defines and displays the current drive mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 4
Default Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read/write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text
1 Open-loop
2 RFC-A
3 RFC-S
4 Regen

Drive Mode (11.084) is used to hold the currently active drive mode.

Parameter 11.085 Security Status


Short description Displays the security status within the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text
0 None
1 Read-only
2 Status-only
3 No Access

Security Status (11.085) shows the security that will apply when security is enabled by setting a non-zero value for User Security Code (11.030).

Parameter 11.086 Menu Access Status


Short description Displays the amount of access of the menus within the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text
0 Menu 0
1 All Menus

If Menu Access Status (11.086) = 0 then only Menu 0 can be accessed with a keypad. If Menu Access Status (11.086) = 1 then all menus can be
accessed with a keypad.

Parameter 11.090 Keypad Port Serial Address


Short description Defines the node address for the keypad port serial comms interface
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 16
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Keypad Port Serial Address (11.090) defines the node address for the keypad port serial comms interface. Normally the default value of 1 is used, but
this can be changed if required. The keypad attached to the port will sense the address automatically.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 321
Parameter 11.091 Additional Identifier Characters 1
Short description Displays the additional identifier characters
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format String Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Product Identifier Characters (11.064).

Parameter 11.092 Additional Identifier Characters 2


Short description Displays the additional identifier characters
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format String Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Product Identifier Characters (11.064).

Parameter 11.093 Additional Identifier Characters 3


Short description Displays the additional identifier characters
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format String Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Product Identifier Characters (11.064).

Parameter 11.095 Number Of Rectifiers Detected


Short description Number Of Rectifiers Detected
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 9
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background Write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Indicates how many controlled rectifiers connected to the drive have been detected. See Number Of Rectifiers Expected (11.096).

Parameter 11.096 Number Of Rectifiers Expected


Short description Number of rectifiers expected on each power stage
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 9
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Number Of Rectifiers Expected (11.096) defines how many controlled rectifiers are expected on each power module. Within a complete drive with a
diode input stage there are no controlled rectifiers. Within a complete drive with a controlled rectifier input stage there is one controlled rectifier. For a
drive where external rectifiers are used the system can register up to nine controlled rectifiers. If Number Of Rectifiers Expected (11.096) = 0 then the
rectifier monitoring system is disabled and the drive does not check how many controlled rectifiers are present. This is the default setting and should be
used for complete drives with internal rectifiers because the monitoring function is not necessary. If Number Of Rectifiers Expected (11.096) is set to a
non-zero value a check is made to ensure that at least this number of external rectifiers are connected to each power module. If there are less external
rectifiers than defined by Number Of Rectifiers Expected (11.096) then a Configuration is initiated with the sub-trip indicating how many rectifers should
be present. See Trip 0 (10.020).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


322 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 12 Single Line Descriptions − User Functions 2 and Brake Control
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


12.001 Threshold Detector 1 Output Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
12.002 Threshold Detector 2 Output Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
12.003 Threshold Detector 1 Source 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
12.004 Threshold Detector 1 Level 0.00 to 100.00 % 0.00 % RW Num US
12.005 Threshold Detector 1 Hysteresis 0.00 to 25.00 % 0.00 % RW Num US
12.006 Threshold Detector 1 Output Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
12.007 Threshold Detector 1 Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
12.008 Variable Selector 1 Source 1 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
12.009 Variable Selector 1 Source 2 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
Input 1 (0), Input 2 (1),
Add (2), Subtract (3),
Multiply (4), Divide (5),
12.010 Variable Selector 1 Mode Time Const (6), Input 1 (0) RW Txt US
Ramp (7), Modulus (8),
Powers (9),
Sectional (10)
12.011 Variable Selector 1 Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
12.012 Variable Selector 1 Output ±100.00 % RO Num ND NC PT
12.013 Variable Selector 1 Source 1 Scaling ±4.000 1.000 RW Num US
12.014 Variable Selector 1 Source 2 Scaling ±4.000 1.000 RW Num US
12.015 Variable Selector 1 Control 0.00 to 100.00 0.00 RW Num US
12.016 Variable Selector 1 Enable Off (0) or On (1) On (1) RW Bit US
12.023 Threshold Detector 2 Source 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
12.024 Threshold Detector 2 Level 0.00 to 100.00 % 0.00 % RW Num US
12.025 Threshold Detector 2 Hysteresis 0.00 to 25.00 % 0.00 % RW Num US
12.026 Threshold Detector 2 Output Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
12.027 Threshold Detector 2 Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
12.028 Variable Selector 2 Source 1 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
12.029 Variable Selector 2 Source 2 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
Input 1 (0), Input 2 (1),
Add (2), Subtract (3),
Multiply (4), Divide (5),
12.030 Variable Selector 2 Mode Time Const (6), Input 1 (0) RW Txt US
Ramp (7), Modulus (8),
Powers (9),
Sectional (10)
12.031 Variable Selector 2 Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
12.032 Variable Selector 2 Output ±100.00 % RO Num ND NC PT
12.033 Variable Selector 2 Source 1 Scaling ±4.000 1.000 RW Num US
12.034 Variable Selector 2 Source 2 Scaling ±4.000 1.000 RW Num US
12.035 Variable Selector 2 Control 0.00 to 100.00 0.00 RW Num US
12.036 Variable Selector 2 Enable Off (0) or On (1) On (1) RW Bit US
12.040 Brake Control: Brake Release Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
12.041 Brake Control: Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
12.043 Brake Control: Lower Current Threshold 0 to 200 % 10 % RW Num US
12.044 Brake Control: Brake Release Speed 0 to 200 10 RW Num US
12.045 Brake Control: Brake Apply Speed 0 to 200 5 RW Num US
12.046 Brake Control: Brake Delay 0.0 to 25.0 s 1.0 s RW Num US
12.047 Brake Control: Post‑brake Release Delay 0.0 to 25.0 s 1.0 s RW Num US
12.048 Brake Control: Brake Apply Delay 0.0 to 25.0 s 1.0 s RW Num US
12.049 Brake Control: Enable Position Control During Brake Release Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
Ref (0), Forward (1),
12.050 Brake Control: Initial Direction Ref (0) RW Txt US
Reverse (2)
12.051 Brake Control: Brake Apply Through Zero Threshold 0 to 200 5 RW Num US
12.052 Brake Control: Mode Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
12.054 External Brake Released Indicator Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
12.055 Brake Release Source Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 323
RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


324 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 12 − User Functions 2 and Brake Control
Mode: RFC‑A

Menu 12 provides parameters for the following features:

1. Threshold detectors
2. Variable selectors
3. Mechanical brake controller

Parameter 12.001 Threshold Detector 1 Output


Short description Displays the output of threshold detector 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

The threshold detector functions are always active even if the source and destination are not routed to valid parameters. If the source is not a valid
parameter then the source value is taken as 0. The update rate for each of the threshold detector functions is always 4ms.

The following description is for threshold detector 1, but threshold detector 2 operates in the same way. The level of the parameter defined by
Threshold Detector 1 Source (12.003) is converted to a percentage and compared to Threshold Detector 1 Level (12.004) with hysteresis to give
Threshold Detector 1 Output (12.001) as follows:

Source Threshold Detector 1 Output (12.001)


Source 0
Lower threshold ≤ Source No change of state
Source ≥ Upper threshold 1

Lower threshold = Threshold Detector 1 Level (12.004) - Threshold Detector 1 Hysteresis (12.005)


Upper threshold = Threshold Detector 1 Level (12.004) + Threshold Detector 1 Hysteresis (12.005)

The output value can then be inverted with Threshold Detector 1 Output Invert (12.006) before being routed to the destination defined by
Threshold Detector 1 Destination (12.007).

Parameter 12.002 Threshold Detector 2 Output


Short description Displays the output of threshold detector 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Threshold Detector 1 Output (12.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 325
Parameter 12.003 Threshold Detector 1 Source
Short description Defines the source parameter for threshold detector 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Threshold Detector 1 Output (12.001).

Parameter 12.004 Threshold Detector 1 Level


Short description Defines the reference level for threshold detector 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 0.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See Threshold Detector 1 Output (12.001).

Parameter 12.005 Threshold Detector 1 Hysteresis


Short description Defines the hysteresis for threshold detector 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 25.00
Default 0.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See Threshold Detector 1 Output (12.001).

Parameter 12.006 Threshold Detector 1 Output Invert


Short description Set to 1 to invert the output of threshold detector 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Threshold Detector 1 Output (12.001).

Parameter 12.007 Threshold Detector 1 Destination


Short description Defines the destination parameter for threshold detector 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See Threshold Detector 1 Output (12.001).

Parameter 12.008 Variable Selector 1 Source 1


Short description Defines the 1st source parameter for variable selector 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

The variable selector functions are always active even if the source and destination are not routed to valid parameters. If a source is not a valid parameter
then the source value is taken as 0. The update rate for each of the variable selector functions is always 4ms.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


326 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
The following description is for variable selector 1, but variable selector 2 operates in the same way. The source parameters selected with
Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008) and Variable Selector 1 Source 2 (12.009) are converted to a percentage value, scaled with
Variable Selector 1 Source 1 Scaling (12.013) and Variable Selector 1 Source 2 Scaling (12.014) respectively and then combined with a function defined
by Variable Selector 1 Mode (12.010) to give Variable Selector 1 Output (12.012) as a percentage value. If Variable Selector 1 Enable (12.016) = 1 then
the function operates normally. If Variable Selector 1 Enable (12.016) = 0 then Variable Selector 1 Output (12.012) = 0.00% and any states within the
function are reset (i.e. the time constant function accumulator is held at zero). If the value of Variable Selector 1 Mode (12.010) is changed then all
internal function state are also reset.

The table below shows the functions that can be selected with Variable Selector 1 Mode (12.010).

Variable Selector 1 Mode


Variable Selector 1 Output (12.012)
(12.010)
0: Input 1 Input 1
1: Input 2 Input 2
2: Add Input 1 + Input 2
3: Subtract Input 1 - Input 2
4: Multiply (Input 1 x Input 2) / 100.00%
5: Divide (Input 1 x 100.00%) / Input 2
6: Time Const Input 1 / (1 + τs) where τ = Variable Selector 1 Control (12.015) seconds
Input 1 as an input to a linear ramp function where the time to ramp from 0.00% to 100.00% is defined by
7: Ramp
Variable Selector 1 Control (12.015) seconds
8: Modulus |Input1|

If Variable Selector 1 Control (12.015) = 0.02 then Input2 / 100.00%

9: Powers Else if Variable Selector 1 Control (12.015) = 0.03 then Input3 / 100.00%

Else Input 1

10: Sectional See description below

Sectional Controller

If Variable Selector 1 Mode (12.010) = 10 then the variable selector can be used to provide a sectional control function. (Variable selector 2 operates in
the same way.) The sectional control function is intended to apply scaling and a speed offset to a 16 bit position value to generate a new 16 bit position
value. The output can be used as an input to the Standard motion controller (Menu 13) and to generate an encoder simulation output (Menu 3).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 327
The position input is selected with Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008) and can be derived from any parameter. However, it is intended to be used with
a position value that has a range from 0 to 65535 (e.g. P1 Position (03.029)). The input is scaled so that as Variable Selector 1 Source 1 Scaling (12.013)
is changed between -4.000 and 4.000 so the proportion of the input position change added to the accumulator varies from 0.000 to 2.000 (i.e. the change
of position input value is added without scaling if Variable Selector 1 Source 1 Scaling (12.013) = 0.000). The remainder from the scaling division is stored
and then added at the next sample to maintain an exact ratio between the position input and the position output, provided the speed from source 2 is zero.
The controller only takes the change of position from the input source parameter, and not the absolute value, so that when the controller is first made
active the output does not jump to the source position, but only moves with any changes of source position after that point in time.

Although the sectional controller is intended to use a source parameter with a range from 0 to 65535, it is possible to use parameters with a different
range provided the maximum is a power of two minus 1, i.e. 231 - 1. It should be noted that the change of position is scaled based on the maximum of the
parameter, and so a signed position value such as P1 Normalised Position (03.058) which has a maximum that corresponds to half its range will give
twice the change of position when compared to P1 Position (03.029). To counteract this effect the scaling applied to the change of position in the sectional
controller should be set to 0.5.

The range of Variable Selector 1 Output (12.012) is 0.00% and 100.00%. Unlike other functions the value is not simply limited, but rolls under or over
respectively. Although the output destination can be any parameter it is intended to be used with a position value that has a range from 0 to 65535.

The speed input defines a speed offset with a resolution of 0.1rpm. Full scale of the source parameter corresponds to 1000.0rpm. Scaling may be applied
using Variable Selector 1 Source 2 Scaling (12.014) to give a full scale value up to 4000.0rpm. The speed input is added to the accumulator to move the
output position forwards or backwards with respect to the position input.

The sample time for the variable selector is 4ms and the input or output position must not change by more than half a revolution over this time. Therefore
the input or output speed must not exceed 7500rpm.

The diagram below shows an example of how the sectional controller function could be configured. The section input position is provided from the
previous section via the P1 position feedback interface. The destination of the variable selector is the Standard Motion Local Reference Position
(13.021) in the standard motion controller which is used to provide the speed reference and to control the local motor attached to the drive. The encoder
simulation system is used to generate the section output to be fed into the next drive. The source for the encoder simulation is
Standard Motion Local Reference Position (13.021).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


328 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 12.009 Variable Selector 1 Source 2
Short description Defines the 2nd source parameter for variable selector 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008).

Parameter 12.010 Variable Selector 1 Mode


Short description Defines the mode for variable selector 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 10
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Input 1
1 Input 2
2 Add
3 Subtract
4 Multiply
5 Divide
6 Time Const
7 Ramp
8 Modulus
9 Powers
10 Sectional

See Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008).

Parameter 12.011 Variable Selector 1 Destination


Short description Defines the destination parameter for variable selector 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008).

Parameter 12.012 Variable Selector 1 Output


Short description Displays the output of variable selector 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008).

Parameter 12.013 Variable Selector 1 Source 1 Scaling


Short description Defines the scaling for the 1st input for variable selector 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -4.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 329
Parameter 12.014 Variable Selector 1 Source 2 Scaling
Short description Defines the scaling for the 2nd input for variable selector 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -4.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008).

Parameter 12.015 Variable Selector 1 Control


Short description Defines the control for variable selector 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 0.00 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008).

Parameter 12.016 Variable Selector 1 Enable


Short description Enables variable selector 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

See Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008) for more details.

Variable Selector 1 Enable (12.016) and Variable Selector 2 Enable (12.036) have a default of 1 so that if these parameters are not used the variable
selectors will still function.

Parameter 12.023 Threshold Detector 2 Source


Short description Defines the source parameter for threshold detector 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Threshold Detector 1 Output (12.001).

Parameter 12.024 Threshold Detector 2 Level


Short description Defines the reference level for threshold detector 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 0.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See Threshold Detector 1 Output (12.001).

Parameter 12.025 Threshold Detector 2 Hysteresis


Short description Defines the hysteresis for threshold detector 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 25.00
Default 0.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See Threshold Detector 1 Output (12.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


330 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 12.026 Threshold Detector 2 Output Invert
Short description Set to 1 to invert the output of threshold detector 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Threshold Detector 1 Output (12.001).

Parameter 12.027 Threshold Detector 2 Destination


Short description Defines the destination parameter for threshold detector 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See Threshold Detector 1 Output (12.001).

Parameter 12.028 Variable Selector 2 Source 1


Short description Defines the 1st source parameter for variable selector 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008).

Parameter 12.029 Variable Selector 2 Source 2


Short description Defines the 2nd source parameter for variable selector 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008).

Parameter 12.030 Variable Selector 2 Mode


Short description Defines the mode for variable selector 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 10
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Input 1
1 Input 2
2 Add
3 Subtract
4 Multiply
5 Divide
6 Time Const
7 Ramp
8 Modulus
9 Powers
10 Sectional

See Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 331
Parameter 12.031 Variable Selector 2 Destination
Short description Defines the destination parameter for variable selector 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008).

Parameter 12.032 Variable Selector 2 Output


Short description Displays the output of variable selector 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008).

Parameter 12.033 Variable Selector 2 Source 1 Scaling


Short description Defines the scaling for the 1st input for variable selector 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -4.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008).

Parameter 12.034 Variable Selector 2 Source 2 Scaling


Short description Defines the scaling for the 2nd input for variable selector 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -4.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

Parameter 12.035 Variable Selector 2 Control


Short description Defines the control for variable selector 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 0.00 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008).

Parameter 12.036 Variable Selector 2 Enable


Short description Enables variable selector 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

See Variable Selector 1 Source 1 (12.008).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


332 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 12.040 Brake Control: Brake Release
Short description Enables the brake release function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

The mechanical brake control function can be used to control an electro-mechanical brake via digital I/O. Brake Control: Brake Release (12.040) = 0 when
the brake should be applied and 1 when the brake should be released. Normally this should be routed to a digital output to control the mechanical brake.
See Brake Control: Enable (12.041) for details.

Parameter 12.041 Brake Control: Enable


Short description Enables the brake control function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If Brake Control: Enable (12.041) = 0 then the brake controller is disabled. The following parameters which are used by the brake controller to operate the
drive are reset to 0 on the transition of Brake Control: Enable (12.041) from 1 to 0.

Brake Control: Mode (12.052) = Brake Control: Mode (12.052) =


Parameter
0 1
Force Reference Direction (01.057) x
Ramp Hold (02.003) x x
Hold Zero Speed (06.008) x
x
Standard Motion Reference Source
*x
(13.004) * *x
Standard Motion Controller Mode (13.010) * *x
*x

* If Brake Control: Enable Position Control During Brake Release (12.049) = 1

RFC-A mode (Brake Control: Mode (12.052) = 0)


In RFC-A mode with Brake Control: Mode (12.052) = 0 the following brake controller is provided.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 333
Flux and current detection
The flux and current detection signal is made active to allow the brake to be released when the motor flux exceeds 90% of its rated level. The flux and
current detection signal remains active unless the motor current falls below Brake Control: Lower Current Threshold (12.043) or the drive is disabled.
Brake Control: Lower Current Threshold (12.043) is used to detect if the motor has been disconnected from the drive and should be set to a suitable level
to detect this condition. In RFC-S mode the flux and current detection signal follows the drive active signal, and so it is not possible to detect if the motor is
disconnected from the drive.

Speed detection
If Reference On (01.011) = 1 then the speed detection signal is active. When Reference On (01.011) is de-activated the speed detection signal is not de-
activated until the modulus of Speed Feedback (03.002) falls below Brake Control: Brake Apply Speed (12.045) and an additional delay defined by
Brake Control: Brake Delay (12.046).

Brake controller sequence


The brake controller sequence is shown for forward movement in the diagram below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


334 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
The brake is released when flux and current detection, and speed detection are active and then the ramp hold is released after a further delay to allow the
motor to accelerate away from standstill. When the Speed Feedback (03.002) subsequently falls below Brake Control: Brake Apply Speed (12.045) and
Reference On (01.011) = 0 (i.e. the motor is required to stop) then the brake is applied after a delay defined by Brake Control: Brake Delay (12.046). The
motor is held at zero speed for a further delay to allow the brake to apply, i.e. Brake Control: Brake Apply Delay (12.048). Ramp Hold (02.003) is held at 1
while the brake is being applied in case the reference is reapplied during this period to prevent the motor running against the brake. Also Ramp Hold
(02.003) will already be active when the drive restarts to hold the speed reference at zero. It is also possible for the Standard motion controller to be active
during this period to help prevent the motor from moving even under load after the brake has been released by
setting Brake Control: Enable Position Control During Brake Release (12.049) = 1.

If required, an input can be routed to External Brake Released Indicator (12.054) to delay the the motor from starting until an external indication is given
that the brake has released. To use an external indication Brake Release Source (12.055) should be set to one.

RFC-A mode (Brake Control: Mode (12.052) = 1)


In RFC-A mode without position feedback is used (i.e. Sensorless Mode Active (03.078) = 1) the torque produced may reduce as the speed passes
through zero. If Brake Control: Mode (12.052) = 1 a brake controller similar to the one used for Open-loop mode is provided for applications using RFC-A
mode without position feedback as shown in the diagram below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 335
The brake controller operates in the same way as the Open-loop mode brake controller except for the following differences.

1. Final Speed Reference (03.001) is used instead of Output Frequency (05.001).


2. The frequency thresholds are replaced with speed thresholds.
3. Current detection is replaced with flux and current detection as described below.

Flux and current detection


The flux and current detection signal is made active to allow the brake to be released when the motor flux exceeds 90% of its rated level. The flux and
current detection signal remains active unless the motor current falls below Brake Control: Lower Current Threshold (12.043) or the drive is disabled.
Brake Control: Lower Current Threshold (12.043) is used to detect if the motor has been disconnected from the drive and should be set to a suitable level
to detect this condition.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


336 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 12.043 Brake Control: Lower Current Threshold
Short description Defines the lower current limit for the brake
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 200
Default 10 Units %
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

See Brake Control: Enable (12.041).

Parameter 12.044 Brake Control: Brake Release Speed


Short description Defines the release speed of the brake
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 200
Default 10 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

See Brake Control: Enable (12.041).

Parameter 12.045 Brake Control: Brake Apply Speed


Short description Defines the apply speed of the brake
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 200
Default 5 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

See Brake Control: Enable (12.041).

Parameter 12.046 Brake Control: Brake Delay


Short description Defines the pre-brake release delay
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 25.0
Default 1.0 Units s
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, BU

See Brake Control: Enable (12.041).

Parameter 12.047 Brake Control: Post-brake Release Delay


Short description Defines the post-brake release delay
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 25.0
Default 1.0 Units s
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, BU

See Brake Control: Enable (12.041).

Parameter 12.048 Brake Control: Brake Apply Delay


Short description Defines the delay for applying the brake
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 25.0
Default 1.0 Units s
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, BU

See Brake Control: Enable (12.041)

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 337
Parameter 12.049 Brake Control: Enable Position Control During Brake Release
Short description Enables position control during brake release
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Brake Control: Enable (12.041)

Parameter 12.050 Brake Control: Initial Direction


Short description Defines the initial direction of the brake
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Ref
1 Forward
2 Reverse

See Brake Control: Enable (12.041).

Parameter 12.051 Brake Control: Brake Apply Through Zero Threshold


Short description Defines if the brake is applied through zero threshold
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 200
Default 5 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

See Brake Control: Enable (12.041).

Parameter 12.052 Brake Control: Mode


Short description Defines the mode of the brake control
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If Brake Control: Mode (12.052) = 1 then the brake controller for RFC-A mode without position feedback is selected.

Parameter 12.054 External Brake Released Indicator


Short description External Brake Released Indicator
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Brake Control: Enable (12.041).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


338 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 12.055 Brake Release Source
Short description Brake Release Source
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Brake Control: Enable (12.041).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 339
Menu 13 Single Line Descriptions − Standard Motion Controller
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


13.001 Standard Motion Revolutions Error -32768 to 32767 revs RO Num ND NC PT
13.002 Standard Motion Position Error -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC PT
13.003 Standard Motion Fine Position Error -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC PT
P1 Drive (0), P2 Drive (1),
P1 Slot1 (2), P2 Slot1 (3),
13.004 Standard Motion Reference Source P1 Slot2 (4), P2 Slot2 (5), P1 Drive (0) RW Txt US
P1 Slot3 (6), P2 Slot3 (7),
Local (10)
P1 Drive (0), P2 Drive (1),
P1 Slot1 (2), P2 Slot1 (3),
13.005 Standard Motion Feedback Source P1 Slot2 (4), P2 Slot2 (5), P1 Drive (0) RW Txt US
P1 Slot3 (6), P2 Slot3 (7),
Sensorless (10)
13.006 Standard Motion Reference Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
13.007 Standard Motion Ratio Numerator 0.000 to 10.000 1.000 RW Num US
13.008 Standard Motion Ratio Denominator 0.000 to 4.000 1.000 RW Num US
13.009 Standard Motion Proportional Gain Kp 0.00 to 100.00 25.00 RW Num US
Disabled (0),
Rigid Spd FF (1), Rigid (2),
Non‑rigid Spd FF (3),
13.010 Standard Motion Controller Mode Disabled (0) RW Txt US
Non‑rigid (4),
Orientate Stop (5),
Orientate (6)
13.011 Standard Motion Absolute Mode Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
13.012 Standard Motion Speed Clamp 0 to 250 rpm 150 rpm RW Num US
13.013 Standard Motion Orientation Position Reference 0 to 65535 0 RW Num US
13.014 Standard Motion Orientation Acceptance Window 0 to 4096 256 RW Num US
13.015 Standard Motion Orientation Complete Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
13.016 Standard Motion Position Error Reset Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
13.017 Standard Motion Relative Jog Reference 0.0 to 4000.0 rpm 0.0 rpm RW Num US
13.018 Standard Motion Relative Jog Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
13.019 Standard Motion Relative Jog Reverse Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
13.020 Standard Motion Local Reference Revolutions 0 to 65535 revs 0 revs RW Num NC
13.021 Standard Motion Local Reference Position 0 to 65535 0 RW Num NC
13.022 Standard Motion Local Reference Fine Position 0 to 65535 0 RW Num NC
13.023 Standard Motion Local Reference Disable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
13.024 Standard Motion Ignore Local Reference Revolutions Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
13.026 Standard Motion Sample Rate Not Active (0), 4ms (1) Not Active (0) RO Txt NC US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


340 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 13 − Standard Motion Controller
Mode: RFC‑A

Motion controller format

The diagram below shows the format and interface for the standard motion controller.

Standard motion controller


The standard motion controller outputs are speed feed-forwards and position control loop output both in 0.1rpm or 0.1mm/s units that can be used
directly by the drive. The conversion to the output speed is based on the set-up parameters of the position feedback selected to control the motor. The
position control loop output is always fed into the Hard Speed Reference (03.022). The speed feed-forwards from the motion controller can be used as a
profile input, with the drive ramp system as the profile generator, by setting Standard Motion Controller Mode (13.010) to a value of 1 or 3. Alternatively
the speed feed-forwards can be derived from the speed reference if required.

Changing Standard Motion Controller Mode (13.010) affects other drive parameters as shown in the table below.

Standard Motion Controller Mode (13.010) Action

On changing from any value to 0:


Speed Feed-forwards (01.039) = 0
0 Speed Feed-forwards Select (01.040) = 0
Hard Speed Reference (03.022) = 0
Hard Speed Reference Select (03.023) = 0

Speed Feed-forwards (01.039) = speed feed-forward


Speed Feed-forwards Select (01.040) = 1
1 or 3
Hard Speed Reference (03.022) = position control loop output
Hard Speed Reference Select (03.023) = 1

Speed Feed-forwards (01.039) = 0
Speed Feed-forwards Select (01.040) = 0
2,4,5 or 6
Hard Speed Reference (03.022) = position control loop output
Hard Speed Reference Select (03.023) = 1

Standard motion controller

The standard motion controller is compatible with the motion controller in Unidrive SP with a sample rate of 4ms. The drive ramp system (Menu 2)
operates normally when the standard motion controller is enabled.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 341
Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide
342 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
The Standard Motion Controller uses the full 48 bit position feedback from the position feedback interfaces (Turns, Position and Fine Position), and so it
is not affected by the number of turns bits selected to normalise the position for the selected position feedback interface. If Sensorless Position (03.080)
is used for the feedback position the 16 fine position bits are zero. The motion controller outputs are converted from the internal speed units of the
motion controller into a speed in rpm or mm/s (see Linear Speed Select (01.055)).

Parameter 13.001 Standard Motion Revolutions Error


Short description Displays the revolutions error for the Standard Motion Controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units revs
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Standard Motion Revolutions Error (13.001), Standard Motion Position Error (13.002) and Standard Motion Fine Position Error (13.003) show the


difference between the accumulated reference and feedback positions. The integrators are large enough to guarantee that the position controller can
operate with a position error from -32768 to 32767 turns before rolling over. For orientation mode the error between the orientation position and the
feedback position is shown in Standard Motion Position Error (13.002) only.

Parameter 13.002 Standard Motion Position Error


Short description Displays the position error for the Standard Motion Controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Standard Motion Revolutions Error (13.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 343
Parameter 13.003 Standard Motion Fine Position Error
Short description Displays the fine position error for the Standard Motion Controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Standard Motion Revolutions Error (13.001).

Parameter 13.004 Standard Motion Reference Source


Short description Defines the input source for the Standard Motion Controller reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 10
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 P1 Drive
1 P2 Drive
2 P1 Slot1
3 P2 Slot1
4 P1 Slot2
5 P2 Slot2
6 P1 Slot3
7 P2 Slot3
10 Local

The reference source can be selected from one of the drive position feedback interfaces, a position feedback interface in an option module or from the
local reference. If the selected position feedback interface does not exist then it will not be possible to enable the motion controller.

Parameter 13.005 Standard Motion Feedback Source


Short description Defines the input source for the Standard Motion Controller feedback
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 10
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 P1 Drive
1 P2 Drive
2 P1 Slot1
3 P2 Slot1
4 P1 Slot2
5 P2 Slot2
6 P1 Slot3
7 P2 Slot3
10 Sensorless

The feedback source can be selected from one of the drive position feedback interfaces, a position feedback interface in an option module or from the
Sensorless Position (03.080). If the selected position feedback interface does not exist or Sensorless Position (03.080) is selected, but sensorless mode
is not active then it will not be possible to enable the motion controller.

Parameter 13.006 Standard Motion Reference Invert


Short description Set to 1 to invert the Standard Motion Controller reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


344 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
If Standard Motion Reference Invert (13.006) = 1 the reference position direction is reversed.

Parameter 13.007 Standard Motion Ratio Numerator


Short description Defines the numerator for the Standard Motion Controller ratio
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 10.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

A ratio of Standard Motion Ratio Numerator (13.007) / Standard Motion Ratio Denominator (13.008) can be applied to the change of reference position.
The ratio cannot be changed when the drive is enabled without causing abrupt changes of position. Although it is possible to set up ratios with a high
gain or even with a denominator of zero, the drive limits the resultant gain of the ratio block to 10.000.

Parameter 13.008 Standard Motion Ratio Denominator


Short description Defines the denominator for the Standard Motion Controller ratio
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See Standard Motion Ratio Numerator (13.007).

Parameter 13.009 Standard Motion Proportional Gain Kp


Short description Defines the Kp gain used by the Standard Motion Controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 25.00 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

The gain of the position control loop is specified in position units/s / position unit. The speed units used in the drive (rpm or mm/s) are dependent on the
type of feedback device used and the value of Linear Speed Select (01.055). If rpm are used then the gain units are rev/s / rev (60 x rpm / rev), or if
mm/s are used then the gain units are mm/s / mm.

Parameter 13.010 Standard Motion Controller Mode


Short description Defines the mode of the Standard Motion Controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 6
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Disabled
1 Rigid Spd FF
2 Rigid
3 Non-rigid Spd FF
4 Non-rigid
5 Orientate Stop
6 Orientate

0: Disabled
The Standard Motion Controller is disabled if Standard Motion Controller Mode (13.010) = 0. The Standard Motion Controller is also disabled
if Reference On (01.011) = 0 (except for orientation control), or if the reference or feedback sources are not valid. When
Standard Motion Controller Mode (13.010) is changed the Standard Motion Controller is disabled for one sample after the change.

1: Rigid lock with speed feed-forwards


The diagram below shows the effect of rigid lock. Once the motion controller has been started it will always try to match the position and speed of the
reference source. If for example the slave shaft is slowed down due to excessive load, the target position will eventually be recovered by running at a
higher speed when the load is removed.

The motion controller generates a speed feed-forward term from the speed of the reference source. This value is passed through Menu 1, and so the
ramps (Menu 2) may be included if required. As the motion controller only has a proportional gain, it is necessary to use speed feed-forwards to prevent
a constant position error.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 345
2: Rigid lock without speed feed-forwards
Rigid lock without speed feed-forwards operates in the same way as rigid lock with speed feed-forwards except that the speed feed-forwards from the
reference source is not provided. If speed feed-forwards is required then this should be supplied via Menu 1.

3: Non-rigid lock with speed feed-forwards


The position control loop is only active when At Speed (10.006) = 1. See At Speed Lower Limit (03.006) for details. This provides position locking once
the feedback speed is close to the reference speed. Speed feed-forwards is generated from the reference source speed.

4: Non-rigid lock without speed feed-forwards


Non-rigid lock without speed feed-forwards operates in the same way as non-rigid lock with speed feed-forwards except that the speed feed-forwards
from the reference source is not provided. If speed feed-forwards is required then this should be supplied via Menu 1.

5: Orientation on stop
The motion controller orientates the motor following a stop command. If hold zero speed is enabled (Hold Zero Speed (06.008) = 1) the drive remains in
position control when orientation is complete and holds the orientation position. If hold zero speed is not enabled the drive is disabled when orientation
is complete.

When orientating from a stop command the drive goes through the following sequence:

1. The motor is decelerated or accelerated to the speed defined by the Standard Motion Speed Clamp (13.012), using ramps if these are
enabled, in the direction the motor was previously running.
2. When the ramp output reaches the set speed, ramps are disabled and the motor continues to rotate until the position is found to be
close to the target position (i.e. within 1/32 of a turn). At this point the speed demand is set to 0 and the position loop is closed.
3. When the position is within the Standard Motion Orientation Acceptance Window (13.014) the orientation complete indication is given
by setting Standard Motion Orientation Complete (13.015) to 1.

The stop mode selected by Stop Mode (06.001) has no effect if orientation is enabled.

6: Orientation on stop and when the drive is enabled


This mode is the same as orientation on stop, except that orientation is performed whenever the drive is enabled and not just when a stop is required.

Parameter 13.011 Standard Motion Absolute Mode Enable


Short description Enables the Absolule mode for the Standard Motion Controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If Standard Motion Absolute Mode Enable (13.011) = 0 the reference and feedback integrators are held at 0 while the motion controller is disabled, and

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


346 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
so the controller operates in incremental mode when it is enabled. If Standard Motion Absolute Mode Enable (13.011) = 1 the reference and feedback
integrators are preset with the position from the reference and feedback sources, and so the controller operates in absolute mode when it is enabled. It
should be noted that Standard Motion Reference Invert (13.006), Standard Motion Ratio Numerator (13.007) and Standard Motion Ratio Denominator
(13.008) are not applied to the value stored in the reference integrator. Therefore the inversion should not be applied and a ratio of unity should be used
in absolute mode.

Parameter 13.012 Standard Motion Speed Clamp


Short description Defines the limit applied to the output of the position control loop
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 250
Default 150 Units rpm
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Standard Motion Speed Clamp (13.012) is the limit applied to the output of the position control loop.

Parameter 13.013 Standard Motion Orientation Position Reference


Short description Defines the orientation position within a turn with a resolution of 1/65536ths of a turn
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Standard Motion Orientation Position Reference (13.013) defines the orientation position within a turn with a resolution of 1/216 of a turn.
Standard Motion Orientation Acceptance Window (13.014) defines the acceptance window with a resolution of 1/216 of a turn. The orientation is
complete when:

Standard Motion Orientation Position Reference (13.013) - Standard Motion Orientation Acceptance Window (13.014) ≤ feedback position ≤


Standard Motion Orientation Position Reference (13.013) + Standard Motion Orientation Acceptance Window (13.014)

Parameter 13.014 Standard Motion Orientation Acceptance Window


Short description Defines the acceptance window with a resolution of 1/65536ths of a turn
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 4096
Default 256 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See Standard Motion Orientation Position Reference (13.013).

Parameter 13.015 Standard Motion Orientation Complete


Short description Shows when the orientation sequence is complete for the Standard Motion Controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Standard Motion Orientation Complete (13.015) is set to 1 when the orientation sequence is complete.

Parameter 13.016 Standard Motion Position Error Reset


Short description Resets the reference and feedback integrators
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If Standard Motion Position Error Reset (13.016) = 1 the reference and feedback integrators are held at their reset values
(See Standard Motion Absolute Mode Enable (13.011)).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 347
Parameter 13.017 Standard Motion Relative Jog Reference
Short description Defines the speed that the reference position is moved at
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 4000.0
Default 0.0 Units rpm
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, BU

If Standard Motion Relative Jog Enable (13.018) = 1 the reference position is moved at the speed defined by Standard Motion Relative Jog Reference
(13.017) and in the direction defined by Standard Motion Relative Jog Reverse (13.019). The relative jog is forwards if
Standard Motion Relative Jog Reverse (13.019) = 0 and reverse if it is 1.

Parameter 13.018 Standard Motion Relative Jog Enable


Short description Enables the use of the relative jog reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Standard Motion Relative Jog Reference (13.017).

Parameter 13.019 Standard Motion Relative Jog Reverse


Short description Sets the direction of the relative jog reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Standard Motion Relative Jog Reference (13.017).

Parameter 13.020 Standard Motion Local Reference Revolutions


Short description Defines the revolutions for the local reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default 0 Units revs
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC, BU

The local reference (Standard Motion Local Reference Revolutions (13.020), Standard Motion Local Reference Position (13.021) and


Standard Motion Local Reference Fine Position (13.022)) can be used as the reference position. If Standard Motion Local Reference Disable (13.023) =
1 then the previously written value is used. This allows all three parts of the local reference position to be changed without data skew problems.

Parameter 13.021 Standard Motion Local Reference Position


Short description Defines the position for the local reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC, BU

See Standard Motion Local Reference Revolutions (13.020).

Parameter 13.022 Standard Motion Local Reference Fine Position


Short description Defines the fine position for the local reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC, BU

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


348 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
See Standard Motion Local Reference Revolutions (13.020).

Parameter 13.023 Standard Motion Local Reference Disable


Short description Disables the use of the local reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See Standard Motion Local Reference Revolutions (13.020).

Parameter 13.024 Standard Motion Ignore Local Reference Revolutions


Short description Disables the use of the local reference revolutions
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 250µs read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If Standard Motion Ignore Local Reference Revolutions (13.024) = 0 all three parts of the local reference are used. If Std
Standard Motion Ignore Local Reference Revolutions (13.024) = 1 and Standard Motion Absolute Mode Enable (13.011) = 0 only the position and fine
position parts of the local reference are used as a 32 bit roll-over counter to define the local reference position.

Parameter 13.026 Standard Motion Sample Rate


Short description Standard Motion Sample Rate
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, NC

Value Text
0 Not Active
1 4ms

Standard Motion Sample Rate (13.026) indicates whether the Standard Motion Controller is active or not, and the sample rate being used. The sample
rate for the Standard Motion Controller is not selectable and will always be 4ms if the controller is active. It should be noted that both the Advanced and
Standard motion controllers cannot be active at the same time. If both are selected at power-up then only the Advanced Motion Controller becomes
active. If one controller is active and the other is subsequently enabled without disabling the active controller then the active controller remains active
until the drive is powered down and back up again.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 349
Menu 14 Single Line Descriptions − User PID Controller
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


350 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter Range Default Type
14.001 PID1 Output ±100.00 % RO Num ND NC PT
14.002 PID1 Feed‑forwards Reference Source 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
14.003 PID1 Reference Source 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
14.004 PID1 Feedback Source 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
14.005 PID1 Reference Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
14.006 PID1 Feedback Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
14.007 PID1 Reference Slew Rate 0.0 to 3200.0 s 0.0 s RW Num US
14.008 PID1 Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
14.009 PID1 Enable Source 1 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
14.010 PID1 Proportional Gain 0.000 to 4.000 1.000 RW Num US
14.011 PID1 Integral Gain 0.000 to 4.000 0.500 RW Num US
14.012 PID1 Differential Gain 0.000 to 4.000 0.000 RW Num US
14.013 PID1 Output Upper Limit 0.00 to 100.00 % 100.00 % RW Num US
14.014 PID1 Output Lower Limit ±100.00 % -100.00 % RW Num US
14.015 PID1 Output Scaling 0.000 to 4.000 1.000 RW Num US
14.016 PID1 Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
14.017 PID1 Integral Hold Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit
14.018 PID1 Symmetrical Limit Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
14.019 PID1 Feed‑forwards Reference ±100.00 % RO Num ND NC PT
14.020 PID1 Reference ±100.00 % RO Num ND NC PT
14.021 PID1 Feedback ±100.00 % RO Num ND NC PT
14.022 PID1 Error ±100.00 % RO Num ND NC PT
14.023 PID1 Reference Scaling 0.000 to 4.000 1.000 RW Num US
14.024 PID1 Feedback Scaling 0.000 to 4.000 1.000 RW Num US
14.025 PID1 Digital Reference ±100.00 % 0.00 % RW Num US
14.026 PID1 Digital Feedback ±100.00 % 0.00 % RW Num US
14.027 PID1 Enable Source 2 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
14.028 PID1 Pre‑sleep Boost Level 0.00 to 100.00 % 0.00 % RW Num US
14.029 PID1 Maximum Boost Time 0.0 to 250.0 s 0.0 s RW Num US
14.030 PID1 Pre‑sleep Boost Level Enable Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
14.031 PID2 Output ±100.00 % RO Num ND NC PT
14.032 PID2 Feed‑forwards Reference Source 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
14.033 PID2 Reference Source 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
14.034 PID2 Feedback Source 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
14.035 PID2 Reference Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
14.036 PID2 Feedback Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
14.037 PID2 Reference Slew Rate Limit 0.0 to 3200.0 s 0.0 s RW Num US
14.038 PID2 Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
14.039 PID2 Enable Source 1 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
14.040 PID2 Proportional Gain 0.000 to 4.000 1.000 RW Num US
14.041 PID2 Integral Gain 0.000 to 4.000 0.500 RW Num US
14.042 PID2 Differential Gain 0.000 to 4.000 0.000 RW Num US
14.043 PID2 Output Upper Limit 0.00 to 100.00 % 100.00 % RW Num US
14.044 PID2 Output Lower Limit ±100.00 % -100.00 % RW Num US
14.045 PID2 Output Scaling 0.000 to 4.000 1.000 RW Num US
14.046 PID2 Destination 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num DE PT US
14.047 PID2 Integral Hold Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit
14.048 PID2 Symmetrical Limit Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
14.049 PID2 Feed‑forwards Reference ±100.00 % RO Num ND NC PT
14.050 PID2 Reference ±100.00 % RO Num ND NC PT
14.051 PID2 Feedback ±100.00 % RO Num ND NC PT
14.052 PID2 Error ±100.00 % RO Num ND NC PT
14.053 PID2 Reference Scaling 0.000 to 4.000 1.000 RW Num US
14.054 PID2 Feedback Scaling 0.000 to 4.000 1.000 RW Num US
14.055 PID2 Digital Reference ±100.00 % 0.00 % RW Num US
14.056 PID2 Digital Feedback ±100.00 % 0.00 % RW Num US
14.057 PID2 Enable Source 2 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
14.058 PID1 Feedback Output Scaling 0.000 to 4.000 1.000 RW Num US
Fbk1 (0), Fbk2 (1),
Fbk1 + Fbk2 (2), Min Fbk (3),
14.059 PID1 Mode Selector Fbk1 (0) RW Txt US
Max Fbk (4), Av Fbk (5),
Min Error (6), Max Error (7)

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 351
14.060 PID1 Feedback Square Root Enable 1 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
14.061 PID2 Feedback Square Root Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
14.062 PID1 Feedback Square Root Enable 2 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


352 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 14 − User PID Controller
Mode: RFC‑A

PID controllers

Two general purpose PID controllers are provided as shown in the diagram below. Both operate in the same way except that PID controller 2 does not
include a pre-sleep boost reference or alternative feedback and error selection. In the following sections a description is given for PID controller 1. The
descriptions also apply to PID controller 2 except where stated. The sample rate for the PID controllers is always 4ms.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 353
Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide
354 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide
Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 355
Parameter 14.001 PID1 Output
Short description Displays the output for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Controller

The controller section for the PID controllers is shown in the introduction. The structure of PID controller 1 shown in the introduction is when
PID1 Mode Selector  (14.059) = 0, PID1 Feedback Output Scaling  (14.058) = 1.000, and PID1 Feedback Square Root Enable 2  (14.062) = 0. The
additional features provided by these parameters are not available for PID controller 2, and so this controller always has the structure shown. If the
combined enable is inactive then all internal states are held at zero and the destination parameter will be defined by PID1 Feed-forwards Reference 
(14.019) alone. If the enable is active the PID controller is active even if the destination is not routed to a valid parameter or to 0.000. It should be noted
that if either of the enable sources is routed to 0.000 or to a non-valid parameter the source value is taken as 1, therefore with default settings,
PID1 Enable Source 1  (14.009) = 0.000 and PID1 Enable Source 2  (14.027) = 0.000, the PID controller can be enabled by simply setting PID1 Enable 
(14.008).

PID1 Error  (14.022) is the difference between the reference and feedback produced by the reference and feedback systems described in the previous
sections. The PID controller output is defined as follows:

PID1 Output  (14.001) = PID1 Error  (14.022) x [Kp + Ki/s + sKd/(0.064s + 1)]

Kp = PID1 Proportional Gain (14.010)

Ki = PID1 Integral Gain  (14.011)

Kd = PID1 Differential Gain  (14.012)

Therefore:

1. If PID1 Error  (14.022) = 100.00% the proportional term gives a value of 100.00% if PID1 Proportional Gain (14.010) = 1.000.

2. If PID1 Error  (14.022) = 100.00% the integral term gives a value that increases linearly by 100.00% per second if PID1 Integral Gain 
(14.011) = 1.000.

3. If PID1 Error  (14.022) increases linearly by 100.00% per second the differential term gives a value of 100.00% if PID1 Differential Gain 
(14.012) = 1.000. (A filter with a time constant of 64ms is provided on the differential gain to reduce the noise produced by this term.)

The output may be limited to a range that is less than the maximum range of PID1 Output  (14.001) using PID1 Output Upper Limit  (14.013)
and PID1 Output Lower Limit (14.014). If PID1 Output Lower Limit (14.014) > PID1 Output Upper Limit  (14.013) then the output is held at the value
defined by PID1 Output Upper Limit  (14.013). If PID1 Symmetrical Limit Enable  (14.018) = 1 then the lower limit = -(PID1 Output Upper Limit 
(14.013)). If the output reaches either of these limits the integral term accumulator is frozen until the output moves away from the limit to prevent integral
wind-up. The integral hold function can also be enabled by the user by setting PID1 Integral Hold  (14.017) = 1.

PID1 Output Scaling  (14.015) can be used to scale the output, which is limited to a range from -100.00% to 100.00% after this function. The output is
then added to PID1 Feed-forwards Reference  (14.019) and is again limited to the range from -100.00% to 100.00% before being routed to the
destination defined by PID1 Destination  (14.016).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


356 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 14.002 PID1 Feed-forwards Reference Source
Short description Defines the input source for the feed-forwards reference source for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See PID1 Output  (14.001).

Parameter 14.003 PID1 Reference Source


Short description Defines the input source for the reference for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

The reference section for the PID controllers is shown in the introduction. The pre-sleep boost control is only included in PID controller 1. The reference
sections are always active even if the PID controller itself is disabled or the reference sources are not routed to valid parameters. If a reference source
is not a valid parameter or is 0.000 then the value is taken as zero.

The reference is the sum of the reference source, the PID1 Digital Reference  (14.025) and the PID1 Pre-sleep Boost Level  (14.028) when it is active.
The result is multiplied by PID1 Reference Scaling  (14.023) and then limited to +/-100.00%. The reference can then be inverted if required
(PID1 Reference Invert (14.005) = 1) and then a slew rate limit is applied with PID1 Reference Slew Rate  (14.007). This limits the maximum rate of
change so that a change from 0.00 to 100.00% takes the time given in PID1 Reference Slew Rate  (14.007).

Sleep mode is used to stop the motor if the frequency or speed reference falls below a specified level so that the system does not run inefficiently at low
speeds (see Sleep / Wake Threshold (06.053)). If the frequency or speed reference is controlled by PID controller 1 then the PID controller feedback will
fall when sleep mode becomes active because the motor has stopped. The PID controller output will rise again above the sleep/wake threshold and the
motor will restart. To minimise the number of transitions into and out of sleep mode the sleep condition can be delayed and an increased reference
applied during this period by setting PID1 Pre-sleep Boost Level  (14.028) to a non-zero value. When Sleep Required (06.056) = 1 the PID1 Pre-
sleep Boost Level  (14.028) is added to the reference until PID1 Error  (14.022) is reduced below zero or until this additional reference has been applied
for PID1 Maximum Boost Time  (14.029). This system is only intended for applications where PID controller 1 alone is used to control the motor
frequency or speed via the Menu 1 reference system and the motor rotates in the positive direction under normal conditions. When the PID output first
falls below the Sleep / Wake Threshold (06.053) it is possible for PID1 Error  (14.022) to be negative because of a positive value remaining in the
integral accumulator. To allow the error to become positive so that the boost period is not terminated immediately, the PID1 Pre-sleep Boost Level 
(14.028) is applied for a minimum of 100ms before the end of the boost period can be terminated because PID1 Error  (14.022) is greater than or equal
to zero.

Parameter 14.004 PID1 Feedback Source


Short description Defines the input source for the feedback for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

Feedback

The feedback section for the PID controllers is shown in the introduction. The feedback sections are always active even if the PID controller itself is
disabled or the feedback sources are not routed to valid parameters. If a feedback source is not a valid parameter or is 0.000 then the value is taken as
zero.

The feedback is the sum of the feedback source and the PID1 Digital Feedback  (14.026). The result is multiplied by PID1 Feedback Scaling  (14.024)
and then limited to +/-100.00%. A square root function can be applied (PID1 Feedback Square Root Enable 1 (14.060) = 1) and the feedback can then
be inverted if required (PID1 Feedback Invert  (14.006) = 1). The square root function is defined as follows.

Square root function output = Sign(Input) x 100.00% x √(|Input| / 100.00%)

where Sign(Input) = 1 if Input ≥ 0 or -1 otherwise

The square root function is useful in applications where the PID controller is operating with air flow as its reference and feedback and the motor is
controlling a fan. It is easier to use a pressure transducer than a flow transducer, and so the feedback from the transducer needs to be converted from
pressure to flow. As flow = Constant x √Pressure the square root function can be used in the conversion.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 357
Parameter 14.005 PID1 Reference Invert
Short description Set to 1 to invert PID1 reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See PID1 Reference Source (14.003).

Parameter 14.006 PID1 Feedback Invert


Short description Set to 1 to invert the PID1 feedback
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See PID1 Feedback Source  (14.004).

Parameter 14.007 PID1 Reference Slew Rate


Short description Defines the rate in change of output for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 3200.0
Default 0.0 Units s
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

See PID1 Reference Source (14.003).

Parameter 14.008 PID1 Enable


Short description Enables the use of PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See PID1 Output  (14.001).

Parameter 14.009 PID1 Enable Source 1


Short description Defines the input source for enabling PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See PID1 Output  (14.001).

Parameter 14.010 PID1 Proportional Gain


Short description Defines the Kp gain used for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See PID1 Output  (14.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


358 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 14.011 PID1 Integral Gain
Short description Defines the Ki gain used for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 0.500 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See PID1 Output  (14.001).

Parameter 14.012 PID1 Differential Gain


Short description Defines the Kd gain used for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See PID1 Output  (14.001).

Parameter 14.013 PID1 Output Upper Limit


Short description Defines the maximum value of the output for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 100.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See PID1 Output  (14.001).

Parameter 14.014 PID1 Output Lower Limit


Short description Defines the minimum value of the output for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default -100.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See PID1 Output  (14.001).

Parameter 14.015 PID1 Output Scaling


Short description Defines the scaling factor of the output for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See PID1 Output  (14.001).

Parameter 14.016 PID1 Destination


Short description Defines the output parameter for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See PID1 Output  (14.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 359
Parameter 14.017 PID1 Integral Hold
Short description Enables the integral hold function for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See PID1 Output  (14.001).

Parameter 14.018 PID1 Symmetrical Limit Enable


Short description Enables the symmetrical limit for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See PID1 Output  (14.001).

Parameter 14.019 PID1 Feed-forwards Reference


Short description Displays the value of the feed-forwards reference for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See PID1 Output  (14.001).

Parameter 14.020 PID1 Reference


Short description Displays the value of the reference for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See PID1 Reference Source (14.003).

Parameter 14.021 PID1 Feedback


Short description Displays the value of the feedback for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See PID1 Feedback Source  (14.004).

Parameter 14.022 PID1 Error


Short description Displays the value of the error for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See PID1 Output  (14.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


360 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 14.023 PID1 Reference Scaling
Short description Defines the scaling factor for the reference for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See PID1 Reference Source (14.003).

Parameter 14.024 PID1 Feedback Scaling


Short description Defines the scaling factor of the feedback for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See PID1 Feedback Source  (14.004).

Parameter 14.025 PID1 Digital Reference


Short description Defines the value of the digital reference for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 0.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See PID1 Reference Source (14.003).

Parameter 14.026 PID1 Digital Feedback


Short description Defines the value of the digital feedback for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 0.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See PID1 Feedback Source  (14.004).

Parameter 14.027 PID1 Enable Source 2


Short description Defines the input source for enabling PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See PID1 Output  (14.001).

Parameter 14.028 PID1 Pre-sleep Boost Level


Short description Defines the level of the pre-sleep boost function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 0.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See PID1 Reference Source (14.003).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 361
Parameter 14.029 PID1 Maximum Boost Time
Short description Defines the maximum time that the boost level can be used
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 250.0
Default 0.0 Units s
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, BU

See PID1 Reference Source (14.003).

Parameter 14.030 PID1 Pre-sleep Boost Level Enable


Short description Enables the pre-sleep boost function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See PID1 Reference Source (14.003).

Parameter 14.031 PID2 Output


Short description Displays the output for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See PID1 Output  (14.001).

Parameter 14.032 PID2 Feed-forwards Reference Source


Short description Defines the input source for the feed-forwards reference source for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See PID1 Feed-forwards Reference Source  (14.002).

Parameter 14.033 PID2 Reference Source


Short description Defines the input source for the reference for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See PID1 Reference Source (14.003).

Parameter 14.034 PID2 Feedback Source


Short description Defines the input source for the feedback for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See PID1 Feedback Source  (14.004).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


362 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 14.035 PID2 Reference Invert
Short description Set to 1 to invert PID2 reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See PID1 Reference Invert (14.005).

Parameter 14.036 PID2 Feedback Invert


Short description Set to 1 to invert PID2 feedback
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See PID1 Feedback Invert  (14.006).

Parameter 14.037 PID2 Reference Slew Rate Limit


Short description Defines the rate in change of output for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 3200.0
Default 0.0 Units s
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

See PID1 Reference Slew Rate  (14.007).

Parameter 14.038 PID2 Enable


Short description Enables the use of PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See PID1 Enable  (14.008).

Parameter 14.039 PID2 Enable Source 1


Short description Defines the input source for enabling PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See PID1 Enable Source 1  (14.009).

Parameter 14.040 PID2 Proportional Gain


Short description Defines the Kp gain used for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See PID1 Proportional Gain (14.010).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 363
Parameter 14.041 PID2 Integral Gain
Short description Defines the Ki gain used for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 0.500 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See PID1 Integral Gain  (14.011).

Parameter 14.042 PID2 Differential Gain


Short description Defines the Kd gain used for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See PID1 Differential Gain  (14.012).

Parameter 14.043 PID2 Output Upper Limit


Short description Defines the maximum value of the output for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 100.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See PID1 Output Upper Limit  (14.013).

Parameter 14.044 PID2 Output Lower Limit


Short description Defines the minimum value of the output for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default -100.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See PID1 Output Lower Limit (14.014).

Parameter 14.045 PID2 Output Scaling


Short description Defines the scaling factor of the output for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See PID1 Output Scaling  (14.015).

Parameter 14.046 PID2 Destination


Short description Defines the output parameter for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, DE, PT, BU

See PID1 Destination  (14.016).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


364 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 14.047 PID2 Integral Hold
Short description Enables the integral hold function for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See PID1 Integral Hold  (14.017).

Parameter 14.048 PID2 Symmetrical Limit Enable


Short description Enables the symmetrical limit for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See PID1 Symmetrical Limit Enable  (14.018).

Parameter 14.049 PID2 Feed-forwards Reference


Short description Displays the value of the feed-forwards reference for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See PID1 Feed-forwards Reference  (14.019).

Parameter 14.050 PID2 Reference


Short description Displays the value of the reference for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See PID1 Reference  (14.020).

Parameter 14.051 PID2 Feedback


Short description Displays the value of the feedback for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See PID1 Feedback  (14.021).

Parameter 14.052 PID2 Error


Short description Displays the value of the error for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default Units %
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See PID1 Error  (14.022).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 365
Parameter 14.053 PID2 Reference Scaling
Short description Defines the scaling factor for the reference for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See PID1 Reference Scaling  (14.023).

Parameter 14.054 PID2 Feedback Scaling


Short description Defines the scaling factor of the feedback for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

See PID1 Feedback Scaling  (14.024).

Parameter 14.055 PID2 Digital Reference


Short description Defines the value of the digital reference for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 0.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See PID1 Digital Reference  (14.025).

Parameter 14.056 PID2 Digital Feedback


Short description Defines the value of the digital feedback for PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -100.00 Maximum 100.00
Default 0.00 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

See PID1 Digital Feedback  (14.026).

Parameter 14.057 PID2 Enable Source 2


Short description Defines the input source for enabling PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Drive reset read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See PID1 Enable Source 2  (14.027).

Parameter 14.058 PID1 Feedback Output Scaling


Short description Defines the scaling factor of the output feedback for PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 4.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

PID1 alternative feedback and error selection

The description given in PID1 Output  (14.001) assumed that PID1 Mode Selector  (14.059) = 0 so that PID controller 1 uses its own feedback (FBK1).
It is possible to select alternative configurations that allow various combinations of feedback or error from either PID controller to be used as shown
Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide
366 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
below.

PID1 Mode Selector  (14.059) can be used to select the feedback and error as shown in the table below. It should be noted that PID controller 2 will
operate normally even when its feedback or error has been selected for PID controller 1. However, if PID1 Mode Selector  (14.059) is non-zero PID
controller 2 enable is controlled directly by the enable state of PID controller 1.

PID1 Mode Selector (14.059) Feedback Error


0: Fbk1 FBK1 ERR1
1: Fbk2 FBK2 ERR1
2: Fbk1 + Fbk2 FBK1 + FBK2 ERR1
3: Min Fbk Lowest of FBK1 or FBK2 ERR1
4: Max Fbk Highest of FBK1 or FBK2 ERR1
5: Av Fbk (FBK1 + FBK2) / 2 ERR1

If |ERR1| ≤ |ERR2| then ERR1


6: Min Error FBK1
Else ERR2

If |ERR1| ≥ |ERR2| then ERR1


7: Max Error FBK1
Else ERR2

PID1 Feedback Output Scaling  (14.058) can then be used to scale the results. PID1 Feedback Square Root Enable 2  (14.062) can be used in
converting the output of the combined feedback from pressure to flow. It is easier to use a pressure transducer than a flow transducer, and so the
feedback from the transducer needs to be converted from pressure to flow. As flow = Constant x √Pressure the square root function can be used in the
conversion.

Parameter 14.059 PID1 Mode Selector


Short description Defines the mode of PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 7
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Fbk1
1 Fbk2
2 Fbk1 + Fbk2
3 Min Fbk
4 Max Fbk
5 Av Fbk
6 Min Error
7 Max Error

See PID1 Feedback Output Scaling  (14.058).

Parameter 14.060 PID1 Feedback Square Root Enable 1


Short description Enables the square root function 1 of PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See PID1 Feedback Source  (14.004).

Parameter 14.061 PID2 Feedback Square Root Enable


Short description Enables the square root function of PID2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See PID1 Feedback Square Root Enable 1 (14.060)

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 367
Parameter 14.062 PID1 Feedback Square Root Enable 2
Short description Enables the square root function 2 of PID1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See PID1 Feedback Output Scaling  (14.058).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


368 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 18 Single Line Descriptions − Application Menu 1
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 369
Parameter Range Default Type
18.001 Application Menu 1 Power‑down Save Integer -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num PS
18.002 Application Menu 1 Read‑only Integer 2 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
18.003 Application Menu 1 Read‑only Integer 3 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
18.004 Application Menu 1 Read‑only Integer 4 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
18.005 Application Menu 1 Read‑only Integer 5 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
18.006 Application Menu 1 Read‑only Integer 6 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
18.007 Application Menu 1 Read‑only Integer 7 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
18.008 Application Menu 1 Read‑only Integer 8 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
18.009 Application Menu 1 Read‑only Integer 9 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
18.010 Application Menu 1 Read‑only Integer 10 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
18.011 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 11 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.012 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 12 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.013 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 13 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.014 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 14 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.015 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 15 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.016 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 16 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.017 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 17 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.018 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 18 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.019 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 19 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.020 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 20 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.021 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 21 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.022 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 22 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.023 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 23 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.024 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 24 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.025 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 25 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.026 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 26 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.027 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 27 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.028 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 28 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.029 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 29 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.030 Application Menu 1 Read‑write Integer 30 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
18.031 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 31 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.032 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 32 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.033 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 33 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.034 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 34 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.035 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 35 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.036 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 36 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.037 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 37 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.038 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 38 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.039 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 39 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.040 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 40 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.041 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 41 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.042 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 42 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.043 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 43 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.044 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 44 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.045 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 45 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.046 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 46 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.047 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 47 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.048 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 48 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


370 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
18.049 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 49 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.050 Application Menu 1 Read‑write bit 50 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
18.051 Application Menu 1 Power‑down Save Long Integer 51 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PS
18.052 Application Menu 1 Power‑down Save Long Integer 52 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PS
18.053 Application Menu 1 Power‑down Save Long Integer 53 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PS
18.054 Application Menu 1 Power‑down Save Long Integer 54 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PS

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 371
Menu 18 − Application Menu 1
Mode: RFC‑A

Menus 18-20 are general application menus that can be used by one of the option modules fitted to the drive. These menus are customisable and the
following RAM is provided to be shared between all 3 menus. This is based on increasing the RAM provided for Unidrive SP by approximately 20%.

1 8 16 32
Volatile 0 32 64 32
User save 64 32 48 12
Power-down save 0 0 2 8

If no option modules provide customisation tables for these menus then the drive provides the customisation tables to give the following parameters.

Parameter 18.001 Application Menu 1 Power-down Save Integer


Short description General power-down save integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.002 Application Menu 1 Read-only Integer 2


Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Parameter 18.003 Application Menu 1 Read-only Integer 3


Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Parameter 18.004 Application Menu 1 Read-only Integer 4


Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Parameter 18.005 Application Menu 1 Read-only Integer 5


Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


372 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 18.006 Application Menu 1 Read-only Integer 6
Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Parameter 18.007 Application Menu 1 Read-only Integer 7


Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Parameter 18.008 Application Menu 1 Read-only Integer 8


Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Parameter 18.009 Application Menu 1 Read-only Integer 9


Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Parameter 18.010 Application Menu 1 Read-only Integer 10


Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Parameter 18.011 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 11


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.012 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 12


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 373
Parameter 18.013 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 13
Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.014 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 14


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.015 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 15


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.016 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 16


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.017 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 17


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.018 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 18


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.019 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 19


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


374 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 18.020 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 20
Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.021 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 21


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.022 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 22


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.023 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 23


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.024 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 24


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.025 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 25


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.026 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 26


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 375
Parameter 18.027 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 27
Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.028 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 28


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.029 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 29


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.030 Application Menu 1 Read-write Integer 30


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.031 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 31


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.032 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 32


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.033 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 33


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


376 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 18.034 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 34
Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.035 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 35


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.036 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 36


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.037 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 37


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.038 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 38


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.039 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 39


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.040 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 40


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 377
Parameter 18.041 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 41
Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.042 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 42


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.043 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 43


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.044 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 44


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.045 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 45


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.046 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 46


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.047 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 47


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


378 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 18.048 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 48
Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.049 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 49


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.050 Application Menu 1 Read-write bit 50


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.051 Application Menu 1 Power-down Save Long Integer 51


Short description General power-down save long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.052 Application Menu 1 Power-down Save Long Integer 52


Short description General power-down save long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.053 Application Menu 1 Power-down Save Long Integer 53


Short description General power-down save long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 18.054 Application Menu 1 Power-down Save Long Integer 54


Short description General power-down save long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 379
Menu 19 Single Line Descriptions − Application Menu 2
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


380 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter Range Default Type
19.001 Application Menu 2 Power‑down Save Integer -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num PS
19.002 Application Menu 2 Read‑only Integer 2 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
19.003 Application Menu 2 Read‑only Integer 3 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
19.004 Application Menu 2 Read‑only Integer 4 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
19.005 Application Menu 2 Read‑only Integer 5 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
19.006 Application Menu 2 Read‑only Integer 6 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
19.007 Application Menu 2 Read‑only Integer 7 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
19.008 Application Menu 2 Read‑only Integer 8 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
19.009 Application Menu 2 Read‑only Integer 9 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
19.010 Application Menu 2 Read‑only Integer 10 -32768 to 32767 RO Num ND NC
19.011 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 11 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.012 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 12 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.013 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 13 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.014 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 14 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.015 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 15 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.016 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 16 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.017 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 17 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.018 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 18 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.019 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 19 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.020 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 20 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.021 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 21 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.022 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 22 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.023 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 23 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.024 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 24 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.025 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 25 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.026 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 26 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.027 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 27 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.028 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 28 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.029 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 29 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.030 Application Menu 2 Read‑write Integer 30 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num US
19.031 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 31 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.032 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 32 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.033 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 33 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.034 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 34 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.035 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 35 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.036 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 36 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.037 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 37 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.038 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 38 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.039 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 39 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.040 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 40 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.041 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 41 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.042 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 42 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.043 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 43 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.044 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 44 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.045 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 45 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.046 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 46 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.047 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 47 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.048 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 48 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 381
19.049 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 49 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.050 Application Menu 2 Read‑write bit 50 Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
19.051 Application Menu 2 Power‑down Save Long Integer 51 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PS
19.052 Application Menu 2 Power‑down Save Long Integer 52 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PS
19.053 Application Menu 2 Power‑down Save Long Integer 53 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PS
19.054 Application Menu 2 Power‑down Save Long Integer 54 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PS

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


382 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 19 − Application Menu 2
Mode: RFC‑A

See the introduction to menu 18.

Parameter 19.001 Application Menu 2 Power-down Save Integer


Short description General power-down save integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.002 Application Menu 2 Read-only Integer 2


Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Parameter 19.003 Application Menu 2 Read-only Integer 3


Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Parameter 19.004 Application Menu 2 Read-only Integer 4


Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Parameter 19.005 Application Menu 2 Read-only Integer 5


Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Parameter 19.006 Application Menu 2 Read-only Integer 6


Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 383
Parameter 19.007 Application Menu 2 Read-only Integer 7
Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Parameter 19.008 Application Menu 2 Read-only Integer 8


Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Parameter 19.009 Application Menu 2 Read-only Integer 9


Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Parameter 19.010 Application Menu 2 Read-only Integer 10


Short description General read-only integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PR, ND, NC

Parameter 19.011 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 11


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.012 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 12


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.013 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 13


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


384 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 19.014 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 14
Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.015 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 15


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.016 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 16


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.017 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 17


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.018 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 18


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.019 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 19


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.020 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 20


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 385
Parameter 19.021 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 21
Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.022 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 22


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.023 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 23


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.024 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 24


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.025 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 25


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.026 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 26


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.027 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 27


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


386 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 19.028 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 28
Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.029 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 29


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.030 Application Menu 2 Read-write Integer 30


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.031 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 31


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.032 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 32


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.033 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 33


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.034 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 34


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 387
Parameter 19.035 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 35
Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.036 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 36


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.037 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 37


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.038 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 38


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.039 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 39


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.040 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 40


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.041 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 41


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


388 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 19.042 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 42
Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.043 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 43


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.044 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 44


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.045 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 45


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.046 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 46


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.047 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 47


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.048 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 48


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 389
Parameter 19.049 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 49
Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.050 Application Menu 2 Read-write bit 50


Short description General read-write bit application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.051 Application Menu 2 Power-down Save Long Integer 51


Short description General power-down save long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.052 Application Menu 2 Power-down Save Long Integer 52


Short description General power-down save long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.053 Application Menu 2 Power-down Save Long Integer 53


Short description General power-down save long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 19.054 Application Menu 2 Power-down Save Long Integer 54


Short description General power-down save long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


390 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 20 Single Line Descriptions − Application Menu 3
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


20.001 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 1 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.002 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 2 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.003 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 3 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.004 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 4 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.005 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 5 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.006 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 6 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.007 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 7 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.008 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 8 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.009 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 9 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.010 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 10 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.011 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 11 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.012 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 12 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.013 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 13 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.014 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 14 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.015 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 15 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.016 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 16 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.017 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 17 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.018 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 18 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.019 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 19 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.020 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Integer 20 -32768 to 32767 0 RW Num
20.021 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 21 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.022 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 22 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.023 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 23 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.024 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 24 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.025 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 25 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.026 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 26 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.027 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 27 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.028 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 28 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.029 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 29 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.030 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 30 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.031 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 31 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.032 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 32 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.033 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 33 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.034 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 34 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.035 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 35 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.036 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 36 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.037 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 37 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.038 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 38 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.039 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 39 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num
20.040 Application Menu 3 Read‑write Long Integer 40 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 391
Menu 20 − Application Menu 3
Mode: RFC‑A

See the introduction to menu 18.

Parameter 20.001 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 1


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.002 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 2


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.003 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 3


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.004 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 4


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.005 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 5


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.006 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 6


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


392 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 20.007 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 7
Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.008 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 8


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.009 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 9


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.010 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 10


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.011 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 11


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.012 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 12


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.013 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 13


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 393
Parameter 20.014 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 14
Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.015 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 15


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.016 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 16


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.017 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 17


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.018 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 18


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.019 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 19


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.020 Application Menu 3 Read-write Integer 20


Short description General read-write integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -32768 Maximum 32767
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


394 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 20.021 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 21
Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.022 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 22


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.023 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 23


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.024 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 24


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.025 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 25


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.026 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 26


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.027 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 27


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 395
Parameter 20.028 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 28
Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.029 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 29


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.030 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 30


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.031 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 31


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.032 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 32


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.033 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 33


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.034 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 34


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


396 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 20.035 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 35
Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.036 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 36


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.037 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 37


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.038 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 38


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.039 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 39


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Parameter 20.040 Application Menu 3 Read-write Long Integer 40


Short description General read-write long integer application parameter
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate N/A
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 397
Menu 21 Single Line Descriptions − Motor 2 Parameters
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP2[MIN] to 50Hz: 1500.0
21.001 M2 Maximum Reference Clamp RW Num US
VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP2[MAX] 60Hz: 1800.0
VM_NEGATIVE_REF_CLAMP2[MIN] to
21.002 M2 Minimum Reference Clamp 0.0 RW Num US
VM_NEGATIVE_REF_CLAMP2[MAX]
A1 A2 (0), A1 Preset (1), A2 Preset (2),
21.003 M2 Reference Selector Preset (3), Keypad (4), Precision (5), A1 A2 (0) RW Txt US
Keypad Ref (6)
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
21.004 M2 Acceleration Rate 1 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] to
21.005 M2 Deceleration Rate 1 2.000 s RW Num US
VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX] s
50Hz: 50.0 Hz
21.006 M2 Rated Frequency 0.0 to 550.0 Hz RW Num US
60Hz: 60.0 Hz
VM_RATED_CURRENT[MIN] to
21.007 M2 Rated Current 0.000 A RW Num RA US
VM_RATED_CURRENT[MAX] A
50Hz: 1500.00 rpm
21.008 M2 Rated Speed 0.00 to 33000.00 rpm RW Num US
60Hz: 1800.00 rpm
200V drive: 230 V
400V drive 50Hz: 400 V
VM_AC_VOLTAGE_SET[MIN] to
21.009 M2 Rated Voltage 400V drive 60Hz: 460 V RW Num RA US
VM_AC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX] V
575V drive: 575 V
690V drive: 690 V
21.010 M2 Rated Power Factor 0.000 to 1.000 0.850 RW Num RA US
21.011 M2 Number Of Motor Poles Automatic (0) to 480 (240) Poles Automatic (0) Poles RW Txt US
21.012 M2 Stator Resistance 0.000000 to 1000.000000 Ω 0.000000 Ω RW Num RA US
21.014 M2 Transient Inductance 0.000 to 500.000 mH 0.000 mH RW Num RA US
21.015 Motor 2 Active Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
21.016 M2 Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 1.0 to 3000.0 s 89.0 s RW Num US
21.017 M2 Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 0.0000 to 200.0000 s/rad 0.0300 s/rad RW Num US
21.018 M2 Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1 0.00 to 655.35 s²/rad 0.10 s²/rad RW Num US
21.019 M2 Speed Controller Differential Feedback Gain Kd1 0.00000 to 0.65535 1/rad 0.00000 1/rad RW Num US
P1 Drive (0), P2 Drive (1), P1 Slot1 (2),
21.021 M2 Motor Control Feedback Select P2 Slot1 (3), P1 Slot2 (4), P2 Slot2 (5), P1 Drive (0) RW Txt US
P1 Slot3 (6), P2 Slot3 (7)
21.022 M2 Current Controller Kp Gain 0 to 30000 150 RW Num US
21.023 M2 Current Controller Ki Gain 0 to 30000 2000 RW Num US
21.024 M2 Stator Inductance 0.00 to 5000.00 mH 0.00 mH RW Num RA US
21.025 M2 Saturation Breakpoint 1 0.0 to 100.0 % 50.0 % RW Num US
21.026 M2 Saturation Breakpoint 3 0.0 to 100.0 % 75.0 % RW Num US
VM_MOTOR2_CURRENT_LIMIT[MIN] to
21.027 M2 Motoring Current Limit 175.0 % RW Num RA US
VM_MOTOR2_CURRENT_LIMIT[MAX] %
VM_MOTOR2_CURRENT_LIMIT[MIN] to
21.028 M2 Regenerating Current Limit 175.0 % RW Num RA US
VM_MOTOR2_CURRENT_LIMIT[MAX] %
VM_MOTOR2_CURRENT_LIMIT[MIN] to
21.029 M2 Symmetrical Current Limit 175.0 % RW Num RA US
VM_MOTOR2_CURRENT_LIMIT[MAX] %
21.032 M2 Current Reference Filter Time Constant 1 0.0 to 25.0 ms 0.0 ms RW Num US
21.033 M2 Low Speed Thermal Protection Mode 0 to 1 0 RW Num US
21.034 M2 Current Controller Mode Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
21.035 M2 Notch Filter Centre Frequency 50 to 1200 Hz 100 Hz RW Num US
21.036 M2 Notch Filter Bandwidth 0 to 1200 Hz 0 Hz RW Num US
21.039 M2 Motor Thermal Time Constant 2 1.0 to 3000.0 s 89.0 s RW Num US
21.040 M2 Motor Thermal Time Constant 2 Scaling 0 to 100 % 0% RW Num US
21.041 M2 Saturation Breakpoint 2 0.0 to 100.0 % 0.0 % RW Num US
21.042 M2 Saturation Breakpoint 4 0.0 to 100.0 % 0.0 % RW Num US
21.043 M2 Torque Per Amp 0.00 to 500.00 Nm/A RO Num ND NC PT
21.044 M2 No‑load Core Loss 0.000 to 99999.999 kW 0.000 kW RW Num US
21.045 M2 Rated Core Loss 0.000 to 99999.999 kW 0.000 kW RW Num US
21.046 M2 Magnetising Current Limit 0.0 to 100.0 % 100.0 % RW Num US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


398 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 21 − Motor 2 Parameters
Mode: RFC‑A

Contains parameter relative to the set up for motor map 2.

Parameter 21.001 M2 Maximum Reference Clamp


Short description Defines the maximum reference clamp for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP2[MIN] Maximum VM_POSITIVE_REF_CLAMP2[MAX]
Default See exceptions below Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

Default Value
1500.0
1800.0

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Maximum Reference Clamp (01.006).

Parameter 21.002 M2 Minimum Reference Clamp


Short description Defines the minimum reference clamp for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_NEGATIVE_REF_CLAMP2[MIN] Maximum VM_NEGATIVE_REF_CLAMP2[MAX]
Default 0.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Minimum Reference Clamp (01.007).

Parameter 21.003 M2 Reference Selector


Short description Defines which reference is used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 6
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 A1 A2
1 A1 Preset
2 A2 Preset
3 Preset
4 Keypad
5 Precision
6 Keypad Ref

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Reference Selector (01.014).

Parameter 21.004 M2 Acceleration Rate 1


Short description Defines the acceleration rate used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Acceleration Rate 1 (02.011).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 399
Parameter 21.005 M2 Deceleration Rate 1
Short description Defines the deceleration rate used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_ACCEL_RATE[MAX]
Default 2.000 Units s
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Deceleration Rate 1 (02.021).

Parameter 21.006 M2 Rated Frequency


Short description Defines the motor rated frequency used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 550.0
Default See exceptions below Units Hz
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

Default Value
50.0
60.0

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Rated Frequency (05.006).

Parameter 21.007 M2 Rated Current


Short description Defines the motor rated used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_RATED_CURRENT[MIN] Maximum VM_RATED_CURRENT[MAX]
Default 0.000 Units A
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM, RA

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Rated Current (05.007).

Parameter 21.008 M2 Rated Speed


Short description Defines the motor rated speed used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 33000.00
Default See exceptions below Units rpm
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW

Default Value
1500.00
1800.00

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Rated Speed (05.008).

Parameter 21.009 M2 Rated Voltage


Short description Defines the motor rated voltage used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AC_VOLTAGE_SET[MIN] Maximum VM_AC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX]
Default See exceptions below Units V
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM, RA

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


400 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Voltage Region Default Value
200V All 230
400V 50Hz 400
400V 60Hz 460
575V All 575
690V All 690

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Rated Voltage (05.009).

Parameter 21.010 M2 Rated Power Factor


Short description Defines the motor rated power factor used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 1.000
Default 0.850 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read/write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, RA

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Rated Power Factor (05.010).

Parameter 21.011 M2 Number Of Motor Poles


Short description Defines the number of motor poles used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 240
Default 0 Units PolePairs
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Number Of Motor Poles (05.011).

Parameter 21.012 M2 Stator Resistance


Short description Defines the stator resistance used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000000 Maximum 1000.000000
Default 0.000000 Units Ω
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 6
Coding RW, RA

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Stator Resistance (05.017).

Parameter 21.014 M2 Transient Inductance


Short description Defines the transient inductance used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 500.000
Default 0.000 Units mH
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, RA

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Transient Inductance (05.024).

Parameter 21.015 Motor 2 Active


Short description Indicates if motor 2 parameters are being used by the drive
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

If Motor 2 Active (21.015) = 0 then the standard motor set-up parameters are being used or if Motor 2 Active (21.015) = 1 then the motor 2 parameters
are being used. The motor set-up parameters do not necessarily change immediately when Select Motor 2 Parameters (11.045) is changed (i.e. the
drive may be enabled). Motor 2 Active (21.015) shows the actual motor parameters being used and only changes when the new parameters start being
used by the drive.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 401
Parameter 21.016 M2 Motor Thermal Time Constant 1
Short description Defines the thermal time constant of the motor used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1.0 Maximum 3000.0
Default 89.0 Units s
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 (04.015).

Parameter 21.017 M2 Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1


Short description Defines the Kp value of the speed controller used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0000 Maximum 200.0000
Default 0.0300 Units s/rad
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010).

Parameter 21.018 M2 Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1


Short description Defines the Ki value of the speed controller used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 655.35
Default 0.10 Units s²/rad
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW, BU

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1 (03.011).

Parameter 21.019 M2 Speed Controller Differential Feedback Gain Kd1


Short description Defines the Kd value of the speed controller used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00000 Maximum 0.65535
Default 0.00000 Units 1/rad
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 5
Coding RW, BU

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Speed Controller Differential Feedback Gain Kd1 (03.012).

Parameter 21.021 M2 Motor Control Feedback Select


Short description Defines the source for the feedback device used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 7
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 P1 Drive
1 P2 Drive
2 P1 Slot1
3 P2 Slot1
4 P1 Slot2
5 P2 Slot2
6 P1 Slot3
7 P2 Slot3

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Motor Control Feedback Select (03.026).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


402 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 21.022 M2 Current Controller Kp Gain
Short description Defines the Kp value of the current controller used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 30000
Default 150 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Current Controller Kp Gain (04.013).

Parameter 21.023 M2 Current Controller Ki Gain


Short description Defines the Ki value of the current controller used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 30000
Default 2000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Current Controller Ki Gain (04.014).

Parameter 21.024 M2 Stator Inductance


Short description Definse the stator inductance of the motor used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 5000.00
Default 0.00 Units mH
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW, RA

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Stator Inductance (05.025).

Parameter 21.025 M2 Saturation Breakpoint 1


Short description Defines the position of saturation breakpoint 1 used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 100.0
Default 50.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Saturation Breakpoint 1 (05.029).

Parameter 21.026 M2 Saturation Breakpoint 3


Short description Defines the position of saturation breakpoint 3 used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 100.0
Default 75.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Saturation Breakpoint 3 (05.030).

Parameter 21.027 M2 Motoring Current Limit


Short description Defines the motoring current limit used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum VM_MOTOR2_CURRENT_LIMIT[MAX]
Default 175.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM, RA, BU

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Motoring Current Limit (04.005).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 403
Parameter 21.028 M2 Regenerating Current Limit
Short description Defines the regenerating current limit used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum VM_MOTOR2_CURRENT_LIMIT[MAX]
Default 175.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM, RA, BU

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Regenerating Current Limit (04.006).

Parameter 21.029 M2 Symmetrical Current Limit


Short description Defines the symmetrical current limit used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum VM_MOTOR2_CURRENT_LIMIT[MAX]
Default 175.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM, RA, BU

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Symmetrical Current Limit (04.007).

Parameter 21.032 M2 Current Reference Filter Time Constant 1


Defines the time constant of a first order filter that can be applied to the final current reference for motor
Short description
map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 25.0
Default 0.0 Units ms
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, BU

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Current Reference Filter 1 Time Constant (04.012).

Parameter 21.033 M2 Low Speed Thermal Protection Mode


Short description Set to enable low speed thermal protection mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Low Speed Thermal Protection Mode (04.025).

Parameter 21.034 M2 Current Controller Mode


Short description Set to enable high performance current controller mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Current Controller Mode (04.030).

Parameter 21.035 M2 Notch Filter Centre Frequency


Short description Defines the centre frequency for a notch filter to cancel a mechanical resonance
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 50 Maximum 1200
Default 100 Units Hz
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Notch Filter Centre Frequency (04.031).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


404 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 21.036 M2 Notch Filter Bandwidth
Short description Defines the bandwidth for a notch filter to cancel a mechanical resonance
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1200
Default 0 Units Hz
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Notch Filter Bandwidth (04.032).

Parameter 21.039 M2 Motor Thermal Time Constant 2


Short description Can be used to define an additional motor thermal time constant for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1.0 Maximum 3000.0
Default 89.0 Units s
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Motor Thermal Time Constant 2 (04.037).

Parameter 21.040 M2 Motor Thermal Time Constant 2 Scaling


Defines the ratio of the contribution to the motor protection accumulator value from each of the time
Short description
constants for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 100
Default 0 Units %
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Motor Thermal Time Constant 2 Scaling (04.038).

Parameter 21.041 M2 Saturation Breakpoint 2


Short description Defines the position of saturation breakpoint 2 used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 100.0
Default 0.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Saturation Breakpoint 2 (05.062).

Parameter 21.042 M2 Saturation Breakpoint 4


Short description Defines the position of saturation breakpoint 4 used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 100.0
Default 0.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Saturation Breakpoint 4 (05.063).

Parameter 21.043 M2 Torque Per Amp


Short description Displays the torque per amp of the motor used for motor map 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 500.00
Default Units Nm/A
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Torque Per Amp (05.032).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 405
Parameter 21.044 M2 No-load Core Loss
Short description M2 No-load Core Loss
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 99999.999
Default 0.000 Units kW
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for No-load Core Loss (04.045).

Parameter 21.045 M2 Rated Core Loss


Short description M2 Rated Core Loss
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 99999.999
Default 0.000 Units kW
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background Read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Rated Core Loss (04.046).

Parameter 21.046 M2 Magnetising Current Limit


Short description M2 Magnetising Current Limit
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 100.0
Default 100.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

This is the motor map 2 equivalent parameter for Magnetising Current Limit (04.049).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


406 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 22 Single Line Descriptions − Menu 0 Set-up
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 407
Parameter Range Default Type
22.001 Parameter 00.001 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 1.007 RW Num PT US
22.002 Parameter 00.002 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 1.006 RW Num PT US
22.003 Parameter 00.003 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 2.011 RW Num PT US
22.004 Parameter 00.004 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 2.021 RW Num PT US
22.005 Parameter 00.005 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 1.014 RW Num PT US
22.006 Parameter 00.006 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 4.007 RW Num PT US
22.007 Parameter 00.007 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 3.010 RW Num PT US
22.008 Parameter 00.008 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 3.011 RW Num PT US
22.009 Parameter 00.009 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 3.012 RW Num PT US
22.010 Parameter 00.010 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 3.002 RW Num PT US
22.011 Parameter 00.011 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 5.001 RW Num PT US
22.012 Parameter 00.012 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 4.001 RW Num PT US
22.013 Parameter 00.013 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 4.002 RW Num PT US
22.014 Parameter 00.014 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 4.011 RW Num PT US
22.015 Parameter 00.015 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 2.004 RW Num PT US
22.016 Parameter 00.016 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 2.002 RW Num PT US
22.017 Parameter 00.017 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 4.012 RW Num PT US
22.018 Parameter 00.018 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 3.123 RW Num PT US
22.019 Parameter 00.019 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 7.011 RW Num PT US
22.020 Parameter 00.020 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 7.014 RW Num PT US
22.021 Parameter 00.021 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 7.015 RW Num PT US
22.022 Parameter 00.022 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 1.010 RW Num PT US
22.023 Parameter 00.023 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 1.005 RW Num PT US
22.024 Parameter 00.024 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 1.021 RW Num PT US
22.025 Parameter 00.025 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 1.022 RW Num PT US
22.026 Parameter 00.026 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 3.008 RW Num PT US
22.027 Parameter 00.027 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 3.034 RW Num PT US
22.028 Parameter 00.028 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 6.013 RW Num PT US
22.029 Parameter 00.029 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 11.036 RW Num PT US
22.030 Parameter 00.030 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 11.042 RW Num PT US
22.031 Parameter 00.031 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 11.033 RW Num PT US
22.032 Parameter 00.032 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 11.032 RW Num PT US
22.033 Parameter 00.033 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 5.016 RW Num PT US
22.034 Parameter 00.034 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 11.030 RW Num PT US
22.035 Parameter 00.035 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.036 Parameter 00.036 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.037 Parameter 00.037 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 24.010 RW Num PT US
22.038 Parameter 00.038 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 4.013 RW Num PT US
22.039 Parameter 00.039 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 4.014 RW Num PT US
22.040 Parameter 00.040 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 5.012 RW Num PT US
22.041 Parameter 00.041 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 5.018 RW Num PT US
22.042 Parameter 00.042 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 5.011 RW Num PT US
22.043 Parameter 00.043 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 5.010 RW Num PT US
22.044 Parameter 00.044 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 5.009 RW Num PT US
22.045 Parameter 00.045 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 5.008 RW Num PT US
22.046 Parameter 00.046 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 5.007 RW Num PT US
22.047 Parameter 00.047 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 5.006 RW Num PT US
22.048 Parameter 00.048 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 11.031 RW Num PT US

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


408 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
22.049 Parameter 00.049 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 11.044 RW Num PT US
22.050 Parameter 00.050 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 11.029 RW Num PT US
22.051 Parameter 00.051 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 10.037 RW Num PT US
22.052 Parameter 00.052 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.053 Parameter 00.053 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 4.015 RW Num PT US
22.054 Parameter 00.054 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.055 Parameter 00.055 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.056 Parameter 00.056 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.057 Parameter 00.057 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.058 Parameter 00.058 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.059 Parameter 00.059 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.060 Parameter 00.060 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.061 Parameter 00.061 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.062 Parameter 00.062 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.063 Parameter 00.063 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.064 Parameter 00.064 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.065 Parameter 00.065 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.066 Parameter 00.066 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.067 Parameter 00.067 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.068 Parameter 00.068 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.069 Parameter 00.069 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.070 Parameter 00.070 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.071 Parameter 00.071 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.072 Parameter 00.072 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.073 Parameter 00.073 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.074 Parameter 00.074 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.075 Parameter 00.075 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.076 Parameter 00.076 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.077 Parameter 00.077 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.078 Parameter 00.078 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.079 Parameter 00.079 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US
22.080 Parameter 00.080 Set‑up 0.000 to 59.999 0.000 RW Num PT US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 409
Menu 22 − Menu 0 Set-up
Mode: RFC‑A

The parameters in this menu are used to set up which parameters are shown in Menu 0.

Parameter 22.001 Parameter 00.001 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.001
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 1.007 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

Each parameter is used to set up the equivalent parameter in Menu 0, for example Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001) is used to set up which parameter
is shown in Menu 0 Parameter 1 (00.001), etc. 80 selectable Menu 0 parameters (00.001 to 00.080) and equivalent set-up parameters (22.001 to
22.080) are provided. When a Menu 0 set-up parameter is set to 00.000 or a value that is not a valid parameter outside Menu 0, the equivalent Menu 0
parameter is not visible. If a parameter has an equivalent motor 2 parameter in Menu 21 then when Motor 2 Active (21.015) = 0 the original parameter is
displayed, but when Motor 2 Active (21.015) = 1 the equivalent motor 2 parameter from Menu 21 is displayed.

Parameter 22.002 Parameter 00.002 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.002
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 1.006 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.003 Parameter 00.003 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.003
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 2.011 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.004 Parameter 00.004 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.004
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 2.021 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.005 Parameter 00.005 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.005
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 1.014 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


410 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 22.006 Parameter 00.006 Set-up
Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.006
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 4.007 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.007 Parameter 00.007 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.007
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 3.010 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.008 Parameter 00.008 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.008
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 3.011 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.009 Parameter 00.009 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.009
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 3.012 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.010 Parameter 00.010 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.010
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 3.002 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.011 Parameter 00.011 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.011
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 5.001 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 411
Parameter 22.012 Parameter 00.012 Set-up
Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.012
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 4.001 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.013 Parameter 00.013 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.013
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 4.002 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.014 Parameter 00.014 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.014
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 4.011 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.015 Parameter 00.015 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.015
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 2.004 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.016 Parameter 00.016 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.016
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 2.002 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.017 Parameter 00.017 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.017
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 4.012 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


412 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 22.018 Parameter 00.018 Set-up
Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.018
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 3.123 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.019 Parameter 00.019 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.019
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 7.011 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.020 Parameter 00.020 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.020
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 7.014 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.021 Parameter 00.021 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.021
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 7.015 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.022 Parameter 00.022 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.022
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 1.010 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.023 Parameter 00.023 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.023
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 1.005 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 413
Parameter 22.024 Parameter 00.024 Set-up
Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.024
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 1.021 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.025 Parameter 00.025 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.025
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 1.022 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.026 Parameter 00.026 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.026
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 3.008 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.027 Parameter 00.027 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.027
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 3.034 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.028 Parameter 00.028 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.028
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 6.013 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.029 Parameter 00.029 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.029
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 11.036 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


414 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 22.030 Parameter 00.030 Set-up
Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.030
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 11.042 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.031 Parameter 00.031 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.031
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 11.033 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.032 Parameter 00.032 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.032
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 11.032 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.033 Parameter 00.033 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.033
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 5.016 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.034 Parameter 00.034 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.034
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 11.030 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.035 Parameter 00.035 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.035
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 415
Parameter 22.036 Parameter 00.036 Set-up
Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.036
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.037 Parameter 00.037 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.037
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 24.010 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.038 Parameter 00.038 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.038
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 4.013 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.039 Parameter 00.039 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.039
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 4.014 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.040 Parameter 00.040 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.040
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 5.012 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.041 Parameter 00.041 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.041
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 5.018 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


416 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 22.042 Parameter 00.042 Set-up
Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.042
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 5.011 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.043 Parameter 00.043 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.043
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 5.010 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.044 Parameter 00.044 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.044
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 5.009 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.045 Parameter 00.045 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.045
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 5.008 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.046 Parameter 00.046 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.046
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 5.007 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.047 Parameter 00.047 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.047
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 5.006 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 417
Parameter 22.048 Parameter 00.048 Set-up
Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.048
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 11.031 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.049 Parameter 00.049 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.049
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 11.044 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.050 Parameter 00.050 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.050
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 11.029 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.051 Parameter 00.051 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.051
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 10.037 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.052 Parameter 00.052 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.052
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.053 Parameter 00.053 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.053
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 4.015 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


418 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 22.054 Parameter 00.054 Set-up
Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.054
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.055 Parameter 00.055 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.055
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.056 Parameter 00.056 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.056
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.057 Parameter 00.057 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.057
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.058 Parameter 00.058 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.058
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.059 Parameter 00.059 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.059
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 419
Parameter 22.060 Parameter 00.060 Set-up
Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.060
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.061 Parameter 00.061 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.061
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.062 Parameter 00.062 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.062
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.063 Parameter 00.063 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.063
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.064 Parameter 00.064 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.064
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.065 Parameter 00.065 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.065
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


420 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 22.066 Parameter 00.066 Set-up
Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.066
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.067 Parameter 00.067 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.067
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.068 Parameter 00.068 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.068
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.069 Parameter 00.069 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.069
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.070 Parameter 00.070 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.070
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.071 Parameter 00.071 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.071
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 421
Parameter 22.072 Parameter 00.072 Set-up
Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.072
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.073 Parameter 00.073 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.073
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.074 Parameter 00.074 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.074
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.075 Parameter 00.075 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.075
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.076 Parameter 00.076 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.076
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.077 Parameter 00.077 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.077
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


422 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 22.078 Parameter 00.078 Set-up
Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.078
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.079 Parameter 00.079 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.079
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Parameter 22.080 Parameter 00.080 Set-up


Short description Defines the parameter to be shown in 00.080
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 59.999
Default 0.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, PT, BU

See Parameter 00.001 Set-up (22.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 423
Menu 26 Single Line Descriptions − Ethernet Setup
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


26.001 Module ID 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT
26.002 Software Version 0 to 99999999 RO Num ND NC PT
26.003 Hardware Version 0.00 to 99.99 RO Num ND NC PT
26.004 Serial Number LS 00000000 to 99999999 RO Num ND NC PT
26.005 Serial Number MS 0 to 99999999 RO Num ND NC PT
Bootldr ‑ Update (-2), Bootldr ‑ Idle (-1),
26.006 Status RO Txt ND NC PT
Initialising (0), OK (1), Config (2), Error (3)
26.007 Reset Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
26.008 Default Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
26.009 Active Alarm Bits 0000000000000000 to 1111111111111111 0000000000000000 RO Bin NC
26.010 Active IP Address 128.0.0.0 to 127.255.255.255 RO IP ND NC PT
26.011 Date Code 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT
26.012 Capability Mask 000000000000000 to 111111111111111 RO Bin ND NC PT

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


424 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 24 − Ethernet Setup
Mode: RFC‑A

Menu 24 is a duplication of slot 4 menu 0. For a description of a particular parameter, click on the relevant slot parameter in the table below.

Drive Parameter Slot Parameter


24.001 Module ID 4.00.001 Module ID
24.002 Software Version 4.00.002 Software Version
24.003 Hardware Version 4.00.003 Hardware Version
24.004 Serial Number LS 4.00.004 Serial Number LS
24.005 Serial Number MS 4.00.005 Serial Number MS
24.006 Status 4.00.006 Status
24.007 Reset 4.00.007 Reset
24.008 Default 4.00.008 Default
24.009 Active Alarm Bits 4.00.009 Active Alarm Bits
24.010 Active IP Address 4.00.010 Active IP Address
24.011 Date Code 4.00.011 Date Code
24.012 Capability Mask 4.00.012 Capability Mask

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 425
Menu 31 Single Line Descriptions − AMC General Set-up
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


31.001 AMC Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
31.002 AMC Absolute Mode Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
31.003 AMC Incremental Position Reset Mode Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
31.004 AMC Master User Units Ratio Numerator 1 to 2147483647 1000 RW Num US
31.005 AMC Master User Units Ratio Denominator 1 to 2147483647 1000 RW Num US
31.006 AMC Slave User Units Ratio Numerator 1 to 2147483647 1000 RW Num US
31.007 AMC Slave User Units Ratio Denominator 1 to 2147483647 1000 RW Num US
31.008 AMC Output User Units Ratio Numerator 1 to 2147483647 1000 RW Num US
31.009 AMC Output User Units Ratio Denominator 1 to 2147483647 1000 RW Num US
31.010 AMC Roll‑over Limit 0 to VM_AMC_ROLLOVER UU 0 UU RW Num US
31.011 AMC Synchronise To Onboard User Program Clock Task Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
4ms (1), 2ms (2), 1ms (3),
31.012 AMC Rate Select 250us (5) RW Txt US
500us (4), 250us (5)
Not Active (0), 4ms (1), 2ms (2),
31.013 AMC Rate Selected RO Txt ND NC PT
1ms (3), 500us (4), 250us (5)
31.014 AMC Speed Mode Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
31.015 AMC Auto Resolution Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
31.016 AMC Auto Resolution Scaling 1 to 2147483647 RO Num ND NC PT

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


426 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 31 − AMC General Set-up
Mode: RFC‑A

System components

The diagram below shows the format and interface for the Advance Motion Controller.

The Advanced Motion Controller includes its own profile generator and combines the speed feed-forwards from the profile with the output of its position control loop to
give a single speed reference in 0.1rpm or 0.1mm/s units. The conversion to the output speed is based on the set-up parameters of the position feedback selected to
control the motor.

The Advanced Motion Controller is made up from the components shown in the diagram below. Individual menus are provided for each of the components.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 427
Function Description

The master position can be used as the input to the Cam or electronic gearbox functions and can be derived as follows:
Master
From a position feedback interface in the drive or a position feedback interface in an option module.
Position
As a speed (normally fixed) so that it can be used to create a time based profile.
As a user position value from a parameter.

The slave position is used as the feedback for the position control loop and can be derived as follows:
Slave
Position From a position feedback interface in the drive or a position feedback interface in an option module.
As a user position value from a parameter.

The reference selector is used to select the input to the profile generator. In addition to the output from the Cam or electronic gearbox functions, a position
Reference
or speed reference can be selected. The stop reference is a position that is constantly updated to provide a target when the system is to stop under the
selector
constraints of the profile generator. The homing system can provide a reference at the input to the profile generator during a homing routine.
The Cam function uses a table to define the movement of the slave with respect to the master. The Cam table consists of a number of segments.
Cam
Interpolation functions are provided to define the type of movement required by the slave within each segment.
Cam
The Cam table is used by the Cam to define the required movement of the slave in response to the movement of the master.
Table
Electronic The electronic gearbox allows the slave to be locked to the master including a gearbox ratio. The profile generator is used during the transition between
gearbox the unlocked and locked states to control the acceleration of the slave.
The input to the profile generator is a target that it attempts to attain within the required constraints. These constraints include the maximum linear
Profile acceleration/deceleration, jerk and speed. The target for the profile generator can be a position, a speed, or a position and a speed. The outputs of the
generator profile generator include a speed that is used directly as a speed feed-forward term, acceleration that is used to derive the torque or acceleration feed-
forward terms and a position that is used as the input to a position control loop.
Position
The position control loop modifies the motion controller output speed to correct the slave position and compensate for deviations from the required profile
control
due to control system and load effects.
loop
Homing The homing system can move the slave under the constraints of the profile generator to find the home position. Once the home position is detected the
system system can be offset so that the required position is seen at the homing point.
Control
The control and status system provides overall control for the motion controller and gives status information with a number of flags.
and status

Position units

Position feedback from a drive or option module position feedback interface is given as a 32 bit signed value (normalised position) including the effect of the marker
input for the interface (if relevant). The number of bits that represent turns (for a rotary position feedback device) or motor poles (for a linear position feedback device)
can be selected for each position feedback device with a parameter in the set-up menu for that interface. Position is represented in the Advanced Motion Controller as
a 32 bit signed value. Conversion ratios can be applied to the master position (AMC Master User Units Ratio Numerator (31.004) /
AMC Master User Units Ratio Denominator (31.005)), the slave position (AMC Slave User Units Ratio Numerator (31.006) / AMC Slave User Units Ratio Denominator
(31.007)) and the motion controller output (AMC Output User Units Ratio Numerator (31.008) / AMC Output User Units Ratio Denominator (31.009)). The
slave position can be provided by the encoder used to control the motor or from an additional encoder attached to the load (i.e. dual loop configuration) as shown
below.

The input ratios should be used to convert the normalised master and slave position to the required user units used for position within the motion controller and the
output ratio should be setup to convert from user units to the normalised position units for the feedback device used to control the motor. If the slave feedback is
derived from the position feedback used to control the motor the output ratio will be the inverse of the slave ratio. In a dual loop configuration the output ratio must be

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


428 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
setup to correct for any differences between the configuration of the normalised units and the speed of the slave (load) and motor feedback, i.e. mechanical gearing.
The conversion from position units to user units (input ratio) and from user units back into position units (output ratio) is demonstrated in the following examples. In
these examples the parameter references refer to a feedback device connected to the drives P1 or P2 interface but any drive or option module interface can be
used.

Example 1 - Rotary encoder

Position feedback configuration and user units requirements:

The normalised position for the slave position feedback has 16 P1 Normalisation Turns (03.057) and 16 position bits
One revolution of the slave gives a movement of 1m
User units are to represent an item that is 3.57cm long with a resolution of 3 decimal places (1 user unit = 3.57cm/1000 = 35.7μm)

The slave user units ratio can be setup to convert the 32 bit normalised position into 35.7μm units as follows:

Change of user units over the required range = 1m / 35.7-6m = 107 / 357
Change of normalised position over the required range = 2Position bits

AMC Slave User Units Ratio Numerator (31.006) = 107

AMC Slave User Units Ratio Denominator (31.007) = 216 x 357 = 23396352

The output ratio is the inverse of the input ratio:

AMC Output User Units Ratio Numerator (31.008) = 216 x 357 = 23396352

AMC Output User Units Ratio Denominator (31.009) = 107

Example 2: Linear Encoder

Position feedback configuration and user units requirements:

The normalised position for the slave position feedback has 8 P1 Normalisation Turns (03.057) and 24 position bits.
64 poles correspond to a linear movement of 10m (P1 Pole Pair Pitch (03.055) = 1000 x 10 / 64 = 156.25 mm).
The position units require a resolution of 1μm.

The slave user units ratio can be setup to convert the 32 bit normalised position into 0.001mm units as follows:

Change of user units over the required range = 10m / 10-6m = 107
Change of normalised position over the required range = 64 x 2Position bits = 230

AMC Slave User Units Ratio Numerator (31.006) = 107

AMC Slave User Units Ratio Denominator (31.007) = 230

The output ratio is the inverse of the input ratio:

AMC Output User Units Ratio Numerator (31.008) = 230

AMC Output User Units Ratio Denominator (31.009) = 107

Example 3 - Rotary encoders with different motor and slave feedback devices (i.e. dual loop configuration)

Position feedback configuration and user units requirements:

The normalised position for the slave position feedback has 12 P1 Normalisation Turns (03.057) and 20 position bits
The normalised position for the motor feedback has 16 P2 Normalisation Turns (03.157) and 16 position bits
User units are to represent one revolution in degrees with three decimal places (1 revolution = 360000 user units)
There is a gear ratio of 16:1 between the motor and slave feedback

The slave user units ratio can be setup to convert the 32 bit normalised position into 0.001 degree units as follows:

Change of user units over the required range = 360000


Change of normalised position over the required range = 220

AMC Slave User Units Ratio Numerator (31.006) = 360000

AMC Slave User Units Ratio Denominator (31.007) = 220

In this example the output ratio is setup to convert from user units to the normalised position units for the motor feedback and must include the inverse of the gear
ratio to ensure that the required output speed is seen at the slave feedback.

AMC Output User Units Ratio Numerator (31.008) = 216 x 16

AMC Output User Units Ratio Denominator (31.009) = 360000

Speed units

Speed parameters are 32 bit values specified in User units/ms with a range from -231 to 231-1. The speed parameters have two decimal places. If PosBits are the
number of bits representing the number of counts per revolution for a rotary position feedback device then the speed resolution is calculated as follows:

Speed resolution

= 0.01 user units/ms


= (0.01 / User units ratio) PosBits/ms
= (0.01 / 2PosBits / User units ratio) revs/ms
= (10 / 2PosBits / User units ratio) revs/s

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 429
= (600 / 2PosBits / User units ratio) rpm

If PosBits are the number of bits representing the counts per pole pitch (PolePitch) for a linear feedback device then the speed resolution is calculated as follows:

Speed resolution

= 0.01 user units/ms


= (0.01 / User units ratio) PosBits/ms
= (0.01 / 2PosBits / User units ratio) poles/ms
= (0.01 x PolePitch / 2PosBits / User units ratio) mm/ms
= (10 x PolePitch / 2PosBits / User units ratio) mm/s

The speed resolution and the maximum speed can be calculated using the equations in the table below.

Speed Calculation Units


Resolution with rotary position feedback device (600 / 2PosBits) / User units ratio rpm
Maximum speed with rotary position feedback device Resolution x 231-1 rpm
Resolution with linear position feedback device (10 x PolePitch / 2PosBits) / User units ratio mm/s
Maximum speed with linear position feedback device Resolution x 231-1 mm/s

The resolution can be used to relate the parameter value to the speed of the position feedback device as follows.

Speed parameter value = Speed of position feedback device / Resolution

The table below shows the speed resolution and the maximum possible speed for a rotary application in rpm and for a linear application with a pole pitch of 50mm in
mm/s with a user units ratio of unity. A user units ratio of more than unity will not change the resolution, but a user units ratio of less than unity will make the resolution
coarser.

Turns bits Position bits Resolution (rpm) Maximum speed (rpm) Resolution (mm/s) Maximum speed (mm/s)
8 24 3.58x10-5 7.68x104 2.98x10-5 6.40x104
12 20 5.72x10-4 1.23x106 4.77x10-4 1.02x106
16 16 9.16x10-3 1.97x107 7.63x10-3 1.64x107
20 12 1.46x10-1 3.15x108 1.22x10-1 2.62x108
24 8 2.34 5.03x109 1.95 4.19x109

To allow the profile generator to work at the minimum acceleration (0.001 user units/ms/ms) the internal speed resolution used by the profile generator is defined by
the minimum acceleration unit. When the profile generator is enabled (AMC Profile Disable (38.005) = 0) the maximum speed can be limited by the output of the profile
generator. As above, the maximum profile speed is calculated from the speed resolution and the internal speed resolution of the profile generator is calculated as
follows:

Profile speed resolution = Speed resolution / 10.24 x (1ms / AMC Rate Selected (31.013))

The table below shows the internal profile speed resolution and the maximum speed when AMC Rate Selected (31.013) = 250μs.

Turns Position Profile Internal Profile Maximum Profile Internal Profile Maximum
bits bits Resolution (rpm) Speed (rpm) Resolution (mm/s) Speed (mm/s)
8 24 8.73x10-7 1.87x103 7.28x10-7 1.56x103
12 20 1.40x10-5 3.00x104 1.16x10-5 2.50x104
16 16 2.24x10-4 4.80x105 1.86x10-4 4.00x105
20 12 3.58x10-3 7.68x106 2.98x10-3 6.40x106
24 8 5.72x10-2 1.23x108 4.77x10-2 1.02x108

If a higher maximum profile speed is required the resolution can be decreased by using a user unit ratio less than unity or AMC Rate Selected (31.013) can be
increased.

Acceleration units

Acceleration parameters are 32 bit values specified in User units/ms/ms with a range from 0 to 230 - 1. The acceleration parameters have 4 decimal places. If PosBits
are the number of counts per revolution for a rotary position feedback device then the acceleration resolution is calculated as follows:

Acceleration resolution

= 0.001 user units/ms/ms


= (0.001 / User units ratio) PosBits/ms/ms
= (0.001 / 2PosBits / User units ratio) revs/ms/ms
= (1000 / 2PosBits / User units ratio) revs/s/s
= (60000 / 2PosBits / User units ratio) rpm/s

If PosBits are the number bits representing the counts per pole pitch (PolePitch) for a linear feedback device then the acceleration resolution is calculated as follows:

Acceleration resolution

= 0.001 user units/ms/ms


= (0.001 / User units ratio) PosBits/ms/ms
= (0.001 / 2PosBits / User units ratio) poles/ms/ms
= (0.001 x PolePitch / 2PosBits / User units ratio) mm/ms/ms
= (1000 x PolePitch / 2PosBits / User units ratio) mm/s2

The acceleration resolution and the maximum acceleration can be calculated using the equations in the table below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


430 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Acceleration Calculation Units
Resolution with rotary position feedback device (60000 / 2PosBits) / User units ratio rpm/s
Maximum acceleration with rotary position feedback device Resolution x 230-1 rpm/s
Resolution with linear position feedback device (1000 x PolePitch / 2PosBits) / User units ratio mm/s2
Maximum acceleration with linear position feedback device Resolution x 230-1 mm/s2

The resolution can be used to relate the parameter value to the acceleration of the position feedback device as follows:

Acceleration parameter value = Acceleration of position feedback device / Resolution

The table below shows the minimum and maximum time that can be set up to acceleration from zero to 3000rpm for a rotary application and zero to 1m/s for a linear
application with a user units ratio of unity. A user units ratio of more than unity will not change the resolution, but a user units ratio of less than unity will make the
resolution coarser.

Turns Position Maximum acceleration time to Minimum acceleration time to Maximum acceleration time Minimum acceleration time
bits bits 3000rpm (s) 3000rpm (s) to 1ms-1 (s) to 1ms-1 (s)
8 24 8.39x105 7.81x10-4 3.36x105 3.13x10-4

12 20 5.24x104 4.88x10-5 2.10x104 1.95x10-5

16 16 3.28x103 3.05x10-6 1.31x103 1.22x10-6


20 12 2.05x105 1.91x10-7 8.19x101 7.63x10-8

24 8 1.28x101 1.19x10-8 5.12 4.77x10-9

Parameter 31.001 AMC Select


Short description Set to 1 to write the output of the motion controller to the Hard Speed Reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

When the Advanced Motion Controller is selected (i.e. AMC Select (31.001) = 1) the output of the motion controller is written to Hard Speed Reference (03.022). The
table below shows the effect of changing the value of AMC Select (31.001).

AMC Select (31.001) Action

On changing from 1 to 0:

0 Hard Speed Reference (03.022) = 0

Hard Speed Reference Select (03.023) = 0

On changing from 0 to 1:

1 Hard Speed Reference (03.022) = AMC Output Speed (39.012)

Hard Speed Reference Select (03.023) = 1

If Hard Speed Reference Select (03.023) is turned off after the motion controller has been initialised the motion controller will operate as expected
but AMC Output Speed (39.012) will not be written to Hard Speed Reference (03.022). If the motion controller is not selected (i.e. AMC Select (31.001) = 0) none of
the functionality in menu 31 to menu 41 is enabled.

Parameter 31.002 AMC Absolute Mode Enable


Short description Set to 1 to enable the absolute mode of the advance motion controller
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

AMC Absolute Mode Enable (31.002) defines how the position feedback information is transferred to the integrators for the master and slave source positions.

If AMC Absolute Mode Enable (31.002) = 0 then the integrators are either held at zero (AMC Incremental Position Reset Mode (31.003) = 0), or continue to operate
normally (AMC Incremental Position Reset Mode (31.003) = 1), when the motion controller is disabled. (See AMC Enable (41.001) for details on how to enable or
disable the motion controller.) Therefore both the master and slave positions are incremental relative to zero when the motion controller is enabled or when the drive
was powered up respectively. When the motion controller is enabled the change of position from the position feedback device is modified by the user unit ratio, and
inverted if required, before being accumulated in the integrator.

If AMC Absolute Mode Enable (31.002) = 1 then the position is taken from the position feedback device, modified by the user units ratio, inverted if required and then
written to the integrator when the motion controller is initialised or any parameter which results in a change of absolute position is modified. After the feedback has

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 431
been initialised the change of position from the position feedback device is modified by the user unit ratio, and inverted if required, before being accumulated in the
integrator when the motion controller is enabled or disabled. If the user unit ratio is above unity the master and slave position integrators can rollover the boundary
during initialisation. When AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) > 0 the initialisation of the slave position is handled differently to allow the position within the rollover limit to be
recovered correctly after the normalised position or the internal user position has rolled over a boundary, see AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010).

Parameter 31.003 AMC Incremental Position Reset Mode


If set to 0 the integrators are held at zero when the AMC is disabled, and if set to 1 the integrators
Short description
continue to operate normally when the AMC is disabled
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See AMC Absolute Mode Enable (31.002).

Parameter 31.004 AMC Master User Units Ratio Numerator


Short description Defines the numerator of the AMC Master User Units Ratio
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 2147483647
Default 1000 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The master user units ratio (AMC Master User Units Ratio Numerator (31.004) / AMC Master User Units Ratio Denominator (31.005)) is applied to the master position
to convert the feedback position from normalised units to user units. Similar ratios are provided for the slave position and the output of the motion controller. The
configuration of these ratios is described in AMC General Set-up (31).

Parameter 31.005 AMC Master User Units Ratio Denominator


Short description Defines the denominator of the AMC Master User Units Ratio
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 2147483647
Default 1000 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See AMC Master User Units Ratio Numerator (31.004).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


432 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 31.006 AMC Slave User Units Ratio Numerator
Short description Defines the numerator of the AMC Slave User Units Ratio
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 2147483647
Default 1000 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See AMC Master User Units Ratio Numerator (31.004).

Parameter 31.007 AMC Slave User Units Ratio Denominator


Short description Defines the denominator of the AMC Slave User Units Ratio
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 2147483647
Default 1000 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See AMC Master User Units Ratio Numerator (31.004).

Parameter 31.008 AMC Output User Units Ratio Numerator


Short description Defines the numerator of the AMC Output User Units Ratio
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 2147483647
Default 1000 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See AMC Master User Units Ratio Numerator (31.004).

Parameter 31.009 AMC Output User Units Ratio Denominator


Short description Defines the denominator of the AMC Output User Units Ratio
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 2147483647
Default 1000 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See AMC Master User Units Ratio Numerator (31.004).

Parameter 31.010 AMC Roll-over Limit


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_ROLLOVER[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

If AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) = 0 the motion controller operates over a range from -231 to 231-1, i.e. VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] = -231 and
VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] = 231-1, and the system can rollover the VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] and VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] boundaries without a transient.
When AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) is set to a non-zero value the motion controller continues to operate over a range from -2 31 to 231-1 internally but the position
parameters display a position from zero to AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) - 1, i.e. VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] = 0 and VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] = AMC Roll-over Limit
(31.010) - 1, and the system can rollover the zero or VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] boundaries without a transient. Note that when AMC Auto Resolution Enable (31.015)
is enabled VM_AMC_ROLLOVER[MAX] = 230-1 / AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016).

When AMC Absolute Mode Enable (31.002) = 0 the position parameters are always set to zero during initialisation. When AMC Absolute Mode Enable (31.002) = 1 the
absolute slave position is recovered from the user and normalised positions saved on power down. This allows an absolute encoder to be homed once and for the
correct position within the rollover limit to be recovered after the internal user position or the normalised position has rolled over the minimum or maximum boundary
one or more times. Note that the correct absolute position will only be recovered if the normalised position has moved by less than half of the maximum range when
the drive is off and absolute mode is enabled when the motion controller is initialised. Note that when using the control word to configure the absolute
mode AMC Control Word Enable (41.021) should be set to mode 2 to ensure the absolute position is recovered correctly during initialisation. The master position is
always initialised with the absolute position calculated using the normalised position and the master user unit ratio. The initial position (AMC Master Position
(32.004)) within the rollover limit is derived from this position as shown in the diagram below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 433
When AMC Absolute Mode Enable (31.002) is enabled the slave position is initialised using the same method as the master position, but after the internal user or
normalised positions have rolled over one of the boundaries the slave position may no longer be directly related to the normalised position of the feedback device.

Parameter 31.011 AMC Synchronise To Onboard User Program Clock Task


Short description Set to 1 to allow the AMC to be controlled synchronously by an onboard user program clock task
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Most time critical parts of the Advanced Motion Controller operate at the sample rate set in AMC Rate Select (31.012). The homing function and most parameter
access operate at a 4ms rate. The timing of the controller (AMC Rate Select (31.012) = 250μs) and parameter reading and writing is shown below with respect to other
tasks in the drive.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


434 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
The following examples show how the Advanced Motion Controller can be controlled in different configurations. Note that
AMC Synchronise To Onboard User Program Clock Task (31.011) should only be enabled when the onboard user program is writing to one of the parameters updated
at the beginning of every motion controller task.

Stand-alone motion controller

Most parameters are set up during commissioning and are not time critical. AMC Action On Event (34.008) can be used to set up triggered time critical events, or the
position and speed references can be controlled via communications from an external controller.

Simple position control loop with option module providing the rest of the motion controller

AMC External Position Reference (39.002), AMC External Speed Reference  (39.004) and AMC External Acceleration Reference (39.014) can be used by an option
module as the references for a simple position control loop. These values should be updated outside the active period of the motion controller.

Motion controller controlled by an option module

AMC Master User Position Reference (32.009), AMC Slave User Position Reference (33.009), AMC Position Reference (34.003), AMC Speed Reference (34.006) and


AMC Reference Select (34.007) can be modified every 250μs and should be updated outside the active period of the motion controller. AMC Action On Event (34.008)
can be used to set up triggered time critical events.

Motion controller controlled by an on-board user program

All 250μs read parameters are cached for use by the motion controller at the start of the thread where the user program timed task will be started and not at the start of
every thread in which the motion controller runs. This means that the values that were updated during the previous timed task are read together.

Parameter 31.012 AMC Rate Select


Short description Defines the sample rate of the AMC
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 5
Default 5 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 435
Value Text
1 4ms
2 2ms
3 1ms
4 500us
5 250us

AMC Rate Selected (31.013) indicates whether the Advanced Motion Controller is active or not, and the sample rate being used. The sample rate for the Advanced
Motion Controller is selected with AMC Rate Select (31.012). It should be noted that both the Advanced and Standard motion controllers cannot be active at the same
time and can only be enabled or disabled when the drive is in the disabled state. If both motion controllers are selected at power-up the Standard Motion Controller will
take priority.

The sample rate of the Advanced Motion Controller is limited in each of conditions shown in the table below. If more than one of the conditions is active the motion
controller will operate at the slower of the two update rates, i.e. if an option module is used to provide the position feedback and an s-ramp profile is enabled then
AMC Rate Selected (31.013) is limited to 1ms.

Mode Description Maximum sample rate

AMC Master Source Select (32.001) ≥ 4 Option module feedback interface 500μs

AMC Slave Source Select (33.001) ≥ 4 Option module feedback interface 500μs

AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) > 0 500μs

AMC Profile Jerk 1 (38.011) > 0 S-ramp profile active 1ms

Sensorless Mode Active (03.078) = On (1) 4ms

Parameter 31.013 AMC Rate Selected


Short description Shows the actual sample rate of the AMC
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 5
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text
0 Not Active
1 4ms
2 2ms
3 1ms
4 500us
5 250us

See AMC Rate Select (31.012).

Parameter 31.014 AMC Speed Mode Enable


Short description Set to 1 to enable speed mode
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Speed mode is active when AMC Speed Mode Enable (31.014) = 1 and AMC Reference Select (34.007) = 2 (speed reference). When speed mode is
active AMC Profile Maximum Speed (38.003) is ignored, AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) and AMC Profile Output Position (38.008) are set to AMC Slave Position
(33.004) at the beginning of each sample and AMC Position Error (39.008) is held at zero. If AMC Position Error (39.008) is not zero when speed mode is activated
AMC Position Error (39.008) x AMC Position Control Loop Kp Gain (39.007) / 1000 (clamped by AMC Output Speed Clamp (39.011)) is added to
AMC Profile Output Speed (38.009) to prevent a transient in AMC Output Speed (39.012).

Parameter 31.015 AMC Auto Resolution Enable


Short description Set to 1 to enable auto resolution which can increase the internal resolution used by the AMC
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

When AMC Auto Resolution Enable (31.015) = 0 the Advanced Motion Controller works in the resolution of the user units. If the output ratio
(AMC Output User Units Ratio Numerator (31.008) / AMC Output User Units Ratio Denominator (31.009)) > 1 the resolution of the user units is lower than the
resolution of the normalised position of the motor feedback device. For example, if the slave moves 100mm for every revolution of the motor and the motor normalised
position has 16 position bits per revolution.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


436 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
AMC Output User Units Ratio Numerator (31.008) / AMC Output User Units Ratio Denominator (31.009) = 65536 / 100

Speed resolution (0.01 User units / ms) = 0.01 x 60,000 / 100 = 6 rpm

To improve the speed resolution the user unit resolution could be increased from mm to μm. In this condition the output ratio will be less than unity and the
resolution of the Advanced Motion Controller is limited by the resolution of the normalised position (0.0091 rpm).

Alternately, when AMC Auto Resolution Enable (31.015) = 1 the resolution of the internal units used by the Advanced Motion Controller is automatically increased by
an internal scaling factor (AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016)) which is the largest value (power of two) that maintains the output ratio at or above unity. This
ensures that the maximum position reference (AMC Position Reference (34.003)) is greater than or equal to the number of normalised turns or poles of the motor
feedback device and the internal speed resolution is never less than half the resolution of the normalised units. Note that the maximum value for
AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016) is the minimum of 231-1/AMC Master User Units Ratio Numerator (31.004), 231-1/AMC Slave User Units Ratio Numerator
(31.006) and 231-1/AMC Output User Units Ratio Denominator (31.009). When this mode is used the internal resolution is increased but all of the user parameters are
defined in user units, i.e. mm.

If this mode is enable in the example above (output ratio >> 1) the internal resolution can be increased as shown below.

AMC Output User Units Ratio Numerator (31.008) / (AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016) x AMC Output User Units Ratio Denominator (31.009)) >= 1

AMC Auto Resolution Scaling (31.016) = 512 (largest power of 2 that satisfies the above requirements, i.e. output ratio >= 1)

Speed resolution (0.01 User units / ms) = 0.01 x 60,000 / (100 x 512) = 0.0117 rpm

If the output ratio is less than or equal to unity the resolution of the user units is limited by the resolution of the normalised units and AMC Auto Resolution Scaling
(31.016) is set to unity.

Parameter 31.016 AMC Auto Resolution Scaling


Shows the internal scaling factor used to increase the internal resolution of the AMC when auto
Short description
resolution is enabled
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See AMC Auto Resolution Enable (31.015).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 437
Menu 32 Single Line Descriptions − AMC Master Position
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


Speed (0), User Position (1),
P1 Drive (2), P2 Drive (3),
32.001 AMC Master Source Select P1 Slot1 (4), P2 Slot1 (5), P2 Drive (3) RW Txt US
P1 Slot2 (6), P2 Slot2 (7),
P1 Slot3 (8), P2 Slot3 (9)
32.002 AMC Master Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] to
32.003 AMC Master Offset 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] UU
VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] to
32.004 AMC Master Position RO Num ND NC PT
VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] UU
VM_AMC_SPEED[MIN] to
32.005 AMC Master Speed RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_AMC_SPEED[MAX] UU/ms
VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] to
32.006 AMC Master Freeze Position RO Num ND NC PT
VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] UU
32.007 AMC Master Freeze Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
VM_AMC_SPEED[MIN] to
32.008 AMC Master Speed Reference 0.00 UU/ms RW Num US
VM_AMC_SPEED[MAX] UU/ms
32.009 AMC Master User Position Reference -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num NC
32.010 AMC Master Freeze Flag Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


438 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 32 − AMC Master Position
Mode: RFC‑A

Master position

Parameter 32.001 AMC Master Source Select


Short description Defines the position feedback source used by the master reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 9
Default 3 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Speed
1 User Position
2 P1 Drive
3 P2 Drive
4 P1 Slot1
5 P2 Slot1
6 P1 Slot2
7 P2 Slot2
8 P1 Slot3
9 P2 Slot3

AMC Master Source Select (32.001) can be set to a value between 2 and 11 to select a position feedback source as the master reference from the drive
position feedback interface or from the position feedback interface in a position feedback category option module. It should be noted that the position includes
the effect of the marker function of the position source. If the selected position feedback source does not exist (i.e. it is not present in the drive or option
module, or the option module cannot provide position feedback) the source position will remain at zero.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 439
If AMC Master Source Select (32.001) is set to 0 then AMC Master Speed Reference (32.008) is used as the source and provides a position that changes at a
constant rate against time. This allows profiles to be produced with a time base instead of a synchronous profile related to master position.

If AMC Master Source Select (32.001) is set to 1 then AMC Master User Position Reference (32.009) is used as the source. This allows the master position to
be provided by the user, or to be provided from a fieldbus interface.

Parameter 32.002 AMC Master Invert


Short description Set to 1 to invert the AMC master position
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

AMC Master Invert (32.002) negates the delta position values that are accumulated by the slave source integrator. If AMC Absolute Mode Enable (31.002) is
enabled the master position is taken from the position feedback device, modified by the user units ratio, inverted if required (AMC Master Invert (32.002) = 1)
and then written to the slave source integrator. Note that the feedback is initialised on power-up or after any parameter which results in a change to the
absolute position is modified.

Parameter 32.003 AMC Master Offset


Short description Defines the offset used for the AMC Master Position
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

see AMC Master Position (32.004).

Parameter 32.004 AMC Master Position


Short description Displays the AMC Master Position
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX]
Default Units UU
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, VM, ND, NC, PT

AMC Master Position (32.004) is the sum of the position in the master source integrator and AMC Master Offset (32.003).

Parameter 32.005 AMC Master Speed


Short description Displays the rate of change of the AMC Master Position
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_SPEED[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_SPEED[MAX]
Default Units UU/ms
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

AMC Master Speed (32.005) gives the rate of change of the AMC Master Position (32.004).

Parameter 32.006 AMC Master Freeze Position


Short description Displays the AMC Master Position after a freeze event has occurred
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX]
Default Units UU
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, VM, ND, NC, PT

AMC Master Freeze Select (32.007) is used to select which freeze source associated with the master should be used to provide AMC Master Freeze Position
(32.006), where the F1 freeze function is selected if AMC Master Freeze Select (32.007) = 0 and the F2 freeze function is selected if
AMC Master Freeze Select (32.007) = 1. For example, if a position interface within the drive is being used as the master source then the F1 or F2 freeze
source provided in the drive can be selected. In the sample after a freeze event occurs AMC Master Position (32.004) at the point in time when the freeze
event occurred is stored in AMC Master Freeze Position (32.006). Note that the freeze flag in the position menu is updated every 250μs but
AMC Master Freeze Select (32.007) is only updated every 4ms. To ensure that AMC Master Freeze Position (32.006) has been
updated AMC Master Freeze Flag (32.010) should be used to indicate when a freeze event has occurred and to clear the master source freeze flag in the
position feedback menu.

If an option module is being used as the master source then a freeze source in the option module can be selected. If a freeze source selected in an option
module does not exist then AMC Master Freeze Position (32.006) will remain at its present value.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


440 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 32.007 AMC Master Freeze Select
Short description Selects between the F1 and F2 freeze functions
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See AMC Master Freeze Position (32.006).

Parameter 32.008 AMC Master Speed Reference


Short description Defines the Master Speed Reference that can be used by the AMC Master Source
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_SPEED[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_SPEED[MAX]
Default 0.00 Units UU/ms
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 250us read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Master Source Select (32.001).

Parameter 32.009 AMC Master User Position Reference


Short description Defines the Master User Position Reference that can be used by the AMC Master Source
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250us read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See AMC Master Source Select (32.001).

Parameter 32.010 AMC Master Freeze Flag


Short description Master freeze flag status
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See AMC Master Source Select (32.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 441
Menu 33 Single Line Descriptions − AMC Slave Position
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


User Position (0), Sensorless (1),
P1 Drive (2), P2 Drive (3),
33.001 AMC Slave Source Select P1 Slot1 (4), P2 Slot1 (5), P1 Drive (2) RW Txt US
P1 Slot2 (6), P2 Slot2 (7),
P1 Slot3 (8), P2 Slot3 (9)
33.002 AMC Slave Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] to
33.003 AMC Slave Offset 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] UU
VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] to
33.004 AMC Slave Position RO Num ND NC PT
VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] UU
VM_AMC_SPEED[MIN] to
33.005 AMC Slave Speed RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_AMC_SPEED[MAX] UU/ms
VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] to
33.006 AMC Slave Freeze Position RO Num ND NC PT
VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] UU
33.007 AMC Slave Freeze Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
33.009 AMC Slave User Position Reference -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num NC
33.010 AMC Slave Freeze Flag Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


442 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 33 − AMC Slave Position
Mode: RFC‑A

Slave position

Parameter 33.001 AMC Slave Source Select


Short description Defines the position feedback source used by the slave reference
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 9
Default 2 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 443
Value Text
0 User Position
1 Sensorless
2 P1 Drive
3 P2 Drive
4 P1 Slot1
5 P2 Slot1
6 P1 Slot2
7 P2 Slot2
8 P1 Slot3
9 P2 Slot3

The slave position system operates in the same way as the master position system except that if AMC Slave Source Select (33.001) = 1 the position is taken
from Sensorless Position (03.080). The least significant 16bits of Sensorless Position (03.080) represents a movement equivalent to one pole of the motor and
the most significant 16 bits represent turns where one turn is the movement associated with one pole. To use Sensorless Position (03.080) as the slave
feedback source AMC Slave User Units Ratio Denominator (31.007) must be multiplied by the number of pole pairs so that the least significant 16 bits of the
position represents one mechanical revolution.

Parameter 33.002 AMC Slave Invert


Short description Set to 1 to invert the AMC slave position
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

AMC Slave Invert (33.002) negates the delta position values that are accumulated by the slave source integrator. If AMC Absolute Mode Enable (31.002) is
enabled the slave position is taken from the position feedback device, modified by the user units ratio, inverted if required (AMC Slave Invert (33.002) = 1) and
then written to the slave source integrator. Note that the feedback is initialised on power-up or after any parameter which results in a change to the absolute
position is modified.

Parameter 33.003 AMC Slave Offset


Short description Displays the offset used for the AMC Slave Position
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

AMC Slave Offset (33.003) is used to add an offset to the value in the slave source integrator and is used during homing to move the alignment of the slave
position. When a new value is written to AMC Slave Offset (33.003) the profile position integrators are automatically modified with the change of offset position
allowing the offset to be adjusted without a transient at the output of the motion controller. If AMC Slave Offset (33.003) is changed when the motion controller is
enabled and AMC Reference Select (34.007) is set to one of the absolute position references (Stop or Position Abs) the slave will move to the absolute position
under the constraints of the profile generator. If the slave is stationary when the slave offset is applied the slave will move a relative position equal to -
ΔAMC Slave Offset (33.003). Note that the slave offset should not be modified when AMC Reference Select (34.007) is set to the home reference because the
homing sequence will not be completed correctly and the profile integrators are not automatically modified in this condition.

Parameter 33.004 AMC Slave Position


Short description Displays the AMC Slave Position
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX]
Default Units UU
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, VM, ND, NC, PT

AMC Slave Position (33.004) is the sum of the position in the slave source integrator and AMC Slave Offset (33.003).

Parameter 33.005 AMC Slave Speed


Short description Displays the rate of change of the AMC Slave Position
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_SPEED[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_SPEED[MAX]
Default Units UU/ms
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

AMC Slave Speed (33.005) gives the rate of change of the AMC Slave Position (33.004).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


444 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 33.006 AMC Slave Freeze Position
Short description Displays the AMC Slave Position after a freeze event has occurred
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX]
Default Units UU
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, VM, ND, NC, PT

AMC Slave Freeze Select (33.007) is used to select which freeze source associated with the master should be used to provide AMC Slave Freeze Position
(33.006), where the F1 freeze function is selected if AMC Slave Freeze Select (33.007) = 0 and the F2 freeze function is selected if AMC Slave Freeze Select
(33.007) = 1. For example, if a position interface within the drive is being used as the master source then the F1 or F2 freeze source provided in the drive can be
selected. In the sample after a freeze event occurs AMC Slave Position (33.004) at the point in time when the freeze event occurred is stored in
AMC Slave Freeze Position (33.006). Note that the freeze flag in the position menu is updated every 250μs but AMC Slave Freeze Position (33.006) is only
updated every 4ms. To ensure that AMC Slave Freeze Position (33.006) has been updated AMC Slave Freeze Flag (33.010) should be used to indicate when a
freeze event has occurred and to clear the slave source freeze flag in the position feedback menu.

If an option module is being used as the slave source then a freeze source in the option module can be selected. If a freeze source selected in an option module
does not exist then AMC Slave Freeze Position (33.006) will remain at its present value.

Parameter 33.007 AMC Slave Freeze Select


Short description Selects between the F1 and F2 freeze functions
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See AMC Slave Freeze Position (33.006).

Parameter 33.009 AMC Slave User Position Reference


Short description Defines the Slave User Position Reference that can be used by the AMC Slave Source
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 250µs read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See AMC Slave Source Select (33.001).

Parameter 33.010 AMC Slave Freeze Flag


Short description Slave freeze flag status
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

See AMC Slave Freeze Position (33.006).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 445
Menu 34 Single Line Descriptions − AMC Reference Selector
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


Profile (0), No Profile (1),
34.001 AMC Stop Mode Profile (0) RW Txt US
Profile Stop (2), No Profile Stop (3)
VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] to
34.002 AMC Stop Reference RO Num ND NC PT
VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] UU
VM_AMC_POSITION_REF[MIN] to
34.003 AMC Position Reference 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_REF[MAX] UU
34.005 AMC Rotary Mode 0 to 6 0 RW Num US
VM_AMC_SPEED[MIN] to
34.006 AMC Speed Reference 0.00 UU/ms RW Num US
VM_AMC_SPEED[MAX] UU/ms
Stop (0), Position Abs (1), Speed (2),
34.007 AMC Reference Select Cam (3), EGB (4), Home (5), Stop (0) RW Txt US
Position Rel (6), Position Profile (7)
None (0), Cam On Freeze (1),
34.008 AMC Action On Event None (0) RW Txt US
EGB On Freeze (2)
Stop (0), Position Abs (1), Speed (2),
34.009 AMC Reference Select Trigger Cam (3), EGB (4), Home (5), Stop (0) RW Txt
Position Rel (6), Position Profile (7)

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


446 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 34 − AMC Reference Selector
Mode: RFC‑A

Reference selector

Parameter 34.001 AMC Stop Mode


Short description Defines the stopping mode used by AMC
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Profile
1 No Profile
2 Profile Stop
3 No Profile Stop

AMC Stop Mode (34.001) defines the actions taken when AMC Stop Reference (34.002) is selected. When the motion controller is enabled
AMC Stop Reference (34.002) is continuously updated with stop position until the stop reference is selected. AMC Stop Reference (34.002) is then
used as the target position for the profile generator.

0 (Profile)

When AMC Stop Mode (34.001) = 0 the stop reference is updated with the position at which the profile would reach zero speed based on the current
profile constrains and outputs, i.e. AMC Profile Output Position (38.008), AMC Profile Output Speed (38.009) and AMC Profile Output Acceleration
(38.010). When AMC Stop Reference (34.002) is set to 0 (stop) the slave will stop under the constraints applied to the profile generator when the stop
was requested.

1 (No profile)

When AMC Stop Mode (34.001) = 1 the stop reference is updated with AMC Slave Position (33.004). When AMC Stop Reference (34.002) is set to 0
(stop) the profile generator is disabled and the slave will stop as quickly as possible.

2 (Profile Stop)

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 447
This mode is the same as the profiled stop mode except that AMC Reference Select (34.007) is automatically changed to 0 if the following error
exceeds the limit defined by AMC Following Error Window (41.007).

3 (No Profile Stop)

This mode is the same as the no profile stop mode except that AMC Reference Select (34.007) is automatically changed to 0 if the following error
exceeds the limit defined by AMC Following Error Window (41.007).

Note that when a software or hardware limit is active AMC Stop Reference (34.002) is updated with the stop position for the stop mode selected in
AMC Hardware Limit Stop Mode (41.023) or AMC Software Limit Stop Mode (41.024).

Parameter 34.002 AMC Stop Reference


Short description Defines the reference used when the stop reference is selected
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX]
Default Units UU
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, VM, ND, NC, PT

See AMC Stop Mode (34.001).

Parameter 34.003 AMC Position Reference


Short description Defines the reference used when AMC Reference Select = 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_REF[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate AMC sample rate read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Reference Select (34.007).

Parameter 34.005 AMC Rotary Mode


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 6
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

When AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) is set to a none zero value and AMC Rate Selected (31.013) >= 500μs the change of position added to the input
integrator of the profile generator is controlled by AMC Rotary Mode (34.005). Although the position parameters are shown with a range from zero to
AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) - 1 additional "turns" information is used internally to allow the rotary modes to operate correctly. The maximum number of
turns that can be accumulated is given by 231-1 / AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) rounded down to the nearest integer, e.g. if AMC Roll-over Limit
(31.010) = 106 then the maximum number of "turns" is limited to 231-1/106 = 2147. For the following modes to operate correctly the difference between
the internal value of the profile input integrator, profile output integrator and the slave source integrator in any rotary mode must not
exceed this maximum value. If the system does not remain within this limit there will be movement in the opposite direction to that expected.

Note that in relative position mode the change of position is the value in AMC Position Reference (34.003) when a relative move is selected and in
absolute position mode it is the difference between AMC Position Reference (34.003) and AMC Profile Input Position (38.006), i.e. Δ =
AMC Position Reference (34.003) - AMC Profile Input Position (38.006).

In modes 4, 5 and 6 the variable maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_REF is modified to allow AMC Position Reference (34.003) to be positive or negative
with a maximum value greater than AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) - 1, i.e. a movement of more than one "turn" can be requested. Note that because
AMC Position Reference (34.003) can be greater than AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) the change of position in absolute mode is only calculated when
AMC Reference Select (34.007) is changed to 1 from another reference or when AMC Reference Select (34.007) = 1 and a change of
AMC Position Reference (34.003) is detected. In absolute position mode the number of "turns" moved by the slave is AMC Position Reference (34.003)
/ AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) rounded down to the nearest integer and the final position within the rollover limit is the remainder from this calculation
for a positive position reference or the remainder + AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) for a negative position reference.

0 (Shortest)

The change of position at the input integrator of the profile generator is limited to ±AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010)/2. In this mode the profile output
position will move to the input position by the shortest path and can rollover the zero or AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) -1 boundary as required.

1 (Forward)

If the change of position at the input integrator of the profile generator is negative the change of position added to the integrator is modified so that -Δ
becomes AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) - Δ. This has the effect of making any reverse movements into forward movements by forcing the profile to
rollover the AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) - 1 boundary as shown below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


448 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
2 (Reverse)

If the change of position at the input integrator of the profile generator is positive the change of position added to the integrator is modified so that +Δ
becomes Δ - AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010). This has the effect of making any forward movements into reverse movements by forcing the profile to
rollover the zero boundary as shown below.

3 (No Rollover)

If the change of position at the input integrator of the profile generator would cause the integrator to rollover the zero or AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) -
1 boundary the change of position is modified so that -Δ (rollover the zero boundary) becomes AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) - Δ and +Δ (rollover the
AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) boundary) becomes Δ - AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010). This has the effect of preventing the profile input position from
crossing the zero or AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) - 1 boundary.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 449
Note that if AMC Rotary Mode (34.005) is set to 3 when the motion controller is enabled and AMC Profile Output Speed (38.009) > 0 it may not be
possible to stop the slave under the constraints of the profile generator before it crosses a boundary.

4 (Multiple Turns Forward)

If the change of position at the input integrator of the profile generator is negative and greater than -AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) the change of position
added to the integrator is modified so that -Δ becomes AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) - Δ. This has the effect of making any reverse movements into
forward movements by forcing the profile to rollover the AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) - 1 boundary. The change of position is ignored by the profile if it
is less than -AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010).

5 (Multiple Turns Reverse)

If the change of position at the input integrator of the profile generator is positive and less than AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010) the change of position
added to the integrator is modified so that +Δ becomes Δ - AMC Roll-over Limit (31.010). This has the effect of making any forward movements into
reverse movements by forcing the profile to rollover the zero boundary. The change of position is ignored by the profile if it is greater than AMC Roll-
over Limit (31.010).

6 (Multiple Turns Delta)

In this mode the change of position is added directly to the input integrator of the profile generator and the direction of movement is defined by the sign
of the position change.

Parameter 34.006 AMC Speed Reference


Short description Defines the speed reference used when AMC Reference Select = 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_SPEED[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_SPEED[MAX]
Default 0.00 Units UU/ms
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate AMC sample rate read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW, VM

AMC Speed Reference (34.006) is used as the input to the profile generator when AMC Reference Select (34.007) = 2.

Parameter 34.007 AMC Reference Select


Short description Defines the input to the profile generator
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 7
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate AMC sample rate read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


450 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Value Text
0 Stop
1 Position Abs
2 Speed
3 Cam
4 EGB
5 Home
6 Position Rel
7 Position Profile

AMC Reference Select (34.007) selects the input to the profile generator as shown below.

AMC Reference Select


Reference Action on select
(34.007)
AMC Stop Reference
0 AMC Stop Reference (34.002) is no longer updated
(34.002)
AMC Position Reference
1 See position mode below
(34.003)
AMC Speed Reference
2
(34.006)
Cam system started from AMC Cam Start Index (35.001) and
3 Cam system output
AMC Cam Start Position In Segment (35.002)
4 Electronic gearbox output Electronic gearbox is started
5 Homing system output Homing sequence is started
AMC Position Reference
6 See position mode below
(34.003)
AMC Profile Input Position
7 See position mode below
(38.006)

Position Mode

Example 1 - Absolute Move

When AMC Reference Select (34.007) is set to 1 the position delta between AMC Position Reference (34.003) and AMC Profile Input Position
(38.006) is continuously written to AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) and the slave will move to the reference position.

Index AMC Position Reference (34.003) AMC Reference Select (34.007)

1 60 1

2 120 1

3 300 1

4 0 1

Example 2 - Relative Move

When AMC Reference Select (34.007) is set to 6 and a change of reference position is detected or when AMC Reference Select (34.007) is changed to
6 from another reference then AMC Position Reference (34.003) is added to AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) and the slave will move relative to
AMC Profile Input Position (38.006). If the slave is required to move by the same distance in successive moves then AMC Position Reference
(34.003) can be changed to zero and then set to the required reference or AMC Reference Select (34.007) can be toggled between mode 6 and
7. When AMC Reference Select (34.007) is set to 7 (profile position) the AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) is held at the previous value and the slave
will continue to move to or remain at the profile input position.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 451
Index AMC Position Reference (34.003) AMC Reference Select (34.007)

1 +60 6

2 +60 to 0 to +60 6

3 +120 6

4 -300 6

It should be noted that instead of changing AMC Position Reference (34.003) it is possible to toggle AMC Reference Select (34.007) between modes 6
and 7 to initiate another relative move of 60 user units for index 2.

Reference Selector and Trigger

AMC Reference Select (34.007) can be automatically changed in the following modes.

Mode Reference after change

AMC Stop Mode (34.001) = 2 or 3 0

AMC Action On Event (34.008) = Cam On Freeze 3

AMC Action On Event (34.008) = EGB On Freeze 4

Homing system (menu 40) 0

AMC Reference Select Trigger (34.009) can be used to set AMC Reference Select (34.007) on a change of reference. This
allows AMC Reference Select (34.007) to be changed automatically and a reference to be continuously written to AMC Reference Select Trigger
(34.009). It should be noted that when AMC Reference Select (34.007) and AMC Reference Select Trigger (34.009) are changed in the same sample
AMC Reference Select (34.007) = AMC Reference Select Trigger (34.009).

Parameter 34.008 AMC Action On Event


Short description Defines the function of the AMC on a positive transition of the master freeze flag
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 None
1 Cam On Freeze
2 EGB On Freeze

0 (None)
This feature is disabled.

1 (Cam On Freeze)
The cam system is started and AMC Reference Select (34.007) is set to 3 when a freeze event is produced by the freeze system (positive transition of
the master freeze flag) in the position feedback interface selected by the AMC Master Source Select (32.001) and AMC Master Freeze Select (32.007).
The diagram below shows the effect of selecting the Cam by writing directly to AMC Reference Select (34.007) or by using the action on a freeze event.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


452 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
When AMC Reference Select (34.007) is written directly the first position change used by the Cam is taken between position datum P N and position
datum PN+1. Therefore the change of position used by the Cam begins at position datum P N, which is the first datum after AMC Reference Select
(34.007) is modified. When the freeze event is used to change AMC Reference Select (34.007) the first position change used by the Cam always starts
at the point where the freeze event occurred, and so the change of position seen at the input to the Cam is with reference to the position at the freeze
event.

2 (EGB On Freeze)
The EGB system is started and AMC Reference Select (34.007) is set to 4 when a freeze event is produced by the freeze system in the position
feedback interface selected by the AMC Master Source Select (32.001) and AMC Master Freeze Select (32.007). The input position is derived in the
same way as described for the Cam.

It should be noted that AMC Action On Event (34.008) is disabled when a hardware or software limit is active.

Parameter 34.009 AMC Reference Select Trigger


Short description The reference selector is set to the reference trigger when a change is detected
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 7
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate AMC sample rate read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 453
Value Text
0 Stop
1 Position Abs
2 Speed
3 Cam
4 EGB
5 Home
6 Position Rel
7 Position Profile

See AMC Reference Select (34.007).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


454 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 35 Single Line Descriptions − AMC Cam
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


35.001 AMC Cam Start Index 0 to 19 0 RW Num US
35.002 AMC Cam Start Position In Segment 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
35.003 AMC Cam Size 1 to 20 1 RW Num US
35.004 AMC Cam Single Shot Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
35.005 AMC Cam Output Ratio Numerator 1 to 2147483647 1000 RW Num US
35.006 AMC Cam Output Ratio Denominator 1 to 2147483647 1000 RW Num US
35.007 AMC Cam Index 0 to 19 RO Num ND NC PT
35.008 AMC Cam Position In Segment 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR UU RO Num ND NC PT
35.009 AMC Cam Final Speed Coefficient -21474836.48 to 21474836.47 UU RO Num ND NC PT
35.010 AMC Cam Complete Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit
35.011 AMC Cam Force Repeat Off (0) or On (1) On (1) RW Bit US
35.012 AMC Cam Mode 0 to 1 0 RW Num US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 455
Menu 35 − AMC Cam
Mode: RFC‑A

Cam

Parameter 35.001 AMC Cam Start Index


Short description Defines which index of the cam table the AMC cam controller starts at
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 19
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Cam input
The cam is enabled when the motion controller is enabled and AMC Reference Select (34.007) is changed to a value of 3. When enabled AMC Cam Index (35.007) and AMC Cam Position In Segment (35.008) are
set to AMC Cam Start Index (35.001) and AMC Cam Start Position In Segment (35.002). If AMC Cam Start Index (35.001) ≥ AMC Cam Size (35.003) or AMC Cam Position In Segment (35.008) is larger than the
input position for the start segment then a CAM.001 trip is initiated. This causes the drive to go into the trip state and the motion controller is disabled.

Any change of AMC Master Position (32.004) is used to move forwards (positive change of master position) or backwards (negative change of master position) through the cam table. The number of input user units
for each segment are defined in the cam table parameters (AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004), AMC Cam Table In 1 (36.007), etc.) and AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004) corresponds to segment 0. AMC Cam Index
(35.007) is incremented when the end of the segment is reached (forwards) or decremented when the beginning of the segment is reached (backwards). When the end of the last segment is reached in the forwards
direction the cam index wraps around to the start of the next cam table and when the start of the first segment is reached in the reverse direction the index wraps around to the end of the next cam table.
AMC Cam Mode (35.012), AMC Cam Start Index (35.001) and AMC Cam Size (35.003) are used to configure the actions taken when the cam wraps around.

It should be noted that if the change of input position causes AMC Cam Index (35.007) to change by more than two segments then a CAM.002 trip is initiated. In addition, the maximum change of master position is
limited to 1,000,000,000 user units and a CAM.004 trip is initiated if the maximum value is exceeded.

Cam Output
The cam table parameters provide an output value and an interpolation method for each cam segment. AMC Cam Table Out 0 (36.005) and AMC Cam Table Interpolation 0 (36.006) correspond to segment 0, etc.
As AMC Cam Start Position In Segment (35.002) moves over the range from 0 to AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004) the output changes from 0 to AMC Cam Table Out 0 (36.005). The change of position is fed out of
the cam controller, the cam ratio is applied and the result is accumulated in the profile input integrator. Therefore for a given change of input position defined by AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004) there is a change of
output position defined by AMC Cam Table Out 0 (36.005) multiplied by the cam output ratio.

The interpolation method for each segment defines the relationship between the input and output positions. The interpolation functions are designed so that there are no speed discontinuities at segment
boundaries, and so the rate of change of output position with respect to input position is the same either side of a segment boundary. It is the responsibility of the user to ensure that the rate of change of the output
is 0 at the end of the last segment to prevent a speed discontinuity as the cam table wraps round. The diagram below shows an example of interpolation within the Nth segment.

x is AMC Cam Start Position In Segment (35.002)

y is the output position

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


456 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
ΔXN is the cam input table value for the segment

ΔYN is the cam output table value for the segment

WN is dy/dx at the end of this segment

WN-1 is dy/dx at the end of the last segment

The following coefficients are calculated for each segment based on the rate of change of position at the end of the previous segment.

AN = WN-1 ΔXN

BN = ΔYN - AN

The output position is calculated using the following function.

y = (AN X) + (BN f(X))

where X is the input position as a proportion of the total input position over the segment, i.e. X = x/ΔXN. The term AN X produces a constant rate of change of output position against input position, and so if the input
speed is constant this will provide a constant output speed that is equivalent to the speed at the start of the segment. This term prevents speed discontinuities between segments. The term B N f(X) produces the
required change of output position ΔYN over the segment using the required interpolation function f(X). Different functions can be used to give different types of interpolation, but f(0) must be 0 and f(1) must be 1 to
give the correct output position change over the segment. The rate of change of output position with respect to the input position is given by

dy/dx = AN/ΔXN + BN df(X)/dx

It should be noted that the rate of change used internally by the motion controller is scaled by 256 and is rounded to the nearest integer. If the magnitude of the rate of change (dy/dx) at the end of any segment
(WN-1) exceeds 231/256 a CAM.003 trip is initiated. This causes the drive to go into the trip state and the Advanced Motion Controller will be disabled.

Interpolation functions with no speed change


If WN = WN-1 then the speed at the start and end of the segment will be the same for a constant input speed. If the whole cam table is filled with segments that use an interpolation method where this is true, then
the speed will return to 0 at the end of every segment. Such a function can be selected if the cam table interpolation parameter for a segment is set to 0 (Cos1). The following function is used:

f(X) = X - (1/(2π)) sin (2πX)

As already defined X = x / ΔXN, and so

f(X) = x/ΔXN - (1/(2π)) sin (2πx / ΔXN)

Differentiating with respect to x gives

df(X)/dx = (1 - cos (2πX)) / ΔXN

df(0)/dx = df(1)/dx = 0, and so WN = WN-1. The diagram below shows this function where WN-1 = WN = 0.

It should be noted that if ΔYN = AN then the output will be a constant speed for a constant speed input.

Interpolation functions that give a speed change


If it is not a requirement to have the same speed at the start and end of a segment then a function can be used where df(0)/dx = 0 and df(1)/dx = 2/ΔX N. In this case WN = AN + 2BN/ΔXN. One of two functions can
be selected by setting the cam table interpolation parameter for a segment to 1 (Square) or 2 (Cos2). These are described below.

For square interpolation f(X) = X2 which gives a linear change of dy/dx. The diagram below shows the position and speed for an acceleration from 0. If ΔY N/ ΔXN is less than WN-1 at the start of the segment then
dy/dx will fall over the segment and WN will be less than WN-1.

For the Cos2 interpolation f(X) = X - (1/π) sin (πX) which gives sinusoidal changes in dy/dx. The diagram below shows the position and speed for an acceleration from 0. If ΔY N/ ΔXN is less than WN-1 at the start of
the segment dy/dx will fall over the segment and WN will be less than WN-1.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 457
Initial speed segment
One cam segment (AMC Cam Table In -1 (36.001), AMC Cam Table Out -1 (36.002), AMC Cam Table Interpolation -1 (36.003)) is provided to give an initial speed to the cam output. When the cam is enabled this
segment becomes active and its output is added to the output provided by the main cam table. If AMC Cam Table Interpolation -1 (36.003) is set for Square or Cos2 interpolation and the end of this segment is
passed in the forward direction the output speed is maintained by applying a ratio of 2ΔY/ ΔX to the change of AMC Master Position (32.004). If the initial master speed is negative the input wraps around the end of
the segment and will continue until the start of the segment is reached. Again the output speed is then maintained by applying a ratio of 2ΔY/ ΔX to the change of AMC Master Position
(32.004). AMC Cam Table Interpolation -1 (36.003) can also be set to linear interpolation, and if this is selected the initial speed segment always applies a ratio of ΔY/ ΔX to the change of AMC Master Position
(32.004). If AMC Cam Table In -1 (36.001) is left at its default value of 0 then this initial segment is disabled and no position is added to the main cam system.

Parameter 35.002 AMC Cam Start Position In Segment


Short description Defines the position in segment that the AMC Cam controller uses when the cam is enabled
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Start Index (35.001).

Parameter 35.003 AMC Cam Size


Short description Defines the number of segments from the cam table that are used to define the cam profile
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 20
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

AMC Cam Size (35.003) defines the number of segments from the cam table that are used to define the cam profile.

Parameter 35.004 AMC Cam Single Shot Enable


Short description Set to 1 to disable the cam system from running continuously
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

When AMC Cam Single Shot Enable (35.004) = 0 the cam will run until it is deselected. If AMC Cam Single Shot Enable (35.004) = 1 the cam will stop when either end of the cam table is reached. For single shot
operation the following apply:

1. The cam function cannot be started unless AMC Cam Complete (35.010) = 0. The cam function can be restarted again by clearing AMC Cam Complete (35.010). Note that AMC Cam Complete
(35.010) is cleared automatically when AMC Cam Single Shot Enable (35.004) is enabled.
2. Once the cam function has stopped it can be restarted by changing AMC Reference Select (34.007) to a value other than 3 (cam) and then back to 3, or by disabling and re-enabling the motion
controller.
3. Once the cam function has stopped it can be restarted by a freeze event (see AMC Action On Event (34.008)) provided the freeze event occurs in a sample after the one in which the cam function
stopped.
4. The cam function is not stopped the first time it wraps around in reverse if it is selected or restarted with AMC Cam Start Index (35.001) = 0 and AMC Cam Start Position In Segment (35.002) = first
segment.

Note that when AMC Cam Single Shot Enable (35.004) is enabled the cam will stop at the beginning of the first segment when running forwards or the end of the last segment when running in reverse.

Parameter 35.005 AMC Cam Output Ratio Numerator


Defines the numerator for the ratio that is applied to the change of output position from the Cam
Short description
function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 2147483647
Default 1000 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The Cam output ratio (AMC Cam Output Ratio Numerator (35.005) / AMC Cam Output Ratio Denominator (35.006)) is applied to the change of output position from the Cam function before it is accumulated by the
profile input integrator.

Parameter 35.006 AMC Cam Output Ratio Denominator


Defines the denominator for the ratio that is applied to the change of output position from the Cam
Short description
function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 2147483647
Default 1000 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See AMC Cam Output Ratio Numerator (35.005).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


458 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 35.007 AMC Cam Index
Short description Displays which index in the Cam table the Cam controller is using
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 19
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See AMC Cam Start Index (35.001).

Parameter 35.008 AMC Cam Position In Segment


Short description Displays the position in the segment that the cam controller is using
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default Units UU
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, VM, ND, NC, PT

See AMC Cam Start Index (35.001).

Parameter 35.009 AMC Cam Final Speed Coefficient


Short description Displays the Final Speed Coefficient that the cam controller uses
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -21474836.48 Maximum 21474836.47
Default Units UU
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

AMC Cam Final Speed Coefficient (35.009) shows the value of AK which is calculated using the rate of change at the end of the last segment and ΔXK, i.e. AK = WN ΔXK where N = AMC Cam Size (35.003) and K
is the first segment in the cam table. Note that the first segment is always segment 0 when AMC Cam Mode (35.012) = 0 or AMC Cam Start Index (35.001) when AMC Cam Mode (35.012) = 1.

When AMC Cam Force Repeat (35.011) is enabled the rate of change at the boundary between the first and last segment is set to zero when the cam is running forwards or to the rate of change at the end of the
last segment when running backwards. This forces the interpolated output position to be identical when the cam repeats in either direction, but will introduce a speed discontinuity at the boundary of the first and last
segment if AMC Cam Final Speed Coefficient (35.009) is not zero. An example of the speed discontinuity which can occur when AMC Cam Force Repeat (35.011) is enabled and the rate of change (dy/dx) at the
end of the last segment is not zero is shown in the figure below.

If AMC Cam Force Repeat (35.011) is disabled the rate of change calculated at the end of the last segment is used to calculate the interpolated position in the next segment. This removes the discontinuity caused
by the rate of change at the end of the last segment but will cause the interpolated position between segment boundaries to change when the cam repeats and the rate of change at the end of the last segment is
not zero. The effect of turning AMC Cam Force Repeat (35.011) off is shown in the figure below.

In this example the speed is continuous but the interpolated position between segment boundaries has changed. This is caused by the rate of change used at the beginning of segment 0 in the second cam which is
not forced to zero when AMC Cam Force Repeat (35.011) is off. Note that the rate of change used to calculate the position in the first segment of the first cam is always zero. This mode is intended to be
used when writing cam table parameters (more than 20 points) from a controller or AMC Cam Mode (35.012) is set to 2 and the rate of change at the end of the last segment is not zero.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 459
Parameter 35.010 AMC Cam Complete
Short description Displays when the cam controller reaches the end of the cam table
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

AMC Cam Complete (35.010) is set to one when the cam function wraps around either end of the cam table. AMC Cam Complete (35.010) is not set the first time the cam wraps around the first segment (running in
the reverse direction) if AMC Cam Start Position In Segment (35.002) = 0 and AMC Cam Start Index (35.001) = first segment. Note that the first segment is always set to segment 0 when AMC Cam Mode
(35.012) = 0 or AMC Cam Start Index (35.001) when AMC Cam Mode (35.012) = 1.

Parameter 35.011 AMC Cam Force Repeat


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

See AMC Cam Final Speed Coefficient (35.009).

Parameter 35.012 AMC Cam Mode


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

AMC Cam Mode (35.012) is used to select between the functionality shown in the table below.

AMC Cam Index AMC Cam Index (35.007) when the cam AMC Cam Index (35.007) when the cam
AMC Cam Mode
(35.007) when the wraps around the last segment in the wraps around the first segment in the Parameter update
(35.012)
cam is enabled forward direction reverse direction

AMC Cam Start Index AMC Cam Start Index (35.001) and AMC Cam Size (35.003) are updated


0 0 AMC Cam Size (35.003) - 1
(35.001) when the cam is disabled

AMC Cam Start Index (35.001) and AMC Cam Size (35.003) are updated


AMC Cam Start Index AMC Cam Start Index
1 AMC Cam Start Index (35.001) when the cam is disabled and when the cam wraps around the last segment
(35.001) (35.001) + AMC Cam Size (35.003) - 1
in either direction

When AMC Cam Mode (35.012) = 1 the last index in the cam table (AMC Cam Start Index (35.001) + AMC Cam Size (35.003) - 1) is automatically limited to the maximum value (i.e. segment 19). For example,
if AMC Cam Start Index (35.001) = 10 and AMC Cam Size (35.003) = 20 the cam would operate between index 10 and 19.

When AMC Cam Mode (35.012) = 0 the cam will run between index 0 and AMC Cam Size (35.003) - 1. The figure below shows a trapezoidal cam with three segments (i.e. ramp in, running and ramp out). In single
shot mode the cam runs once and stops at the beginning of the first segment (i.e. AMC Cam Index (35.007) = 0 and AMC Cam Position In Segment (35.008) = 0).

In some applications (e.g. rotary knife) the ramp in and ramp out segments are only required at the beginning and end of a process. When AMC Cam Mode (35.012) = 1 it is possible to change
AMC Cam Start Index (35.001), AMC Cam Size (35.003) and AMC Cam Single Shot Enable (35.004) while the cam is running to produce the cam profile shown below, i.e. the cam remains in the running
segment until the ramp out is required.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


460 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Note that any parameter in AMC Cam (35) or AMC Cam Table (36) must be updated at least 4ms before the cam enters the segment in which the new value is applied, e.g. when running forwards AMC Cam Size
(35.003) must be updated 4ms before the end of the last segment is reached.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 461
Menu 36 Single Line Descriptions − AMC Cam Table
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


462 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter Range Default Type
36.001 AMC Cam Table In ‑1 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.002 AMC Cam Table Out ‑1 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.003 AMC Cam Table Interpolation ‑1 Linear (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Linear (0) RW Txt US
36.004 AMC Cam Table In 0 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.005 AMC Cam Table Out 0 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.006 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 0 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.007 AMC Cam Table In 1 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.008 AMC Cam Table Out 1 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.009 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 1 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.010 AMC Cam Table In 2 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.011 AMC Cam Table Out 2 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.012 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 2 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.013 AMC Cam Table In 3 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.014 AMC Cam Table Out 3 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.015 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 3 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.016 AMC Cam Table In 4 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.017 AMC Cam Table Out 4 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.018 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 4 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.019 AMC Cam Table In 5 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.020 AMC Cam Table Out 5 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.021 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 5 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.022 AMC Cam Table In 6 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.023 AMC Cam Table Out 6 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.024 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 6 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.025 AMC Cam Table In 7 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.026 AMC Cam Table Out 7 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.027 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 7 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.028 AMC Cam Table In 8 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.029 AMC Cam Table Out 8 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.030 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 8 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.031 AMC Cam Table In 9 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.032 AMC Cam Table Out 9 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.033 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 9 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.034 AMC Cam Table In 10 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.035 AMC Cam Table Out 10 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.036 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 10 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.037 AMC Cam Table In 11 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.038 AMC Cam Table Out 11 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.039 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 11 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.040 AMC Cam Table In 12 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.041 AMC Cam Table Out 12 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.042 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 12 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.043 AMC Cam Table In 13 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.044 AMC Cam Table Out 13 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.045 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 13 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.046 AMC Cam Table In 14 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.047 AMC Cam Table Out 14 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.048 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 14 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.049 AMC Cam Table In 15 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.050 AMC Cam Table Out 15 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 463
36.051 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 15 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.052 AMC Cam Table In 16 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.053 AMC Cam Table Out 16 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.054 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 16 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.055 AMC Cam Table In 17 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.056 AMC Cam Table Out 17 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.057 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 17 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.058 AMC Cam Table In 18 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.059 AMC Cam Table Out 18 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.060 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 18 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US
36.061 AMC Cam Table In 19 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] to
36.062 AMC Cam Table Out 19 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX] UU
36.063 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 19 Cos1 (0), Square (1), Cos2 (2) Cos1 (0) RW Txt US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


464 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 36 − AMC Cam Table
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter 36.001 AMC Cam Table In -1


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for the initial start segment
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Read when the cam is enabled
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

AMC Cam Table In -1 (36.001), AMC Cam Table Out -1 (36.002) and AMC Cam Table Interpolation -1 (36.003) are the cam table entries for the initial
start segment.

Parameter 36.002 AMC Cam Table Out -1


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for the initial start segment
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Read when the cam is enabled
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In -1 (36.001).

Parameter 36.003 AMC Cam Table Interpolation -1


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for the initial start segment
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read when the cam is enabled
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Linear
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In -1 (36.001).

Parameter 36.004 AMC Cam Table In 0


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 0
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004), AMC Cam Table Out 0 (36.005) and AMC Cam Table Interpolation 0 (36.006) are the cam table entries for segment 0.
These parameters are read in a 4ms task and transferred to an internal RAM array for use by the cam system.

The parameter numbers for the cam table entries for each of the other segments are calculated using the following, where 1 ≤ X ≤ 19.

Entry Parameter Number


AMC Cam Table In X 36.004 + 3X
AMC Cam Table Out X 36.005 + 3X
AMC Cam Table Interpolation X 36.006 + 3X

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 465
Parameter 36.005 AMC Cam Table Out 0
Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 0
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.006 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 0


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 0
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.007 AMC Cam Table In 1


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.008 AMC Cam Table Out 1


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.009 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 1


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 1
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


466 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 36.010 AMC Cam Table In 2
Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.011 AMC Cam Table Out 2


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.012 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 2


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 2
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.013 AMC Cam Table In 3


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.014 AMC Cam Table Out 3


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 467
Parameter 36.015 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 3
Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 3
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.016 AMC Cam Table In 4


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 4
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.017 AMC Cam Table Out 4


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 4
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.018 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 4


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 4
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.019 AMC Cam Table In 5


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 5
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


468 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 36.020 AMC Cam Table Out 5
Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 5
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.021 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 5


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 5
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.022 AMC Cam Table In 6


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 6
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.023 AMC Cam Table Out 6


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 6
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.024 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 6


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 6
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 469
Parameter 36.025 AMC Cam Table In 7
Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 6
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.026 AMC Cam Table Out 7


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 7
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.027 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 7


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 7
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.028 AMC Cam Table In 8


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 8
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.029 AMC Cam Table Out 8


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 8
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


470 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 36.030 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 8
Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 8
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.031 AMC Cam Table In 9


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 9
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.032 AMC Cam Table Out 9


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 9
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.033 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 9


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 9
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.034 AMC Cam Table In 10


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 10
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 471
Parameter 36.035 AMC Cam Table Out 10
Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 10
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.036 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 10


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 10
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.037 AMC Cam Table In 11


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 11
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.038 AMC Cam Table Out 11


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 11
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.039 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 11


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 11
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


472 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 36.040 AMC Cam Table In 12
Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 12
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.041 AMC Cam Table Out 12


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 12
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.042 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 12


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 12
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.043 AMC Cam Table In 13


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 13
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.044 AMC Cam Table Out 13


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 13
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 473
Parameter 36.045 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 13
Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 13
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.046 AMC Cam Table In 14


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 14
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.047 AMC Cam Table Out 14


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 14
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.048 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 14


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 14
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.049 AMC Cam Table In 15


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 15
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


474 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 36.050 AMC Cam Table Out 15
Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 15
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.051 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 15


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 15
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.052 AMC Cam Table In 16


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 16
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.053 AMC Cam Table Out 16


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 16
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.054 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 16


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 16
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 475
Parameter 36.055 AMC Cam Table In 17
Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 17
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.056 AMC Cam Table Out 17


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 17
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.057 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 17


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 17
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.058 AMC Cam Table In 18


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 18
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.059 AMC Cam Table Out 18


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 18
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


476 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 36.060 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 18
Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 18
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.061 AMC Cam Table In 19


Short description Defines the input entry to the cam table for segment 19
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.062 AMC Cam Table Out 19


Short description Defines the output entry to the cam table for segment 19
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_CAM[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Parameter 36.063 AMC Cam Table Interpolation 19


Short description Defines the interpolation entry to the cam table for segment 19
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Cos1
1 Square
2 Cos2

See AMC Cam Table In 0 (36.004).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 477
Menu 37 Single Line Descriptions − AMC Electronic Gear Box
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


37.001 AMC EGB Enable Rigid Lock Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
37.002 AMC EGB Ratio Numerator 1 to 2147483647 1000 RW Num US
37.003 AMC EGB Ratio Denominator 1 to 2147483647 1000 RW Num US
VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MIN] to
37.004 AMC EGB Locking Speed Band 10.92 UU/ms RW Num US
VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MAX] UU/ms
37.005 AMC EGB Locking Position Band 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR UU 256 UU RW Num US
37.006 AMC EGB Locked Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


478 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 37 − AMC Electronic Gear Box
Mode: RFC‑A

Electronic gearbox

Parameter 37.001 AMC EGB Enable Rigid Lock


Short description Set to 1 to enable rigid locking of the electronic gearbox
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

When the electronic gearbox is not selected or the Advanced Motion Controller is disabled AMC EGB Locked (37.006) = 0 and the electronic gearbox
control is in the inactive state. The electronic gearbox is enabled when the motion controller is enabled and AMC Reference Select (34.007) is changed
to a value of 4 (electronic gear box).

If AMC EGB Enable Rigid Lock (37.001) = 0 the system attempts to match the speed of the slave with the speed of the master. The speed at the output
of the profile generator can only change within the acceleration/deceleration constraints set up for the profile generator (i.e. AMC Profile Acceleration
(38.001), AMC Profile Deceleration (38.002) and AMC Profile Maximum Speed (38.003)). Once the modulus of the difference between the speed at the
input and output of the profile generator is less than or equal to AMC EGB Locking Speed Band (37.004) the profile generator is disabled so that the
output of the profile generator follows the input with no delay and AMC EGB Locked (37.006) is set to 1. AMC EGB Locked (37.006) can be reset and
the profile generator re-enabled by selecting another reference with AMC Reference Select (34.007)) or by disabling the motion controller. The diagram
below shows the speed of the master and slave systems with AMC EGB Enable Rigid Lock (37.001) = 0.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 479
If AMC EGB Enable Rigid Lock (37.001) = 1 the system attempts to match the speed and position of the slave before changing to the locked state as
shown above. The profile generator output will exceed the profile generator input speed to make up the position lost during acceleration. The system
only changes to the locked state when the modulus of the speed difference between the input and output of the profile generator is within
AMC EGB Locking Speed Band (37.004) and the modulus of the difference between the input and output position is within
AMC EGB Locking Position Band (37.005).

Note that rigid lock will not be enabled when the output of the profile generator is jerk limited, i.e. AMC Profile Jerk 1 (38.011) > 0.

Parameter 37.002 AMC EGB Ratio Numerator


Short description Defines the numerator of the ratio used at the input to the electronic gearbox
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 2147483647
Default 1000 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

The electronic gear box ratio (AMC EGB Ratio Numerator (37.002) / AMC EGB Ratio Denominator (37.003)) is applied to changes in
the AMC Master Position (32.004) at the input to the electronic gearbox.

Parameter 37.003 AMC EGB Ratio Denominator


Short description Defines the denominator of the ratio used at the input to the electronic gearbox
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 1 Maximum 2147483647
Default 1000 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


480 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
See AMC EGB Ratio Numerator (37.002).

Parameter 37.004 AMC EGB Locking Speed Band


Short description Defines the speed band used to lock the electronic gearbox
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 10.92 Units UU/ms
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW, VM

The default value of 10.92 UU/ms is the equivalent of 10rpm for a feedback device with 16 normalised position bits per revolution and a user unit ratio of
unity.

See AMC EGB Enable Rigid Lock (37.001).

Parameter 37.005 AMC EGB Locking Position Band


Short description Defines the position band used to lock the electronic gearbox
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 256 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC EGB Enable Rigid Lock (37.001).

Parameter 37.006 AMC EGB Locked


Short description Displays when the electronic gearbox is locked
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See AMC EGB Enable Rigid Lock (37.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 481
Menu 38 Single Line Descriptions − AMC Profile Generator
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


VM_AMC_RATE_UNIPOLAR[MIN] to
38.001 AMC Profile Acceleration 1.092 UU/ms² RW Num US
VM_AMC_RATE_UNIPOLAR[MAX] UU/ms²
VM_AMC_RATE_UNIPOLAR[MIN] to
38.002 AMC Profile Deceleration 1.092 UU/ms² RW Num US
VM_AMC_RATE_UNIPOLAR[MAX] UU/ms²
VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MIN] to
38.003 AMC Profile Maximum Speed 1092.00 UU/ms RW Num US
VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MAX] UU/ms
38.005 AMC Profile Disable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit
VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] to
38.006 AMC Profile Input Position RO Num ND NC PT
VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] UU
VM_AMC_SPEED[MIN] to
38.007 AMC Profile Input Speed RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_AMC_SPEED[MAX] UU/ms
VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] to
38.008 AMC Profile Output Position RO Num ND NC PT
VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] UU
VM_AMC_SPEED[MIN] to
38.009 AMC Profile Output Speed RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_AMC_SPEED[MAX] UU/ms
VM_AMC_RATE[MIN] to
38.010 AMC Profile Output Acceleration RO Num ND NC PT
VM_AMC_RATE[MAX] UU/ms²
VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MIN] to
38.011 AMC Profile Jerk 1 0.0000 UU/ms³ RW Num US
VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MAX] UU/ms³
VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MIN] to
38.012 AMC Profile Jerk 2 0.0000 UU/ms³ RW Num US
VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MAX] UU/ms³
VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MIN] to
38.013 AMC Profile Jerk 3 0.0000 UU/ms³ RW Num US
VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MAX] UU/ms³
VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MIN] to
38.014 AMC Profile Jerk 4 0.0000 UU/ms³ RW Num US
VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MAX] UU/ms³
38.015 AMC Profile Update Mode 0 to 1 1 RW Num US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


482 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 38 − AMC Profile Generator
Mode: RFC‑A

Profile generator

Main profile

AMC Profile Input Speed (38.007) is the rate of change of position over each sample from any of the references. This provides the speed target for the profile generator and this is integrated to give AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) which is the position
target. When the profile generator is enabled it produces AMC Profile Output Speed (38.009) which is the rate of change of output position and this is integrated to give AMC Profile Output Position (38.008). Depending on the profile mode the profile generator
aims to make either the AMC Profile Output Speed (38.009) equal to the AMC Profile Input Speed (38.007), the AMC Profile Output Position (38.008) equal to the AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) at zero speed, or both. The profile target mode depends on
the input to the profile generator as follows.

Input Target
AMC Stop Reference (34.002) Stop reference at zero speed
AMC Position Reference (34.003) (AMC Reference Select (34.007) = 1 or 6) Position reference at zero speed
AMC Speed Reference (34.006) Speed reference
Cam Profile disabled

Input speed when not locked


Electronic gearbox with non-rigid lock
Profile disabled when locked

Input speed and position when not locked


Electronic gearbox with rigid lock
Profile disabled when locked

Input speed while finding home position


Homing system
Input position at zero speed when moving to home reset position

Profile input position (AMC Reference Select (34.007) = 7) Constant target position at zero speed

The profile generator can operate with a linear ramp (AMC Profile Jerk 1 (38.011) = 0) or an s-ramp profile (AMC Profile Jerk 1 (38.011) > 0). When the profile is operating in linear mode the rate of change of AMC Profile Output Speed (38.009) is constrained
by the profile generator. If an s-ramp profile is enabled the rate of change of acceleration is also constrained and up to four unique jerk values can be defined, see AMC Profile Jerk 1 (38.011).

If the profile generator is disabled AMC Profile Output Speed (38.009) = AMC Profile Input Speed (38.007) and AMC Profile Output Position (38.008) = AMC Profile Input Position (38.006). The profile generator can be disabled under any of the following
conditions.

Conditions for profile generator disable Comments

AMC Profile Disable (38.005) = 1 Profile disabled by the user

AMC Reference Select (34.007) = 0
Stop reference selected and no profile stop required
and AMC Stop Mode (34.001) = 1 or 3

Cam system enabled


The Cam system provides its own profile, and so the profile generator is not required
(i.e. AMC Reference Select (34.007) = 3)

AMC EGB Locked (37.006) = 1 Electronic gearbox output is locked and should follow the master position without any delay

Parameter 38.001 AMC Profile Acceleration


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_RATE_UNIPOLAR[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_RATE_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 1.092 Units UU/ms²
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

The default value of 1.092 UU/ms2 is the equivalent of an acceleration of 1000rpm/s for a feedback device with 16 normalised position bits per revolution and a user unit ratio of unity.

The profile generator applies the constraints to the output speed defined by AMC Profile Acceleration (38.001) when the speed is moving away from 0, AMC Profile Deceleration (38.002) when the speed is moving towards 0, and AMC Profile Maximum Speed
(38.003) in either direction.

Parameter 38.002 AMC Profile Deceleration


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_RATE_UNIPOLAR[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_RATE_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 1.092 Units UU/ms²
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

The default value of 1.092 UU/ms2 is the equivalent of a deceleration of 1000rpm/s for a feedback device with 16 normalised position bits per revolution and a user unit ratio of unity.

See AMC Profile Acceleration (38.001).

Parameter 38.003 AMC Profile Maximum Speed


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 1092.00 Units UU/ms
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW, VM

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 483
The default value of 1092 UU/ms is the equivalent of 1000rpm for a feedback device with 16 normalised position bits per revolution and a user unit ratio of unity.

See AMC Profile Acceleration (38.001).

Parameter 38.005 AMC Profile Disable


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See the introduction to menu 38.

Parameter 38.006 AMC Profile Input Position


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX]
Default Units UU
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, VM, ND, NC, PT

See the introduction to menu 38.

Parameter 38.007 AMC Profile Input Speed


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_SPEED[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_SPEED[MAX]
Default Units UU/ms
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

See the introduction to menu 38.

Parameter 38.008 AMC Profile Output Position


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX]
Default Units UU
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, VM, ND, NC, PT

See the introduction to menu 38.

Parameter 38.009 AMC Profile Output Speed


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_SPEED[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_SPEED[MAX]
Default Units UU/ms
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

See the introduction to menu 38.

Parameter 38.010 AMC Profile Output Acceleration


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_RATE[MAX]
Default Units UU/ms²
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RO, VM, ND, NC, PT

See the introduction to menu 38.

Parameter 38.011 AMC Profile Jerk 1


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0.0000 Units UU/ms³
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW, VM

If AMC Profile Jerk 1 (38.011) > 0 and AMC Rate Selected (31.013) >= 1ms the maximum rate of change of AMC Profile Output Acceleration (38.010) is constrained by the jerk parameters in AMC Profile Generator (38). Note that it is only possible to change
between the s-ramp profile and the linear profile when the drive or motion controller is disabled.

Jerk configuration

It is possible to configure up to four independent jerk values as shown in the diagram below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


484 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
To minimise the error between AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) and AMC Profile Output Position (38.008) after the initial profile has been completed the maximum values of AMC Profile Jerk 3 (38.013) and AMC Profile Jerk 4 (38.014) which are used during
the profile are limited to the following ratios.

AMC Profile Jerk 3 (38.013) ≤ 100 × AMC Profile Jerk 4 (38.014)

AMC Profile Jerk 4 (38.014) ≤ 100 × AMC Profile Jerk 3 (38.013)

If any of the jerk parameters are set to zero the jerk used in that section is inherited from the previous section. This allows the s-ramp to be setup in one of the following configurations without changing all of the jerk parameters individually. If a linear change of
speed is required in a section of the s-ramp the corresponding jerk parameter must be set to a value that ensures that the maximum rate (AMC Profile Acceleration (38.001) or AMC Profile Deceleration (38.002)) is achieved in a single sample.

Note that if AMC Profile Update Mode (38.015) is configured to allow a change of jerk during a profile and AMC Profile Jerk 1 (38.011) is set to zero before the profile has been completed the minimum jerk (0.0001 uu/ms 3) will be
used until AMC Profile Output Speed (38.009) reaches standstill.

Profile 1 - Single jerk

AMC Profile Jerk 1 (38.011) > 0

AMC Profile Jerk 2 (38.012) = 0

AMC Profile Jerk 3 (38.013) = 0

AMC Profile Jerk 4 (38.014) = 0

Profile 2 - Acceleration and deceleration jerk

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 485
AMC Profile Jerk 1 (38.011) > 0

AMC Profile Jerk 2 (38.012) = 0

AMC Profile Jerk 3 (38.013) > 0

AMC Profile Jerk 4 (38.014) = 0

Profile operation

If AMC Profile Output Speed (38.009) crosses the zero boundary without stopping (i.e. AMC Speed Reference (34.006) is changed from a positive to negative value) AMC Profile Output Acceleration (38.010) is limited by the deceleration parameters
(AMC Profile Deceleration (38.002), AMC Profile Jerk 3 (38.013) and AMC Profile Jerk 4 (38.014)) until the acceleration is reduced to zero (constant speed) as shown in the diagram below.

The above description also applies when the s-ramp is operating in position mode. If AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) is changed when the output of the profile is at standstill (AMC Profile Output Speed (38.009) and AMC Profile Output Acceleration
(38.010) = 0) the profile will accelerate to the target speed under the constraints of AMC Profile Acceleration (38.001), AMC Profile Jerk 1 (38.011) and AMC Profile Jerk 2 (38.012) and decelerate to zero speed under the constraints of AMC Profile Deceleration
(38.002), AMC Profile Jerk 3 (38.013) and AMC Profile Jerk 4 (38.014). This is shown in the diagram below. Note that when AMC Profile Complete Window (41.005) is set to zero AMC Profile Complete Flag (41.006) can be used to detect when the output of
the profile has reached the target position and is at standstill.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


486 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
If AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) is changed before the profile has been completed and AMC Profile Output Speed (38.009) must cross the zero boundary to reach the new target speed the profile will be constrained by the deceleration parameters for the
entire movement as shown in the diagram below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 487
Parameter 38.012 AMC Profile Jerk 2
Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0.0000 Units UU/ms³
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Profile Jerk 1 (38.011).

Parameter 38.013 AMC Profile Jerk 3


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0.0000 Units UU/ms³
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Profile Jerk 1 (38.011).

Parameter 38.014 AMC Profile Jerk 4


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_JERK_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0.0000 Units UU/ms³
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 4
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Profile Jerk 1 (38.011).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


488 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 38.015 AMC Profile Update Mode
Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

AMC Profile Update Mode (38.015) can be used to select when a change to the profile acceleration, deceleration or jerk parameter is applied to the profile generator.

AMC Profile Update Mode


Profile update Ramp type
(38.015)

Linear ramp and S-


0 Profile acceleration, deceleration and jerk values are updated in the sample after the parameter has been read by the drive.
ramp

When the s-ramp profile is enabled (AMC Profile Jerk 1 (38.011) > 0) the profile acceleration, deceleration and jerk values are only
S-
updated when the output of the profile generator is at standstill (speed and acceleration = 0). This prevents a change to the profile
ramp
1 constraints causing an overshoot of the target speed or position. Note that an overshoot can still occur if the target speed or position is changed
when the profile generator is not at standstill. If the profile generator is disabled (see the introduction to menu 38) or the linear ramp is enabled
the profile parameters are updated as described in the previous mode.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 489
Menu 39 Single Line Descriptions − AMC Position Control Loop
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


39.001 AMC External Reference Select Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
39.002 AMC External Position Reference -2147483648 to 2147483647 UU 0 UU RW Num
VM_AMC_SPEED[MIN] to
39.004 AMC External Speed Reference 0.00 UU/ms RW Num
VM_AMC_SPEED[MAX] UU/ms
39.005 AMC Inertia Compensation Mode None (0), Acceleration (1), Torque (2) None (0) RW Txt US
39.007 AMC Position Control Loop Kp Gain 0.000 to 500.000 25.000 RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] to
39.008 AMC Position Error RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] UU
VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MIN] to
39.009 AMC Position Control Loop Speed Clamp 109.20 UU/ms RW Num US
VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MAX] UU/ms
39.010 AMC Speed Feed‑forwards Gain 0.000 to 2.000 1.000 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
39.011 AMC Output Speed Clamp 1000.0 RW Num US
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] to
39.012 AMC Output Speed RO Num ND NC PT FI
VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
39.013 AMC Output Invert Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
VM_AMC_RATE[MIN] to
39.014 AMC External Acceleration Reference 0.000 UU/ms² RW Num
VM_AMC_RATE[MAX] UU/ms²
39.015 AMC External Reference Mode 0 to 1 0 RW Num US
39.016 AMC External Control State 0 to 17 RO Num ND NC PT

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


490 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 39 − AMC Position Control Loop
Mode: RFC‑A

Position control loop

Parameter 39.001 AMC External Reference Select


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If AMC External Reference Select (39.001) = 0 the position, speed and acceleration reference for the position control loop are taken from the output of the profile generator. However, it
is possible to provide these references from an external application (i.e. an applications category module program). If AMC External Reference Select (39.001) = 1 the position reference
is taken from AMC External Position Reference (39.002), the speed reference is taken from AMC External Speed Reference  (39.004) and the acceleration reference is taken from
AMC External Acceleration Reference (39.014).

Parameter 39.002 AMC External Position Reference


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate AMC sample rate read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See AMC External Reference Select (39.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 491
Parameter 39.004 AMC External Speed Reference
Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_SPEED[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_SPEED[MAX]
Default 0.00 Units UU/ms
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate AMC sample rate read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW, VM

See AMC External Reference Select (39.001).

Parameter 39.005 AMC Inertia Compensation Mode


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 None
1 Acceleration
2 Torque

AMC Inertia Compensation Mode (39.005) selects the inertia compensation mode as shown below.

0 (None)

No inertia compensation.

1 (Acceleration feed-forwards)

When acceleration feed-forwards is selected a gain term is automatically calculated based on the currently active drive speed controller gains, Motor And Load Inertia (03.018) and
Torque Per Amp (05.032). The acceleration feed-forwards term is intended to cancel the effect of the speed controller time constant and give a faster position control loop response. The
acceleration feed-forwards term is only compatible with a first order speed controller, i.e. Speed Controller Set-up Method (03.017) = 7.

2 (Torque feed-forwards)

When torque feed-forwards is selected the acceleration from the profile generator is used to define the torque feed-forwards. The Motor And Load Inertia (03.018), Torque Per Amp
(05.032) and the output user units ratio are used to convert from acceleration to torque. It should be noted that the Inertia Compensation Torque (02.038) is added to the output of the
speed controller when Inertia Compensation Enable (04.022) = 1.

Parameter 39.007 AMC Position Control Loop Kp Gain


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 500.000
Default 25.000 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

AMC Position Control Loop Kp Gain (39.007) is the proportional gain with units of (User units/s) / User units. A AMC Position Control Loop Kp Gain (39.007) of
unity and a AMC Position Error (39.008) of one User unit will give a position control loop speed of 1 User unit/s.

Parameter 39.008 AMC Position Error


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX]
Default Units UU
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

AMC Position Error (39.008) gives the difference between the final position reference and the AMC Slave Position (33.004) in User units.

Parameter 39.009 AMC Position Control Loop Speed Clamp


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 109.20 Units UU/ms
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW, VM

The default value of 109.2 UU/ms is the equivalent of 100rpm for a feedback device with 16 normalised position bits per revolution and a user unit ratio of unity.

The AMC Position Control Loop Speed Clamp (39.009) defines the maximum positive or negative speed output from the position control loop in User units/ms.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


492 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 39.010 AMC Speed Feed-forwards Gain
Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 2.000
Default 1.000 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW

Normally the speed feed-forwards is used directly to provide the speed reference for the drive, with the position controller used as a trim to compensate for system and load effects
to give the correct position. The default value of AMC Speed Feed-forwards Gain (39.010) is unity, but in some applications it may be necessary to reduce the speed feed-forward
component to reduce overshoot.

Parameter 39.011 AMC Output Speed Clamp


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default 1000.0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW, VM

AMC Output Speed Clamp (39.011) provides a final clamp on the output speed in drive speed parameter units (i.e. rpm or mm/s).

Parameter 39.012 AMC Output Speed


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MIN] Maximum VM_SPEED_FREQ_REF[MAX]
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RO, FI, VM, ND, NC, PT

AMC Output Speed (39.012) is the final output from the Advanced Motion Controller in 0.1rpm or 0.1mm/s. Although the update rate for this parameter is 4ms the output speed is written
to the Hard Speed Reference (03.022) at the sample rate selected in AMC Rate Select (31.012). The output speed is written in internal units (232cpr/250μs) to increase the maximum
speed resolution to 5.59e-5rpm or Pole Pitch x 9.31e-7mm/s.

Parameter 39.013 AMC Output Invert


Short description Set to 1 to invert the AMC output speed
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If AMC Output Invert (39.013) = 1 then AMC Output Speed (39.012) and the output torque (AMC Inertia Compensation Mode (39.005) = 2) is inverted.

Parameter 39.014 AMC External Acceleration Reference


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_RATE[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_RATE[MAX]
Default 0.000 Units UU/ms²
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate AMC sample rate read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, VM

See AMC External Reference Select (39.001).

Parameter 39.015 AMC External Reference Mode


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

AMC External Reference Mode (39.015) can be used to modify the operation of the Advanced Motion Controller when an external profile generator is being used to provide the
references for the position control loop. When an external profile is used it is important that the profile is always synchronised to AMC Slave Position (33.004) and the outputs of the
profile are written to the external references before the drive is enabled. If this is not done the position error may cause the slave to move.

If AMC External Reference Mode (39.015) = 0 the external references are always used when selected (AMC External Reference Select (39.001) = 1) and no other changes are made to
the operation of the Advanced Motion Controller.

If AMC External Reference Mode (39.015) = 1 the following apply when the external references are selected. This mode of operation is intended to be used with an external motion
controller, such as the MCi option module.

1. The state machine described in AMC External Control State (39.016) is enabled. AMC External Control State (39.016) provides the state of the drive (unhealthy or disabled),
indicates the active reference, the status of a homing routine and if an error has occurred, i.e. the stop reference has been selected while the external reference or homing
routine was active, a limits has become active, etc. To synchronise the external profile with the slave position AMC External Control State (39.016) should be in one of
the stopped states. In a stopped state the reference selector is set to stop and AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) = AMC Profile Output Position (38.008) which ensures that
the external profile can be updated without introducing a position error when the external reference is activated.
2. The external references are not used when AMC Reference Select (34.007) is set to stop or home. This allows the on-board profile generator to perform a stop or homing
routine without having to change AMC External Reference Select (39.001).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 493
3. When the external references are being used the outputs of the on-board profile generator are set to the slave position, speed and acceleration. This allows the stop reference to
be selected while the slave is moving and for a ramped stop to be performed.
4. AMC Reference Select (34.007) is set to stop when the drive is disabled. This ensures that the slave will be held at the slave position until the external profile is synchronised
and is ready to provide the external reference.
5. AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) displays the rollover position when rollover mode is enabled (AMC Profile Output Position (38.008) > 0). This allows the external profile to be
synchronised with the internal (AMC Profile Output Position (38.008)) and rollover (AMC Slave Position (33.004)) positions.
6. If a hardware or software limit is active and the output speed due to the position error or velocity feedforwards is towards the active limit AMC Output Speed (39.012) is set to
zero and AMC Reference Select (34.007) is set to stop.

Parameter 39.016 AMC External Control State


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 17
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

AMC External Control State (39.016) shows the current state of the state machine shown in the diagram below. This state machine is active when AMC External Reference Mode
(39.015) is set. See AMC External Reference Mode (39.015) for a description of how the state machine is used.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


494 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 40 Single Line Descriptions − AMC Homing System
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


40.001 AMC Home Direction Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
40.002 AMC Home Mode -1 to 9 0 RW Num US
VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MIN] to
40.003 AMC Home Maximum Speed 10.92 UU/ms RW Num US
VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MAX] UU/ms
VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] to
40.004 AMC Home Position 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] UU
40.005 AMC Home Complete Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MIN] to
40.006 AMC Home Offset Maximum Speed 10.92 UU/ms RW Num US
VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MAX] UU/ms
VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] to
40.007 AMC Home Offset Position 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] UU
40.008 AMC Home Offset Complete Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
40.009 AMC Home Maximum Allowed Move 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR UU 0 UU RW Num US
40.010 AMC Home Complete Window 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR UU 1 UU RW Num US
40.011 AMC Home On Freeze Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
40.012 AMC Home Switch Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
40.013 AMC Home Positive Limit Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
40.014 AMC Home Negative Limit Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
40.015 AMC Home Positive Limit Selector 0 to 2 0 RW Num US
40.016 AMC Home Negative Limit Selector 0 to 2 0 RW Num US
40.017 AMC Home Torque Limit Active Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
40.018 AMC Home Hard Stop Torque Threshold 0.0 to 1000.0 % 0.0 % RW Num US
40.019 AMC Home Hard Stop Delay Time 0.000 to 60.000 s 0.000 s RW Num US
40.020 AMC Home Required Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
None (-1), User Position (0), Sensorless (1),
P1 Drive (2), P2 Drive (3), P1 Slot1 (4),
40.021 AMC Home Slave Source None (-1) RW Txt PS
P2 Slot1 (5), P1 Slot2 (6), P2 Slot2 (7),
P1 Slot3 (8), P2 Slot3 (9)
40.022 AMC Home Mode Setup 000000000000000 to 111111111111111 000000000000000 RW Bin NC US
40.023 AMC Home Restart Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
Not Active (0), Home Switch (1),
40.024 AMC Homing Sequence State RO Txt ND NC PT
Home Switch Rev (2), Freeze (3), Offset (4)

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 495
Menu 40 − AMC Homing System
Mode: RFC‑A

Homing system

Homing is a method used to detect a particular position, usually with some type of mechanical switch (a "home switch"). The position feedback (the slave position in the AMC) is
then modified so that it has a known position at the point where the "home switch" position was detected. In the example below the scaling has been set up so that the AMC user
units are millimetres.

The total movement is from 0mm to 1000mm moving from left to right. Initially the system starts at a position of 100mm from the left, but the AMC is operating in incremental mode
with a position feedback device that does not give absolute position, and so the slave position (AMC Slave Position (33.004)) is zero. Homing is started when
AMC Reference Select (34.007) is set to 5 (Home) and in this case the system will move to the right by 300mm until the "home switch" is detected. At this point the mechanical
position will be 400mm, but the slave position will be 300mm because it has increased from its initial value of 0mm by 300mm. In this example the slave position should be 0mm at
the left-hand end and 1000mm at the right-hand end, and so the slave position should be 400mm at the "home switch" transition. To achieve this an offset is applied to the slave
position. The user knows that the "home switch" transition is at 400mm, and must indicate this by setting AMC Home Position (40.004) = 400. The drive will then perform the
following calculation to modify the slave offset:

AMC Slave Offset (33.003) = AMC Home Position (40.004) - AMC Slave Position (33.004) = 400mm - 300mm = 100mm

Because the system has moved by 300mm the slave position will be 300mm just before the "home switch" transition, and so after the transition:

AMC Slave Position (33.004) = 300mm + (400mm - 100mm) = 400mm

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


496 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
So now the slave position is 400mm at the transition, the absolute position is known and the position changes from 0mm to 1000mm over the range of travel. Because the slave
position is always the sum of the slave position feedback and its offset, the above will always work even if the initial value of AMC Slave Position (33.004) is non-zero. Normally
this step change of the slave position would cause unwanted movement because this change would be seen as a position error by the position controller. To avoid this effect both
the input and output of the profile generator are also adjusted by the same change applied to the slave offset.

The homing sequence can include up to three phases:

Phase 1: Home to switch
The system operates in speed control (with maximum speed in either direction of AMC Home Maximum Speed (40.003)) until it detects a valid "home switch" transition. Phase 1
does not have to be present in the homing sequence (i.e. AMC Home Mode (40.002) = 1). In this case the sequence starts in Phase 2. If Phase 1 is not present then Phase 2
must be present to detect the "home switch" transition.

Phase 2: Home to freeze
The system operates in speed control (with maximum speed in either direction of AMC Home Maximum Speed (40.003)) until it detects a freeze event. Phase 2 is optional and
can follow on from Phase 1 to give a more accurate home position than is possible from the initial "home switch" transition. Alternatively it can be used alone to detect the home
position.

Phase 3: Home offset
The system operates in position control (with a maximum speed in either direction of AMC Home Offset Maximum Speed (40.006)) until the system moves to a position that is a
distance from the home position defined by AMC Home Offset Position (40.007).

Each of these phases is described in more detail below. It is possible to see the progress through these phases by monitoring AMC Homing Sequence State (40.024).

Phase 1: Home to switch


There are a number of possible homing modes (see AMC Home Mode (40.002)), but homing Mode 5 is used as an example to describe this phase. AMC Home Switch (40.012),
AMC Home Positive Limit (40.013) and AMC Home Negative Limit (40.014), which can be controlled for example by digital inputs, are used to define the movement of the system
in an attempt to produce the required "home switch" transition and to set the home position. The left-hand end of the movement is the negative end and the right-hand end is the
positive end. In Mode 5 AMC Home Negative Limit (40.014) is not active in controlling the movement. If this switch becomes active an error has occurred, and
so AMC Reference Select (34.007) is automatically set to 0 (Stop) and the home sequence is aborted. The direction of movement depends on the state of the "home switch".
Three example starting points are shown on the diagram below. When the switch is low (Starting Points 1 and 3) the movement is forwards and when the switch is high (Starting
Point 2) the movement is backwards. The home position is detected when a transition occurs on the negative edge (the one closest to the negative end) of AMC Home Switch
(40.012). This can occur with the system moving either forwards (negative end to positive end) or backwards (positive end to negative end), and so it corresponds to a rising
transition in the forwards direction or a falling transition in the reverse direction as shown.

The diagram below shows the movement from each starting point until the "home switch" transition is detected at the end of Phase1.

If the initial position is on the negative side of the required negative edge transition (Starting Point 1) then the movement will be forwards toward the required negative edge
transition and the system will complete Phase 1 successfully.

If the initial position is where the "home switch" is high (Starting Point 2) again the movement will be backwards toward the required negative edge transition and the system will
complete Phase 1 successfully.

However, if the initial position is beyond the positive edge of the region where the "home switch" is high (Starting Point 3) the resulting forward movement will be away from the
required negative edge transition and unless further action is taken Phase 1 will fail. To prevent this, if AMC Home Positive Limit (40.013) becomes active it reverses the direction
of motion. This state is latched and overrides the state of AMC Home Switch (40.012) so that the backwards movement continues until the negative edge of the home switch is
reached to complete Phase 1.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 497
If Phase 2 is not required (AMC Home On Freeze (40.011) = 0) the home position has now been found and the slave position offset must be modified to make the physical
position where the transition occurred equal to the required home position as described previously. The slave offset is modified so that

AMC Slave Offset (33.003) = AMC Home Position (40.004) - AMC Slave Position (33.004)

The system then proceeds to Phase 3.

Phase 2: Home to freeze


Phase 2 is either used alone or follows on from Phase 1 to give a more accurate home position than can be achieved in Phase 1. The home system runs with a sampling time of
4ms, and in Phase 1 the "home switch" transition is detected in the sample after it occurs. This means there will be an error in the home position that is dependent on the speed
when the "home switch" is detected.

The freeze system captures the position of the transition independently of the system samples, and so the result is more accurate and does not include a significant speed
dependent error. The freeze signal can be derived from a marker pulse, which will occur once per revolution in a rotary system as in the example shown below, or from a sensor
connected via a digital input to the drive, or from an option module freeze system.

At the start of Phase 2 the freeze flag of the slave position freeze source is cleared. For example, if the drive F1 freeze is being used as the source then F1 Freeze Flag
(03.104) is cleared. This has the effect of also clearing AMC Slave Freeze Flag (33.010) so that a new freeze position can be detected.

The direction used to approach the freeze transition is defined by AMC Home Direction (40.001), where 0 corresponds to the forward direction and 1 to the backwards direction. In
the example shown below the initial position is where the "home switch" is active, and so the initial direction is backwards. At the end of Phase 1 the slave offset is not modified,
but the direction of movement changes to forwards because AMC Home Direction (40.001) = 0 and the system continues in the forward direction until the freeze is detected. The
slave offset is then modified so that

AMC Slave Offset (33.003) = AMC Home Position (40.004) - AMC Slave Freeze Position (33.006)

The system then proceeds to Phase 3.

Phase 3: Home offset


So far during the homing sequence the system has been operating in speed control with the maximum speed in either direction defined by AMC Home Maximum Speed
(40.003). When the required transition is detected at the end of the previous phase (i.e. Phase 1 or Phase 2) the system will be moving at a speed up to this maximum speed. If
the reference selector (AMC Reference Select (34.007)) is simply set to 0 (Stop) the system would slow to a standstill under control of the profile, and so its final position would be
away from the home position.

The position required at the end of the homing sequence is defined as the distance from the home position by AMC Home Offset Position (40.007). If this is set to zero then the
required position at the end of the sequence is the home position itself. During Phase 3 the system operates in position control, with a maximum speed of
AMC Home Offset Maximum Speed (40.006) to move to a distance of AMC Home Offset Position (40.007) from the home position.

In the example given below AMC Home Offset Position (40.007) is a positive non-zero value longer than the distance required to stop at the speed at the end of the previous
phase. Therefore the system continues to move in the forwards direction until it stops at the required position. The user can define how close the slave position must be to the

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


498 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
required position to terminate Phase 3 with AMC Home Complete Window (40.010).

The example given is for AMC Home Mode (40.002) = 5. This demonstrates the principles used for all the other homing modes.

Parameter 40.001 AMC Home Direction


Short description Defines the direction of movement during home to freeze where 0 is forwards and 1 is backwards
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

AMC Home Direction (40.001) defines the direction of movement during Phase 2 (home to freeze) when the system operates under speed control to detect the freeze input
transition, where 0 is forwards and 1 is backwards.

Parameter 40.002 AMC Home Mode


Short description Defines the homing mode to be used
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -1 Maximum 9
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

AMC Home Mode (40.002) is used to select the required homing mode. Each of the modes is described below. It should be noted that only Phase 1 is described for Modes 2 to 8.
In these modes Phase 3 always occurs and Phase 2 occurs if AMC Home On Freeze (40.011).

Mode -1 - Home direct


AMC Slave Offset (33.003) is simply updated to make present position become the AMC Home Position (40.004) without any movement. The AMC Reference Select (34.007) is
changed immediately back to 0 (Stop).

Mode 0 - Manual
Only Phase 1 is allowed in this mode, and so AMC Home On Freeze (40.011) has no effect. In the general description at the start of this menu it was stated that if
either AMC Home Positive Limit (40.013) or AMC Home Negative Limit (40.014) become active then this is latched and the defined movement overrides the movement defined
by AMC Home Switch (40.012). Manual mode operates differently to the other modes in that the activation of the limits is not latched and the direction is defined by the state of
these switches as given in the table below.

AMC Home Positive Limit (40.013) AMC Home Negative Limit (40.014) Direction
0 0 STOP
0 1 Forwards
1 0 Backwards
1 1 STOP

It is assumed that the initial position is where the home switch is not active so that the home position can be detected on the change from not active to active at the appropriate
edge of AMC Home Switch (40.012). AMC Home Positive Limit (40.013) and AMC Home Negative Limit (40.014) can be used as jog controls, for example, to move the system

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 499
until the home position is detected.

Mode 1 - Home on freeze flag


Phase 1 is not used in this mode, but the home position is always detected in Phase 2 when the AMC Slave Freeze Flag (33.010) becomes active. (Unlike all the following states it
is not necessary to set AMC Home On Freeze (40.011) to 1.) Once the home position has been detected the system moves on to Phase 3.

Mode 2 - Home on positive limit


During Phase 1 AMC Home Positive Limit (40.013) defines the direction of movement so that the system moves towards the point where it changes state.

Mode 3 - Home on negative limit


During Phase 1 AMC Home Negative Limit (40.014) defines the direction of movement so that the system moves towards the point where it changes state.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


500 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Mode 4 - Home on home switch
During Phase 1 AMC Home Switch (40.012) defines the direction of movement so that the system moves towards the point where it changes state.

Mode 5 - Home on negative edge of home switch with positive limit


AMC Home Switch (40.012) is connected to a "home switch" that can be approached from either direction. The negative edge of the "home switch" is used to define the home
position. From Starting Points 1 and 2 the defined movement is towards the home position. However, the movement from Starting Point 3 is away from the home position, and
so AMC Home Positive Limit (40.013) must be connected to some form of limit switch so that when the positive end of the system is reached the direction is reversed.

Mode 6 - Home on positive edge of home switch with positive limit


This operates in the same way as Mode 5 except that the home position is at the positive edge of the "home switch". To achieve this the direction off a high "home switch" is
changed from backwards to forwards.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 501
Mode 7 - Home on negative edge of home switch with negative limit
This operates in the same way as Mode 5 except that a negative limit is used to reverse the direction when the movement is away from the required home switch transition.
To achieve this the direction off a low "home switch" is changed from forwards to backwards.

Mode 8 - Home on positive edge of home switch with negative limit


This operates in the same way as Mode 5 except that the home position is at the positive edge of the "home switch" and a negative limit is used to reverse the direction when the
movement is away from the required home switch transition. To achieve this the direction of movement off a low or high "home switch" are both reversed.

Mode 9 - User defined mode


This is a flexible mode that allows different aspects of the homing sequence to be defined by the bits in AMC Home Mode Setup (40.022).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


502 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 40.003 AMC Home Maximum Speed
Short description Defines the maximum homing speed used during home to switch and home to freeze
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 10.92 Units UU/ms
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW, VM

During Phases 1 and 2 the homing system operates in speed control and AMC Home Maximum Speed (40.003) is the maximum speed used during these phases. The homing
system will set the speed reference at the input to the profile generator to either -AMC Home Maximum Speed (40.003) or AMC Home Maximum Speed (40.003) to try and reach
the home switch. Depending on the acceleration rate and the distance and time required to reach the "home switch" it may or may not be possible to reach the defined maximum
speed.

Parameter 40.004 AMC Home Position


Short description Defines the slave position after the home to switch or home to freeze has been completed
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

AMC Home Position (40.004) defines the slave position after Phase 1 (or Phase 2 if being used) has been completed. The slave position offset is modifed so that the slave
position is equal to AMC Home Position (40.004) at the end of Phase 1 (or Phase 2 if being used). See the introduction for this menu for more details.

Parameter 40.005 AMC Home Complete


Short description Indicates that home to switch or home to freeze has been completed
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

AMC Home Complete (40.005) is set to zero when a homing sequence is started. It is set to one again at the end of Phase 1 if Phase 2 is not being used, or otherwise at the end
of Phase 2.

Parameter 40.006 AMC Home Offset Maximum Speed


Short description Defines the maximum speed used during the the home offset phase
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 10.92 Units UU/ms
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW, VM

During Phase 3 the homing system operates in position control. AMC Home Offset Maximum Speed (40.006) defines the maximum speed that can be used in either direction
during this phase.

Parameter 40.007 AMC Home Offset Position


Short description Defines the home offset position
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

The offset from the home position during Phase 3 of the homing sequence, i.e the distance of the final target position from the home position is defined by
AMC Home Offset Position (40.007).

Parameter 40.008 AMC Home Offset Complete


Short description Indicates that the system has reached the home offset position
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

AMC Home Offset Complete (40.008) is set to zero when a homing sequence is started. It is set to one again when Phase 3 is completed and the system has reached its target
position.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 503
Parameter 40.009 AMC Home Maximum Allowed Move
Short description Defines the maximum distance the slave is allowed to move to complete the home
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

AMC Home Maximum Allowed Move (40.009) defines the maximum distance the slave is allowed to move to complete the home sequence. The slave position is stored at the start
of the homing sequence. If the distance moved from this initial position up to the point where the home position has been detected (at the end of Phase 1 if Phase 2 is not being
used, or at the end of Phase 2) becomes greater than AMC Home Maximum Allowed Move (40.009) then AMC Reference Select (34.007) is set to 0 to abort the homing
sequence. If AMC Home Maximum Allowed Move (40.009) is set to zero then this feature is disabled and there is no limit on the possible movement.

Parameter 40.010 AMC Home Complete Window


Short description Defines the window allowed in detecting that the home offset position has been reached
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 1 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

AMC Home Complete Window (40.010) is used to define the window allowed in detecting that the AMC Home Offset Position (40.007) has been reached at the end of Phase 3 of
the homing sequence. Phase 3 is complete when |AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) - AMC Slave Position (33.004)| ≤ AMC Home Complete Window (40.010)

Parameter 40.011 AMC Home On Freeze


Short description Enables homing to a freeze input
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Read when homing is enabled
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

In Home Modes 2 to 8, if AMC Home On Freeze (40.011) = 1 then Phase 2 is used to detect the home position using the selected slave position freeze source. Otherwise the
home position detected from the "home switch" in Phase 1 and the homing sequence moves directly from Phase 1 to Phase 3. In Home Modes 0, 1 and 9 AMC Home On Freeze
(40.011) has no effect.

Parameter 40.012 AMC Home Switch


Short description Set to 1 to activate the home switch
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

AMC Home Switch (40.012) can be used as a home switch input. AMC Home Mode (40.002) describes how this is used in different homing modes.

Parameter 40.013 AMC Home Positive Limit


Short description Set to 1 to activate the positive limit
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

AMC Home Positive Limit (40.013) can be used as a home switch or a limit switch. AMC Home Mode (40.002) describes how this is used in different homing modes.

Parameter 40.014 AMC Home Negative Limit


Short description Set to 1 to activate the negative limit
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

AMC Home Negative Limit (40.014) can be used as a home switch or a limit switch. AMC Home Mode (40.002) describes how this is used in different homing modes.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


504 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 40.015 AMC Home Positive Limit Selector
Short description Selects the source of the positive limit
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If AMC Home Positive Limit Selector (40.015) = 0 then AMC Home Positive Limit (40.013) is writable. If AMC Home Positive Limit Selector (40.015) = 1 then


AMC Home Positive Limit (40.013) is defined by the output of the hard stop detector.

Parameter 40.016 AMC Home Negative Limit Selector


Short description Selects the source of the negative limit
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If AMC Home Negative Limit Selector (40.016) = 0 then AMC Home Negative Limit (40.014) is writable. If AMC Home Negative Limit Selector (40.016) = 1 then


AMC Home Negative Limit (40.014) is defined by the output of the hard stop detector.

Parameter 40.017 AMC Home Torque Limit Active


Short description Indicates that the homing torque limit has been reached
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

The positive output of the hard stop detector can be selected instead of AMC Home Positive Limit (40.013) and the negative output instead of AMC Home Negative Limit (40.014).
This detector is intended to indicate when the system has reached a mechanical end stop and is trying to move against it, producing more than a specific level of torque in rotary
system (or force in a linear system). When Final Torque Reference (04.003) is greater or equal to AMC Home Hard Stop Torque Threshold (40.018) it is assumed that the system
is trying to travel forwards and has hit the positive end of the system. AMC Home Hard Stop Torque Threshold (40.018) should be set to a level higher than the torque seen in
normal operation so that the detector only becomes acitve when the system is at a mechanical stop. A time delay is provided that is reset to zero each time the torque reference is
below the threshold and counts up when it is above the threshold, so that the limit condition must exist for the delay time before the positive home limit becomes active. A similar
detector is provided to indicate when the system is at its negative mechanical limit. AMC Home Torque Limit Active (40.017) indicates if either limit is active without the time delay.
The hard stop detector operates whether a home sequence is active or not.

Parameter 40.018 AMC Home Hard Stop Torque Threshold


Short description Defines the homing hard stop torque threshold
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.0 Maximum 1000.0
Default 0.0 Units %
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 1
Coding RW

See AMC Home Torque Limit Active (40.017).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 505
Parameter 40.019 AMC Home Hard Stop Delay Time
Short description Defines the homing hard stop delay time
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.000 Maximum 60.000
Default 0.000 Units s
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 3
Coding RW, BU

See AMC Home Torque Limit Active (40.017).

Parameter 40.020 AMC Home Required


Short description Enables the home required before motion function
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

AMC Home Required (40.020) can be used to enable the "home before motion" function which ensures that the system is homed before any motion other than the homing
sequence is allowed. If AMC Home Required (40.020) = 0 then the "home before motion" function is disabled, and AMC Home Required Flag (41.017) and bit 14 of AMC Status
(41.002) are held at zero.

If AMC Home Required (40.020) = 1 then the "home before motion" function is enabled. AMC Home Slave Source (40.021) indicates the source of the slave position that was
used when the last homing sequence was completed successfully. If this is not the same as the currently selected slave source (i.e. AMC Home Slave Source (40.021) is not
equal to AMC Slave Source Select (33.001)) then AMC Home Required Flag (41.017) and bit 14 of AMC Status (41.002) are set to one, and it is not possible to produce any
movement unless AMC Reference Select (34.007) is used to select a homing sequence. At the end of a successful homing sequence the value of AMC Home Slave Source
(40.021) is automatically made equal to AMC Slave Source Select (33.001), which sets AMC Home Required Flag (41.017) and bit 14 of AMC Status (41.002) to zero and enables
all the motion references to be used. If an absolute position feedback device is providing the slave position and therefore absolute mode is selected (AMC Absolute Mode Enable
(31.002) = 1) then it is not necessary to repeat the homing sequence each time the drive is power cycled. In addition to AMC Home Slave Source (40.021), indicating the slave
source used during homing, AMC Slave Offset (33.003) is updated to make the slave position correspond to AMC Home Position (40.004) at the physical point where the home
switch transition was detected. To make the results of the home sequence valid after subsequent power cycling AMC Home Slave Source (40.021) and AMC Slave Offset
(33.003) must be saved. To achieve this AMC Home Slave Source (40.021) is a power-down save parameter, and AMC Slave Offset (33.003) is automatically saved at the end of
a successful homing sequence if absolute mode is selected (AMC Absolute Mode Enable (31.002) = 1). The drive must also ensure that when "home before motion" is enabled
that a homing sequence is carried out when necessary. To achieve this AMC Home Slave Source (40.021) is reset to -1 (None), which does not correspond with any valid slave
source, under various conditions. The table below gives all the conditions and actions used to make the "home before motion" system operate correctly.

Condition Action Comments


If the AMC is deselected then AMC Home Slave Source (40.021) is made equal to -
AMC Select (31.001) = 0 AMC Home Slave Source (40.021) = -1 (None) 1 so that if the AMC is subsequently selected homing is required if "home before
motion" is selected.
The AMC is operating in incremental mode. Homing is required on leaving the AMC
*AMC Disabled AND Disabled condition. This is not strictly necessary if
AMC Absolute Mode Enable AMC Home Slave Source (40.021) = -1 (None) AMC Incremental Position Reset Mode (31.003) = 1 except after power-up or if the
(31.002) = 0 position feedback becomes uninitialised, but the reset condition is chosen to keep
the system as simple as possible.

AMC Home Slave Source (40.021) = If an absolute encoder is used the home position will still be valid even after drive
AMC Slave Source Select (33.001) power cycling. AMC Home Slave Source (40.021) is a power-down save parameter,
A homing sequence is and so it will be valid after power-cycling. AMC Slave Offset (33.003) is only a user-
completed successfully and AMC Slave Offset (33.003) is modified so that the slave save parameter, and hence why it is saved after the homing is complete.
AMC Home Required position is equal to AMC Home Position (40.004) at the
(40.020) = 1 physical position where the home event was detected and If "home before motion" is not selected (i.e. AMC Home Required (40.020) = 0)
AMC Slave Offset (33.003) is saved if then AMC Home Slave Source (40.021) is left at the value of -1 (set when homing
AMC Absolute Mode Enable (31.002) = 1. begins, see condition below) and AMC Slave Offset (33.003) is not saved.

A homing sequence is If a homing sequence is started, but does not complete successfully
started by setting AMC Home Slave Source (40.021) will be left at -1. This means that if "home before
AMC Home Slave Source (40.021) = -1 (None)
AMC Reference Select motion" is enabled, or is subsequently enabled, homing will be required again
(34.007) to 5 before any other motion is possible.

*The "AMC Disabled" condition is true when AMC Select (31.001) = 1 AND ( AMC Enable (41.001) = 0 OR Reference On (01.011) = 0 OR AMC Position Feedback Initialised Flag
(41.018) = 0).

Note that power-down save parameters are saved when the 24V control supply is removed from Digitax HD products, and so AMC Home Slave Source (40.021) is always saved
when the power is removed. With all other products power-down save parameters are only saved when the power is removed if User Supply Select (06.072) = 0 AND
Low Under Voltage Threshold Select (06.067) = 0 AND Backup Supply Mode Enable (06.068) = 0. If these conditions are not met then the user should save parameters at the
appropriate time to store AMC Home Slave Source (40.021).

Note that setting AMC Home Required (40.020) = 0 does not reset AMC Home Slave Source (40.021) = -1 (None), and so it is possible to temporarily disable the "home before
motion" function to move the system and then enable it again without forcing the system to be homed again.

Parameter 40.021 AMC Home Slave Source


Indicates the source of the slave position that was used when the last homing sequence was completed
Short description
successfully and home required before motion is enabled
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum -1 Maximum 9
Default -1 Units
Type 8 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


506 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Value Text
-1 None
0 User Position
1 Sensorless
2 P1 Drive
3 P2 Drive
4 P1 Slot1
5 P2 Slot1
6 P1 Slot2
7 P2 Slot2
8 P1 Slot3
9 P2 Slot3

See AMC Home Required (40.020).

Parameter 40.022 AMC Home Mode Setup


Short description Defines the homing sequence when homing mode 9 is selected
Mode RFC‑A
0 32767
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 000000000000000) (Display: 111111111111111)
0
Default Units
(Display: 000000000000000)
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC, BU

When AMC Home Mode (40.002) is set to mode 9 the bits in AMC Home Mode Setup (40.022) are used to set up different parts of the homing sequence. The table below shows
the purpose of each bit and then a more detailed description is given below the table.

Bits Function
0 Home direct
1 Do not update the home position
2 Direction off high home switch
3 Direction off low home switch
4-5 Home switch selector
6 Positive limit enabled
7 Negative limit enabled
8-9 Home transition
10 Home switch side
11 Home on edge in either direction
12 Home on freeze
13-14 Direction in Phase 2.

b0: Home direct


If this bit is one it overrides all other bits except for bit 1 and causes the homing sequence to terminate immediately after it is started with no movement and sets AMC Slave Offset
(33.003) = AMC Home Position (40.004) - AMC Slave Position (33.004). This has the effect of setting the home position at the present physical position of the system and leaving
the system at the home position without any movement. If this bit is zero it has no effect.

b1: Do not update the home position


If this bit is one then the required homing sequence is completed as normal except that AMC Slave Offset (33.003) and the input/output of the profile are not modified when the
home position is detected. This has the effect of causing all the movement of the homing sequence in Phase 1 and/or Phase 2 as applicable, and then during Phase 3
the AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) is left at the value it had when the previous phase was completed. Therefore during Phase 3 the system simply moves to this position.

b2: Direction off high home switch


b3: Direction off low home switch
These bits define the required direction of movement off the home switch during Phase 1. "b2 Direction of high home switch" defines the direction when the selected "home
switch" is active where 0 is forwards and 1 is backwards, and "b3 Direction off low home switch" defines the direction when the selected "home switch" is inactive. It should be
noted that if either the positive limit or negative limit is enabled, and becomes active and latched then the direction defined by the latch limit will override the direction defined by
the home switch. This is shown in the example below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 507
The table below shows how the positive and negative limits are latched.

AMC Home Positive Limit (40.013) AMC Home Negative Limit (40.014) Action
0 0 No change to latched limits
0 1 Negative limit latched
1 0 Positive limit latched
1 1 Both latched

b4-5: Home switch selector


The table below shows the "home switch" selected by these bits. If AMC Slave Freeze Flag (33.010) is selected then the homing sequence omits Phase 1 and starts in Phase 2.

b5 b4 "Home switch"
0 0 AMC Home Switch (40.012)
0 1 AMC Home Positive Limit (40.013)
1 0 AMC Home Negative Limit (40.014)
1 1 AMC Slave Freeze Flag (33.010)

b6: Positive limit enabled


If this bit is zero the positive limit is disabled, and if this limit becomes active AMC Reference Select (34.007) is set to zero to terminate the homing sequence. If this bit is one the
positive limit is enabled and will cause the required movement to be backwards away from this limit as shown in the example for b2 and b3 above.

b7: Negative limit enabled


If this bit is zero the negative limit is disabled, and if this limit becomes active AMC Reference Select (34.007) is set to zero to terminate the homing sequence. If this bit is one the
negative limit is enabled and will cause the required movement to be forwards away from this limit.

b8-9: Home transition


b10: Home switch side
b11: Home on edge in either direction
b8-9 define the required home transition as follows:

b9 b8 Home switch transition


0 0 High state
0 1 Low state
1 0 Rising edge
1 1 Falling edge

b10 defines the home switch side as 0 = positive side and 1 = negative side. The positive side is the edge nearest to the positive end of the system.

Bits b8 to b11 combine to define the "home detection direction" and the transitions required to detect the home switch to end Phase 1 of the homing sequence. First the "home
detection direction" is defined as follows:

1. If "b11 Home on edge in either direction" is one then the "home detection direction" is the same as "b3 Direction off low home switch".
2. If the "home switch transition" is either high state or low state then the "home detection direction" is the same as "b3 Direction off low home switch".
3. Otherwise the "home detection direction" is given in the table below. The "home detection direction" and the home transition will then automatically select the required side
of the home switch.

b8-9 Home transition b10 Home switch side "Home detection direction"
Rising edge Negative Forwards
Falling edge Negative Backwards
Rising edge Positive Backwards
Falling edge Positive Forwards

Next the transitions that can be used to detect the required home switch edge has been passed or the required static state has been detected are defined.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


508 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
b8-9 Home "Home detection State/Transition in the forward State/Transition in the backwards
transition direction" direction direction
High state Don't care High state High state
Low state Don't care Low state Low state
Rising edge Forwards Rising edge Falling edge
Rising edge Backwards Falling edge Rising edge
Falling edge Forwards Falling edge Rising edge
Falling edge Backwards Rising edge Falling edge

If "b11 Home on edge in either direction" = 1 or the "home switch transition" is either high state or low state then if either the state/transition for the forward or backwards direction
are detected in the appropriate direction Phase 1 is complete and the "home switch" has been located. This means that the required state has occurred, or if a transition is
required the correct edge has been passed in either direction.

Otherwise if "b11 Home on edge in either direction" = 0 and a transition is required it is necessary to pass the home switch in the correct direction. This means that the home
switch will always be approached in the same direction when Phase 1 is completed which can give more consistent results. The transition is detected in either direction as the
required transition for both forwards and backwards is specified, but if the direction is opposite to the "home detection direction" the required movement is reversed so that the
home switch edge will be passed again in the opposite direction to complete Phase 1.

b12: Home on freeze


AMC Home On Freeze (40.011) has no effect when Home Mode 9 is selected, but is replaced by this bit. If this bit is one Phase 2 is included, otherwise the homing sequence
changes directly to Phase 3 at the end of Phase 1.

b13-14: Direction in Phase 2


The direction of movement during Phase 2 is given in the table below.

b14 b13 Direction in Phase 2


0 0 "home detection direction" defined by bits 8 to 11
0 1 Forwards
1 0 Backwards
1 1 Defined by AMC Home Direction (40.001)

Parameter 40.023 AMC Home Restart


Short description Set to 1 to restart the homing sequence
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

A homing sequence can be aborted and restarted by changing AMC Reference Select (34.007) from 5 (Homing) to another value and back again to 5. This can also be achieved
by setting AMC Home Restart (40.023) to one. This parameter is automatically reset to zero and the homing sequence restarted from the beginning of the sequence. Any
information obtained during the previous home sequence will be ignored.

Parameter 40.024 AMC Homing Sequence State


Short description Shows the current state of the homing sequence.
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text
0 Not Active
1 Home Switch
2 Home Switch Rev
3 Freeze
4 Offset

AMC Homing Sequence State (40.024) gives the state of the homing sequence.

State Description
Not Active (0) The homing system is not active.
Home Switch (1) Phase 1 is active and the system is searching for the required "home switch" transition under speed control.
Phase 1 is active and a "home switch" transition has occurred, but the transition was in the wrong direction, and so
Home Switch the system has reversed to cross the "home switch" edge in the other direction. This can only occur if
Reverse (2) AMC Home Mode (40.002) = 9 and the "Home on edge in either direction" bit in AMC Home Mode Setup (40.022) is
not set.
Freeze (3) Phase 2 is active and the system is searching for a freeze event under speed control.
Phase 3 is active and the system is under position control and moving from the home position to the required home
Offset (4)
offset position.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 509
Menu 41 Single Line Descriptions − AMC Control and Status
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


41.001 AMC Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
41.002 AMC Status 0000000000000000 to 1111111111111111 0000000000000000 RO Bin NC
41.003 AMC Movement Complete Window 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR UU 256 UU RW Num US
41.004 AMC Movement Complete Flag Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
41.005 AMC Profile Complete Window 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR UU 256 UU RW Num US
41.006 AMC Profile Complete Flag Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
41.007 AMC Following Error Window 0 to VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR UU 256 UU RW Num US
41.008 AMC Following Error Flag Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MIN] to
41.009 AMC At Speed Window 10.92 UU/ms RW Num US
VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MAX] UU/ms
41.010 AMC At Speed Flag Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
41.011 AMC Master Speed Too High Flag Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
41.012 AMC Following Error Stop Flag Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
41.013 AMC Positive Hardware Limit Flag Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
41.014 AMC Negative Hardware Limit Flag Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
41.015 AMC Positive Software Limit Flag Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
41.016 AMC Negative Software Limit Flag Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
41.017 AMC Home Required Flag Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
41.018 AMC Position Feedback Initialised Flag Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
41.019 AMC Control Word 0000000000000000 to 1111111111111111 0000000000000000 RW Bin NC
41.020 AMC Control Word Mask 0000000000000000 to 1111111111111111 1111111111111111 RW Bin US
41.021 AMC Control Word Enable 0 to 2 0 RW Num US
41.022 AMC Active Control Word 0000000000000000 to 1111111111111111 0000000000000000 RO Bin PT PS
41.023 AMC Hardware Limit Stop Mode Profile (0), No Profile (1) No Profile (1) RW Txt US
41.024 AMC Software Limit Stop Mode Profile (0), No Profile (1) Profile (0) RW Txt US
41.025 AMC Enable Software Limits Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] to
41.026 AMC Positive Software Limit Position 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] UU
VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] to
41.027 AMC Negative Software Limit Position 0 UU RW Num US
VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX] UU

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


510 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Menu 41 − AMC Control and Status
Mode: RFC‑A

Control and status

Parameter 41.001 AMC Enable


Short description Enables or disables the AMC
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate AMC sample rate read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

If AMC Enable (41.001), Reference On (01.011) or AMC Position Feedback Initialised Flag (41.018) = 0 the Advanced Motion Controller is held in the disabled state. The parameters given in the table below are held at the
values given while the motion controller is disabled.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 511
Parameter Value in disable state
AMC Stop Reference (34.002) AMC Slave Position (33.004)
AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) if AMC Reference Select (34.007) is 4 AMC Master Position (32.004) x Electronic gearbox ratio
AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) if AMC Reference Select (34.007) is not 4 AMC Slave Position (33.004)
AMC Profile Output Position (38.008) AMC Slave Position (33.004)

When the motion controller is disabled the electronic gearbox is held in the unlocked state and the cam system is held at its start position.

Parameter 41.002 AMC Status


Short description Shows the status of the AMC
Mode RFC‑A
0 65535
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0000000000000000) (Display: 1111111111111111)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0000000000000000)
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, NC, BU

AMC Status (41.002) gives the status of the motion controller with the bits shown in the table below.

Bit Status
0 AMC EGB Locked (37.006)
1 AMC Cam Complete (35.010)
2 AMC Movement Complete Flag (41.004)
3 AMC Profile Complete Flag (41.006)
4 AMC Following Error Flag  (41.008)
5 AMC At Speed Flag (41.010)
6 AMC Master Speed Too High Flag (41.011)
7 AMC Following Error Stop Flag (41.012)
8 AMC Home Complete (40.005)
9 AMC Home Offset Complete (40.008)
10 AMC Positive Hardware Limit Flag (41.013)
11 AMC Negative Hardware Limit Flag (41.014)
12 AMC Positive Software Limit Flag (41.015)
13 AMC Negative Software Limit Flag (41.016)
14 AMC Home Required Flag (41.017)
15 AMC Position Feedback Initialised Flag (41.018)

Parameter 41.003 AMC Movement Complete Window


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 256 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

AMC Movement Complete Flag (41.004) is set to 1 if |AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) - AMC Slave Position (33.004)| ≤ AMC Movement Complete Window (41.003).

Parameter 41.004 AMC Movement Complete Flag


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See AMC Movement Complete Window (41.003).

Parameter 41.005 AMC Profile Complete Window


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 256 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

AMC Profile Complete Flag (41.006) is set to 1 if |AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) - AMC Profile Output Position (38.008)| ≤ AMC Profile Complete Window (41.005). If AMC Profile Complete Window (41.005) is set to
zero when the s-ramp profile is enabled (AMC Profile Jerk 1 (38.011) > 0) then AMC Profile Complete Flag (41.006) is not set until AMC Profile Input Position (38.006) = AMC Profile Output Position (38.008) and the output of
the profile is at standstill, i.e. AMC Profile Output Speed (38.009) = 0 and AMC Profile Output Acceleration (38.010) = 0.

Parameter 41.006 AMC Profile Complete Flag


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See AMC Profile Complete Window (41.005).

Parameter 41.007 AMC Following Error Window


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 256 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

AMC Following Error Flag  (41.008) is set to 1 if AMC Profile Output Position (38.008) - AMC Slave Position (33.004)| > AMC Following Error Window (41.007).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


512 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 41.008 AMC Following Error Flag
Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See AMC Following Error Window (41.007).

Parameter 41.009 AMC At Speed Window


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0.00 Maximum VM_AMC_SPEED_UNIPOLAR[MAX]
Default 10.92 Units UU/ms
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RW, VM

*10rpm for a 16 bits per revolution device (user units ratio = 1)

AMC At Speed Flag (41.010) is set to 1 if AMC Profile Output Speed (38.009) - AMC Profile Input Speed (38.007)| ≤ AMC At Speed Window (41.009).

Parameter 41.010 AMC At Speed Flag


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See AMC At Speed Window (41.009).

Parameter 41.011 AMC Master Speed Too High Flag


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

AMC Master Speed Too High Flag (41.011) is set to 1 if |AMC Master Speed (32.005)| > AMC Profile Maximum Speed (38.003).

Parameter 41.012 AMC Following Error Stop Flag


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

AMC Following Error Stop Flag (41.012) is set to 1 when AMC Reference Select (34.007) is automatically changed to 0 because a following error stop mode has been selected (AMC Stop Mode (34.001) = 2 or 3)
and AMC Following Error Flag  (41.008) is set, i.e. the following error has exceeded AMC Following Error Window (41.007) during a motion sequence. AMC Following Error Stop Flag (41.012) is cleared when
AMC Reference Select (34.007) is changed.

Parameter 41.013 AMC Positive Hardware Limit Flag


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

The following diagram shows a typical configuration for the hardware and software limits.

The operating range of the Advanced Motion Controller is defined by the physical position of the hardware limit switches which are routed to Forward Limit Switch (06.035) and Reverse Limit Switch (06.036). If digital input 4 or
5 are routed to Forward Limit Switch (06.035) or Reverse Limit Switch (06.036) the maximum delay between a limit switch being reached and the motion controller taking action is 4.35ms. The software limits are configured
using AMC Positive Software Limit Position (41.026) and AMC Negative Software Limit Position (41.027) and these limits are active when AMC Enable Software Limits (41.025) = 1. The software position limits can be used to
define a working range which will normally be within the operating range defined by the hardware limits. Unlike the operating range the working range is flexible and can be configured for an individual motion sequence. The

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 513
maximum delay for a software limit is 4ms. Note that the software limits are disabled when performing a homing routine (AMC Reference Select (34.007) = 7).

The logic diagram for the limit switches is shown below.

The hardware and software limits are active in the following conditions.

Limit switch 0 1
AMC Positive Hardware Limit Flag
Forward Limit Switch (06.035) = 0 Forward Limit Switch (06.035) = 1
(41.013)
AMC Negative Hardware Limit Flag
Reverse Limit Switch (06.036) = 0 Reverse Limit Switch (06.036) = 1
(41.014)
AMC Positive Software Limit Flag AMC Enable Software Limits (41.025) = 0 or AMC Slave Position (33.004) < (AMC Positive Software Limit Position AMC Slave Position (33.004) >=
(41.015) (41.026) + Hysteresis) AMC Positive Software Limit Position (41.026)
AMC Negative Software Limit Flag AMC Enable Software Limits (41.025) = 0 or AMC Slave Position (33.004) > (AMC Negative Software Limit Position AMC Slave Position (33.004) <=
(41.016) (41.027) + Hysteresis) AMC Negative Software Limit Position (41.027)

Note: When a software limit is active a hysteresis is applied to prevent the limit being disabled until the slave has moved away from the limit. This is required to prevent a small change of slave position from reactivating the limit
when the slave is close to the position limit. The hysteresis applied is 4 x AMC Slave User Units Ratio Numerator (31.006) / AMC Slave User Units Ratio Denominator (31.007).

When a positive or negative limit is reached (positive transition of limit flag) AMC Stop Reference (34.002) is updated with the stop position and AMC Reference Select (34.007) is set to the stop reference. The stop mode used
by the profile when a limit is reached is selected by AMC Hardware Limit Stop Mode (41.023) and AMC Software Limit Stop Mode (41.024). If AMC Hardware Limit Stop Mode (41.023) or AMC Software Limit Stop Mode
(41.024) = 0 (profile) AMC Stop Reference (34.002) is set to AMC Profile Output Position (38.008) + stop position delta (position taken to reduce AMC Profile Output Speed (38.009) to zero under the constraints of the profile
generator). Note that the target position for the slave will include AMC Position Error (39.008). When AMC Hardware Limit Stop Mode (41.023) or AMC Software Limit Stop Mode (41.024) = 1 (no profile) AMC Stop Reference
(34.002) is set to AMC Slave Position (33.004) bringing the slave to a hard stop. If a limit is reached during a profiled stop and the stop mode for this limit is set to no profile the no profile stop will take priority and override the
profile stop. When a limit is active the change of position applied to the input of the profile generator can only be in the direction that moves the slave away from the active limit. If a positive and negative limit are active no
movement will be allowed.

Parameter 41.014 AMC Negative Hardware Limit Flag


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See AMC Positive Hardware Limit Flag (41.013).

Parameter 41.015 AMC Positive Software Limit Flag


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See AMC Positive Hardware Limit Flag (41.013).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


514 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 41.016 AMC Negative Software Limit Flag
Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See AMC Positive Hardware Limit Flag (41.013).

Parameter 41.017 AMC Home Required Flag


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms Write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

AMC Home Required Flag (41.017) is set to 1 if AMC Home Required (40.020) is enabled and AMC Home Slave Source (40.021) is not the same as AMC Slave Source Select (33.001).

Parameter 41.018 AMC Position Feedback Initialised Flag


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

AMC Position Feedback Initialised Flag (41.018) is set to 1 when the master and slave position accumulators have been initialised. The motion controller cannot enter the enabled state (see AMC Enable (41.001)) until this flag
is set. Note that the initialisation of the master and slave feedback cannot be completed until all of the position feedback devices connected to the drive (see Position Feedback Initialized (03.076)) have been initialised and
AMC Position Feedback Initialised Flag (41.018) is reset if any bit in Position Feedback Initialized (03.076) is cleared (e.g. Initialise Position Feedback (03.075) = 1).

Parameter 41.019 AMC Control Word


Short description Controls the AMC if the control word is enabled
Mode RFC‑A
0 65535
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0000000000000000) (Display: 1111111111111111)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0000000000000000)
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC, BU

When AMC Control Word Enable (41.021) = 0 the control word is disabled and AMC Control Word (41.019),  AMC Control Word Mask (41.020) and AMC Active Control Word (41.022) are not used by the motion
controller. If AMC Control Word Enable (41.021) = 1 the bits in AMC Control Word (41.019) can be used instead of the parameters listed in the table below. Note that in this mode AMC Active Control Word (41.022) is always
set to AMC Control Word (41.019) and bit 15 in the control word is ignored.

Bits Corresponding parameter or function


0 AMC Enable (41.001)
1 AMC Absolute Mode Enable (31.002)
2 AMC Incremental Position Reset Mode (31.003)
3 AMC Home Switch (40.012)
4 AMC Home Positive Limit (40.013)
5 AMC Home Negative Limit (40.014)
6 AMC Master Invert (32.002)
7 AMC Slave Invert (33.002)
8 AMC Output Invert (39.013)
9 AMC EGB Enable Rigid Lock (37.001)
10 AMC Speed Mode Enable (31.014)
11 AMC Enable Software Limits (41.025)
12 AMC Auto Resolution Enable (31.015)
13 AMC Home Required (40.020)
14 Not used
15 Control word valid

Note that bits 4 and 5 are only used when the corresponding selector (AMC Home Positive Limit Selector (40.015) or AMC Home Negative Limit Selector (40.016)) is set to zero.

Each bit in the control word can be enabled or disabled independently by selecting or deselecting the corresponding bits in  AMC Control Word Mask (41.020). None of the parameters in the table above have any effect when
the control word is enabled unless the corresponding bit in the control word is disabled by the mask.

When AMC Control Word Enable (41.021) = 2 and a valid control word is written to AMC Control Word (41.019) (bit 15 = 1) the control word is copied to AMC Active Control Word (41.022) and the motion controller uses the
control word to control the motion. If the control word is invalid (bit 15 = 0) the motion controller will continue to use the control word in AMC Active Control Word (41.022) until another valid control word is written to
AMC Control Word (41.019). If the control word is being used to enable absolute mode then AMC Control Word Enable (41.021) should always be set to mode 2 otherwise the home position with rollover enabled will not be
correct when the drive is power cycled.

Parameter 41.020 AMC Control Word Mask


Short description Controls the active bits in the AMC control word
Mode RFC‑A
0 65535
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0000000000000000) (Display: 1111111111111111)
65535
Default Units
(Display: 1111111111111111)
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate 4ms read
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

See AMC Control Word (41.019).

Parameter 41.021 AMC Control Word Enable


Short description Set to 1 to enable the AMC control word
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See AMC Control Word (41.019).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 515
Parameter 41.022 AMC Active Control Word
Short description Control word used by the AMC
Mode RFC‑A
0 65535
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0000000000000000) (Display: 1111111111111111)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0000000000000000)
Type 16 Bit Power Down Save Update Rate 4ms write
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PT, BU

See AMC Control Word (41.019).

Parameter 41.023 AMC Hardware Limit Stop Mode


Short description Stop mode used when a hardware limit is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Profile
1 No Profile

See AMC Positive Hardware Limit Flag (41.013).

Parameter 41.024 AMC Software Limit Stop Mode


Short description Stop mode used when a software limit is active
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text
0 Profile
1 No Profile

See AMC Positive Hardware Limit Flag (41.013).

Parameter 41.025 AMC Enable Software Limits


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

See AMC Positive Hardware Limit Flag (41.013).

Parameter 41.026 AMC Positive Software Limit Position


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Positive Hardware Limit Flag (41.013).

Parameter 41.027 AMC Negative Software Limit Position


Short description
Mode RFC‑A
Minimum VM_AMC_POSITION[MIN] Maximum VM_AMC_POSITION[MAX]
Default 0 Units UU
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, VM

See AMC Positive Hardware Limit Flag (41.013).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


516 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Slot 4 Menu 0 Single Line Descriptions − Ethernet Setup
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


4.00.001 Module ID 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT
4.00.002 Software Version 0 to 99999999 RO Num ND NC PT
4.00.003 Hardware Version 0.00 to 99.99 RO Num ND NC PT
4.00.004 Serial Number LS 00000000 to 99999999 RO Num ND NC PT
4.00.005 Serial Number MS 0 to 99999999 RO Num ND NC PT
Bootldr ‑ Update (-2), Bootldr ‑ Idle (-1),
4.00.006 Status RO Txt ND NC PT
Initialising (0), OK (1), Config (2), Error (3)
4.00.007 Reset Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
4.00.008 Default Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
4.00.009 Active Alarm Bits 0000000000000000 to 1111111111111111 0000000000000000 RO Bin NC
4.00.010 Active IP Address 128.0.0.0 to 127.255.255.255 RO IP ND NC PT
4.00.011 Date Code 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT
4.00.012 Capability Mask 000000000000000 to 111111111111111 RO Bin ND NC PT

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 517
Slot 4 Menu 0 − Ethernet Setup
Mode: RFC‑A

Setup parameter information

Parameter 4.00.001 Module ID


Short description Module ID
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

The Module ID. Onboard Ethernet module = 430. SI-Ethernet = 433. RR-Ethernet = 437

Parameter 4.00.002 Software Version


Short description Software Version
Minimum 0 Maximum 99999999
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up
Display Format Version Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Module firmware version in ww.xx.yy.zz format

Parameter 4.00.003 Hardware Version


Short description Hardware Version
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 99.99
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Contains the module’s hardware version information in the format xx.yy.

Parameter 4.00.004 Serial Number LS


Short description Serial Number LS
0 99999999
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00000000) (Display: 99999999)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Lead Zero Pad Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

The module serial number is available as a pair of 32 bit values where Serial Number LS (MM.004) provides the least significant 8 decimal digits and
Serial Number MS (MM.005) provides the most significant 8 decimal digits. The reconstructed serial number is ((MM.005* 100000000) + MM.004). For
example serial number "0001234567898765" would be stored as MM.005 = 12345, MM.004 = 67898765.

Parameter 4.00.005 Serial Number MS


Short description Serial Number MS
Minimum 0 Maximum 99999999
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

See Serial Number LS (MM.004).

Parameter 4.00.006 Status


Short description Status
Minimum -2 Maximum 3
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


518 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Value Text Description
-2 Bootldr - Update The bootloader is performing a flash update
-1 Bootldr - Idle The bootloader is idle
0 Initialising Initialising
1 OK Module is initialised with no errors present
2 Config A configuration error has been detected
An error has occurred preventing the module from running
3 Error
correctly

Module Status, informs the user what state the module is in. The status is updated for bootloader state and application state.

Parameter 4.00.007 Reset


Short description Reset
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Read every 200ms, Written to 0 on
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate
module initialisation
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

When set the module performs a warm reset. When the reset has been performed and the module is performing its initialization routines the parameter
will be cleared to zero. Note: The drive, and any other modules fitted to the drive will not be affected by the reset.

Parameter 4.00.008 Default


Short description Default
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Read every 200ms, Written to 0 on
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate
module initialisation
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

If set to “ON” when the module is reset, this parameter will cause the option module to return to its "Out of Box configuration" any settings stored on the
module will be returned to their default values. This will include any Web page customisations, e-mail settings etc. Following the default the module will
set the parameter to "OFF" and the module will reset.

Take care using this parameter as any configuration information will be irretrievably lost!

Note: The password for the ‘root’ account is not reset back to default.

Parameter 4.00.009 Active Alarm Bits


Short description Current Active Alarm Bits
0 65535
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0000000000000000) (Display: 1111111111111111)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0000000000000000)
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, NC, BU

Bit Alarm

0 User Program
1 eCMP
2 Modbus
3 Ethernet/IP
4 Reserved
5 Filesystem
6 Too Hot

Parameter 4.00.010 Active IP Address


Short description Active IP address
-2147483648 2147483647
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 128.0.0.0) (Display: 127.255.255.255)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background
Display Format IP Address Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Modules active IP address.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 519
Parameter 4.00.011 Date Code
Short description Date when first firmware updated
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

Date Code (0000.011) is a two-digit number in the form yyww where yy is the year and ww the week number.

Parameter 4.00.012 Capability Mask


Short description Current Capability Value
0 32767
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 000000000000000) (Display: 111111111111111)
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up or reset
Display Format Binary Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

This is a read only value that shows the capability status of the PROFINET protocol; if the value of bit zero is 1 it indicates that the PROFINET protocol
is not available; a value of zero indicates that it is available. If the user attempts to switch to the PROFINET protocol when it is not available a TRIP will
be raised. This field is locked as it is determined at the point of manufacture.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


520 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Slot 4 Menu 2 Single Line Descriptions − Ethernet Configuration
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


Initialising (0), Links Down (1),
4.02.003 Network Status DHCP In Progress (2), No Address (3), RO Txt ND NC PT
Ready (4), Active (5), IP Addr Conflict (6)
4.02.004 Network Message Count 0 to 65535 Messages/s RO Num ND NC PT
4.02.005 DHCP Enable Off (0) or On (1) On (1) RW Bit US
4.02.006 IP Address 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 192.168.1.100 RW IP US
4.02.007 Subnet Mask 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 255.255.255.0 RW IP US
4.02.008 Default Gateway 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 192.168.1.254 RW IP US
4.02.009 Primary DNS 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 0.0.0.0 RW IP US
4.02.010 Secondary DNS 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 0.0.0.0 RW IP US
4.02.011 MAC Address 00:00:00:00:00:00 to FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF RO Mac ND NC PT
EtherNet/IP (1), ProfiNet (2),
4.02.018 Protocol Mode Select EtherNet/IP (1) RW Txt US
CIP Safety (3)
EtherNet/IP (1), ProfiNet (2),
4.02.019 Active Protocol Mode EtherNet/IP (1) RO Txt NC PT
CIP Safety (3)
None (0), Modbus TCP (1),
4.02.020 Priority Protocol None (0) RW Txt US
EtherNet/IP (2)
4.02.021 Web Server Enable Off (0) or On (1) On (1) RW Bit US
4.02.022 Web Server Port 0 to 65535 80 RW Num US
4.02.024 Ethernet MTU 158 to 1500 Bytes 1500 Bytes RW Num US
Switch (0), Gateway (1),
4.02.025 Gateway Mode Switch (0) RW Txt US
Strict Gateway (2)
4.02.030 VLAN Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
4.02.034 Drive compatibility mode Default (0), Unidrive SP (1) Default (0) RW Txt US
4.02.035 Non cyclic enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
4.02.036 Non cyclic base parameter 0 to 59999 0 RW Num US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 521
Slot 4 Menu 2 − Ethernet Configuration
Mode: RFC‑A

Note: The maximum Ethernet packet size is 400 bytes.

Parameter 4.02.003 Network Status


Short description Shows the module status
Minimum 0 Maximum 6
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Written every second
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

Value Text Description


0 Initialising The network interface is being initialised
No link connection has been detected on either of the Ethernet
1 Links Down
ports
The module is apptempting to obtain an IP address, subnet
2 DHCP In Progress mask, default gateway and DNS server addresses from a
DHCP server
The module does not have an IP address - either the user has
3 No Address not provided one manually or one could not be allocated via
DHCP
The network interface has been successfully configured but no
4 Ready
data is being received or transmitted
5 Active The network interface is receiving or transmitting data
6 IP Addr Conflict Duplicate IP address detected on network

This parameter indicates the status of the network that the module is connected to.

Parameter 4.02.004 Network Message Count


Short description Shows the number of messages per second
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units Messages/s
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Written every second
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

The number of frames that the module is transmitting / receiving every second.

Parameter 4.02.005 DHCP Enable


Short description Set to enable DHCP
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Controls whether or not the module will attempt to use a Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) server to obtain an IP address, subnet mask,
default gateway and DNS servers.

When DHCP is enabled, the following parameters will become read-only immediately (no reset required):

IP Address (4.02.006)

Subnet Mask (4.02.007)

Default Gateway (4.02.008)

Primary DNS (4.02.009)

Secondary DNS (4.02.010)

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


522 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.02.006 IP Address
Short description Sets and/or shows the IP address of the module
0 4294967295
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0.0.0.0) (Display: 255.255.255.255)
3232235876
Default Units
(Display: 192.168.1.100)
DHCP enabled : write on event; DHCP
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
disabled : read on reset
Display Format IP Address Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Controls and displays the IP address of the module.

If DHCP is enabled ( DHCP Enable (4.02.005) ) this parameter becomes read-only and, until an IP address is allocated to the module, will display
0.0.0.0.

If DHCP is disabled the module will initialise, on reset or power cycle, with the default IP address of 192.168.1.100 which can be updated and then
saved.

Parameter 4.02.007 Subnet Mask


Short description Sets and/or shows the subnet mask of the module
0 4294967295
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0.0.0.0) (Display: 255.255.255.255)
4294967040
Default Units
(Display: 255.255.255.0)
DHCP enabled : write on event; DHCP
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
disabled : read on reset
Display Format IP Address Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Controls and displays the subnet mask of the module.

If DHCP is enabled ( DHCP Enable (4.02.005) ) this parameter becomes read-only and, until a subnet mask is allocated to the module, will display
0.0.0.0.

If DHCP is disabled the module will initialise, on reset or power cycle, with the default subnet of 255.255.255.0 which can be updated and then saved.

Parameter 4.02.008 Default Gateway


Short description Sets and/or shows the default gateway of the module
0 4294967295
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0.0.0.0) (Display: 255.255.255.255)
3232236030
Default Units
(Display: 192.168.1.254)
DHCP enabled : write on event; DHCP
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
disabled : read on reset
Display Format IP Address Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Controls and displays the default gateway of the module.

If DHCP is enabled ( DHCP Enable (4.02.005) ) this parameter becomes read-only and, until a default gateway is allocated to the module, will display
0.0.0.0.

If DHCP is disabled the module will initialise, on reset or power cycle, , with the default Gateway of 192.168.1.254 which can be updated and then
saved.

Parameter 4.02.009 Primary DNS


Short description Sets and/or shows the primary DNS address of the module
0 4294967295
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0.0.0.0) (Display: 255.255.255.255)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0.0.0.0)
DHCP enabled : write on event; DHCP
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
disabled : read on reset
Display Format IP Address Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

The module can use this IP address when it wishes to resolve the IP address for a domain name. This parameter performs the same function as the
Secondary DNS parameter Secondary DNS (4.02.010) , however the address specified in this parameter will be tried first. Only when this address is
unsuccessful will the Secondary DNS address be tried.

If DHCP is enabled ( DHCP Enable (4.02.005) ) this parameter becomes read-only and, until a primary DNS address is allocated to the module, will
display 0.0.0.0.

If DHCP is disabled the module will initialise, on reset or power cycle, with the primary DNS address stored for the parameter.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 523
Parameter 4.02.010 Secondary DNS
Short description Sets and/or shows the secondary DNS address of the module
0 4294967295
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0.0.0.0) (Display: 255.255.255.255)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0.0.0.0)
DHCP enabled : write on event; DHCP
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
disabled : read on reset
Display Format IP Address Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

The module can use this IP address when it wishes to resolve the IP address for a domain name. This parameter performs the same function as the
Primary DNS parameter Primary DNS (4.02.009) , however the address specified in this parameter will be tried only when the Primary DNS address is
unsuccessful.

If DHCP is enabled ( DHCP Enable (4.02.005) ) this parameter becomes read-only and, until a secondary DNS address is allocated to the module, will
display 0.0.0.0.

If DHCP is disabled the module will initialise, on reset or power cycle, with the secondary DNS address stored for the parameter.

Parameter 4.02.011 MAC Address


Short description Shows the MAC address of the module
0 281474976710655
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00:00:00:00) (Display: FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF)
Default Units
Type 64 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up write
Display Format MAC Address Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

The 48-bit MAC address of the module.

Parameter 4.02.018 Protocol Mode Select


Short description Protocol Mode Select
Minimum 1 Maximum 3
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Specifies the interface type of the option module. By default "EtherNet/IP" is selected. After selecting appropriate interface, user has to save the
parameter, and then do the option reset.

Value Text Description


1 EtherNet/IP EtherNet/IP interface selected
2 ProfiNet Profinet interface selected
3 CIP Safety CIP Safety interface for safety module

This parameter select one of three interfaces i.e. EtherNet/IP, Profinet or CIP Safety.

By default EtherNet/IP is selected.

If Mode Select = 1, then EtherNet/IP will be selected

If Mode Select = 2, then Profinet will be selected

If Mode Select = 3 then CIP Safety will be selected

After selecting the appropriate interface, user has to save and reset the option module

Parameter 4.02.019 Active Protocol Mode


Short description Active Protocol Mode
Minimum 1 Maximum 3
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Power-up Or Reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, NC, PT, BU

Shows currently active selected mode

Value Text Description


1 EtherNet/IP EtherNet/IP active interface
2 ProfiNet Profinet active interface
3 CIP Safety CIP Safety interface for safety module

Shows, currently active protocol. By default Ethernet/IP will be enabled


Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide
524 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.02.020 Priority Protocol
Short description Sets the Priority Protocol
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Selection of the fieldbus protocol to have priority over all other protocols.

Value Text Description


0 None All protocols have equal priority
1 Modbus TCP Modbus TCP has highest priority
2 EtherNet/IP EtherNet/IP has highest priority

Enables selection of one fieldbus protocol to have priority over others. A tick period of 1 ms will be given to the highest priority fieldbus protocol, 5 ms to
all other fieldbus protocols (equal priority).

If no fieldbus protocol has been selected to have priority over others all protocols will have equal priority and a tick rate of 5 ms.

Parameter 4.02.021 Web Server Enable


Short description Enables the Web Server
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Controls the running of the webserver on the module.

Parameter 4.02.022 Web Server Port


Short description Specifies the web server port
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default 80 Units
Read on module reset and
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate
HTTP_ENABLE
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

The web server port. This may be changed for added security.

Parameter 4.02.024 Ethernet MTU


Short description Specifies the MTU for the Ethernet interface
Minimum 158 Maximum 1500
Default 1500 Units Bytes
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on module reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter sets the maximum Ethernet packet size (MTU). This is expressed as the size of IP payload as opposed to EThernet frame size.

Parameter 4.02.025 Gateway Mode


Short description Specifies the operation mode of the gateway
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on module reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text
0 Switch
1 Gateway
2 Strict Gateway

Specifies the operation mode of the gateway. By default the gateway is disabled and the switch operates in normal switch mode, by enabling the
gateway mode all packets are filtered by the module and prioritised before being forwarded on. In strict mode the gateway will drop packets from
unsupported protocols.

VLAN must be enabled VLAN Enable (4.02.030) when the gateway is enabled.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 525
Parameter 4.02.030 VLAN Enable
Short description Enables VLAN tagging
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on module reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Controls whether the module will use VLAN tagging.

When used in conjunction with Drive VLAN ID (4.02.031) network traffic from the interface will be tagged with the chosen VLAN identifier.

When default values for Drive VLAN ID (4.02.031) is set, enabling this parameter will add VLAN prioritisation to all packets helping to ensure real-time
packets are not delayed by those of lower priority. If disabled, prioritisation will use the Diffserv field in IP traffic only, meaning non-IP traffic can still
affect real-time IP traffic.

Parameter 4.02.034 Drive compatibility mode


Short description Specifies the mimic of the drive from a PLC for EthernetIP and Modbus
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on module reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Defines the parameter conversion for EthernetIP and Modbus.

Value Text
0 Default
1 Unidrive SP

This parameter defines the conversion rules for parameter values coming via EthernetIP or Modbus.
This gives customers a way to mimic other drives from the point of view of PLC.

Parameter 4.02.035 Non cyclic enable


Short description Specify non cyclic enable
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Enable the Non cyclic data transfer.

Parameter 4.02.036 Non cyclic base parameter


Short description Specify the base parameter of the user program non cyclic handling
Minimum 0 Maximum 59999
Default 0 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Background
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

The value in this parameter points to the base address of a group of parameters which used for handling non cyclic data by user programs.

Suppose the base address is S.MM.PPP, the following are the functions of the group of the parameters. Please note that these parameters should be at
least 16 bits in size.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


526 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter S.MM.PPP

Description Command and Status

Identifier

Mode(s)

Minimum 0 Maximum 0x0403

Default 0 Units

Type 16 bit user save Update rate

FL Floating point parameter 0 ND No default 0

DF Display format 0 RA Rating dependent 0

PR Pseudo read-only 0 NC Not clonable 1

FI Filtered 0 NV Not visible 0

DE Destination parameter 0 PT Protected 0

TE Text parameter 0 NR Not readable 0

VM Variable minimum/maximum 0 W Writable 1

UNIT 0 DP Decimal places 0 BU Default (1 bit types) / Unipolar (all other types): 1

The MSB is used for Status and the LSB is used for Command.

Possible values for the Command are:

Value Meaning Description

0 No Command No command or Abort during a command process

1 Check / Abort Check if the status idle or abort from read or write command.

2 Read Read one parameter

3 Write Write one parameter

Possible values for the Status are:

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 527
Value Meaning Description

0 IDLE Idle

1 READY The parameter channel is ready to take commands

2 PROCESSING Processing the command

3 OK The command processed successfully

4 ERROR Error is detected, detail will be found in the first parameter.

Parameter S.MM.PPP + 1

Description Destination IP Address www.xxx

Identifier

Mode(s)

Minimum 0 Maximum 0xFFFF

Default 0 Units

Type 16 Bit User Save Update rate

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


528 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
FL Floating point parameter 0 ND No default 0

DF Display format 0 RA Rating dependent 0

PR Pseudo read-only 0 NC Not clonable 0

FI Filtered 0 NV Not visible 0

DE Destination parameter 1 PT Protected 0

TE Text parameter 0 NR Not readable 0

VM Variable minimum/maximum 0 W Writable 1

UNIT 0 DP Decimal places 0 BU Default (1 bit types) / Unipolar (all other types): 1

The higher two sections for the destination IP address. 0xFF000000 (127.0.0.1) represents the current drive.

Parameter S.MM.PPP + 2

Description Destination IP Address yyy.zzz

Identifier

Mode(s)

Minimum 0 Maximum 0xFFFF

Default 0 Units

Type 16 Bit User Save Update rate

FL Floating point parameter 0 ND No default 0

DF Display format 0 RA Rating dependent 0

PR Pseudo read-only 0 NC Not clonable 0

FI Filtered 0 NV Not visible 0

DE Destination parameter 1 PT Protected 0

TE Text parameter 0 NR Not readable 0

VM Variable minimum/maximum 0 W Writable 1

UNIT 0 DP Decimal places 0 BU Default (1 bit types) / Unipolar (all other types): 1

The lower two sections for the destination IP address

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 529
Parameter S.MM.PPP + 3

Description Parameter Address SMM

Identifier

Mode(s)

Minimum 0 Maximum 499

Default 0 Units

Type 16 Bit User Save Update rate

FL Floating point parameter 0 ND No default 0

DF Display format 0 RA Rating dependent 0

PR Pseudo read-only 0 NC Not clonable 0

FI Filtered 0 NV Not visible 0

DE Destination parameter 0 PT Protected 0

TE Text parameter 0 NR Not readable 0

VM Variable minimum/maximum 0 W Writable 1

UNIT 0 DP Decimal places 0 BU Default (1 bit types) / Unipolar (all other types): 1

Destination parameter address – Slot and Menu sections.

Parameter S.MM.PPP + 4

Description Parameter Address PPP

Identifier

Mode(s)

Minimum 0 Maximum 999

Default 0 Units

Type 16 Bit User Save Update rate

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


530 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
FL Floating point parameter 0 ND No default 0

DF Display format 0 RA Rating dependent 0

PR Pseudo read-only 0 NC Not clonable 0

FI Filtered 0 NV Not visible 0

DE Destination parameter 0 PT Protected 0

TE Text parameter 0 NR Not readable 0

VM Variable minimum/maximum 0 W Writable 1

UNIT 0 DP Decimal places 0 BU Default (1 bit types) / Unipolar (all other types): 1

Destination parameter address - parameter section

Parameter S.MM.PPP + 5

Description Parameter Value LSW / Error Code

Identifier

Mode(s)

Minimum -215 Maximum 215-1

Default 0 Units

Type 16 Bit User Save Update rate

FL Floating point parameter 0 ND No default 0

DF Display format 4 RA Rating dependent 0

PR Pseudo read-only 0 NC Not clonable 0

FI Filtered 0 NV Not visible 0

DE Destination parameter 0 PT Protected 0

TE Text parameter 0 NR Not readable 0

VM Variable minimum/maximum 0 W Writable 1

UNIT 0 DP Decimal places 0 BU Default (1 bit types) / Unipolar (all other types): 0

It stores the least significant word of the value to be write in to the destination parameter if the command is Write (2)

It stores the least significant word of the value read from the destination parameter if the command is read and the status is Done.

It is the error code for the process if the status is Error.

The following table list the possible error codes:

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 531
Value Meaning Description

-1 Address Type The addressing type is not supported

-2 Timeout A timeout occurred trying to access the specified item

-3 Access Denied The requesting device does not have sufficient access rights

-4 Does not exist The specified item does not exist

-5 Data Type The data could not be converted from the specified type

-6 Failed Read The value could not be read, reason unknown

-7 Failed Write The value could not be written, reason unknown

-8 Not Readable The data could not be read as the source does not allow read access.

-9 Not Writeable The data could not be written as the destination does not allow write access.

-10 Over Range The specified value is outside the suitable range for the item.

-11 Request Invalid The request contained invalid information.

Response Too
-12 The response will not fit in the maximum response size.
Big

The decimal place information is invalid (i.e. out of range of allowed values for a
-13 Decimal Place
write).

-14 Invalid Param Invalid parameter in the parameter channel.

-15 Invalid CMD Invalid command

-16 Invalid IP Invalid IP address

-17 Unknown Error An unknown error happens

-18 to -
Reserved
128

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


532 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter S.MM.PPP + 6

Description Parameter Value MSW

Identifier

Mode(s)

Minimum -215 Maximum 215-1

Default 0 Units

Type 16 Bit User Save Update rate

FL Floating point parameter 0 ND No default 0

DF Display format 4 RA Rating dependent 0

PR Pseudo read-only 0 NC Not clonable 0

FI Filtered 0 NV Not visible 0

DE Destination parameter 0 PT Protected 0

TE Text parameter 0 NR Not readable 0

VM Variable minimum/maximum 0 W Writable 1

UNIT 0 DP Decimal places 0 BU Default (1 bit types) / Unipolar (all other types): 0

It stores the most significant word of the value to be write in to the destination parameter if the command is Write (2)

It stores the most significant word of the value read from the destination parameter if the command is read and the status is Done.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 533
Slot 4 Menu 9 Single Line Descriptions − Resources
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


4.09.001 Cyclic Tx links free 0 to 255 RO Num ND NC PT
4.09.002 Cyclic Rx links free 0 to 255 RO Num ND NC PT
4.09.003 Fieldbus Links Free 0 to 255 RO Num ND NC PT
4.09.004 Cyclic Mappings Free 0 to 255 RO Num ND NC PT
4.09.008 Background cycles per second 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT
4.09.010 Synchronous Task % Free 0 to 255 % RO Num ND NC PT
4.09.011 Nonsync link update period 0.00 to 655.35 RO Num ND NC PT
4.09.020 Synchronous Task Worst % Free 0 to 255 % RO Num ND NC PT
4.09.021 Max nonsync link update period 0.00 to 655.35 RO Num ND NC PT
4.09.030 PCB Temperature -128 to 127 °C RO Num ND NC PT

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


534 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Slot 4 Menu 9 − Resources
Mode: RFC‑A

Message Load

The Ethernet interface can accommodate multiple protocols running concurrently, each protocol demanding system resources. To ensure that the
interface is not overloaded the following limitations should be followed.

1. maximum number of parameter accesses per second is 6000 for Onboard Ethernet interface / 200 for option module Ethernet interface
2. maximum number of messages per second (02.004) is 8000

When checking that the message loading on a device is going to be acceptable, consider all protocols, e.g.:

Protocol Number of Parameters Rate Parameters Accesses / Second Message Rate / Second

Modbus TCP/IP 10 read 100 ms 100 10

EtherNet/IP 5 read 10 ms 500 100

5 write 10 ms 500 100

RTMoE 2 write 500 µs 4000 2000

Total 5100 2210

Max. supported by Onboard Ethernet interface 6000 8000

Within Capability? Yes Yes

Cyclic data, with the exception of synchronous cyclic data, is exchanged with the drive and other options in the interface's background
task. Background cycles per second (4.09.008) can be used to view the cycle rate of the background task. If the value drops to zero then a
BG Overrun drive trip will occur.

RTMoE

RTMoE is an industrial Ethernet protocol for both cyclic and acyclic communication. The Ethernet interface RTMoE capabilities can be found in the table
below.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 535
Capability Support Level

Non-cyclic communication Supported

Total transmit cyclic links 5

Total receive cyclic links 5

Max number of transmit synchronous cyclic links 1 (Onboard interface only)

Max number of receive synchronous cyclic links 1 (Onboard interface only)

Max length of non-synchronous cyclic link 10 x 32 bit

Max length of synchronous cyclic link 2 x 32 bit

Min transmission period 500 µs

Synchronized with AMC Yes (when cycle time >= 500us)

Synchronized with onboard program Yes (when cycle time = 4ms)

Parameter 4.09.001 Cyclic Tx links free


Short description Cyclic Tx links free
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

The number of available transmit cyclic links.

Parameter 4.09.002 Cyclic Rx links free


Short description Cyclic Rx links free
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

The number of available receive cyclic links.

Parameter 4.09.003 Fieldbus Links Free


Short description Available Tx/Rx process images
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

The number of available transmit / receive process images for fieldbus protocols such as Ethernet/IP.

Parameter 4.09.004 Cyclic Mappings Free


Short description Number of cyclic mapping free
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

The number of available mappings in the system for use in cyclic links.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


536 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.09.008 Background cycles per second
Short description Background task runs per seconds
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

The background task cycles per second represents the number of times per second the background task is currently executing. The background task is
responsible for cyclic data exchange with the drive. With more cyclic data mapped the cycle rate of the task will decrease.

Parameter 4.09.010 Synchronous Task % Free


Short description Synchronous Task % Free
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units %
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

Note: Synchronous Cyclic Links are supported by the Onboard Ethernet interface, but not on the option module interface.

Parameter 4.09.011 Nonsync link update period


Short description Nonsync link update period
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 655.35
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

The number of detected overruns per seconds for non-synchronous cyclic links.

Parameter 4.09.020 Synchronous Task Worst % Free


Short description Sync Task Worst % Free
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default Units %
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

Worst case free resource of the synchronous task.

Note: Synchronous Cyclic Links are supported by the Onboard Ethernet interface, but not on the option module interface.

Parameter 4.09.021 Max nonsync link update period


Short description Max nonsync link update period
Minimum 0.00 Maximum 655.35
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 2
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

The maximum detected overruns per seconds for non-synchronous cyclic links.

Parameter 4.09.030 PCB Temperature


Short description PCB Temperature
Minimum -128 Maximum 127
Default Units °C
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

Gives the current PCB temperature

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 537
Slot 4 Menu 10 Single Line Descriptions − RTMOE Easy Mode
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


538 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter Range Default Type
4.10.001 Enable Off (0) or On (1) On (1) RW Bit US
4.10.002 Reset Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
4.10.003 Default Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
4.10.004 Cyclic Messages Per Second 0 to 65535 Messages/s RO Num ND NC PT
4.10.005 Configuration Valid Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
4.10.006 Operational Off (0) or On (1) RO Bit ND NC PT
4.10.007 Active Configuration None (0), Easy Mode (1), Offline (2) RO Txt ND NC PT
4.10.008 Timeout Count 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT
4.10.009 Data Late Count 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT
4.10.010 Tx1 Link profile Std (0), Sync (1) Std (0) RW Txt US
4.10.011 Tx1 Link number 0 to 255 0 RW Num US
4.10.012 Tx1 Source parameter 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.10.013 Tx1 Parameter count 0 to 10 0 RW Num US
Unicast (0), Broadcast (1),
Multicast1 (2), Multicast2 (3),
Multicast3 (4), Multicast4 (5),
4.10.014 Tx1 Link transmission type Unicast (0) RW Txt US
Multicast5 (6), Multicast6 (7),
Multicast7 (8), Multicast8 (9),
Multicast9 (10), Multicast10 (11)
4.10.015 Tx1 Destination address 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 0.0.0.0 RW IP US
4.10.016 Tx1 Message Rate 0 to 100 ms 0 ms RW Num US
Disabled (-31), VLAN disabled (-30),
Reserved 29 (-29), Reserved 28 (-
28), Reserved 27 (-27),
Reserved 26 (-26), Reserved 25 (-
25), Reserved 24 (-24),
Reserved 23 (-23), Invalid DST IP (-
22), SYNC unsupported (-21),
MEC offset (-20), Invalid tx rate (-
19), Too many mapping (-18),
Link busy (-17), Invalid profile (-16),
4.10.019 Tx1 Link status Invalid mapping (-15), RO Txt ND NC PT
Read only param (-14),
Msg mismatch (-13), Msg too long (-
12), Attrib NA (-11), Attrib RO (-10),
Attrib missing (-9), Timeout (-8),
In error (-7), Link num in use (-6),
Not editable (-5), Invalid link num (-
4), Invalid args (-3),
Too many links (-2),
Out of memory (-1), OK (0),
Not running (1), OK sync (2)
4.10.020 Tx2 Link profile Std (0), Sync (1) Std (0) RW Txt US
4.10.021 Tx2 Link number 0 to 255 0 RW Num US
4.10.022 Tx2 Source parameter 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.10.023 Tx2 Parameter count 0 to 10 0 RW Num US
Unicast (0), Broadcast (1),
Multicast1 (2), Multicast2 (3),
Multicast3 (4), Multicast4 (5),
4.10.024 Tx2 Link transmission type Unicast (0) RW Txt US
Multicast5 (6), Multicast6 (7),
Multicast7 (8), Multicast8 (9),
Multicast9 (10), Multicast10 (11)
4.10.025 Tx2 Destination address 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 0.0.0.0 RW IP US
4.10.026 Tx2 Message Rate 0 to 100 ms 0 ms RW Num US
Disabled (-31), VLAN disabled (-30),
Reserved 29 (-29), Reserved 28 (-
28), Reserved 27 (-27),
Reserved 26 (-26), Reserved 25 (-
25), Reserved 24 (-24),
Reserved 23 (-23), Invalid DST IP (-
22), SYNC unsupported (-21),
MEC offset (-20), Invalid tx rate (-
19), Too many mapping (-18),
Link busy (-17), Invalid profile (-16),
4.10.029 Tx2 Link status Invalid mapping (-15), RO Txt ND NC PT
Read only param (-14),
Msg mismatch (-13), Msg too long (-
12), Attrib NA (-11), Attrib RO (-10),
Attrib missing (-9), Timeout (-8),
In error (-7), Link num in use (-6),
Not editable (-5), Invalid link num (-
4), Invalid args (-3),
Too many links (-2),
Out of memory (-1), OK (0),
Not running (1), OK sync (2)
4.10.030 Tx3 Link profile Std (0), Sync (1) Std (0) RW Txt US

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 539
4.10.031 Tx3 Link number 0 to 255 0 RW Num US
4.10.032 Tx3 Source parameter 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.10.033 Tx3 Parameter count 0 to 10 0 RW Num US
Unicast (0), Broadcast (1),
Multicast1 (2), Multicast2 (3),
Multicast3 (4), Multicast4 (5),
4.10.034 Tx3 Link transmission type Unicast (0) RW Txt US
Multicast5 (6), Multicast6 (7),
Multicast7 (8), Multicast8 (9),
Multicast9 (10), Multicast10 (11)
4.10.035 Tx3 Destination address 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 0.0.0.0 RW IP US
4.10.036 Tx3 Message Rate 0 to 100 ms 0 ms RW Num US
Disabled (-31), VLAN disabled (-30),
Reserved 29 (-29), Reserved 28 (-
28), Reserved 27 (-27),
Reserved 26 (-26), Reserved 25 (-
25), Reserved 24 (-24),
Reserved 23 (-23), Invalid DST IP (-
22), SYNC unsupported (-21),
MEC offset (-20), Invalid tx rate (-
19), Too many mapping (-18),
Link busy (-17), Invalid profile (-16),
4.10.039 Tx3 Link status Invalid mapping (-15), RO Txt ND NC PT
Read only param (-14),
Msg mismatch (-13), Msg too long (-
12), Attrib NA (-11), Attrib RO (-10),
Attrib missing (-9), Timeout (-8),
In error (-7), Link num in use (-6),
Not editable (-5), Invalid link num (-
4), Invalid args (-3),
Too many links (-2),
Out of memory (-1), OK (0),
Not running (1), OK sync (2)
4.10.040 Rx1 Link profile Std (0), Sync (1) Std (0) RW Txt US
4.10.041 Rx1 Link number 0 to 255 0 RW Num US
4.10.042 Rx1 Destination parameter 0 to 499999 0 RW Num US
4.10.043 Rx1 Parameter count 0 to 10 0 RW Num US
Direct (0), Multicast1 (1),
Multicast2 (2), Multicast3 (3),
Multicast4 (4), Local (5),
4.10.044 Rx1 Source type Direct (0) RW Txt US
Multicast5 (6), Multicast6 (7),
Multicast7 (8), Multicast8 (9),
Multicast9 (10), Multicast10 (11)
4.10.045 Rx1 Timeout 0 to 65535 ms 100 ms RW Num US
Trip (0), Clear output (1),
4.10.046 Rx1 Timeout action Trip (0) RW Txt US
Hold last (2)
This slot (0), Slot 1 (1), Slot 2 (2),
4.10.047 Rx1 Timeout event destination This slot (0) RW Txt US
Slot 3 (3), Slot 4 (4)
No Event (0), Event (1), Event1 (2),
4.10.048 Rx1 Timeout event type No Event (0) RW Txt US
Event2 (3), Event3 (4)
Disabled (-31), VLAN disabled (-30),
Reserved 29 (-29), Reserved 28 (-
28), Reserved 27 (-27),
Reserved 26 (-26), Reserved 25 (-
25), Reserved 24 (-24),
Reserved 23 (-23), Invalid DST IP (-
22), SYNC unsupported (-21),
MEC offset (-20), Invalid tx rate (-
19), Too many mapping (-18),
Link busy (-17), Invalid profile (-16),
4.10.049 Rx1 Link status Invalid mapping (-15), RO Txt ND NC PT
Read only param (-14),
Msg mismatch (-13), Msg too long (-
12), Attrib NA (-11), Attrib RO (-10),
Attrib missing (-9), Timeout (-8),
In error (-7), Link num in use (-6),
Not editable (-5), Invalid link num (-
4), Invalid args (-3),
Too many links (-2),
Out of memory (-1), OK (0),
Not running (1), OK sync (2)
4.10.050 Rx2 Link profile Std (0), Sync (1) Std (0) RW Txt US
4.10.051 Rx2 Link number 0 to 255 0 RW Num US
4.10.052 Rx2 Destination parameter 0 to 499999 0 RW Num US
4.10.053 Rx2 Parameter count 0 to 10 0 RW Num US
Direct (0), Multicast1 (1),
Multicast2 (2), Multicast3 (3),
Multicast4 (4), Local (5),
4.10.054 Rx2 Source type Direct (0) RW Txt US
Multicast5 (6), Multicast6 (7),
Multicast7 (8), Multicast8 (9),

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


540 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Multicast9 (10), Multicast10 (11)
4.10.055 Rx2 Timeout 0 to 65535 ms 100 ms RW Num US
Trip (0), Clear output (1),
4.10.056 Rx2 Timeout action Trip (0) RW Txt US
Hold last (2)
This slot (0), Slot 1 (1), Slot 2 (2),
4.10.057 Rx2 Timeout event destination This slot (0) RW Txt US
Slot 3 (3), Slot 4 (4)
No Event (0), Event (1), Event1 (2),
4.10.058 Rx2 Timeout event type No Event (0) RW Txt US
Event2 (3), Event3 (4)
Disabled (-31), VLAN disabled (-30),
Reserved 29 (-29), Reserved 28 (-
28), Reserved 27 (-27),
Reserved 26 (-26), Reserved 25 (-
25), Reserved 24 (-24),
Reserved 23 (-23), Invalid DST IP (-
22), SYNC unsupported (-21),
MEC offset (-20), Invalid tx rate (-
19), Too many mapping (-18),
Link busy (-17), Invalid profile (-16),
4.10.059 Rx2 Link status Invalid mapping (-15), RO Txt ND NC PT
Read only param (-14),
Msg mismatch (-13), Msg too long (-
12), Attrib NA (-11), Attrib RO (-10),
Attrib missing (-9), Timeout (-8),
In error (-7), Link num in use (-6),
Not editable (-5), Invalid link num (-
4), Invalid args (-3),
Too many links (-2),
Out of memory (-1), OK (0),
Not running (1), OK sync (2)
4.10.060 Rx3 Link profile Std (0), Sync (1) Std (0) RW Txt US
4.10.061 Rx3 Link number 0 to 255 0 RW Num US
4.10.062 Rx3 Destination parameter 0 to 499999 0 RW Num US
4.10.063 Rx3 Parameter count 0 to 10 0 RW Num US
Direct (0), Multicast1 (1),
Multicast2 (2), Multicast3 (3),
Multicast4 (4), Local (5),
4.10.064 Rx3 Source type Direct (0) RW Txt US
Multicast5 (6), Multicast6 (7),
Multicast7 (8), Multicast8 (9),
Multicast9 (10), Multicast10 (11)
4.10.065 Rx3 Timeout 0 to 65535 ms 100 ms RW Num US
Trip (0), Clear output (1),
4.10.066 Rx3 Timeout action Trip (0) RW Txt US
Hold last (2)
This slot (0), Slot 1 (1), Slot 2 (2),
4.10.067 Rx3 Timeout event destination This slot (0) RW Txt US
Slot 3 (3), Slot 4 (4)
No Event (0), Event (1), Event1 (2),
4.10.068 Rx3 Timeout event type No Event (0) RW Txt US
Event2 (3), Event3 (4)
Disabled (-31), VLAN disabled (-30),
Reserved 29 (-29), Reserved 28 (-
28), Reserved 27 (-27),
Reserved 26 (-26), Reserved 25 (-
25), Reserved 24 (-24),
Reserved 23 (-23), Invalid DST IP (-
22), SYNC unsupported (-21),
MEC offset (-20), Invalid tx rate (-
19), Too many mapping (-18),
Link busy (-17), Invalid profile (-16),
4.10.069 Rx3 Link status Invalid mapping (-15), RO Txt ND NC PT
Read only param (-14),
Msg mismatch (-13), Msg too long (-
12), Attrib NA (-11), Attrib RO (-10),
Attrib missing (-9), Timeout (-8),
In error (-7), Link num in use (-6),
Not editable (-5), Invalid link num (-
4), Invalid args (-3),
Too many links (-2),
Out of memory (-1), OK (0),
Not running (1), OK sync (2)

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 541
Slot 4 Menu 10 − RTMOE Easy Mode
Mode: RFC‑A

Overview

The minimum parameters required to configure a 3 transmit links and 3 receive links are specified below. In addition to these each receive link can have its own timeout configured with an additional custom action.

Base link parameters

Link Sync Enable Link No. Src/Dst Par Par Count Type IP Address Message Period
Tx 1 S.10.010 S.10.011 S.10.012‡ S.10.013 S.10.014† S.10.015† S.10.016
Tx 2 S.10.020 S.10.021 S.10.022‡ S.10.023 S.10.024† S.10.025† S.10.026
Tx 3 S.10.030 S.10.031 S.10.032‡ S.10.033 S.10.034† S.10.035† S.10.036

Rx 1 S.10.040 S.10.041 S.10.042 S.10.043 S.10.044 n/a n/a


Rx 2 S.10.050 S.10.051 S.10.052 S.10.053 S.10.054 n/a n/a
Rx 3 S.10.060 S.10.061 S.10.062 S.10.063 S.10.064 n/a n/a

† Required if Type == ‘direct’

Parameter Mapping Configuration

For each cyclic link a start parameter and number of consecutive parameters must be defined. A typical requirement is to transmit and receive parameter values from non-consecutive parameters. This can be performed by
configuring a suitable Menu 0 parameter as the start parameter and the required number of parameters as the count. Menu 22 of the drive can be used to configure what parameters the selected Menu 0 parameters point to.

For example to configure a 1ms transmit cyclic link with control word and speed reference the following parameter changes would be required:

Pr S.10.011 1
Pr S.10.012 0.00.020
Pr S.10.013 2
Pr S.10.014 Broadcast (1)
Pr S.10.016 1
Pr 0.22.020 6.042
Pr 0.22.021 1.021

Synchronous Cyclic Data

Note: Synchronous Cyclic Links are supported on the factory fitted Ethernet interface but not on the option module interface.

Cyclic data links can be made synchronous, utilising the IEEE1588 clock time distributed across the network. The IEEE1588 clock can synchronise the drive's control loops, Pr 11.002 displays the active option slot providing
synchronisation. With synchronised control loops the Ethernet interface can be used to transfer drive parameters containing motion information, including those from the AMC.

Synchronous links work by including the time of when the data should be used along with the data values. This time allows enough time for the cyclic link to reach all destination devices, the time allowed for can be set in
Easy Mode Maximum Network Delay (11.030). The receiving interface will wait for its current time to match the timestamp in the cyclic link before processing the message.

Transmit

1 link can be synchronous with a maximum of 2 x 32bit parameters.

Receive

1 link can be synchronous with a maximum of 2 x 32bit parameters.

VLAN

To guarantee the timing of synchronous links VLANs must be enabled using Drive VLAN ID (4.02.031). VLANs include a priority field that is applied to all messages. This field is used to apply a higher priority to synchronous cyclic
data than other non-deterministic traffic.

AMC & Onboard User Program Timing

Synchronous cyclic data can be used with both the AMC and the drives user program. When using synchronous cyclic data with the AMC ensure that the AMC Rate Select (Pr 31.012) is the same as the transmission rate; 250us,
500us, 1ms, 2ms or 4ms. the clock task of the onboard user program can be scheduled for periods 4ms and greater. For the clock task on multiple drives synchronised with IEEE1588 to be synchronised and in phase all clock
tasks must be set to 4ms only. If synchronous cyclic data is used both for the AMC and the user program interacting with the AMC then Pr 31.012 and the clock task must be 4ms.

Virtual Master

It is possible to send cyclic data to devices on the network and use the same data on the transmitting device. The cyclic links must be synchronous to include timing information. On the transmitting device a receive link must also
be configured with a matching link number to the transmit. for this link you must set the source type Rx1 Source Type4. to be Local. The Ethernet interface will delay the usage of the data transmitted until the same point in time that
all receiving slaves will use the data.

Parameter Update Rate

Parameters are exchange over the network. The value exchanged with the network must be exchanged with the drive or option parameter. The rate of data exchange differs for synchronous / non-synchronous cyclic links as well
as for drive/option destinations.

The diagram below depicts the update cycles used within the Ethernet interface. Cyclic link mappings being exchanged with the drive will be updated at the background task rate. This rate Background cycles per second
(4.09.008) varies with the load on the Ethernet interface; Ethernet/IP data exchange also takes place in the background task.

Parameter 4.10.001 Enable


Short description Easy mode enable
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

When set 1, indicates interface is enabled otherwise disabled

Parameter 4.10.002 Reset


Short description Set to reset the interface
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

This parameter is used to perform a warm reset of the protocol interface. When set and the protocol has reset, the parameter will be reset to zero (Off).

Parameter 4.10.003 Default


Short description Set to default the protocol interface
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

This parameter allows the protocol to be defaulted to factory settings. This includes all of the protocol features, configuration, mappings and stored objects.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


542 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.10.004 Cyclic Messages Per Second
Short description Displays the total number of received amd transmitted per second
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units Messages/s
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

Displays the total number of cyclic (Rx and Tx) messages per second. This includes Easy Mode and Offline configurations.

Parameter 4.10.005 Configuration Valid


Short description Indicates that the active configuration is valid
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Reset, Background
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

If the active configuration identified by Active Configuration (4.10.007) has no configuration errors then the configuration is valid and this parameter will be On (1).

If the active configuration is Easy Mode made effective through a Reset (4.10.002) to On; Configuration Valid (4.10.005) value can be read once Reset (4.10.002) returns to Off as shown in the associated timing diagram.

If the active configuration is Offline (representing a configuration provided by a PC tool) the configuration was created in conjunction with the user application.

Parameter 4.10.006 Operational


Short description Indicates that the all links in the active configuration are receiving/transmitting successfully
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate 1ms
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

This parameter provides an indication that all links in the active configuration are:

1. Receiving new messages successfully AND


2. Transmitting links; this however does not mean the destination devices are receiving the messages; this will be dependent on their own state.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 543
A receive link timeout will cause this parameter to become cleared until a new message is received. A single data late event will cause this parameter to be Off until the next cyclic message is received on time. This parameter is
updated every 1ms; if low latency reactions to timeout and data late events are required then appropriate actions should be configured for the links, see Rx1 Timeout Action4. and Rx1 Late Synchronisation Frame Action4. for
further details.

See timing diagram in Configuration Valid (4.10.005).

A user program utilising cyclic data may use this parameter along with Configuration Valid (4.10.005) to detect when cyclic communication is operational; once detected if the user program wishes to monitor for timeout or data late
events the provided counters (Timeout Count (4.10.008) and Data Late Count (4.10.009)) can be used.

Parameter 4.10.007 Active Configuration


Short description Displays the active configuration source of cyclic data
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

Value Text Description


0 None No configuration active
1 Easy Mode Easy Mode configuration active
2 Offline Offline configuration from PC tools active

Displays the active configuration source of cyclic data.

Parameter 4.10.008 Timeout Count


Short description Displays the number of receive timeout events
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 1ms
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

This parameter displays the total number of receive timeout events; the parameter value will wrap over to zero.

A reset of the configuration will clear this count; see the timing diagram of Configuration Valid (4.10.005). Each timeout event will increment the count. The count can be sampled by a user application in order to detect change since
the last sample; this enables custom reaction to a timeout event occurring on any cyclic receive link which has a timeout value configured, irrespective of the timeout action for the link.

If a custom timeout reaction is required on a per-link basis then the link action must be chosen appropriately in Rx1 Timeout Action4.; this could be Clear output to write zero to all of the cyclic parameters and implement monitoring
code for this condition in the user application.

Parameter 4.10.009 Data Late Count


Short description Displays the number of receive data late events
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate 1ms
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

This parameter displays the total number of receive data late events; the parameter value will wrap over to zero.

A reset of the configuration will clear this count; see the timing diagram of Configuration Valid (4.10.005). Each data late event will increment the count. The count can be sampled by a user application in order to detect change
since the last sample; this enables custom reaction to a data late event occurring on a synchronous cyclic receive link which has a received a message containing a time that is now in the past irrespective the defined action for the
link.

Parameter 4.10.010 Tx1 Link profile


Short description Selects the Tx1 link as a standard or synchronous cyclic link
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text Description


0 Std Standard link
1 Sync Synchronized link

Used to select Tx1 as a standard or synchronous cyclic link.

Parameter 4.10.011 Tx1 Link number


Short description Sets the link number for the Tx1 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This is used to set the link number for the Tx1 link.

Parameter 4.10.012 Tx1 Source parameter


Short description Sets the source parameter for the Tx1 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This sets the source parameter for the Tx1 link.

Parameter 4.10.013 Tx1 Parameter count


Short description Sets the number of parameters for the Tx1 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 10
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This is used to set the number of contiguous parameters for the Tx1 link.

Parameter 4.10.014 Tx1 Link transmission type


Short description Sets the transmission type of the Tx1 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 11
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


544 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Value Text Description
0 Unicast Link is unicast to the IP address specified
1 Broadcast Link is broadcast (255.255.255.255)
2 Multicast1 Link is multicast (239.255.0.1)
3 Multicast2 Link is multicast (239.255.0.2)
4 Multicast3 Link is multicast (239.255.0.3)
5 Multicast4 Link is multicast (239.255.0.4)
6 Multicast5 Link is multicast (239.255.0.5)
7 Multicast6 Link is multicast (239.255.0.6)
8 Multicast7 Link is multicast (239.255.0.7)
9 Multicast8 Link is multicast (239.255.0.8)
10 Multicast9 Link is multicast (239.255.0.9)
11 Multicast10 Link is multicast (239.255.0.10)

This specifies the type of transmission for the Tx1 link.

Parameter 4.10.015 Tx1 Destination address


Short description Sets the destination address of the Tx1 link
0 4294967295
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0.0.0.0) (Display: 255.255.255.255)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0.0.0.0)
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format IP Address Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This specifies the IP address of the destination device for the Tx1 link. If Tx1 Link Transmission Type4. is set to either broadcast or multicast this parameter will display the appropiate address.

Parameter 4.10.016 Tx1 Message Rate


Short description Defines the period at which Tx1 Link will be transmitted. Zero disables the transmission.
Minimum 0 Maximum 100
Default 0 Units ms
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Defines, in milliseconds, the period at which Tx1 Link will be transmitted. A value of zero disables the transmission of data.

Parameter 4.10.019 Tx1 Link status


Short description Link status when loaded
Minimum -31 Maximum 2
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Write on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text Description


-31 Disabled Easy Mode protocol is disabled or link number is set to 0
VLAN is required in order to guarantee timing in synchronous
-30 VLAN disabled
mode but it is disabled.
-29 Reserved 29
-28 Reserved 28
-27 Reserved 27
-26 Reserved 26
-25 Reserved 25
-24 Reserved 24
-23 Reserved 23
-22 Invalid DST IP The destination IP address is invalid
-21 SYNC unsupported Sync link does not support mappings to other option parameters
-20 MEC offset Incorrect MEC offset
-19 Invalid tx rate Tx rate must be a factor of 1 second
-18 Too many mapping The number of mapping items exceeds the range supported
-17 Link busy The link specified is busy
-16 Invalid profile The profile is invalid
-15 Invalid mapping The mapped parameter does not exist
-14 Read only param The mapped parameter is read only
-13 Msg mismatch Link number and direction do not match
-12 Msg too long Resulting message is too long
-11 Attrib NA Attribute not available
-10 Attrib RO Attribute is read only
-9 Attrib missing Attribute is missing
-8 Timeout Timeout
-7 In error The link specified is in Error state
-6 Link num in use The link number specified is already in use
-5 Not editable The link specified is not editable
-4 Invalid link num An invalid link number was specified
Link Number or another argument specified was zero or some
-3 Invalid args
other invalid number
Operation failed as the maximum number of links in use has
-2 Too many links
been reached
-1 Out of memory Failed to allocate memory.
0 OK Configuration of link successful
1 Not running OK. Not running.
2 OK sync Configuration of synchronous link successful

This reports the links status if it has been loaded. A Reset (4.10.002) is required to load any changes.

Parameter 4.10.020 Tx2 Link profile


Short description Selects the Tx2 link as a standard or synchronous cyclic link
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text Description


0 Std Standard link
1 Sync Synchronized link

Used to select Tx2 as a standard or synchronous cyclic link.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 545
Parameter 4.10.021 Tx2 Link number
Short description Sets the link number for the Tx2 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This is used to set the link number for the Tx2 link.

Parameter 4.10.022 Tx2 Source parameter


Short description Sets the source parameter for the Tx2 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This sets the source parameter for the Tx2 link.

Parameter 4.10.023 Tx2 Parameter count


Short description Sets the number of parameters for the Tx2 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 10
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This is used to set the number of contiguous parameters for the Tx2 link.

Parameter 4.10.024 Tx2 Link transmission type


Short description Sets the transmission type of the Tx2 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 11
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 Unicast Link is unicast to the IP address specified
1 Broadcast Link is broadcast (255.255.255.255)
2 Multicast1 Link is multicast (239.255.0.1)
3 Multicast2 Link is multicast (239.255.0.2)
4 Multicast3 Link is multicast (239.255.0.3)
5 Multicast4 Link is multicast (239.255.0.4)
6 Multicast5 Link is multicast (239.255.0.5)
7 Multicast6 Link is multicast (239.255.0.6)
8 Multicast7 Link is multicast (239.255.0.7)
9 Multicast8 Link is multicast (239.255.0.8)
10 Multicast9 Link is multicast (239.255.0.9)
11 Multicast10 Link is multicast (239.255.0.10)

This specifies the type of transmission for the Tx2 link.

Parameter 4.10.025 Tx2 Destination address


Short description Sets the destination address of the Tx2 link
0 4294967295
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0.0.0.0) (Display: 255.255.255.255)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0.0.0.0)
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format IP Address Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This specifies the IP address of the destination device for the Tx1 link. If Tx2 Link Transmission Type4. is set to either broadcast or multicast this parameter will display the appropiate address.

Parameter 4.10.026 Tx2 Message Rate


Short description Defines the period at which Tx2 Link will be transmitted. Zero disables the transmission.
Minimum 0 Maximum 100
Default 0 Units ms
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Defines, in milliseconds, the period at which Tx2 Link will be transmitted. A value of zero disables the transmission of data.

Parameter 4.10.029 Tx2 Link status


Short description Link status when loaded
Minimum -31 Maximum 2
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Write on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


546 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Value Text Description
-31 Disabled Easy Mode protocol is disabled or link number is set to 0
VLAN is required in order to guarantee timing in synchronous
-30 VLAN disabled
mode but it is disabled.
-29 Reserved 29
-28 Reserved 28
-27 Reserved 27
-26 Reserved 26
-25 Reserved 25
-24 Reserved 24
-23 Reserved 23
-22 Invalid DST IP The destination IP address is invalid
-21 SYNC unsupported Sync link does not support mappings to other option parameters
-20 MEC offset Incorrect MEC offset
-19 Invalid tx rate Tx rate must be a factor of 1 second
-18 Too many mapping The number of mapping items exceeds the range supported
-17 Link busy The link specified is busy
-16 Invalid profile The profile is invalid
-15 Invalid mapping The mapped parameter does not exist
-14 Read only param The mapped parameter is read only
-13 Msg mismatch Link number and direction do not match
-12 Msg too long Resulting message is too long
-11 Attrib NA Attribute not available
-10 Attrib RO Attribute is read only
-9 Attrib missing Attribute is missing
-8 Timeout Timeout
-7 In error The link specified is in Error state
-6 Link num in use The link number specified is already in use
-5 Not editable The link specified is not editable
-4 Invalid link num An invalid link number was specified
Link Number or another argument specified was zero or some
-3 Invalid args
other invalid number
Operation failed as the maximum number of links in use has
-2 Too many links
been reached
-1 Out of memory Failed to allocate memory.
0 OK Configuration of link successful
1 Not running OK. Not running.
2 OK sync Configuration of synchronous link successful

This reports the links status if it has been loaded. A Reset (4.10.002) is required to load any changes.

Parameter 4.10.030 Tx3 Link profile


Short description Selects the Tx3 link as a standard or synchronous cyclic link
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text Description


0 Std Standard link
1 Sync Synchronized link

Used to select Tx3 as a standard or synchronous cyclic link.

Parameter 4.10.031 Tx3 Link number


Short description Sets the link number for the Tx3 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This is used to set the link number for the Tx3 link.

Parameter 4.10.032 Tx3 Source parameter


Short description Sets the source parameter for the Tx3 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This sets the source parameter for the Tx3 link.

Parameter 4.10.033 Tx3 Parameter count


Short description Sets the number of parameters for the Tx3 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 10
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This is used to set the number of contiguous parameters for the Tx3 link.

Parameter 4.10.034 Tx3 Link transmission type


Short description Sets the transmission type of the Tx3 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 11
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 547
Value Text Description
0 Unicast Link is unicast to the IP address specified
1 Broadcast Link is broadcast (255.255.255.255)
2 Multicast1 Link is multicast (239.255.0.1)
3 Multicast2 Link is multicast (239.255.0.2)
4 Multicast3 Link is multicast (239.255.0.3)
5 Multicast4 Link is multicast (239.255.0.4)
6 Multicast5 Link is multicast (239.255.0.5)
7 Multicast6 Link is multicast (239.255.0.6)
8 Multicast7 Link is multicast (239.255.0.7)
9 Multicast8 Link is multicast (239.255.0.8)
10 Multicast9 Link is multicast (239.255.0.9)
11 Multicast10 Link is multicast (239.255.0.10)

This specifies the type of transmission for the Tx3 link.

Parameter 4.10.035 Tx3 Destination address


Short description Sets the destination address of the Tx3 link
0 4294967295
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0.0.0.0) (Display: 255.255.255.255)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0.0.0.0)
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format IP Address Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This specifies the IP address of the destination device for the Tx1 link. If Tx3 Link Transmission Type4. is set to either broadcast or multicast this parameter will display the appropiate address.

Parameter 4.10.036 Tx3 Message Rate


Short description Sets and shows the Tx3 message rate
Minimum 0 Maximum 100
Default 0 Units ms
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Defines, in milliseconds, the period at which Tx3 Link will be transmitted. A value of zero disables the transmission of data.

Parameter 4.10.039 Tx3 Link status


Short description Link status when loaded
Minimum -31 Maximum 2
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Write on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text Description


-31 Disabled Easy Mode protocol is disabled or link number is set to 0
VLAN is required in order to guarantee timing in synchronous
-30 VLAN disabled
mode but it is disabled.
-29 Reserved 29
-28 Reserved 28
-27 Reserved 27
-26 Reserved 26
-25 Reserved 25
-24 Reserved 24
-23 Reserved 23
-22 Invalid DST IP The destination IP address is invalid
-21 SYNC unsupported Sync link does not support mappings to other option parameters
-20 MEC offset Incorrect MEC offset
-19 Invalid tx rate Tx rate must be a factor of 1 second
-18 Too many mapping The number of mapping items exceeds the range supported
-17 Link busy The link specified is busy
-16 Invalid profile The profile is invalid
-15 Invalid mapping The mapped parameter does not exist
-14 Read only param The mapped parameter is read only
-13 Msg mismatch Link number and direction do not match
-12 Msg too long Resulting message is too long
-11 Attrib NA Attribute not available
-10 Attrib RO Attribute is read only
-9 Attrib missing Attribute is missing
-8 Timeout Timeout
-7 In error The link specified is in Error state
-6 Link num in use The link number specified is already in use
-5 Not editable The link specified is not editable
-4 Invalid link num An invalid link number was specified
Link Number or another argument specified was zero or some
-3 Invalid args
other invalid number
Operation failed as the maximum number of links in use has
-2 Too many links
been reached
-1 Out of memory Failed to allocate memory.
0 OK Configuration of link successful
1 Not running OK. Not running.
2 OK sync Configuration of synchronous link successful

This reports the links status if it has been loaded. A Reset (4.10.002) is required to load any changes.

Parameter 4.10.040 Rx1 Link profile


Short description Selects the Rx1 link as a standard or synchronous cyclic link
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text Description


0 Std Standard link
1 Sync Synchronized link

Used to select Rx1 as a standard or synchronous cyclic link.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


548 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.10.041 Rx1 Link number
Short description Sets the link number for the Rx1 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter is used to set the link number for the Rx1 link.

Parameter 4.10.042 Rx1 Destination parameter


Short description Sets the destination parameter for the Rx1 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter sets the desintation parameter for the Rx1 link.

Parameter 4.10.043 Rx1 Parameter count


Short description Sets the number of parameters for the Rx1 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 10
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter is used to set the number of contiguous parameters for the Rx1 link.

Parameter 4.10.044 Rx1 Source type


Short description Sets the transmission type of the Rx1 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 11
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 Direct Link listens to unicast or broadcast i.e. any address
1 Multicast1 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.1)
2 Multicast2 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.2)
3 Multicast3 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.3)
4 Multicast4 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.4)
5 Local Link listens to local loopback (127.0.0.1)
6 Multicast5 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.5)
7 Multicast6 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.6)
8 Multicast7 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.7)
9 Multicast8 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.8)
10 Multicast9 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.9)
11 Multicast10 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.10)

This parameter specifies the type of transmission for the Rx1 link.

Parameter 4.10.045 Rx1 Timeout


Short description Sets the timeout value for the Rx1 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default 100 Units ms
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter specifies the watchdog timer for the Rx1 link. If no cyclic data is received on the Rx1 link the action taken will be determined by the setting in Rx1 Timeout Action4..

Note:
It is good system design to allow for some message loss by setting the timeout duration to be greater than the transmit period by a factor of 2 or more.

Parameter 4.10.046 Rx1 Timeout action


Short description Defines the timeout action for the Rx1 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 Trip Trip drive with Slx.Er and sub-trip code
1 Clear output PLC output parameters will have their values set to zero
2 Hold last Hold the last value in output parameters

Defines the action to be taken for a timeout on the Rx1 link.

Parameter 4.10.047 Rx1 Timeout event destination


Short description Defines the timeout event destination slot for the Rx1 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 This slot Trigger module event in this slot
1 Slot 1 Trigger module event in slot 1
2 Slot 2 Trigger module event in slot 2
3 Slot 3 Trigger module event in slot 3
4 Slot 4 Trigger module event in slot 4

This parameter defines the slot in which an event will occur if a cyclic data timeout occurs on the Rx1 link.

<< This feature is not currently supported >>

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 549
Parameter 4.10.048 Rx1 Timeout event type
Short description Defines the event to trigger for a timeout on the Rx1 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 No Event No Event
1 Event Trigger module event
2 Event1 Trigger module event 1
3 Event2 Trigger module event 2
4 Event3 Trigger module event 3

Defines the event to trigger in the given destination, as specified in Rx1 Timeout Event Destination4., if a cyclic data timeout occurs on the Rx1 link.

Parameter 4.10.049 Rx1 Link status


Short description Link status when loaded
Minimum -31 Maximum 2
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Write on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text Description


-31 Disabled Easy Mode protocol is disabled or link number is set to 0
VLAN is required in order to guarantee timing in synchronous
-30 VLAN disabled
mode but it is disabled.
-29 Reserved 29
-28 Reserved 28
-27 Reserved 27
-26 Reserved 26
-25 Reserved 25
-24 Reserved 24
-23 Reserved 23
-22 Invalid DST IP The destination IP address is invalid
-21 SYNC unsupported Sync link does not support mappings to other option parameters
-20 MEC offset Incorrect MEC offset
-19 Invalid tx rate Tx rate must be a factor of 1 second
-18 Too many mapping The number of mapping items exceeds the range supported
-17 Link busy The link specified is busy
-16 Invalid profile The profile is invalid
-15 Invalid mapping The mapped parameter does not exist
-14 Read only param The mapped parameter is read only
-13 Msg mismatch Link number and direction do not match
-12 Msg too long Resulting message is too long
-11 Attrib NA Attribute not available
-10 Attrib RO Attribute is read only
-9 Attrib missing Attribute is missing
-8 Timeout Timeout
-7 In error The link specified is in Error state
-6 Link num in use The link number specified is already in use
-5 Not editable The link specified is not editable
-4 Invalid link num An invalid link number was specified
Link Number or another argument specified was zero or some
-3 Invalid args
other invalid number
Operation failed as the maximum number of links in use has
-2 Too many links
been reached
-1 Out of memory Failed to allocate memory.
0 OK Configuration of link successful
1 Not running OK. Not running.
2 OK sync Configuration of synchronous link successful

This reports the links status if it has been loaded. A Reset (4.10.002) is required to load any changes.

Parameter 4.10.050 Rx2 Link profile


Short description Selects the Rx2 link as a standard or synchronous cyclic link
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text Description


0 Std Standard link
1 Sync Synchronized link

Used to select Rx2 as a standard or synchronous cyclic link.

Parameter 4.10.051 Rx2 Link number


Short description Sets the link number for the Rx2 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter is used to set the link number for the Rx2 link.

Parameter 4.10.052 Rx2 Destination parameter


Short description Sets the destination parameter for the Rx2 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter sets the desintation parameter for the Rx2 link.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


550 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.10.053 Rx2 Parameter count
Short description Sets the number of parameters for the Rx2 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 10
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter is used to set the number of contiguous parameters for the Rx2 link.

Parameter 4.10.054 Rx2 Source type


Short description Sets the transmission type of the Rx2 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 11
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 Direct Link listens to unicast or broadcast i.e. any address
1 Multicast1 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.1)
2 Multicast2 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.2)
3 Multicast3 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.3)
4 Multicast4 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.4)
5 Local Link listens to local loopback (127.0.0.1)
6 Multicast5 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.5)
7 Multicast6 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.6)
8 Multicast7 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.7)
9 Multicast8 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.8)
10 Multicast9 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.9)
11 Multicast10 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.10)

This parameter specifies the type of transmission for the Rx2 link.

Parameter 4.10.055 Rx2 Timeout


Short description Sets the timeout value for the Rx2 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default 100 Units ms
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter specifies the watchdog timer for the Rx1 link. If no cyclic data is received on the Rx1 link the action taken will be determined by the setting in Rx2 Timeout Action4..

Note:
It is good system design to allow for some message loss by setting the timeout duration to be greater than the transmit period by a factor of 2 or more.

Parameter 4.10.056 Rx2 Timeout action


Short description Defines the timeout action for the Rx2 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 Trip Trip drive with Slx.Er and sub-trip code
1 Clear output PLC output parameters will have their values set to zero
2 Hold last Hold the last value in output parameters

Defines the action to be taken for a timeout on the Rx2 link.

Parameter 4.10.057 Rx2 Timeout event destination


Short description Defines the timeout event destination slot for the Rx2 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 This slot Trigger module event in this slot
1 Slot 1 Trigger module event in slot 1
2 Slot 2 Trigger module event in slot 2
3 Slot 3 Trigger module event in slot 3
4 Slot 4 Trigger module event in slot 4

This parameter defines the slot in which an event will occur if a cyclic data timeout occurs on the Rx2 link.

<< This feature is not currently supported >>

Parameter 4.10.058 Rx2 Timeout event type


Short description Defines the event to trigger for a timeout on the Rx2 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 No Event No Event
1 Event Trigger module event
2 Event1 Trigger module event 1
3 Event2 Trigger module event 2
4 Event3 Trigger module event 3

Defines the event to trigger in the given destination, as specified in Rx2 Timeout Event Destination4., if a cyclic data timeout occurs on the Rx2 link.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 551
Parameter 4.10.059 Rx2 Link status
Short description Link status when loaded
Minimum -31 Maximum 2
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Write on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Value Text Description


-31 Disabled Easy Mode protocol is disabled or link number is set to 0
VLAN is required in order to guarantee timing in synchronous
-30 VLAN disabled
mode but it is disabled.
-29 Reserved 29
-28 Reserved 28
-27 Reserved 27
-26 Reserved 26
-25 Reserved 25
-24 Reserved 24
-23 Reserved 23
-22 Invalid DST IP The destination IP address is invalid
-21 SYNC unsupported Sync link does not support mappings to other option parameters
-20 MEC offset Incorrect MEC offset
-19 Invalid tx rate Tx rate must be a factor of 1 second
-18 Too many mapping The number of mapping items exceeds the range supported
-17 Link busy The link specified is busy
-16 Invalid profile The profile is invalid
-15 Invalid mapping The mapped parameter does not exist
-14 Read only param The mapped parameter is read only
-13 Msg mismatch Link number and direction do not match
-12 Msg too long Resulting message is too long
-11 Attrib NA Attribute not available
-10 Attrib RO Attribute is read only
-9 Attrib missing Attribute is missing
-8 Timeout Timeout
-7 In error The link specified is in Error state
-6 Link num in use The link number specified is already in use
-5 Not editable The link specified is not editable
-4 Invalid link num An invalid link number was specified
Link Number or another argument specified was zero or some
-3 Invalid args
other invalid number
Operation failed as the maximum number of links in use has
-2 Too many links
been reached
-1 Out of memory Failed to allocate memory.
0 OK Configuration of link successful
1 Not running OK. Not running.
2 OK sync Configuration of synchronous link successful

This reports the links status if it has been loaded. A Reset (4.10.002) is required to load any changes.

Parameter 4.10.060 Rx3 Link profile


Short description Selects the Rx3 link as a standard or synchronous cyclic link
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE

Value Text Description


0 Std Standard link
1 Sync Synchronized link

Used to select Rx3 as a standard or synchronous cyclic link.

Parameter 4.10.061 Rx3 Link number


Short description Sets the link number for the Rx3 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 255
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter is used to set the link number for the Rx3 link.

Parameter 4.10.062 Rx3 Destination parameter


Short description Sets the destination parameter for the Rx3 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter sets the desintation parameter for the Rx3 link.

Parameter 4.10.063 Rx3 Parameter count


Short description Sets the number of parameters for the Rx3 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 10
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter is used to set the number of contiguous parameters for the Rx3 link.

Parameter 4.10.064 Rx3 Source type


Short description Sets the transmission type of the Rx3 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 11
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


552 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Value Text Description
0 Direct Link listens to unicast or broadcast i.e. any address
1 Multicast1 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.1)
2 Multicast2 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.2)
3 Multicast3 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.3)
4 Multicast4 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.4)
5 Local Link listens to local loopback (127.0.0.1)
6 Multicast5 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.5)
7 Multicast6 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.6)
8 Multicast7 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.7)
9 Multicast8 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.8)
10 Multicast9 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.9)
11 Multicast10 Link listens to multicast (239.255.0.10)

This parameter specifies the type of transmission for the Rx3 link.

Parameter 4.10.065 Rx3 Timeout


Short description Sets the timeout value for the Rx3 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default 100 Units ms
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter specifies the watchdog timer for the Rx1 link. If no cyclic data is received on the Rx1 link the action taken will be determined by the setting in Rx3 Timeout Action4..

Note:
It is good system design to allow for some message loss by setting the timeout duration to be greater than the transmit period by a factor of 2 or more.

Parameter 4.10.066 Rx3 Timeout action


Short description Defines the timeout action for the Rx3 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 Trip Trip drive with Slx.Er and sub-trip code
1 Clear output PLC output parameters will have their values set to zero
2 Hold last Hold the last value in output parameters

Defines the action to be taken for a timeout on the Rx3 link.

Parameter 4.10.067 Rx3 Timeout event destination


Short description Defines the timeout event destination slot for the Rx3 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 This slot Trigger module event in this slot
1 Slot 1 Trigger module event in slot 1
2 Slot 2 Trigger module event in slot 2
3 Slot 3 Trigger module event in slot 3
4 Slot 4 Trigger module event in slot 4

This parameter defines the slot in which an event will occur if a cyclic data timeout occurs on the Rx3 link.

<< This feature is not currently supported >>

Parameter 4.10.068 Rx3 Timeout event type


Short description Defines the event to trigger for a timeout on the Rx3 link
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 No Event No Event
1 Event Trigger module event
2 Event1 Trigger module event 1
3 Event2 Trigger module event 2
4 Event3 Trigger module event 3

Defines the event to trigger in the given destination, as specified in Rx3 Timeout Event Destination4., if a cyclic data timeout occurs on the Rx3 link.

Parameter 4.10.069 Rx3 Link status


Short description Link status when loaded
Minimum -31 Maximum 2
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Write on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 553
Value Text Description
-31 Disabled Easy Mode protocol is disabled or link number is set to 0
VLAN is required in order to guarantee timing in synchronous
-30 VLAN disabled
mode but it is disabled.
-29 Reserved 29
-28 Reserved 28
-27 Reserved 27
-26 Reserved 26
-25 Reserved 25
-24 Reserved 24
-23 Reserved 23
-22 Invalid DST IP The destination IP address is invalid
-21 SYNC unsupported Sync link does not support mappings to other option parameters
-20 MEC offset Incorrect MEC offset
-19 Invalid tx rate Tx rate must be a factor of 1 second
-18 Too many mapping The number of mapping items exceeds the range supported
-17 Link busy The link specified is busy
-16 Invalid profile The profile is invalid
-15 Invalid mapping The mapped parameter does not exist
-14 Read only param The mapped parameter is read only
-13 Msg mismatch Link number and direction do not match
-12 Msg too long Resulting message is too long
-11 Attrib NA Attribute not available
-10 Attrib RO Attribute is read only
-9 Attrib missing Attribute is missing
-8 Timeout Timeout
-7 In error The link specified is in Error state
-6 Link num in use The link number specified is already in use
-5 Not editable The link specified is not editable
-4 Invalid link num An invalid link number was specified
Link Number or another argument specified was zero or some
-3 Invalid args
other invalid number
Operation failed as the maximum number of links in use has
-2 Too many links
been reached
-1 Out of memory Failed to allocate memory.
0 OK Configuration of link successful
1 Not running OK. Not running.
2 OK sync Configuration of synchronous link successful

This reports the links status if it has been loaded. A Reset (4.10.002) is required to load any changes.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


554 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Slot 4 Menu 11 Single Line Descriptions − RTMOE Sync
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


4.11.001 Preferred Sync Master 0 to 4 1 RW Num US
4.11.002 Master Clock Domain 0 to 3 0 RW Num US
4.11.005 Grandmaster MAC Address 00:00:00:00:00:00 to FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF RO Mac ND NC PT
4.11.006 Synchronisation Jitter From Grandmaster -2147483648 to 2147483647 ns RO Num ND NC PT
4.11.007 Synchronisation Jitter Threshold 500 to 1000000 ns 1000 ns RW Num US
4.11.008 Module Synchronised Flag Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RO Bit
4.11.009 Inhibit Drive Synchronisation Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
4.11.010 PTP Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 RO Date ND NC PT
4.11.011 PTP Time 00:00:00 to 23:59:59 RO Time ND NC PT
4.11.015 PTP Delay Measurement Select P2P DELAY (1), OFF (2) P2P DELAY (1) RW Txt US
4.11.016 PTP Sync Rate -4 to 0 -4 RW Num US
4.11.017 In sync window length 3 to 255 s 20 s RW Num US
4.11.020 Network Error Count 0 to 4294967295 RO Num ND NC PT
MASTER (0), PRODUCER (1),
4.11.022 Interoption Sync Status RO Txt ND NC PT
INDEPENDENT (2)
4.11.030 Easy Mode Maximum Network Delay 1 to 100 ms 3 ms RW Num US
4.11.040 Rx1 Late Synchronisation Frame Action Trip (1), Do not use (2), Use (3) Trip (1) RW Txt US
This slot (0), Slot 1 (1), Slot 2 (2),
4.11.041 Rx1 Late Synchronisation Frame Destination This slot (0) RW Txt US
Slot 3 (3), Slot 4 (4)
No Event (0), Event (1), Event1 (2),
4.11.042 Rx1 Late Synchronisation Frame Event No Event (0) RW Txt US
Event2 (3), Event3 (4)
4.11.050 Rx2 Late Synchronisation Frame Action Trip (1), Do not use (2), Use (3) Trip (1) RW Txt US
This slot (0), Slot 1 (1), Slot 2 (2),
4.11.051 Rx2 Late Synchronisation Frame Destination This slot (0) RW Txt US
Slot 3 (3), Slot 4 (4)
No Event (0), Event (1), Event1 (2),
4.11.052 Rx2 Late Synchronisation Frame Event No Event (0) RW Txt US
Event2 (3), Event3 (4)
4.11.060 Rx3 Late Synchronisation Frame Action Trip (1), Do not use (2), Use (3) Trip (1) RW Txt US
This slot (0), Slot 1 (1), Slot 2 (2),
4.11.061 Rx3 Late Synchronisation Frame Destination This slot (0) RW Txt US
Slot 3 (3), Slot 4 (4)
No Event (0), Event (1), Event1 (2),
4.11.062 Rx3 Late Synchronisation Frame Event No Event (0) RW Txt US
Event2 (3), Event3 (4)

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 555
Slot 4 Menu 11 − RTMOE Sync
Mode: RFC‑A

Note: Synchronous Cyclic Links are supported by the Onboard Ethernet interface, but not on the option module interface.

Parameter 4.11.001 Preferred Sync Master


Short description Defines the module's synchronisation master preferences
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This module will be preferred as the grandmaster over others with higher preferred values or none specified. A value of zero will ensure that the module
will not become grandmaster (effectively turning this functionality off). If more than one module have the same preferred value only one will be chosen
as the grandmaster using the IEEE 1588 BMC algorithm.

The parameter does not guarantee that the module will become grandmaster but a value of zero guarantees that the module will not become a
grandmaster.

Parameter 4.11.002 Master Clock Domain


Short description Specifies the clock domain for the grandmaster clock
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Specifies the clock domain for the module to act as a grandmaster clock.

Parameter 4.11.005 Grandmaster MAC Address


Short description Displays the MAC address of the synchronisation grandmaster
0 18446744073709551615
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00:00:00:00) (Display: FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF)
Default Units
Type 64 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background write
Display Format MAC Address Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

This parameter displays the MAC address, as a 64-bit hexadecimal value, of the synchronisation grandmaster (if there is a grandmaster).

Parameter 4.11.006 Synchronisation Jitter From Grandmaster


Short description Displays the jitter from the grandmaster
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default Units ns
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Written every 500ms
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT

This parameter displays the synchronisation jitter in nanoseconds. The value is filtered to be human readable.

Parameter 4.11.007 Synchronisation Jitter Threshold


Short description Synchronisation Jitter Threshold
Minimum 500 Maximum 1000000
Default 1000 Units ns
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Sets the application tolerable clock jitter in ns from the grandmaster. If Synchronisation Jitter From Grandmaster (4.11.006) is within the tolerance the
local clock is synchronised to the grandmaster and synchronised cyclic data links will be processed.

Parameter 4.11.008 Module Synchronised Flag


Short description Module synchronised flag
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Written every 10ms
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


556 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
The parameter displays the module's synchronisation status. 1 = Synchronised, 0 = Not synchronised.

Parameter 4.11.009 Inhibit Drive Synchronisation


Short description Specifies whether the module should synchronise with the grandmaster
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Immediate
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

This parameter controls whether the module synchronises the OPT_SYNC with the network grandmaster. A value of ON inhibits this.

Parameter 4.11.010 PTP Date


Short description PTP Date
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Written every 500ms
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

This parameter displays the current date. If the module has no time source it will display the date based on its power-up date of 1st January 1970.

Parameter 4.11.011 PTP Time


Short description PTP Time
0 235959
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00:00:00) (Display: 23:59:59)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Written every 500ms
Display Format Time Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

This parameter displays the current time. If the module has no time source it will display the date based on its power-up date of 00:00:00.

Parameter 4.11.015 PTP Delay Measurement Select


Short description PTP delay measurement select
Minimum 1 Maximum 2
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


1 P2P DELAY Peer-to-peer delay
2 OFF Delay off

PTP Delay Measurement is always Peer-to-Peer.

This parameter selects the delay measurement. 1 = Peer-to-peer, 2 = OFF

Peer-to-peer delay mechanism provides not only the PTP event transit time information, but also provides the corrections for the propagation
delay of the link connected to the port receiving the PTP event message.

OFF disables the PTP messages so that the module will not respond to a PTP delay request message or initiate a PTP delay request message
and will therefore not synchronise with the master.

Parameter 4.11.016 PTP Sync Rate


Short description PTP Sync rate
Minimum -4 Maximum 0
Default -4 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

This parameter controls the rate at which PTP Sync frames are sent. The message rate is determined by raising 2 to the power of this parameter. E.g a
value of -2 results in four sync messages per second.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 557
Parameter 4.11.017 In sync window length
Short description In sync window length
Minimum 3 Maximum 255
Default 20 Units s
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Duration that the jitter Synchronisation Jitter From Grandmaster (4.11.006) must be below the jitter threshold for before the in sync
flag Module Synchronised Flag (4.11.008) is set.

For a system the duration depends upon the number of IEEE1588 capable masters on the network. To use lower values here the number of devices
which are capable of acting as a synchronisation master must be kept as low as possible by setting Preferred Sync Master (4.11.001) to 0 on all
interfaces except those who may be master.

Parameter 4.11.020 Network Error Count


Short description Displays the number of errors detected on the network
Minimum 0 Maximum 4294967295
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate Written every 500ms
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

The parameter displays a count of network errors since startup. It can be used as an indication of a problem.

Parameter 4.11.022 Interoption Sync Status


Short description Interoption Sync Status
Minimum 0 Maximum 2
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

This module does not support Slave mode

Value Text Description


0 MASTER The module is master but not producing
1 PRODUCER The module is master and producing
2 INDEPENDENT The module is not master

Provides the status of the inter-option synchronization via an enumeration.

Parameter 4.11.030 Easy Mode Maximum Network Delay


Short description Defines the maximum allowable delay for Easy Mode cyclic transmit links
Minimum 1 Maximum 100
Default 3 Units ms
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This defines the allowable network delay (in milliseconds) for the Easy Mode synchronous transmit cyclic links to arrive at their destination.

From firmware V01.03.00.00 onwards, the default delay has been changed to 3ms (previous value 0ms). If the old default of 0ms is encountered, this
is automatically changed to 3ms as the new minimum is 1ms).

Parameter 4.11.040 Rx1 Late Synchronisation Frame Action


Short description Defines the action to take when synchronised frame is received late
Minimum 1 Maximum 3
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


1 Trip Trip drive with Slx.Er and sub-trip code
2 Do not use The data is ignored
3 Use The data is used immediately

This parameter defines the action to be taken when a late synchronised frame is received.

From firmware V01.03.00.00 onwards there is a reduced range of actions. Since the option zero has been deprecated, the new default action is Trip
(1st option).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


558 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.11.041 Rx1 Late Synchronisation Frame Destination
Short description Sets the slot to trigger an event
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 This slot Trigger module event in this slot
1 Slot 1 Trigger module event in slot 1
2 Slot 2 Trigger module event in slot 2
3 Slot 3 Trigger module event in slot 3
4 Slot 4 Trigger module event in slot 4

Defines the destination (slot) to trigger the event when a late synchronised frame is received.

Parameter 4.11.042 Rx1 Late Synchronisation Frame Event


Short description Sets the event number to trigger
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 No Event No Event
1 Event Trigger module event
2 Event1 Trigger module event 1
3 Event2 Trigger module event 2
4 Event3 Trigger module event 3

Defines the event number to trigger in the given destination (slot) when a late synchronised frame is received.

Parameter 4.11.050 Rx2 Late Synchronisation Frame Action


Short description Defines the action to take when synchronised frame is received late
Minimum 1 Maximum 3
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


1 Trip Trip drive with Slx.Er and sub-trip code
2 Do not use The data is ignored
3 Use The data is used immediately

This parameter defines the action to be taken when a late synchronised frame is received.

From firmware V01.03.00.00 onwards there is a reduced range of actions. Since the option zero has been deprecated, the new default action is Trip
(1st option).

Parameter 4.11.051 Rx2 Late Synchronisation Frame Destination


Short description Sets the slot to trigger an event
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 This slot Trigger module event in this slot
1 Slot 1 Trigger module event in slot 1
2 Slot 2 Trigger module event in slot 2
3 Slot 3 Trigger module event in slot 3
4 Slot 4 Trigger module event in slot 4

Defines the destination (slot) to trigger the event when a late synchronised frame is received.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 559
Parameter 4.11.052 Rx2 Late Synchronisation Frame Event
Short description Sets the event number to trigger
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 No Event No Event
1 Event Trigger module event
2 Event1 Trigger module event 1
3 Event2 Trigger module event 2
4 Event3 Trigger module event 3

Defines the event number to trigger in the given destination (slot) when a late synchronised frame is received.

Parameter 4.11.060 Rx3 Late Synchronisation Frame Action


Short description Defines the action to take when synchronised frame is received late
Minimum 1 Maximum 3
Default 1 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


1 Trip Trip drive with Slx.Er and sub-trip code
2 Do not use The data is ignored
3 Use The data is used immediately

This parameter defines the action to be taken when a late synchronised frame is received.

From firmware V01.03.00.00 onwards there is a reduced range of actions. Since the option zero has been deprecated, the new default action is Trip
(1st option).

Parameter 4.11.061 Rx3 Late Synchronisation Frame Destination


Short description Sets the slot to trigger an event
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 This slot Trigger module event in this slot
1 Slot 1 Trigger module event in slot 1
2 Slot 2 Trigger module event in slot 2
3 Slot 3 Trigger module event in slot 3
4 Slot 4 Trigger module event in slot 4

Defines the destination (slot) to trigger the event when a late synchronised frame is received.

Parameter 4.11.062 Rx3 Late Synchronisation Frame Event


Short description Sets the event number to trigger
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Read on reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 No Event No Event
1 Event Trigger module event
2 Event1 Trigger module event 1
3 Event2 Trigger module event 2
4 Event3 Trigger module event 3

Defines the event number to trigger in the given destination (slot) when a late synchronised frame is received.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


560 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Slot 4 Menu 15 Single Line Descriptions − Modbus TCP/IP Setup
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


4.15.001 Enable Off (0) or On (1) On (1) RW Bit US
4.15.002 Reset Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
4.15.003 Default Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
No error (0), Port in use (1),
4.15.004 Modbus Configuration Error Timeout event (2), RO Txt ND NC PT
Num Connections (3)
4.15.005 Modbus Listening Port 0 to 65535 502 RW Num US
4.15.006 Maximum Connections 0 to 10 2 RW Num US
4.15.007 Maximum Priority Connections 0 to 5 0 RW Num US
4.15.008 Maximum Connections Per Client 1 to 10 2 RW Num US
4.15.009 Modbus Timeout 1 to 10000 ms 100 ms RW Num US
4.15.010 Modbus Timeout Action Trip (0), No action (1) No action (1) RW Txt US
This slot (0), Slot 1 (1), Slot 2 (2),
4.15.011 Modbus Timeout Event Destination This slot (0) RW Txt US
Slot 3 (3), Slot 4 (4)
No event (0), Trigger Event (1),
Trigger Event 1 (2),
4.15.012 Modbus Timeout Event Type Trigger Event 2 (3), No event (0) RW Txt US
Trigger Event 3 (4),
Trigger Event 4 (5)
4.15.013 Modbus Register Addressing Mode Standard (0), Modified (1) Standard (0) RW Txt US
4.15.020 Priority Connection 1 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 0.0.0.0 RW IP US
4.15.021 Priority Connection 2 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 0.0.0.0 RW IP US
4.15.022 Priority Connection 3 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 0.0.0.0 RW IP US
4.15.023 Priority Connection 4 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 0.0.0.0 RW IP US
4.15.024 Priority Connection 5 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 0.0.0.0 RW IP US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 561
Slot 4 Menu 15 − Modbus TCP/IP Setup
Mode: RFC‑A

Modbus TCP/IP is one of the most widely supported industrial Ethernet based protocols offering the functionality and simplicity of the Modbus protocol,
with the flexibility of Ethernet. The table below shows the supported Modbus function codes.

The implementation of Modbus TCP/IP follows the specification provided by the Modbus organisation. Modbus TCP/IP uses the standard Protocol Data
Unit (PDU) but without the CRC bytes and encapsulates it within a Modbus TCP/IP Application Data Unit (ADU) for transmission. This means that the
Modbus PDU is the same for both standard (RTU) and Ethernet based transmission.

Code Description
3 Read multiple 16 bit registers
6 Write single 16 bit register
16 Write multiple 16 bit registers
23 Read and write multiple 16 bit registers

Parameter 4.15.001 Enable


Short description Set to enable Modbus functionality
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter is used to enable or disable Modbus master and slave functionality.

Parameter 4.15.002 Reset


Short description Set to reset the interface
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Background read; written to 0 on
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate
initialisation
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

This parameter is used to perform a warm reset of the protocol interface. When set and the protocol has reset, the parameter will be reset to zero (Off).

Parameter 4.15.003 Default


Short description Set to default the protocol interface
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
On module reset, protocol interface
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate
reset or protocol enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

This parameter allows the protocol to be defaulted to factory settings. This includes all of the protocol features, configuration, mappings and stored
objects.

Parameter 4.15.004 Modbus Configuration Error


Short description Displays the Modbus configuration error
Minimum 0 Maximum 3
Default Units
Module reset, Modbus interface reset
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate
or Modbus interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

Value Text Description


0 No error No error
1 Port in use Specified port is currently in use by another protocol
2 Timeout event Timeout trigger event location is not valid
3 Num Connections The Max priority connection is greater than the max connections

This parameter will indicate any Modbus configuration errors.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


562 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.15.005 Modbus Listening Port
Short description Defines the Modbus TCP/IP port
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default 502 Units
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate See Priority Protocol (S.02.020)
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter can be changed from its default port of 502, however it is the user's responsibility to ensure that a valid port is set.

Parameter 4.15.006 Maximum Connections


Short description Defines the maximum number of connections to the module
Minimum 0 Maximum 10
Default 2 Units
Module reset, Modbus interface reset
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
or Modbus interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter permits the user to specify the total number of connections that one or more clients can open with the module at any one time.

Parameter 4.15.007 Maximum Priority Connections


Short description Defines the maximum number of priority connections
Minimum 0 Maximum 5
Default 0 Units
Module reset, Modbus interface reset
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
or Modbus interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter defines how many of the maximum connections specified in Maximum Connections (4.15.006) can be configured as a priority
connection. A connection is accepted into the priority connections pool if the client's IP address matches one of the values stored in
parameters Priority Connection 1 (4.15.020), Priority Connection 2 (4.15.021), Priority Connection 3 (4.15.022) or Priority Connection 4 (4.15.023).

The priority connections are permanent and, once made will only be deleted at the request of the client or due to a communications error.

Any connections not in the priority connections pool are kept in the non-priority connections pool. If a client attempts to establish a priority connection
and all available non-priority connections are in use, the non-priority connection that has not been used for the longest will be closed to make way for
the new priority connection.

Parameter 4.15.008 Maximum Connections Per Client


Short description Defines the maximum number of connections per client
Minimum 1 Maximum 10
Default 2 Units
Module reset, Modbus interface reset
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
or Modbus interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter defines the maximum number of priority connections that any one client can establish. This check is only performed on the connections
in the priority connections pool.

Parameter 4.15.009 Modbus Timeout


Short description Defines the Modbus timeout value
Minimum 1 Maximum 10000
Default 100 Units ms
Module reset, Modbus interface reset
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate
or Modbus interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter defines the time period in which the Modbus server must receive a message before any specified action (00 defined in
Modbus Timeout Action (0015.010)) is performed. When the timeout occurs, bit 2 in the module's alarm parameter (00
href="menu0.html#9">Active Alarm Bits (0000.009)) will be set and the specified action will be performed.

The timeout is enabled when the server receives its first message.

Note:
It is good system design to allow for some message loss by setting the timeout duration to be greater than the transmit period by a factor of 2 or more.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 563
Parameter 4.15.010 Modbus Timeout Action
Short description Defines the action to perform on a Modbus timeout
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Module reset, Modbus interface reset
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
or Modbus interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 Trip Trip drive and raise error
1 No action No action

Defines the action when no message is received within the time period specified in Modbus Timeout (4.15.009). Note: if a Trip is enabled, this will be
triggered by Connect scanning the network since Connect sends a Modbus function code 64. Similar Acyclic Read/Write PC Tools can cause a Timeout
Trip for the same reason.

Parameter 4.15.011 Modbus Timeout Event Destination


Short description Defines the destination for the Modbus timeout event
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Module reset, Modbus interface reset
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
or Modbus interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 This slot Trigger event in this slot
1 Slot 1 Trigger event in slot 1
2 Slot 2 Trigger event in slot 2
3 Slot 3 Trigger event in slot 3
4 Slot 4 Trigger event in slot 4

Defines the destination slot to trigger the event (defined by Modbus Timeout Event Type (4.15.012)) when a timeout occurs.

<< This feature is not currently supported >>

Parameter 4.15.012 Modbus Timeout Event Type


Short description Defines the event type to trigger
Minimum 0 Maximum 5
Default 0 Units
Module reset, Modbus interface reset
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
or Modbus interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 No event No event
1 Trigger Event Trigger module Event
2 Trigger Event 1 Trigger module Event 1
3 Trigger Event 2 Trigger module Event 2
4 Trigger Event 3 Trigger module Event 3
5 Trigger Event 4 Trigger module Event 4

Defines the event to trigger when a timeout occurs. Modbus Timeout Event Destination (4.15.011) must specify an appropriate consumer (slot option) of
the event.

Parameter 4.15.013 Modbus Register Addressing Mode


Short description Defines the Modbus register addressing mode
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Module reset, Modbus interface reset
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
or Modbus interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


564 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Value Text Description
0 Standard (mm x 100) + ppp - mm<=162 and ppp<=99
1 Modified (mm x 256) + ppp - mm<=63 and ppp<=255

Specifies the Modbus register addressing mode.

Parameter 4.15.020 Priority Connection 1


Short description Specifies the IP address for the connection
0 4294967295
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0.0.0.0) (Display: 255.255.255.255)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0.0.0.0)
Module reset, Modbus interface reset
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
or Modbus interface enable
Display Format IP Address Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter specifies an IP address for a priority connection.

Note: parameters 20 through 24 must be filled in the order starting from the Priority_Connection_1 through Priority_Connection_5. If a higher numbered
Priority Connection is specified without the lower ones being filled, then it will be ignored.

Parameter 4.15.021 Priority Connection 2


Short description Specifies the IP address for the connection
0 4294967295
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0.0.0.0) (Display: 255.255.255.255)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0.0.0.0)
Module reset, Modbus interface reset
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
or Modbus interface enable
Display Format IP Address Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter specifies an IP address for a priority connection.

Note: parameters 20 through 24 must be filled in the order starting from the Priority_Connection_1 through Priority_Connection_5. If a higher numbered
Priority Connection is specified without the lower ones being filled, then it will be ignored.

Parameter 4.15.022 Priority Connection 3


Short description Specifies the IP address for the connection
0 4294967295
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0.0.0.0) (Display: 255.255.255.255)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0.0.0.0)
Module reset, Modbus interface reset
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
or Modbus interface enable
Display Format IP Address Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter specifies an IP address for a priority connection.

Note: parameters 20 through 24 must be filled in the order starting from the Priority_Connection_1 through Priority_Connection_5. If a higher numbered
Priority Connection is specified without the lower ones being filled, then it will be ignored.

Parameter 4.15.023 Priority Connection 4


Short description Specifies the IP address for the connection
0 4294967295
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0.0.0.0) (Display: 255.255.255.255)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0.0.0.0)
Module reset, Modbus interface reset
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
or Modbus interface enable
Display Format IP Address Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter specifies an IP address for a priority connection.

Note: parameters 20 through 24 must be filled in the order starting from the Priority_Connection_1 through Priority_Connection_5. If a higher numbered
Priority Connection is specified without the lower ones being filled, then it will be ignored.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 565
Parameter 4.15.024 Priority Connection 5
Short description Specifies the IP address for the connection
0 4294967295
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 0.0.0.0) (Display: 255.255.255.255)
0
Default Units
(Display: 0.0.0.0)
Module reset, Modbus interface reset
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
or Modbus interface enable
Display Format IP Address Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter specifies an IP address for a priority connection.

Note: parameters 20 through 24 must be filled in the order starting from the Priority_Connection_1 through Priority_Connection_5. If a higher numbered
Priority Connection is specified without the lower ones being filled, then it will be ignored.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


566 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Slot 4 Menu 20 Single Line Descriptions − EtherNet/IP Setup
Mode: RFC‑A

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 567
Parameter Range Default Type
4.20.001 Enable EtherNet/IP Off (0) or On (1) On (1) RW Bit US
4.20.002 Reset Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
4.20.003 Default Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
No error (0),
RPI event dst (1),
RPI event type (2),
IDLE event dst (3),
4.20.004 Configuration error IDLE event type (4), RO Txt ND NC PT
Input mapping (5),
Output mapping (6),
In cons trig pr (7),
Out cons trig pr (8)
4.20.007 Cyclic data transfers per second 0 to 65535 Messages/s RO Num ND NC PT
Trip (0), Send flt values (1),
4.20.011 RPI timeout action Clear output (2), Hold last (3) RW Txt US
Hold last (3), No Action (4)
This slot (0), Slot 1 (1),
4.20.012 RPI timeout event destination Slot 2 (2), Slot 3 (3), This slot (0) RW Txt US
Slot 4 (4)
No event (0),
Trigger Event (1),
Trigger Event 1 (2),
4.20.013 RPI timeout event type No event (0) RW Txt US
Trigger Event 2 (3),
Trigger Event 3 (4),
Trigger Event 4 (5)
Trip (0), Send flt values (1),
4.20.015 PLC idle action Clear output (2), No Action (4) RW Txt US
Hold last (3), No Action (4)
This slot (0), Slot 1 (1),
4.20.016 PLC idle event destination Slot 2 (2), Slot 3 (3), This slot (0) RW Txt US
Slot 4 (4)
No event (0),
Trigger Event (1),
Trigger Event 1 (2),
4.20.017 PLC idle event type No event (0) RW Txt US
Trigger Event 2 (3),
Trigger Event 3 (4),
Trigger Event 4 (5)
100‑PrimaryI (0),
70‑BscSpdCtrlI (1),
4.20.018 Active input assembly object 71‑ExtSpdCtrlI (2), RO Txt ND NC PT
72‑SpdTqCtrlI (3),
73‑ExtSpdTqCtrlI (4)
101‑PrimaryO (0),
20‑BscSpdCtrlO (1),
4.20.019 Active output assembly object 21‑ExtSpdCtrlO (2), RO Txt ND NC PT
22‑SpdTqCtrlO (3),
23‑ExtSpdTqCtrlO (4)
4.20.020 Input assembly object size 4 to 128 Bytes 8 Bytes RW Num US
4.20.021 Output assembly object size 4 to 128 Bytes 8 Bytes RW Num US
4.20.024 Input assembly object process time 0 to 65535 ms RO Num ND NC PT
4.20.025 Output assembly object process time 0 to 65535 ms RO Num ND NC PT
4.20.026 Input assembly object consistency enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
4.20.027 Input assembly object consistency trigger parameter 0 to 499999 0 RW Num US
4.20.028 Output assembly object consistency enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
4.20.029 Output assembly object consistency trigger parameter 0 to 499999 0 RW Num US
257 ‑ CT (0),
4.20.030 Custom Vendor ID 257 ‑ CT (0) RW Txt US
553 ‑ CT AMERICA (1)
4.20.031 Custom product code 0 to 65535 0 RW Num US
4.20.032 Custom product revision code 0 to 65535 0 RW Num US
4.20.033 Actual Product Code 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT
4.20.034 Actual Product Revision 0 to 65535 RO Num ND NC PT
2‑FC DC (0), 6‑WRI (1),
4.20.040 Type of Motor 1 7‑SCI (2), 9‑Sin PM BL (3), 7‑SCI (2) RO Txt PT US
10‑Trap PM BL (4)
2‑FC DC (0), 6‑WRI (1),
4.20.041 Type of Motor 2 7‑SCI (2), 9‑Sin PM BL (3), 7‑SCI (2) RO Txt PT US
10‑Trap PM BL (4)
4.20.054 QoS DSCP Urgent 0 to 63 55 RW Num US

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


568 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
4.20.055 QoS DSCP Scheduled 0 to 63 47 RW Num US
4.20.056 QoS DSCP High 0 to 63 43 RW Num US
4.20.057 QoS DSCP Low 0 to 63 31 RW Num US
4.20.058 QoS DSCP Explicit 0 to 63 27 RW Num US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 569
Slot 4 Menu 20 − EtherNet/IP Setup
Mode: RFC‑A

The Ethernet interface supports the EtherNet/IP protocol and conforms to the EtherNet/IP adaptation of the Common Industrial Protocol (CIP)
Specification. This is the same upper-layer protocol and object model as used in DeviceNet.

The Ethernet interface will operate as a slave device and the following functionality is supported.

Variable length input assembly object (instance 100)


Variable length output assembly object (instance 101)
Maximum assembly object size of 128 bytes (32 parameters)
Explicit (non-cyclic) access to parameters
A.C. drive profiles
Management of consistent data transfer between the Ethernet interface and user programs.
Configuration via parameters

Parameter Update Rate

Parameters are exchanged over the network. The value exchanged over the network must be exchanged with the drive or option parameter. The rate of
data exchange differs for drive and option destinations.

The diagram below depicts the update cycles used within the Ethernet interface. CIP assembly mappings being exchanged with the drive will be
updated at the background task rate. This rate (Background cycles per second (09.008)) varies with the load on the Ethernet interface Easy Mode data
exchange also takes place in the background task.

Parameter 4.20.001 Enable EtherNet/IP


Short description Set to enable the EtherNet/IP interface
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter is used to enable or disable Ethernet/IP slave functionality.

Parameter 4.20.002 Reset


Short description Set to reset the interface
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Background read; written to 0 on
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate
initialisation
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


570 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
This parameter is used to perform a warm reset of the protocol interface. When set and the protocol has reset, the parameter will be reset to zero (Off).

Parameter 4.20.003 Default


Short description Set to default the protocol interface
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
On module reset, protocol interface
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate
reset or protocol enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

This parameter allows the protocol to be defaulted to factory settings. This includes all of the protocol features, configuration, mappings and stored
objects.

Parameter 4.20.004 Configuration error


Short description Displays the EtherNet/IP configuration error
Minimum 0 Maximum 8
Default Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

Value Text Description


0 No error No error
1 RPI event dst RPI timeout event destination not valid
2 RPI event type RPI timeout event type not valid
3 IDLE event dst PLC IDLE event destination not valid
4 IDLE event type PLC IDLE event type not valid
5 Input mapping Output mapping parameter not valid
6 Output mapping Output mapping parameter not valid
7 In cons trig pr Input consistency trigger parameter not valid
8 Out cons trig pr Output consistency trigger parameter not valid

This parameter is used to display the error code if an Ethernet/IP configuration error occurs.

Parameter 4.20.007 Cyclic data transfers per second


Short description Showing the EIP cyclic data transfer rate
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units Messages/s
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

This parameter shows the EtherNet/IP cyclic data transfer rate.

Parameter 4.20.011 RPI timeout action


Short description Defines the action when an RPI timeout occurs
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 3 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 Trip Trip drive with Slx.Er and sub-trip code
1 Send flt values Send configured fault values to the output parameters
2 Clear output PLC output parameters will have their values set to zero
3 Hold last Hold the last value in output parameters
4 No Action No action with output parameters

This timeout is defined by the EtherNet/IP protocol and is configured in the PLC master. The interface will monitor the data traffic and if data is not
received within the specified time, it will perform the requested action. This indicates that the interface has detected that the cyclic data communication
has been interrupted.

Trip
On an RPI timeout the interface will cause a slot trip with sub trip value 101 (EtherNet/IP RPI Timeout).

Send Fault Values


On an RPI timeout the interface will not trip the drive. It will write the values specified in Fault Values menu (23) to the PLC output mappings for the
assembly object 101 if active.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 571
Clear Output
On an RPI timeout the interface will not trip the drive. It will write all PLC output mappings for the assembly object 101 if active to zero.

Hold Last
On an RPI timeout the interface will not trip the drive. The last value received will be maintained.

No Action
On an RPI timeout the interface will not trip the drive. The last value received will be maintained.

Parameter 4.20.012 RPI timeout event destination


Short description Defines the destination for the RPI timeout event
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 This slot Trigger event in this slot
1 Slot 1 Trigger event in slot 1
2 Slot 2 Trigger event in slot 2
3 Slot 3 Trigger event in slot 3
4 Slot 4 Trigger event in slot 4

This parameter defines the destination slot to trigger the event upon an RPI timeout.

<< This feature is not currently supported >>

Parameter 4.20.013 RPI timeout event type


Short description Sets the event to trigger on RPI timeout
Minimum 0 Maximum 5
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 No event No event
1 Trigger Event Trigger module Event
2 Trigger Event 1 Trigger module Event 1
3 Trigger Event 2 Trigger module Event 2
4 Trigger Event 3 Trigger module Event 3
5 Trigger Event 4 Trigger module Event 4

Defines the event to trigger in the specified destination (RPI timeout event destination (4.20.012)) upon an RPI timeout

Parameter 4.20.015 PLC idle action


Short description Defines the action for a PLC idle event
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 4 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 Trip Trip drive with Slx.Er and sub-trip code
1 Send flt values Send configured fault values to the output parameters
2 Clear output PLC output parameters will have their values set to zero
3 Hold last Hold the last value in output parameters
4 No Action No action with output parameters

This parameter defines the action to be taken upon a PLC idle event.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


572 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.20.016 PLC idle event destination
Short description Defines the destination for a PLC idle event
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 This slot Trigger event in this slot
1 Slot 1 Trigger event in slot 1
2 Slot 2 Trigger event in slot 2
3 Slot 3 Trigger event in slot 3
4 Slot 4 Trigger event in slot 4

This parameter defines the destination slot to trigger the event upon a PLC idle event.

<< This feature is not currently supported >>

Parameter 4.20.017 PLC idle event type


Short description Sets the event to trigger on PLC idle
Minimum 0 Maximum 5
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 No event No event
1 Trigger Event Trigger module Event
2 Trigger Event 1 Trigger module Event 1
3 Trigger Event 2 Trigger module Event 2
4 Trigger Event 3 Trigger module Event 3
5 Trigger Event 4 Trigger module Event 4

Defines the event to trigger in the specified destination (PLC idle event destination (4.20.016)) upon a PLC idle event.

Parameter 4.20.018 Active input assembly object


Short description Sets and displays the active input assembly object
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

Value Text Description


0 100-PrimaryI Primary input (100)
1 70-BscSpdCtrlI Basic speed control input (70)
2 71-ExtSpdCtrlI Extended speed control input (71)
3 72-SpdTqCtrlI Speed and torque control input (72)
4 73-ExtSpdTqCtrlI Extended speed and torque control input (73)

This parameter defines and shows the required input assembly object.

Parameter 4.20.019 Active output assembly object


Short description Sets and displays the active ouput assembly object
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, ND, NC, PT, BU

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 573
Value Text Description
0 101-PrimaryO Primary output (101)
1 20-BscSpdCtrlO Basic speed control output (20)
2 21-ExtSpdCtrlO Extended speed control output (21)
3 22-SpdTqCtrlO Speed and torque control output (22)
4 23-ExtSpdTqCtrlO Extended speed and torque control output (23)

This parameter defines and shows the required output assembly object.

Parameter 4.20.020 Input assembly object size


Short description Defines the size of the input assembly object
Minimum 4 Maximum 128
Default 8 Units Bytes
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter defines the size of the input assembly object (100).

Parameter 4.20.021 Output assembly object size


Short description Defines the size of the output assembly object
Minimum 4 Maximum 128
Default 8 Units Bytes
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter defines the size of the output assembly object (101).

Parameter 4.20.024 Input assembly object process time


Short description Displays the input assembly object process time
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units ms
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

This is the time between getting the input value from the master and it being sent successfully to the drive.

Parameter 4.20.025 Output assembly object process time


Short description Displays the output assembly object process time
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units ms
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

This is the time between getting the output value from the drive and it being sent successfully to the master.

Parameter 4.20.026 Input assembly object consistency enable


Short description Enables or disables consistency on the input assembly object
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

This parameter allows for enabling and disabling input assembly object consistency.

Under normal conditions, cyclic data is sampled and transmitted at the Requested Packet Interval (RPI). However, if an option module was in the
process of modifying the mapped parameters while these parameters were being sampled, then the data transmitted across the network may not be
consistent across the entire assembly object. If read consistency is enabled (and a trigger parameter specified in
Input assembly object consistency trigger parameter (4.20.027)) then data will only be sampled when the trigger parameter
Input assembly object consistency trigger parameter (4.20.027) contains a non-zero value. This trigger parameter will then be set to zero after the data
has been sampled.

It is therefore possible, by controlling the trigger parameters, that a user program in the drive or option module can ensure that the values in the cyclic
data parameters are not sampled until all values are updated. Whether consistency is enabled or not, data will always be consistent for an individual
parameter, i.e. all 4 bytes of a 32 bit value will be consistent.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


574 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.20.027 Input assembly object consistency trigger parameter
Short description Sets the trigger parameter for input assembly object consistency
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter specifies the parameter to use for triggering input assembly object consistency. See Input assembly object consistency enable
(4.20.026) for more information on consistency.

Parameter 4.20.028 Output assembly object consistency enable


Short description Enables or disables consistency on the output assembly object
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

This parameter allows for enabling and disabling output assembly object consistency.

Writing of data can be controlled using consistency by enabling this parameter and setting a trigger
parameter (Output assembly object consistency trigger parameter (4.20.029)).

Consistency enabled

When output assembly object consistency is enabled, the value in the output assembly object consistency trigger parameter
(Output assembly object consistency trigger parameter (4.20.029)) is checked at the beginning of the writing routine. If it is zero then data is written to
the cyclic data destination parameters and the trigger parameter is set to 1. If the value is non-zero then new data is discarded.

Consistency disabled

When output assembly object consistency is disabled, new data is written to the cyclic data destination parameters just after it has been received.

Note : If write consistency is enabled, then at reset or at power-up, the value in the trigger parameter is set to zero.

Parameter 4.20.029 Output assembly object consistency trigger parameter


Short description Sets the trigger parameter for output assembly object consistency
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter specifies the parameter to use for triggering output assembly object consistency. See Output assembly object consistency enable
(4.20.028) for more information on consistency.

Parameter 4.20.030 Custom Vendor ID


Short description Custom Defined Vendor ID
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, BU

Value Text Description


0 257 - CT EtherNet/IP interface
1 553 - CT AMERICA EtherNet/IP America interface

This parameter defines the customised vendor ID.

Parameter 4.20.031 Custom product code


Short description Sets and displays the custom product code
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 575
Parameter S.20.031 provides a way to mimic a legacy drive from a PLC's point of view.

This parameter defines a custom product revision value, which is used to identify the product on the network. It returns a 16 bit value to identify the drive
type, major revision number and the drive mode.

B15 B14 B13 B12 B11 B10 B9 B8 B7 B6 B5 B4 B3 B2 B1 B0

Product code Major Revision Mode 0

Basic product code: Represented by bit number b15, b14, b13 as defined below

Description
Product code

AC Drive DC Drive Type

1 Unidrive SP Mentor MP

2 Commandar SK Reserved

4 GP20 Reserved

5 Digitax ST Reserved

6 Affinity Reserved

Multi-protocol Ethernet - EIP allows connection with the PLC without any modification to an existing PLC project. This is done by disabling the Run/Idle
header checking.

Parameter 4.20.032 Custom product revision code


Short description Sets and displays the custom product revision code
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 16 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter defines a custom product revision value which is used to identify the product on the network.

Higher bytes represents the Major revision number and lower bytes represent the Minor revision number.

For e.g. if the version 127.20 mentioned in EDS file then value should be set as 32532 as shown below,

B15 B14 B13 B12 B11 B10 B9 B8 B7 B6 B5 B4 B3 B2 B1 B0


0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0
127 20

Parameter 4.20.033 Actual Product Code


Short description Displays the actual product code
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

This parameter defines the actual product code.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


576 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.20.034 Actual Product Revision
Short description Display the actual product revision
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

This parameter defines the actual revision number.

Parameter 4.20.040 Type of Motor 1


Short description The type of motor 1
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 2 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, PT, BU

Value Text Description


0 2-FC DC FC DC Motor
1 6-WRI Wound Rotor Induction Motor
2 7-SCI Squirrel Cage Induction Motor
3 9-Sin PM BL Sinusoidal PM BL Motor
4 10-Trap PM BL Trapezoidal PM BL Motor

This parameter defines the type of motor 1

Parameter 4.20.041 Type of Motor 2


Short description The type of motor 2
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 2 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate Reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, PT, BU

Value Text Description


0 2-FC DC FC DC Motor
1 6-WRI Wound Rotor Induction Motor
2 7-SCI Squirrel Cage Induction Motor
3 9-Sin PM BL Sinusoidal PM BL Motor
4 10-Trap PM BL Trapezoidal PM BL Motor

This parameter defines the type of motor 2

Parameter 4.20.054 QoS DSCP Urgent


Short description QoS DSCP Urgent
Minimum 0 Maximum 63
Default 55 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

Parameter indicates QoS Object instance 1's attribute 4. This DSCP value shall be used for the CIP transport class 0/1 Urgent priority messages.

EtherNet/IP 'SET' Service should be used to change the value of this parameter.

Any change to the value of the parameter shall take effect the next time the device restarts.

Parameter 4.20.055 QoS DSCP Scheduled


Short description QoS DSCP Scheduled
Minimum 0 Maximum 63
Default 47 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter indicates QoS object instance 1's attribute 5. This DSCP value shall be used for the CIP transport class 0/1 Scheduled priority

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 577
messages.

EtherNet/IP 'SET' service should be used to change the value of this parameter.

Any change to the value of the parameter shall take effect the next time the device restarts.

Parameter 4.20.056 QoS DSCP High


Short description QoS DSCP High
Minimum 0 Maximum 63
Default 43 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter indicates QoS object instance 1's attribute 6. This DSCP value shall be used for the CIP transport class 0/1 High priority messages.

EtherNet/IP 'SET' service should be used to change the value of this parameter.

Any change to the value of the parameter shall take effect the next time the device restarts.

Parameter 4.20.057 QoS DSCP Low


Short description QoS DSCP Low
Minimum 0 Maximum 63
Default 31 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter indicates QoS object instance 1's attribute 7. This DSCP value shall be used for the CIP transport class 0/1 Low priority messages.

EtherNet/IP 'SET' service should be used to change the value of this parameter.

Any change to the value of the parameter shall take effect the next time the device restarts.

Parameter 4.20.058 QoS DSCP Explicit


Short description QoS DSCP Explicit
Minimum 0 Maximum 63
Default 27 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter indicates QoS object instance 1's attribute 8. This DSCP value shall be used for all EtherNet/IP traffic except class 0/1 messages.
These include CIP UCMM, CIP transport class 2/3 and encapsulation messages.

EtherNet/IP 'SET' service should be used to change the value of this parameter.

Any change to the value of the parameter shall take effect the next time the device restarts.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


578 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Slot 4 Menu 21 Single Line Descriptions − EtherNet/IP In Mappings
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


4.21.001 Input mapping parameter 1 0 to 499999 10040 RW Num PT US
4.21.002 Input mapping parameter 2 0 to 499999 2001 RW Num PT US
4.21.003 Input mapping parameter 3 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.004 Input mapping parameter 4 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.005 Input mapping parameter 5 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.006 Input mapping parameter 6 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.007 Input mapping parameter 7 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.008 Input mapping parameter 8 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.009 Input mapping parameter 9 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.010 Input mapping parameter 10 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.011 Input mapping parameter 11 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.012 Input mapping parameter 12 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.013 Input mapping parameter 13 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.014 Input mapping parameter 14 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.015 Input mapping parameter 15 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.016 Input mapping parameter 16 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.017 Input mapping parameter 17 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.018 Input mapping parameter 18 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.019 Input mapping parameter 19 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.020 Input mapping parameter 20 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.021 Input mapping parameter 21 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.022 Input mapping parameter 22 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.023 Input mapping parameter 23 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.024 Input mapping parameter 24 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.025 Input mapping parameter 25 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.026 Input mapping parameter 26 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.027 Input mapping parameter 27 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.028 Input mapping parameter 28 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.029 Input mapping parameter 29 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.030 Input mapping parameter 30 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.031 Input mapping parameter 31 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.21.032 Input mapping parameter 32 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 579
Slot 4 Menu 21 − EtherNet/IP In Mappings
Mode: RFC‑A

This menu contains the parameters used to define the source parameters for data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.001 Input mapping parameter 1


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 1
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 10040 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.002 Input mapping parameter 2


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 2
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 2001 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.003 Input mapping parameter 3


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 3
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.004 Input mapping parameter 4


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 4
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.005 Input mapping parameter 5


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 5
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.006 Input mapping parameter 6


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 6
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


580 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.007 Input mapping parameter 7


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 7
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.008 Input mapping parameter 8


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 8
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.009 Input mapping parameter 9


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 9
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.010 Input mapping parameter 10


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 10
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.011 Input mapping parameter 11


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 11
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.012 Input mapping parameter 12


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 12
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 581
Parameter 4.21.013 Input mapping parameter 13
Short description Sets input mapping parameter 13
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.014 Input mapping parameter 14


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 14
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.015 Input mapping parameter 15


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 15
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.016 Input mapping parameter 16


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 16
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.017 Input mapping parameter 17


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 17
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.018 Input mapping parameter 18


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 18
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


582 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.21.019 Input mapping parameter 19
Short description Sets input mapping parameter 19
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.020 Input mapping parameter 20


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 20
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.021 Input mapping parameter 21


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 21
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.022 Input mapping parameter 22


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 22
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.023 Input mapping parameter 23


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 23
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.024 Input mapping parameter 24


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 24
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 583
Parameter 4.21.025 Input mapping parameter 25
Short description Sets input mapping parameter 25
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.026 Input mapping parameter 26


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 26
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.027 Input mapping parameter 27


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 27
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.028 Input mapping parameter 28


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 28
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.029 Input mapping parameter 29


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 29
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.030 Input mapping parameter 30


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 30
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


584 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.21.031 Input mapping parameter 31
Short description Sets input mapping parameter 31
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Parameter 4.21.032 Input mapping parameter 32


Short description Sets input mapping parameter 32
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a source parameter for the data that will be transmitted to the PLC.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 585
Slot 4 Menu 22 Single Line Descriptions − EtherNet/IP Out Mappings
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


4.22.001 Output mapping parameter 1 0 to 499999 6042 RW Num PT US
4.22.002 Output mapping parameter 2 0 to 499999 1021 RW Num PT US
4.22.003 Output mapping parameter 3 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.004 Output mapping parameter 4 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.005 Output mapping parameter 5 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.006 Output mapping parameter 6 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.007 Output mapping parameter 7 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.008 Output mapping parameter 8 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.009 Output mapping parameter 9 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.010 Output mapping parameter 10 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.011 Output mapping parameter 11 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.012 Output mapping parameter 12 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.013 Output mapping parameter 13 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.014 Output mapping parameter 14 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.015 Output mapping parameter 15 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.016 Output mapping parameter 16 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.017 Output mapping parameter 17 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.018 Output mapping parameter 18 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.019 Output mapping parameter 19 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.020 Output mapping parameter 20 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.021 Output mapping parameter 21 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.022 Output mapping parameter 22 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.023 Output mapping parameter 23 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.024 Output mapping parameter 24 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.025 Output mapping parameter 25 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.026 Output mapping parameter 26 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.027 Output mapping parameter 27 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.028 Output mapping parameter 28 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.029 Output mapping parameter 29 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.030 Output mapping parameter 30 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.031 Output mapping parameter 31 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US
4.22.032 Output mapping parameter 32 0 to 499999 0 RW Num PT US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


586 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Slot 4 Menu 22 − EtherNet/IP Out Mappings
Mode: RFC‑A

This menu contains the parameters used to define the destination parameters for data that will be received from the PLC

Parameter 4.22.001 Output mapping parameter 1


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 1
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 6042 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.002 Output mapping parameter 2


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 2
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 1021 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.003 Output mapping parameter 3


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 3
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.004 Output mapping parameter 4


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 4
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.005 Output mapping parameter 5


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 5
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.006 Output mapping parameter 6


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 6
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 587
This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.007 Output mapping parameter 7


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 7
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.008 Output mapping parameter 8


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 8
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.009 Output mapping parameter 9


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 9
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.010 Output mapping parameter 10


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 10
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.011 Output mapping parameter 11


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 11
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.012 Output mapping parameter 12


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 12
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


588 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.22.013 Output mapping parameter 13
Short description Sets output mapping parameter 13
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.014 Output mapping parameter 14


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 14
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.015 Output mapping parameter 15


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 15
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.016 Output mapping parameter 16


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 16
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.017 Output mapping parameter 17


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 17
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.018 Output mapping parameter 18


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 18
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 589
Parameter 4.22.019 Output mapping parameter 19
Short description Sets output mapping parameter 19
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.020 Output mapping parameter 20


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 20
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.021 Output mapping parameter 21


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 21
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.022 Output mapping parameter 22


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 22
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.023 Output mapping parameter 23


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 23
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.024 Output mapping parameter 24


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 24
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


590 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.22.025 Output mapping parameter 25
Short description Sets output mapping parameter 25
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.026 Output mapping parameter 26


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 26
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.027 Output mapping parameter 27


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 27
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.028 Output mapping parameter 28


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 28
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.029 Output mapping parameter 29


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 29
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.030 Output mapping parameter 30


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 30
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 591
Parameter 4.22.031 Output mapping parameter 31
Short description Sets output mapping parameter 31
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Parameter 4.22.032 Output mapping parameter 32


Short description Sets output mapping parameter 32
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT, BU

This parameter defines a destination parameter for the data that will be received from the PLC.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


592 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Slot 4 Menu 23 Single Line Descriptions − EtherNet/IP Fault Values
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


4.23.001 Output fault value 1 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.002 Output fault value 2 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.003 Output fault value 3 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.004 Output fault value 4 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.005 Output fault value 5 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.006 Output fault value 6 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.007 Output fault value 7 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.008 Output fault value 8 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.009 Output fault value 9 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.010 Output fault value 10 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.011 Output fault value 11 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.012 Output fault value 12 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.013 Output fault value 13 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.014 Output fault value 14 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.015 Output fault value 15 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.016 Output fault value 16 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.017 Output fault value 17 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.018 Output fault value 18 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.019 Output fault value 19 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.020 Output fault value 20 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.021 Output fault value 21 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.022 Output fault value 22 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.023 Output fault value 23 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.024 Output fault value 24 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.025 Output fault value 25 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.026 Output fault value 26 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.027 Output fault value 27 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.028 Output fault value 28 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.029 Output fault value 29 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.030 Output fault value 30 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.031 Output fault value 31 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US
4.23.032 Output fault value 32 -2147483648 to 2147483647 0 RW Num PT US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 593
Slot 4 Menu 23 − EtherNet/IP Fault Values
Mode: RFC‑A

These parameters define the fault values to sent to the mapped output parameters when a fault occurs.

This menu contains the parameters used to define the values to be sent to the mapped output destinations when fault values have been configured to
be sent after either a RPI timeout event (see RPI timeout action (4.20.011), RPI timeout event destination (4.20.012) and RPI timeout event type
(4.20.013)) or a PLC idle event (see PLC idle action (4.20.015), PLC idle event destination (4.20.016) and PLC idle event type (4.20.017)) has occurred.

Parameter 4.23.001 Output fault value 1


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 1
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.002 Output fault value 2


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 2
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.003 Output fault value 3


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 3
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.004 Output fault value 4


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 4
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.005 Output fault value 5


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 5
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


594 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.23.006 Output fault value 6
Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 6
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.007 Output fault value 7


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 7
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.008 Output fault value 8


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 8
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.009 Output fault value 9


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 9
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.010 Output fault value 10


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 10
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.011 Output fault value 11


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 11
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 595
Parameter 4.23.012 Output fault value 12
Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 12
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.013 Output fault value 13


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 13
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.014 Output fault value 14


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 14
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.015 Output fault value 15


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 15
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.016 Output fault value 16


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 16
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.017 Output fault value 17


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 17
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


596 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.23.018 Output fault value 18
Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 18
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.019 Output fault value 19


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 19
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.020 Output fault value 20


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 20
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.021 Output fault value 21


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 21
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.022 Output fault value 22


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 22
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.023 Output fault value 23


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 23
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 597
Parameter 4.23.024 Output fault value 24
Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 24
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.025 Output fault value 25


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 25
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.026 Output fault value 26


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 26
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.027 Output fault value 27


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 27
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.028 Output fault value 28


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 28
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.029 Output fault value 29


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 29
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


598 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.23.030 Output fault value 30
Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 30
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.031 Output fault value 31


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 31
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Parameter 4.23.032 Output fault value 32


Short description Sets the output fault value for mapping 32
Minimum -2147483648 Maximum 2147483647
Default 0 Units
Module reset, EtherNet/IP interface
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate
reset or EtherNet/IP interface enable
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, PT

This parameter defines the value to be sent to the mapped output destination when fault values have been configured to be sent
(with RPI timeout action (4.20.011) and PLC idle action (4.20.015)).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 599
Slot 4 Menu 24 Single Line Descriptions − Profinet Setup
Mode: RFC‑A

Parameter Range Default Type


4.24.001 Enable Profinet Interface Off (0) or On (1) On (1) RW Bit US
4.24.002 Reset Profinet Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
4.24.003 Profinet Default Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit NC
No Error (0), Input Mapping (1),
Output Mapping (2),
Data Size (3), Param Config (4),
4.24.004 Configuration error No Error (0) RO Txt NC PT
Slot Not Avail (5),
Read Only Param (6),
Out Of Memory (7)
4.24.005 Cyclic data transfers per second 0 to 65535 Messages/s RO Num ND NC PT
4.24.006 Revision counter 0 to 65535 RO Num ND PT
4.24.007 Profile ID 0 to 65535 62976 RO Num PT
4.24.008 Installation Date 00-00-00 to 31-12-99 RO Date ND PT
4.24.009 Profinet Timeout Value 1 to 10000 ms 100 ms RO Num PT
Trip (0), Reserved (1),
4.24.010 Profinet Timeout Action Clear output (2), Hold last (3), No action (4) RW Txt PT US
No action (4)
This slot (0), Slot 1 (1), Slot 2 (2),
4.24.011 Destination For Timeout Event This slot (0) RW Txt PT US
Slot 3 (3), Slot 4 (4)
No Event (0), Trigger Event (1),
Trigger Event 1 (2),
4.24.012 Profinet Timeout Event Type Trigger Event 2 (3), No Event (0) RW Txt PT US
Trigger Event 3 (4),
Trigger Event 4 (5)
4.24.026 Profinet Input Consistency Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
4.24.027 Profinet Input Consistency Trigger 0 to 499999 0 RW Num US
4.24.028 Profinet Output Consistency Enable Off (0) or On (1) Off (0) RW Bit US
4.24.029 Profinet Output Consistency Trigger 0 to 499999 0 RW Num US

RW Read / Write RO Read-only Bit Bit parameter Txt Text string Date Date parameter Time Time parameter
Chr Character parameter Bin Binary parameter IP IP address Mac MAC address Ver Version number SMP Slot, menu, parameter
No
Num Number parameter DE Destination ND RA Rating dependent NC Non-copyable PT Protected
default value
Power-
FI Filtered US User save PS
down save

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


600 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Slot 4 Menu 24 − Profinet Setup
Mode: RFC‑A

The Ethernet interface supports the profinet protocol and conforms the profinet specification version 2.1

Profinet option module feature listed below,

1. Number of slots : 64 slots (32 input and 32 output)

2. Identification and Maintenance : I&M0, I&M1, I&M2, I&M3, I&M4

3. Link Layer Discovery Protocol

4. Dynamic configuration change

5. Cyclic data at 1ms rate

Parameter 4.24.001 Enable Profinet Interface


Short description Enable Profinet Interface
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 1 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

This parameter is used to enable or disable Profinet functionality.

Protocol Mode Sele4.ct
Parameter 4.24.002 Reset Profinet
Short description Reset Profinet
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

This parameter is used to perform a warm reset of the protocol interface. When set and the protocol has reset, the parameter will be reset to zero (Off).

Parameter 4.24.003 Profinet Default


Short description Profinet Default
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit Volatile Update Rate On Module reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, NC

This parameter allows the protocol to be defaulted to factory settings. This includes all of the protocol features, configuration, mappings and stored
communication parameters

Parameter 4.24.004 Configuration error


Short description Display Profinet Configuration Error
Minimum 0 Maximum 7
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit Volatile Update Rate On connect request from PLC
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, TE, NC, PT, BU

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 601
Value Text Description
0 No Error No Configuration Error detected
1 Input Mapping More than 32 input slots configured
2 Output Mapping More than 32 out slots configured
3 Data Size Size given in GSDML and actual size miss match
4 Param Config Param does not exists
5 Slot Not Avail Slot configured in flexible slots and actual fitted slot miss-match
6 Read Only Param Read only param is configured for writing
7 Out Of Memory Not sufficient memory to configure InterOption slots

Value Text Description

0 No Error No Error

1 Input Mapping Error More than 32 inputs parameters are configured

2 Output Mapping Error More than 32 outputs parameters are configured

3 Data Size Error Data size given in GSDML is not matching with the actual parameter size

4 Parameter Configuration Error Parameter given in connect request is either not found or validation failed

Parameter 4.24.005 Cyclic data transfers per second


Short description Showing the Profinet cyclic data transfer rate
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units Messages/s
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, NC, PT, BU

This parameter shows the profinet cyclic data transfer rate

Parameter 4.24.006 Revision counter


Short description Module Revision Counter
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate On module reset or save
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, PT, BU

Initial value of revision counter is 0.

Revision counter will increment if one of the following action is performed,

- On drive parameter save

- On drive parameter default

- On drive mode change

Criteria to reset the revision counter

- When it reaches to 65535, it will reset to 0

Parameter 4.24.007 Profile ID


Short description Profinet Supported Profinet ID
Minimum 0 Maximum 65535
Default 62976 Units
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Background read
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PT, BU

Supported Profinet ID. By default it is 0xF600

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


602 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.24.008 Installation Date
Short description Date when profinet configured
0 311299
Minimum Maximum
(Display: 00-00-00) (Display: 31-12-99)
Default Units
Type 32 Bit Volatile Update Rate On device start or reset
Display Format Date Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, ND, PT, BU

This parameter indicates the date of installation or commissioning of the device.

Installation date will be written by controller and user cannot modify it.

Parameter 4.24.009 Profinet Timeout Value


Short description Timeout value
Minimum 1 Maximum 10000
Default 100 Units ms
Type 16 Bit Volatile Update Rate Connect Request from PLC
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RO, PT, BU

This parameter defines the time period in which PROFINET must receive a cyclic data from PLC before any specified action is performed. Default
timeout value is 100ms and it will be over written by the PLC when connect request is received. User cannot write the timeout value.

Parameter 4.24.010 Profinet Timeout Action


Short description Action on cyclic data timeout
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 4 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate On reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, PT, BU

Value Text Description


0 Trip Trip drive and raise error
1 Reserved Reserved
2 Clear output PLC output parameter will have their values set to zero
3 Hold last Hold the last value in output
4 No action No action

Defines the action when no message is received within the time period specified in Profinet timeout value (S.25.09)

Please note that currently only TRIP option is supported to generate the trip on drive in case of Profinet timeout.

Value Text Description

0 Trip Trip drive and raise error

1 Reserved Reserved

2 Clear output PLC output parameter will have their values set to zero

3 Hold last Hold the last value in output parameters

4 No action No action

Parameter 4.24.011 Destination For Timeout Event


Short description Destination for timout event
Minimum 0 Maximum 4
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate On Module reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, PT, BU

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 603
Value Text Description
0 This slot Trigger event in this slot
1 Slot 1 Trigger event in slot 1
2 Slot 2 Trigger event in slot 2
3 Slot 3 Trigger event in slot 3
4 Slot 4 Trigger event in slot 4

Value Text Description

0 This slot Trigger event in this slot

1 Slot 1 Trigger event in slot 1

2 Slot 2 Trigger event in slot 2

3 Slot 3 Trigger event in slot 3

4 Slot 4 Trigger event in slot 4

Please note that this version of Profinet does not support PROFINET_TIMEOUT_EVENT_DST

Parameter 4.24.012 Profinet Timeout Event Type


Short description Event type trigger
Minimum 0 Maximum 5
Default 0 Units
Type 8 Bit User Save Update Rate On power on/reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, TE, PT, BU

Value Text Description


0 No Event No Event
1 Trigger Event Trigger module event
2 Trigger Event 1 Trigger module event 1
3 Trigger Event 2 Trigger module event 2
4 Trigger Event 3 Trigger module event 3
5 Trigger Event 4 Trigger module Event 4

Value Text Description

0 No event Trigger event in this slot

1 Trigger Event Trigger module event

2 Trigger Event 1 Trigger module event 1

3 Trigger Event 2 Trigger module event 2

4 Trigger Event 3 Trigger module event 3

5 Trigger Event 4 Trigger module event 4

Defines the event to trigger when a timeout occur. Profinet Timeout Event Destination (S.25.011) must specify an appropriate consumer (slot option) of
the event

Please note that this version of PROFINET does not support PROFINET_TIMEOUT_EVENT_TYPE

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


604 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Parameter 4.24.026 Profinet Input Consistency Enable
Short description Profinet Input Consistency Enable
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate Start-up or Reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Value Text Description

0 OFF Consistency is disabled

1 ON Consistency is enabled

Parameter 4.24.027 Profinet Input Consistency Trigger


Short description Profinet Input Consistency Trigger
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate On startup, Reset
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

By default, cyclic data is read from the drive (or via inter-option communication to an option module) just before it is transmitted to the PLC. If the user
wishes to control the sampling of new data (e.g. if an NGA module is putting data into the drive menu 20 parameters and data should not be transmitted
until they have all been updated) then input profinet consistency should be enabled and a trigger parameter selected.

The following scheme is specified:

· When input profinet consistency is disabled, new cyclic data is sampled just prior to transmission. The cyclic data gets updated in background
task.

· When input profinet consistency is enabled, the value in the input profinet consistency trigger parameter (specified by #S.25.27) is checked at the
beginning of the sampling routine. If it is zero then last set of cyclic data is retransmitted. If the value is non-zero then new data is sampled and
transmitted, the trigger parameter value is then set to zero.

If read consistency is enabled, then at reset or following a power cycle, the value in the trigger parameter is set to zero.

In the slot number of parameter S.25.027,

If S = 0 means drive,

If S=1 to 3 means the module in slot 1 to 3, where “S=4” means factory fit module.

Parameter 4.24.028 Profinet Output Consistency Enable


Short description Profinet Output Consistency Enable
Minimum 0 Maximum 1
Default 0 Units
Type 1 Bit User Save Update Rate On starup, Reset
Display Format Standard Decimal Places 0
Coding RW

Value Text Description

0 OFF Consistency is disabled

1 ON Consistency is enabled

Parameter 4.24.029 Profinet Output Consistency Trigger


Short description Profinet Output Consistency Trigger Parameter
Minimum 0 Maximum 499999
Default 0 Units
Type 32 Bit User Save Update Rate On startup, Reset
Display Format Slot Menu Parameter Decimal Places 0
Coding RW, BU

By default, cyclic data is written to the drive (or via inter-option communication to an option module) just after it is received from the PLC. If the user

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 605
wishes to control the writing of new data (e.g. if an NGA module is reading data from drive menu 20 parameters and data should only be read when until
they have all been updated) then output profinet consistency should be enabled and a trigger parameter selected.

The following scheme is specified:

· When input profinet consistency is disabled, new cyclic data is sampled just prior to transmission. This cyclic data gets updated in background
task.

· When output profinet consistency is enabled, the value in the output profinet consistency trigger parameter (specified by #S.25.29) is checked at
the beginning of the writing routine. If it is zero then data is written to the cyclic data destination parameters and the trigger parameter is set to 1. If the
value is non zero the new data is discarded.

If write consistency is enabled, then at reset or following a power cycle, the value in the trigger parameter is set to zero.

In the slot number of parameter S.25.029, “S=0” means drive, “S= 1 to 3” means the module in slot 1 to 3, “S=4” means factory fit module.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


606 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Trips
Mode: RFC‑A

Trip 0 (10.020) to Trip 9 (10.029) store the most recent 10 trips that have occurred where Trip 0 (10.020) is the most recent and Trip 9 (10.029) is the oldest. When
a new trip occurs it is written to Trip 0 (10.020) and all the other trips move down the log, with oldest being lost. The date and time when each trip occurs are also
stored in the date and time log, i.e. Trip 0 Date (10.041) to Trip 9 Time (10.060). The date and time are taken from Date (06.016) and Time (06.017). Some trips
have sub-trip numbers which give more detail about the reason for the trip. If a trip has a sub-trip number its value is stored in the sub-trip log, i.e. Trip 0 Sub-
trip Number (10.070) to Trip 9 Sub-trip Number (10.079). If the trip does not have a sub-trip number then zero is stored in the sub-trip log.

Trip categories and priorities


Trips are grouped into the categories given in the table below. A trip can only occur when the drive is not tripped, or if it is already tripped and the new trip has a
higher priority than the active trip (i.e. lower priority number). Unless otherwise stated a trip cannot be reset until 1.0s after it has been initiated.

Priority Category Trips Comments


These are fatal problems that cannot be reset. All drive features are inactive after any of these trips
1 Internal faults HF01 - HF26 occur. If a basic keypad is fitted it will show the trip, but the keypad will not function. These trips are not
stored in the trip log.
This trip cannot be cleared unless 1299 is entered into Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) and a reset is
1 Stored HF trip Stored HF
initiated.
Trip numbers 218 to 247,
Non-resettable
2 Slot1 HF, Slot2 HF, These trips cannot be reset.
trips
Slot3 HF or Slot4 HF
Volatile memory This can only be reset if Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) is set to 1233 or 1244, or if Load Defaults (11.043)
3 EEPROM Fail
failure is set to a non-zero value.
Internal 24V power
4 PSU 24V
supply
Non-volatile media Trip numbers 174, 175 and
5 These trips are priority 6 during power-up.
trips 177 to 188
Position feedback
5 interface power Encoder 1 This trip can override Encoder 2 to Encoder 6 trips.
supply
Trips with
6 extended reset OI ac, OI Brake, and OI dc These trips cannot be reset until 10s after the trip was initiated.
times
Phase loss and The drive will attempt to stop the motor before tripping if a Phase Loss.000 trip occurs unless this feature
Phase Loss and
6 d.c. link power has been disabled (see Action On Trip Detection (10.037). The drive will always attempt to stop the
OHt dc bus
circuit protection motor before tripping if an OHt dc bus occurs.
6 Standard trips All other trips

Internal faults
Trips {HF01} to {HF26} are internal faults that do not have trip numbers. If one of these trips occurs, the main drive processor has detected an irrecoverable error. All
drive functions are stopped and the trip message will be displayed on the drive keypad. The error can only be reset by powering the drive down and up again. The
table below gives the reasons for internal faults and their corresponding trip.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 607
Trip Reason
{HF01} CPU has detected an address error
{HF02} CPU DMAC has detected an address error
{HF03} CPU has detected an Illegal opcode
{HF04} CPU has detected an Illegal slot instruction
{HF05} An interrupt has occurred that does not have a defined function (Undefined exception)
{HF06} An interrupt has occurred which is reserved (Reserved exception)
{HF07} Watchdog failure
{HF08} CPU Interrupt crash
{HF09} Free store overflow
{HF10} Parameter routing system error
{HF11} Non-volatile memory comms error

Stack overflow. Sub-trip is shown to indicate which stack:


1 - background tasks
{HF12}
2 - timed tasks
3 - main system interrupts

The control hardware is not compatible with the firmware. The sub-trip number gives the actual ID code of the
{HF13}
control board hardware.
{HF14} CPU register bank error
{HF15} CPU divide error
{HF16} RTOS error (the background task has returned)
{HF17} The clock supplied to the control board logic is out of specification

The internal flash memory has failed when writing option module parameter data.

Sub-trip is shown to indicate which failure:


{HF18}
1 - Programming error while writing menu in flash
2 - Erase flash block containing setup menus failed
3 - Erase flash block containing application menus failed

{HF19} Invalid main application firmware CRC. Reprogramming required.


{HF20} The ASIC is not compatible with the firmware. The sub-trip number displayed is the ASIC version.
{HF23} If this trip occurs please consult the drive supplier.
{HF24} If this trip occurs please consult the drive supplier.
{HF25} If this trip occurs please consult the drive supplier.
The control pod is either a UF90A or a UF99A and is fitted to a power stage that is not compatible because it only
{HF26}
provided two phase current feedback. If this trip occurs pleas consult the drive supplier.

When the drive is subsequently powered up a Stored HF trip is initiated where the sub-trip number is the number of the HF trip that last occurred. This trip will occur
at every power-up until it is reset. The trip can only be reset by first entering 1299 into Parameter mm.000 (mm.000). If the drive is powered up and a Stored HF trip
occurs, Onboard User Program: Enable (11.047) is reset to zero to prevent the on-board user program from running. This ensures that the user program can be
changed or erased in case it causes an HF trip at every power-up. Once the Stored HF is cleared, it is necessary to power cycle the drive or to re-download the user
program to allow the program to restart.

Similar trips that can be initiated by the control system or the power system
Trips shown in the table below can be generated either from the drive control system or from the power system. The sub-trip number which is in the form xxyzz is
used to identify the source of the trip. The digits xx are 00 for a trip generated by the control system or the number of a power module if generated by the power
system. If the drive is not a multi-power module drive then xx will always have a value of 1 indicating the trip is related to the power system. The y digit is used to
identify the location of a trip which is generated by a rectifier module connected to a power module. Where the y digit is relevant it will have a value of 1 or more,
otherwise it will be 0. The zz digits give the reason for the trip and are defined in each trip description.

Over Volts OHt dc bus
OI ac Phase Loss
OI Brake Power Comms
PSU OI Snubber
OHt Inverter Cloning
OHt Power Temp Feedback
OHt Control Power Data

Braking IGBT
The list below gives conditions that will disable the braking IGBT:

1. Braking IGBT Upper Threshold (06.074) = 0, or Low Voltage Braking IGBT Threshold Select (06.076) = 1 and Low Voltage Braking IGBT Threshold


(06.075) = 0.
2. The drive is in the under-voltage state.
3. A priority 1, 2 or 3 trip is active (see Trip 0 (10.020)).
4. One of the following trips is active or would be active if another trip is not already active: OI Brake, PSU, Th Brake Res or OHt Inverter.
5. Percentage Of Drive Thermal Trip Level (07.036) = 100%. This is an indication that some part of the drive is too hot and is used to indicate if an
internally fitted braking resistor is too hot.
6. Brake R Too Hot is active or the system has been set up to disable the braking IGBT based on the braking resistor temperature and the resistor is
too hot (i.e. bit 2 of Action On Trip Detection (10.037) is set).

Note that the braking IGBT over-current trip cannot be reset until 10s after it is initiated. This period consists of a 9s period after the trip where the braking IGBT
cannot be switched on again and the OI Brake trip is held active and cannot be reset. This 9s period is followed by the normal 1s delay, that is present for other
trips, before the trip can be reset. During this 1s period it is possible for the braking IGBT to switch on again. If the conditions are still present that caused the trip
then the trip will be initiated again with a further 9s hold-off period etc.

Trips Summary (numerical order)

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


608 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Value Trip
0 None
1 Reserved 001
2 Over Volts
3 OI ac
4 OI Brake
5 PSU
6 External Trip
7 Over Speed
8 Inductance
9 PSU 24V
10 Th Brake Res
11 Autotune 1
12 Autotune 2
13 Autotune 3
14 Autotune 4
15 Autotune 5
16 Autotune 6
17 Autotune 7
18 Autotune Stopped
19 Brake R Too Hot
20 Motor Too Hot
21 OHt Inverter
22 OHt Power
23 OHt Control
24 Thermistor
25 Th Short Circuit
26 I/O Overload
27 OHt dc bus
28 An Input 1 Loss
29 An Input 2 Loss
30 Watchdog
31 EEPROM Fail
32 Phase Loss
33 Resistance
34 Keypad Mode
35 Control Word
36 User Save
37 Power Down Save
38 Low Load
39 Line Sync
40 User Trip 40
41 User Trip 41
42 User Trip 42
43 User Trip 43
44 User Trip 44
45 User Trip 45
46 User Trip 46
47 User Trip 47
48 User Trip 48
49 User Trip 49
50 User Trip 50
51 User Trip 51
52 User Trip 52
53 User Trip 53
54 User Trip 54
55 User Trip 55
56 User Trip 56
57 User Trip 57
58 User Trip 58
59 User Trip 59
60 User Trip 60
61 User Trip 61
62 User Trip 62
63 User Trip 63
64 User Trip 64
65 User Trip 65
66 User Trip 66
67 User Trip 67
68 User Trip 68

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 609
69 User Trip 69
70 User Trip 70
71 User Trip 71
72 User Trip 72
73 User Trip 73
74 User Trip 74
75 User Trip 75
76 User Trip 76
77 User Trip 77
78 User Trip 78
79 User Trip 79
80 User Trip 80
81 User Trip 81
82 User Trip 82
83 User Trip 83
84 User Trip 84
85 User Trip 85
86 User Trip 86
87 User Trip 87
88 User Trip 88
89 User Trip 89
90 Power Comms
91 User 24V
92 OI Snubber
93 Inductor Too Hot
94 Rectifier Set-up
95 Reserved 095
96 User Prog Trip
97 Data Changing
98 Out Phase Loss
99 CAM
100 Reset
101 OHt Brake
102 Cloning
103 Inter-connect
104 Reserved 104
105 Reserved 105
106 Reserved 106
107 Reserved 107
108 Reserved 108
109 OI dc
110 Undefined
111 Configuration
112 User Trip 112
113 User Trip 113
114 User Trip 114
115 User Trip 115
116 User Trip 116
117 User Trip 117
118 User Trip 118
119 User Trip 119
120 User Trip 120
121 User Trip 121
122 User Trip 122
123 User Trip 123
124 User Trip 124
125 User Trip 125
126 User Trip 126
127 User Trip 127
128 User Trip 128
129 User Trip 129
130 User Trip 130
131 User Trip 131
132 User Trip 132
133 User Trip 133
134 User Trip 134
135 User Trip 135
136 User Trip 136
137 User Trip 137
138 User Trip 138

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


610 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
139 User Trip 139
140 User Trip 140
141 User Trip 141
142 User Trip 142
143 User Trip 143
144 User Trip 144
145 User Trip 145
146 User Trip 146
147 User Trip 147
148 User Trip 148
149 User Trip 149
150 User Trip 150
151 User Trip 151
152 User Trip 152
153 User Trip 153
154 User Trip 154
155 User Trip 155
156 User Trip 156
157 User Trip 157
158 User Trip 158
159 User Trip 159
160 Island
161 Reserved 161
162 Encoder 12
163 Encoder 13
164 Encoder 14
165 Reserved 165
166 Reserved 166
167 Reserved 167
168 Reserved 168
169 Voltage Range
170 Reserved 170
171 Reserved 171
172 Reserved 172
173 Reserved 173
174 Card Slot
175 Card Product
176 Name Plate
177 Card Boot
178 Card Busy
179 Card Data Exists
180 Card Option
181 Card Read Only
182 Card Error
183 Card No Data
184 Card Full
185 Card Access
186 Card Rating
187 Card Drive Mode
188 Card Compare
189 Encoder 1
190 Encoder 2
191 Encoder 3
192 Encoder 4
193 Encoder 5
194 Encoder 6
195 Encoder 7
196 Encoder 8
197 Encoder 9
199 Destination
200 Slot1 HF
201 Slot1 Watchdog
202 Slot1 Error
203 Slot1 Not Fitted
204 Slot1 Different
205 Slot2 HF
206 Slot2 Watchdog
207 Slot2 Error
208 Slot2 Not Fitted
209 Slot2 Different

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 611
210 Slot3 HF
211 Slot3 Watchdog
212 Slot3 Error
213 Slot3 Not Fitted
214 Slot3 Different
215 Option Disable
216 Slot App Menu
217 App Menu Changed
218 Temp Feedback
219 An Output Calib
220 Power Data
221 Stored HF
222 Reserved 222
223 Rating Mismatch
224 Drive Size
225 Current Offset
226 Soft Start
227 Sub-array RAM
228 Reserved 228
229 Reserved 229
230 Reserved 230
231 Reserved 231
232 Reserved 232
233 Reserved 233
234 Reserved 234
235 Reserved 235
236 Reserved 236
237 Reserved 237
238 Reserved 238
239 Reserved 239
240 Reserved 240
241 Reserved 241
242 Reserved 242
243 Reserved 243
244 Reserved 244
245 Reserved 245
246 Reserved 246
247 Derivative ID
248 Derivative Image
249 User Program
250 Slot4 HF
251 Slot4 Watchdog
252 Slot4 Error
253 Slot4 Not Fitted
254 Slot4 Different
255 Reset Logs

Trips (alphabetical order)

Trip An Input 1 Loss


Value 28
Short description

Indicates that a current loss was detected in current mode on Analog Input 1 (Terminal 5, 6). In 4-20mA and 20-4mA modes. loss of input is detected if the current
falls below 3mA. See Analog Input 1 Mode (07.007) for further details.

Recommended actions:

Check control wiring is correct.


Check control wiring is undamaged.
Check Analog Input 1 Mode (07.007).
Check that the current signal is present and greater than 3mA.

Trip An Input 2 Loss


Value 29
Short description

Indicates that a current loss was detected in current mode on Analog Input 2 (Terminal 7). In 4-20mA and 20-4mA modes. loss of input is detected if the current falls
below 3mA. See Analog Input 2 Mode (07.011) for further details.

Recommended actions:

Check control wiring is correct.


Check control wiring is undamaged.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


612 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Check Analog Input 2 Mode (07.011).
Check that the current signal is present and greater than 3mA.

Trip An Output Calib


Value 219
Short description

The zero offset calibration of one or both of the analogue outputs has failed. This indicates that the drive hardware has failed, or a voltage has been applied to the
output via a low impedance possibly due to a wiring error.

Sub-trip Reason
1 Output 1 failed
2 Output 2 failed

Recommended actions:

Check the wiring associated with analog outputs.


Remove all the wiring that is connected to analog outputs and perform a recalibration by power cycling the drive.
If trip persists, replace the drive.

Trip App Menu Changed


Value 217
Short description

The customisation table for an application menu has been changed. The sub-trip indicates which menu has changed:

Sub-trip Reason
1 Menu 18
2 Menu 19
3 Menu 20

If more than one menu has changed the lowest menu has priority. Drive user parameters must be saved to prevent this trip on the next power-up.

Recommended actions:

Reset the trip and perform a parameter save to accept the new settings.

Trip Autotune 1
Value 11
Short description

The drive has tripped during an auto-tune. The cause of the trip can be identified from the sub-trip number.

Sub-
Reason Recommended actions
trip
The position feedback did not change when position feedback is Ensure that the motor is free to turn (i.e. mechanical brake is released).
1
being used during rotating auto-tune. Check that the position feedback is selected correctly and operates correctly.
The motor did not reach the required speed during mechanical load Ensure that the motor is free to turn and that the static load plus inertia is not too large
2
measurement. for the drive to accelerate within the test time.
The required commutation signal edge could not be found during a
3 Check that the position feedback signals are connected correctly.
rotating auto-tune with a Commutation Only position feedback device.
The required movement angle cannot be produced during a minimal
4 Reduce the angular movement required.
movement test.
The second part of the minimal movement test during auto-tuning
5 Reduce the angular movement required.
cannot locate the motor flux position accurately.
The phasing offset angle is measured twice during a stationary auto- If a minimal movement test is being used and excessive motor movement is occurring
6 during the test reduce the required angle movement. Otherwise try and increase the
tune and the results are not within 30o of each other. required angle movement.
The motor is moving when a phasing test on enable is selected and
7 the drive is enabled, but the motor is still moving at a speed above the Ensure that the motor is stationary before the drive is enabled.
zero speed threshold.

Trip Autotune 2
Value 12
Short description

The drive has tripped during a rotating auto-tune. The cause of the trip can be identified from the associated sub-trip number.

Sub-
Reason
trip
1 The position feedback direction is incorrect when position feedback is being used during a rotating auto-tune.
A SINCOS encoder with comms is being used for position feedback and the comms position is rotating in the
2
opposite direction to the sine wave based position.

Recommended actions:

Check motor cable wiring is correct.


Check feedback device wiring is correct.
Swap any two motor phases.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 613
Trip Autotune 3
Value 13
Short description

The drive has tripped during a rotating auto-tune or mechanical load measurement. The cause of the trip can be identified from the associated sub-trip number.

Sub-trip Reason
1 Measured inertia has exceeded the parameter range during a mechanical load measurement.
2 The commutation signals changed in the wrong direction during a rotating auto-tune.
3 The mechanical load test has been unable to identify the motor inertia.

Recommended actions for sub-trip 2:

Check motor cable wiring is correct.


Check feedback device U, V and W commutation signal wiring is correct.

Recommended actions for sub-trip 3:

Increase the test level.


If the test was carried out at standstill repeat the test with the motor rotating within the recommended speed range.

Trip Autotune 4
Value 14
Short description

A position feedback device with commutation signals is being used (i.e AB Servo, FD Servo, FR Servo, SC Servo or Commutation Only encoder) and the U
commutation signal did not change during a rotating auto-tune.

Recommended actions:

Check feedback device U commutation signal wiring is correct (Encoder terminals 7 and 8).

Trip Autotune 5
Value 15
Short description

A position feedback device with commutation signals is being used (i.e AB Servo, FD Servo, FR Servo, SC Servo or Commutation Only encoder) and the V
commutation signal did not change during a rotating auto-tune.

Recommended actions:

Check feedback device V commutation signal wiring is correct (Encoder terminals 9 and 10).

Trip Autotune 6
Value 16
Short description

A position feedback device with commutation signals is being used (i.e AB Servo, FD Servo, FR Servo, SC Servo or Commutation Only encoder) and the W
commutation signal did not change during a rotating auto-tune.

Recommended actions:

Check feedback device W commutation signal wiring is correct (Encoder terminals 11 and 12).

Trip Autotune 7
Value 17
Short description

An Autotune 7 trip is initiated during a rotating auto-tune, if the number of motor poles or the position feedback resolution have been set up incorrectly where
position feedback is being used.

Recommended actions:

Check the lines per revolution for the feedback device.


Check the number of poles in Number Of Motor Poles (05.011).

Trip Autotune Stopped


Value 18
Short description

The drive was prevented from completing an auto-tune, because either the Final drive enable or the Final drive run were removed.

Recommended actions:

Check the drive enable signal (Terminal 31) was active during the auto-tune.
Check the run command was active in Digital Input 05 State (08.005) during the auto-tune.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


614 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Trip Brake R Too Hot
Value 19
Short description

This trip indicates that braking resistor overload has timed out. The value in Braking Resistor Thermal Accumulator (10.039) is calculated using
Braking Resistor Rated Power (10.030), Braking Resistor Thermal Time Constant (10.031) and Braking Resistor Resistance (10.061). This trip is initiated when
Braking Resistor Thermal Accumulator (10.039) reaches 100%.

Recommended actions:

Ensure the values entered in Braking Resistor Rated Power (10.030), Braking Resistor Thermal Time Constant (10.031) and Braking Resistor Resistance
(10.061) are correct.
If an external thermal protection device is being used and the braking resistor software overload protection is not required, set
Braking Resistor Rated Power (10.030), Braking Resistor Thermal Time Constant (10.031) and Braking Resistor Resistance (10.061) to 0 to disable the trip.

Trip CAM
Value 99
Short description

Advanced motion controller cam failure.

Sub-trip Reason
AMC Cam Start Index (35.001) > AMC Cam Size (35.003) or AMC Cam Start Position In Segment (35.002) > Cam Table In
1
for the start index
2 AMC Cam Index (35.007) has change by more than 2 in one sample
3 The rate of change at a segment boundary has exceeded the maximum value
The sum of the AMC Cam Position In Segment (35.008) and the change of master position has exceeded the maximum
4
value

Trip Card Access


Value 185
Short description

A communications failure has occurred with a NV media card. If this occurs during a data transfer to the card then the file being written may be corrupted. If this
occurs when data is being transferred from the card then the data transfer may be incomplete. If a parameter file is transferred to the drive and this trip occurs
during the transfer the parameters are not saved to non-volatile memory, and so the original parameters can be restored by powering the drive down and up again.

Recommended actions:

Check the NV media card is installed / located correctly.


Replace the NV media card.

Trip Card Boot


Value 177
Short description

A write to a Menu 0 parameter has been initiated via the keypad by exiting edit mode and Parameter Cloning (11.042) is set up for auto or boot mode, but the
necessary boot file has not been created on the NV media card fitted to the drive to take the new parameter value. This occurs when Parameter Cloning (11.042) is
changed to auto or boot mode, but the drive is not subsequently reset. The action of resetting the trip will create the necessary file and prevent further trips.

If this trip occurs after the drive has attempted to transfer parameters from the NV media card to the drive at boot, then the following sub-trips will give the reason for
the trip.

Sub-trip Reason
1 Failed to open / read / close card file 001 when retrieving drive parameter data
2 Failed to open / write / close drive parameter file
11 Failed to open / read / close card file 001 when retrieving option module slot 1 parameter data
12 Failed to open / write / close option module slot 1 parameter file
21 Failed to open / read / close card file 001 when retrieving option module slot 2 parameter data
22 Failed to open / write / close option module slot 2 parameter file
31 Failed to open / read / close card file 001 when retrieving option module slot 3 parameter data
32 Failed to open / write / close option module slot 3 parameter file
41 Failed to open / read / close card file 001 when retrieving option module slot 4 parameter data
42 Failed to open / write / close option module slot 4 parameter file
3 Failed to open / read / close card file 002 when retrieving onboard user program
4 Failed to open / write / close onboard user program in the drive
5 Drive failed to restart following onboard user program update

Recommended actions:

Ensure that Parameter Cloning (11.042) is correctly set, and then reset the drive to create the necessary file on the NV media card.
Re-attempt the parameter write to the Menu 0 parameter.
Ensure any option modules are correctly fitted
Erase the file on the NV media card and recreate the bootable parameter file

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 615
Trip Card Busy
Value 178
Short description

An attempt has been made to access a file on a NV media card, but the file is already being accessed by an Option Module, such as one of the Applications
modules. No data is transferred.

Recommended actions:

Wait for the Option Module to finish accessing the NV media card and re-attempt the required function.

Trip Card Compare


Value 188
Short description

A compare has been carried out between a file on a NV media card and the drive and these are different and no other NV media card related trips have occurred.

Recommended actions:

Set Pr mm.000 to 0 to reset the trip.


Check to ensure the correct data block on the NV media card has been used for the compare.

Trip Card Data Exists


Value 179
Short description

An attempt has been made to store data on a NV media card, but the file already exists. No data is transferred. The file should be erased first to prevent this trip.

Recommended actions:

Erase the data in data location.


Write data to an alternative data location.

Trip Card Drive Mode


Value 187
Short description

This trip is produced during a compare if the drive mode in the file on the NV media card is different from the current drive mode and the file is a parameter file. This
trip is also produced if an attempt is made to transfer a parameter file where the source and target drive modes are different and the drive mode is outside the range
allowed for the target drive.

Recommended actions:

Ensure the destination drive supports the drive operating mode in the parameter file.
Clear the value in Pr mm.000 and reset the drive.
Ensure destination drive operating mode is the same as the source parameter file.

Trip Card Error


Value 182
Short description

An attempt has been made to access a NV media card, but an error has been detected in the data structure on the card. Resetting this trip will cause the drive to
erase the <MCDF> folder from the NV media card (if it exists) and create the correct folder structure. On an SD card, whilst this trip is still present, missing
directories will be created, and if the header file is missing it will be created. The following sub-trip numbers are used with this trip.

Sub-
Reason
trip
1 The required folder and file structure is not present.
2 The <000> file is corrupted.
Two or more files in the <MCDF\> folder have the same file identification
3
number.

Recommended actions:

Erase all the data blocks and re-attempt the process.


Ensure the card is located correctly.
Replace the NV media card.

Trip Card Full


Value 184
Short description

An attempt has been made to write to a NV media card, but there is insufficient space available. No data is transferred.

Recommended actions:

Delete a data block or the entire NV media card to create space.


Replace the NV media card.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


616 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Trip Card No Data
Value 183
Short description

An attempt has been made to access a non-existent file on a NV media card. No data is transferred.

Recommended actions:

Ensure data block number is correct.

Trip Card Option


Value 180
Short description

A parameter file has been transferred from a NV media card to the drive, but at least one of the option modules are difference between source and target drives.
This trip does not stop the data transfer, but is a warning that the data for the option modules that are different will be set to the default values and not the values
from the card. This trip also applies if a compare is performed between a parameter file on a card and the drive and the option modules fitted are different between
the source and target.

If this trip occurs after the drive has attempted to transfer parameters from the NV media card to the drive at boot, then the following sub-trips will give the reason for
the trip.

Sub-trip Reason
0 One or more option module in the drive differs to the booted image.
1 Option module missing from slot 1
2 Option module missing from slot 2
3 Option module missing from slot 3
4 Option module missing from slot 4

Recommended actions:

Ensure the correct option modules are installed.


Ensure the option modules are in the same option module slot as the parameter set stored.
Press the red reset button to acknowledge that the parameters for one or more of the option modules installed will be at their default values.
This trip can be suppressed by setting Pr mm.000 to 9666 and resetting the drive.

Trip Card Product


Value 175
Short description

If Drive Derivative (11.028) or Product Type (11.063) are different between the source and target drives then this trip is initiated either at power-up or when the card
is accessed. It will have one of the following sub-trip numbers:

Sub-
Reason
trip
If Drive Derivative (11.028) is different between the source and target drives, this trip is initiated either at power-up
or when the SD Card is accessed. Data is still transferred, since this is a warning trip; the trip can be suppressed by
1
entering code 9666 in parameter xx.000, and reseting the drive (this applies the warning suppression flag to the
card).
If Product Type (11.063) is different between the source and target drives or if corruption is detected in the
2 parameter file, this trip is initiated either at power-up or when the SD Card is accessed. This trip can be reset but no
data are transferred in either direction between the drive and the card.
A Unidrive SP parameter value was found that has no equivalent parameter on the destination drive. Data is still
3 transferred, since this is a warning trip; the trip can be suppressed by entering code 9666 in parameter xx.000, and
reseting the drive (this applies the warning suppression flag to the card).

Recommended actions:

Use a different NV media card.


This trip can be suppressed by setting Pr mm.000 to 9666 and resetting the drive.

Trip Card Rating


Value 186
Short description

A parameter file has been transferred from a NV media card to the drive, but the current and/or voltage ratings are different between source and target drive. This
trip does not stop the data transfer, but is a warning that the data for rating dependent parameters may not be the same on the target as the source drive. This trip
also applies if a compare (using Pr mm.000 set to 8yyy) is performed between a parameter file on the card on the drive.

Recommended actions:

Reset the drive to clear the trip.


This trip can be suppressed by setting Pr mm.000 to 9666 and resetting the drive.

Trip Card Read Only


Value 181
Short description

An attempt has been made to modify data on a read-only NV media card or to modify a read-only file (i.e. erase the card, erase a file or create a file). No data is
transferred.

Recommended actions:

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 617
Clear the read only flag by setting Pr mm.000 to 9777 and reset the drive. This will clear the read only flag for all data blocks in the NV media card.

Trip Card Slot


Value 174
Short description

The transfer of an option module application program to or from an application module can fail because the option module does not respond correctly. If this
happens this trip is produced with the sub-trip indicating the option module slot number.

Sub-trip Reason
1 Error in option slot 1
2 Error in option slot 2
3 Error in option slot 3
4 Error in option slot 4

Recommended actions:

Ensure the source / destination option module is installed on the correct slot.

Trip Cloning
Value 102
Short description

If an attempt is made to use the cloning system to back-up the drive and option modules (parameter mm.000 values from 40001 to 40999) or restore the drive and
option modules (parameter mm.000 values from 60001 to 60999) and the action fails then a "Cloning" trip is initiated. The sub-trip value indicates the reason for the
trip.

Sub-
Reason
trip
The option module in Slot 1 has indicated that it will either back-up or restore its data to/from an SD card, but has
1
failed to respond correctly and the system has timed out.
2 As 1, but for Option Slot 2.
3 As 1, but for Option Slot 3.
4 As 1, but for Option Slot 4.
5 Back-up folders exist or cannot be created when a back-up is initiated.
6 The required back-up folders do not exist when a restore is initiated.

Trip Configuration
Value 111
Short description

The Number Of Power Modules Detected (11.071) is different from the number expected. The sub-trip value indicates the number of power modules expected.

Recommended actions:

Ensure that all the power modules are correctly connected and powered up.
Ensure that the value in Number Of Power Modules Detected (11.071) is set to the number of power modules connected.
Set Number Of Power Modules Test (11.035) to 0 to disable the trip if not required.

This trip is also initiated if the number of external rectifiers connected to each power module is less than the number defined by Number Of Rectifiers Expected
(11.096). If this is the reason for the trip the sub-trip is 10x where x is the number of external rectifiers that should be connected.

Recommended actions:

Ensure that all the external rectifiers are connected correctly.


Ensure that the value in Number Of Rectifiers Expected (11.096) is correct.

Trip Control Word


Value 35
Short description

This trip is initiated by setting bit 12 on the control word in Control Word (06.042) when the control word is enabled (Control Word Enable (06.043) = On).

Recommended actions:

Check the value of Control Word (06.042).


Disable the control word in Control Word Enable (06.043).

Trip Current Offset


Value 225
Short description

The current feedback offset is too large to be trimmed correctly. The sub-trip relates to the output phase for which the offset error has been detected.

Sub-trip Phase
1 U
2 V
3 W

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


618 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Recommended actions:

Ensure that there is no possibility of current flowing in the output phase of the drive when the drive is not enabled.
Hardware fault - contact the supplier of the drive.

Trip Data Changing


Value 97
Short description

A user action or a file system write is active that is changing the drive parameters and the drive has become active, i.e. Drive Active (10.002) = 1. The user actions
that change drive parameters are loading defaults, changing drive mode, or transferring data from an NV memory card or a position feedback device to the drive.
The file system actions that will cause this trip to be initiated if the drive is enabled during the transfer are writing a parameter or macro file to the drive, or
transferring a derivative or user program to the drive. It should be noted that none of these actions can be started if the drive is active, and so the trip only occurs if
the action is started and then the drive is enabled.

Recommended actions:

Ensure the drive is not enabled when one of the following is being carried out:
Loading defaults
Changing drive mode
Transferring data from a NV media card or position feedback device
Transferring user programs

Trip Derivative ID
Value 247
Short description

There is a problem with the identifier associated with derivative image which customises the drive. The reason for the trip is given by the sub-trip as follows.

Sub-
Reason for trip
trip
There should be a derivative image in the product but this has been
1
erased.
2 The identifier is out of range.
3 The derivative image has been changed.

Trip Derivative Image


Value 248
Short description

An error has been detected in the derivative product image. The sub-trip indicated the reason for the trip.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 619
Sub-
Reason Comments
trip
1 Divide by zero
2 Undefined trip
Attempted fast parameter access set-up with
3
non-existent parameter
4 Attempted access to non-existent parameter
5 Attempted write to read-only parameter
6 Attempted and over-range write
7 Attempted read from write-only parameter

The image has failed because either its CRC is


incorrect, or there are less than 6 bytes in the Occurs when the drive powers-up or the image is programmed.
30
image or the image header version is less than The image tasks will not run.
5.
The image requires more RAM for heap and
31 As 30.
stack than can be provided by the drive.
The image requires an OS function call that is
32 As 30.
higher than the maximum allowed.

The timed task has not completed in time and


40
has been suspended.
Undefined function called, i.e. a function in the
41 host system vector table that has not been As 40.
assigned.

Core menu customisation table CRC check


51 As 30.
failed
52 Customisable menu table CRC check failed As 30.
Occurs when the drive powers-up or the image is programmed and
53 Customisable menu table changed the table has changed. Defaults are loaded for the derivative menu
and the trip will keep occurring until drive parameters are saved.

The option module fitted in slot 1 is not allowed


61 As 30.
with the derivative image.
The option module fitted in slot 2 is not allowed
62 As 30.
with the derivative image.
The option module fitted in slot 3 is not allowed
63 As 30.
with the derivative image.
The option module fitted in slot 4 is not allowed
64 As 30.
with the derivative image.

An option module that is required by the


70 As 30.
derivative image is not fitted in any slot.
An option module specifically required to be
71 As 30.
fitted in slot 1 not present.
An option module specifically required to be
72 As 30.
fitted in slot 2 not present.
An option module specifically required to be
73 As 30.
fitted in slot 3 not present.
An option module specifically required to be
74 As 30.
fitted in slot 4 not present.

80 *Image is not compatible with the control board Initiated from within the image code.
*Image is not compatible with the control board
81 As 80.
serial number

Recommended actions:

Contact the supplier of the drive.

Trip Destination
Value 199
Short description

This trip indicated that destination output parameters of two or more logic functions (Menus 05, 07, 08, 09, 12 or 14) within the drive are writing to the same
parameter.

Recommended actions:

Set Pr mm.000 to "Destinations" or 12001 and check all visible parameters in all menus for parameter write conflicts.

Trip Drive Size


Value 224
Short description

This trip indicates that the control PCB has not recognized the drive size of the power circuit to which it is connected.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


620 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Recommended actions:

Ensure the drive is programmed to the latest software version.


Hardware fault - return drive to supplier.

Trip EEPROM Fail


Value 31
Short description

EEPROM Fail trip indicates that default parameters have been loaded because of the reasons given below.

Sub-trip Reason
1 The most significant digit of the internal parameter database version number has changed.
2 The CRC's applied to the parameter data stored in internal non-volatile memory indicate that a
valid set of parameters cannot be loaded.
3 The drive mode restored from internal non-volatile memory is outside the allowed range for the
product or the derivative image does not allow the previous drive mode.
4 The drive derivative image has been changed and it has changed the customisation of the drive
core menus.
5 The power stage hardware has been change and changed the customisation of the drive core
menus.
6 The internal I/O hardware has been change and changed the customisation of the drive core
menus.
7 The position feedback interface hardware has been change and changed the customisation of the
drive core menus.
8 The control board hardware has been change and changed the customisation of the drive core
menus.
9 The checksum on the non-parameter area of the EEPROM has failed.

The drive holds two banks of user save parameters and two banks of power down save parameters in non-volatile memory. If the last bank of either set of
parameters that was saved is corrupted a User Save or Power Down Save trip is produced. If one of these trips occurs the parameters values that were last saved
successfully are used. It can take some time to save parameters when requested by the user and if the power is removed from the drive during this process it is
possible to corrupt the data in the non-volatile memory.

If both banks of user save parameters or both banks of power down save parameters are corrupted or one of the other conditions given in the table above
occurs EEPROM Fail.xxx trip is produced. If this trip occurs it is not possible to use the data that has been saved previously, and so the drive will be in lowest
allowed drive mode with default parameters. The trip can only be reset if Parameter mm.000 (mm.000) is set to 10, 11, 1233 or 1244 or if Load Defaults (11.043) is
set to a non-zero value.

Recommended actions:

Default the drive and perform a drive reset.


Allow sufficient time to perform a save before the supply to the drive is removed.
If the trip persists, return drive to the supplier.

Trip Encoder 1
Value 189
Short description

Drive position feedback interface power supply overloaded. Terminals 13 & 14 of the 15 way D-type connector can supply a maximum current of 200mA at 15V or
300mA at 5V.

Recommended actions:

Check encoder power supply wiring.


Disable the termination resistors (P1 Termination Select (03.039) set to 0) to reduce current consumption.
For 5V encoders with long cables, select 8V (P1 Supply Voltage (03.036)) and fit a 5V voltage regulator close to the encoder.
Check the encoder specification to confirm it is compatible with the encoder port power supply current capability.
Replace the encoder.
Use an external power supply with higher current capability.

Trip Encoder 2
Value 190
Short description

There is a wire break between the drive and the position feedback device. These trips are provided for the P1 position feedback interface only and the exact cause
of the trip can be identified from the sub-trip number as given below.

Sub-trip Signals
1 Resolver or SINCOS sine wave signals
11 Digital incremental A signal
12 Digital incremental B signal
13 Digital incremental Z signal
14 SC SC device single turn sine wave commutation signals.
15 SC SC device marker

This trip can occur if the position feedback device type selected in P1 Device Type (03.038) is not correct for the position feedback device connected to the drive.

Recommended actions:

Ensure that the position feedback device type selected in P1 Device Type (03.038) is correct for the position feedback device connected to the P1 interface
on the drive.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 621
If wire break detection on the drive encoder input is not required, set bit 0 of P1 Error Detection Level (03.040) to 0 to disable the Encoder 2 trip.
If the trip is due to the digital incremental Z (marker signal) this is often not connected. Check that this trip is disabled by setting P1 Termination Select
(03.039) to a value that disables the termination on this input, which will disable hardware wire break detection.
Check cable continuity.
Check wiring of feedback signals is correct.
Check encoder power supply is set correctly (P1 Supply Voltage (03.036)).
Replace the encoder.

Trip Encoder 3
Value 191
Short description

The drive has detected an incorrect UVW phase angle while running (RFC-S mode only) or SINCOS phase error. The feedback device which has caused the trip
can be identified by the sub-trip number.

Sub-trip Reason
1 Drive position feedback interface 1
2 Drive position feedback interface 2

Recommended actions:

Check encoder shield connections.


Ensure the encoder cable is one uninterrupted cable.
Check the encoder signal for noise with an oscilloscope.
Check the integrity of the encoder mechanical mounting.
For a UVW servo encoder, ensure that the phase rotation of the UVW commutation signals is the same as the phase rotation of the motor.
For a SINCOS encoder, ensure that motor and incremental SINCOS connections are correct and that for forward rotation of the motor, the encoder rotates
clockwise (when looking at the shaft of the encoder).
Repeat the offset measurement test.

Trip Encoder 4
Value 192
Short description

This trip indicates that the encoder communications has timed out or the communications position message transfer time is too long. This trip can also be caused
due to a wire break in the communication channel between the drive and the encoder. The feedback device which has caused the trip can be identified by the sub-
trip number.

Sub-trip Reason
1 Drive position feedback interface 1
2 Drive position feedback interface 2

Recommended actions:

Ensure the encoder power supply setting (P1 Supply Voltage (03.036)) is correct.


Complete encoder auto-configuration (P1 Auto-configuration Select (03.041) = Enabled).
Check the encoder wiring.
If using an EnDat, BiSS or SSI encoder ensure the the DATA channel uses pins 1/2 and the clock uses pins 3/4. This is different to a SCEnDat, SC BiSS or
SC SSI encoder which uses the DATA channel on pins 5/6 and clock on 11/12.
Replace the feedback device.

Trip Encoder 5
Value 193
Short description

This trip indicates that there is a checksum or CRC error, or the SSI encoder is not ready. The Encoder 5 trip can also indicate a wire break to a communications
based encoder.

Sub-trip Reason
1 Drive position feedback interface 1
2 Drive position feedback interface 2

Recommended actions:

Check the encoder cable shield connections.


Ensure the cable is one uninterrupted cable - remove any connector blocks or if unavoidable minimise the length of any shield pigtails to the connector
block.
Check the encoder signal for noise with an oscilloscope.
Check P1 Comms Bits (03.035).
If using a Hiperface or EnDat encoder, carry out an encoder auto-configuration (P1 Auto-configuration Select (03.041) = Enabled).
If using a BiSS encoder ensure the CRC is set correctly in P1 Additional Configuration (03.074). For most BiSS encoders P1 Additional Configuration
(03.074) should be set to 67 000 000.
If using a BiSS encoder ensure that P1 Calculation Time (03.060) is correct for the encoder. With some encoders this may need increasing from the default
value. This may be specified on the encoder datasheet as tbusy.
Replace the encoder.

Trip Encoder 6
Value 194
Short description

This trip indicates that the encoder has indicated an error or that the power supply has failed to an SSI encoder. This trip can also indicate a wire break to an SSI
encoder.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


622 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Sub-trip Reason
1 Drive position feedback interface 1
2 Drive position feedback interface 2

Recommended actions:

Check the wiring. Check that all data and clock signals are connected correctly and the screen is terminated correctly.
For SSI encoders check the encoder power supply setting (P1 Supply Voltage (03.036)) and comms bits (P1 Comms Bits (03.035)).
For a correctly configured BiSS or SC BiSS encoder this trip indicates that the encoder has detected an error, otherwise this trip will often occur
if P1 Comms Bits (03.035) is not set correctly because a position or CRC bit may be read instead of the /Error bit.
For EnDat or SC EnDat encoders this trip indicates that the encoder has detected an error.
For SC Hiperface encoders this trip indicates that the encoder has detected an error.
Replace the encoder / contact the supplier of the encoder.

Trip Encoder 7
Value 195
Short description

A set-up parameter for the position feedback device has been changed. See P1 Error Detection Level (03.040).

Sub-trip Reason
1 Drive position feedback interface 1
2 Drive position feedback interface 2

Trip Encoder 8
Value 196
Short description

This trip indicates that the position feedback interface communications time exceeds 250us. The feedback device which has caused the trip can be identified by the
sub-trip number.

Sub-trip Reason
1 Drive position feedback interface 1
2 Drive position feedback interface 2

Recommended actions:

Ensure the encoder is connected correctly.


Ensure that the encoder is compatible.
Increase baud rate.

Trip Encoder 9
Value 197
Short description

This indicates that the position feedback selected from an option slot that does not contain a position feedback category option module.

Recommended action:

Check the setting of Motor Control Feedback Select (03.026) (or M2 Motor Control Feedback Select (21.021) if the second motor parameters have been
enabled).
Ensure that the option slot selected in Motor Control Feedback Select (03.026) has a feedback option module installed.

Trip Encoder 12
Value 162
Short description

This trip indicates that the drive is communicating with the encoder but the encoder type is not recognised.

Sub-trip Reason
1 Drive position feedback interface 1
2 Drive position feedback interface 2

Recommended actions:

Enter the encoder setup parameters manually.


Check to see if the encoder supports auto-configuration.

Trip Encoder 13
Value 163
Short description

This trip indicates that the data read from the encoder was out of range during auto-configuration. No parameters will be modified with data read from the encoder
as a result of auto-configuration. The tens in the sub-trip number indicate the interface number (i.e. 1 for P1 interface and 2 for P2 interface).

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 623
Sub-trip Reason
x1 Rotary lines per revolution error
x2 Linear comms pitch error
x3 Linear line pitch error
x4 Rotary turns bits error
x5 Communications bits error
x6 Calculation time is too long
x7 Line delay measured is longer than 5us

Recommended actions:

Enter the encoder setup parameters manually.


Check to see if the encoder supports auto-configuration.

Trip Encoder 14
Value 164
Short description

The data given in the additional configuration parameter for a position feedback interface is out of range. If the sub-trip number is one then the data is out of range in
P1 Additional Configuration (03.074), or if the sub-trip number is 2 the data is out of range in P2 Additional Configuration (03.174). Not all position feedback devices
use the additional configuration, but those that do are listed below.

BiSS
Range checking is applied to the turns padding (decimal digits 5-3) and position padding (decimal digits 2-0). If these give a padding value outside +/-16 then the
trip is initiated. Note that in each case the most significant digit indicates left (0) or right (1) padding, and the least significant 2 digits indicate the number of bits.

Trip External Trip


Value 6
Short description

External trip is initiated as shown in the table below.

Sub-trip Reason
1 External Trip Mode  (08.010) = 1 or 3 and SAFE TORQUE OFF Input 1 is low
2 External Trip Mode  (08.010) = 2 or 3 and SAFE TORQUE OFF Input 2 is low
3 External Trip (10.032) = 1

Recommended actions:

Check the SAFE TORQUE OFF signal voltage on terminal 31 is 24V.


Check the value of STO Input 01 State (08.009) which indicates the digital state of terminal 31.
If external trip detection of the SAFE TORQUE OFF input is not required, set External Trip Mode  (08.010) to Off (0).
Check the value of External Trip (10.032).
Select "Destinations" (or enter 12001) in Pr mm.000 and check for a parameter controlling External Trip (10.032).
Ensure External Trip (10.032) or User Trip (10.038) (=6) is not being used by serial comms.

Trip I/O Overload


Value 26
Short description

This trip indicates that the total current drawn from the 24V user supply or from the digital output has exceeded the limit. A trip is initiated if one or more of the
following conditions:

Maximum output current from one digital output is 100mA.


The combined maximum output current from outputs 1 and 2 is 100mA.
The combined maximum output current from output 3 and +24V output is 100mA.

Recommended actions:

Check total loads on digital outputs.


Check control wiring is correct.
Check output wiring is undamaged.

Trip Inductance
Value 8
Short description

This trip occurs in RFC-S mode when the drive has detected that the motor inductances are not suitable for the operation being attempted. The trip is either caused
because the ratio or difference between Ld and Lq is too small or because the saturation characteristic of the motor cannot be measured.

If the inductance ratio or difference is too small this is because one of the following conditions is true:

(No-load Lq (05.072)- Ld (05.024)) / Ld (05.024) < 0.1

(No-load Lq (05.072) - Ld (05.024)) < (K / Full Scale Current Kc (11.061))H

where:

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


624 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Drive Rated Voltage (11.033) K
200V 0.0073
400V 0.0146
575V 0.0174
690V 0.0209

If the saturation characteristic of the motor cannot be measured this is because when the flux in the motor is changed the measured value of Ld does not change
sufficiently due to saturation to be measured. When half of Rated Current (05.007) is applied in the d axis of the motor in each direction the inductance must change
by at least (K / (2 x Full Scale Current Kc (11.061))) H.

The specific reasons for each of the sub-trips are given in the table below.

Sub-
Reason
trip
1 The inductance ratio or difference is too small when the drive has been started in sensorless mode.
2 The saturation characteristic of the motor cannot be measured when the drive has been started in sensorless mode.
The inductance ratio or difference is too small when an attempt is made to determine the location of the motor flux
during a stationary auto-tune in RFC-S mode. This trip is also produced when the inductance ratio or inductance
3 difference is too small when carrying out a phasing test on starting in RFC-S mode. If position feedback is being
used the measured value for Position Feedback Phase Angle (03.025) may not be reliable. Also the measured
values of Ld (05.024) and No-load Lq (05.072) may not correspond to the d and q axis respectively.
The direction of the flux in the motor is detected by the change of inductance with different currents. This trip is
4 initiated if the change cannot be detected when an attempt is made to perform a stationary auto-tune when position
feedback is being used, or to perform a phasing test on starting in RFC-S mode.

Trip Inductor Too Hot


Value 93
Short description

Regen inductor overload. See Inductor Thermal Time Constant (04.015).

Trip Inter-connect
Value 103
Short description

Multi-power module drive interconnection cable error. The sub-trip "xx000" indicates which power module has detected the fault where xx is the power module
number. This trip is also initiated if the number of modules present changes from the number of modules detected at power-up. In this case the sub-trip is the
number of modules that are still communicating correctly.

Trip Island
Value 160
Short description

This trip indicates that a regen system is connected to an island supply. The sub-trips indicate the reason for the trip.

Sub-
Reason
trip
1 Island detection system has been enabled and detected an island condition
The minimum synchronisation voltage is non-zero and the supply voltage has been below this threshold and been
2
simulating its own supply synchronisation for more than 2.0s.

Recommended actions:

Check the supply / supply connections to the regen drive.

Trip Keypad Mode


Value 34
Short description

If keypad reference mode is enabled (Reference Selected Indicator (01.049) = 4 or 6) (i.e. Reference Selector (01.014) is set to 4 or 6 if motor map 1 is selected,
or M2 Reference Selector (21.003) is set to 4 or 6 if motor map 2 is selected) and the keypad removed, then this trip is initiated.

Recommended actions:

Re-install keypad and reset.


Change Reference Selector (01.014) to select the reference from another source.

Trip Line Sync


Value 39
Short description

This trip indicates that the inverter has lost the synchronization with the ac supply in Regen mode.

Recommended actions:

Check the supply / supply connections to the regen drive.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 625
Trip Low Load
Value 38
Short description

This trip is initiated if the low load detector is set up to produce a trip on low load detection and this condition occurs. See Enable Trip On Low Load (04.029).

Trip Motor Too Hot


Value 20
Short description

This trip indicates a motor thermal overload based on the Rated Current (05.007) and Motor Thermal Time Constant 1 (04.015). Motor Protection Accumulator
(04.019) displays the motor temperature as a percentage of the maximum value. The drive will trip on Motor Too Hot when Motor Protection Accumulator
(04.019) gets to 100%.

Recommended actions:

Ensure the load is not jammed / sticking.


Check the load on the motor has not changed.
If seen during an auto-tune test in RFC-S mode, ensure the Rated Current (05.007) is = Heavy duty current rating of the drive.
Tune the Rated Speed (05.008) (RFC-A mode only).
Check feedback signal for noise.
Ensure the Rated Current (05.007) is not zero.

Trip Name Plate


Value 176
Short description

This trip is initiated if there is a problem detected when an electronic name plate transfer from the motor to the drive is initiated. The reasons for the trip are given
below:

Sub-trip Reason Details

It is unlikely that this sub-trip will occur as most encoder errors will cause and encoder
1 A communication error with the encoder has been detected. trip. It is possible that incorrect data in the nameplate could cause this trip, and so the
nameplate data should be verified.

A data error has been detected in the nameplate. This is either


because the number of entries is out of range, i.e. less than 1 or Either there is no valid nameplate in the position feedback device or there is a data
2
greater than 168, or the calculated CRC does not match the CRC error in the nameplate area.
from the nameplate.

If the encoder is connected to a drive interface, then this occurs because the encoder
is not connected to the drive or is not initialised.
If the encoder is connected to an option module interface, then this occurs because
3 The exchange with the encoder has timed out.
the position feedback interface (i.e. P1 or P2) is not present on the option module, or
a suitable position feedback device is not selected, or because no device is
connected, or it is not initialised.

Trip None
Value 0
Short description

No trip has been stored in this position in the trip log.

Trip OHt Brake


Value 101
Short description

This trip indicates that braking IGBT over-temperature has been detected based on firmware thermal model.

Recommended actions:

Check braking resistor value is greater than or equal to the minimum resistance value.

Trip OHt Control


Value 23
Short description

This trip indicates that a control stage over-temperature has been detected. From the sub-trip "xxyzz", the cause of the trip can be identified as follows:

Source xx y zz
Control 00 0 01: Control board thermistor 1
system
Control 00 0 02: Control board thermistor 2
system
Control 00 0 03: I/O board thermistor (or brake resistor thermistor)
system

Recommended actions:

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


626 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Check enclosure / drive fans are still functioning correctly.
Check enclosure ventilation paths.
Check enclosure door filters.
Increase ventilation.
Reduce the drive switching frequency.
Check ambient temperature.

Trip OHt dc bus


Value 27
Short description

This trip indicates a DC bus component over temperature based on a firmware thermal model. The drive includes a thermal protection system to protect the DC bus
components within the drive. This includes the effects of the output current and DC bus ripple. The estimated temperature is displayed as a percentage of the trip
level in Percentage Of d.c. Link Thermal Trip Level (07.035). If this parameter reaches 100% then an OHt dc bus trip with sub-trip 200 is initiated. The drive will
attempt to stop the motor before tripping. If the motor does not stop in 10 seconds then the drive trips immediately.

Source xx y zz
Control 00 2 00: D.c. link thermal model gives {OHt dc bus} trip with sub-trip 0.
system

It is also possible in a multi-power module system for d.c. link over-temperature to be detected from within the power stage. From this source the estimated
temperature as a percentage of trip is not available and the trip is indicated as follows:

Source xx y zz
Control 01 0 00: Power stage gives {OHt dc bus} trip with sub-trip 0.
system

Recommended actions:

Check the AC supply voltage balance and levels.


Check the DC bus ripple level.
Reduce duty cycle.
Reduce motor load.
Check output current stability. If unstable;
Check the motor map settings with motor nameplate (Rated Frequency (05.006), Rated Current (05.007), Rated Speed (05.008), Rated Voltage
(05.009), Rated Power Factor (05.010) and Number Of Motor Poles (05.011)) - (All modes).
Disable slip compensation (Enable Slip Compensation (05.027) = Off (0)) - (Open-loop).
Disable dynamic V to F operation (Dynamic V To F Select (05.013) = Off (0)) - (Open-loop).
Select fixed boost (Open-loop Control Mode (05.014) = Fixed (2)) - (Open-loop).
Select high stability space vector modulation (High Stability Space Vector Modulation (05.019) = On (1)) - (Open-loop).
Disconnect the load and complete a rotating auto-tune (Auto-tune (05.012) = 2) - (RFC-A and RFC-S).
Auto-tune the rated speed value (Rated Speed Optimisation Select (05.016) = 1) - (RFC-A and RFC-S).
Reduce speed loop gains (Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010), Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1 (03.011) and
Speed Controller Differential Feedback Gain Kd1 (03.012)) - (RFC-A and RFC-S).
Add a speed feedback filter value (P1 Feedback Filter (03.042)) - (RFC-A and RFC-S).
Add a current demand filter (Current Reference Filter 1 Time Constant (04.012)) - (RFC-A and RFC-S).
Check encoder signals for noise with an oscilloscope - (RFC-A and RFC-S).
Check encoder mechanical coupling - (RFC-A and RFC-S).

Trip OHt Inverter


Value 21
Short description

This trip indicates that an IGBT junction over-temperature has been detected based on a firmware thermal model. The sub-trip indicates which model has initiated
the trip in the form xxyzz as given below.

Source xx y zz
Control 00 1 00: Inverter thermal model
system
Control
00 3 00: Braking IGBT thermal model
system
Control
00 4 00: Rectifier thermal model
system

Recommended actions with sub-trip 100:

Reduce the selected drive switching frequency.


Ensure Auto-switching Frequency Change (05.035) is set to Enabled (0).
Reduce duty cycle.
Decrease acceleration / deceleration rates.
Reduce motor load.
Check the DC bus ripple.
Ensure all three input phases are present and balanced.

Recommended actions with sub-trip 300:

Reduce the braking load.

Recommended actions with sub-trip 400:

Check the AC supply voltage balance and levels.


Check the DC bus ripple level.
Reduce duty cycle.
Reduce motor load.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 627
Trip OHt Power
Value 22
Short description

This trip indicates that a power stage over-temperature has been detected. The sub-trip "xxyzz" indicates which thermistor is indicating the over-temperature. The
thermistor numbering is different for a single module type drive (i.e. no parallel board fitted) and a multi-module type drive (i.e. parallel board fitted with one or more
power modules) as shown below:

Single module type drive:

Source xx y zz
Power system 01 0 zz: Thermistor location defined by zz in the power board
Power Rectifier
01 zz: Thermistor location defined by zz in the rectifier
system number

Multi-module type system:

Source xx y zz
Power Power module
0 01: U phase power device
system number
Power Power module
0 02: V phase power device
System number
Power Power module
0 03: W phase power device
system number
Power Power module
0 04: Rectifier
system number
Power Power module
0 05: General power system
system number

Power Power module


0 00: Braking IGBT
system number

Note that the power module that has caused the trip cannot be identified except for the braking IGBT temperature measurement

Recommended actions:

Check enclosure / drive fans are still functioning correctly.


Force the heatsink fans to run at maximum speed.
Check enclosure ventilation paths.
Check enclosure door filters.
Increase ventilation.
Reduce duty cycle.
Decrease acceleration / deceleration rates.
Reduce motor loads.
Check the derating tables and confirm the drive is correctly sized for the application.
Use a drive with larger current / power rating.

Trip OI ac
Value 3
Short description

This trip indicates that the instantaneous drive output current has exceeded the drive over current threshold.

Source xx y zz
Control 00: Instantaneous over-current trip when the measured a.c. current exceeds
00 0
system over current threshold
Power module 00: Instantaneous over-current trip when the measured a.c. current exceeds
Power system 0
number over current threshold.

The over current threshold is the maximum current the drive can measure and is defined by VM_DRIVE_CURRENT[MAX].

Recommended actions:

Acceleration / deceleration rate is too short.


If seen during auto-tune reduce the voltage boost.
Check for short circuit on the output cabling.
Check integrity of the motor insulation using a Megger.
Check feedback device wiring.
Check feedback drive mechanical coupling.
Check feedback signals are free from noise.
Check motor cable is within limits for the frame size.
Reduce the speed loop gains (Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010), Speed Controller Integral Gain Ki1 (03.011),
Speed Controller Differential Feedback Gain Kd1 (03.012)).
Check that the phase angle auto-tune has been completed (RFC-S mode only).
Reduce the current loop gains (RFC-A and RFC-S modes only).

Trip OI Brake
Value 4
Short description

This trip indicates that an over-current has been detected in braking IGBT or braking IGBT protection has been activated. The braking IGBT over-current trip is
detected within the power system. If the drive is a single module drive then there is no sub-trip. If the drive is a multi-power module drive the following sub-trip is
used to indicate the source of the trip.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


628 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Source xx y zz
Power module
Power system 0 00: Braking IGBT instantaneous over-current trip
number

Recommended actions:

Check brake resistor wiring.


Check braking resistor value is greater than or equal to the minimum resistance value.
Check braking resistor insulation.

Trip OI dc
Value 109
Short description

This trip indicates that the short circuit protection for the drive output stage has been activated. The table below shows where the trip has been detected.

Source xx y zz
Control
00 0 00
system
Power module
Power system 0 00
number

Recommended actions:

Disconnect the motor cable at the drive end and check the motor and cable insulation with a Megger.
Replace the drive.

Trip OI Snubber
Value 92
Short description

This trip indicates that an over-current condition has been detected in the rectifier snubbing circuit, The exact cause of the trip can be identified by the sub-trip
number.

Source xx y zz
Power system 01 Rectifier 00: Rectifier snubber over-current trip detected.
number*

*For a parallel power-module system the rectifier number will be one as it is not possible to determine which rectifier has detected the fault.

Recommended actions:

Ensure the internal EMC filter is installed.


Ensure the motor cable length does not exceed the maximum for selected switching frequency.
Check for supply voltage imbalance.
Check for supply disturbance such as notching from a DC drive.
Check the motor and motor cable insulation with a Megger.
Fit an output line reactor or sinusoidal filter.

Trip Option Disable


Value 215
Short description

During drive mode changeover option modules must acknowledge that they have stopped accessing the communications system between the option slots and the
drive. If an option module does not do this in the allowed time then this trip is produced.

Recommended actions:

Reset the trip.


If the trip persists, replace the option module.

Trip Out Phase Loss


Value 98
Short description

This trip indicates that phase loss has been detected at the drive output.

Sub-trip Reason
1 U phase output not connected when drive is enabled*
2 V phase output not connected when drive is enabled*
3 W phase output not connected when drive is enabled*
4 Output phase loss detected when the drive is running
5 U phase lower IGBT failure detection on drive enable
6 V phase lower IGBT failure detection on drive enable
7 W phase lower IGBT failure detection on drive enable
*These sub-trips could also indicate that the upper IGBT has failed in the indicated phase.
Note that if Reverse Output Phase Sequence (05.042) = 1 the physical output phases are reversed, and so sub-trip 3 refers to physical output phase V and sub-trip
2 refers to physical output phase W.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 629
Recommended actions:

Check motor and drive connections.


To disable the trip set Output Phase Loss Detection Enable (06.059) to zero.

Trip Over Speed


Value 7
Short description

In open-loop mode, if the Output Frequency (05.001) exceeds the threshold set in Over Speed Threshold (03.008) in either direction, an Over Speed trip is
produced. In RFC-A and RFC-S modes, if the Speed Feedback (03.002) exceeds the threshold set in Over Speed Threshold (03.008) in either direction, an
Over Speed trip is produced. If Over Speed Threshold (03.008) is set to 0.0 the threshold is then equal to 1.2 x the value set in Maximum Reference Clamp
(01.006).

In RFC-A and RFC-S modes if an SSI encoder is being used and P1 SSI Incremental Mode (03.047) is set to Off, an Over Speed trip will be produced when the
encoder passes through the boundary between its maximum position and zero.

Recommended actions:

Reduce the Speed Controller Proportional Gain Kp1 (03.010) to reduce the speed overshoot (RFC-A and RFC-S modes only).
If an SSI encoder is being used, set P1 SSI Incremental Mode (03.047) to On.

The above description relates to a standard over speed trip, however in RFC-S mode it is possible to produce an Overspeed trip with sub-trip 1. This is caused if the
speed is allowed to exceed the safe level in RFC-S mode with flux weakening. See Enable High Speed Mode (05.022) for details.

Trip Over Volts


Value 2
Short description

This trip indicates that the DC bus voltage has exceeded VM_DC_VOLTAGE[MAX] or VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX] for 15s. The trip threshold varies depending
on voltage rating of the drive drive as shown below.

Voltage rating VM_DC_VOLTAGE[MAX] VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX]


200 415 410
400 830 815
575 990 970
690 1190 1175

The exact cause of the trip can be identified by the sub-trip number.

Source xx y zz
Control 00 0 01: Instantaneous trip when the d.c. link voltage exceeds
system VM_DC_VOLTAGE[MAX].
Control 00 0 02: Time delayed trip indicating that the d.c. link voltage is above
system VM_DC_VOLTAGE_SET[MAX].

Recommended actions:

Increase deceleration ramp.


Decrease the braking resistor value (staying above the minimum value).
Check nominal AC supply level.
Check for supply disturbances which could cause the DC bus level to rise.
Check motor insulation using a Megger.

Trip Phase Loss


Value 32
Short description

This trip indicates that the drive has detected an input phase loss or large supply imbalance. Phase loss can be detected directly from the supply where the drive
has a thyristor base charge system (Frame size 7 and above). If phase loss is detected using this method the drive trips immediately and the xx part of the sub-trip
is set to 01. In all sizes of drive phase loss is also detected by monitoring the ripple in the d.c. link voltage in which case the drive attempts to stop the drive before
tripping unless bit 2 of Action On Trip Detection (10.037) is set to one. When phase loss is detected by monitoring the ripple in the d.c. link voltage the xx part of the
sub-trip is zero.

Source xx y zz
Control 00 0 00: Phase loss detected from d.c. link ripple
system
Power 01 Rectifier number 00: Phase loss detected directly from the supply
system (1) (2)

(1) Input phase loss detection can be disabled when the drive required to operate from the DC supply or from a single phase supply in
Input Phase Loss Detection Mode (06.047).

(2) For a parallel power-module system the rectifier number will be one as it is not possible to determine which rectifier has detected the fault.

This trip does not occur in regen mode.

Recommended actions:

Check that the input power supply connections are good and tightened correctly.
Check the AC supply voltage balance and level at full load.
Check the DC bus ripple level with an isolated oscilloscope.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


630 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Check the output current stability.
Reduce the duty cycle.
Reduce the motor load.
Disable the phase loss detection by setting Input Phase Loss Detection Mode (06.047) to Disabled.

Trip Power Comms


Value 90
Short description

A Power Comms trip indicates a communications problem within the power system of the drive. The reason for the trip can be identified by the sub-trip number.

Type of drive xx y zz
Single power 01 Rectifier 00: Excessive communications errors detected by the rectifier module.
module number*
system

*For a parallel power-module system the rectifier number will be one as it is not possible to determine which rectifier has detected the fault.

Recommended actions:

Hardware fault - contact the supplier of the drive.

Trip Power Data


Value 220
Short description

This trip can be generated either from the drive control system or from the power system.

This trip is produced if there is an error in the configuration data stored in the power system. If the source of the trip is the control system then the trip related to the
table that is uploaded from the power system at power-up.

Source xx y zz
Control
00 0 02: There is no data table to be uploaded to the control board.
system
Control 03: The power system data table is bigger than the space available in the
00 0
system control pod to store it.
Control
00 0 04: The size of the table given in the table is incorrect
system
Control
00 0 05: Table CRC error.
system
06: The version number of the generator software that produced the table is
Control
00 0 too low, i.e. a table from a newer generator is required that includes features
system
that have been added to the table that may not be present.
Control 07: The power board data table does not
00 0
system match the power board hardware identifier.
00: The power data table used internally by the power module has an error.
Power system 01 0 (For a multi-power module drive this indicates any error with the code tables
in the power system.)
01: The power data table that should be uploaded to the control system on
Power system 01 0
power up has an error.
02: The power data table used internally by the power module does not
Power system 01 0
match the hardware identification of the power module.

Recommended actions:

Hardware fault - contact the supplier of the drive.

Trip Power Down Save


Value 37
Short description

This trip indicates that an error has been detected in the power down save parameters stored in non-volatile memory.

Recommended actions:

Perform a 1001 save in Pr mm.000 to ensure that the trip doesn't occur the next time the drive is powered up.

Trip PSU
Value 5
Short description

This trip indicates that one or more internal power supply rails are outside limits or overloaded.

Source xx Y zz
Control
00 0 00: Internal power supply overload.
system
Power module Rectifier
Power system 00: Rectifier internal power supply overload.
number number*

*For a parallel power-module system the rectifier number will be zero as it is not possible to determine which rectifier has detected the fault.

Recommended actions:

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 631
Remove any option modules and perform a reset.
Remove encoder connection and perform a reset.
Hardware fault within the drive - return the drive to the supplier.

Trip PSU 24V


Value 9
Short description

The total user load of the drive and option modules has exceeded the internal 24V power supply limit. The user load consists of the drive digital outputs and main
encoder supply.

Recommended actions:

Reduce the load and reset.


Provide an external 24V power supply on control terminal 2.
Remove all option modules.

Trip Rating Mismatch


Value 223
Short description

This trip indicates that there is a voltage rating or current rating mismatch in a multi-module drive system. This trip is only applicable to modular drives that are
connected in parallel. A mixture of power modules with different voltage or current ratings within the same multi-module drive system is not allowed and will cause
a Rating Mismatch trip.

Recommended actions:

Ensure that all modules in a multi-modular drive system are of the same frame size and rating (voltage and current).
Hardware fault - contact the supplier of the drive.

Trip Rectifier Set-up


Value 94
Short description

A rectifier has not been set-up correctly in a multi-power module system.

Recommended actions:

Check the inter-power module wiring

Trip Reserved 001


Value 1
Short description

This trip value is used in Unidrive SP for an under voltage trip. The under voltage condition is now a drive state, and so this trip is no longer used by the drive.

Trip Reserved 095


Value 95
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 104


Value 104
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 105


Value 105
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 106


Value 106
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 107


Value 107
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 108


Value 108
Short description

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


632 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 161


Value 161
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 165


Value 165
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 166


Value 166
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 167


Value 167
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 168


Value 168
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 170


Value 170
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 171


Value 171
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 172


Value 172
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 173


Value 173
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 222


Value 222
Short description

If this trip occurs please consult the drive supplier.

Trip Reserved 228


Value 228
Short description

If this trip occurs please consult the drive supplier.

Trip Reserved 229


Value 229
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 230


Value 230
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 633
Trip Reserved 231
Value 231
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 232


Value 232
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 233


Value 233
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 234


Value 234
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 235


Value 235
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 236


Value 236
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 237


Value 237
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 238


Value 238
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 239


Value 239
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 240


Value 240
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 241


Value 241
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 242


Value 242
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 243


Value 243
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


634 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Trip Reserved 244
Value 244
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 245


Value 245
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reserved 246


Value 246
Short description

Reserved trip number.

Trip Reset
Value 100
Short description

This is not a valid trip number as this value is used in User Trip (10.038) to reset the drive.

Trip Reset Logs


Value 255
Short description

This is not a valid trip number as this value is used in User Trip (10.038) to reset the trip logs.

Trip Resistance
Value 33
Short description

This trip indicates that either the value being used for motor stator resistance is too high or that an attempt to do a test involving measuring motor stator resistance
has failed. The maximum for the stator resistance parameters is generally higher than the maximum value that can be used in the control algorithms. If the value
exceeds (VFS / √2) / Full Scale Current Kc (11.061), where VFS is the full scale d.c. link voltage defined by VM_DC_VOLTAGE, then this trip is initiated. If the value
is the result of a measurement made by the drive then sub-trip 1 is applied, or if it is because the parameter has been changed by the user then sub-trip 3 is applied.
During the stator resistance section of auto-tuning an additional test is performed to measured the drive inverter characteristics to provide the compensation
necessary for dead-times. If the inverter characteristic measurement fails then sub-trip 2 is applied.

Sub-
Reason
trip
1 Measured stator resistance exceeded the allowed range
2 It was not possible to measure the inverter characteristic
The stator resistance associated with the presently selected motor map
3
exceeds the allowed range

Recommended actions:

Check that a value has not been entered in the stator resistance for the presently selected motor map does not exceed the allowed range.
Check the motor cable / connections.
Check the integrity of the motor stator winding using an insulation tester.
Check the motor phase to phase resistance at the drive terminals.
Check the motor phase to phase resistance at the motor terminals.
Ensure the stator resistance of the motor falls within the range of the drive model.
Select fixed boost mode (Open-loop Control Mode (05.014) = Fixed) and verify the output current waveforms with an oscilloscope.
Replace the motor.

Trip Slot1 Different


Value 204
Short description

If the option module fitted in option slot 1 is different to the option module present at the last power-down then this trip is produced. The sub-trip number gives the
identification code of the module that was originally fitted. The priority order for the option module different trips is Slot1 Different highest, then Slot2 Different, then
Slot3 Different then Slot4 Different. Drive user parameters must be saved to prevent this trip on the next power-up if the module has changed. If the menus have
been changed, but not the module, the trip will not occur on the next power-up. The sub-trip number gives the following indications of the reason for the trip.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 635
Sub-trip Reason

1 No module was fitted previously

A module with the same identifier is fitted, but the set-up menu for this option slot has been
2
changed, and so default parameters have been loaded for this menu.

A module with the same identifier is fitted, but the applications menu for this option slot has been
3
changed, and so default parameters have been loaded for this menu.

A module with the same identifier is fitted, but the set-up and applications menu for this option slot
4
have been changed, and so default parameters have been loaded for these menus.

>99 Shows the identifier of the module previously fitted.

Recommended actions:

Turn off the power, ensure the correct option modules are installed in the correct option slots and re-apply the power.
Confirm that the currently installed option module is correct, ensure option module parameters are set correctly and perform a user save in Pr mm.000.

Trip Slot1 Error


Value 202
Short description

The option module in option slot 1 has indicated an error. The option module can give the reason for the error and this is shown in the sub-trip number. As default
the sub-trip number is shown as a number on the display, however, it is possible for the option module to supply sub-trip number strings which will be displayed
instead of the number if available.

Recommended actions:

See relevant Option Module User Guide for details of the trip.

Trip Slot1 HF
Value 200
Short description

This trip indicates that there is a fault with the option module in option slot 1 that means that this module cannot operate. The possible causes of the trip are given by
the sub-trip value.

Sub-trip Reason

1 The module category cannot be identified

All the required customisable menu table information has not been supplied or the tables supplied
2
are corrupt

3 There is insufficient memory available to allocate the comms buffers for this module.

4 The module has not indicated that it is running correctly during drive power-up

The module has been removed after power-up or it has ceased to indicate to the drive processor
5
that it is still active.

The module has not indicated that it has stopped accessing drive parameters during a drive mode
6
change

7 The module has failed to acknowledge that a request has been made to reset the drive processor.

8 The drive failed to read correctly the menu table from the module during drive power-up.
9 The drive failed to upload menu tables from the module and timed-out (5s).
10 Menu table CRC invalid.

Recommended actions:

Ensure the option module is installed correctly.


Replace the option module.
Replace the drive.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


636 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Trip Slot1 Not Fitted
Value 203
Short description

Each option module fitted in the drive is identified at power-up and the option fitted is stored by the drive in its non-volatile memory. If an option module was fitted in
slot 1 at power-down, but that option module has subsequently been removed before power up then this trip is produced. The sub-trip number gives the
identification code of the option module that has been removed. The priority order for the option module not fitted trips is Slot1 Not Fitted highest, then
Slot2 Not Fitted, then Slot3 Not Fitted then Slot4 Not Fitted. Drive user parameters must be saved to prevent this trip on the next power-up.

Recommended actions:

Ensure the option module is installed correctly.


Re-install the option module.
To confirm that the removed option module is no longer required perform a save function in Pr mm.000.

Trip Slot1 Watchdog


Value 201
Short description

This trip indicates that the option module in option slot 1 has started the option watchdog function and then failed to service this watchdog correctly.

Recommended actions:

Replace the option module.

Trip Slot2 Different


Value 209
Short description

If the option module fitted in option slot 2 is different to the option module present at the last power-down then this trip is produced. The sub-trip number gives the
identification code of the module that was originally fitted. The priority order for the option module different trips is Slot1 Different highest, then Slot2 Different, then
Slot3 Different then Slot4 Different. Drive user parameters must be saved to prevent this trip on the next power-up if the module has changed. If the menus have
been changed, but not the module, the trip will not occur on the next power-up. The sub-trip number gives the following indications of the reason for the trip.

Sub-trip Reason

1 No module was fitted previously

A module with the same identifier is fitted, but the set-up menu for this option slot has been
2
changed, and so default parameters have been loaded for this menu.

A module with the same identifier is fitted, but the applications menu for this option slot has been
3
changed, and so default parameters have been loaded for this menu.

A module with the same identifier is fitted, but the set-up and applications menu for this option slot
4
have been changed, and so default parameters have been loaded for these menus.

>99 Shows the identifier of the module previously fitted.

Recommended actions:

Turn off the power, ensure the correct option modules are installed in the correct option slots and re-apply the power.
Confirm that the currently installed option module is correct, ensure option module parameters are set correctly and perform a user save in Pr mm.000.

Trip Slot2 Error


Value 207
Short description

The option module in option slot 2 has indicated an error. The option module can give the reason for the error and this is shown in the sub-trip number. As default
the sub-trip number is shown as a number on the display, however, it is possible for the option module to supply sub-trip number strings which will be displayed
instead of the number if available.

Recommended actions:

See relevant Option Module User Guide for details of the trip.

Trip Slot2 HF
Value 205
Short description

This trip indicates that there is a fault with the option module in option slot 2 that means that this module cannot operate. The possible causes of the trip are given by
the sub-trip value.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 637
Sub-trip Reason

1 The module category cannot be identified

All the required customisable menu table information has not been supplied or the tables supplied
2
are corrupt

3 There is insufficient memory available to allocate the comms buffers for this module.

4 The module has not indicated that it is running correctly during drive power-up

The module has been removed after power-up or it has ceased to indicate to the drive processor
5
that it is still active.

The module has not indicated that it has stopped accessing drive parameters during a drive mode
6
change

7 The module has failed to acknowledge that a request has been made to reset the drive processor.

8 The drive failed to read correctly the menu table from the module during drive power-up.
9 The drive failed to upload menu tables from the module and timed-out (5s).
10 Menu table CRC invalid.

Recommended actions:

Ensure the option module is installed correctly.


Replace the option module.
Replace the drive.

Trip Slot2 Not Fitted


Value 208
Short description

Each option module fitted in the drive is identified at power-up and the option fitted is stored by the drive in its non-volatile memory. If an option module was fitted in
slot 2 at power-down, but that option module has subsequently been removed before power up then this trip is produced. The sub-trip number gives the
identification code of the option module that has been removed. The priority order for the option module not fitted trips is Slot1 Not Fitted highest, then
Slot2 Not Fitted, then Slot3 Not Fitted then Slot4 Not Fitted. Drive user parameters must be saved to prevent this trip on the next power-up.

Recommended actions:

Ensure the option module is installed correctly.


Re-install the option module.
To confirm that the removed option module is no longer required perform a save function in Pr mm.000.

Trip Slot2 Watchdog


Value 206
Short description

This trip indicates that the option module in option slot 2 has started the option watchdog function and then failed to service this watchdog correctly.

Recommended actions:

Replace the option module.

Trip Slot3 Different


Value 214
Short description

If the option module fitted in option slot 3 is different to the option module present at the last power-down then this trip is produced. The sub-trip number gives the
identification code of the module that was originally fitted. The priority order for the option module different trips is Slot1 Different highest, then Slot2 Different, then
Slot3 Different then Slot4 Different. Drive user parameters must be saved to prevent this trip on the next power-up if the module has changed. If the menus have
been changed, but not the module, the trip will not occur on the next power-up. The sub-trip number gives the following indications of the reason for the trip.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


638 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Sub-trip Reason

1 No module was fitted previously

A module with the same identifier is fitted, but the set-up menu for this option slot has been
2
changed, and so default parameters have been loaded for this menu.

A module with the same identifier is fitted, but the applications menu for this option slot has been
3
changed, and so default parameters have been loaded for this menu.

A module with the same identifier is fitted, but the set-up and applications menu for this option slot
4
have been changed, and so default parameters have been loaded for these menus.

>99 Shows the identifier of the module previously fitted.

Recommended actions:

Turn off the power, ensure the correct option modules are installed in the correct option slots and re-apply the power.
Confirm that the currently installed option module is correct, ensure option module parameters are set correctly and perform a user save in Pr mm.000.

Trip Slot3 Error


Value 212
Short description

The option module in option slot 3 has indicated an error. The option module can give the reason for the error and this is shown in the sub-trip number. As default
the sub-trip number is shown as a number on the display, however, it is possible for the option module to supply sub-trip number strings which will be displayed
instead of the number if available.

Recommended actions:

See relevant Option Module User Guide for details of the trip.

Trip Slot3 HF
Value 210
Short description

This trip indicates that there is a fault with the option module in option slot 3 that means that this module cannot operate. The possible causes of the trip are given by
the sub-trip value.

Sub-trip Reason

1 The module category cannot be identified

All the required customisable menu table information has not been supplied or the tables supplied
2
are corrupt

3 There is insufficient memory available to allocate the comms buffers for this module.

4 The module has not indicated that it is running correctly during drive power-up

The module has been removed after power-up or it has ceased to indicate to the drive processor
5
that it is still active.

The module has not indicated that it has stopped accessing drive parameters during a drive mode
6
change

7 The module has failed to acknowledge that a request has been made to reset the drive processor.

8 The drive failed to read correctly the menu table from the module during drive power-up.
9 The drive failed to upload menu tables from the module and timed-out (5s).
10 Menu table CRC invalid.

Recommended actions:

Ensure the option module is installed correctly.


Replace the option module.
Replace the drive.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 639
Trip Slot3 Not Fitted
Value 213
Short description

Each option module fitted in the drive is identified at power-up and the option fitted is stored by the drive in its non-volatile memory. If an option module was fitted in
slot 3 at power-down, but that option module has subsequently been removed before power up then this trip is produced. The sub-trip number gives the
identification code of the option module that has been removed. The priority order for the option module not fitted trips is Slot1 Not Fitted highest, then
Slot2 Not Fitted, then Slot3 Not Fitted then Slot4 Not Fitted. Drive user parameters must be saved to prevent this trip on the next power-up.

Recommended actions:

Ensure the option module is installed correctly.


Re-install the option module.
To confirm that the removed option module is no longer required perform a save function in Pr mm.000.

Trip Slot3 Watchdog


Value 211
Short description

This trip indicates that the option module in option slot 3 has started the option watchdog function and then failed to service this watchdog correctly.

Recommended actions:

Replace the option module.

Trip Slot4 Different


Value 254
Short description

If the option module fitted in option slot 4 is different to the option module present at the last power-down then this trip is produced. The sub-trip number gives the
identification code of the module that was originally fitted. The priority order for the option module different trips is Slot1 Different highest, then Slot2 Different, then
Slot3 Different then Slot4 Different. Drive user parameters must be saved to prevent this trip on the next power-up if the module has changed. If the menus have
been changed, but not the module, the trip will not occur on the next power-up. The sub-trip number gives the following indications of the reason for the trip.

Sub-trip Reason

1 No module was fitted previously

A module with the same identifier is fitted, but the set-up menu for this option slot has been
2
changed, and so default parameters have been loaded for this menu.

A module with the same identifier is fitted, but the applications menu for this option slot has been
3
changed, and so default parameters have been loaded for this menu.

A module with the same identifier is fitted, but the set-up and applications menu for this option slot
4
have been changed, and so default parameters have been loaded for these menus.

>99 Shows the identifier of the module previously fitted.

Recommended actions:

Turn off the power, ensure the correct option modules are installed in the correct option slots and re-apply the power.
Confirm that the currently installed option module is correct, ensure option module parameters are set correctly and perform a user save in Pr mm.000.

Trip Slot4 Error


Value 252
Short description

The option module in option slot 4 has indicated an error. The option module can give the reason for the error and this is shown in the sub-trip number. As default
the sub-trip number is shown as a number on the display, however, it is possible for the option module to supply sub-trip number strings which will be displayed
instead of the number if available.

Recommended actions:

See relevant Option Module User Guide for details of the trip.

Trip Slot4 HF
Value 250
Short description

This trip indicates that there is a fault with the option module in option slot 4 that means that this module cannot operate. The possible causes of the trip are given by
the sub-trip value.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


640 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Sub-trip Reason

1 The module category cannot be identified

All the required customisable menu table information has not been supplied or the tables supplied
2
are corrupt

3 There is insufficient memory available to allocate the comms buffers for this module.

4 The module has not indicated that it is running correctly during drive power-up

The module has been removed after power-up or it has ceased to indicate to the drive processor
5
that it is still active.

The module has not indicated that it has stopped accessing drive parameters during a drive mode
6
change

7 The module has failed to acknowledge that a request has been made to reset the drive processor.

8 The drive failed to read correctly the menu table from the module during drive power-up.
9 The drive failed to upload menu tables from the module and timed-out (5s).
10 Menu table CRC invalid.

Recommended actions:

Ensure the option module is installed correctly.


Replace the option module.
Replace the drive.

Trip Slot4 Not Fitted


Value 253
Short description

Each option module fitted in the drive is identified at power-up and the option fitted is stored by the drive in its non-volatile memory. If an option module was fitted in
slot 4 at power-down, but that option module has subsequently been removed before power up then this trip is produced. The sub-trip number gives the
identification code of the option module that has been removed. The priority order for the option module not fitted trips is Slot1 Not Fitted highest, then
Slot2 Not Fitted, then Slot3 Not Fitted then Slot4 Not Fitted. Drive user parameters must be saved to prevent this trip on the next power-up.

Recommended actions:

Ensure the option module is installed correctly.


Re-install the option module.
To confirm that the removed option module is no longer required perform a save function in Pr mm.000.

Trip Slot4 Watchdog


Value 251
Short description

This trip indicates that the option module in option slot 4 has started the option watchdog function and then failed to service this watchdog correctly.

Recommended actions:

Replace the option module.

Trip Slot App Menu


Value 216
Short description

This trip indicates that more than one option slot has requested to customize application menus 18, 19 and 20. The sub-trip number indicates which option slot has
been allowed to customize the menus.

Recommended actions:

Ensure that only one of the Application modules is configured to customize the application menus 18, 19 and 20.

Trip Soft Start


Value 226
Short description

This trip indicates that the soft start relay in the drive has failed to close or the soft start monitoring circuit has failed.

Recommended actions:

Hardware fault - contact the supplier of the drive.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 641
Trip Stored HF
Value 221
Short description

If an HF01 to HF19 trip occurs then a Stored HF trip occurs each time the drive is powered up until this trip is reset. The sub-trip code is the number of the original
HF trip. The Stored HF trip can only be reset by first writing 1299 to Pr mm.000 and resetting the drive.

Recommended actions:

Enter 1299 into Pr mm.000 and press reset to clear the trip.

Trip Sub-array RAM


Value 227
Short description

An option module, derivative image or user program image has requested more parameter RAM than is allowed. The RAM allocation is checked in order of resulting
sub-trip numbers, and so the failure with the highest sub-trip number is given. The sub-trip is calculated as (parameter size x 1000) + (parameter type x 100) + sub-
array number. Note that if this trip occurs, all menu customisation provided by option modules, the derivative image or the user program image is not used. The
tables below show the values corresponding to the parts of the sub-trip number.

Parameter size Value


1 bit 1
8 bit 2
16 bit 3
32 bit 4
64 bit 5

Parameter type Value


Volatile 0
User save 1
Power-down save 2

Sub-array Menus Value


Applications menus 18-20 1
Derivative image 29 2
User program image 30 3
Option slot 1 set-up 15 4
Option slot 1 applications 25 5
Option slot 2 set-up 16 6
Option slot 2 applications 26 7
Option slot 3 set-up 17 8
Option slot 3 applications 27 9
Option slot 4 set-up 24 10
Option slot 4 applications 28 11

Trip Temp Feedback


Value 218
Short description

This trip indicates a fault with a thermistor in the drive (i.e. open circuit or short circuit).

Source xx y zz
01: Control board thermistor 1
Control
00 00 02: Control board thermistor 2
board
03: I/O board thermistor
Zero for temperature feedback provided via power system
Power Power module
0 comms.
system number
21, 22 and 23 for direct ELV temperature feedback.
Rectifier
Power system 01 Always zero
number*

*For a parallel power-module system the rectifier number will be one as it is not possible to determine which rectifier has detected the fault.

Recommended actions:

Hardware fault - contact the supplier of the drive.

Trip Th Brake Res


Value 10
Short description

If hardware based braking resistor thermal monitoring is provided and the resistor overheats this trip is initiated. If the braking resistor is not present then this trip
must be disabled with bit 3 of Action On Trip Detection (10.037) to prevent this trip.

Recommended actions:

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


642 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Check braking resistor wiring.
Check braking resistor value is greater than or equal to the minimum resistance value.
Check braking resistor insulation.

Trip Th Short Circuit


Value 25
Short description

This trip indicates that a temperature sensor connected to an analogue input or terminal 15 on the position feedback interface has a low impedance (i.e. < 50
Ohms). The cause of the trip can be identified by the sub-trip number.

Sub-trip Source
1 Analogue input 1
2 Analogue input 2
3 Analogue input 3
4 Position feedback interface

Recommended actions:

Check temperature feedback connection.


Replace sensor.

Trip Thermistor
Value 24
Short description

This trip indicates that a temperature sensor connected to one of the analogue inputs or terminal 15 on the position feedback interface (15 way D-type connector)
has indicated an over-temperature. The source of the trip can be identified by the sub-trip number.

Sub-trip Source
1 Analogue input 1
2 Analogue input 2
3 Analogue input 3
4 Position feedback interface

Recommended actions:

Check why the temperature measured by the sensor is too high temperature.
Check temperature sensor connection.

Trip Undefined
Value 110
Short description

This trip indicates that the power system has generated but did not identify the trip from the power system. The cause of the trip is unknown.

Recommended actions:

Hardware fault - contact the supplier of the drive.

Trip User 24V


Value 91
Short description

This trip is initiated if User Supply Select (06.072) = 1 or Low Under Voltage Threshold Select (06.067) = 1 or Backup Supply Mode Enable (06.068) = 1 and no user
24V present on the user 24V input.

Recommended actions:

Ensure that the user 24V supply is present on the control terminals.

Trip User Prog Trip


Value 96
Short description

This trip can be initiated from within an onboard user program using a function call which defines the sub-trip number.

Recommended actions:

Check the user program.

Trip User Program


Value 249
Short description

An error has been detected in the onboard user program image. The sub-trip indicated the reason for the trip.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 643
Sub-trip Reason Comments
1 Divide by zero
2 Undefined trip
Attempted fast parameter access set-up with non-existent
3
parameter
4 Attempted access to non-existent parameter
5 Attempted write to read-only parameter
6 Attempted an over-range write
7 Attempted read from write-only parameter

The image has failed because either its CRC is incorrect,


Occurs when the drive powers-up or the image is
30 or there are less than 6 bytes in the image or the image
programmed. The image tasks will not run.
header version is less than 5.
The image requires more RAM for heap and stack than
31 As 30.
can be provided by the drive.
The image requires an OS function call that is higher than
32 As 30.
the maximum allowed.
33 The ID code within the image is not valid As 30.

The timed task has not completed in time and has been Onboard User Program: Enable (11.047) is reset
40
suspended. to zero when the trip is initiated.
Undefined function called, i.e. a function in the host
41 As 40.
system vector table that has not been assigned.

52 Customisable menu table CRC check failed As 30.


Occurs when the drive powers-up or the image is
programmed and the table has changed. Defaults
53 Customisable menu table changed are loaded for the user program menu and the trip
will keep occurring until drive parameters are
saved.

80 *Image is not compatible with the control board Initiated from within the image code.
*Image is not compatible with the control board serial
81 As 80.
number

Image has detected and prevented attempted pointer


100
access outside of the IEC task's heap area.
Image has detected and prevented misaligned pointer
101
usage.
Image has detected an array bounds violation and
102
prevented its access.
Image has attempted to convert a data type to or from an
103
unknown data type, has failed and has shut itself down.
Image has attempted to use an unknown user service
104
function.

User program has invoked a "divide" service with a


denominator of zero. (Note that this is raised by the
200 downloaded image and has therefore been given a
distinct error code despite being the same fundamental
problem as sub-trip 1.)
Parameter access is not supported. An attempt to read
201
database other than the host drive.
Parameter does not exist. Database was host drive but
202
the specified parameter does not exist.
203 Parameter is read-only.
204 Parameter is write-only.
205 Unknown parameter error.
Invalid bit present in parameter. The parameter does not
206
contain the specified bit.
Parameter format lookup failed. Failed to get parameter
207
information data.
208 An over-range write has been attempted.

The following table gives the differences when compared to the derivative product image.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


644 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Sub-trip Difference
40, 41 Onboard User Program: Enable (11.047) is reset to zero when the trip is initiated.
51 Not applicable as core menu customisation not allowed
6x Not applicable as option module restrictions not allowed
7x Not applicable as option module restrictions not allowed
100 Image has detected and prevented attempted pointer access outside of the IEC task's heap area.
101 Image has detected and prevented misaligned pointer usage.
102 Image has detected an array bounds violation and prevented its access.
Image has attempted to convert a data type to or from an unknown data type, has failed and has shut itself
103
down.
104 Image has attempted to use an unknown user service function.
User program has invoked a "divide" service with a denominator of zero. (Note that this is raised by the
200 downloaded image and has therefore been given a distinct error code despite being the same fundamental
problem as sub-trip 1.)

Trip User Save


Value 36
Short description

This trip indicates that an error has been detected in the user save parameters saved in non-volatile memory. For example, following a user save command, if the
power to the drive was removed when the user parameters were being saved.

Recommended actions:

Perform a user save in Pr mm.000 to ensure that the trip doesn't occur the next time the drive is powered up.
Ensure that the drive has enough time to complete the save before removing the power to the drive.

Trip User Trip 40


Value 40
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 41


Value 41
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 42


Value 42
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 43


Value 43
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 44


Value 44
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 45


Value 45
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 46


Value 46
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 47


Value 47
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 645
Trip User Trip 48
Value 48
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 49


Value 49
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 50


Value 50
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 51


Value 51
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 52


Value 52
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 53


Value 53
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 54


Value 54
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 55


Value 55
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 56


Value 56
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 57


Value 57
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 58


Value 58
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 59


Value 59
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 60


Value 60
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


646 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Trip User Trip 61
Value 61
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 62


Value 62
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 63


Value 63
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 64


Value 64
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 65


Value 65
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 66


Value 66
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 67


Value 67
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 68


Value 68
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 69


Value 69
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 70


Value 70
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 71


Value 71
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 72


Value 72
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 73


Value 73
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 647
Trip User Trip 74
Value 74
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 75


Value 75
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 76


Value 76
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 77


Value 77
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 78


Value 78
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 79


Value 79
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 80


Value 80
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 81


Value 81
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 82


Value 82
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 83


Value 83
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 84


Value 84
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 85


Value 85
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 86


Value 86
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


648 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Trip User Trip 87
Value 87
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 88


Value 88
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 89


Value 89
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 112


Value 112
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 113


Value 113
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 114


Value 114
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 115


Value 115
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 116


Value 116
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 117


Value 117
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 118


Value 118
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 119


Value 119
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 120


Value 120
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 121


Value 121
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 649
Trip User Trip 122
Value 122
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 123


Value 123
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 124


Value 124
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 125


Value 125
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 126


Value 126
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 127


Value 127
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 128


Value 128
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 129


Value 129
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 130


Value 130
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 131


Value 131
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 132


Value 132
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 133


Value 133
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 134


Value 134
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


650 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Trip User Trip 135
Value 135
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 136


Value 136
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 137


Value 137
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 138


Value 138
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 139


Value 139
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 140


Value 140
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 141


Value 141
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 142


Value 142
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 143


Value 143
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 144


Value 144
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 145


Value 145
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 146


Value 146
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 147


Value 147
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 651
Trip User Trip 148
Value 148
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 149


Value 149
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 150


Value 150
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 151


Value 151
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 152


Value 152
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 153


Value 153
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 154


Value 154
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 155


Value 155
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 156


Value 156
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 157


Value 157
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 158


Value 158
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip User Trip 159


Value 159
Short description

This trip is not used by the drive and can be used for a user trip.

Trip Voltage Range


Value 169
Short description

This trip is initiated if the Regen Maximum Voltage (03.027) is set to a non-zero value and the supply voltage is outside the range defined
by Regen Minimum Voltage (03.026) and Regen Maximum Voltage (03.027) for more than 100ms.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


652 Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00)
Sub-trip Reason
1 Supply voltage is below Regen Minimum Voltage (03.026)
2 Supply voltage is above Regen Maximum Voltage (03.027)

Recommended actions:

Ensure the supply voltage is operating within the drive specification.


Ensure Regen Minimum Voltage (03.026) and Regen Maximum Voltage (03.027) are set correctly.
Check the supply voltage waveform using an oscilloscope.
Reduce the level of supply disturbance.
Set Regen Maximum Voltage (03.027) to zero to disable this trip.

Trip Watchdog
Value 30
Short description

This trip indicates that the control word watchdog has been enabled and has timed out.

Unidrive M700 Parameter Reference Guide


Issue: 01.21.00 (Ethernet 02.09.00) 653

You might also like